Professional Documents
Culture Documents
Honors Geometry Solutions Manual
Honors Geometry Solutions Manual
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 009 12 11 10 09 08 07 06 05 04 03
CONTENTS
Chapter 1 Points, Lines, Planes, and Angles. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 1
Chapter 2 Reasoning and Proof . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 24
Chapter 3 Parallel and Perpendicular Lines. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54
Chapter 4 Congruent Triangles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85
Chapter 5 Relationships in Triangles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .120
Chapter 6 Proportions and Similarity . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .151
Chapter 7 Right Triangles and Trigonometry. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 189
Chapter 8 Quadrilaterals. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 238
Chapter 9 Transformations. . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 289
Chapter 10 Circles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 345
Chapter 11 Areas of Polygons and Circles . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 383
Chapter 12 Surface Area . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .. 411
Chapter 13 Volume………………………………………………………...447
Prerequisite Skills …………………………………………………………477
Extra Practice………………………………………………………………502
Mixed Problem Solving and Proof…………………………………………567
Chapter 1 Points, Lines, Planes, and Angles
Page 5 Getting Started 2. See students’ work; sample answer: Two lines
1–4. intersect at a point.
y
3. Micha; the points must be noncollinear to
D( 1, 2) determine a plane.
4. Sample answers: line p; plane R
B(4, 0) 5. Sample answer: y
O x
A(3, 2)
C( 4, 4) W
x
O
5. 3
3 6 3 X
4 8 8 8 Z
9 1
8 18
5
Y
1 37 4
1
16 5 8 ¬ 16 8
6. 2
37 82 6.
¬16 16
r
P
119 7
¬16 ¬7 16 s
9
7. 7 9
14 Q
8 16 ¬ 16 16
5 7. There are six planes: plane ABC, plane AGE,
¬16
plane CDE, plane BCD, plane FAB, and plane
8. 11 1 7 23 15
2 9 16 ¬ 2 16
1
DEF.
184 15 1
¬16 16
8. A, K, B or B, J, C
33 9. No; A, C, and J lie in plane ABC, but D does not.
¬ 1
16 2 16
10. line 11. point 12. plane
9. 2 17 15
10. 23 (14)¬ 23 14
37 Pages 9–11 Practice and Apply
11. [7 (2)]2¬ (7 2)2 13. n 14. F
(5)2 25 15. R 16. W
12. 92 132¬ 81 169
17. Sample answer: PR
250
13. P¬ 4s 18. Yes, it intersects both m and n when all three
4(5) 20 lines are extended.
The perimeter is 20 in. 19. (D, 9) 20. Charlotte
14. P¬ 2 2w 21.
B
¬ 2(6) 2 21
2
¬ 12 5 17 W
The perimeter is 17 ft. Q
15. P¬ 2 2w A
2(4.8) 2(7.5)
9.6 15 24.6 22.
The perimeter is 24.6 m. R
W
T
23. Sample answer:
1-1 Points, Lines, and Planes
y
1 Chapter 1
24. Sample answer: 36. Sample answer: points E, A, and B are coplanar,
y but points E, A, B, and C are not.
37.
AC 38. point
C R 39. lines 40. plane
41. plane
P
D 42. two planes intersecting in a line
43. point 44. intersecting lines
S O x 45. point 46. line
47.
25.
a
b
c
48.
26. a
F b
V
c
27. s
49. See students’ work.
C r 50. Sample answer: the image is rotated so that the
D front or back plane is not angled.
M 51. Sample answer:
28. s
A
B C
Chapter 1 2
57. B; 2 x 2 x
2x22x2 1-2 Linear Measure and Precision
x x
x x x x
2x 0 Page 16 Check for Understanding
Thus, x must be 0. 1. Align the 0 point on the ruler with the leftmost
58. y endpoint of the segment. Align the edge of the
ruler along the segment. Note where the
rightmost endpoint falls on the scale and read
the closest eighth of an inch measurement.
2. Sample answers: rectangle, square, equilateral
triangle
3. Each inch on the ruler is divided into eighths.
O x Point Q is closer to the 16
8 -inch mark. Thus, PQ is
about 16
or 13 inches long.
8 4
a line 4. The long marks on the ruler are centimeters, and
59. y the shorter marks are millimeters. There are
10 millimeters for each centimeter. Thus, the bee
is 13 millimeters or 1.3 centimeters long.
O x 5. The measurement is precise to within 0.5 meter.
So, a measurement of 14 meters could be 13.5 to
14.5 meters.
1
6. The measuring tool is divided into 4-inch
increments. Thus, the measurement is precise
to within 1
1 1
2 4 or 8 inch. Therefore, the
part of the coordinate plane above the line measurement could be between 31 1
4 8 38
1
y 2x 1 inches and 31 1 3
4 8 3 8 inches.
60. 1
4 1 3
2 8 , so 2 in. 8 in. 7. EG EF FG
4
61. 1 4 1 EG 2.4 1.3
4 16 , so 16 in. 4 in. EG 3.7
8
62. 4 4 6
5 10 , so 5 in. 10 in. G
So, E is 3.7 centimeters long.
63. 10 mm 1 cm 8. XY YZ¬ XZ
64. 2.5 cm 25 mm, so 2.5 cm 28 mm XY 15
8 ¬ 3
65. 0.025 cm 0.25 mm, so 0.025 cm 25 mm XY 15 5 5
8 1 8 ¬ 3 1 8
3
XY¬ 18
3
Y
So, X is 18 inches long.
Page 12 Reading Mathematics
9.
1. Points P, Q, and R lie on . Point T is not collinear 5x 3x
with P, Q, and R. 15
2. Planes F, G, and H intersect at line j. N L M
3. The intersection of planes W, X, Y, and Z is NL 5x¬ 15
point P. 5x 15
4. 5 ¬ 5
A x¬ 3
B LM 3x
C LM 3(3)
LM 9
10. 30
6x 5 2x 3
N L M
NM¬ NL LM
30¬ 6x 5 2x 3
30¬ 8x 2
30 2¬ 8x 2 2
32¬ 8x
3
2 8
x
8 ¬ 8
3 Chapter 1
4¬ x XZ 5
4
LM 2x 3
So, X is 5
Z 1
4 or 1 4 inches long.
LM 2(4) 3 8 3
LM 11 24. PR¬ PQ QR
C
11. BC D because they both have length
5
21
4 ¬ 16 QR
10 inches. 9 5
16 ¬
5
16 QR
5
4 16
E
BE D because they both have length 8 inches. 36 5
A
BD A because they both have length 16 16 ¬ QR
14.4 inches. 31
16 ¬ QR
31 15
So, QR is
16 or 1 16 inches long.
Pages 17–19 Practice and Apply 25. RT¬ RS ST
12. Each inch on the ruler is divided into sixteenths. 4.0¬ 1.2 ST
Point B is closer to the 1 5
B
-inch mark. Thus, A 4.0 1.2¬ 1.2 ST 1.2
16 2.8¬ ST
5
is about 1 inches long.
16 T
So, S is 2.8 centimeters long.
13. The long marks on the ruler are centimeters, and
26. WY WX XY
the shorter marks are millimeters. Point D is
4.8 WX WX X
W is congruent to X
Y
.
closer to the 45-millimeter mark. Thus, C D
is
4.8 2WX
about 45 millimeters or 4.5 centimeters long.
4.8 2WX
2 2
14. The long marks on the ruler are centimeters, and
the shorter marks are millimeters. The right end 2.4 WX
of the key is closer to the 33-millimeter mark. X
So, W is 2.4 centimeters long.
Thus, the key is about 33 millimeters or 27. AD¬ AB BC CD
3.3 centimeters long.
33
4 ¬ BC BC BC A
B is congruent to B
C
15. Each inch on the ruler is divided into sixteenths.
D
and C is congruent to BC.
The right tip of the paperclip is closer to the 33
4 4 4 ¬ 3BC
1 -inch mark. Thus, the paperclip is about 1
16
1
or 14 inches long.
16
1
1
5 1
3 4 3 (3BC)
16. The measurement is precise to within 1
2 inch. So,
15
12 ¬ BC
a measurement of 80 inches could be 79 1 1
2 to 80 2 C is 1 3 1
So, B 12 or 14 inches long.
inches.
28. 7a 12a
17. The measurement is precise to within 0.5
millimeter. So, a measurement of 22 millimeters 28
could be 21.5 to 22.5 millimeters. R S T
18. The measuring tool is divided into 1 RS 7a¬ 28
2 -inch
7a 28
increments. Thus, the measurement is precise to ¬
7 7
within 1
1 1
2 2 or 4 inch. Therefore, the a¬ 4
measurement could be between 161 1 1
2 4 16 4
ST 12a
1 1 3
inches and 162 4 164 inches. ST 12(4)
19. The measurement is precise to within 0.5 ST 48
centimeter. So, a measurement of 308 centimeters 29.
could be between 307.5 and 308.5 centimeters. 34
Chapter 1 4
30. 25 34. yes; AB CD 3 cm
35. no; EF 6 ft and FG 8 ft
2x 3x 36. no; NP 1.75 in. and LM 0.75 in.
37. yes; WX XY 6 m
R S T 38. not from the information given
RT¬ RS ST 39. yes; TR¬ 3(a b) 3c 3a 3b 3c
25¬ 2x 3x SU¬ 3a 3(b c) 3a 3b 3c
25¬ 5x 40. The width of a music CD is 12 centimeters.
5
2 5x
5 ¬ 5 41. F
C D G, AB
H I, C
E
E D
E FE G
5¬ x 42. 144 cm3; 343 mL could be actually as much as
ST¬ 3x 343.5 mL and 200 mL as little as 199.5 mL;
ST¬ 3(5) 343.5 199.5 144.
ST¬ 15
43. The lengths of the bars are given in tenths of
31. 5x 10 millions, and 0.1 million 100,000. So the graph
is precise to within 50,000 visitors.
16 2x
44. 50,000 0.05 million, so a measurement of 98.5
million could be 98.45 million to 98.55 million
R S T visitors.
RT¬ RS ST 45. No; the number of visitors to Washington state
5x 10¬ 16 2x parks could be as low as 46.35 million or as high
5x 10 10¬ 16 2x 10 as 46.45 million. The visitors to Illinois state
5x¬ 6 2x parks could be as low as 44.45 million or as high
5x 2x¬ 6 2x 2x as 44.55 million visitors. The difference in visitors
3x¬ 6 could be as high as 2.0 million.
3x 6
3 3
46. 12.5 cm; Each measurement is accurate within
x¬ 2 0.5 cm, so the least perimeter is 2.5 cm 4.5 cm
ST¬ 2x 5.5 cm.
ST¬ 2(2) 47. 15.5 cm; Each measurement is accurate within
ST¬ 4 0.5 cm, so the greatest perimeter is 3.5 cm
32. 5.5 cm 6.5 cm.
21
48.
E
3y 1 2y F
EF 4(CD)
R S T
49. 2(CD)
RT¬ RS ST
21¬ 3y 1 2y E
F
21¬ 5y 1
21 1¬ 5y 1 1 3(AB)
20¬ 5y 50a. 2 50b. 5 50c. 7
0
2 5y
5 ¬ 5 51. Sample answer: Units of measure are used to
4¬ y differentiate between size and distance, as well as
ST¬ 2y for accuracy. Answers should include the
ST¬ 2(4) following.
ST¬ 8 • When a measurement is stated, you do not
33. 5y
know the precision of the instrument used to
make the measure. Therefore, the actual
4y 1 2y 1 measure could be greater or less than that
stated.
• You can assume equal measures when
R S T segments are shown to be congruent.
RT¬ RS ST
allowab
le error 0.5
ft
5y¬ 4y 1 2y 1 52. measure
27 ft 0.019 or 1.9%
5y¬ 6y 2 allowab
le error 0.25in.
5y 2¬ 6y 2 2 53. measure
14.5 in. 0.017 or 1.7%
5y 2¬ 6y allowab
le error 0.05cm
5y 2 5y¬ 6y 5y 54. measure
42.3 cm 0.001 or 0.1%
2¬ y allowab
le error 0.05km
55. 63.7 km 0.0008 or 0.08%
ST¬ 2y 1 measure
ST¬ 2(2) 1 56. B; 5(12 in.) 60 in. or 5 ft
ST¬ 3
5 Chapter 1
57. D; forty percent are jazz tapes so sixty percent are
blues tapes; 0.60(80) 48. 1-3 Distance and Midpoints
S R T (1, 5)
TS¬ RS TR 4. d ¬(x 2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
Chapter 1 6
2. Sample answer: 4 2x 6 2x
12. B; M(7, 8) M , 2 2
P 4 2x 6 2x
7 8
2 2
14 4 2x 16 6 2x
7 mm 7 mm 10 2x 10 2x
A M B 5x 5x
Q
Pages 25–27 Practice and Apply
3. AB |2 10| 13. DE ¬|2 4| 14. CF ¬|0 7|
|8| or 8 ¬|2| or 2 ¬|7| or 7
4. CD |3 4| 15. AB ¬|4 (1)| 16. AC ¬|4 0|
|7| or 7 ¬|3| or 3 ¬|4| or 4
5. 17. AF ¬|4 7| 18. BE ¬|1 4|
y
¬|11| or 11 ¬|5| or 5
12 X
19. y
8
8 B
Y 4
W
x
x
8 4 A 4 X
8 4 4 8
4
DE ¬(8 2
)2 (6
0)2 ¬
62 62
DE ¬36 36 D
DE ¬72
DE ¬8.49
10 (2)
7. M 2 C
12 X
2
6 x 0
3 6 (CD)2 (CX)2 (DX)2
8. M 2
(CD)2 (3)2 (4)2
3
2 or 1.5 (CD)2 25
x1 x2 y1 y2 4 (1) 3 5 CD 5
9. , ,
2 2 2 2 21. y
5 8
2, 2 or (2.5, 4) 12
F
x1 x2 y1 y2 2 (2) 8 2
10. , ,
2 2 2
2 8
(0, 5) 4
x1 (3) y1 6
11. B(0, 5.5) B
2
,
2 8 8
x
x1 (3) y1 6 E X
0 5.5 4
2 2
0 x1 (3) 11 y1 6
3 x1 5 y1 (EF)2 (EX)2 (FX)2
The coordinates of A are (3, 5) (EF)2 (5)2 (12)2
(EF)2 169
EF 13
7 Chapter 1
22. y H 30. d ¬
(x2 x 2
1) (y 2 y
1)
2
8
AB ¬ [5 (4)]2 [1 2
(3)]
4 AB ¬(1)
2 4
2 1 16
x AB ¬ 17
8 4 0 4 8 Because the figure is a square, the four sides
are congruent. So the perimeter of the square is
417 16.5 units.
G8 X
6 0 2 8
31. M ¬ 2
32. M ¬ 2
6 10
(GH)2 (GX)2 (HX)2 ¬2 ¬2
(GH)2 (8)2 (15)2 ¬3 ¬5
(GH)2 289 0 5 3 2
GH 17 33. M ¬ 2 34. M ¬2
d ¬
(x2 x ¬5 ¬ 1
2 or 0.5
1) (
y2 y 2 or 2.5
23. 2 2
1)
JK ¬
(12
0)2
(9 0
)2
122
92 6 8 3 5
35. M ¬ 2
36. M ¬ 2
JK ¬225
15 2
¬2 ¬2
2
24. d ¬
(x2
x1)2 (y2
y1)2 ¬1 ¬1
LM ¬
(7 3)
2 (9 5)2
42 42 x1 x2 y1 y2 8 12 4 2
LM ¬ 32
16 16
37. , ¬ 2, 2
2 2
LM ¬5.7
2
¬
0 6
2 , 2
25. d ¬
(x2 x
1) (
2 y2 y
1)
2
¬(10, 3)
ST ¬[6 (
3)]2
(5
2)2 x1 x2 y1 y2 9 17 5 4
ST ¬9 2 3
2 81 9
38. , ¬ 2, 2
2 2
ST ¬90 ¬2 , 2
26 9
NP ¬
[3 (2)] 2
[4
(2)]2 x1 x2 y1 y2 4 8 2 (6)
NP ¬5 2 6
2
25 36
40. , ¬ 2, 2
2 2
NP ¬61 ¬2 , 2
12
4
NP ¬7.8 ¬(6, 2)
28. d ¬
(x2 x 2
1) (y 2 y
1)
2
x1 x2 y1 y2 3.4 7.8 2.1 3.6
QR ¬[1 5)]2
( (5
3)2
41. , ¬ 2, 2
2 2
QR ¬ 6 2
2 2 36 4
11
¬
.2
2 , 2
5.7
QR ¬ 40 ¬(5.6, 2.85)
QR ¬6.3 x x y y 1.4 2.6
3.2 (5.4)
29. d ¬(x2 x1) (
2 y2 y1)
2
42.
1
2
,
1
2
2
¬ 2,
2
2
2
XY ¬[2 (2)]
2 [5 (1)]2 ¬2 , 2
1.2
.2
XY ¬4 2 6
2 16 36 ¬(0.6, 1.1)
XY ¬52 x1 (4) y1 3
YZ ¬(4 2)2 (3 5)2
43. S(1, 5) 2
,
2
x1 (4) y1 3
YZ ¬2 (
2 2)
2 44 1 ¬ 5 ¬
2 2
YZ ¬8 2 ¬x1 (4) 10 ¬y1 3
XZ ¬[4 (
2)]2 [3 (1)]2 2 ¬x1 7 ¬y1
XZ ¬6
2 42 36 16 The coordinates of R are (2, 7).
x 2 y 8
XZ ¬52 44. S(2, 2)
1
,
1
2 2
XY YZ XZ 52 8 52 x1 2 y 8
17.3 units 2 ¬ 2 ¬ 1
2 2
4 ¬x1 2 4 ¬y1 8
6 ¬x1 4 ¬y1
The coordinates of R are (6, 4).
Chapter 1 8
2 x2 5 y 52. The new coordinates are A(3, 9), B(18, 30), and
45. S 5
3
3, 3
2 , 2
2 C(33, 54).
2 x2 d ¬ (x2 x
1) (
2 y2 y
1)
2
5 y
5 ¬
3
3 2 3 ¬2 AB ¬ (18 3)
2 (30 9)2
2
10
¬2 x2 6 ¬5 y2 AB ¬ 15
2 21
2 225 441
3 3
AB ¬ 666
8 ¬x2 11 ¬y2
3 BC ¬ (33 18)2 (54 30)2
The coordinates of T are 8
3 , 11 . BC ¬ 15
2 24
2 225 576
x1 31.8 y1 106.4
46. M(31.1, 99.3) ,
2 2 BC ¬ 801
x1 31.8 y1 106.4 AC ¬ (33 3)2 (54 9)2
31.1 ¬ 99.3 ¬
2 2 AC ¬ 302 452 900 2025
62.2 ¬x1 31.8 198.6 ¬y1 106.4 AC ¬ 2925
30.4 ¬x1 92.2 ¬y1 The perimeter of ABC is 666
801
The other endpoint is at (30.4°, 92.2°). 2925, which is approximately 108.2 units.
53. Sample answer: The perimeter increases by the
47. LaFayette, LA is near (30.4°, 92.2°). same factor.
48. Sample answer: SQRT((A2 C2) 2
x1 x2 y1 y2 26 66
(B2 D2) 2)
54a. F
, F 2, 2
2 2
49a. (54 113)2 (12 2 111.8
0 215)
F2, 2 or F(4, 6)
8 1 2
49b. (68 175)
2 (153 336)2 212.0
49c. (421 502) 2 (45 2 353.4
4 798) x1 x2 y1 y2 66 62
49d. (837 612)2 (980 62
5)2 420.3
E
2 2
, E 2, 2
49e. (1967 1998) 2 2 37.4
(3 24) E2, 2 or E(6, 4)
12 8
49f.
(4173.5 2080.6) (3
2 2 2092.9
4.9 22.4) 54b. G(4, 4); it has the same x-coordinate as F and
d ¬(x
the same y-coordinate as E.
2 x
1) (y 2 y
50. 2 2
1)
AB ¬ (6 1) 2 (10 3)2 G
54c. D G B ; use the Distance Formula to show
DG GB.
AB ¬5 2 7
2 25 49
d ¬(x 2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
AB ¬ 74
DG ¬(4 2)2 (4 2)2
BC ¬ (11 6)2 (18 10)2
DG ¬2 2
2 2 44
BC ¬5 2 8
2 25 64
DG ¬8
BC ¬ 89
GB ¬(6 4
)2 (6 4)2
AC ¬ (11 1) 2 (18 3)2
GB ¬2 2
2 2 44
AC ¬10 2 15
2 100 225
GB ¬8
AC ¬ 325
Thus, DG GB.
The perimeter of ABC is 74 89
325
,
which is approximately 36.1 units. 55. 1 1
4 (x2 x1) 4 [5 (3)]
51. The new coordinates are A(2, 6), B(12, 20), 1
4 (8) 2
C(22, 36).
1(y2 y1) 1[12 (8)]
d ¬(x 2 x1) (y
2 2 y1)
2 4 4
AB ¬(12 2)2 (20 6)2 1
4 (20) 5
9 Chapter 1
56. Sample answer: You can copy the segment 66. 12m 7 ¬3m 52
onto a coordinate plane and then use either the 12m ¬3m 45
Pythagorean Theorem or the Distance Formula 9m ¬45
to find its length. Answers should include the m ¬5
following. 67. 8x 7 ¬5x 20
• To use the Pythagorean Theorem, draw a 8x ¬5x 13
vertical segment from one endpoint and a 3x ¬13
horizontal segment from the other endpoint 1
x ¬ 3
to form a triangle. Use the measures of these 3
68. 13n 18 ¬5n 32
segments as a and b in the formula
13n ¬5n 50
a2 b2 c2. Then solve for c. To use the
8n ¬50
Distance Formula, assign the coordinates of the 50
n ¬ 8 or 6.25
endpoints of the segment as (x1, y1) and (x2, y2).
Then use them in d (x 2 x
1) (
2 y2 y 2
1) to
find the length of the segment. Page 28 Geometry Activity: Modeling the
• 61 7.8 units Pythagorean Theorem
57. B; d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
1. 25, 144, 169
d ¬(2 6)2
(4
11)2 2. 25 144 169
d ¬(8)
2
(15)2 3. a2, b2, c2
d ¬64 2
25 4. The formula for the Pythagorean Theorem can
d ¬289 be expressed as a2 b2 c2.
d ¬17 5. All of these fit the a2 b2 c2 pattern.
58. A 6. The number of grid squares is 52 52, which is
50 grid squares.
A T
n S R
m QPR 60
P Q m QPT 90
63. 2k ¬5k 30 mA mZ
3. m QPS 120
3k ¬30
4. C
k ¬10
5.
BA,
BC
64. 14x 31 ¬12x 8
14x ¬12x 39 6. CDB, 1
2x ¬39 7. 135°; 135 90 and 135 180 so WXY is obtuse.
39
x ¬
2 or 19.5 8. 45°; 45 90 so WXZ is acute.
65. 180 8t ¬90 2t
90 8t ¬2t
90 ¬10t
9 ¬t
Chapter 1 10
9.
QT bisects RQS, so RQT SQT. 35.
YT bisects XYW, so 1 2.
mRQT mSQT m1 ¬m2
6x 5 ¬7x 2 5x 10 ¬8x 23
6x 7 ¬7x 5x 33 ¬8x
7 ¬x 33 ¬3x
mRQT 6x 5 11 ¬x
6(7) 5 m2 ¬8x 23
42 5 or 47 ¬8(11) 23
10. QT bisects RQS, so RQT TQS and ¬88 23
mRQS 2 mRQT. ¬65
36. YT bisects XYW, so mXYW 2 m1.
22a 11 ¬2(12a 8)
6y 24 ¬2y
22a 11 ¬24a 16
24 ¬4y
22a 5 ¬24a
6 ¬y
5 ¬2a
37.
YU bisects WYZ, so mWYZ 2 mZYU.
5 ¬a
2 82 ¬2(4r 25)
mTQS m RQT 82 ¬8r 50
12a 8 32 ¬8r
12 5
2 8
4 ¬r
bisects ZYW, so ZYU UYW, and
38. YU
30 8 or 22
mZYU mUYW.
11. 1, right; 2, acute; 3, obtuse
and YZ
YX are opposite rays, so
mWYX mUYW mZYU ¬180.
Pages 34–35 Practice and Apply
2(12b 7) 9b 1 9b 1 ¬180
12. E 13. B 14. A
24b 14 18b 2 ¬180
15. A A
16. D
, DB 17. A,
B AD 42b 12 ¬180
18.
ED, EG
19. AD, AE 20. ABC, CBA 42b ¬168
21. FEA, 4 b ¬4
22. 2, DBA, EBA, ABE, FBA, ABF mUYW mZYU
9b 1
23. AED, DEA, AEB, BEA, AEC, CEA
9(4) 1
24. D, H 25. 2 36 1 or 35
26. Sample answer: 4, 3 39.
YU bisects ZYW, so mZYU 1 2 mZYW.
27. bisects EAB so 5 6.
AD
1 mZYU ¬1
2 mZYW
m5 ¬mEAB
2 13a 7 ¬1
2 (90)
1
¬(60) 13a 7 ¬45
2
¬30 13a ¬52
m6 ¬m5 a ¬4
¬30 40. The angle at which the dogs must turn to get the
28. BFD is marked with a right angle symbol, so scent of the article they wish to find is an acute angle.
mBFD 90; BFD is a right angle. 41. Sample answer: Acute can mean something that
29. 60°; 60 90, so AFB is acute. is sharp or having a very fine tip like a pen, a
30. 30°; 30 90, so DFE is acute. knife, or a needle. Obtuse means not pointed or
blunt, so something that is obtuse would be wide.
31. 90°; EFC is a right angle.
36
0
32. 150°; 150 90 and 150 180, so AFD is obtuse. 42. m1 6 60
36
0
33. 120°; 120 90 and 120 180, so EFB is obtuse. m2
12 30
34.
YU bisects ZYW, so ZYU UYW. 36
0
m3 4 90
mZYU ¬mUYW 36
0
m4 6 60
8p 10 ¬10p 20
8p 10 ¬10p 36
0
m5 3 120
10 ¬2p 36
0
m6 6 60
5 ¬p
mZYU ¬8p 10
8(5) ¬10
40 ¬10 or 30
11 Chapter 1
43. m(angle of reflection) ¬1
2 mIBR
d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y 2 y
54. 2 2
1)
1
¬2(62) EF ¬
[5
(3)]2
[8 2
(2)]
¬31
EF ¬ 2
82 10
64 100
BN is at a right angle to the barrier.
So mIBA 90 31 or 59. EF ¬164
44. You can only compare the measures of the angles. EF ¬12.8
x x y y
The arcs indicate both measures are the same
regardless of the length of the rays.
M ¬
1
2
2 1
, 2
2
3 5 2 8
45. 1, 3, 6, 10, 15 ¬2, 2
46. 3 rays: (3
2) 2 3 angles;
¬2, 2 or (1, 3)
2 6
4 rays: (4
3) 2 6 angles;
5 rays: (5
4) 2 10 angles; 55. WX WR RX
6 rays: (6
5) 2 15 angles 5 1
WX 3
12 6 4
47. 7 rays: (7
6) 2 ¬21 angles
8 2
10 rays: (10
9) 2 ¬45 angles WX 9 12 or 9 3
n(n 1)
48. a 2, for a number of angles and WX is 92
3 ft long.
n number of rays
1 56. XZ ¬XY YZ
49. Sample answer: A degree is 360 of a circle. 15.1 ¬3.7 YZ
Answers should include the following. 11.4 ¬YZ
• Place one side of the angle to coincide with 0 on Z
Y is 11.4 mm long.
the protractor and the vertex of the angle at 57. 6x 5 2x 7
the center point of the protractor. Observe the
point at which the other side of the angle
intersects the scale of the protractor. P Q R
• See students’ work. PQ ¬QR
50. D 6x 5 ¬2x 7
6x ¬2x 12
51. C; 5n 4 ¬7(n 1) 2n
4x ¬12
5n 4 ¬7n 7 2n
x ¬3
5n 4 ¬5n 7
PQ ¬6x 5
4 ¬7
PQ ¬6(3) 5
PQ ¬18 5 or 13
Page 36 Maintain Your Skills 58. Five planes are shown: plane FJK, plane HJK,
plane GHK, plane FGK, and plane FGH.
52. d ¬(x
2 x1)2 (y
2 y
1)
2
59. F, L, J 60. G or L
AB ¬(5 2)2 (7
3)2
61. 14x (6x 10) ¬90
AB ¬3 4
2 2
20x 10 ¬90
AB ¬9 16 25 20x ¬100
AB ¬5 x ¬5
x x y y
2
M ¬
1
2 1
, 2
2
62. 2k 30 ¬180
2k ¬150
25 37
¬2, 2 k ¬75
63. 180 5y ¬90 7y
¬, or (3.5, 5)
7 10
2 2
90 5y ¬7y
90 ¬2y
53. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
45 ¬y
CD ¬
[6 (2)]2
(4
0)2 64.
1
90 4t ¬4 (180 t)
CD ¬
82
64 16
42 4(90 4t) ¬180 t
CD ¬80
360 16t ¬180 t
CD ¬8.9 180 16t ¬t
x x y y 180 ¬15t
2
M ¬
1
2 1
, 2
2
12 ¬t
2 6 0 4 (6m 8) (3m 10) ¬90
¬,
65.
2 2 9m 18 ¬90
¬, or (2, 2)
4 4 9m ¬72
2 2 m ¬8
66. (7n 9) (5n 45) ¬180
12n 36 ¬180
12n ¬144
n ¬12
Chapter 1 12
Page 36 Practice Quiz 2
x x y y 1-5 Angle Relationships
2
1. M ¬
1
2
,
1
2
2
3 (4) 1 3
¬,
2 2 Page 38 Geometry Activity: Angle Relationships
¬, or 1, 1
1 2 1. BCE DCA 2. DCB ACE
2 2 2 3. See students’ work.
d ¬
(x2 x
1) (
2 y2 y
1)
2
4. ACD and ECB, DCB and ACE; measures
AB ¬
(4
3)2 2
[3 (1)] for each pair of vertical angles should be the
same.
AB ¬(7)
2 42
49 16
5. ACD and DCB, DCB and BCE, BCE and
AB ¬65
ECA, ECA and ACD; measures for each
linear pair should add to 180.
AB ¬8.1
6. Sample answers: The measures of vertical angles
x x y y
2
2. M ¬
1
2
,
1
2
2
are equal or vertical angles are congruent.
The sum of the measures of a linear pair is 180 or
6 2 4 (8)
¬, angles that form a linear pair are supplementary.
2 2
8 4
¬, or (4, 2)
2 2
d ¬(x
Page 41 Check for Understanding
2 x
1) (y 2 y
2 2
1)
1.
CD ¬
(2 6
)2 (8 4)2
CD ¬
(4)2 2
(12)
16 144
70 110
CD ¬160
2. Sample answer: When two angles form a linear
CD ¬12.6 pair, then their noncommon sides form a straight
x x y y
2
3. M ¬
1
2
,
1
2
2 angle, which measures 180. When the sum of the
measures of two angles is 180, then the angles are
10 (10) 20 (20)
¬, supplementary.
2 2
3. Sample answer: The noncommon sides of a linear
¬(0, 0) pair of angles form a straight line.
d ¬
(x2 x
1) (
2 y2 y
1)
2 4. Sample answer: ABF and CBD are vertical
angles. They each have measures less than 90°, so
EF ¬(10
10)2
(
20 2
0)2 they are acute.
EF ¬(20)
2 (
40)2 5. Sample answer: ABC and CBE are adjacent
angles. They each have measures greater than
EF ¬
400
1600
90°, so they are obtuse.
EF ¬2000
6. Explore: The problem involves three angles: an
angle, its supplement, and its complement.
EF ¬44.7
Plan: Let A be the given angle, B its
4. mRXT ¬mSXT mRXS supplement and C the complement. Then
111 ¬3a 4 2a 5 mA mB 180 or mB 180 mA, and
111 ¬5a 1 mA mC 90 or mC 90 mA. The
110 ¬5a problem states that mB 3 mC 60, so
22 ¬a substitute for mB and mC and solve for mA.
mRXS 2a 5
Solve: mB ¬3 mC 60
2(22) 5
180 mA ¬3(90 mA) 60
44 5 or 49
180 mA ¬270 3 mA 60
5. mQXS ¬mQXR mRXS 180 2 mA ¬210
4a 1 ¬a 10 91 2 mA ¬30
4a 1 ¬a 101 mA ¬15
4a ¬a 102
Examine: Check to see if the answer satisfies the
3a ¬102
problem.
a ¬34
mQXS 4a 1 The measure of the complement of an angle with
4(34) 1 a measure of 15° is 75°. The measure of the
136 1 or 135 supplement of the original angle is 165°.
3 75 60 ¬165
165 ¬165
The answer checks.
13 Chapter 1
7. Lines p and q are perpendicular if angles 1 and 2 mSQR 9 4a
are both right angles. Then m1 m2 90. So 9 4(7)
3x 18 90 8y 70 90 9 28 or 37
3x 72 8y 160 Examine: Add the angle measures to verify their
x 24 y 20 sum is 90.
8. No; while SRT appears to be a right angle, no 53 37 90
information verifies this. 18. Explore: The problem relates the measures of two
9. Yes; they share a common side and vertex, so they complementary angles. You know that the sum of
R
are adjacent. Since P falls between P
Q
and P
S, the measures of complementary angles is 90.
mQPR 90, so the two angles cannot be Plan: The angles are complementary, so the sum
complementary or supplementary. of the measures of the angles is 90.
10. m4 60 and 2 and 4 are vertical angles, so Solve: 16z 9 4z 3 ¬90
m2 60. 20z 6 ¬90
1 and 4 are supplementary angles. 20z ¬96
m1 m4 ¬180 z ¬4.8
m1 60 ¬180 16z 9 ¬16(4.8) 9
m1 ¬120 ¬76.8 9 or 67.8
1 and 3 are vertical angles so m3 120. 4z 3 ¬4(4.8) 3
¬19.2 3 or 22.2
Examine: Add the angle measures to verify that
Pages 42–43 Practice and Apply the angles are complementary.
11. WUT and VUX are vertical angles. They each 67.8 22.2 90
have measures less than 90°, so they are acute. 19. Explore: The problem involves an angle and its
12. WUV and XUT are vertical angles. They each supplement. You know that the sum of the
have measures greater than 90°, so they are measures of two supplementary angles is 180.
obtuse. Plan: Let mT x. Its supplement has measure
13. ZWU is a right angle and ZWU and YWU 180 x. The problem also states that mT is 20
are supplementary so YWU is a right angle. more than four times its supplement.
Then UWT and TWY are adjacent angles that Solve: x ¬4(180 x) 20
are complementary because x ¬720 4x 20
mUWT mTWY mYWU. 5x ¬740
14. VXU and WYT are nonadjacent angles that x ¬148
are complementary because So mT 148.
mVXU mWYT 60 30 or 90. Examine: Check to see if the answer satisfies the
15. WTY and WTU is a linear pair with vertex T. problem.
If mT 148, its supplement has a measure of 32.
16. UVX
4
32 20 148
17. Explore: The problem relates the measures The answer checks.
formed by perpendicular rays.
20. Explore: The problem involves an angle and its
Plan: QP QR, so PQS and SQR are
supplement.
complementary.
Plan: Let the measure of one angle be x. Its
mPQS mSQR 90
supplement has measure 180 x. The problem
R states that the measure of the angle’s supplement
is 44 less than x.
Solve: 180 x ¬x 44
S
224 x ¬x
9 4a
224 ¬2x
112 ¬x
180 x ¬180 112 or 68
4 7a The measures of the angle and its supplement are
112 and 68.
Q P Examine: 112 44 68
Solve: 4 7a 9 4a ¬90 21. Explore: The problem involves an angle and its
13 11a ¬90 supplement.
11a ¬77 Plan: Let the measure of one angle be x. Its
a ¬7 supplement has measure 180 x. The problem
mPQS 4 7a states that one angle measures 12° more than
4 7(7) the other.
4 49 or 53
Chapter 1 14
Solve: x 12 ¬180 x 29. BFA and DFE are vertical angles so they have
x ¬168 x the same measure.
2x ¬168 3r 12 ¬8r 210
x ¬84 3r ¬8r 198
180 x 180 84 or 96 11r ¬198
The measures of the angle and its supplement are r ¬18
84 and 96. mBFA 3r 12
Examine: 96 84 12 3(18) 12
54 12 or 66
22. Explore: The problem states that m1 is five
BFA and AFE are adjacent supplementary
less than 4 m2 and 1 and 2 form a linear
angles, so mBFA mAFE 180.
pair. So m1 m2 180.
66 mAFE ¬180
Plan: Let m1 x.
mAFE ¬114
Solve: m1 m2 ¬180
x m2 ¬180 30. ¬L and M are complementary.
mL mM ¬90
4 m2 5 m2 ¬180
y 2 2x 3 ¬90
5 m2 ¬185
y 2x 1 ¬90
m2 ¬37
y 2x ¬89
m1 4 m2 5 y ¬89 2x
4(37) 5 N and P are complementary.
148 5 or 143
mN mP ¬90
Examine: 4(37) 5 ¬143 2x y x 1 ¬90
143 ¬143 3x y 1 ¬90
1 and 2 are supplementary because 3x y ¬91
143 37 180. y ¬91 3x
23. Always; the sum of two angles that each measure y ¬3x 91
less than 90° can never equal 180°, so if one angle Equate the two expressions for y and solve for x.
is acute the other must be obtuse. 89 2x ¬3x 91
24. Always; complementary angles are angles whose 180 2x ¬3x
measures have a sum of 90°, so each angle must 180 ¬5x
measure less than 90°. 36 ¬x
25. Sometimes; for example, consider the following: Now substitute the value of x into either
mA 90 expression for y and solve for y.
mB 90 y ¬3x 91
mC 90 y ¬3(36) 91
Then mA mB 180 and mB mC 180 y ¬108 91 or 17
and mA mC 180. mL ¬y 2
However, now consider mL ¬17 2 or 15
mA 100 mM ¬2x 3
mB 80 mM ¬2(36) 3
mC 100 mM ¬72 3 or 75
mA mB 180 and mB mC 180 but mN ¬2x y
mA mC 200, so A is not supplementary mN ¬2(36) 17
to C. mN ¬72 17 or 55
26. Never; PN and PQ
have point P in common and mP ¬x 1
form a right angle. NPQ is formed by P N
and mP ¬36 1 or 35
Q
P . Since P is the vertex, NPQ is a right angle. 31. Yes; the symbol denotes that DAB is a right
27. CF
FD if CFD is a right angle. So find a so angle.
that mCFD 12a 45 is equal to 90. 32. Yes; they are vertical angles.
12a 45 ¬90 33. Yes; the sum of their measures is mADC, which
12a ¬45 is 90.
a ¬3.75
34. No; there is no indication of the measures of these
28. mAFC ¬mAFB mBFC angles.
90 ¬8x 6 14x 8
35. No; we do not know mABC.
90 ¬22x 2
88 ¬22x 36. Sample answer: Complementary means serving to
4 ¬x fill out or complete, while complimentary means
given as a courtesy or favor. Complementary has
the mathematical meaning of an angle completing
the measure to make 90°.
15 Chapter 1
37. Sample answer: 52. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
1 EF ¬
[4
(2)]2
[1
0 (
10)]2
2
EF ¬
(2)2 202
EF ¬ 404
4 400
38. mAKB mBKC mCKD 20 25 45 or EF ¬20.1
90, so AKD is a right angle and A
KK D.
53. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
mDKE mEKF 60 30 or 90, so DKF is
a right angle and K K
D F. GH ¬
(6
7)2
(0 2)2
mEKF mFKG 30 60 or 90, so EKG is GH ¬(13)
2 (
2)2
a right angle and K K
E G.
GH ¬169
4 173
39. Because WUT and TUV are supplementary, GH ¬13.2
let mWUT x and mTUV 180 x. A
bisector creates measures that are half of the 54. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
Chapter 1 16
60. s ¬2 PS ¬[03)]
( 2 (4 4)2
4s ¬4(2) ¬ 3 0
2 2
¬8 ¬ 93
61. 3, w ¬8, s 2 Perimeter PQ QR RS PS
w ws ¬3 8 8 2 5 3 5 3 or 16 units
¬24 16 or 40 10. AB BC CD AD ¬95
62. 3, w ¬8, s 2 3a 2 2(a 1) 6a 4 5a 5 ¬95
s( w) ¬2(3 8) 3a 2 2a 2 6a 4 5a 5 ¬95
¬2(11) or 22 16a 1 ¬95
16a ¬96
a ¬6
Page 44 Geometry Activity: Constructing AB 3a 2 BC ¬2(a 1)
Perpendiculars 3(6) 2 ¬2(6 1)
1. See students’ work. 18 2 20 ¬2(5) 10
2. The first step of the construction locates two CD 6a 4 AD ¬5a 5
points on the line. Then the process is very similar 6(6) 4 ¬5(6) 5
to the construction through a point on a line. 36 4 40 ¬30 5 25
11. P 5s
5(921)
4605
1-6 Polygons The perimeter of the outside of the Pentagon is
4605 feet.
¬ 25 5
17 Chapter 1
24. The new side lengths are 3 and 1 units. The new VZ ¬ (2 3)2
(12 0)2
perimeter is 3 1 1 3 1 1 3 1 1 ¬(5)
2 (12) 2
3 1 1 or 20 units. The perimeter is divided by 2. ¬ 169 13
25. The length of each side is multiplied by 10, so 10 The perimeter is VW WX XY YZ VZ or
can be factored out of the sum of the sides. Thus 13 17 85 6 13 58.2 units.
the new perimeter is multiplied by 10 so the 29. There are 6 sides and all sides are congruent.
perimeter is 12.5(10) 125 m. All sides are 90
6 or 15 cm.
26. d ¬(x 2 x1) (y
2 2 y
1)
2
30. There are 4 sides and all sides are congruent.
AB ¬[31)]
( 2 (4 1)2 All sides are 14
4 or 3.5 mi.
¬4 3
2 2
31. P ¬x 1 x 7 3x 5
¬25 5 31 ¬5x 1
BC ¬(6) 3 2 (0 4)2 30 ¬5x
¬3 2 (4) 2
6 ¬x
¬25 5 x 1 ¬6 1 5
CD ¬ (2 6)2 ( 3 0)2 x 7 ¬6 7 13
¬(4)
2 (3) 2 3x 5 ¬3(6) 5 13
¬25 5 The sides are 13 units, 13 units, and 5 units.
AD ¬[2 (1)]2 (3 1)2 32. P ¬6x 3 8x 3 6x 4
¬3 2 (4) 2 84 ¬20x 4
80 ¬20x
¬25 5
4 ¬x
The perimeter is AB BC CD AD 5 5
6x 3 6(4) 3 21
5 5 or 20 units.
8x 3 8(4) 3 35
27. d ¬(x 2 x1) (y
2 2 y
1)
2
6x 4 6(4) 4 28
PQ ¬ [3 (2)] 2 (3 3)2 The sides are 21 m, 35 m, and 28 m.
¬5 2 02
33. P ¬2 2w
¬25 5 42 ¬2(3n 2) 2(n 1)
QR ¬ (7 3) 2 (0 3)2 42 ¬6n 4 2n 2
¬4 2 (3) 2
42 ¬8n 2
¬ 25 5 40 ¬8n
RS ¬ (3 7 )2 ( 3 0)2 5 ¬n
¬(4)
2 (3) 2 3n 2 ¬3(5) 2 17
¬25 5 n 1 ¬5 1 4
The sides are 4 in., 4 in., 17 in., and 17 in.
ST ¬ (2 3)2 [3 (3)]2
¬(5)
2 0 2 34. P ¬2x 1 2x x 2x
41 ¬7x 1
¬25 5
42 ¬7x
TU ¬ [6 (2)]2 [0 (3 )]2
6 ¬x
¬(4)
2 3 2
2x 1 ¬2(6) 1 11
¬25 5 2x ¬2(6) 12
PU ¬ [6 (2)]2 (0 3)2 The sides are 6 yd, 11 yd, 12 yd, and 12 yd.
¬(4)
2 (3) 2
35. 52 units; count the units in the figure.
¬25 5 36.
The perimeter is PQ QR RS ST TU PU 5 squares
or 5 5 5 5 5 5 30 units.
28. d ¬ (x2 x 1) (
2 y2 y1)
2 8 squares
VW ¬ (2 3)
2 (12 0)2
¬ (5)
2 12 2
¬ 289 17
36a. It is a square with side length of 3 units.
XY ¬ [8 (10)] 2 [12 (3)]2
36b. In Part a, the rectangle with the greatest
¬
2 (9)
2 2
number of squares was a square with side of 3
¬85
units. So if a rectangle has perimeter of 36 units,
YZ ¬ [2 (8)]2 [ 12 (12)]2 a square would have the largest area. The side of
¬6 2 02 36
this square would be 4 9 units.
¬36 6
Chapter 1 18
37. Sample answer: Some toys use pieces to form Page 52 Geometry Software Investigation:
polygons. Others have polygon-shaped pieces that Measuring Polygons
connect together. Answers should include the 1. The sum of the side measures equals the
following. perimeter.
• triangles, quadrilaterals, pentagons
2. 35.53 90.38 54.09 180
•
3. See students’ work.
4. Sample answer: When the lengths of the sides are
doubled, the perimeter is doubled.
5. See student’s work.
6. Sample answer: The sum of the measures of the
angles of a triangle is 180.
38. A square has four congruent sides. If one side 7. Sample answer: The sum of the measures of the
remains to be fenced, three sides have been angles of a quadrilateral is 360; pentagon 540;
fenced. So each side has length 1
3 (3x) or x meters.
hexagon 720.
39. D; 5n 5 ¬10 8. Sample answer: The sum of the measures of the
5n ¬5 angles of polygons increases by 180 for each
n ¬1 additional side.
11 n ¬11 1 10 9. yes; sample answer: triangle: 3 sides, angle
measure sum: 180; quadrilateral: 4 sides, angle
measure sum: 180 180 360; pentagon: 5 sides,
Page 50 Maintain Your Skills angle measure sum: 360 180 540; hexagon:
40. Always; true by the definitions of linear pairs and 6 sides, angle measure sum: 540 180 720
supplementary angles. 10. Yes; sample answer: If the sides of a polygon are
41. Sometimes; angles with measures 100 and 80 are a, b, c, and d, then its perimeter is a b c d.
supplementary but two right angles are also If each of the sides are increased by a factor of n
supplementary. then the sides measure na, nb, nc, and nd, and
42.
AM bisects RAL, so MAR MAL. the perimeter is na nb nc nd. By factoring,
mMAR ¬mMAL the perimeter is n(a b c d), which is the
2x 13 ¬4x 3 original perimeter increased by the same factor as
2x 16 ¬4x the sides.
16 ¬2x
8 ¬x
mRAL ¬mMAR mMAL Chapter 1 Study Guide and Review
¬2x 13 4x 3
¬2(8) 13 4(8) 3 or 58 Pages 53–56
43.
AM bisects RAL, so MAR LAM and 1. B
d; ABC
, so C
B is the midpoint of A .
mRAL ¬2 mMAR. 2. h 3. f 4. e
x 32 ¬2(x 31) 5. b 6. g 7. p or m
x 32 ¬2x 62 8. K or L 9. F 10. S
x 94 ¬2x 11. 12.
94 ¬x S T U
C
mLAM mMAR
m
¬x 31 V
¬94 31 63 13.
bisects MAR, so RAS SAM. 25
44. AS
AM bisects LAR, so mLAR 2 mMAR. 7 3x
mRAS ¬mSAM
25 2x ¬3x 5
20 2x ¬3x A P B
20 ¬5x AB ¬AP PB
4 ¬x 25 ¬7 3x
mLAR ¬2 mMAR 18 ¬3x
¬2(mSAM mRAS) 6 ¬x
¬2(3x 5 25 2x) PB ¬3x
¬2(x 30) ¬3(6)
¬2x 60 ¬18
¬2(4) 60 68
19 Chapter 1
14. 9 23. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
MP ¬[6 (4)]2
(1
9 16)2
4c 2c
¬(2)
2 3
2 13
¬3.6
A P B x x y y
AB ¬AP PB
2
24. M ¬
1
2
,
1
2
2
0 22 0 (18)
9 ¬4c 2c ¬2, 2
9 ¬6c
22 18
3 ¬c or c 1.5 ¬2, 2 or (11, 9)
2
PB ¬2c x x y y
25. M ¬,
1 2 1 2
¬2 3
2
2 2
6 12 3 (7)
¬3 ¬2, 2
15. 6 10
8s 7 ¬2, 2 or (3, 5)
x x y y
s2 4s 26. M ¬,
1 2 1 2
2 2
2 (1) 5 (1)
¬2, 2
A P B
¬2, 2 or (0.5, 2)
1 4
AB ¬AP PB
8s 7 ¬s 2 4s x x y y
27. M ¬,
1 2 1 2
8s 7 ¬5s 2 2 2
8s ¬5s 9 3.4 (2.2) 7.3 (5.4)
¬
2
, 2
3s ¬9
1.2 12.7
s ¬3 ¬2, 2 or (0.6, 6.35)
PB ¬4s
¬4(3) 28. D , FG
29. FE 30. DEH
¬12 31. 70°; 70 90, so SQT is acute.
16. 11 32. 110°; 110 90 and 110 180, so PQT is obtuse.
k6 33. 50°; 50 90, so T is acute.
2k 34. 70°; 70 90, so PRT is acute.
35.
XV bisects YXW, so YXV VXW.
A P B mYXV ¬mVXW
AB ¬AP PB 3x ¬2x 6
11 ¬2k k 6 x ¬6
11 ¬k 6 mYXW ¬mYXV mVXW
5 ¬k ¬3x 2x 6
5 ¬k ¬3(6) 2(6) 6
PB ¬k 6 ¬36
¬5 6
36. XW bisects YXZ, so YXW WXZ.
¬1 mYXW ¬mWXZ
17. yes, because HI KJ 9 m 12x 10 ¬8(x 1)
18. no, because AB 13.6 cm and AC 19.3 cm 12x 10 ¬8x 8
19. not enough information to determine if 12x ¬8x 18
5x 1 4x 3 4x ¬18
20. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2 x ¬9
2
AB ¬(3 1)2
(2 0
)2 mYXZ ¬mYXW mWXZ
¬12x 10 8(x 1)
¬(4)
2
2 20
2
¬4.5
¬12 9
9
2 10 8 2 1
¬54 10 44
21. d ¬(x
2 xy
1) (
2
2 y
1)
2
¬88
GL ¬[3
(
7)]2
(3 4)2
¬10
2
(1) ¬
2 101
¬10.0
22. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
Chapter 1 20
37.
XW bisects YXZ, so YXW WXZ and d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y 2 y
46. 2 2
1)
mWXZ ¬1 2 mYXZ.
WX¬[73)]
( 2 (1 5)2
mWXZ ¬1
2 mYXZ
¬
10
2 (4) 116
2
7x 9 ¬1
2 (9x 17)
XY ¬(5 7
)2 ( 4 1)2
7x 9 ¬9 17 ¬
(2)2
(5 )2 29
2 x 2
9 35 YZ ¬(5 5)
2 2
[0 (4)]
7x ¬
2 x 2
5
¬
(10)2 4
2 116
35
x ¬
2 2 WZ ¬[5 (3)]2 (0 5)2
x ¬7 ¬
(2)2
(5 )2 29
mYXW ¬mWXZ Perimeter ¬WX XY YZ WZ
¬7x 9
¬ 116 29 116 29
¬7(7) 9
¬40 ¬32.3 units
38. TWY, WYX 39. TWY, XWY
40. W
T W Z if mTWZ 90.
mTWZ ¬2c 36 Chapter 1 Practice Test
90 ¬2c 36
54 ¬2c Page 57
27 ¬c 1. true 2. true
41. ZWX ¬ZWY YWX 3. False; the sum of two supplementary angles is
90 ¬4k 2 5k 11 180.
90 ¬9k 9 4. true 5. m
81 ¬9k
6. D 7. C
9 ¬k
8. 29
42. There are 4 sides, so the polygon is a quadrilateral.
No line containing any of the sides will pass 2
through the interior of the quadrilateral, so it is 3x
convex. The sides are congruent, and the angles
are congruent, so it is regular. UV W
43. The figure is not a polygon because there are UW ¬UV VW
sides that intersect more than two other sides. 29 ¬2 3x
44. There are 8 sides, so the polygon is an octagon. 27 ¬3x
There is a side such that a line containing that 9 ¬x
side will pass through the interior of the octagon, VW ¬3x
so it is concave. The sides are not congruent, so ¬3(9) 27
the octagon is irregular. 9.
42
45. d ¬(x 2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
21 Chapter 1
11. 4c ¬0
2 4
2 (4)
GH ¬(3 0)2
(4 0)2
¬(3)
2 4
2 25 C
¬5
13. d ¬(x2 x
1) (
2 y2 y1)
2
NK ¬(2 5)2
(8 2)2 S X Y
¬(7)
2 6
2 85 Use the information known about the cities to
¬9.2 place them on a coordinate plane. Then use the
14. d ¬(x2 x
1) (
2 y2 y
1)
2 gridlines to form a triangle using the points S for
Springfield, B for Brighton, and Y. Use the
AW ¬ [2 (4)]2 [2 2
(4)]
Pythagorean Theorem.
¬2 6
2 2 40 (SB)2 ¬(SY)2 (BY)2
¬6.3 (SB)2 ¬62 72
15. C 16.
EC,
ED (SB)2 ¬85
17. ABD or ABE 18. 9 SB ¬9.2
19. 4r 7 r 2¬ 180 Highway 1 is approximately 9.2 miles long.
5r 5¬ 180 24.
5r¬ 175
r¬ 35 B
4r 7 ¬4(35) 7 or 147
r 2 ¬35 2 or 33
20. Let x be the measure of one angle. Then the other
angle has measure x 26 and x x 26 90. C
x x 26¬ 90
2x 26¬ 90
2x¬ 64
x¬ 32 S X Y
x 26 32 26 58 Use the information known about the cities to
21. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2 place them on a coordinate plane. Then use the
PQ ¬[1 (
6)]2 [1 2
(3)] gridlines to form a triangle using the points S for
Springfield, C for Capital City, and X. Use the
¬72 2
2 53
Pythagorean Theorem.
QR ¬(1 1)2 [ 2
5 (1)] (SC)2 ¬(SX)2 (CX)2
¬0 2 4
2 (4)
(SC)2 ¬52 32
PR ¬[1 (
6)]2 [5 2
(3)] (SC)2 ¬34
¬72
(2) 2 53 SC ¬5.8
Perimeter ¬PQ QR PR Highway 4 is approximately 5.8 miles long.
¬ 53 4 53 25. C; the figure has sides with a common endpoint
¬18.6 units that are collinear.
22. d ¬(x
2 x
1) (y
2
2 y
1)
2
AB ¬
[4 (6)]2 (7 2)2
¬2
2 5
2 29
BC ¬
[0 (
4)]2 (4 7)2
¬4
2
2 (3)
¬
25 5
CD ¬
(0 0)2 (0 4)2
Chapter 1 22
Chapter 1 Standardized Test Practice y ¬2x 3
y ¬2(2) 3 or 7
The solution is (2, 7).
Pages 58–59 12. y
1. C; there are 15 hours between 7 A.M. and 10 P.M., B C
so there are 15 60 900 minutes during that
time. Then Juanita blinks 11 900 or 9900 times
during the time she is awake.
2. A x
O
2x2 12x 16 2(x2 6x 8)
3. B;
2x 4 ¬
2(x 2) A D
2(x 4)(x 2)
¬
2(x 2)
¬x 4 ABCD is a rectangle, so D must have coordinates
4. A; three noncollinear points determine a plane, so D(3, 1).
x x y y
if the two planes are distinct, their intersection is
not a plane. Two planes intersect in only one line.
13. M
1
2
2
,
1
2
2
5. B; 1 fathom 6 feet so 55 fathoms 55(6) or 2, 2
2 (4) 1 3
330 feet, which is 110 yards.
6. C; use the Pythagorean Theorem, where x is the 2, 2 (1, 1)
2 2
height up the side of the house that the ladder 14. (AB)2 ¬602 1102
reaches. (AB)2 ¬3600 12,100
(18)2 ¬(6)2 x2 (AB)2 ¬15,700
324 ¬36 x2 AB ¬125 m
288 ¬x2 15. P 2 2w
17.0 ¬x 2(16) 2(24)
7. C; mABD ¬mCBD 80
2x 14 ¬5x 10 The perimeter of the basement is 80 feet. If the
2x 14 10 ¬5x 10 10 80
pieces of plasterboard are 4 feet wide, it takes 4
2x 24 ¬5x or 20 pieces of plasterboard to cover the walls.
2x 24 2x ¬5x 2x 16a. y
24 ¬3x
8 ¬x
mABD 2x 14
2(8) 14
30 O x
8. D; let x be the measure of FEG.
mDEG mFEG ¬180
612x x ¬180
15
2 x ¬180
x x y y
x ¬24 16b. M ¬
1
2
,
2
1
2
2
mDEG ¬61
2 (24)
¬156
4
0
2 , 2
0 4
¬(2, 2)
9. D; treasure 4
2
0 0 (4)
, 2 ¬(2, 2)
4
0 0 (4)
2, 2 ¬(2, 2)
4
0 04
2 , 2 ¬(2, 2)
17a. You are given that a 25. The measure of the
other angle marked with a single arc is also
115 25 because the arcs tell us that the angles are
Kaitlin Henry congruent. Both of the angles marked with
double arcs have a measure of a 10, which
is 25 10 or 35. In the remaining angle,
If Kaitlin turns 115°, Henry turns 180° 115°
b 180 (25 35 25 35) or 60 because
or 65°.
the angles can be combined to form linear pairs,
10. 2x 6 4x2 x x2 5 5x2 x 1 which are supplementary.
11. 2y ¬3x 8 17b. All are acute.
y ¬2x 3
2(2x 3) ¬3x 8
4x 6 ¬3x 8
x ¬2
23 Chapter 1
Chapter 2 Reasoning and Proof
Page 61 Getting Started
1. 3n 2 3(4) 2 2-1 Inductive Reasoning and
12 2 10 Conjecture
2. (n 1) n (6 1) 6
76 Pages 63–64 Check for Understanding
13 1. Sample answer: After the news is over, it’s time
3. n2 3n (3)2 3(3) for dinner.
9 3(3) 2. Sometimes; the conjecture is true when E is
990 between D and F; otherwise it is false.
4. 180(n 2) 180(5 2) 3. Sample answer: When it is cloudy, it rains.
180(3) 540 Counterexample: It is often cloudy and it does not
5. nn
2 ¬10 2
10
rain.
¬10(5) 50 4. There is one of each shape in the first figure.
There are two of each shape in the second figure
n(n 3) 8(8 3)
6. 2 ¬ 2
and three of each shape in the third figure. So the
8(5)
¬ next figure will have four of each shape.
2
4 0
¬2 20
5. 8 5 2 1 4
7. 6x 42 ¬4x
3 3 3 3
42 ¬2x
The numbers in the sequence increase by 3. The
21 ¬x
next number will increase by 3. So, it will be 4 3
8. 8 3n ¬2 2n or 7.
10 3n ¬2n
6. PQ TU
10 ¬5n
2 ¬n P Q
9. 3(y 2) ¬12 y R S
3y 6 ¬12 y
3y ¬18 y T U
2y ¬18
y ¬9 7.
AB and
CD intersect at a single point P, so the
10. 12 7x ¬x 18 lines are distinct. Thus the points A, B, C, and D
7x ¬x 30 are not all on the same line. So, A, B, C, and D are
6x ¬30 noncollinear.
x ¬5
A D
11. 3x 4 ¬1
2x 5
P
3x ¬1
2x 9
C B
5x ¬9
2
18 8. False; if x 2, then x (2) or 2.
x ¬
5 9. True; opposite sides of a rectangle are congruent,
2
12. 2 2x ¬3x 2 and the sides of the rectangle can be determined
4 2x ¬2 from the order of the letters in its name.
3x
10. Sample answer: Snow will not stick on a roof with
4 ¬8
3x a steep angle.
3
¬x
2
13. AGB and EGD are vertical angles, so
mAGB mEGD. Pages 64–66 Practice and Apply
4x 7 ¬71 11. Each figure is formed by adding another row of
4x ¬64 dots to the top and another column of dots on the
x ¬16 side. The number of dots in each figure is 2, 6, 12,
20.
14. mBGC mCGD mDGE 180
2 6 12 20
45 8x 4 15x 7 ¬180
4 6 8
23x 42 ¬180
23x ¬138
x ¬6
Chapter 2 24
The numbers increase by 4, 6, and 8. The next 20. Each arrangement of blocks is formed by adding a
number will increase by 10. So, it will be 30. level of blocks to the bottom. The number of
blocks on the bottom level of the figures is 1, 3,
and 6.
1 3 6
2 3
13. 1 2 4 8 16
1 2 4 8
17. 2 6 18 54 –8
(3) (3) (3)
A(–2, –11)
The numbers are multiplied by 3. The next
number will be 54 (3) or 162. 23. Linear pairs of angles are supplementary, so 3
18. 5 25 125 625 and 4 are supplementary.
(5) (5) (5)
130
QR (6) 62 [5)]
(22
02 7
2
49
or 7
25 Chapter 2
PR [6
1)]
( 2 (5
7)2
AB is horizontal, and B
C is vertical. So the
72)
2 ( 2 segments are perpendicular to each other. So B
53
is a right angle. Therefore, ABC is a right
The lengths PQ, QR, and PR are all different, so triangle.
PQR is a scalene triangle. 33. True; the square of any real number is a
y nonnegative number.
P
R(6, 5)
34. False; D, E, and F do not have to be collinear.
(–1, 7)
35. False; JKLM may not have a right angle.
36. True; any three noncollinear points form a
triangle.
37. trial and error, a process of inductive reasoning
O x 38. The first three alkanes have 1, 2, and 3 carbon
atoms. The fourth alkane will have 4 carbon
Q (6, –2) atoms. The first three alkanes have 4, 6, and 8
hydrogen atoms. The fourth alkane, butane, will
26. A square has 4 congruent sides. From the name of
have 8 2 or 10 hydrogen atoms.
I, IJ
the square the sides are H , J
K
, and K
H
.
Thus, HI IJ JK KH. H H H H
H I
H C C C C H
H H H H
K J 39. The 1st alkane has formula CH4 (or C1H4).
27. A rectangle has 4 sides where opposite sides are The 2nd alkane has formula C2H6.
congruent. From the name of the rectangle the The 3rd alkane has formula C3H8.
Q
sides are P, QR
, S
R
, and P
S. The pairs of The subscripts for C increase by 1 and are the
Q
opposite sides are P , S
R
and QR
, P
S. Thus, same number as the number of the alkane in the
PQ SR and QR PS. series. The subscripts for H increase by 2. So the
P Q 7th alkane in the series has formula
C7H(8 2 2 2 2) or C7H16.
40. The nth alkane has n carbon atoms so the
subscript for C is n. The number of hydrogen
S R atoms in the nth alkane is 2 more than twice the
28. A triangle that has a right angle is a right numbers of the alkane in the series, or 2n 2. So
triangle. The Pythagorean Theorem is true for the subscript for H is 2n 2. The formula is
every right triangle. Since B is the right angle of CnH2n 2.
C
the triangle, the hypotenuse is A and the legs 41. False; if n 41, then n2 n 41 (41)2 41
B
are A and B
C . So (AB)2 (BC)2 (AC)2. 41 or 412, which is not prime.
A
42. Sample answer: By past experience, when dark
clouds appear, there is a chance of rain. Answers
C should include the following.
B
• When there is precipitation in the summer, it is
29. False;
usually rain because the temperature is above
freezing. When the temperature is below
2 freezing, as in the winter, ice or snow forms.
1
• See students’ work.
30. False; if y 7 and m 5, then 7 5 10 and 43. C; 1, 1, 2, 3, 5, 8
5 4, but 7 6. 112
31. False; 123
W X Y Z 235
358
32. True; Each number in the sequence is found by adding
y the two numbers before it. 5 8 13, so the next
A B
number in the sequence is 13.
44. D; Let x be the sum of the six numbers and y be
the sum of the three numbers whose average is 15.
x
6 18
C
x 18(6) or 108
x
O
Chapter 2 26
y
3 15 59. PN 3x and PN 24.
y 15(3) or 45 3x ¬24
The sum of the remaining three numbers is x ¬8
108 45 or 63. MP ¬7x
¬7(8) or 56
60. PN 9c and PN 63.
Page 66 Maintain Your Skills 9c ¬63
c ¬7
45. There are 6 sides, so the polygon is a hexagon. No
MP ¬2c
line containing any of the sides will pass through
¬2(7) or 14
the interior of the hexagon, so it is convex. Not all
sides are congruent, so the hexagon is irregular. 61. MN MP PN
36 ¬4x 5x
46. There are 5 sides, so the polygon is a pentagon.
36 ¬9x
No line containing any of the sides will pass
4 ¬x
through the interior of the pentagon, so it is
MP 4x
convex. The sides and angles are congruent, so the
¬4(4) or 16
pentagon is regular.
62. MN MP PN
47. There are 7 sides, so the polygon is a heptagon. 60 ¬6q 6q
There is a side such that a line containing the 60 ¬12q
side will pass through the interior of the 5 ¬q
heptagon, so it is concave. Not all sides are MP 6q
congruent, so the heptagon is irregular. ¬6(5) or 30
48. Yes; the symbol denotes that KJN is a right 63. MN MP PN
angle. 63 ¬4y 3 2y
49. No; we do not know anything about the angle 63 ¬6y 3
measures. 60 ¬6y
50. No; we do not know whether MNP is a right 10 ¬y
angle. MP 4y 3
51. Yes; they form a linear pair. ¬4(10) 3
¬43
52. Yes; since the other three angles in rectangle KLPJ
are right angles, KLP must also be a right angle. 64. MN MP PN
x x y y 43 ¬2b 7 8b
53. M
1
2
,
1
2
2
2 43 ¬10b 7
1
2 , 3 (5) 50 ¬10b
2
5
5 ¬b
4
2 , 2 or (2, 1)
2
MP ¬2b 7
x1 x2 y1 y2 ¬2(5) 7
54. M 2
,
2 ¬3
4 (3)
2, 2 7
1 65. x 2 5
2 2 4. 4 5. So 2 2
5.
1
2 , 2 or (0.5, 4)
8 3 2 5. 5 5. So 3 2
5.
x1 x2 y1 y2 4 2 6. 6 5. So 4 2 5.
55. M 2
,
2 5 2 7. 7 5. So 5 2 5.
4 (2) 9 (15) The values in the replacement set that make the
2, 2
inequality true are 4 and 5.
24
2
2 , 2 or (1, 12)
66. 12 x 0
x1 x2 y1 y2 12 11 1. 1 ¬0. So 12 11 0.
56. M 2
,
2 12 12 0. 0 ¬0. So 12 12 0.
12 13 1. 1 ¬0. So 12 13 0.
2
5 , 22
7
4
12 14 2. 2 ¬0. So 12 14 0.
2
2
2 , 2 or (1, 1)
The values in the replacement set that make the
inequality true are 13 and 14.
x1 x2 y1 y2
57. M 2
,
2 67. 5x 1 25
5(4) 1 21. 21 25. So 5(4) 1
25.
2, 2
8 3 1.8 6.2
5(5) 1 26. 26 25. So 5(5) 1 25.
5(6) 1 31. 31 25. So 5(6) 1 25.
11 4.4
2 , 2 or (5.5, 2.2) 5(7) 1 36. 36 25. So 5(7) 1 25.
x1 x2 y1 y2
58.
M ,
2 2 The values in the replacement set that make the
inequality true are 5, 6, and 7.
1.5 6
2, (4)
2
3
5
.5 3
2 , 2 or (2.75, 1.5)
27 Chapter 2
14. p q r p q (p q) r
2-2 Logic T T T T T
T T F T T
Pages 71–72 Check for Understanding T F T T T
1. The conjunction (p and q) is represented by the T F F T T
intersection of the two circles. F T T T T
2a. Sample answer: October has 31 days or F T F T T
5 3 8. F F T F T
2b. Sample answer: A square has five right angles F F F F F
and the Postal Service does not deliver mail on
15. The states that produce more than 100 million
Sundays.
bushels of corn are represented by the set labeled
2c. Sample answer: July 5th is not a national Corn. There are 14 states that produce more than
holiday. 100 million bushels of corn.
3. A conjunction is a compound statement using the 16. The states that produce more than 100 million
word and, while a disjunction is a compound bushels of wheat are represented by the set
statement using the word or. labeled Wheat. There are 7 states that produce
4. 9 5 14 and February has 30 days.; false, more than 100 million bushels of wheat.
because p is true and q is false 17. The states that produce more than 100 million
5. 9 5 14 and a square has four sides.; true, bushels of corn and wheat are represented by the
because p is true and r is true intersection of the sets. There are 3 states that
6. February has 30 days and a square has four produce more than 100 million bushels of corn
sides.; false, because q is false and r is true and wheat.
7. 9 5 14 or February does not have 30 days.;
true, because p is true and q is true
8. February has 30 days or a square has four sides.; Pages 72–74 Practice and Apply
true, because r is true 18. 64
8 and an equilateral triangle has three
9. 9 5 14 or a square does not have four sides.; congruent sides; false, because p is false and q is
false, because p is false and r is false true.
10. 19. 64
8 or an equilateral triangle has three
p q q p q congruent sides; true, because q is true.
T T F F 20. 64
8 and 0 0; false, because p is false and
T F T T r is false.
F T F F 21. 0 0 and an obtuse angle measures greater than
90° and less than 180°; false, because r is false
F F T F and s is true.
11. 22. An equilateral triangle has three congruent sides
p q pq or 0 0; true, because q is true.
T T T 23. An equilateral triangle has three congruent sides
T F F and an obtuse angle measures greater than 90°
and less than 180°; true, because q is true and
F T F
s is true.
F F F 24. 64
8 and an obtuse angle measures greater
12. than 90° and less than 180°; false, because
q r qr p is false and s is true.
T T T 25. An equilateral triangle has three congruent sides
T F T and 0 0; false, because q is true and r is false.
F T T 26. 0 0 or 64
8; false, because r is false and
p is false.
F F F
27. An obtuse angle measures greater than 90° and
13. less than 180° or an equilateral triangle has three
p r p p r
congruent sides; true, because s is true and
T T F F q is true.
T F F F 28. 64
8 and an equilateral triangle has three
F T T T congruent side, or an obtuse angle measures
greater than 90° and less than 180°; true, because
F F T F s is true.
Chapter 2 28
29. An obtuse angle measures greater than 90° and 37. q r r q r
less than 180°, or an equilateral triangle has
three congruent sides and 0 0; true, because T T F F
s is true. T F T T
30. p q p p q F T F F
T T F T F F T F
T F F F 38. p q p q p q
F T T T
F F T T T T F F F
T F F T F
31. p q p q p q F T T F F
T T F F F F F T T T
T F F T F 39. p q r p r q r p (q r)
F T T F F
T T T F F F F
F F T T T T T F F T T T
32. T F T F F F F
p q r pq (p q) r
T F F F T F F
T T T T T
F T T T F F T
T T F T F
F T F T T T T
T F T T T
T F F T F F F T T F F T
F T T T T F F F T T F T
F T F T F 40. p q r q r q r p (q r)
F F T F F
T T T F F F F
F F F F F
T T F F T T T
33. q r q and r T F T T F T T
T T T T F F T T T T
T F F F T T F F F F
F T F F T F F T T F
F F F F F T T F T F
F F F T T T F
34. p q p or q
41. The teens that said they listened to none of these
T T T types of music are represented by the region
T F T outside the Pop, Country, and Rap sets. There are
F T T 42 teens that said they listened to none of these
types of music.
F F F
42. The teens that said they listened to all three
35. types of music are represented by the intersection
p r p or r
of three sets. There are 7 teens that said they
T T T listened to all three types of music.
T F T 43. The teens that said they listened to only pop and
rap music are represented by the intersection of
F T T
the Pop and Rap sets excluding the teens that
F F F also listen to country music (hence listen to all
three types of music). There are 25 teens that said
36. p q p and q they listened to only pop and rap music.
T T T 44. The teens that said they listened to pop, rap, or
country music are represented by the union of the
T F F
Pop, Rap, and Country sets. There are
F T F 175 25 7 34 45 10 62 or 358 teens
F F F that said they listened to pop, rap, or country
music.
29 Chapter 2
45. Level of Participation 57. 1 3 9 27
Among 310 Students
3 3 3
Chapter 2 30
65. d (xx 2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2 4. Hypothesis: it rains on Monday;
LM (4 ) 2 2 (5 1) 2 Conclusion: I will stay home
2 2 42 5. Hypothesis: x 3 7;
Conclusion: x 10
20 25
6. Hypothesis: a polygon has six sides;
MN (6 ) 4 2 (4 5)2
Conclusion: it is a hexagon
21)
2 ( 5 2
7. Sample answer: If a pitcher is a 32-ounce pitcher,
NP (7 ) 642 ( 4)2 then it holds a quart of liquid.
1 8)
2 ( 2 65 8. Sample answer: If two angles are supplementary,
PQ (5 ) 782 [4)] (2 then the sum of the measures of the angles is 180.
(2)
2 ) (4 2
9. Sample answer: If an angle is formed by
20 25 perpendicular lines, then it is a right angle.
QR (3 ) 572 [8)] (2 10. The hypothesis is true because you drove 70 miles
(2)
2 1 2 per hour, and the conclusion is true because you
5 received a speeding ticket. Since the promised
result is true, the conditional statement is true.
LR (3 ) 272 ( 1)2
11. The hypothesis is false, and the statement does
1 8)
2 ( 2
not say what happens if you drive 65 miles per
65 hour or less. You could still get a speeding ticket if
Perimeter you are driving in a zone where the posted speed
LM MN NP PQ QR LR limit is less than 65 miles per hour. In this case,
25 5 65 25 5
65
we cannot say that the statement is false so the
65 2 65 statement is true.
29.5 12. The hypothesis is true, but the conclusion is false.
66. 145°; 90 145 180 so ABC is obtuse. Because the result is not what was promised, the
67. 55°; 55 90 so DBC is acute. conditional statement is false.
68. 90°; right 13. Converse: If plants grow, then they have water;
69. The front and back could be as much as 35.5 feet true.
each and the sides could be as much as 75.5 feet Inverse: If plants do not have water, then they
each. will not grow; true.
P 2 2w Contrapositive: If plants do not grow, then they do
2(35.5) 2(75.5) not have water. False; they may have been killed
71 151 222 by overwatering.
Michelle should buy 222 feet of fencing. 14. Conditional in if-then form: If you are flying in an
70. 5a 2b 5(4) 2(3) airplane, then you are safer than riding in a car.
20 6 or 14 Converse: If you are safer than riding in a car,
then you are flying in an airplane. False; there
71. 4cd 2d 4(5)(2) 2(2)
are other places that are safer than riding in a car.
40 4 or 44
Inverse: If you are not flying in an airplane, then
72. 4e 3f 4(1) 3(2) you are not safer than riding in a car. False; there
4 (6) or 10 are other places that are safer than riding in a car.
73. 3g h 3(8)2 (8)
2
Contrapositive: If you are not safer than riding in
3(64) (8) a car, then you are not flying in an airplane; true.
192 (8) or 184 15. Sample answer: If you are in Colorado, then
aspen trees cover high areas of the mountains.
If you are in Florida, then cypress trees rise from
the swamps.
2-3 Conditional Statements If you are in Vermont, then maple trees are
prevalent.
Page 78 Check for Understanding
1. Writing a conditional in if-then form is helpful so
that the hypothesis and conclusion are easily Pages 78–80 Practice and Apply
recognizable. 16. Hypothesis: 2x 6 10;
2. Sample answer: If you eat your peas, then you Conclusion: x 2
will have dessert. 17. Hypothesis: you are a teenager;
3. In the inverse, you negate both the hypothesis Conclusion: you are at least 13 years old
and the conclusion of the conditional. In the 18. Hypothesis: you have a driver’s license;
contrapositive, you negate the hypothesis and the Conclusion: you are at least 16 years old
conclusion of the converse. 19. Hypothesis: three points lie on a line;
Conclusion: the points are collinear
31 Chapter 2
20. Hypothesis: a man hasn’t discovered something 40. Converse: If you live in Texas, then you live in
he will die for; Dallas. False; you could live in Austin.
Conclusion: he isn’t fit to live Inverse: If you don’t live in Dallas, then you don’t
21. Hypothesis: the measure of an angle is between live in Texas. False; you could live in Austin.
0 and 90; Contrapositive: If you don’t live in Texas, then you
Conclusion: the angle is acute don’t live in Dallas; true.
22. Sample answer: If you buy a 1-year fitness plan, 41. Converse: If you are in good shape, then you
then you get a free visit. exercise regularly; true.
23. Sample answer: If you are a math teacher, then Inverse: If you do not exercise regularly, then you
you love to solve problems. are not in good shape; true.
Contrapositive: If you are not in good shape, then
24. Sample answer: If I think, then I am.
you do not exercise regularly. False; an ill person
25. Sample answer: If two angles are adjacent, then may exercise a lot, but still not be in good shape.
they have a common side.
42. Conditional: If two angles are complementary,
26. Sample answer: If two angles are vertical, then then their sum is 90.
they are congruent. Converse: If the sum of two angles is 90, then
27. Sample answer: If two triangles are equiangular, they are complementary; true.
then they are equilateral. Inverse: If two angles are not complementary,
28. The hypothesis is true because you are 19 years then their sum is not 90; true.
old, and the conclusion is true because you vote. Contrapositive: If the sum of two angles is not 90,
Since the predicted result is true, the conditional then they are not complementary; true.
statement is true. 43. Conditional: If a figure is a rectangle, then it is a
29. The hypothesis is false, and the conclusion is true. quadrilateral.
The statement doesn’t say what happens if you Converse: If a figure is a quadrilateral, then it is
are younger than 18 years old. It is possible that a rectangle. False; it could be a rhombus.
you vote in a school election. In this case, we Inverse: If a figure is not a rectangle, then it is
cannot say that the statement is false. Thus, the not a quadrilateral. False; it could be a rhombus.
statement is true. Contrapositive: If a figure is not a quadrilateral,
30. The hypothesis is true, and the conclusion is false. then it is not a rectangle; true.
Because the result is not what was predicted, the 44. Conditional: If an angle is a right angle, then its
conditional statement is false. measure is 90.
31. The hypothesis is false, and the conclusion is Converse: If an angle has a measure of 90, then it
false. The statement doesn’t say what happens if is a right angle; true.
you are younger than 18 years old. In this case, Inverse: If an angle is not a right angle, then its
we cannot say that the statement is false. Thus, measure is not 90; true.
the statement is true. Contrapositive: If an angle does not have a
measure of 90, then it is not a right angle; true.
32. The hypothesis is true because your sister is 21
years old, and the conslusion is true because she 45. Conditional: If an angle is acute, then its measure
votes. Since the predicted result is true, the is less than 90.
conditional statement is true. Converse: If an angle has measure less than 90,
then it is acute; true.
33. The hypothesis is true, and the conclusion is false.
Inverse: If an angle is not acute, then its measure
Because the result is not what was predicted, the
is not less than 90; true.
conditional statement is false.
Contrapositive: If an angle’s measure is not less
34. True; P, Q, and R are collinear, and P is in plane than 90, then it is not acute; true.
M and Q is in plane N. The line containing P and
46. Sample answer: In Alaska, if it is summer, then
Q is the intersection of M and N, so the line that
there are more hours of daylight than darkness.
is the intersection of these planes is the line
In Alaska, if it is winter, then there are more
through P and Q, and thus R. So P, Q, and R are
hours of darkness than daylight.
in M.
47. Sample answer: In Alaska, if there are more
35. True; points Q and B lie in plane N, so the line
hours of daylight than darkness, then it is
that connects them also lies in plane N.
summer. In Alaska, if there are more hours of
36. True; Q is on the line through P that is the darkness than daylight, then it is winter.
intersection of planes M and N. The line is in M,
48. Sample answer: If I am exercising, then I am
so Q is in M.
asleep. If I am exercising, then I am not asleep.
37. False; P and A lie in plane M and Q and B lie in
49. Conditional statements can be used to describe
plane N. M and N are distinct planes, so P, Q, A,
how to get a discount, rebate, or refund. Sample
and B are not coplanar.
answers should include the following.
38. false
• If you are not 100% satisfied, then return the
39. True; line RQ is the same as line PQ since P, Q, product for a full refund.
and R are collinear. P is in M and Q is in N so M
• Wearing a seatbelt reduces the risk of injuries.
and N intersect at line PQ and hence line RQ.
Chapter 2 32
50. C; The contrapositive of a statement always has 61. PQR is a right angle.
the same truth value as the statement. P
51. B; let x be the number of girls in class. Then there
are 32 x boys in class.
x Q R
¬5
32 x 3
3x ¬5(32 x) 62. d (xx 2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2
3x ¬160 5x CD [02)] ( 2 [3 (1)]2
8x ¬160 2 2 4 20
2
x ¬20 4.5
32 x ¬12 63. d (xx 2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2
Thus, there are 20 girls and 12 boys in class, so JK [13)]
( 2 (0 5)2
there are 20 12 or 8 more girls than boys. 4 5)
2 ( 41
2
6.4
64. d (xx 2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2
Page 80 Maintain Your Skills PQ
[2 (3)] 2 [3 (
1)]2
52. George Washington was the first president of the
52)
2 ( 29
2
United States and a hexagon has 5 sides.
5.4
p q is false because p is true and q is false.
65. d (xx 2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2
53. A hexagon has five sides or 60 3 18.
q r is false because q is false and r is false. RS (4
1)2 7)][3 (2
54. George Washington was the first president of the (5)
2 10 125
2
United States or a hexagon has five sides. 11.2
p q is true because p is true. 66. Subtract 4 from each side.
55. A hexagon doesn’t have five sides or 60 3 18. 67. Multiply each side by 2.
q r is true because q is true. 68. Divide each side by 8.
56. George Washington was the first president of the
United States and a hexagon doesn’t have five
sides. Page 80 Practice Quiz 1
p q is true because p is true and q is true. 1. False
57. George Washington was not the first president of W X
the United States and 60 3 18.
p r is false because p is false and r is
true.
58. AB CD; AD BC
D C
Y
2. True; m1 m2 ¬90
A B m2 ¬90 m1
59. The sum of the measures of the angles in a m2 m3 ¬90
triangle is 180. (90 m1) m3 ¬90
G m1 m3 ¬0
67 m3 ¬m1
3.
F 45 p q p p q
68 T T F F
H
T F F F
60. JKL has two sides congruent.
F T T T
y K
F F T F
J L
O x
33 Chapter 2
4. p q r qr p (q r)
T T T T T
2-4 Deductive Reasoning
T T F F T
T F T F T Page 84 Check for Understanding
T F F F T 1. Sample answer: a: If it is rainy, the game will be
F T T T T cancelled.
F T F F F b: It is rainy.
c: The game will be cancelled.
F F T F F
F F F F F 2. Transitive Property of Equality: a b and b c
implies a c. Law of Syllogism. a implies b and b
5. Converse: If two angles have a common vertex, implies c implies a implies c. Each statement
then the angles are adjacent. False; ABD is not establishes a relationship between a and c
adjacent to ABC. through their relationships to b.
A C 3. Lakeisha; if you are dizzy, that does not
necessarily mean that you are seasick and thus
D have an upset stomach.
B
4. Valid; the conditional is true and the hypothesis is
Inverse: If two angles are not adjacent, then they
true, so the conclusion is true.
do not have a common vertex; False, ABC and
DBE have a common vertex and are not 5. Invalid; congruent angles do not have to be
adjacent. vertical.
A C 6. no conclusion
B 7. Let p, q, and r represent the parts of the
statement.
D E p: the midpoint divides a segment
Contrapositive: If two angles do not have a q: two segments are congruent
common vertex, then they are not adjacent; true. r: two segments have equal measures
The given statements are true,
Statement (1): p → q
Statement (2): q → r
Page 81 Reading Mathematics
So by the Law of Syllogism p → r. Thus, the
1. Conditional: If a calculator runs, then it has
midpoint of a segment divides it into two
batteries.
segments with equal measures.
Converse: If a calculator has batteries, then it will
run. 8. p: Molly arrives at school at 7:30 A.M.
False; a calculator may be solar powered. q: she will get help in math
r: she will pass her math test
2. Conditional: If two lines intersect, then they are
Statement (3) is a valid conclusion by the Law of
not vertical.
Syllogism.
Converse: If two lines are not vertical, then they
intersect. 9. Invalid; not all angles that are congruent are
False; two parallel horizontal lines will not right angles.
intersect. 10. A 35-year old female pays $14.35 per month for
3. Conditional: If two angles are congruent, then $30,000 of insurance, and Ann is a 35-year old
they have the same measure. female, so by the Law of Detachment, Ann pays
Converse: If two angles have the same measure, $14.35 per month.
then they are congruent. 11. No; Terry could be a man or a woman. She could
true be 45 and have purchased $30,000 of life
4. Conditional: If 3x 4 20, then x 7. insurance.
Converse: If x 7, then 3x 4 20.
False; 3x 4 17 when x 7.
5. Conditional: If a line is a segment bisector, then it Pages 85–87 Practice and Apply
intersects the segment at its midpoint. 12. invalid; 10 12 22
Converse: If a line intersects a segment at its 13. Valid; since 5 and 7 are odd, the Law of
midpoint, then it is a segment bisector. Detachment indicates that their sum is even.
true 14. Valid; since 11 and 23 are odd, the Law of
Detachment indicates that their sum is even.
15. Invalid; the sum is even.
16. Valid; A, B, and C are noncollinear, and by
definition three noncollinear points determine a
plane.
Chapter 2 34
17. Invalid; E, F, and G are not necessarily • Doctors use what is known to be true about
noncollinear. diseases and when symptoms appear, then
18. Invalid; the hypothesis is false as there are only deduce that the patient has a particular illness.
two points. 34. C; if A were true, then Yasahiro would be a
19. Valid; the vertices of a triangle are noncollinear, professional athlete by I, contradicting II. If B
and therefore determine a plane. were true, then either Yasahiro is a professional
20. no conclusion athlete (contradicting II), or Yasahiro gets paid,
which, together with III and I, contradicts II. D
21. If the measure of an angle is less than 90, then it
contradicts III. If C was not true, then II would
is not obtuse.
be contradicted. Therefore C must be true.
22. If X is the midpoint of YZ
, then YXX Z
.
35. B; 15% off the $16 meal means the diner’s meal
23. no conclusion cost (0.85)($16) or $13.60. 20% of $13.60 means
24. p: you are an in-line skater the diner left a tip of (0.20)($13.60) or $2.72.
q: you live dangerously Thus, the diner paid a total of $13.60 $2.72 or
r: you like to dance $16.32.
Yes, statement (3) follows from (1) and (2) by the
Law of Syllogism.
25. p: the measure of an angle is greater than 90 Page 87 Maintain Your Skills
q: the angle is obtuse 36. If you try Casa Fiesta, then you’re looking for a
Yes, statement (3) follows from (1) and (2) by the fast, easy way to add some fun to your family’s
Law of Detachment. menu.
26. Invalid; statement (1) is true, but statement (3) 37. They are a fast, easy way to add fun to your
does not follow from (2). Not all congruent angles family’s menu.
are vertical angles.
38. No; the conclusion is implied.
27. p: an angle is obtuse
39. q r qr
q: the angle cannot be acute
Yes, statement (3) follows from (1) and (2) by the T T T
Law of Detachment. T F F
28. p: you drive safely F T F
q: you can avoid accidents
F F F
Yes, statement (3) follows from (1) and (2) by the
Law of Detachment. 40. p r p p r
29. p: you are a customer
T T F T
q: you are always right
r: you are a teenager T F F F
r → p does not follow from (p → q) (r → q); F T T T
invalid F F T T
30. p: John Steinbeck lived in Monterey
41. p q r qr p (q r)
q: during the 1940s, one could hear the grating
noise of the fish canneries. T T T T T
If John Steinbeck lived in Monterey in 1941, then T T F T T
he could hear the grating noise of the fish
T F T T T
canneries.
T F F F F
31. p: Catriona Le May Doan skated her second 500
meters in 37.45 seconds F T T T F
q: She beat the time of monique Garbrecht- F T F T F
Enfeldt F F T T F
r: She would win the race
F F F F F
By the Law of Syllogism, if Catriona Le May Doan
skated her second 500 meters in 37.45 seconds, 42. p q r q q r p (q r)
then she would win the race.
T T T F F T
32. Sample answer: Stacey assumed that the
conditional statement was true. T T F F F T
33. Sample answer: Doctors and nurses use charts to T F T T T T
assist in determining medications and their doses T F F T F T
for patients. Answers should include the F T T F F F
following. F T F F F F
• Doctors need to note a patient’s symptoms to
F F T T T T
determine which medication to prescribe, then
determine how much to prescribe based on F F F T F F
weight, age, severity of the illness, and so on.
35 Chapter 2
43. HDC is a right angle and HDC and HDF are 52.
a linear pair so HDF is a right angle. Thus, M
HDG is complementary to FDG because H
F G
mHDG mFDG 90
44. Sample answer: KHJ and DHG
45. Sample answer: JHK and DHK
53.
46. Congruent, adjacent, supplementary, linear pair W r
47. Yes, slashes on the segments indicate that they
are congruent. s
48. 54. Q
B y
P
R
55.
C A A
n
B
x
O
(AB)2 (AC)2 (BC)2
(AB)2 ¬32 42 25
AB ¬5 M
56. Sample answer: AC M, CNB N, AM CM,
49. y CN BN, M is midpoint of A
C
, N is midpoint
C
of B.
D
57. Sample answer: 1 and 2 are complementary,
m1 m2 90.
58. Sample answer: 4 and 5 are supplementary,
m4 m5 180, 5 and 6 are supplementary,
x
m5 m6 180, 4 6, m4 m6.
O
C E
(CD)2 (CE)2 (DE)2 Page 88 Geometry Activity: Matrix Logic
(CD)2 62 82 100 1.
Job Nate John Nick
CD 10
50. y Veterinarian’s office ✓ ✗ ✗
Computer store ✗ ✗ ✓
Restaurant ✗ ✓ ✗
F
Nate works at the veterinarian’s office, John
works at the restaurant, and Nick works at the
x computer store.
O G H 2. Apartment Anita Kelli Scott Eric Ava Roberto
(FG)2 (GH)2 (FH)2 A ✗ ✗ ✗ ✗ ✗ ✓
(FG)2 62 42 52 B ✗ ✗ ✗ ✓ ✗ ✗
FG 52 7.2
C ✓ ✗ ✗ ✗ ✗ ✗
51. y
D ✗ ✗ ✗ ✗ ✓ ✗
N E ✗ ✗ ✓ ✗ ✗ ✗
F ✗ ✓ ✗ ✗ ✗ ✗
Roberto lives in A, Eric lives in B, Anita lives in C,
Ava lives in D, Scott lives in E, and Kelli lives in F.
x
M O P
(MN)2 (MP)2 (NP)2
(MN)2 92 72 130
MN 130
11.4
Chapter 2 36
10. Given: P is the midpoint of QR and ST, and
Postulates and Paragraph QR ST.
Proofs Prove: PQ PT
Q T
P
Page 91 Check for Understanding
1. Deductive reasoning is used to support claims
that are made in a proof. S R
2. Proof: Since P is the midpoint of QR and ST
,
PQ PR 1 2
QR and PS = PT = 1 ST by the
2
definition of midpoint. We are given QR
S T
so
QR ST by the definition of congruent segments.
By the Multiplication Property, 1
1
2 QR = 2 ST. So,
by substitution, PQ = PT.
11. Explore: There are six students, and each
student is connected to five other students with
ribbons.
3. postulates, theorems, algebraic properties,
Plan: Draw a diagram to illustrate the solution.
definitions
4. Explore: There are four points, and each pair is A B
to be connected by a segment.
Plan: Draw a diagram to illustrate the solution.
A B F C
E D
Solve: Let noncollinear points A, B, C, D, E, and
D C F represent the six students. Connect each point
Solve: Connect each point with every other point. with every other point. Then, count the number of
Then, count the number of segments. Between segments. Between every two points there is
every two points there is exactly one segment. For exactly one segment. For the 6 points, 15
the four points, six segments can be drawn. segments can be drawn.
Examine: The six segments that can be drawn Examine: In the figure, AB
, AC
, A
D
, A
E, A
F
, B
C
,
B
are A , A
C
, A
D
, BC, B
D
, and C
D
. D
B , B
E
, BF
, C
D
, C
E
, C
F
, D
E
, DF
, and E
F each
5. Explore: There are six points, and each pair is to represent a ribbon between two students. There
be connected by a segment. are 15 segments, so 15 ribbons are needed.
Plan: Draw a diagram to illustrate the solution 12. Explore: There are four points, and each pair is
B to be connected by a segment.
A Plan: Draw a diagram.
C
A
F
D
E
Solve: Connect each point with every other point.
Then, count the number of segments. Between
every two points there is exactly one segment. For
B C D
the 6 points, 15 segments can be drawn.
Solve: Connect each point with every other point.
Examine: The 15 segments that can be drawn
Then, count the number of segments. Between
are AB
, A
C
, A
D, A
E, A
F
, B
C
, B
D
, BE
, B
F, C
D, C
E
,
every two points there is exactly one segment. For
F
C , D
E
, D
F, and EF
.
the four points, six segments can be drawn.
6. Sometimes; if the planes have a common Examine: The six segments that can be drawn
intersection, then their intersection is one line. B
are A , A
C
, A
D
, BC, B
D
, and C
D
.
7. Definition of collinear
8. Through any three points not on the same line,
there is exactly one plane.
9. Through any two points, there is exactly one line.
37 Chapter 2
13. Explore: There are five points, and each pair is 21. Sometimes; and m could be skew, so they would
to be connected by a segment. not lie in the same plane.
Plan: Draw a diagram. 22. Postulate 2.1: Through any two points, there is
A B exactly one line.
23. Postulate 2.5: If two points lie in a plane, then the
entire line containing those points lies in that plane.
24. Postulate 2.2: Through any three points not on
the same line, there is exactly one plane.
C D E 25. Postulate 2.5: If two points lie in a plane, then the
Solve: Connect each point with every other point. entire line containing those points lies in the plane.
Then, count the number of segments. Between 26. Postulate 2.1: Through any two points, there is
every two points there is exactly one segment. For exactly one line.
the five points, ten segments can be drawn. 27. Postulate 2.2: Through any three points not on
Examine: The ten segments that can be drawn the same line, there is exactly one plane.
are
AB,
A
C,
AD,
AE,
B
C,
B
D,
B
E,
C
D,
C
E, and
D
E.
28. Given: C is the midpoint of A B.
14. Explore: There are six points, and each pair is to D
B is the midpoint of C .
be connected by a segment. Prove: A CB D
Plan: Draw a diagram.
B A C B D
Proof: We are given that C is the midpoint of A B,
and B is the midpoint of C D. By the definition of
midpoint A C
C B
and C B
B D. Using the
A C definition of congruent segments, AC CB, and
F CB BD. AC BD by the Transitive Property of
Equality. Thus, A C
B D
by the definition of
congruent segments.
E D
Solve: Connect each point with every other point. 29. There are 4 points, call them A, B, C, and D. Then
Then, count the number of segments. Between there is exactly one line between each pair of
every two points there is exactly one segment. For points, so there are 6 lines:
AB,
AC,
AD,
BC,
BD,
the 6 points, 15 segments can be drawn. and CD. The points are noncollinear and
Examine: The 15 segments that can be drawn noncoplanar, and through any three points not on
are AB
, A
C
, A
D, A
E
, AF
, B
C
, B
D
, B
E
, B
F
, C
D
, C
E
, the same line there is exactly one plane. So there
F
C , D
E
, D
F, and E
F. are 4 different planes: plane ABC, plane ACD,
15. Explore: There are seven points, and each pair is plane BCD, and plane ABD.
to be connected by a segment. 30. Sample answer: Lawyers make final arguments,
Plan: Draw a diagram which is a speech that uses deductive reasoning,
A B in court cases.
31. It’s possible that all five points lie in one plane.
The points are noncollinear, and through any
three points not on the same line there is exactly
C E one plane. If the five points are points A, B, C, D,
D
and E, then there are as many as 10 planes
defined by these points: plane ABC, plane ABD,
F G plane ABE, plane ACD, plane ACE, plane ADE,
Solve: Connect each point with every other point. plane BCD, plane BCE, plane BDE, and plane CDE.
Then, count the number of segments. Between 32. Sample answer: The forms and structures of
every two points there is exactly one segment. For different types of writing are accepted as true,
the 7 points, 21 segments can be drawn. such as the structure of a poem. Answers should
Examine: The 21 segments that can be drawn include the following.
are AB
, A
C, A
D
, A
E, A
F
, A
G, B
C, B
D
, B
E, B
F
, B
G, • The Declaration of Independence, “We hold
D
C , C
E, C
F
, C
G, D
E
, D
F, D
G, E
F, E
G
, and FG
. these truths to be self-evident, ...”
16. Sometimes; the three points cannot be on the • Through any two points, there is exactly one line.
same line. 33. C; A is true because Postulate 2.2 states that
17. Always; if two points lie in a plane, then the entire through any 3 points not on the same line, there
line containing those points lies in that plane. is exactly one plane.
18. Never; the intersection of a line and a plane can be B is true because Postulate 2.6 states that if 2
a point, but the intersection of two planes is a line. lines intersect, then their intersection is one point.
19. Sometimes; the three points cannot be on the D is true by the Midpoint Theorem.
same line. C is not true because it contradicts Postulate 2.1
which states that through any two points, there is
20. Always; one plane contains at least three points,
exactly one line.
so it must contain two.
Chapter 2 38
34. A; 44. 3y 57
(8x4 2x2 3x 5) (2x4 x3 3x 5) y 19
8x4 2x2 3x 5 2x4 x3 3x 5 y
45. 12 ¬14
6x4 x3 2x2 10 6
y
¬2
6
y ¬12
Page 93 Maintain Your Skills 46. t 3 ¬27
35. p: one has a part-time job t ¬24
q: one must work 20 hours per week t ¬24
Statement (3) is a valid conclusion by the Law of 47. 8n 39 ¬41
Detachment. 8n ¬80
36. Converse: If you have a computer, then you have n ¬10
access to the Internet at your house. False; you 48. 6x 33 ¬0
can have a computer and not have access to the 6x ¬33
Internet. 11
Inverse: If you do not have access to the Internet x ¬
2
at your house, then you do not have a computer.
False; it is possible to not have access to the
Internet and still have a computer.
Contrapositive: If you do not have a computer, 2-6 Algebraic Proof
then you do not have access to the Internet at
your house. False; you could have Internet access
through your television or wireless phone.
Page 97 Check for Understanding
1. Sample answer: If x 2 and x y 6, then
37. Converse: If ABC has an angle measure greater
2 y 6.
than 90, then ABC is a right triangle. False; the
triangle would be obtuse. 2. given and prove statements and two columns, one
Inverse: If ABC is not a right triangle, none of of statements and one of reasons.
its angle measures are greater than 90. False; it 3. hypothesis; conclusion
could be an obtuse triangle. 4. Division Property
Contrapositive: If ABC does not have an angle 5. Multiplication Property
measure greater than 90, ABC is not a right 6. Substitution
triangle. False; mABC could still be 90 and
7. Addition Property
ABC be a right triangle.
38. 8. Given: 2x 4x 7 11
Animal Prove: x 4
Arthropod Proof:
Butterfly Statements Reasons
1. 2x 4x 7 11 1. Given
d (x
x 2 1) (y2 2. 22x 4x 7 2(11)
39. 2 y1)2 2. Mult. Prop.
DF (4
) 312 ( 3)2
3. x 8x 14 22 3. Distributive Prop.
1 (
2 4) 17
2
4.1 4. 9x 14 22 4. Substitution
40. d (xx 2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2 5. 9x 36 5. Add. Prop.
MN (5
0) )
2 (5 22
6. x 4 6. Div. Prop.
(5)
2 3 34
2
5.8 9. Given: 5 2
3x 1
41. d (xx 2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2 Prove: x 6
PQ [1
8)]
( 2 (3 2)2 Proof:
95)
2 ( 106
2
Statements Reasons
10.3
42. d (xx a. ? 5 2
3x 1
a. Given
2 1) (y2
2 y1)2
RS [2
5)]
( 2 (1 12)2
b. 35 2
3 x 3(1)
b. ? Mult. Prop.
711)
2 ( 170 2
13.0 c. 15 2x 3 c. ? Dist. Prop.
43. m 17 8
d. ? 2x 12 d. Subt. Prop.
m 25
e. x 6 e. ? Div. Prop.
39 Chapter 2
3x 5
10. Given: 25 7( y 3) 5y 24. Given: 2 7
Prove: 2 y Prove: x 3
Proof: Proof:
Statements Reasons
Statements Reasons
1. 25 7( y 3) 5y 1. Given 3x 5
a. 2 7 a. ? Given
2. 25 7y 21 5y 2. Dist. Prop.
3x
3. 25 2y 21 3. Substitution b. ?
2
2
5
2(7) b. Mult. Prop.
Chapter 2 40
28. Given: 1
2m 9
3. mXCA mACB 3. Substitution
Prove: m 18 mYBA mABC
Proof: 4. mXCA mACB 4. Substitution
Statements Reasons mYBA mACB
5. mXCA mYBA 5. Subt. Prop.
1. 1
2m 9
1. Given
32. Given: Ek hf W
2. 2 1
2 m 2(9)
2. Mult. Prop. Ek W
Prove: f h
3. m 18 3. Substitution Proof:
2z 1
29. Given: 5
3 Statements Reasons
Prove: z 6 1. Ek hf W 1. Given
Proof:
2. Ek W hf 2. Subt. Prop.
Statements Reasons
Ek W
3. h f 3. Div. Prop.
1. 5 2
3z 1
1. Given
Ek W
2. 3 5 2
3 z 3(1) 2. Mult. Prop. 4. f h 4. Symmetric Prop.
X C B Y
Statements Reasons
1. mACB mABC 1. Given
2. mXCA mACB 180 2. Def. of supp.
mYBA mABC 180
41 Chapter 2
37. B; mP mQ mR ¬180 3. If two lines intersect, then their intersection is
mQ mQ 2(mQ) ¬180 exactly one point.
4(mQ) ¬180 4. If two points lie in a plane, then the entire line
mQ ¬45 containing those points lies in that plane.
mP ¬mQ 5. Given: 2(n 3) 5 3(n 1)
¬45 Prove: n 2
38. B; 4 x y 5 Proof:
x ¬y 9
Statements Reasons
1. 2(n 3) 5 3(n 1) 1. Given
Page 100 Maintain Your Skills
39. Let the four buildings be named A, B, C, and D. In 2. 2n 6 5 3n 3 2. Dist. Prop.
order to have exactly one sidewalk between each 3. 2n 1 3n 3 3. Substitution
building, there should be 6 sidewalks. If A B is the
sidewalk between buildings A and B, then the 6 4. 2n 1 2n 3n 3 2n 4. Subt. Prop.
sidewalks are AB, A
C, A
D
, BC
, B
D, and C D
.
5. 1 n 3 5. Substitution
40. Valid; since 24 is divisible by 6, the Law of
Detachment says it is divisible by 3. 6. 1 3 n 3 3 6. Add. Prop.
41. Invalid; 27 6 4.5, which is not an integer.
7. 2 n 7. Substitution
42. Valid; since 85 is not divisible by 3, the
contrapositive of the statement and the Law of 8. n 2 8. Symmetric
Detachment say that 85 is not divisible by 6. Prop.
43. Sample answer: If people are happy, then they
rarely correct their faults.
44. Sample answer: If you don’t know where you are 2-7 Proving Segment Relationships
going, then you will probably end up somewhere
else.
45. Sample answer: If a person is a champion, then Page 101 Geometry Software Investigation:
the person is afraid of losing. Adding Segment Measures
46. Sample answer: If we would have new knowledge, 1. See students’ work. The sum AB BC should
then we must get a whole new world of questions. always equal AC.
47. The measurement is precise to within 1
2 foot. So, 2. See students’ work. The sum AB BC should
1
a measurement of 13 feet could be 122 feet to always equal AC.
131
2 feet. 3. See students’ work. The sum AB BC should
48. The measurement is precise to within 0.05 meter. always equal AC.
So, a measurement of 5.9 meters could be 4. AB BC AC
5.85 meters to 5.95 meters. 5. no
49. The measurement is precise to within 0.5 inch.
So, a measurement of 74 inches could be
73.5 inches to 74.5 inches. Pages 103–104 Check for Understanding
50. The measurement is precise to within 1. Sample answer: The distance from Cleveland to
0.05 kilometer. So, a measurement of Chicago is the same as the distance from
3.1 kilometers could be 3.05 kilometers to Cleveland to Chicago.
3.15 kilometers.
B
2. Sample answer: If AX Y and X
YP Q
, then
51. JL ¬JK KL B
AP Q
.
25 ¬14 KL P
11 ¬KL B
52. PS ¬PQ QS A
51 ¬23 QS Y
28 ¬QS
53. WZ ¬WY YZ X
Q
WZ ¬38 9
WZ ¬47 3. If A, B, and C are collinear and AB BC AC,
then B is between A and C.
4. Reflexive
Page 100 Practice Quiz 2 5. Symmetric
1. Invalid; not all real numbers are integers. 6. Subtraction
2. Through any three points not on the same line,
there is exactly one plane.
Chapter 2 42
Q
7. Given: P R
S, Q
S
S
T
10. Given:
ABC
D
B
R S T
S
Prove: P R
T
Prove: C DA
B A
Q
C
D
P
Proof:
Proof:
Statements Reasons
Statements Reasons
B
1. AC
D
1. Given
a. ? , ? Q
P R
S
, a. Given
S
QS T
2. AB CD 2. Def. of segs.
Statements Reasons
Pages 104–106 Practice and Apply
12. Symmetric
P
1. AC
P
and B
P
D
P
1. Given
13. Substitution
2. AP CP and BP DP 2. Def. of segs. 14. Segment Addition
3. AP PB AB 3. Seg. Add. Post. 15. Transitive
4. CP DP AB 4. Substitution 16. Addition
5. CP PD CD 5. Seg. Add. Post. 17. Subtraction
18. Given: AD
C E , D
B
E
B
B
6. AB CD 6. Transitive Prop.
Prove: AB
C
B
B
7. AC
D
7. Def. of segs.
D E
9. Given:
HI T
U
H
and HJTV
Prove: IJ
UV I A C
Proof:
T U V Statements: Reasons:
J
Proof: a. ? D
AC
E
, D
B
E
B
a. Given
43 Chapter 2
19. Given:
X
YWZ and
W
Z
A
B W d. WY WA AY, d. ? Segment
B
Prove: X YA
B
ZX ZA AX Addition Post.
A
X e. WA AY ZA AX e. ? Substitution
Y Z
Proof: f. WA WA ZA ZA f. ? Substitution
Y
1. XW
Z
and W
Z
A
B
1. Given h. ? WA ZA h. Division Property
Proof:
20. Given:
A
B A
C and
P
C Q
B C B
P
Prove: A A Q
Statements Reasons
P Q
M
1. LP
N and X
M
X
N
1. Given
A 2. LM PN and XM XN 2. Def. of segs.
Proof:
3. LM LX XM, 3. Seg. Add. Post.
Statements Reasons
PN PX XN
B
1. A A
C
and P
C
Q
B
1. Given 4. LX XM PX XN 4. Substitution
P
8. AA
Q
8. Def. of segs. 1. AB BC 1. Given
21. Given:
WYZ X
W 2. AC AB BC 2. Seg. Add. Post.
Y
A is the midpoint of W .
A is the midpoint of
ZX. 3. AC BC BC 3. Substitution
A
Prove: W Z A
Z X
A 4. AC 2BC 4. Substitution
24. Given:
AB
Proof: Y
Prove: A BA
B
A B
Proof:
Statements Reasons
Statements Reasons
Y
a. W Z X
a. ? Given B
1. A 1. Given
Y
A is the midpoint of W .
A is the midpoint of
ZX. 2. AB AB 2. Reflexive Prop.
B
3. AA
B
3. Def. of segs.
b. WY ZX b. ? Def. of segs.
c. ? WA AY, ZA AX c. Definition of
midpoint
Chapter 2 44
25. Given:
ABD E AQ ¬1
2 AD
C is the midpoint
¬1
1
2 39 4
D
of B.
C
Prove: A C E ¬195
8
A B C D E 1
BP ¬2BC
Proof:
Statements Reasons
¬1
2 12 4
3
¬63
B
1. AD E, C is the 1. Given 8
D
midpoint of B AP ¬AB BP
2. BC CD 2. Def. of midpoint ¬141
3
4 68
¬205
3. AB DE 3. Def. of segs. 8
AP ¬AQ QP
4. AB BC CD DE 4. Add. Prop.
205 5
8 ¬19 8 QP
5. AB BC AC 5. Seg. Add. Post. 1 ¬QP
CD DE CE
30. Let x be the price of a box of popcorn. Then a tub
6. AC CE 6. Substitution of popcorn costs 2x.
60(2x) ¬150
C
7. AC
E
7. Def. of segs.
120x ¬150
26. Given:
AB E
F and x ¬1.25
C
B D
E
Thus, a box of popcorn costs $1.25 and a tub costs
C
Prove: A D F 2(1.25) or $2.50.
C D Total popcorn sales were $275 and $150 of that
A F
B E was for tubs, so boxes account for $275 $150 or
125
$125. So the number of boxes sold was 1.2
5
or 100.
Proof:
Statements Reasons
Page 106 Maintain Your Skills
B
1. A E
F and 1. Given 31. Substitution
C
B D
E
32. Distributive Property
2. AB EF and BC DE 2. Def. of segs. 33. Addition Property
34. Transitive Property
3. AB BC DE EF 3. Add. Prop.
35. Never; the midpoint of a segment divides it into
4. AC AB BC, 4. Seg. Add. Post. two congruent segments.
1DF DE EF 36. Sometimes; if the lines have a common
intersection point, then it is a single point.
5. AC DF 5. Substitution
37. Always; if two planes intersect, they intersect in
C
6. AD
F
6. Def. of segs. a line.
38. Sometimes; if the points are noncollinear, then
27. Sample answers: L N
Q O and
they lie on three distinct lines.
M
L M NR SS TQ PP O
39. P ¬2 2w
28. Sample answer: You can use segment addition to
44 ¬2(2x 7) 2(x 6)
find the total distance between two destinations
44 ¬4x 14 2x 12
by adding the distances of various points in
44 ¬6x 26
between. Answers should include the following.
18 ¬6x
• A passenger can add the distance from San 3 ¬x
Diego to Phoenix and the distance from Phoenix 2x 7 ¬2(3) 7 or 13
to Dallas to find the distance from San Diego to x 6 ¬3 6 or 9
Dallas. The dimensions of the rectangle are 9 cm by
• The Segment Addition Postulate can be useful if 13 cm.
you are traveling in a straight line. 40. 2x x ¬90
29. B; AD ¬AB BC CD 3x ¬90
¬141 3 1 x ¬30
4 12 4 12 4
41. 2x 4x ¬90
¬391
4 6x ¬90
x ¬15
45 Chapter 2
42. 3x 2 x ¬90 6. Given: 1 and 2 are supplementary, 3 and 4
4x 2 ¬90 are supplementary, 1 4
4x ¬88 Prove: 2 3
x ¬22
43. x 3x ¬180
4x ¬180 1 2 3 4
x ¬45 Proof:
44. 26x 10x ¬180
36x ¬180 Statements Reasons
x ¬5 a. 1 and 2 are a. ? Given
45. 4x 10 3x 5 ¬180 supplementary.
7x 5 ¬180 3 and 4 are
7x ¬175 supplementary.
x ¬25 1 4
b. m1 m2 180 b. ? Def. of supp.
m3 m4 180
2-8 Proving Angle Relationships c. m1 m2 c. ? Substitution
m3 m4
Page 110 Geometry Activity: Right Angles d. m1 m4 d. ? Def. of
1. The lines are perpendicular.
e. m2 m3 e. ? Subt. Prob.
2. They are congruent and they form linear pairs.
3. 90 f. 2 3 f. ? Def. of
4. They form right angles.
7. Given:
VX bisects WVY, W
5. They all measure 90° and are congruent.
VY bisects XVZ.
Prove: WVX YVZ X
V
Pages 111–112 Check for Understanding Y
1. Tomas; Jacob’s answer left out the part of ABC
represented by EBF. Z
2. Sample Answer: If 1 2 and 2 3, Proof:
then 1 3.
1 2 3 Statements Reasons
Chapter 2 46
11. Given: ABC is a right angle. C m11 4x
B
Prove: 1 and 2 are 2 4(31) or 124
1
complementary angles. m12 2x 6
A 2(31) 6 or 56
21. 13 14
Proof: m13 ¬m14
2x 94 ¬7x 49
Statements Reasons 2x 45 ¬7x
1. ABC is a right angle. 1. Given 45 ¬5x
9 ¬x
2. mABC 90 2. Def. of rt. m13 2x 94
3. mABC m1 m2 3. Angle Add. Post. 2(9) 94 or 112
4. m1 m2 90 4. Substitution m14 7x 49
7(9) 49 or 112
5. 1 and 2 are 5. Def. of comp.
complementary angles. 22. 15 16
m15 ¬m16
12. 1 and 2 are complementary to X, so x ¬6x 290
1 2. 5x ¬290
m1 ¬m2 x ¬58
2n 2 ¬n 32 m15 m16 58
2n ¬n 30 23. 17 18
n ¬30 m17 ¬m18
13. m1 ¬2n 2 2x 7 ¬x 30
¬2(30) 2 2x ¬x 23
¬62 x ¬23
14. m2 n 32 m17 2x 7
30 32 2(23) 7
62 53
15. mX m1 ¬90 m18 x 30
mX 62 ¬90 23 30 or 53
mX ¬28 24. m19 m20 ¬180
100 20x 20x ¬180
100 40x ¬180
Pages 112–114 Practice and Apply 40x ¬80
16. m1 m2 ¬180 x ¬2
m1 67 ¬180 m19 100 20x
m1 ¬113 100 20(2) or 140
17. m3 m4 ¬90 m20 20x
38 m4 ¬90 20(2) or 40
m4 ¬52 25. Given: A
18. 7 and 8 are complementary, so Prove: A A
m7 m8 90. Also,
A
m5 m6 m7 m8 180, so by Proof:
substitution m5 m6 90. m6 29, so
m5 61. 5 8 so m8 m5 61. Finally, Statements Reasons
m7 m8 90 so m7 90 61 or 29.
1. A is an angle. 1. Given
19. m9 m10 ¬180
2x 4 2x 4 ¬180 2. mA mA 2. Reflexive Prop.
4x ¬180 3. A A 3. Def. of angles
x ¬45
m9 ¬2x 4
¬2(45) 4 or 86
m10 ¬2x 4
¬2(45) 4 or 94
20. m11 m12 ¬180
4x 2x 6 ¬180
6x 6 ¬180
6x ¬186
x ¬31
47 Chapter 2
26. Given: 1 2, 2 3 35. Given: m
Prove: 1 3 Prove: 1 2
1 2 m
3 4
1 2 3
Proof:
Proof:
Statements Reasons
Statements Reasons
1. 1 2, 2 3 1. Given
1. m 1. Given
2. m1 m2, 2. Def. of angles
m2 m3 2. 1 and 2 are rt. 2. lines intersect
to form 4 rt. .
3. m1 m3 3. Trans. Prop.
3. 1 2 3. All rt. are .
4. 1 3 4. Def. of angles
27. sometimes
36. Given: 1 2, 1 and 2
28. always are supplementary.
29. always Prove: 1 and 2 are rt. . 1 2
30. sometimes Proof:
31. sometimes
Statements Reasons
32. always
33. Given: m 1. 1 2, 1 and 2 1. Given
Prove: 2, 3, 4 are rt. are supplementary.
1 2 m 2. m1 m2 180 2. Def. of supp.
3 4
3. m1 m2 3. Def. of angle
Proof: 4. m1 m1 180 4. Substitution
Statements Reasons
5. 2(m1) 180 5. Add. Prop.
11. m 11. Given
12. 1 is a right angle. 12. Def. of 6. m1 90 6. Div. Prop.
Chapter 2 48
38. Given: ABD YXZ 42. m1 m4 ¬90;
Prove: CBD WXZ m1 m2 m3 m4 ¬180
W X Y m1 m1 m4 m4 ¬180
2(m1) 2(m4) ¬180
D 2(m1 m4) ¬180
Z
m1 m4 ¬90
43. Two angles that are supplementary to the same
A B C
angle are congruent. Answers should include the
Proof: following.
Statements Reasons • 1 and 2 are supplementary; 2 and 3 are
supplementary.
1. ABD YXZ, ABD and 1. Given; from • 1 and 3 are vertical angles, and are
CBD form a linear pair. the figure therefore congruent.
YXZ and WXZ form a • If two angles are complementary to the same
linear pair. angle, then the angles are congruent.
2. mABD mCBD 180, 2. Linear pairs 44. B; Let x be the measure of one angle. Then the
mYXZ mWXZ 180 are supple- measure of the other angle is 90 x.
mentary. x 4
90 x ¬1
3. mABD mCBD 3. Substitution x ¬4(90 x)
mYXZ mWXZ x ¬360 4x
5x ¬360
4. mABD mYXZ 4. Def. of x ¬72
The other angle has mesure 90 72 or 18.
5. mYXZ mCBD 5. Substitution
mYXZ mWXZ 45. B; The members of set T are 1, 4, 9, 16, 25, 36,
and 49. The median of these numbers is 16.
6. mYXZ mYXZ 6. Reflexive
Prop.
7. mCBD mWXZ 7. Subt. Prop. Page 114 Maintain Your Skills
8. CBD WXZ 8. Def. of 46. Given: G is between F and H.
H is between G and J.
39. Given: mRSW mTSU Prove: FG GJ FH HJ
Prove: mRST mWSU
J
G H
T F
R
W Proof:
U Statements Reasons
S
1. G is between F and H; 1. Given
Proof: H is between G and J.
Statements Reasons 2. FG GJ FJ, 2. Segment Addition
FH HJ FJ Postulate
1. mRSW mTSU 1. Given
3. FJ FH HJ 3. Symmetric Prop.
2. mRSW mRST 2. Angle Addition
4. FG GJ FH HJ 4. Transitive Prop.
mTSW, mTSU Postulate
mTSW mWSU Y
47. Given: X is the midpoint of W.
3. mRST mTSW 3. Substitution Prove: WX YZ XZ
mTSW mWSU
4. mTSW mTSW 4. Reflexive Prop. W X Y
5. mRST mWSU 5. Subt. Prop. Z
Proof:
40. m1 m2 ¬180
28 m2 ¬180
m2 ¬152 Statements Reasons
41. Because the lines are perpendicular, the angles Y
1. X is the midpoint of W. 1. Given
formed are right angles. All right angles are
2. WX XY 2. Def. of midpoint
congruent. Therefore, 1 is congruent to 2.
3. XY YZ XZ 3. Segment Addition
Postulate
4. WX YZ XZ 4. Substitution
49 Chapter 2
48. Given: AC BD 14. The sum of the measures of two supplementary
A B C D angles is 180 and 1 0.; false, because r is true
Prove: AB CD
Proof: and p is false.
15. 1 0, and in a right triangle with right angle C,
Statements Reasons a2 b2 c2, or the sum of the measures of two
1. AC BD 1. Given supplementary angles is 180.; false, because q is
true and r is true so q r is true but p is false.
2. AB BC AC, 2. Segment Addition
16. In a right triangle with right angle C,
BC CD BD Postulate
a2 b2 c2, or 1 0 or the sum of the
3. BC BC 3. Reflexive Prop. measures of two supplementary angles is 180.;
4. AB BC BC CD 4. Substitution (2 and 3) true, because p is false and r is true so p r is
true but q is true.
5. AB CD 5. Subt. Prop.
17. In a right triangle with right angle C,
49. ONM, MNR a2 b2 c2 and the sum of the measures of two
supplementary angles is 180, and 1 0.; false,
50. PMQ QMN
because q is true and r is true so q r is true but
51. N or R p is false.
52. POQ, QON, NOM, MOP 18. Converse: If an angle is obtuse, then it measures
53. obtuse 120. False; the measure could be any value
54. Sample answer:
NR and
NP between 90 and 180.
55. NML, NMP, NMO, RNM, ONM Inverse: If an angle measure does not equal 120,
then it is not obtuse. False; the measure could be
any value other than 120 between 90 and 180.
Contrapositive: If an angle is not obtuse, then its
Chapter 2 Study Guide and Review measure does not equal 120; true.
19. Converse: If a month has 31 days, then it is
March. False; July has 31 days.
Page 115 Vocabulary and Concept Check Inverse: If a month is not March, then it does not
1. conjecture have 31 days. False; July has 31 days.
2. truth value Contrapositive: If a month does not have 31 days,
3. compound then it is not March; true.
4. and 20. Converse: If a point lies on the y-axis, then its
ordered pair has 0 for its x-coordinate; true.
5. hypothesis
Inverse: If an ordered pair does not have 0 for its
6. converse x-coordinate, then the point does not lie on the
7. Postulates y-axis; true.
8. informal proof Contrapositive: If a point does not lie on the
y-axis, then its ordered pair does not have 0 for its
x-coordinate; true.
Pages 115–120 Lesson-by-Lesson Review 21. true, because the hypothesis is satisfied and the
9. mA mB 180 conclusion follows
22. true, because the hypothesis is not satisfied and
we cannot say the statement is false
45 135 23. false, because the hypothesis is satisfied yet the
A B conclusion does not follow
24. true, because the hypothesis is not satisfied and
Z
10. Y is the midpoint of X. we cannot say the statement is false
X Y Z 25. Valid; by definition, adjacent angles have a
common vertex.
11. LMNO is a square.
26. Invalid; vertical angles also have a common
M N vertex.
27. yes; Law of Detachment
p: a student attends North High School
L O q: a student has an ID number
28. Invalid; Statements (1) and (2) are true, but (3)
12. 1 0 and in a right triangle with right angle C, does not follow from (1) and (2).
a2 b2 c2.; false, because p is false and q is true.
29. yes; Law of Syllogism
13. In a right triangle with right angle C, p: you like pizza with everything
a2 b2 c2 or the sum of the measures of two q: you like Cardo’s Pizza
supplementary angles is 180.; true, because q is r: you are a pizza connoisseur
true and r is true.
Chapter 2 50
30. Never; the intersection of two lines is a point. 45. Given: AC AB, AC 4x 1, AB 6x 13
31. Always; if P is the midpoint of XY
, then X
PPY. Prove: x 7
By definition of congruent segments, XP PY. A 6x 13 B
32. sometimes; if M, X, and Y are collinear
33. sometimes; if the points are collinear 4x 1 C
34. Always; there is exactly one line through Q and R. Proof:
The line lies in at least one plane.
35. sometimes; if the right angles form a linear pair Statements Reasons
36. Always; the Reflexive Property states that 1 1. 1. AC AB, AC 4x 1,
1. Given
37. Never; adjacent angles must share a common AB 6x 13
side, and vertical angles do not. 2. 4x 1 6x 13 2. Substitution
38. Given: M is the midpoint of A B
and Q is the
3. 4x 1 1 6x 13 1 3. Subt. Prop.
midpoint of A M
.
Prove: AQ 1
4 AB 4. 4x 6x 14 4. Substitution
A Q M B 5. 4x 6x 6x 14 6x 5. Subt. Prop.
B
Proof: If M is the midpoint of A, then
6. 2x 14 6. Substitution
AM 1
M
2 (AB). Since Q is the midpoint of A,
2
x 1
4
2 2
7. 7. Div. Prop.
AQ 1 1 1 1
2 AM or 2 2 (AB) 4 AB.
8. x 7 8. Substitution
39. Distributive Property
40. Division Property
41. Subtraction Property 46. Given: MN PQ, PQ RS
42. Transitive Property Prove: MN RS
43. Given: 5 2 1
2x
M N R
Prove: x 6
Proof: P Q
S
Statements Reasons Proof:
1. 5 2 1
2x 1. Given Statements Reasons
1. MN PQ, PQ RS 1. Given
2. 5 2 2 1
2x 2
2. Subt. Prop.
2. MN RS 2. Transitive Prop.
3. 3 1
2x 3. Substitution
4. 2(3) 2 1
2x 4. Mult. Prop. 47. Reflexive Property
48. Symmetric Property
5. 6 x 5. Substitution
49. Addition Property
6. x 6 6. Symmetric Prop. 50. Transitive Property
x 10 51. Division or Multiplication Property
44. Given: x 1 2
52. Addition Property
Prove: x 4
Proof: 53. Given: BC EC, CA CD B E
Prove: BA DE
Statements Reasons
C
x
10
1. x 1 2 1. Given
D
x
2. 2(x 1) 2 10
2 2. Mult. Prop.
Proof:
A
9. x 4 9. Substitution
51 Chapter 2
54. Given: AB CD 9. 3 2, or 3x 12 when x 4 and an equilateral
Prove: AC BD triangle is also equiangular.; true, because
q is true and r is true so q r is true and
A B C D p is false
Proof: 10. Hypothesis: you eat an apple a day; Conclusion:
the doctor will stay away; If you eat an apple a
Statements Reasons
day, then the doctor will stay away.
1. AB CD 1. Given Converse: If the doctor stays away, then you eat
2. BC BC 2. Reflexive Prop. an apple a day.
Inverse: If you do not eat an apple a day, then the
3. AB BC CD BC 3. Add. Prop.
doctor will not stay away.
4. AB BC AC 4. Seg. Add. Post. Contrapositive: If the doctor does not stay away,
CD BC BD then you do not eat an apple a day.
5. AC BD 5. Substitution 11. Hypothesis: a stone is rolling; Conclusion: it
gathers no moss; If a stone is rolling, then it
55. m6 180 35 or 145 gathers no moss.
56. m7 180 157 or 23 Converse: If a stone gathers no moss, then it is
57. m8 180 90 or 90 rolling.
58. Given: 1 and 2 form a linear Inverse: If a stone is not rolling, then it gathers
pair. m2 2(m1) moss.
1 2
Prove: m1 60 Contrapositive: If a stone gathers moss, then it is
Proof: not rolling.
12. valid; Law of Detachment
Statements Reasons p: two lines are perpendicular
a. 1 and 2 form a linear q: the lines intersect
a. ? Given
pair. 13. m1 73 95
b. 1 and 2 are b. ? Supplement m1 22
supplementary. Theorem 14. m2 180 (m1 73)
c. ? m1 m2 c. Definition of 180 (22 73)
180 supplementary 85
angles 15. m3 m2
85
d. m2 2(m1) d. ? Given
16. Given: y 4x 9; x 2
e. ? m1 2(m1) e. Substitution Prove: y 17
180 Proof:
f. ? 3(m1) 180 f. Substitution Statements Reasons
3(m1) 18
0 1. y 4x 9; x 2 1. Given
g. 3 3 g. ? Division
Property 2. y 4(2) 9 2. Substitution
h. ? m1 60 h. Substitution 3. y 8 9 3. Substitution
4. y 17 4. Substitution
Chapter 2 Practice Test
17. Given: AM CN, MB ND A M B
Prove: AB CD
Page 121
1. Sample answer: Formal is the two-column proof,
informal can be paragraph proofs. D N C
2. Sample answer: You can use a counterexample. Proof:
3. Sample answer: statements and reasons to justify We are given that AM CN, MB ND. By the
statements Addition Property, AM MB CN MB. Then
by Substitution, AM MB CN ND. Using the
4. true; Symmetric Prop.
Segment Addition Postulate, AB AM MB, and
5. false; y 2 CD CN ND. Then, by Substitution AB CD.
6. false; a 4 18. Hypothesis: you are a hard-working person;
7. 3 2 and 3x 12 when x 4.; false, because Conclusion: you deserve a great vacation; If you
p is false and q is true are a hard-working person, then you deserve a
8. 3 2 or 3x 12 when x 4.; true, because great vacation.
p is false and q is true 19. A
Chapter 2 52
Chapter 2 Standardized Test Practice 14a. Possible lengths and Perimeter of
widths where area is rectangle with given
100 sq ft length and width
Pages 122–123 1 ft by 100 ft 202 ft
1. D; 49 0.143 2.646 49
2. C; 2(7) 3 11, so (7, 11) is on the line. 2 ft by 50 ft 104 ft
2(4) 3 5, so (4, 5) is on the line. 4 ft by 25 ft 58 ft
2(2) 3 7, so (2, 10) is not on the line.
2(5) 3 13, so (5, 13) is on the line. 5 ft by 20 ft 50 ft
3. A; a protractor is used to measure angles, not 10 ft by 10 ft 40 ft
lengths. A calculator is not a measuring tool. A
centimeter ruler is more accurate than a The dimensions that require the least amount of
yardstick because its unit of measurement fencing are 10 ft by 10 ft.
(centimeters) is smaller. 14b. Sample answer: Make a list of all possible whole-
E
4. B; D E F so DE EF. number lengths and widths that will form a
8x 3 ¬3x 7 100-square-foot area. Then find the perimeter of
8x ¬3x 10 each rectangle. Choose the length and width
5x ¬10 combination that has the smallest perimeter.
x ¬2 14c. As the length and width get closer to having the
5. A; ACF DCF ACD by the Angle Addition same measure as one another, the amount of
Postulate. So mACF mDCF 90 since fencing required decreases.
ACD is a right angle. Then ACF and DCF 15. Given: 1 and 3 are vertical angles.
are complementary angles. m1 3x 5, m3 2x 8
6. C; inductive reasoning uses specific examples to Prove: m1 14
make a conjecture.
2 3
7. A 1 4
8. A; divide both sides by 3.
9. The shortest distance is the length of the Proof:
hypotenuse of the right triangle whose legs have
Statements Reasons
lengths 120 yd and 531
3 yd. Use the Pythagorean a. 1 and 3 are vertical
Theorem to find the length of the hypotenuse.
angles. m1 3x 5, a. Given
Call this length d.
2 m3 2x 8
d2 (120)2 531
3 b. 1 3 b. Vert. are
25,600
d2 14,400
9 c. m1 m3 c. Def. of
d ¬17,24
4.4 d. 3x 5 2x 8 d. Substitution
d ¬131 yd
10. inverse e. x 5 8 e. Subt. Prop.
11. (p → q) (q → r) → (p → r) f. x 3 f. Subt. Prop.
Martina drank 300 mg of calcium.
g. m1 3(3) 5 g. Substitution
12. Segment Addition Postulate
13. Sample answer: Marti can measure a third h. m1 14 h. Substitution
distance c, the distance between the ends of the
two sides, and make sure it satisfies the equation
a2 b2 c2.
53 Chapter 2
Chapter 3 Parallel and Perpendicular Lines
Page 125 Getting Started 2. Juanita; Eric has listed interior angles, but they
1.
PQ are not alternate interior angles.
2.
PR or
RS 3. Sample answer: looking down railroad tracks
3.
ST 4. ABC, JKL, ABK, CDM
4.
TR or TP B
5. A , J
K, L
M
5. The arcs in the figure indicate that 2 is K
6. B , C
L, J
K
, L
M
, BL
, K
M
congruent to 4, 6, and 8. 7. q and r, q and t, r and t
6. The arcs in the figure indicate that 5 is 8. p and q, p and t, q and t
congruent to 1, 3, and 7. 9. p and r, p and t, r and t
7. The arcs in the figure indicate that 3 is 10. p and q, p and r, q and r
congruent to 1, 5, and 7. 11. alternate interior
8. The arcs in the figure indicate that 8 is 12. corresponding
congruent to 2, 4, and 6.
13. consecutive interior
9. y 7x 12
14. alternate exterior
7(3) 12
21 12 9 15. p; consecutive interior
2 16. p; alternate exterior
10. y ¬3x 4
17. q; alternate interior
2
¬3(8) 4 18. Sample answer: The pillars form parallel lines.
1612
¬3 4
3 3
19. Sample answer: The roof and the floor are parallel
planes.
11. 2x 4y ¬18
2(6) 4y ¬18 20. Sample answer: One of the west pillars and the
12 4y ¬18 base on the east side form skew lines.
4y ¬6 21. Sample answer: The top of the memorial “cuts”
y ¬6
4 or 2
3 the pillars.
Chapter 3 54
48. Skew lines; the planes are flying in different 61. mEFG is less than 90; Law of Detachment
directions and at different altitudes. p: an angle is acute
G
49. C , DH, E
I q: its measure is less than 90
E
50. D , FG
, H
I, G
H
, B
F
, D
H
, E
I 62. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
51. No; plane ADE will intersect all the planes if they AB ¬
[3 (
1)]2
[4
(8)]2
are extended.
¬ 2
42 12
52. Sample answers: parallel bars in gymnastics,
¬160
parallel port on a computer, parallel events, parallel
voices in a choir, latitude parallels on a map ¬12.65
53. Infinite number; consider any line through P in 63. d ¬(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
any plane that does not contain . CD ¬
(2
0)2
(9
1)2
54. 1 ¬(2)2
82 ¬68
55. Sample answer: Parallel lines and planes are used ¬8.25
in architecture to make structures that will be 64. d ¬(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
stable. Answers should include the following.
EF ¬[5
(
3)]2 [4 2
(12)]
• Opposite walls should form parallel planes; the
floor may be parallel to the ceiling. ¬
82 1
62 ¬320
• The plane that forms a stairway will not be ¬17.89
parallel to some of the walls. 65. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
56. A GH ¬(9
4
)2 [
25 (10)]2
57. The elements of M are 15, 18, 21, 24, 27, and 30. ¬
52 (
15)2 ¬250
The elements of P are 16, 20, 24, and 28. The
numbers that are in P but not in M are 16, 20, ¬15.81
and 28. Select any one of these three numbers. 66. d ¬(x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
2
JK ¬ (3 1)2 7
4 4
1
Page 131 Maintain Your Skills ¬
(4)2
(2)2 ¬20
58. Given: mABC ¬mDFE
¬4.47
m1 ¬m4
Prove: m2 ¬m3 A D 67. d ¬(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
1 4 2
2 3 LM ¬ [5 (5)]2 2
5 5
8
Proof: B C E F
¬102
(2)2 ¬104
Statements Reasons ¬10.20
68.
1. mABC mDFE 1. Given M
m1 m4
2. mABC m1 m2 2. Angle Addition A P B
mDFE m3 m4 Post. N
3. m1 m2 m3 3. Substitution Prop.
m4 69. T
4. m4 m2 m3 4. Substitution Prop. R
m4
S
5. m2 m3 5. Subt. Prop.
70. 50, 180 50 or 130
The measures of the angles are 50 and 130.
59. P Q R
71. 90, 180 90 or 90
The measures of the angles are 90 and 90.
72. x 2x ¬180
X Y Z 3x ¬180
x ¬60
Q
Since P Z Y and QR
X Y, PQ ZY and
60, 2(60) or 120
QR XY by the definition of congruent segments.
By the Addition Property, PQ QR ZY XY. The measures of the angles are 60 and 120.
Using the Segment Addition Postulate, 73. 2y 3y ¬180
PR PQ QR and XZ XY YZ. By 5y ¬180
substitution, PR XZ. Because the measures are y ¬36
R
equal, PX Z by the definition of congruent 2y ¬2(36) or 72
segments. 3y ¬3(36) or 108
60. no conclusion The measures of the angles are 72 and 108.
55 Chapter 3
74. x 2x 3x ¬180 2.
6x ¬180 35
x ¬30
35
There are two linear pairs in the figure. In one
linear pair the angles measure x and
3x 2x 5x, or 30 and 150. In the other pair the 3. 1; all other angles can be determined using the
angles measure 3x and x 2x 3x, or 90 and 90. Corresponding Angles Postulate, the Alternate
75. 3x 1 2x 6 ¬180 Interior Angles Theorem, the Consecutive Interior
5x 5 ¬180 Angles Theorem, and the Alternate Exterior
5x ¬175 Angles Theorem.
x ¬35 4. Alternate Interior Angles Theorem
3x 1 ¬3(35) 1
5. 1 ¬3
¬104
m1 ¬m3
2x 6 ¬2(35) 6
m1 ¬110
¬76
6. 6 ¬3
The measures of the angles are 76 and 104.
m6 ¬m3
m6 ¬110
Page 132 Geometry Software Investigation: 7. 2 and 3 are supplementary.
Angles and Parallel Lines m2 m3 ¬180
1. The pairs of corresponding angles are AEG and m2 110 ¬180
CFE, AEF and CFH, BEG and DFE, m2 ¬70
BEF and DFH. The pairs of alternate interior 8. 10 ¬12
angles are AEF and DFE, BEF and CFE. m10 ¬m12
The pairs of alternate exterior angles are AEG m10 ¬55
and DFH, BEG and CFH. The pairs of 9. 13 ¬12
consecutive interior angles are AEF and CFE, m13 ¬m12
BEF and DFE. m13 ¬55
2. The pairs of corresponding angles in Exercise 1 10. 15 ¬12
that have the same measure are AEG and m15 ¬m12
CFE, AEF and CFH, BEG and DFE, m15 ¬55
BEF and DFH. The pairs of alternate interior 11. 8y 2 25y 20 ¬180
angles that have the same measure are AEF 33y 18 ¬180
and DFE, BEF and CFE. The pairs of 33y ¬198
alternate exterior angles that have the same y ¬6
measure are AEG and DFH, BEG and CFH. 10x 8y 2 ¬180
3. They are supplementary. 10x 8(6) 2 ¬180
4a. If two parallel lines are cut by a transversal, 10x 50 ¬180
then corresponding angles are congruent. 10x ¬130
4b. If two parallel lines are cut by a transversal, x ¬13
then alternate interior angles are congruent. 12. 4x 5 ¬3x 11
4c. If two parallel lines are cut by a transversal, 4x ¬3x 16
then alternate exterior angles are congruent. x ¬16
4d. If two parallel lines are cut by a transversal, then 4x 5 3y 1 ¬180
consecutive interior angles are supplementary. 4(16) 5 3y 1 ¬180
60 3y ¬180
5. Yes; the angle pairs show the same relationships.
3y ¬120
6. See students’ work. y ¬40
7a. Sample answer: All of the angles measure 90°. 13. 36
7b. Sample answer: If two parallel lines are cut by a 2
transversal so that it is perpendicular to one of 1
the lines, then the transversal is perpendicular 3
to the other line. 31
Chapter 3 56
Theorem. So m3 31. 27. 5 ¬3
m1 ¬m2 m3 m5 ¬m3
¬36 31 or 67 m5 ¬60
28. 2 and 6 are supplementary.
m2 m6 ¬180
Pages 136–138 Practice and Apply m4 m5 m6 ¬180
14. 3 ¬9 m6 ¬180 (m4 m5)
m3 ¬m9 m2 180 (m4 m5) ¬180
m3 ¬75 m2 ¬m4 m5
15. 5 ¬9 5 ¬3
m5 ¬m9 m5 ¬m3
m5 ¬75 From Exercise 26,
16. 6 and 9 are supplementary. m4 ¬m1 50
m6 m9 ¬180 m2 ¬m1 m3
m6 75 ¬180 m2 ¬50 60
m6 ¬105 m2 ¬110
17. 7 ¬9 29. m6 m4 m5 ¬180
m7 ¬75 m6 50 60 ¬180
7 and 8 are supplementary. m6 ¬70
m7 m8 ¬180 30. 7 ¬2
75 m8 ¬180 m7 ¬m2
m8 ¬105 m2 ¬110 (from Exercise 28)
18. 11 ¬9 So m7 ¬110.
m11 ¬m9 31. 8 is congruent to an angle that forms a linear
m11 ¬75 pair with 3.
19. 12 and 9 are supplementary. m8 m3 ¬180
m12 m9 ¬180 m8 60 ¬180
m12 75 ¬180 m8 ¬120
m12 ¬105 32. 4x 56 ¬180
20. 2 and 3 are supplementary. 4x ¬124
m2 m3 ¬180 x ¬31
m2 43 ¬180 3y 11 56 ¬180
m2 ¬137 3y 45 ¬180
21. 7 ¬3 3y ¬135
m7 ¬m3 y ¬45
m7 ¬43 33. 2x ¬68
22. 10 ¬2 x ¬34
m10 ¬m2 68 3x 15 y2 ¬180
m10 ¬137 68 3(34) 15 y2 ¬180
155 y2 ¬180
23. 11 ¬3
y2 ¬25
m11 ¬m3
y ¬5
m11 ¬43
34.
24. 13 ¬3
m13 ¬m3
m13 ¬43 110
4
25. 16 ¬2
m16 ¬m2 2
1
m16 ¬137 3
26. 37
7
2
6 p Draw a third line through the vertex of 1
9 4 5 8
parallel to the two given lines.
1
3
q 2 4 by the Alternate Interior Angles
j Theorem. m4 110 180, so m4 70 and
k m n hence m2 70.
4 ¬9
3 is congruent to the angle whose measure is
9 ¬1
labeled 37° by the Alternate Interior Angles
4 ¬1
Theorem. So m3 ¬37.
m4 ¬m1
m1 ¬m2 m3
m4 ¬50
¬70 37 or 107
57 Chapter 3
35. 39. Given: m p
Prove: 1 ¬8
2 ¬7 1 2
3 4
1 5 6
5 7 8
m
4 90 3 157
2 Proof:
Statements Reasons
1. m 1. Given
Extend the ray that forms the 157° angle in the 2. 1 ¬5, 2 ¬6 2. Corresponding
opposite direction so that the line crosses the left Angles Postulate
line of the pair of parallel lines.
3. 5 ¬8, 6 ¬7 3. Vertical Angles
Then m4 90.
Theorem
m5 m4 m2 ¬180
m5 ¬180 m4 m2 4. 1 ¬8, 2 ¬7 4. Transitive Property
m5 ¬180 90 m2
40. Given: m n, is
m5 ¬90 m2
a transversal. m
2 ¬3 1 3
Prove: 1 and 2 are
m2 ¬m3 2 4
supplementary; n
m3 157 ¬180
3 and 4 are
m3 ¬23
m2 ¬23 supplementary.
m1 m5 ¬180 Proof:
m1 90 m2 ¬180 Statements Reasons
m1 90 23 ¬180
m1 67 ¬180 1. m n, is a transversal 1. Given
m1 ¬113
2. 1 and 3 form a 2. Def. of linear
36. x ¬90 linear pair; 2 and 4 pair
3y 11 ¬y 19 form a linear pair.
3y ¬y 30
2y ¬30 3. 1 and 3 are 3. If two angles form
y ¬15 supplementary; a linear pair, then
3y 11 4z 2 x ¬180 2 and 4 are they are
3(15) 11 4z 2 90 ¬180 supplementary. supplementary.
4z 126 ¬180 4. 1 ¬4, 2 ¬3 4. Alt. int. ¬
4z ¬54
z ¬13.5 5. 1 and 2 are 5. Substitution
37. 7y 4 7x 9 ¬180 supplementary;
7y 7x 5 ¬180 3 and 4 are
7y 7x ¬175 supplementary.
7y ¬175 7x
y ¬1 41. Given: m, m n
7 (175 7x)
Prove: n
y ¬25 x
2y 5 11x 1 ¬180
2(25 x) 5 11x 1 ¬180 1 2
m
50 2x 5 11x 1 ¬180 3 4
54 9x ¬180 n
9x ¬126
x ¬14
Proof: Since m, we know that 1 2,
y ¬25 x
because perpendicular lines form congruent right
¬25 14 or 11
angles. Then by the Corresponding Angles
z 7x 9 ¬180
Postulate, 1 3 and 2 4. By the definition
z 7(14) 9 ¬180
of congruent angles, m1 m2, m1 m3 and
z 107 ¬180
m2 m4. By substitution, m3 m4.
z ¬73
Because 3 and 4 form a congruent linear pair,
38. The angle with measure 40° is congruent to an
they are right angles. By definition, n.
angle that forms a linear pair with the angle
whose measure is x°. So 40 x 180. 42. The angle formed by the pipe on the other side of
Then x 140. the road is supplementary to the angle that
measures 65°. So the angle is 180 65 or 115.
Chapter 3 58
43. 2 and 6 are consecutive interior angles for 5. 4 ¬2
the same transversal, which makes them m4 ¬m2
supplementary because W X Y
Z
. 4 and 6 are m2 m1 ¬180
not necessarily supplementary because WZ may m2 105 ¬180
not be parallel to XY. m2 ¬75
44. Sample answer: Angles and lines are used in art m4 ¬75
to show depth, and to create realistic objects.
Answers should include the following.
• Rectangular shapes are made by drawing
parallel lines and perpendiculars.
3-3 Slopes of Lines
• M. C. Escher and Pablo Picasso use lines and
angles in their art. Page 142 Check for Understanding
45. C; Let y° be the measure of the third angle of the 1. horizontal; vertical
right triangle in the figure. 2. Curtis; Lori added the coordinates instead of
160 ¬y 120 finding the difference.
40 ¬y
3. horizontal line, vertical line
x y 90 ¬180 (y y )
x 40 90 ¬180 4. m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
x ¬50 1 3
¬
2 (4)
46. C; ax ¬bx c
ax bx ¬c 4
¬2 or 2
(a b)x ¬c
c 5. Line goes through P(0, 4) and Q(4, 2).
x ¬
a b (y y )
m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
2 4
Page 138 Maintain Your Skills ¬
40
2 1
47. FG ¬4 or 2
48. B
A , D
E
, FG
, IJ
, A
E
, F
J
6. Line m goes through C(0, 3) and D(3, 1).
49. CDH (y y )
50. G
B , C
H, F
G
, HI m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
51. m1 124 ¬180 1 (3)
m1 ¬56 ¬
30
52. m2 ¬53 2
¬3
53. Hypothesis: it rains this evening
7. Line has slope 1
2 (from Exercise 5). Any line
Conclusion: I will mow the lawn tomorrow
perpendicular to has a slope that is the opposite
54. Hypothesis: you eat a balanced diet reciprocal of 1
Conclusion: it will keep you healthy 2 , or 2.
¬0 13
7 9 2 2 8. slope of GH
8 5 3 or 3
55. 11 14
1313
3 6 9 ¬
2
5 or
25
56. 8 ¬
2 6
¬5 7
¬3
2
slope of RS 4
(3)
14 11 12
3 ¬
23 15 8
57. 1 or 12
15 23 8 The slopes are not the same, so
GH and
RS are
8
14 11 3 or 3
58. 156
not parallel. The product of the slopes is 25 , so
GH and RS are not perpendicular. Therefore,
9 5 ¬ 45
36 GH
59. 2
1
8
4 and
RS are neither parallel nor perpendicular.
¬5
9 (9)
9. slope of
GH ¬
9 15
0
¬
6 or 0
Page 138 Practice Quiz 1 1
¬
slope of RS (1)
1. p; alternate exterior 3 (4)
2. ; consecutive interior ¬0
7 or 0
3. q; alternate interior and RS
The slopes are the same so GH are
4. 6 1 parallel.
m6 m1
m6 105
59 Chapter 3
10. Start at (1, 2). Move up 2 units and then move right Pages 142–144 Practice and Apply
1 unit. Draw the line through this point and (1, 2). (y y )
15. m ¬
2
1
y (x2 x1)
32 1
¬
7 0 or 7
(y2 y1)
P (1, 2) 16. m ¬
(x2 x1)
5 (3)
O x ¬6 (2)
2 1
¬4 or 2
(y2 y1)
17. m ¬
(x2 x1)
. 3 2
11. Find the slope of MN ¬43
(y y ) 5
m ¬
2
1
¬1 or 5
(x2 x1)
20 (y2 y1)
¬1 18. m ¬
5 (x2 x1)
2
¬4 or 1 37
2 ¬
41
Since 22 1, the slope of the line
1
through A(6, 4) is 2. ¬4
3
perpendicular to MN
1 (2)
Graph the line. Start at (6, 4). Move up 2 units 19. slope of
PQ ¬
9 (3)
and then move right 1 unit. Draw the line 3 1
¬
12 or 4
through this point and (6, 4).
2
¬ 6
y slope of UV 53
8
12 ¬2 or 4
The product of the slopes is 4(4) or 1. So,
1
PQ
8
is perpendicular to UV.
¬ 3
0
4 A(6, 4) 20. slope of PQ 0 (4)
3
¬4
O 8 12 x 6 (
3)
slope of
UV ¬
8 (4)
9 3
12. The hill has an 8% grade, so the road will rise or ¬
1
2 or 4
fall 8 units vertically with every 100 horizontal is parallel to UV
The slopes are the same, so PQ .
8 2
units traveled. So the slope is either
100 25 ¬
21. slope of PQ 1 7
8 2 2 (10)
or
100
25
. 6 1
2 ¬
12 or
13. Let (x1, y1) (0, 0) and m . Then y2 120 2
25 10
¬
because the biker is 120 meters below her slope of UV
64
starting position. 1
¬2
(y2 y1)
m ¬ The slopes are not the same, so PQ and UV
are
(x2 x1)
not parallel. The product of the slopes is 21
2
1
¬ x120
2 0
25 20 1 and UV
or 4, so PQ are not perpendicular.
25 ¬ x1
2 20
Therefore, PQ and UV
are neither parallel nor
2
x2 ¬1500 perpendicular.
12
If m 2
then x2 1500. So the current 22. slope of
PQ ¬
0 (9)
25
1
position of the biker is represented ¬9
by (1500, 120) or (1500, 120). 1 8
¬
14. The distance is the same no matter which
slope of UV 2
(1)
9
coordinates are used for the biker’s current ¬
1 or 9
position.
The product of the slopes is 9(9) or 1. So, PQ
1
d ¬ (x2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2 .
is perpendicular to UV
¬ (1500 0)
2 (120 0)2 81
¬
23. slope of PQ
¬1500
2
(120) 2 91
7
¬ 2,264 ,400 ¬8
¬1505 ¬ 8
1
slope of UV 2 (6)
The biker has traveled 1505 meters down the hill. 7
¬8
is parallel to UV
The slopes are the same, so PQ .
Chapter 3 60
0 (4)
24. slope of
PQ ¬
10 5 The line to be graphed is parallel to
CD so the
line has slope 1.
¬4
5 Start at (1, 3). Move down 1 unit and then
¬
slope of UV 13 (8)
move right 1 unit. Draw the line through this
59
¬5
4
point and (1, 3).
The slopes are not the same, so
PQ and
UV are y
not parallel. The product of the slopes is 4
5 4
5
or 1, so
PQ and
UV are not perpendicular.
and UV
Therefore, PQ are neither parallel nor
O x
perpendicular.
(y2 y1)
25. m ¬
(x2 x1)
1 2
A( 1, 3)
¬
0 (1)
3
¬1 or 3
26. m ¬
2(y y )
1 35. Find the slope of
GH.
(x2 x1) (y y )
m ¬
2
1
4 (
5) (x2 x1)
¬1 (4) 03
¬ 3
0
¬9
5
3
¬3 or 1
(y2 y1)
27. m ¬ Since 1(1) 1, the slope of the line
(x2 x1)
through M(4, 1), is 1.
perpendicular to GH
1 5
¬3 (2) Start at (4, 1). Move down 1 unit and then move
6 right 1 unit. Draw the line through this point and
¬ 1 or 6 (4, 1).
(y2 y1)
28. m ¬ y
(x2 x1)
4 (4)
¬ 4 ( 2)
¬0
6
or 0
is 6 (from Exercise 27). A line
29. The slope of LM M(4, 1)
parallel to
LM has the same slope as
LM, thus
has slope 6. O x
30. The slope of
9
PQ is 5 (from Exercise 26). A line
has slope that is the opposite
perpendicular to PQ
9 5 36. Start at (7, 1). Move up 2 units and then move
reciprocal of 5, or 9. right 5 units. Draw the line through this point
is 0 (from Exercise 28). EF
31. The slope of EF is and (7, 1).
horizontal, so a line perpendicular to
EF is y
vertical and has undefined slope.
32. The slope of
AB is 3 (from Exercise 25). A line
parallel to
AB has the same slope as
AB, thus has
slope 3.
33. Start at (2, 1). Move down 4 units and then O x
move right 1 unit. Draw the line through this J ( 7, 1)
point and (2, 1).
y
P ( 2, 1)
O x
61 Chapter 3
1
37. Find the slope of
KL. 41. Let (x1, y1) (2000, 35.3) and m 3.
(y y ) (y y )
m ¬
2
1
m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1) (x2 x1)
40.6 35.3
7
¬ 2122
1
¬
3 x2 2000
19
¬0 which is undefined x2 2000 ¬3(5.3)
KL is a vertical line, so a line parallel to
KL x2 ¬2015.9
through Q(2, 4) is also vertical. The median age will be 40.6 in 2016.
Draw a vertical line through (2, 4). (y y )
42. m ¬
2
1
y (x2 x1)
3 1 2
7 ¬ x
6
3 3
7 ¬
x 6
O x 7 ¬x 6
13 ¬x
y
12
Q( 2, 4)
8
Chapter 3 62
90 77
13 ¬
x 2000 Page 144 Maintain Your Skills
13 (x 2000) ¬13 51. 6 ¬1
x 2000 ¬1 m6 ¬m1
x ¬2001 m6 ¬131
90% of classrooms will have Internet access in 52. 7 is supplementary to 6.
2001. m7 m 6 ¬180
46. No; the graph can only rise until it reaches 100%. m7 131 ¬180
47. The y-intercept can be found by setting the m7 ¬49
equation for x equal to zero, solving for t, then 53. 4 ¬7
using this value in the equation for y. m4 ¬m 7
x ¬5 2t m4 ¬49
0 ¬5 2t 54. m2 m1 ¬180
5 ¬2t m2 131 ¬180
5
2 ¬t m2 ¬49
y ¬3 t 55. m5 m1 ¬180
m5 131 ¬180
y ¬3 5
2
m5 ¬49
11
y ¬2 56. 8 ¬6
Find the x-intercept in a similar manner. 6 ¬1
y ¬3 t 8 ¬1
0 ¬3 t m8 ¬m1
3 ¬t m8 ¬131
x ¬5 2t 57. ; alternate exterior
x ¬5 2(3) 58. ; corresponding
x ¬11 59. p; alternate interior
11
So two points on the line are (0, 2) and (11, 0).
(y y ) 60. q; consecutive interior
m ¬
2
1
61. m; alternate interior
(x2 x1)
0 2
11 62. q; corresponding
¬
11 0 63. H, I, and J are noncollinear.
11 H
2 1
¬ or 2 I
11
J
The slope-intercept form of the equation of the
1 11 64. XZ ZY XY.
line is y 2x
2 .
48. Sample answer: Slope is used when driving X Z Y
through hills to determine how fast to go. 65. R, S, and T are collinear.
Answers should include the following. y
• Drivers should be notified of the grade so that
they can adjust their speed accordingly. A
positive slope indicates that the driver must O x
speed up, while a negative slope indicates that
the driver should slow down.
S T R
• An escalator must be at a steep enough slope to
be efficient, but also must be gradual enough to
ensure comfort.
(y y )
49. C; m ¬
2
1
66. acute
(x2 x1)
2 1 67. obtuse
¬ 3 (5)
68. right
3
¬2 69. obtuse
2x y ¬7
23 23 1, so the slope of the line 70.
y ¬2x 7
perpendicular to the line containing (5, 1) and
71. 2x 4y ¬5
(3, 2) is 2
3. 4y ¬2x 5
24
50. A; the winning sailboat completed the race in 9
1
y ¬2x 5
2 4
hours, or 23 hours. The second-place boat 72. 5x 2y 4 ¬0
24
completed the race in 8 hours, or 3 hours. The 5x 4 ¬2y
difference in times is 1
3 hour, or 20 minutes.
5
2x 2 ¬y
5
y ¬2 x 2
63 Chapter 3
Alternate plan: y ¬0.95x 4.95
3-4 Equations of Lines ¬0.95(60) 4.95
¬61.95
He should keep his current plan, based on his
Pages 147–148 Check for Understanding average usage.
1. Sample answer: Use the point-slope form where
(x1, y1) (2, 8) and m 2
5.
2. Sample answer: y 2x 3, y x 6 Pages 148–149 Practice and Apply
3. Sample answer: y x 15. y ¬mx b
y y ¬1
6x 4
y x
16. y ¬mx b
y ¬2
3x 8
17. y ¬mx b
O x y ¬5
8x 6
18. y ¬mx b
y ¬2
9x 3
1
19. y ¬mx b
4. y ¬mx b y ¬x 3
1 20. y¬¬mx b
y ¬2x 4 1
y¬¬ x1
5. y ¬mx b 12
3 21. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y ¬5x 2
y 1 ¬2(x 3)
6. y ¬mx b
22. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y ¬3x 4
y 7 ¬5(x 4)
7. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
23. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y (1) ¬3
2 (x 4)
y (5) ¬4
5 [x (12)]
y 1 ¬3
2 (x 4)
y 5 ¬4
5 (x 12)
8. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
24. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 5 ¬3(x 7) 1
y 11 ¬
16 (x 3)
9. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
25. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 137.5 ¬1.25(x 20) y 17.12 ¬0.48(x 5)
(y y )
10. m ¬2
1 26. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
(x2 x1)
y 87.5 ¬1.3 (x 10)
53
¬
0 (1) 27. Find the slope of k using (0, 2) and (1, 1).
(y y )
¬2 m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
y ¬2x 5
(y y ) 1 (2)
11. m ¬2
1 ¬1 0
(x2 x1)
¬3
32
¬1
0 y ¬mx b
¬1 y ¬3x 2
y ¬x 2 28. Find the slope of using (0, 5) and (1, 4).
12. The slope of is 2 (from Exercise 10). The line (y y )
m ¬
2
1
parallel to that contains (4, 4) also has slope 2. (x2 x1)
y y1 ¬m(x x1) 45
¬
1
0
y 4 ¬2(x 4)
y 4 ¬2x 8 ¬1
y ¬2x 4 y ¬mx b
13. The total monthly cost of Justin’s current plan is y ¬x 5
y 39.95. For the other provider, the cost 29. Find the slope of m using (2, 0) and (1, 2).
increases $0.95 for each hour of connection so the (y y )
m ¬
2
1
Chapter 3 64
30. Find the slope of n using (0, 6) and (8, 5). y y1 ¬m(x x1)
(y2 y1)
m ¬ y (3) ¬1
5 [x (5)]
(x2 x1)
1
5
¬ 6 y 3 ¬5x 1
80
1 y ¬1
5x 4
¬8
(y y )
y ¬mx b 40. m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
y ¬1
8x 6
¬1 0
05
31. Since the slope of line is 1 (from Exercise 28),
the slope of a line perpendicular to it is 1. ¬1
5
y y1 ¬m(x x1) y ¬mx b
y 6 ¬1[x (1)] y ¬1
5x 1
y 6 ¬x 1 (y y )
y ¬x 5 41. m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
32. Since the slope of line k is 3 (from Exercise 27), ¬
4 8
the slope of a line parallel to it is 3. 6 (6)
12
y y1 ¬m(x x1) ¬
0 which is undefined
y 0 ¬3(x 7) There is no slope-intercept form for this line. An
y ¬3x 21 equation for the line is x 6.
1 (y y )
33. Since the slope of line n is 8 (from Exercise 30), 42. m ¬
2
1
1 (x2 x1)
the slope of a line parallel to it is 8.
5 (1)
y y1 ¬m(x x1) ¬
8 (4)
4
y 0 ¬1 ¬
4 or 1
8 (x 0)
y y1¬m(x x1)
y ¬1
8x y (1) ¬1[x (4)]
34. Since the slope of line m is 2 (from Exercise 29), y 1 ¬x 4
the slope of a line perpendicular to it is 1
y ¬x 3
2.
y y1 ¬m(x x1) 43. 2x 5y ¬8
5y ¬2x 8
y (3) ¬12 [x (3)]
1 3
y ¬2
5x 5
8
y 3 ¬2 x 2 The slope of the line is 2
5 , so the slope of a line
y ¬1 9
2x 2
parallel to it is 2
5
.
35. y ¬mx b y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y ¬3x 5 y (2) ¬2
5 (x 7)
36. y ¬mx b y 2 ¬2 14
5x 5
y ¬0 x 6
y ¬6 y ¬2
24
5x 5
(y y ) 44. 2y 2 ¬7
4 (x 7)
37. m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
2y 2 ¬7 4
4x 4
9
3 0
¬ 2y ¬7 41
4x 4
05
¬3 y ¬7 41
8x 8
5
y ¬mx b 7
The slope of the line is 8, so the slope of a line
y ¬3
5x 3
perpendicular to it is 8
7.
(y2 y1) y y1 ¬m(x x1)
38. m ¬
(x2 x1) y (3) ¬8
7 [x (2)]
1
(1) y 3 ¬8 16
7x 7
¬
2 4
¬
0 y ¬8
7x 7
5
6 or 0
y y1 ¬m(x x1) 45. For each appliance Ann sells she earns $50, so
Ann earns 15($50) or $750 plus commission. If the
y (1) ¬0(x 4)
total price of the appliances Ann sells is x dollars,
y 1 ¬0
her commission is 0.05x. So, Ann earned y
y ¬1
(y y ) 0.05x 750 dollars in a week in which she sold
39. m ¬
2
1
15 appliances.
(x2 x1)
6 (3) 46. 750x
¬10 (5) 47. The number of gallons of paint in stock decreases
3 1
¬15 or 5
at a rate of 750 gallons per day.
y 750x 10,800
65 Chapter 3
48. 16 Page 150 Maintain Your Skills
¬
10
Chapter 3 66
AC ¬(5 10)2 [7 (6)]2 6. From Exercise 4, q has slope 1
2 and has
¬(15) 2 ( 1) ¬
2 226 y-intercept 2.
y ¬mx b
AB BC AC ¬ 148 10 226
¬30.36 y ¬1
2x 2
67 Chapter 3
8. mADE ¬9x 5
¬9(11.375) 5
A
¬97.375
B (5x 9) Verify the angle measure by using the value of x
to find mABC.
C mABC ¬7x 3
D (14x 9) ¬7(11.375) 3
¬82.625
Now mCBD 180 mABC 180 82.625
or 97.375. Since mCBD mADE,
E
m CBD ADE and m.
10. Given: 1 2
Explore: From the figure, you know that
Prove: m 1
mABC 5x 90 and mADE 14x 9. You
also know that ABC and ADE are 3
corresponding angles. 2
m
Plan: For line to be parallel to line m, the Proof:
corresponding angles must be congruent. So,
mABC mADE. Substitute the given angle Statements Reasons
measures into this equation and solve for x. 1. 1 2 1. Given
Solve: mABC ¬mADE
2. 2 3 2. Vertical angles are
5x 90 ¬14x 9
congruent.
90 ¬9x 9
81 ¬9x 3. 1 3 3. Trans. Prop. of
9 ¬x 4. m 4. If corr. are , then
Examine: Now use the value of x to find lines are .
mABC. 2
mABC ¬5x 90 11. slope of
AB ¬ (3) 1
0 (7) or 7
¬5(9) 90 135 7
1
4 2
Verify the angle measure by using the value of x slope of
CD ¬
6 (4)
to find mADE. That is, 14x 9 14(9) 9 or
5
135. Since mABC mADE, ABC ADE 4 1
¬
10 or 8
and m.
9. The slope of
CD is 1
8 , and the slope of line AB is
A 1
E . The slopes are not equal, so the lines are not
7
parallel.
(9x 5)
(7x 3) 12. Yes; sample answer: Pairs of alternate
B interior angles are congruent.
Chapter 3 68
25. Given: t t Solve: mABC ¬mDEF
mt 8x 4 ¬9x 11
Prove: m
1 4 ¬x 11
15 ¬x
2 Examine: Verify the angle measures by using the
value of x to find mABC and mDEF.
m
mABC ¬8x 4
Proof: ¬8(15) 4 or 124
mDEF ¬9x 11
Statements Reasons
¬9(15) 11 or 124
1. t, m t 1. Given Since mABC mDEF, ABC DEF
2. 1 and 2 are right 2. Definition of and m.
angles. perpendicular 28. m
3. 1 2 3. All rt. are . D
4. m 4. If corr. are ,
then lines are .
A B
26. A
(7x 1) E F
(9x 4)
B
m C
D
C
E Explore: From the figure, you know that
140
mABC 7x 1 and DEF is a right angle and
hence has measure 90. You also know that ABC
F and DEF are alternate exterior angles.
Plan: For line to be parallel to line m, the
Explore: From the figure, you know that mABC alternate exterior angles must be congruent. So,
9x 4 and mDEF 140. You also know that mABC mDEF. Substitute the given angle
ABC and DEF are alternate exterior angles. measures into this equation and solve for x.
Plan: For line to be parallel to line m, the Solve: mABC ¬mDEF
alternate exterior angles must be congruent. So, 7x 1 ¬90
mABC mDEF. Substitute the given angle 7x ¬91
measures into this equation and solve for x. x ¬13
Solve: mABC ¬mDEF Examine: Verify the angle measure by using
9x 4 ¬140 the value of x to find mABC. That is, 7x 1
9x ¬144 7(13) 1 or 90. Since mABC mDEF,
x ¬16 ABC DEF and m.
Examine: Verify the angle measure by using 29. m
the value of x to find mABC. That is, 9x 4 A E
D
9 (16) 4 or 140. Since mABC mDEF,
ABC DEF and m.
27. (4 5x) (7x 100)
A
C
(8x 4) E D
B
C B (9x 11)
69 Chapter 3
Solve: mABC ¬mECD Plan: For line to be parallel to line m, the
4 5x ¬7x 100 alternate exterior angles must be congruent. So,
4 ¬12x 100 mABC mDEF. Substitute the given angle
96 ¬12x measures into this equation and solve for x.
8 ¬x Solve: mABC ¬mDEF
Examine: Verify the angle measures by using the 178 3x ¬7x 38
value of x to find mABC and mECD. 178 ¬10x 38
mABC ¬4 5x 216 ¬10x
¬4 5(8) or 44 21.6 ¬x
mECD ¬7x 100 Examine: Verify the angle measures by using the
¬7(8) 100 or 44 value of x to find mABC and mDEF.
Since mABC mECD, ABC ECD mABC ¬178 3x
and m. ¬178 3(21.6) or 113.2
30. mDEF ¬7x 38
A
¬7(21.6) 38 or 113.2
Since mABC mDEF, ABC DEF and m.
32. Given: 1 and 2
(14x 9)
B are supplementary.
1
D Prove: m 2
3
m
E C
(5x 90)
Proof:
Statements Reasons
F m 1. 1 and 2 are 1. Given
supplementary.
Explore: From the figure, you know that mABC
14x 9 and mDEF 5x 90. You also know 2. 2 and 3 form a 2. Definition of
that ABC and DEF are alternate exterior angles. linear pair. linear pair
Plan: For line to be parallel to line m, the 3. 2 and 3 are 3. Supplement Th.
alternate exterior angles must be congruent. So, supplementary.
mABC mDEF. Substitute the given angle
measures into this equation and solve for x. 4. 1 3 4. suppl. to same
Solve: mABC ¬mDEF or are .
14x 9 ¬5x 90 5. m 5. If corr. are ,
9x 9 ¬90 then lines are .
9x ¬81
x ¬9 33. Given: 4 6
Examine: Verify the angle measures by using the Prove: m
4
value of x to find mABC and mDEF.
6 m
mABC ¬14x 9 7
¬14(9) 9 or 135
mDEF ¬5x 90
¬5(9) 90 or 135 Proof: We know that 4 6. Because 6 and
Since mABC mDEF, ABC DEF 7 are vertical angles they are congruent. By the
and m. Transitive Property of Congruence, 4 7.
31. Since 4 and 7 are corresponding angles, and
they are congruent, m.
A
(178 3x) C 34. Given: 2 1, 1 3 S V
Prove: ST
U V
1
W
2
B m 3
E T U
Proof:
Statements Reasons
(7x 38)
D F 1. 2 1, 1 3 1. Given
2. 2 3 2. Trans. Prop.
Explore: From the figure, you know that mABC 3. If alt. int. are
T
3. S U
V
178 3x and mDEF 7x 38. You also know , lines are .
that ABC and DEF are alternate exterior angles.
Chapter 3 70
1.5
(0.75)
35. Given:
ADC
D, 1 2 C D 39. slope of
AB ¬ 2 (1)
Prove: B CC
D
2 0.75
1 ¬ or 0.25
3
B 1.5 1.8
slope of
CD ¬
0 (1 .5)
A
0.3
Proof: ¬
1.5 or 0.2
No, the lines are not parallel since the slopes are
Statements Reasons
not the same.
D
1. AC
D
, 1 2 1. Given 40. When he measures the angle that each picket
D
2. A B
C
2. If alt. int. are makes with the 2 by 4, he is measuring
, lines are . corresponding angles. When all of the
corresponding angles are congruent, the pickets
C
3. BC
D
3. Perpendicular
must be parallel.
Transversal Th.
41. The 10-yard lines will be parallel because they
M
36. Given: J KN
, 1 2, 3 4 are all perpendicular to the sideline and two or
more lines perpendicular to the same line are
M
Prove: K L
N
J K L parallel.
42. Consecutive angles are supplementary; opposite
1 2 3 4
angles are congruent; the sum of the measures of
the angles is 360.
43. See students’ work.
M N 44. Sample answer: They should appear to have the
Proof: same slope. Answers should include the following.
Statements Reasons • The corresponding angles must be equal in
order for the lines to be parallel.
M
1. J K N
, 1 2, 1. Given • The parking lot spaces have right angles.
3 4 45. B; 2 and 3 are supplementary to 1 because
2. 1 3 2. If lines are , corr. they each form a linear pair with 1. 4 is not
are . necessarily supplementary to 1 because 1 and
3. 2 4 4 are vertical angles and hence are congruent.
3. Substitution
1 5 because m and 1 and 5 are
M
4. K L
N 4. If corr. are corresponding angles. 7 and 6 are
, lines are . supplementary to 5 because they each form a
linear pair with 5, and so by substitution 7
37. Given: RSP PQR, R S and 6 are supplementary to 1. 8 is not
QRS and PQR necessarily supplementary to 1 because 8 and
are supplementary 5 are vertical angles, so 8 5 and 8 1.
S
Prove: P Q R
46. D; let p, n, d, and q represent the numbers of
Q P pennies, nickels, dimes, and quarters Kendra has,
Proof: respectively. Then we are given that p 3n,
Statements Reasons n d, and d 2q. So we can see that n 2q so
p 3(2q) or 6q, and thus all the numbers of coins
1. RSP PQR, QRS 1. Given depend on the number of quarters. Kendra has at
and PQR are least one quarter, so if q 1 then d 2(1) or 2,
supplementary n 2, and p 6(1) or 6.
2. mRSP mPQR 2. Def. of Then 0.01p 0.05n 0.10d 0.25q
0.01(6) 0.05(2) 0.10(2) 0.25(1)
3. mQRS mPQR 3. Definition of 0.61
180 suppl.
4. mQRS mRSP 4. Substitution Page 157 Maintain Your Skills
180
47. y ¬mx b
5. QRS and RSP are 5. Def. of suppl. y ¬0.3x 6
supplementary. 48. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
QR
6. If cons. int. y (15) ¬1
3 [x (3)]
6. PS
are suppl., lines
y 15 ¬1
3x 1
are .
y ¬1
3 x 14
4
38. slope of
AB ¬4 (
2
4) or 4
1
1
slope of
CD ¬ 0
4 0 or 4
1
Yes, the lines are parallel since the slopes are the
same.
71 Chapter 3
(y2 y1)
49. m ¬ 63. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(x2 x1)
11
¬
7 ¬(1 8)2 (2 0)2
3 5
¬(9)
2 2 2
¬8 or 1
4
2 ¬85
y y1 ¬ m(x x1) ¬9.22
y 7 ¬1
2 (x 5)
64. d ¬(x2 x1)2 (y2
y1)2
y 7 ¬1
5
2x 2 ¬[8 (6)]2
[ 2
2 (4)]
y ¬1 1
9 ¬(2)
2 22
2x 2
¬8
50. The slope of y 1 1
2 x 14 is 2 , so a line
¬2.83
perpendicular to y 2x 4 has slope 2.
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 1 ¬2(x 4)
Page 158 Graphing Calculator Investigation:
y 1 ¬2x 8
y ¬2x 9
Points of Intersection
3 2 1. Enter the equations in the Y list and graph in
51. slope of
5
BD ¬ 40 or
4 the standard viewing window.
3 (3)
¬ KEYSTROKES: Y 2 X, T,
, n 10 ENTER 2
52. slope of CD or 0
4 (1)
2 (2) X, T,
, n 2 ENTER () 1 2
53. slope of AB ¬ 0 (
4) or 1
0
54. slope of
EO 2 1
0 4 or 2 X, T,
, N 4 ZOOM 6
2 (
55. slope of
DE
44
3)
Use the CALC menu to find the points of
¬5
0 , which is undefined
intersection.
Any line parallel to
DE also has undefined slope. Find the intersection of a and t.
56. slope of
5 KEYSTROKES: 2nd [CALC] 5 ENTER
BD 4 (from Exercise 51)
The slope of any line perpendicular to
BD is 4
5. ENTER ENTER
57.
p q p and q
T T T
T F F
F T F
F F F
58. p q
q p or
q
T T F T Lines a and t intersect at (5.6, 1.2).
T F T T Find the intersection of b and t.
F T F F KEYSTROKES: 2nd [CALC] 5 ENTER
F F T T ENTER ENTER
59. p q
p
p q
T T F F
T F F F
F T T T
F F T F
60.
p q
p
q
p
q
Lines b and t intersect at (2.4, 2.8).
T T F F F
2. Enter the equations in the Y list and graph in
T F F T F
the standard viewing window.
F T T F F
F F T T T KEYSTROKES: Y () X, T,
, n 3 ENTER
¬
169 or 13
Chapter 3 72
Find the intersection of a and t. Find the intersection of a and t.
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [CALC] 5 ENTER KEYSTROKES: 2nd [CALC] 5 ENTER
ENTER ENTER ENTER ENTER
Lines a and t intersect at (1.5, 4.5). Lines a and t intersect at (2.1, 7.3)
Find the intersection of b and t. Find the intersection of b and t.
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [CALC] 5 KEYSTROKES: 2nd [CALC] 5 ENTER
ENTER ENTER ENTER ENTER ENTER
73 Chapter 3
6. Enter the equations in the Y list and graph in 6. y
the decimal viewing window.
KEYSTROKES: Y () 1 6 X, T,
, n
O x
2 3 ENTER () 1 6 X, T,
, n X
5 12 ENTER 6 X, T,
, n
Z
2 ZOOM 4 A
Use the CALC menu to find the points of Y
intersection. 1. Graph line and point A. Place the compass
Find the intersection of a and t. point at point A. Make the setting wide enough
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [CALC] 5 ENTER so that when an arc is drawn, it intersects in
ENTER ENTER two places. Label these points X and Y.
2. Put the compass at point X and draw an arc
above line .
. AZ
4. Draw AZ . The segment constructed
from point A(2, 6) perpendicular to line
appears to intersect line at (2, 4). Use the
Distance Formula to find the distance between
point A and .
Lines a and t intersect at (0.2, 0.7).
Find the intersection of b and t. d ¬(x
2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [CALC] 5 ENTER ¬
(2
2)2
[4
(6)]2
ENTER ENTER ¬
(4)2 (2)2 16 4 20 4.47
The distance between A and is about
4.47 units.
7. First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
to the given lines. The slope of p is the opposite
reciprocal of 3 4
4 , or 3 . Use the y-intercept of
y 3
4 x 1, (0, 1), as one of the endpoints of the
Lines b and t intersect at (0.3, 0.5). perpendicular segment.
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y (1) ¬4
3 (x 0)
3-6 Perpendiculars and Distance
y 1 ¬4
3x
1. Construct a perpendicular line between them. Next, use a system of equations to determine the
2. Sample answer: You are hiking and need to find point of intersection of y 3 1
4 x 8 and p.
the shortest path to a shelter. 3x 1 ¬4x 1
4 8 3
3. Sample answer: Measure distances at different
parts; compare slopes; measure angles. Finding 3x 4x ¬1 1
4 3 8
slopes is the most readily available method. 25
x ¬9
12 8
4. L M 27
x ¬
50
y ¬3 27
4 50 8
1
7
K N y ¬ 25
5. C
2
The point of intersection is 7
7
50 , 25 .
Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
B D
27
distance between (0, 1) and
7
50 , 25 .
d ¬(x2
x1)
2 (y2 y1)2
2
2 2
0 (1)
27 7
A ¬
50 5
E
¬.81
¬0.9
The distance between the lines is 0.9 unit.
Chapter 3 74
8. x 3y ¬6 4. Draw
PQ.
PQ is perpendicular to y 3 1
4x 4.
3y ¬x 6 Label point R at the intersection of the lines.
y ¬1
3x 2
The segment constructed from P(2, 5)
perpendicular to y 3 1
4 x 4 appears to
x 3y ¬14
intersect y 3
x 1 at R(1, 1).
4 4
3y ¬x 14 Use the Distance Formula to find the distance
y ¬1 1
3x 3
4
between P and y 3 4x 4.
1
Q P
( 1, 1)
O x 14. W X
Z Y
1. Graph y 3 1
4 x 4 and point P. Place the
15. M G
compass at point P. Make the setting wide
enough so that when an arc is drawn, it
intersects y 3 1
4 x 4 in two places. Label
L H
these points of intersection A and B.
2. Put the compass at point A and draw an arc K J
below the line.
16. R
3. Using the same compass setting, put the S
Q
compass at point B and draw an arc to
intersect the one drawn in step 2. Label the T
point of intersection Q. X
U
W
V
75 Chapter 3
17. Graph line and point P. Construct m 21. First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
perpendicular to through P. Line m appears to to the lines y 2x 2 and y 2x 3. The slope
intersect line at (4, 0). Use the Distance of p is the opposite reciprocal of 2, or 1
2 . Use the
Formula to find the distance between P and . y-intercept of the line y 2x 2, (0, 2), as one of
d ¬(x2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2 the endpoints of the perpendicular segment.
¬(4 4) (3
2 0) 2 y y1 ¬m(x x1)
¬93 y 2 ¬1
2 (x 0)
The distance between P and is 3 units. y 2 ¬1
2x
y
y ¬1
2x 2
P (4, 3) Next, use a system of equations to determine the
point of intersection of the line y 2x 3 and p.
2x 3 ¬1 2x 2
O x
2x 1
2 x ¬2 3
5
2x ¬5
x ¬2
y ¬2(2) 3
18. Graph line and point P. Construct m
perpendicular to through P. Line m appears to y ¬1
intersect line at (1, 3). Use the Distance The point of intersection is (2, 1).
Formula to find the distance between P and . Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 distance between (0, 2) and (2, 1).
d ¬ (x2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2
¬
(4
1)2 2
(4 3)
¬ (2 0) 2 (1 2)2
¬ (5)2
12 26
¬ (2)2 (1)2
The distance between P and is 26
units.
¬ 5
P y
The distance between the lines is 5 units.
22. First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
m to the lines y 4x and y 4x 17. The slope of p
is the opposite reciprocal of 4, or 1
4 . Use the
O x y-intercept of the line y 4x, (0, 0), as one of the
endpoints of the perpendicular segment.
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 0 ¬14 (x 0)
y ¬1
4x
19. The lines y 3 and y 1 are horizontal lines. Next, use a system of equations to determine the
The y-axis is perpendicular to these lines. point of intersection of the line y 4x 17 and p.
The y-intercept of y 3 is (0, 3). The y-axis 4x 17 ¬1
4x
intersects the line y 1 at the point (0, 1). Use 17
17 ¬ 4 x
the Distance Formula to determine the distance
4 ¬x
between (0, 3) and (0, 1).
y ¬4(4) 17
d (x 2x1)2 (y2 y1)2 y ¬1
¬ (0 0
)2 [1 (3 )]2 The point of intersection is (4, 1).
¬0 2 42 Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
¬ 16 or 4 distance between (0, 0) and (4, 1).
The distance between the lines is 4 units. d ¬
(x2
x1)2 (y2 y1)2
20. The lines x 4 and x 2 are vertical lines. The ¬
(1 0)
2 (4 0
)2
x-axis is perpendicular to these lines. The line ¬
(1)2
(4)2
x 4 intersects the x-axis at the point (4, 0). The
¬
17
line x 2 intersects the x-axis at the point
(2, 0). Use the Distance Formula to determine The distance between the lines is 17
units.
the distance between (4, 0) and (2, 0).
d ¬ (x2
x1)2 (y2 y1)2
¬ (2 4)
2 (0 0)2
¬(6)
2
02 36 or 6
The distance between the lines is 6 units.
Chapter 3 76
23. 2x y ¬4 3 4
4 x 5 ¬ 3 x 1
y ¬2x 4
3 4
4 x 3 x ¬1 5
y ¬2x 4
25
First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
12 x ¬6
to the lines y 2x 3 and y 2x 4. The slope 72
of p is the opposite reciprocal of 2, or 1
x ¬
2 . Use the 25
4 25 5
y-intercept of the line y 2x 3, (0, 3), as one of y ¬3
72
the endpoints of the perpendicular segment. 71
y ¬
y y1 ¬m(x x1) 25
The point of intersection is
25 , 25 .
72
71
y (3) ¬1
2 (x 0)
Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
y 3 ¬1 distance between (0, 1) and 25 , 25 .
72 71
2x
y ¬1
2x 3
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
25 25
Next, use a system of equations to determine the 2 2
¬ 0
72 (1)
71
point of intersection of the line y 2x 4 and p.
¬
2 2
2x 4 ¬1
72 96
2x 3
25 25
2x 1
2 x ¬3 4
57
¬ 6 2
25 or 5
4
y ¬85
( 2, 4) y 5
The point of intersection is
14
8
5 , 5 .
Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
distance between (0, 3) and 5 , 5 .
14 8 O x
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
0 5
14 2 8 2
¬ 5 (3)
The distance from a line to a point not on the line
¬154
5
2 2 is the length of the segment perpendicular to the
7
line from the point. From the figure, this
distance is 1.
19
¬ 6 49
25 25
26. y
¬
24
5 y 2x 2
25 or 9.8
O x
The distance between the lines is 9.8
units.
24. 3x 4y ¬20
4y ¬3x 20
( 3, 4)
y ¬34x 5
( 1, 5)
First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
to the lines y 3 3
4 x 1 and y 4 x 5. The
The perpendicular segment from the point
slope of p is the opposite reciprocal of 3 4
4 , or 3 . (1, 5) to the line y 2x 2 appears to
3
Use the y-intercept of the line y 4x 1, intersect the line y 2x 2 at (3, 4). Use the
(0, 1), as one of the endpoints of the Distance Formula to find the distance between
perpendicular segment. (1, 5) and y 2x 2.
y y1 ¬m(x x1) d ¬ (x2
x1)2 (y2 y1)2
¬ [1 (3)] 2 [5 (
4)]2
y (1) ¬4
3 (x 0)
¬2 2 (
1) 2
y 1 ¬4
3x ¬ 5
y ¬4 The distance between the line y 2x 2 and the
3x 1
Next, use a system of equations to determine point (1, 5) is 5 units.
the point of intersection of the line y 3
4x 5
and p.
77 Chapter 3
27. 2x 3y ¬9 32b. 1
3y ¬2x 9 P
y ¬2
3x 3
2
y
32c.
y 2–
3
x 3 Q1 P Q2
(0, 3)
P
O (2, 0) x
32d.
The perpendicular segment from the point (2, 0) P
to the line y 2
3 x 3 appears to intersect the
Q1
line y 2
3
x 3 at (0, 3). Use the Distance
Formula to find the distance between (2, 0) and
y 2
Q2
3 x 3.
P
d ¬
(x2
x1)2 (y2
y1)2
¬
(2 0
)2 (0 3)2 32e.
¬ 2
22 (3) Q1 P Q2
¬13
The distance between the line y 2
3 x 3 and the
point (2, 0) is 13
units.
28. Given: is equidistant to m. 32f.
n is equidistant to m.
Q1 P Q2
Prove: n
m
n
33. Sample answer: We want new shelves to be
Paragraph proof: We are given that is parallel so they will line up.
equidistant to m, and n is equidistant to m. By Answers should include the following.
definition of equidistant, is parallel to m, and n • After marking several points, a slope can be
is parallel to m. By definition of parallel lines, calculated, which should be the same slope as
slope of slope of m, and slope of n slope of the original brace.
m. By substitution, slope of slope of n. Then,
• Building walls requires parallel lines.
by definition of parallel lines, n.
29. It is everywhere equidistant from the ceiling. 34. A
30. The plumb line will be vertical and will be C
perpendicular to the floor. The shortest distance from
a point to the floor will be along the plumb line.
31. a 3, b 4, c 6, (x1, y1) (4, 6) X
|ax1 by1 c| |3(4) 4(6) 6|
¬
a2 b2 32 42
|30|
¬ B D
25 AB 16 and X is the midpoint of A
B, so XB 8.
30
¬ CD 20 and X is the midpoint of C
D, so XD 10.
5 or 6
D
B A B
, so XBD is a right triangle. Use the
32a. 1
Pythagorean Theorem to find BD.
P p (XD)2 ¬(XB)2 (BD)2
102 ¬82 (BD)2
2
36 ¬(BD)2
6 ¬BD
Chapter 3 78
35. D; The coin came up heads 14 times, but since the 44. Given: NL ¬NM, AL ¬BM
first and last flips were both heads and there Prove: NA ¬NB
were 24 total flips, it’s not possible to have all L M
14 times heads came up be consecutive. But it is
possible that the first 13 flips were heads, or the A B
last 13 flips were heads.
N
Proof:
Page 164 Maintain Your Skills
36. CF
DE ; alternate interior Statements Reasons
37.
DA EF; corresponding 1. NL NM 1. Given
38.
DA
EF; 1 4 and consecutive interior are AL BM
supplementary 2. NL NA AL 2. Segment Addition
39. Find the slope of a using (0, 3) and (2, 4). NM NB BM Post.
(y y )
m ¬
2
1
3. NA AL NB BM 3. Substitution
(x2 x1)
4 3 4. NA BM NB BM 4. Substitution
¬ 1
2 0 or 2
5. NA NB 5. Subt. Prop.
y ¬mx b
y ¬1
2x 3
Pages 165–166 Geometry Activity:
40. Find the slope of b using (0, 5) and (1, 4). Non-Euclidean Geometry
(y y ) 1. The great circle is finite.
m ¬
2
1
2. A curved path on the great circle passing through
(x2 x1)
4 5
two points is the shortest distance between the
¬
1 0 or 1 two points.
y ¬mx b 3. There exist no parallel lines.
y ¬x 5 4. Two distinct great circles intersect in exactly two
41. Find the slope of c using (0, 2) and (3, 0). points.
(y y ) 5. A pair of perpendicular great circles divides the
m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1) sphere into four finite congruent regions.
0 ( 2) 2 6. There exist no parallel lines.
¬
3 0 or 3
7. There are two distances between two points.
y ¬mx b
8. true
y ¬2
3x 2
9. False; in spherical geometry, if three points are
42. Line a has slope 1
2 (from Exercise 39), so a line collinear, any point can be between the other two.
perpendicular to a has slope 2. 10. False; in spherical geometry, there are no parallel
y y1 ¬m(x x1) lines.
y (4) ¬2[x (1)]
y 4 ¬2x 2
y ¬2x 6 Chapter 3 Study Guide and Review
43. Line c has slope 2
3 (from Exercise 41), so a line
parallel to c has slope 2
3.
Page 167 Vocabulary and Concept Check
y y1 ¬m(x x1) 1. alternate
2. perpendicular
y 5 ¬2
3 (x 2)
3. parallel
y 5 ¬2
4
3x 3 4. transversal
y ¬2 11
3x 3
5. alternate exterior
6. congruent
7. consecutive
79 Chapter 3
5 (
13. consecutive interior 25. slope of
AB ¬
41
3)
14. alternate exterior
¬8
3
15. alternate interior
2 (1)
16. 1 and 2 are supplementary. slope of
CD ¬ 7 1
m1 m2 ¬180 ¬3
8
53 m2 ¬180 The product of the slopes is 8
3 3 or 1.
8
m2 ¬127 So,
AB is perpendicular to
CD.
17. 3 ¬6 3
26. slope of AB ¬ 6 2
0
6 ¬1
3 ¬1 ¬3
4
m3 ¬m1 1
slope of CD ¬ (4)
3 (1)
m3 ¬53
18. m4 m3 ¬180 ¬3
4
and CD
The slopes are the same, so AB are
m4 53 ¬180
m4 ¬127 parallel.
19. m5 m6 180
27. First, find the slope of AB.
(y2 y1)
6 ¬1 m ¬
(x2 x1)
m6 ¬m1
62
m5 m1 ¬180 ¬1 (1 )
m5 53 ¬180 4
¬2 or 2
m5 ¬127
Parallel lines have the same slope, so the slope of
20. 6 ¬1 the line to be drawn is 2.
m6 ¬m1 Graph the line. Start at (2, 3). Move up 2 units
m6 ¬53 and then move right 1 unit. Draw the line
21. m7 m6 ¬180 through this point and (2, 3).
m7 53 ¬180 y
m7 ¬127
22. Find a. (2, 3)
1 and 2 are supplementary, so
m1 m2 180.
3a 40 2a 25 ¬180 O x
5a 65 ¬180
5a ¬115
a ¬23
Find b.
.
28. First, find the slope of PQ
2 4 and m4 m3 180, so
m2 m3 180. (y y )
m ¬
2
1
2a 25 5b 26 ¬180 (x2 x1)
2(23) 25 5b 26 ¬180 4 2
¬ 35
5b 45 ¬180 6
5b ¬135 ¬2 or 3
b ¬27 Since 313 1, the slope of the line to be
1
¬ 1
23. slope of AB 3 (4) drawn is 1 3 . Graph the line. Start at (2, 2).
Move down 1 unit and then move right 3 units.
¬2
7 Draw the line through this point and (2, 2).
¬
9 2
slope of CD 02 y
¬7
2
The slopes are not the same, so
AB and
CD are
not parallel. The product of the slopes is 2
7 2
7
or 1, so AB and CD are not perpendicular. O x
and CD
Therefore, AB are neither parallel nor
perpendicular. ( 2, 2)
2
2
24. slope of
AB ¬ 26
4
¬
4 or 1 29. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
¬2 (
4)
slope of CD 5 (1) y (5) ¬2 (x 1)
y 5 ¬2x 2
¬6
6 or 1
and CD
are y ¬2x 7
The slopes are the same, so AB
parallel.
Chapter 3 80
(y y )
30. m ¬
2
1
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(x2 x1)
1 5 ¬
(2
0)2
[3
(4)]2
¬
2 2
6 3 ¬
(2)2 12
¬
4 or 2
y y1 ¬m (x x1) ¬5
The distance between the lines is 5
units.
y 5 ¬3
2 (x 2)
42. First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
3
y 5 ¬2x 3
to y 1 1
2 x and y 2 x 5. The slope of p is the
y ¬3
2x 2
opposite reciprocal of 1
2 , or 2. Use the
1
31. y ¬mx b y-intercept of y 2 x, (0, 0), as one of the
y ¬2
7x 4
endpoints of the perpendicular segment.
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
32. y y1 ¬m(x x1) y 0 ¬2 (x 0)
y (4) ¬3 y ¬2x
2 (x 2)
Next, use a system of equations to determine the
y 4 ¬3
2x 3
point of intersection of the line y 1
2 x 5 and p.
y ¬3
2x 1
1x 5 ¬2x
2
33. y ¬mx b 5 ¬2x 1
2x
y ¬5x 3 5 ¬5
x
2
(y y )
34. m ¬
2
1 2 ¬x
(x2 x1)
y ¬1
2 (2) 5
¬ 64 (
1)
3 y ¬4
7
¬7 or 1
The point of intersection is (2, 4).
y y1 ¬m(x x1) Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
y (1) ¬1(x 3) distance between (0, 0) and (2, 4).
y 1 ¬x 3
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
y ¬x 2
35.
AL and
BJ, alternate exterior are ¬
(2
0)2
(4 0)2
36. and BJ
AL , consecutive interior are ¬
(2)2 42
supplementary
¬20 25
37. and GK
CF , 2 lines to the same line
The distance between the lines is 20
units.
38.
AL and BJ, alternate interior are
39.
CF and
GK, consecutive interior are
supplementary
40.
CF and
GK, corresponding are
Chapter 3 Practice Test
41. First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
Page 171
to y 2x 4 and y 2x 1. The slope of p is the
opposite reciprocal of 2, or 1 1. The slope of a line perpendicular to y 3x 2
7 is
2 . Use the y-intrecept
of y 2x 4, (0, 4), as one of the endpoints of the opposite reciprocal of 3, or 1
.
3
the perpendicular segment. Sample answer: y 1 3x 1
81 Chapter 3
1 5
7. m11 m12 ¬180 14. slope of
FG ¬
3 3
m11 64 ¬180 6
m11 ¬116 ¬
6 or 1
8. m3 m4 ¬180 Start at (1, 1). Move 1 unit up and then move
4 ¬12 1 unit right. Draw the line through this point and
m4 ¬m12 (1, 1).
m3 m12 ¬180 y F (3, 5)
m3 64 ¬180
m3 ¬116
9. 4 ¬12
m4 ¬m12
m4 ¬64 O x
10. m9 m10 180 G M(1, 1)
( 3, 1)
10 ¬12
m10 ¬m12
m9 m12 ¬180 15. Start at (3, 2). Move 4 units up and then move 3
m9 64 ¬180 units left. Draw the line through this point
m9 ¬116 and (3, 2).
11. 5 ¬7 y
7 ¬12
5 ¬12
m5 ¬m12
m5 ¬64
O x
12. Start at (2, 1). Move 1 unit down and then move K(3, 2)
1 unit right. Draw the line through this point and
(2, 1).
y
16. ABD ACE
mACE mECF ¬180
mABD mECF ¬180
( 2, 1)
3x 60 2x 15 ¬180
O x
5x 45 ¬180
5x ¬225
x ¬45
17. DBC ¬ECF
30 mDBC ¬mECF
13. slope of
AB ¬
4 (2) y ¬2(45) 15
y ¬105
¬3
1
6 or 2
18. mFCF ¬2x 15
1
2 (2) 1, so the slope of the line to be graphed
¬2(45) 15
is 2. ¬105
Start at (1, 3). Move 2 units down and then
move 1 unit right. Draw the line through this 19. mABD ¬3x 60
point and (1, 3). ¬3(45) 60
¬75
y
B(4, 3) 20. mBCE mFCE ¬180
Q ( 1, 3) mBCE 105 ¬180
mBCE ¬75
A( 2, 0)
21. mCBD ¬y
O x
¬105
Chapter 3 82
22. The slope of a line perpendicular to y 2x 1 24. The slope of a line perpendicular to y x 4
and y 2x 9 is 1
2 . Use the y-intercept of and y x is 1. Use the y-intercept of y x,
y 2x 1, (0, 1), as one of the endpoints of the (0, 0), as one of the endpoints of the perpendicular
perpendicular segment. segment.
y y1 ¬m(x x1) y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y (1) ¬1 y 0 ¬1(x 0)
2 (x 0)
y ¬x
y 1 ¬1
2x Use a system of equations to determine the point
y ¬1
2x 1
of intersection of the line y x 4 and the
perpendicular segment.
Use a system of equations to determine the point
x 4 ¬x
of intersection of the line y 2x 9 and the
4 ¬2x
perpendicular segment.
2 ¬x
2x 9 ¬1
2x 1
y ¬(2) 4
2x 1 y ¬2
2 x ¬1 9
The point of intersection is (2, 2).
5x ¬10
2 Use the Distance Formula to determine the
x ¬4
y ¬2(4) 9 distance between (0, 0) and (2, 2).
y ¬1 d ¬ (x2 x1)2
(y2
y1)2
The point of intersection is (4, 1). ¬ (2 0)
2 (2 0)2
Use the Distance Formula to determine the ¬(2)
2 (2) ¬
2 8
distance between (0, 1) and (4, 1). ¬2.83
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 The distance between the lines y x and
y x 4 is about 2.83 units. So, the distance
¬
(4
0)2 2
[1 (1)] between Lorain Road and Detroit Road is about
2.83 miles.
¬
(4)2
22
25. B; 1 3, and 3 and 4 are supplementary so
¬20
1 and 4 are supplementary.
The distance between the lines is 20 or about m4 180 m1 so m4 107 and hence
4.47 units. m4 73. Furthermore, 1 is not congruent to
23. The slope of a line perpendicular to y x 4 4. Lines m and are parallel so consecutive
and y x 2 is 1. Use the y-intercept of interior angles are supplementary. Hence,
y x 4, (0, 4), as one of the endpoints of the m2 m3 180. So the only statement that
perpendicular segment. cannot be true is B.
y y1 ¬m (x x1)
y 4 ¬1(x 0)
y 4 ¬x Chapter 3 Standardized Test Practice
y ¬x 4
Use a system of equations to determine the point Pages 172–173
of intersection of the line y x 2 and the 1. B; 2 m 200 cm
perpendicular segment. 2. C; d ¬(x
2x1)2
(y2
y1)2
x 2 ¬x 4
¬ (2 2)2 (3 4)2
2x ¬6
x ¬3 ¬(4
)2
(7)2 ¬65
y ¬( 3) 2 3. A; statement A is true by definition of angle
y ¬1 bisector. There is not enough information to
The point of intersection is (3, 1). establish that any of the other statements are
Use the Distance Formula to determine the true.
distance between (0, 4) and (3, 1). 4. D; 180 72 108
d ¬ (x2
x1)2 (y2 y1)2 5. D; 4x 4 ¬6x 8
4 8 ¬6x 4x
¬(3 0)2 (1 4
)2
12 ¬2x
¬(3)
2 (3)
2
6 ¬x
¬18 6. C
The distance between the lines is 18
or about
7. B; 1 and 3 are corresponding angles.
4.24 units.
83 Chapter 3
(y y )
8. C; 4y x ¬8 15a. m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
4y ¬x 8
48 44
¬
y ¬1
4x 2
21
¬4
14(4) 1, so the slope of the perpendicular 15b. The slope represents the increase in the average
line is 4. y 4x 15 is the only choice with monthly cable bill each year.
slope 4. 15c. The slope of the line through the points is 4. One
9. C; the number 2 in y 2x 5 is the slope, which point on the line is (1, 44). Find the equation of
determines the steepness of the line. the line.
4x
10. 3 3 3(10)
6 y 44 ¬4(x 1)
y 44 ¬4x 4
11. mFHC mFHD 180
y ¬4x 40
FHD HGB
mFHD mHGB After 10 years the cable bill will be
mFHC mHGB ¬180 y 4(10) 40, or $80.
mFHC 70 ¬180
mFHC ¬110
The flag holder rotates 110°.
12. CHG ¬HGB
mCHG ¬mHGB
mCHG ¬70
(y y )
13. m ¬
2
1
(x2 x1)
6 4
¬93
¬2
6 or 3
1
14. The ball did not reach home plate. The distance
between second base and home plate forms the
hypotenuse of a right triangle, with second base
to third base as one leg, and third base to home
plate as the other leg. The Pythagorean Theorem
is used to find the distance between second base
and home plate.
902 902 ¬c2
8100 8100 ¬c2
16,200 ¬c2
16,200 ¬c
127.3 ¬c
Since the ball traveled 120 feet and the distance
from second base to home plate is about 127.3
feet, the ball did not make it to home plate.
Chapter 3 84
Chapter 4 Congruent Triangles
Page 177 Getting Started 10. 12 is supplementary to 4 linear pair
1. 2x 18 ¬5 2. 3m 16 ¬12 12 is supplementary to 16 linear pair
2x ¬13 3m ¬28 12 is supplementary to 11 12 3
x ¬13
or 6 1 m ¬28
1 corresponding ,
2 2 3 or 9 3 3 is supplemen-
3. 4y 12 ¬16 4. 10 ¬8 3z tary to 11
4y ¬4 2 ¬3z linear pair
y ¬1 2
3 ¬z
12 is supplementary to 14 12 is supple-
mentary to 16
5. 6 ¬2a 1
2 6. 2
3 b 9 ¬15
linear pair,
11
¬2a 2b ¬24
2 3 16 14
11 corresponding
4 ¬a b ¬36
12 is supplementary to 5 12 is supple-
2 3
4 ¬a
mentary to 10
7. 8 2 vertical consecutive
8 12 corresponding interior ,
8 15 alternate exterior 10 5
8 6 corresponding alternate
8 9 alternate exterior exterior
8 3 8 15 alternate exterior , 12 is supplementary to 1 12 is supple-
15 3 alternate interior , mentary to 10
transitivity consecutive
8 13 8 15 alternate exterior , interior ,
15 13 corresponding , 10 1
transitivity corresponding
8. 13 2 13 15 corresponding , 12 is supplementary to 7 12 8
15 2 corresponding , corresponding ,
transitivity 8 is supplemen-
13 12 alternate exterior tary to 7
13 15 corresponding linear pair
13 6 alternate exterior 12 is supplementary to 10 consecutive
13 9 corresponding interior
13 3 vertical 11. d ¬(x
x2
1)2 (y 2 y 1)
2
85 Chapter 4
Pages 180–181 Check for Understanding 12. 8 scalene triangles (green), 8 isosceles triangles in
1. Triangles are classified by sides and angles. For the middle (blue), 4 isosceles triangles around the
example, a triangle can have a right angle and middle (yellow), and 4 isosceles triangles at the
have no two sides congruent. corners of the square (purple).
2. Sample answer:
Chapter 4 86
28. QRS is equilateral so all three sides are 32. AB ¬(3 ) 51
2 ( 4)2
congruent. ¬4 25 29
QR ¬2x 2 BC ¬(7) 31
2 [1)] (2
RS ¬x 6 ¬16
0 16 or 4
QS ¬3x 10 AC ¬(7) 51
2 ( 4)2
QR ¬RS ¬4 25 29
2x 2 ¬x 6 B
Since A and A C have the same length, ABC is
2x x ¬6 2 isosceles.
x ¬8 33. AB ¬[5 4)]
( 2 (6 1)2
QR ¬2x 2 ¬815 2 106
¬2(8) 2 ¬14 BC ¬(3
5)2 (7 6)2
RS ¬x 6 ¬6469 1 233
¬8 6 ¬14 AC ¬[3
(4)]27 ( 1)2
QS ¬3x 10 ¬1 64 65
¬3(8) 10 ¬14 ABC is scalene because no two sides are
29. JL ¬2x 5 congruent.
JK ¬x 3 34. AB ¬[7 (7)]21 () 92
KL ¬x 1 ¬0 0 10 100 or 10
J
K ¬L
J BC ¬[47)]
( 2 [11)]
(2
KJ ¬LJ ¬121
0 121 or 11
x 3 ¬2x 5 AC ¬[47)]
( 2 (1 9)2
3 5 ¬2x x ¬121
100 221
8 ¬x ABC is scalene because no two sides are
JL ¬2x 5 congruent.
¬2(8) 5 ¬11
35. AB ¬[2 3)]
( 2 [1 (1)]2
JK ¬x 3
¬25 4 29
¬8 3 ¬11
BC ¬(2 ) 23
2 ( 1)2
KL ¬x 1
¬0 16 16 or 4
¬8 1 ¬7
AC ¬[23)]
( 2 [31)]
(2
30. P is the midpoint of MN, so MP PN 1
2 (24) or ¬25 4 29
12. OPM N, so MPO and NPO are right B
Since A and A C have the same length, ABC is
triangles. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find isosceles.
MO and NO.
36. AB ¬ (53
0)2
(2 5)2
(MO)2 ¬(MP)2 (OP)2
¬75 9 84
(MO)2 ¬122 122
BC ¬ (0 53)2
(1 2)2
(MO)2 ¬288
¬75 9 84
MO ¬288
AC ¬(0) 01
2 () 52
(NO)2 ¬(PN)2 (OP)2
¬0 36 36 or 6
(NO)2 ¬122 122
B
Since A and B C have the same length, ABC is
(NO)2 ¬288
isosceles.
NO ¬288
MPO and NPO are not equilateral because 37. AB ¬ [5 (9)]2 (63 0)2
MO NO 288 . ¬1608 1 124
31. Let x be the distance from Lexington to Nashville. BC ¬ [1 (5)]2 (0 63
)2
Then the distance from Cairo to Nashville is ¬1608 1 124
x 40, the distance from Cairo to Lexington is AC ¬[1
(9)]2 (0 0)2
x 81, and (x 40) (x 81) x 593 ¬64 0 64 or 8
3x 41 ¬593 B
Since A and B C have the same length, ABC is
3x ¬552 isosceles.
x ¬184
x 40 ¬184 40 or 144
x 81 ¬184 81 or 265
The triangle formed is scalene; it is 184 miles
from Lexington to Nashville, 265 miles from Cairo
to Lexington, and 144 miles from Cairo to
Nashville.
87 Chapter 4
38. Given: EUI is equiangular. 42. Use the Distance Formula and Slope Formula.
L
QU I KL ¬(4 ) 2 2 (2
6)2
Prove: EQL is equiangular. ¬4 16
E ¬20
L
KL M
, so LM 20 .
2 6
L
slope of K ¬42
4
Q L ¬ 2 or 2
KLM is a right angle, so K LL M
and L
M
has
slope 1
2.
U I
Let (x2, y2) be the coordinates of M.
Proof: 2 y 2
M
slope of L ¬
Statements Reasons x2 4
y2 2
1. EUI is equiangular. 1. Given 1 ¬
2 x2 4
L
QU
I x2 4 ¬2(y2 2)
2. E EUI EIU 2. Definition of equi- LM ¬(x 4)
2 (y
2 2)
2
2
angular triangle 20
¬[2(y 2)]2 (y 2)2
2 2
3. EUI EQL 3. Corresponding 20
¬4(y 2 2)
2 (y2 2)2
EIU ELQ are . 20
¬5(y 2 2)2
0 a2 b)
B
(0
2
41. AD ¬ 2
A
¬ 2 (b ) a4 b
2 2
a 2 2 x
CD ¬ 2
(0 b)
2 C
a a 2
AD CD, so A
D
C
D
. ADC is isosceles by All three angles of ABC are acute, so ABC is
definition. acute.
Chapter 4 88
x y 15 35
45. B; ¬25 The perpendicular segment from the point (6, 2)
4
to the line y 7 intersects the line y 7 at (6, 7).
x y 50 ¬100
Use the Distance Formula to find the distance
x y ¬50
between (6, 2) and y 7.
x 15 35
¬27 d ¬(xx2 1) (y2
2 y1)2
3
x 50 ¬81 ¬(6) 62
2 ( 7)2
x ¬31 ¬0 81
Substituting 31 for x, ¬81 or 9
31 y ¬50 The distance between the line y 7 and the point
y ¬19 (6, 2) is 9 units.
49.
A
C 110˚
p
Page 183 Maintain Your Skills B
46. D E
y q
F
(4x 10)˚
y x 2
Explore: From the figure, you know that
mABC 110 and mDEF 4x 10.
O x
(2, –2)
Plan: For line p to be parallel to line q,
corresponding angles must be congruent, so
ABC AED. Since AED is supplementary to
The perpendicular segment from the point (2, 2) DEF because they are a linear pair, it must be
to the line y x 2 appears to intersect the line true that p q if ABC is supplementary to
y x 2 at (1, 1). Use the Distance Formula to DEF, or mABC mDEF 180. Substitute
find the distance between (2, 2) and y x 2. the given angle measures into this equation and
d ¬(xx2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2 solve for x.
¬(1
2) 2)]
2 [1 (2 Solve: mABC mDEF ¬180
¬9 9 110 4x 10 ¬180
¬18
4x ¬60
The distance between the line y x 2 and the x ¬15
point (2, 2) is 18
units. Examine: Verify the measure of DEF by using
47. y the value of x. That is, 4x 10 4(15) 10 or 70,
(3, 3) and 110 70 180. Since mABC mDEF
180, ABC is supplementary to DEF and p q.
x y 2 50. p q
O x A
(3x 50)˚ E F
C B (2x 5)˚
xy2
y x 2 D
The perpendicular segment from the point (3, 3)
to the line x y 2 appears to intersect the line Explore: From the figure, you know that
x y 2 at (1, 1). Use the Distance Formula to mABC 3x 50 and mDEF 2x 5. You
find the distance between (3, 3) and x y 2. also know that ABC and DEF are alternate
d ¬(xx2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2 exterior angles.
¬(3) 1 2 (3 1)2 Plan: For line p to be parallel to line q, the
¬4 4 alternate exterior angles must be congruent. So
¬8 mABC mDEF. Substitute the given angle
The distance between the line x y 2 and the measures into this equation and solve for x.
point (3, 3) is 8 units. Solve: mABC ¬mDEF
48. 3x 50 ¬2x 5
y
x ¬45
Examine: Verify the angle measures by using the
y 7 value of x to find mABC and mDEF.
mABC ¬3x 50
¬3(45) 50
¬85
mDEF ¬2x 5
O x ¬2(45) 5
¬85
(6, –2) Since mABC mDEF, ABC DEF and p q.
89 Chapter 4
51. A
57˚ 4-2 Angles of Triangles
p
B C
E q
D Pages 188–189 Check for Understanding
F (3x 9)˚ 1. Sample answer: 2 and 3 are the remote
Explore: From the figure, you know that interior angles of exterior 1.
mABC 57 and mDEF 3x 9. 2
Plan: For line p to be parallel to line q,
corresponding angles must be congruent, so 1 3
ABC AED. Since AED is supplementary to
DEF, because they are a linear pair, it must be 2. Najee; the sum of the measures of the remote
true that p q if ABC is supplementary to interior angles is equal to the measure of the
DEF, or mABC mDEF 180. Substitute corresponding exterior angle.
the given angle measures into this equation and 3. Let P be the unknown angle at Pittsburgh.
solve for x. mP 85 52 ¬180
Solve: mABC mDEF ¬180 mP 137 ¬180
57 3x 9 ¬180 mP ¬43
3x ¬132 4. Let A be the unknown angle in the figure.
x ¬44 mA 62 19 ¬180
Examine: Verify the measure of DEF by using mA 81 ¬180
the value of x. That is, 3x 9 3(44) 9 or 123, mA ¬99
and 57 123 180. Since mABC 5. m1 23 32
mDEF 180, mABC is supplementary to 55
DEF, and p q.
6. m2 22 ¬m1
52. 1. Given m2 22 ¬55
2. Subtraction Property m2 ¬33
3. Addition Property
7. m3 22 (180 m1)
4. Division Property
22 180 55
53. any three: 2 and 11, 3 and 6, 4 and 7, 147
3 and 12, 7 and 10, 8 and 11
8. m1 25 ¬90
54. 1 and 4, 1 and 10, 5 and 2, 5 and 8, m1 ¬65
9 and 6, 9 and 12
9. m2 65 90
55. 6, 9, and 12 by alternate interior and m2 ¬25
transitivity
10. m1 m2 ¬90
56. 1, 4, and 10 by alternate interior and m1 70 ¬90
transitivity m1 ¬20
57. 2, 5, and 8 by alternate interior and
transitivity
Pages 189–191 Practice and Apply
11. Let X be the third angle in the triangle.
Page 184 Geometry Activity: Angles of Triangles mX 40 47 ¬180
1. congruent mX 87 ¬180
2. congruent mX ¬93
3. congruent 12. Let X be one of the two congruent angles of the
4. 180, because DFA DFE AFE, and AFE triangle.
and EFC form a linear pair. mX mX 39 ¬180
2mX 39 ¬180
5. mA mB mC 180 by substitution
2mX ¬141
6. The sum of the measures of the angles of any mX ¬70.5
triangle is 180. The missing angles have measure 70.5 and 70.5.
7. mA mB is the measure of the exterior angle 13. Let X be one of the two congruent angles of the
at C. triangle.
8. See students’ work. mX mX 50 ¬180
9. yes 2mX 50 ¬180
10. See students’ work. 2mX ¬130
11. See students’ work. mX ¬65
The missing angles have measure 65 and 65.
12. The measure of an exterior angle is equal to the
sum of the measures of the two remote interior
angles.
Chapter 4 90
14. Let X be the unknown acute angle of the 35. m4 m2 ¬90
triangle. m4 50 ¬90
mX 27 ¬90 m4 ¬40
mX ¬63 36. m1 26 101 ¬180
15. m1 47 57 ¬180 m1 127 ¬180
m1 104 ¬180 m1 ¬53
m1 ¬76 37. m2 26 103
16. m2 m1 129
m2 76 38. m3 101 (180 128)
17. m3 m2 55 ¬180 153
m3 76 55 ¬180 39. Given: FGI IGH
m3 131 ¬180 I F
G H
m3 ¬49 Prove: F H
18. m1 69 47 ¬180 G
m1 116 ¬180
m1 ¬64
19. m1 m2 63 ¬180
64 m2 63 ¬180
m2 127 ¬180 F I H
m2 ¬53 Proof:
20. m3 m2 63 GI ⊥ FH
53 63 Given
116
21. m4 m5 m3 ¬180
2m4 116 ¬180 GIF and GIH
2m4 ¬64 are right angles. FGI IGH
m4 ¬32 ⊥ lines form rt. . Given
22. m5 m4 23. m6 136 ¬180
m5 32 m6 ¬44
GIF GIH F H
24. m7 47 ¬136
All rt. are . Third Angle Theorem
m7 ¬89
25. m1 33 24 ¬180 40. Given: ABCD is a quadrilateral.
m1 57 ¬180 Prove: mDAB mB mBCD mD 360
m1 ¬123 A B
1 2
26. m2 95 ¬m1
m2 95 ¬123 3
m2 ¬28 4
D C
27. m3 109 ¬m1
Proof:
m3 109 ¬123
m3 ¬14 Statements Reasons
28. m1 126 ¬180 29. m2 73 ¬126 1. ABCD is a quadrilateral. 1. Given
m1 ¬54 m2 ¬53
2. m2 m3 mB 180 2. Angle Sum
30. m3 43 ¬180 m1 m4 mD 180 Theorem
m3 ¬137
3. m2 m3 mB m1 3. Addition
31. m4 34 43 ¬180
m4 mD 360 Property
m4 77 ¬180
m4 ¬103 4. mDAB m1 m2 4. Angle
32. m1 mDGF ¬90 mBCD m3 m4 addition
m1 53 ¬90 5. mDAB mB mBCD 5. Substitution
m1 ¬37 mD 360
33. m2 mAGC ¬90
m2 40 ¬90
m2 ¬50
34. m3 mAGC ¬90
m3 40 ¬90
m3 ¬50
91 Chapter 4
41. Given: ABC Given: PQR
Prove: mCBD mA mC P is obtuse.
C Prove: There can be at most one obtuse angle in
a triangle.
D Q
A
B
R
Proof:
P
Statements Reasons
Proof: In PQR, P is obtuse. So mP 90.
1. ABC 1. Given mP mQ mR 180. It must be
that mQ mR 90. So, Q and R must be
2. CBD and ABC form 2. Def. of linear
acute.
a linear pair. pair
44. Given: A D
3. CBD and ABC are 3. If 2 form a B E
supplementary. linear pair, they Prove: C F
are suppl.
F
4. mCBD mABC 180 4. Def. of suppl. C
D E
5. mA mABC 5. Angle Sum A B
mC 180 Theorem Proof:
6. mA mABC 6. Subsitution Statements Reasons
mC mCBD Property 1. A D 1. Given
mABC B E
7. mA mC 7. Subtraction 2. mA mD 2. Def. of
mCBD Property mB mE
42. Given: RST
3. mA mB mC 180 3. Angle Sum
R is a right angle
mD mE mF 180 Theorem
Prove: S and T are complementary
S 4. mA mB mC 4. Transitive
mD mE mF Property
5. mD mE mC 5. Substitution
R T mD mE mF Property
Proof:
6. mC mF 6. Subtraction
R is a rt. . Property
Given 7. C F 7. Def. of
45. m1 m2 m3 ¬180
m R 90 m R m S m T 180 4x 5x 6x ¬180
Def. of rt. Angle Sum Theorem 15x ¬180
x ¬12
90 m S m T 180 m1 4(12) or 48
Substitution m2 5(12) or 60
m3 6(12) or 72
46. Sample answer: The shape of a kite is symmetric. If
m S m T 90
triangles are used on one side of the kite, congruent
Subtraction Prop.
triangles are used on the opposite side. The wings
of this kite are made from congruent right
S and T are complementary triangles. Answers should include the following.
Def. of complementary • By the Third Angle Theorem, if two angles of
two congruent triangles are congruent, then the
43. Given: MNO N third angles of each triangle are congruent.
M is a right • If one angle measures 90, the other two angles
angle. are both acute.
Prove: There can be at M O
47. A; mZ mX ¬90
most one right
a
2 2a ¬90
angle in a triangle.
a 4a ¬180
Proof: In MNO, M is a right angle.
5a ¬180
mM mN mO 180. mM 90, so
a ¬36
mN mO 90. If N were a right angle,
then mO 0. But that is impossible, so there mZ ¬a
2
36
cannot be two right angles in a triangle. ¬2 or 18
Chapter 4 92
48. B; let x be the measure of the first angle. Then the d ¬(xx2 1)
2 (y2
y1)2
other angles have measure 3x and x 25. ¬(4
0 ) )
2 (1 32
x 3x x 25 ¬180 ¬16 4
5x 25 ¬180 ¬20
5x ¬155 The distance between the lines is 25 units.
x ¬31
54. 4x y ¬20
3x ¬3(31) or 93
y ¬4x 20
x 25 ¬31 25 or 56
y ¬4x 20
4x y ¬3
y ¬4x 3
Page 191 Maintain Your Skills y ¬4x 3
49. AED is scalene because no two sides are First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
congruent. to 4x y 20 and 4x y 3. The slope of p is
50. AED is obtuse because mAED 90. the opposite reciprocal of 4, or 1
4 . Use the
mAED mBEC, so BEC is obtuse. y-intercept of 4x y 20, (0, 20), as one of the
51. BEC is isosceles because E B
E C. endpoints of the perpendicular segment.
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
52. First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
to y x 6 and y x 10. The slope of p is the y (20) ¬1
4 (x 0)
opposite reciprocal of 1, or 1. Use the y-intercept y 20 ¬1
4x
of y x 6, (0, 6), as one of the endpoints of the
perpendicular segment. y ¬1
4 x 20
y y1 ¬m(x x1) Next, use a system of equations to determine the
y 6 ¬1(x 0) point of intersection of line 4x y 3 and p.
y 6 ¬x 4x 3 ¬14 x 20
y ¬x 6 17
4 x ¬17
Next, use a system of equations to determine the
point of intersection of line y x 10 and p. x ¬4
x 10 ¬x 6 y 14 (4) 20
2x ¬16 y 19
x ¬8 The point of intersection is (4,19).
y 8 10 Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
y 2 distance between (0, 20) and (4,19).
The point of intersection is (8, 2). d ¬(xx2 1) (y2
2 y1)2
Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
¬(4
0)
2 [190)]
(22
distance between (0, 6) and (8, 2).
¬16 1
d ¬(x x
2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2
¬17
¬(8 ) 02
2 () 62 The distance between the lines is 17 units.
¬64 4 6
55. 2x 3y ¬9
¬128
3y ¬2x 9
The distance between the lines is 82 units.
y ¬2
3x 3
53. First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
to y 2x 3 and y 2x 7. The slope of p is 2x 3y ¬6
the opposite reciprocal of 2, or 1 3y ¬2x 6
2 . Use the
y-intercept of y 2x 3, (0, 3), as one of the y ¬2
3x 2
endpoints of the perpendicular segment. First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
y y1 ¬m(x x1) to 2x 3y 9 and 2x 3y 6. The slope of p
y 3 ¬1 is the opposite reciprocal of 2 3
3 , or 2 . Use the
2 (x 0)
y-intercept of 2x 3y 9, (0, 3), as one of the
y 3 ¬1
2x endpoints of the perpendicular segment.
y ¬1
2x 3
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
Next, use a system of equations to determine the y 3 ¬3
2 (x 0)
point of intersection of line y 2x 7 and p.
y 3 ¬3
2x
2x 7 ¬12x 3
5 y ¬32x 3
2 x ¬10
x ¬4 Next, use a system of equations to determine the
y 2(4) 7 point of intersection of line 2x 3y 6 and p.
y1 2 x 2 ¬3 x 3
3 2
The point of intersection is (4, 1). 13
Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
6 x ¬1
6
distance between (0, 3), and (4, 1). x ¬
13
93 Chapter 4
6. The red triangles are congruent: BME, ANG,
6
y 3
2 13 3 DKH, CLF. The blue triangles are congruent:
9 30
y 13 3 or 13
EMJ, GNJ, HKJ, FLJ. The purple
The point of intersection is
6
30
13 , 13 .
triangles are congruent to each other and to the
triangles made up of a blue triangle and a red
Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
triangle: BLJ, AMJ, JND, JKC, BMJ,
distance between (0, 3) and 1
6
30
.
3 , 13 ANJ, JKD, JLC. Another set of congruent
d ¬(x
x 2
1)
2 (y2
y1)2 triangles consists of triangles made up of a red, a
blue, and a purple triangle: BAJ, ADJ, DCJ,
163
0
3103
3
2 2
¬ CBJ. Another set of congruent triangles consists
of the triangles which are each half of the square:
36
¬ 81
169 169
BCD, ADC, CBA, DAB.
7.
¬
11
7 1
17 y
169 or 13 Q Q’
1
17
The distance between the lines is 1
3 units.
56. 2y 8 142 ¬180 linear pair
x
2y 150 ¬180
2y ¬30
y ¬15 T
R T’ R’
4x 6 ¬142 corresponding angles
4x ¬136
x ¬34
Use the Distance Formula to find the length of
z ¬4x 6 alternate exterior angles
each side in the triangles.
z ¬4(34) 6
QR ¬[4 (4)]22 () 32
z ¬142
¬0 25 or 5
57. x 68 ¬180 supplementary consecutive interior QR ¬(4) 422 () 32
angles ¬0 25 or 5
x ¬112 RT ¬[1 (4)]22 [2)] (2
4y 68 ¬180 linear pair ¬9 0 or 3
4y ¬112 RT ¬(1) 422 [2)] (2
y ¬28
¬9 0 or 3
5z 2 ¬x alternate interior angles
QT ¬[1 (4)]22 ( 3)2
5z 2 ¬112
¬9 25 or 34
5z ¬110
QT ¬(1) 42
2 ( 3)2
z ¬22
¬9 25 or 34
58. 3x ¬48 alternate interior angles The lengths of the corresponding sides of two
x ¬16 triangles are equal. Therefore, by the definition of
y 42 48 ¬180 Angle Sum Theorem congruence, Q RQ R
, R
T
R T
, and
y 90 ¬180 T
Q Q T
. Use a protractor to measure the
y ¬90 angles of the triangles. You will find that the
z 42 alternate interior angles measures are the same. In conclusion, because
59. reflexive 60. symmetric R
Q QR, R T
R T
, Q
TQ T, Q Q,
61. symmetric 62. transitive R R, and T T, QRT QRT.
63. transitive 64. transitive QRT is a flip of QRT.
8. G K, H L, J P, G HK L
,
J
H L P, G
J K P
4-3 Congruent Triangles
Pages 195–198 Practice and Apply
9. CFH JKL 10. RSV TSV
Page 195 Check for Understanding 11. WPZ QVS 12. EFH GHF
1. The sides and the angles of the triangle are not 13. T X, U Y, V Z, T U
X Y
,
affected by a congruence transformation, so V
U YZ, T
VXZ
congruence is preserved.
14. C R, D S, G W, C D
R S
,
2. Sample answer: G
D SW, CGRW
15. B D, C G, F H, B C
D G
,
F
CG H, BFDH
16. A H, D K, G L, A D
H K,
G
D K L, A
G
H L
3. AFC DFB 4. HJT TKH 17. 1 10, 2 9, 3 8, 4 7,
5. W S, X T, Z J, W
X
S
T
, 5 6
Z
XTJ
, W
Z
S J
18. s 1–4, s 5–12, s 13–20
Chapter 4 94
19. s 1, 5, 6, and 11, s 3, 8, 10, and 12, s 2, 4, 7, Therefore, GHF GHF.
and 9 GHF is a slide of GHF.
20. UFS, TDV, ACB 25. Use the figure and the Distance Formula to find
21. We need to know that all the corresponding the length of each side in the triangles.
angles are congruent and that the other JK ¬[2
(4)]23 () 32
corresponding sides are congruent. ¬4 36 or 40
22. Use the figure and the Distance Formula to find JK ¬(8
) 21
2 [3)] (2
the length of each side in the triangles. ¬36
4 or 40
PQ ¬2 KL¬[02)]
( 2 [2 (3)]2
PQ ¬2 ¬4 25 or 29
QV ¬4 KL ¬(3
) 82 [11)]
(2
QV ¬4 ¬25
4 or 29
JL ¬[0
4)]
( 2 (2 3)2
PV ¬[2 (4)]2 (4 8)2
¬16
1 or 17
¬4 16 or 20
JL ¬(3
) 22 [13)]
(2
PV ¬(2 ) 4 2 (4 8)2
¬1 16 or 17
¬4 16 or 20
The lengths of the corresponding sides of the two
The lengths of the corresponding sides of the two
triangles are equal. Therefore, by the definition of
triangles are equal. Therefore, by the definition of
congruence, JK
J K
, K
LK L
, and J
L
J
L
.
congruence, P QP Q
, Q
V
Q V
, and
Use a protractor to confirm that the
V
P P V
.
corresponding angles are congruent.
Use a protractor to confirm that the
Therefore, JKL JKL.
corresponding angles are congruent.
JKL is a turn of JKL.
Therefore, PQV PQV.
PQV is a flip of PQV. 26. False; A X, B Y, and C Z but the
corresponding sides are not congruent.
23. Use the figure and the Distance Formula to find
the length of each side in the triangles. Y
MN ¬8 B
MN ¬8 X Z
NP ¬2
NP ¬2 A C
MP ¬[2 6)]
( 2 (2 4)2 27. True; D
¬64 4 or 68
MP ¬[2 6)]
( 2 [24)]
(2 A
¬64 4 or 68 E F
The lengths of the corresponding sides of the two
B C
triangles are equal. Therefore, by the definition of
congruence, M NM N, N
PN P, and 28. Both statements are correct because the spokes
P
M M P
. A
are the same length, E IA
, and A
E
A I.
Use a protractor to confirm that the 29. 12
H J
corresponding angles are congruent.
6
Therefore, MNP MNP. 10
12 G
MNP is a flip of MNP. R S
24. Use the figure and the Distance Formula to find 10 6
the length of each side in the triangles. Q
GF ¬(5 ) 2 2 (3 2)2 30.
HJ corresponds to R
S
, so H
J
R
S
.
¬9 1 or 10 2x – 4 ¬12
GF ¬(12 9)2 2)(3 2 2x ¬16
¬9 1 or 10 x ¬8
GH ¬(3 ) 2 2 (5 2)2
31.
¬1 9 or 10 K
GH ¬(10 9)2 2)(5 2 64
¬1 9 or 10 E
HF ¬(5 ) 3 2 (3 5)2 J
36 80
L 64
¬4 4 or 8
HF ¬(12 10)2 5) (3 2 36 80
¬4 4 or 8 D F
The lengths of the corresponding sides of the two 32. D J, so mD mJ 36.
triangles are equal. Therefore, by the definition of mD mE mF ¬180
congruence, G FG F
, G
H
G H, and 36 64 3x 52 ¬180
F
H H F
. 3x 152 ¬180
Use a protractor to confirm that the 3x ¬28
28
corresponding angles are congruent. x ¬
3
95 Chapter 4
33. Given: RST XYZ Page 198 Maintain Your Skills
Prove: XYZ RST 40. x 40 ¬115 41. x 42 ¬100
R S X Y x ¬75 x ¬58
42. x x 30 ¬180
T Z 2x ¬150
Proof: x ¬75
RST XYZ C
43. B C D
, so BC CD.
Given 2x 4 ¬10
2x ¬6
R X, S Y, T Z, x ¬3
RS XY, ST YZ, RT XZ BC 2x 4
CPCTC
2(3) 4 or 10
CD 10
BD x 2
X R, Y S, Z T, 3 2 or 5
XY RS, YZ ST, XZ RT
44. HKT is equilateral, so HKH T hence
Congruence of and HK HT.
segments is symmetric.
x 7 ¬4x 8
15 ¬3x
XYZ RST 5 ¬x
Def. of HK KT HT 4x 8
4(5) 8 or 12
34. a. Given (y y )
b. Given 45. m ¬ 2
1
(x x )
2 1
c. Congruence of segments is reflexive. 3 3
¬ 3
d. Given 4 0 or 2
e. Def. of lines y ¬mx b
f. Given y ¬ 3
2x 3
g. Def. of lines 46. y ¬mx b
h. All right are .
y ¬3
4x 8
i. Given
j. Alt. int. are . 47. m ¬4
k. Given y y1 ¬m(x x1)
l. Alt. int. are . y 1 ¬4[x (3)]
m. Def. of s y 1 ¬4x 12
35. Given: DEF y ¬4x 11
E
Prove: DEF DEF 48. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 2 ¬4[x (3)]
D F y 2 ¬4x 12
Proof: y ¬4x 10
DEF 49. d ¬(x
x2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2
Given ¬[1
1)]
( 2 (6 7)2
¬4 1 or 5
DE DE, EF EF, D D, E E, d ¬(x
x2 1) (y2
50. 2 y1)2
DF DF F F
¬(4
) 82
2 () 22
Congruence of Congruence of
segments is reflexive. is reflexive.
¬16
6 1 or 32
51. d ¬(x
x2 1)
2 (y2 y1)2
DEF DEF ¬(5
) 32 (2 5) 2
Chapter 4 96
3. AB 2x NP ¬(3 ) 42 (1 6)2
2(3.5) or 7 ¬1 25 or 26
BC 4x 7 EF ¬[4 (2)]2 [62)]
(2
4(3.5) 7 or 7 ¬4 64 or 68
AC x 3.5 MN ¬(4 ) 22 (6 2)2
3.5 3.5 or 7 ¬4 16 or 20
4. m1 50 70 ¬180 The corresponding sides are not congruent, so the
m1 120 ¬180 triangles are not congruent.
m1 ¬60 5. Given: DE and BC B
m2 m1 50 bisect each other.
60 50 or 110 Prove: DGB EGC
m3 m2 21 ¬180 D E
G
m3 110 21 ¬180
m3 ¬49 C
5. M J, N K, P L; Proof:
N
MJ K, N
P
K L, M
P
J
L
DE and BC bisect each other.
Given
Page 199 Reading Mathematics
1. Sample answer: If side lengths are given, DG GE, BG GC
determine the number of congruent sides and
Def. of bisector
name the triangle. Some isosceles triangles are of segments
equilateral triangles.
2. ABC is obtuse because mC 90. DGB EGC DGB EGC
3. equiangular or equilateral SAS Vertical are .
M
6. Given: KJ
L
, K
M
JL
K
Prove: JKM MLJ
4-4 Proving Congruence—SSS, SAS M
J
97 Chapter 4
Pages 204–206 Practice and Apply E
14. Given: AFC
, A
B
BC
, B
E
B
F
10. JK ¬[7
(3)]2 (4 2)2 Prove: AFB CEB
¬16
4 or 20 B
FG ¬(4) 22 (7 3)2
¬4 16 or 20
KL ¬[1
(7)]2 (9 4)2 C
¬36
5 2 or 61 A
F
E
GH ¬(9 ) 4 2 (1 7)2
¬25
6 3 or 61 Proof:
JL ¬[1
(3)]2 (9 2)2
¬4 49 or 53 AE FC
FH ¬(9) 2 2 (1 3)2 Given
¬49
4 or 53
Each pair of corresponding sides has the same AE FC
measure so they are congruent. JKL FGH Def. of seg.
by SSS.
AE EF EF FC EF EF
11. JK ¬[2 (1)]22 () 12
Addition Prop. Reflexive Prop.
¬1 9 or 10
FG ¬(3 ) 222 [1)] (2
AE EC AE EF AF
¬1 1 or 2
Substitution EF FC EC
KL ¬[5
(2)]21 [2)] (2
Seg. Addition Post.
¬9 1 or 10
AF EC
GH ¬(2 ) 3 2 [52)]
(2
Def. of seg.
¬1 49 or 50
AB BC
JL ¬[5
(1)]21 () 12
AFB CEB BE BF
¬16 4 or 20
SSS Given
FH ¬(2 ) 2 2 [51)]
(2
¬0 36 or 6 15. Given: T
RQ Q
Y
Q
WQ
R
The corresponding sides are not congruent, so RQY WQT
JKL is not congruent to FGH. Prove: QWT QYR
Y
12. JK ¬[0 1)]
( 2 [6 (1)]2 Q
¬1 49 or 50
FG ¬(5 ) 3 2 (3 1)2
¬4 4 or 8 W T
KL ¬(2) 0 2 (3 6)2 Proof:
¬4 9 or 13
RQ TQ YQ WQ RQY WQT
GH ¬(8 ) 5 2 (1 3)2
Given Given
¬9 4 or 13
JL ¬[21)]
( 2 [3 (1)]2
QWT QYR
¬9 16 or 5
SAS
FH ¬(8 ) 3 2 (1 1)2
¬25 0 or 5 16. Given: CDE is an isosceles triangle.
The corresponding sides are not congruent, so E
G is the midpoint of C.
JKL is not congruent to FGH. Prove: CDG EDG
D
13. JK ¬(4 ) 3 2 (6 9)2
¬1 9 or 10
FG ¬(2 ) 1 2 (4 7)2
¬1 9 or 10
KL ¬(1 ) 4 2 (5 6)2 C G E
¬9 1 or 10 Proof:
GH ¬(1 2)2 4)
(3 2
¬9 1 or 10 Statements Reasons
JL ¬(1) 3 2 (5 9)2 1. CDE is an isosceles 1. Given
¬4 16 or 20 triangle, G is the
FH ¬(1 1)2 7)
(3 2 midpoint of CE.
¬4 16 or 20
The corresponding sides have the same measure D
2. CD
E
2. Def. of isos.
so they are congruent. JKL FGH by SSS. G
3. CG
E
3. Midpoint Th.
G
4. DDG
4. Reflexive Property
5. CDG EDG 5. SSS
Chapter 4 98
17. Given: MRN QRP, MNP QPN 3. R P 3. Third Angle Theorem
Prove: MNP QPN M Q
4. RST PNM 4. SAS
R
21. Given: H
EF F
Proof: N P H
G is the midpoint of E.
Prove: EFG HFG
Statements Reasons
H
1. MRN QRP, 1. Given
MNP QPN F G
N
2. MQ
P
2. CPCTC E
P
3. NN
P
3. Reflexive Property Proof:
4. MNP QPN 4. SAS Statements Reasons
18. Given:
ACG C A 1. H
EF F
; G is the 1. Given
C
E bisects A
G
. H
midpoint of E.
Prove: GEC AEC E C G
2. EG
H
2. Midpoint Theorem
G
3. FF
G
3. Reflexive Property
G 4. EFG HFG 4. SSS
Proof:
Statements Reasons 22. Each pair of corresponding sides is congruent. The
triangles are congruent by the SSS Postulate.
1.
ACG C, E
C
1. Given 23. The triangles have two pairs of corresponding
G
bisects A. sides congruent and one pair of angles congruent
E
2. AE
G
2. Def. of segment bisector but what is needed is the pair of included angles
to be congruent. It is not possible to prove the
C
3. EE
C
3. Reflexive Property
triangles are congruent.
4. GEC AEC 4. SSS
24. The triangles have one pair of angles congruent
and one pair of sides (the shared side) congruent. It
19. Given: GHJ LKJ H K is not possible to prove the triangles are congruent.
Prove: GHL LKG
J 25. The triangles have three pairs of corresponding
sides congruent and one pair of corresponding
G L
angles congruent. The triangles are congruent by
Proof: the SSS or SAS Postulates.
Statements Reasons 26. Given: T S
S FF H
H T S
1. GHJ LKJ TSF, SFH, FHT,
1. Given
and HTS are right P
2.
HJK
J
, G
J
L
J, 2. CPCTC angles. T F
H
G L
K S
Prove: HT
F
3. HJ KJ, GJ LJ 3. Def. of segments H
4. HJ LJ KJ JG 4. Addition Property
5. KJ GJ KG; 5. Segment Addition Proof:
HJ LJ HL Statements Reasons
6. KG HL 6. Substitution
1.
TSSF F
H
H T
1. Given
G
7. KH
L
7. Def. of segments 2. TSF, SFH, FHT, 2. Given
L
8. GGL
8. Reflexive Property and HTS are right
9. GHL LKG 9. SSS angles.
3. STH THF 3. All right are .
20. Given: P
RS N
N
4. STH THF 4. SAS
T
RM P
S
S N S
5. HT
F
5. CPCTC
M
T M T
Prove: RST PNM P
Proof: R
Statements Reasons
S
1. RP
N
, R
T
M
P
1. Given
2. S N, and 2. Given
T M
99 Chapter 4
27. Given:
TSS
FF H
H T
S 30. C; using vertical angles and exterior angles,
TSF, SFH, FHT, and a b 90. Given this fact, it is impossible for the
HTS are right angles. P
other statements to be true.
Prove: SHT SHF T F 31. B; 3x 6x 7x ¬180
16x ¬180
H x ¬11.25
3x 3(11.25) or 33.75
Proof: 6x 6(11.25) or 67.5
Statements Reasons 7x 7(11.25) or 78.75
Because the angles are all less than 90°, the
1.
TSS FF
H
H T 1. Given triangle is acute.
2. TSF, SFH, FHT, 2. Given
and HTS are right
angles.
Page 206 Maintain Your Skills
3. STH SFH 3. All rt. are . 32. ACB DCE 33. WXZ YXZ
4. STH SFH 4. SAS 34. LMP NPM 35. m2 78
5. SHT SHF 5. CPCTC 36. m3 m2 ¬180
m3 78 ¬180
E
28. Given: DFB
, A
E
FC
, A
E
D
B
, C
F
D
B
m3 ¬102
Prove: ABD CDB 37. m4 m5 ¬90
A B m5 ¬90 m4
F m4 m3 56 ¬180
m4 102 56 ¬180
m4 ¬22
E
m5 ¬90 m4
D C ¬90 22 or 68
Plan: First use SAS to show that ADE CBF. 38. m4 m3 56 ¬180
Next use CPCTC and Reflexive Property for m4 102 56 ¬180
segments to show ABD CDB. m4 ¬22
Proof:
39. m1 m2 43 ¬180
Statements Reasons m1 78 43 ¬180
m1 ¬59
E
1. DF
B
, A
E
F
C
1. Given
40. m6 m5 78 ¬180
E
2. AD
B
, C
F
D
B
2. Given m6 68 78 ¬180
3. AED is a right angle. 3. lines form m6 ¬34
0.3
1.3
CFB is a right angle. right . 41. rate of change 21
4. AED CFB 4. All right angles 1
0.3
1.1
are . 42. rate of change 32
5. ADE CBF 5. SAS 1.4
D
6. AB
C
6. CPCTC 43. There is a steeper rate of decline from the second
quarter to the third.
B
7. DD
B
7. Reflexive Property
bisects B
E
44. B , since AE C
for Segments
45. CBD, since BD bisects ABC
8. CBD ADB 8. CPCTC
46. BDA, since BDC is a right angle and forms a
9. ABD CDB 9. SAS linear pair with BDA
29. Sample answer: The properties of congruent D
47. C , since
BD bisects AC
triangles help land surveyors double check
measurements. Answers should include the
following.
• If each pair of corresponding angles and sides
4-5 Proving Congruence—ASA, AAS
are congruent, the triangles are congruent by
definition. If two pairs of corresponding sides Page 207 Construction
and the included angle are congruent, the
5. JKL ABC
triangles are congruent by SAS. If each pair of
corresponding sides are congruent, the triangles
are congruent by SSS.
• Sample answer: Architects also use congruent Page 208 Geometry Activity
triangles when designing buildings. 1. They are congruent.
2. The triangles are congruent.
Chapter 4 100
Page 210 Check for Understanding 7. Given: E K, DGH DHG, E
G
K
H
1. Two triangles can have corresponding congruent Prove: EGD KHD
angles without corresponding congruent sides. D
A D, B E, and C F. However,
B
A
D E
, so ABC
DEF.
B
E G H K
E
A C Proof: Since EGD and DGH are linear pairs,
the angles are supplementary. Likewise, KHD
D F and DHG are supplementary. We are given that
2. Sample answer: In ABC, A
B
is the included side DGH DHG. Angles supplementary to
of A and B. congruent angles are congruent so EGD
C KHD. Since we are given that E K and
G
E K H, EGD KHD by ASA.
A B 8. This cannot be determined. The information given
cannot be used with any of the triangle congruence
3. AAS can be proven using the Third Angle Theorem.
postulates, theorems or the definition of congruent
Postulates are accepted as true without proof.
triangles. By construction, two different triangles
H
4. Given: G K J, G
K
HJ G H can be shown with the given information. Therefore,
Prove: GJK JGH it cannot be determined if SRT MKL.
K J 5.5
5.5
Proof:
49
GH || KJ GK || HJ 7
Given Given
Pages 211–213 Practice and Apply
HGJ KJG KGJ HJG 9. Given: G
EF H
, F
Alt. int. are . Alt. int. are . F
EGH E
K
Prove: E KH
GJK JGH
K
ASA H
G
GJ GJ Proof:
Reflexive Property
EF || GH
W
5. Given: XY
Z
, X Z X Y Given EF GH
Prove: WXY YZW Given
E H
Alt. int. are . EKF HKG
W Z AAS
GKH EKF
Proof:
Vert. are . EK KH
XW || YZ X Z
CPCTC
Given Given
10. Given:
DEJK J
XWY ZYW WY WY K
D bisects J
E
.
Alt. int. are . Reflexive Prove: EGD JGK D
Property
G K
WXY YZW
AAS
E
Proof:
6. Given:
QS bisects RST; R DK bisects JE.
R T.
Given
Prove: QRS QTS DE || JK
Q S
Given EG GJ
Def. of seg. bisector
T E J
Proof: We are given that R T and Q S Alt. int. are . EGD JGK
bisects RST, so by definition of angle bisector, ASA
RSQ TSQ. By the Reflexive Property, DGE KGJ
S
Q Q S. QRS QTS by AAS. Vert. are .
101 Chapter 4
11. Given: V S, T
V
Q
S
Proof:
R
Prove: VS R
MN PQ
T S Given
1 2 MN PQ
R
Def. of seg.
V Q
Proof: MN NP NP PQ NP NP
Addition Prop. Reflexive Prop.
V S
TV QS 1 2
MP NQ MN NP MP
Given Vert. are .
Substitution NP PQ NQ
Seg. Addition Post.
TRV QRS
AAS MP NQ
Def. of seg.
VR SR
CPCTC
MLP QLN M Q
12. Given: F
EJ K
, J
G
K
H
J K ASA 2 3
F
EGH
Given
Prove: EJG FKH T
14. Given: Z is the midpoint of C.
Y
C T E
Z
Prove: YE Z
E F G H
E C
Proof:
EF GH
Given Z
EF GH T Y
Def. of seg. Proof:
CY || TE
EF FG FG GH FG FG Z is the
Given
Addition Prop. Reflexive Prop. midpoint of CT.
Given ETC YCT
EG FH EF FG EG
TEY CYE
Substitution FG GH FH TZ CZ
Seg. Addition Post. Alt. int. are .
Midpt. Th.
EG FH EZT YZC
EJ || FK, JG || KH
Def. of seg. AAS
Given
Chapter 4 102
17. Given: F J, F 4. P P 4. Reflexive Property
E H
H 5. IPK TPB 5. AAS
G
EC H
G
F
Prove: E HJ
E C
21. Explore: We are given the measurement of one
J side of each triangle. We need to determine
Proof: We are given that F J, E H, whether two triangles are congruent.
and ECG H
. By the Reflexive Property, Plan: CDG H, because the segments have the
G
C C G
. Segment addition results in EG same measure. CFD HFG because vertical
EC CG and CH CG GH. By the definition angles are congruent. Since F is the midpoint of
of congruence, EC GH and CG CG. Substitute G
D , D
FF G.
to find EG CH. By AAS, EFG HJC. By Solve: We are given information about side-side-
CPCTC, E F
H J
. angle (SSA). This is not a method to prove two
18. Given: S
TX Y
T X triangles congruent.
TXY TSY Examine: Use a compass, protractor, and ruler to
Prove: TSY YXT draw a triangle with the given measurements. For
simplicity of measurement, use 1 inch instead of
S Y 4 feet and 2 inches instead of 8 feet, so the
Proof: Since TX
S Y
, YTX TYS by measurements of the construction and those of
Y
Alternate Interior Angles Theorem. TTY
by the garden will be proportional.
the Reflexive Property. Given TXY TSY,
TSY YXT by AAS.
19. Given: MYT NYT M
MTY NTY
Prove: RYM RYN 1 in.
R T
Y
N 29
Proof:
2 in.
Statements Reasons
• Draw a segment 2 inches long.
1. MYT NYT, 1. Given • At one end, draw an angle of 29°. Extend the
MTY NTY line longer than 2 inches.
T
2. YY
T
, R
Y
R
Y
2. Reflexive • At the other end of the segment, draw an arc
Property with a radius of 1 inch such that it intersects
the line.
3. MYT NYT 3. ASA
Notice that there are two possible segments that
4.
MYN Y
4. CPCTC could determine the triangle. It cannot be
5. RYM and MYT are a 5. Def. of determined whether CFD HFG. The
linear pair; RYN and linear pair information given does not lead to a unique
NYT are a linear pair triangle.
22. Explore: We need to determine whether two
6. RYM and MYT are 6. Supplement
triangles are congruent.
supplementary and RYN Theorem
Plan: Since F is the midpoint of DG
, DFF G
. F
and NYT are
H
is also the midpoint of C, so C
FF H. Since
supplementary.
G
D C H, D
F
C F and FG
F H. CFD
7. RYM RYN 7. suppl. to HFG because vertical angles are congruent.
are . Solve: CFD HFG by SAS.
8. RYM RYN 8. SAS Examine: The corresponding sides and angles
used to determine the triangles are congruent by
20. Given: BMI KMT B I SAS are D FF G
, CFD HFG, and C FF H.
IP
P
T P 23. Explore: We need to determine whether two
Prove: IPK TPB M triangles are congruent.
T Plan: Since N is the midpoint of JL
, J
NN L
.
JNK LNK because perpendicular lines form
K right angles and right angles are congruent. By
Proof: N
the Reflexive Property, K K N.
Solve: JKN LKN by SAS.
Statements Reasons
Examine: The corresponding sides and angles
1. BMI KMT 1. Given used to determine the triangles are congruent by
2. B K 2. CPCTC SAS are J
N NL, JNK LNK, and K
N KN.
3. IP
P
T 3. Given
103 Chapter 4
x
24. Explore: We are given the measurements of one 32. A; x percent of 10,000 ¬100 (10,000)
side and one angle of each triangle. We need to 1 percent of x percent of 10,000
determine whether the two triangles are congruent.
M
Plan: It is given that J L M
and NJM
¬ 1 x
100
100 (10,000)
x
NLM. By the Reflexive Property, N MN M. ¬
10,000 (10,000)
Solve: We are given information about side-side- ¬x
angle (SSA). This is not a method to prove two
triangles congruent.
Examine: Use a compass, protractor, and ruler Page 213 Maintain Your Skills
to draw a triangle with the given measurements. 33. Given: D
BA E
,
For simplicity of measurement, we will use B D
A
D B
E
C
centimeters instead of feet, so the measurements Prove: BEA DAE
of the construction and those of the kite will be A E
proportional. Proof:
• Draw a segment 2.7 centimeters long.
• At one end, draw an angle of 68°. Extend the DA BE
line to exactly 2 centimeters. Given
• At the other end of the segment, draw a seg-ment
that intersects the 2 centimeter segment at any BA DE BEA DAE
place other than either of its endpoints. Given SSS
Because no information is known about the length
of the segment that determines the triangle, an AE AE
infinite number of triangles are possible. It cannot Reflexive Prop.
be determined whetherJNM LNM. The
34. Given:
XZW Y, W
information given does not lead to a unique triangle.
Z
X bisects W
Y
. Z
Prove: WZX YZX
2 cm Y
X
Proof:
68˚
J M XZ WY
2.7 cm
Given
25. VNR, AAS or ASA 26. VMN, ASA or AAS
XZ bisects WY.
27. MIN, SAS 28. RMI, AAS or ASA WZX and
Given
29. Since Aiko is perpendicular to the ground, two YZX are rt .
right angles are formed and right angles are Def. of ⊥ lines. WZ ZY
congruent. The angles of sight are the same and Def. of seg. bisector
her height is the same for each triangle. The WZX YZX
triangles are congruent by ASA. By CPCTC, the All rt. are . WZX YZX
distances are the same. The method is valid. SAS
XZ XZ
30. Sample answer: The triangular trusses support the
structure. Answers should include the following. Reflexive Prop.
• To determine whether two triangles are
35. RS ¬[1 (2)]2 (1
2)2
congruent, information is needed about
¬1 1 or 2
consecutive side-angle-side, side-side-side,
RS ¬(1) 212 [2)]
(2
angle-side-angle, angle-angle-side, or about each
¬1 1 or 2
angle and each side.
ST ¬[2
(1)]2 (1
1)2
• Triangles that are congruent will support weight
¬1 0 or 1
better because the pressure will be evenly divided.
ST ¬(2 )
11
2 [1)]
(2
31. D; mB mBAC mBCA ¬180 ¬1 0 or 1
76 mBAC mBCA ¬180 RT ¬[2 (2)]2 (1
2)2
mBAC mBCA ¬104 ¬0 1 or 1
bisects BAC, so mDAC ¬1
D
A
2 mBAC.
RT ¬(2) 212 [2)]
(2
1 ¬0 1 or 1
C
D bisects BCA, so mDCA ¬2mBCA. RT ¬(2) 212 [2)]
(2
mDAC mDCA ¬1 1 ¬0 1 or 1
2 mBAC 2 mBCA
Each pair of corresponding sides has the same
¬1
2 (mBAC mBCA)
measure, so they are congruent. Use a protractor
¬1
2 (104) or 52
to confirm that the corresponding angles are
mADC mDAC mDCA ¬180 congruent. Therefore, RST RST. RST
mADC 52 ¬180 is a turn of RST.
mADC ¬128
Chapter 4 104
36. MP ¬[1
(3)]2
(1 1)2 8. Given: ABC and XYZ are right triangles.
¬4 0 or 2 A and X are right angles.
MP ¬(0) 2 2 (1
1)2 C
BY Z
¬4 0 or 2 B Y
MN ¬[3 (3)]2
(4 1)2 Prove: ABC XYZ
¬0 9 or 3 C Z
MN ¬(2 ) 2 2 (4
1)2
¬0 9 or 3 A B X Y
NP ¬[1
(3)]2
(1 4)2 Proof: We are given that ABC and XZY are
¬4 9 or 13 right triangles with right angles A and X,
NP ¬(2) 0 2 (4
1)2 C
B Y Z
, and B Y. Since all right angles
¬4 9 or 13 are congruent, A X. Therefore,
Each pair of corresponding sides has the same ABC XYZ by AAS.
measure, so they are congruent. Use a protractor
9. Case 1:
to confirm that the corresponding angles are
Given: ABC and DEF are right triangles.
congruent. Therefore, MPN MPN.
C
AD F
MPN is a flip of MPN.
C F
37. If people are happy, then they rarely correct their Prove: ABC DEF
faults.
C F
38. If a person is a champion, then he or she is afraid
of losing.
A B D E
39. Since two sides are marked congruent, the
triangle is isosceles. Proof: It is given that ABC are DEF are right
C
triangles, A D F , C F. By the definition
40. Since three sides are marked congruent, the
of right triangles, A and D are right angles.
triangle is equilateral.
Thus, A D since all right angles are
41. Since two sides are marked congruent, the congruent. ABC DEF by ASA.
triangle is isosceles. Case 2:
Given: ABC and DEF are right triangles.
C
A D F
Pages 214–215 Geometry Activity: Congruence B E
in Right Triangles Prove: ABC DEF
1. yes; a. SAS, b. ASA, c. AAS C F
2a. LL
2b. LA A B D E
2c. HA Proof: If is given that ABC and DEF are right
3. None; two pairs of legs congruent is sufficient for C
triangles, AD F
, and B E. By the
proving right triangles congruent. definition of right triangle, A and D are right
angles. Thus, A D since all right angles are
4. yes 5. yes
congruent. ABC DEF by AAS.
6. SSA is a valid test of congruence for right
10. Given: M LM K, J
KK M, J L
triangles.
Prove: J M
K L
7. Given: DEF and RST are right triangles.
M
E and S are right angles. L
F
E S T
D
E S R J
Prove: DEF RST K
F T Proof:
Statements Reasons
D E R S
F
Proof: We are given that ES T, E
DS R, and 1.
MLMK, J
K
K
M
, 1. Given
E and S are right angles. Since all right J L
angles are congruent, E S. Therefore, by 2. LMK and JKM are 2. lines form
SAS, DEF RST. rt. rt. .
3. LMK and JKM are 3. Def. of rt.
rt. s
K
4. MM
K
4. Reflexive
Property
5. LMK JKM 5. LA
M
6. JK
L
6. CPCTC
105 Chapter 4
11. Given: K
JK M, M 7. Given: CTE is isosceles T
M
JK L
L with vertex C. 60
L
M J
K
mT 60 C
L
Prove: M JK
J Prove: CTE is equilateral.
K
Proof: E
Proof:
Statements Reasons
Statements Reasons
1. K
JK M, J
M
K L
, 1. Given 1. CTE is isosceles 1. Given
L
M J
K
with vertex C.
2. JKM is a rt. 2. lines form rt. T
2. CC
E
2. Def. of isosceles
triangle
M
3. KM
L
3. Perpendicular 3. E T 3. Isosceles Triangle
Transversal Th. Theorem
4. LMK is a rt. 4. lines form rt. 4. mE mT 4. Def. of
K
5. M MK
5. Reflexive Property 5. mT 60 5. Given
6. JMK LMK 6. HL 6. mE 60 6. Substitution
L
7. MJ
K
7. CPCTC 7. mC + mE + mT 7. Angle Sum Theorem
180
8. mC 60 60 180 8. Substitution
4-6 Isosceles Triangles 9. mC 60 9. Subtraction
10. CTE is equiangular. 10. Def. of equiangular
11. CTE is equilateral. 11. Equiangular s are
Page 216 Geometry Activity: Isosceles Triangles
equilateral.
1. A B
2. They are congruent. 8. A;
3. They are congruent. Read the Test Item
PQS is isosceles with base P S
. Likewise, QRS
S
is isosceles with base Q .
Page 219 Check for Understanding Solve the Test Item
1. The measure of only one angle must be given in Step 1 The base angles of QRS are congruent.
an isosceles triangle to determine the measures of Let x mRSQ mRQS.
the other two angles. mPRS mRSQ mRQS ¬180
X
2. W Z X
; W Z 72 x x ¬180
72 2x ¬180
3. Sample answer: Draw a line segment. Set your 2x ¬108
compass to the length of the line segment and x ¬54
draw an arc from each endpoint. Draw segments So, mRSQ mRQS 54.
from the intersection of the arcs to each endpoint. Step 2 RQS and PQS form a linear pair. Solve
4. ADH is opposite A H and AHD is opposite A D, for mPQS.
so ADH AHD. mRQS mPQS ¬180
H
5. B is opposite BDH and B D is opposite BHD, 54 mPQS ¬180
H
so BB D. mPQS ¬126
6. Each angle of an equilateral triangle measures 60°. Step 3 The base angles of PQS are congruent.
mF ¬3x 4 Let y represent mQPS and mPSQ.
60 ¬3x 4 mPQS mQPS mPSQ ¬180
56 ¬3x 126 y y ¬180
56 126 2y ¬180
3 ¬x
2y ¬54
mG ¬6y y ¬27
60 ¬6y The measure of QPS is 27. Choice A is
10 ¬y correct.
mH ¬19z 3
60 ¬19z 3
57 ¬19z Pages 219–221 Practice and Apply
3 ¬z 9. LRT is opposite L
T and LTR is opposite L
R, so
LRT LTR.
10. LXW is opposite L
W and LWX is opposite LX,
so LXW LWX.
11. LSQ is opposite Q
L and LQS is opposite S
L,
so LSQ LQS.
Chapter 4 106
12.
LX is opposite LYX and L Y
is opposite LXY, so 24. MLP is isosceles with base M
P, JMP is
X
L L Y
. P
isosceles with base J.
S
13. L is opposite LRS and L R
is opposite LSR, so Step 1 The base angles of MLP are congruent.
S
L L R. Let x represent mPML and mMPL.
Y
14. L is opposite LWY and L W
is opposite LYW, mPML mMPL mPLJ ¬180
Y
so L L W. x x 58 ¬180
15. The base angles of an isosceles triangle are 2x 58 ¬180
congruent. So LNM MLN. From the figure, 2x ¬122
mMLN 20. So mLNM 20. x ¬61
16. mLNM mMLN mM ¬180 So, mPML mMPL 61.
20 20 mM ¬180 Step 2 PML and JMP form a linear pair.
mM ¬140 Solve for mJMP.
17. The base angles of an isosceles triangle are mPML mJMP ¬180
congruent, so mLKN ¬mLNK. 61 mJMP ¬180
mLKN mLNK mKLN ¬180 mJMP ¬119
mLKN mLKN 18 ¬180 Step 3 The base angles of JMP are congruent.
2mLKN ¬162 Let y represent mPJL and mJPM.
mLKN ¬81 mJPM mPJL mJMP ¬180
18. mJKN ¬mJKL mLKN y y 119 ¬180
130 ¬mJKL 81 2y 119 ¬180
49 ¬mJKL 2y ¬61
mJKL mJLK mJ ¬180 y ¬30.5
49 25 mJ ¬180 So, mJPM mPJL 30.5.
mJ ¬106 25. GKH is isosceles with base HK
. JKH is
19. The base angles of DFG are congruent, so J
isosceles with base H .
DFG D. Step 1 The base angles of GKH are congruent.
mDFG mD Let x represent mGHK and mGKH.
28 mHGK mGHK mGKH ¬180
20. mDGF mD mDFG ¬180 28 x x ¬180
28 28 mDGF ¬180 2x ¬152
mDGF ¬124 x ¬76
21. FGH and DGF are a linear pair. So, mGHK mGKH 76.
mDGF mFGH ¬180 Step 2 GKH and HKJ form a linear pair.
124 mFGH ¬180 Solve for mHKJ.
mFGH ¬56 mGKH mHKJ ¬180
22. The base angles of FGH are congruent, so 76 mHKJ ¬180
FGH H. From Exercise 21, mFGH ¬56. mHKJ ¬104
mFGH mH mGFH ¬180 Step 3 The base angles of JKH are congruent.
56 56 mGFH ¬180 Let x represent mHJK and mJHK.
mGFH ¬68 mHJK mJHK mHKJ ¬180
23. MLP is isosceles with base M P. JMP is x x 104 ¬180
isosceles with base JP. 2x 104 ¬180
Step 1 The base angles of MLP are congruent. 2x ¬76
Let x represent mPML and mMPL. x ¬38
mPML mMPL mPLJ ¬180 So, mHJK mJHK 38.
x x 34 ¬180 26. GKH is isosceles with base HK
.
2x 34 ¬180 Step 1 The base angles of GKH are congruent.
2x ¬146 Let x represent mGHK and mGKH.
x ¬73 mHGK mGHK mGKH ¬180
So, mPML mMPL 73. 42 x x ¬180
Step 2 PML and JMP form a linear pair. 42 2x ¬180
Solve for mJMP. 2x ¬138
mPML mJMP ¬180 x ¬69
73 mJMP ¬180 So, mGHK mGKH 69.
mJMP ¬107 Step 2 GKH and HKJ form a linear pair.
Step 3 The base angles of JMP are congruent. Solve for mHKJ.
Let y represent mJ and mJPM. mGKH mHKJ ¬180
mJPM mJ mJMP ¬180 69 mHKJ ¬180
y y 107 ¬180 mHKJ ¬111
2y 107 ¬180
2y ¬73
y ¬36.5
So, mJPM mJ 36.5.
107 Chapter 4
27. LMN is equilateral, so LMM NL N. M
P
10. mLNM 10. Sum of measures of a
N
bisects L, so MP
bisects LMN. LMN is mLNP 180 linear pair of angles is
equilateral, hence equiangular. So mLMN 180
mMLP 60 and mPML 30. 11. 2mLNM 180 11. Substitution
LM ¬MN
3x 1 ¬4x 2 12. mLNM 90 12. Division
3 ¬x 13. LNM is a right 13. Definition of right
mPLM mPML mMPL ¬180 angle. angle
60 30 5y ¬180
N
14. L M
P
14. Definition of
90 5y ¬180 perpendicular
5y ¬180
y ¬18 31. Case I:
28. LM 3x 1 Given: ABC is an equilateral triangle.
3(3) 1 or 10 Prove: ABC is an equiangular triangle.
LM MN LN, so all sides have measure 10. B
29. Given: XKF is equilateral. X
J
X bisects X.
Prove: J is the midpoint A C
F
of K .
1 2 Proof:
K J F
Statements Reasons
Proof:
1. ABC is an 1. Given
Statements Reasons equilateral triangle.
1. XKF is equilateral. 1. Given B
2. AA
C
B
C
2. Def. of equilateral
X
2. KF
X
2. Definition of 3. A B, B C, 3. Isosceles Triangle
equilateral A C Theorem
3. 1 2 3. Isosceles Triangle 4. A B C 4. Substitution
Theorem 5. ABC is an 5. Def. of equiangular
J
4. X bisects X 4. Given equiangular triangle.
5. KXJ FXJ 5. Def. of bisector
Case II:
6. KXJ FXJ 6. ASA Given: ABC is an equiangular triangle.
J
7. KJ
F
7. CPCTC Prove: ABC is an equilateral triangle.
B
F
8. J is the midpoint of K. 8. Def. of midpoint
Statements Reasons
M N P
Proof: 1. ABC is an 1. Given
equiangular triangle.
Statements Reasons
2. A B C 2. Def. of equiangular
1. MLP is isosceles. 1. Given
3.
ABA
C
, A
B
B
C
, 3. Conv. of Isos. Th.
L
2. ML
P 2. Definition of isosceles C
A B
C
3. M P 3. Isosceles Triangle B
4. AA
C
B
C
4. Substitution
Theorem 5. ABC is an 5. Def. of equilateral
4. N is the midpoint 4. Given equilateral triangle.
P
of M .
N
5. MNP
5. Midpoint Theorem
6. MNL PNL 6. SAS
7. LNM LNP 7. CPCTC
8. mLNM 8. Congruent angles have
mLNP equal measures.
9. LNM and LNP 9. Definition of linear pair
are a linear pair
Chapter 4 108
32. Given: MNO is an O 36. The triangle is isosceles with base angles having
equilateral triangle. measure 3x 8.
Prove: mM mN mO 60 (3x 8) (3x 8) (2x 20) ¬180
8x 36 ¬180
M N
8x ¬144
Proof: x ¬18
Statements Reasons 37. The triangle on the bottom half of the figure is
isosceles. The base angles are congruent.
1. MNO is an 1. Given 2x 25 ¬x 5
equilateral triangle. x 25 ¬5
N
2. MM
O
N
O
2. Def. of equilateral x ¬30
38. There are two sets of 12 isosceles triangles. One
3. M N O 3. Isosceles Thm.
black set forms a circle with their bases on the
4. mM mN mO 4. Def. of outside of the circle. Another black set encircles a
5. mM mN 5. Angle Sum Theorem circle in the middle.
mO 180
6. 3mM 180 6. Substitution
7. mM 60 7. Division Property
39. The triangles in each set appear to be acute.
8. mM mN 8. Substitution
40. DCE is equilateral, hence equiangular so
mO 60 mCDE mDEC mDCE 60. Then we
know, mACB mDCE so mACB 60 and
33. Given: ABC B mFCG mDCE so mFCG 60. This means
A C
that in isosceles ABC, BAC and ABC are the
B
Prove: AC B
congruent base angles, so mABC mBAC 42.
A D C Also, in isosceles FCG, CFG and FGC are the
congruent base angles, so mCFG mFGC 77.
Proof: mACB mABC mBAC ¬180
mACB 42 42 ¬180
Statements Reasons mACB ¬96
mFCG mCFG mFGC ¬180
1. Let
BD bisect ABC. 1. Protractor Postulate mFCG 77 77 ¬180
2. ABD CBD 2. Def. of bisector mFCG ¬26
So m3 26
3. A C 3. Given
mCFD mCFG ¬180
D
4. BB
D
4. Reflexive Property mCFD 77 ¬180
5. ABD CBD 5. AAS mCFD ¬103
mCGF mCGE ¬180
B
6. AC
B
6. CPCTC 77 mCGE ¬180
mCGE ¬103
34. The minimum requirement is that two angles m2 mCDF mCFD ¬180
measure 60°. m2 60 103 ¬180
35. The front face of the figure has two congruent m2 ¬17
angles and one angle of measure 60. Let y represent m4 mCEG mCGE ¬180
the measure of each of the congruent angles. m4 60 103 ¬180
y y 60 ¬180 m4 ¬17
2y 60 ¬180 CDA CEB by AAS Postulate
2y ¬120 So 1 5
y ¬60 2m1 2(17) 26 ¬mACB
Therefore all angles have measure 60, so the 2m1 60 ¬96
triangle is equiangular and equilateral. All sides 2m1 ¬36
have length 2x 5, in particular the edge m1 ¬18
between the front face and the side face showing. So, m1 18, m2 17, m3 26, m4 17,
Because the side face has two congruent base and m5 18.
angles it is isosceles and the sides opposite the
41. Sample answer: Artists use angles, lines, and
congruent angles are congruent.
shapes to create visual images. Answers should
2x 5 ¬3x 13
include the following.
2x 18 ¬3x
• Rectangle, squares, rhombi, and other polygons
18 ¬x
are used in many works of art.
• There are two rows of isosceles triangles in the
painting. One row has three congruent isosceles
triangles. The other row has six congruent
isosceles triangles.
109 Chapter 4
42. A; mZXY mPYZ ¬90 47. QR ¬(5) 1 2 [1)]
(52
mZXY 26 ¬90 ¬166 3 or 52
mZXY ¬64 EG ¬[1
(4)]2 [2)]
(32
PYZ is isosceles since YP YZ, so mYPZ ¬9 25 or 34
mYZP. RS ¬(4) 5 2 (0 1)2
mYPZ mYZP mPYZ ¬180 ¬1 1 or 2
2(mYPZ) 26 ¬180 GH ¬[21)]
( 2 (1 2)2
2(mYPZ) ¬154 ¬9 1 or 10
mYPZ ¬77 QS ¬(4) 1 2 [0)]
(52
mXPZ mYPZ ¬180 ¬9 25 or 34
mXPZ 77 ¬180 EH ¬[24)]
( 2 [1 (3)]2
mXPZ ¬103 ¬366 1 or 52
mXZP mXPZ mPXZ ¬180 The corresponding sides are not congruent so
mXZP 103 64 ¬180 QRS is not congruent to EGH.
mXZP ¬13 48. a b a and b
x1 x2 y1 y2
43. D; 2 2 3 9 5 13
, 2, 2 T T T
2 , 2 or (6, 9)
12
1
8 T F F
F T F
Page 221 Maintain Your Skills F F F
44. Given: N D, G N
G I, S 49. p q p q p or q
A
NSD A
Prove: ANG SDI D I T T F F F
T F F T T
Proof: We are given N D and G I. By
the Third Angle Theorem, A S. We are also F T T F T
N
given AS D. ANG SDI by ASA. F F T T T
45. Given:
VRR
S, V R
T
U S
U,
S
R U
S
S 50. k m m k and m
Prove: VRS TUS T T F F
U T
T F T T
Proof: We are given that VRR S
, U
T
S U
and F T F F
S
RU S . Perpendicular lines form four right F F T F
angles so R and U are right angles. R U
because all right angles are congruent. RSV
51. y y or z
UST since vertical angles are congruent. y z
Therefore, VRS TUS by ASA. T T F T
46. QR ¬[13)]
( 2 (2 1)2 T F F F
¬16
1 or 17
EG ¬(2) 632 [2)]
(2 F T T T
¬16
1 or 17 F F T T
RS ¬(1
1)2 (2 2)2
¬4 16 or 20 x1 x2 y1 y2
GH ¬(4) 2 2 [1)]
(32 52. 2 2
2 7 15 9
, 2, 2
¬4 16 or 20 (4.5, 12)
QS ¬[1
(3)]22
( 1)2 x1 x2 y1 y2
¬4 9 or 13 53. 2 2
4 2 6 (12)
, 2, 2
EH ¬(4) 6 2 [1)]
(22 (1, 3)
¬4 9 or 13 x1 x2 y1 y2
Each pair of corresponding sides has the same 54. , 2, 2
2 2
3 7.5 2.5 4
measure so they are congruent. QRS EGH (5.25, 3.25)
by SSS.
Chapter 4 110
Page 221 Practice Quiz 2 2. Sample answer:
1. JM ¬[2
(4)]2
(6
5)2 y
¬4 1 or 5 C(0, b)
BD ¬[4
(3)]22
[4)]
(2
¬1 4 or 5
ML ¬[1
(2)]2 (1
6)2
A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x
¬1 25 or 26
DG ¬[14)]
( 2 [1)]
(22 3. • Use the origin as vertex F of the triangle.
¬25
1 or 26 • Place the base of the triangle along the positive
JL ¬[1
(4)]2 (1
5)2 x-axis.
¬9 16 or 5 • Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
BG ¬[13)]
( 2 [1)]
(42 • Since H is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
¬16
9 or 5 x-coordinate is 2b because the base of the
Each pair of corresponding sides has the same triangle is 2b units long.
measure so they are congruent. JML BDG • Since FGH is isosceles, the x-coordinate of G
by SSS. is halfway between 0 and 2b or b. We cannot
2. Given: A H, AEJ HJE determine the y-coordinate in terms of b, so call
Prove: AJ
E H it c.
y G(b, c)
A E
J H
Proof: F(0, 0) H(2b, 0) x
Statements Reasons 4. • Use the origin as vertex C of the triangle.
• Place side CD
of the triangle along the positive
1. A H, AEJ HJE 1. Given x-axis.
J
2. EE
J
2. Reflexive • Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
Property • Since D is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
3. AEJ HJE 3. AAS x-coordinate is a because each side of the
triangle is a units long.
J
4. AE
H
4. CPCTC • Since CDE is equilateral, the x-coordinate of E
is halfway between 0 and a, or a 2. We cannot
X
3. From the figure, W X Y
so the angles opposite
determine the y-coordinate in terms of a, so call
these sides are congruent. That is, mXWY it b.
mXYW. a
y
mXYW mXYZ ¬180 E 2 ,b
mXYW 128 ¬180
mXYW ¬52
So, mXWY 52.
4. From Question 3, mXWY 52.
C(0, 0) D (a, 0) x
mWXY mXWY mXYW ¬180
mWXY 52 52 ¬180 5. Vertex P is on the y-axis, so its x-coordinate is 0.
mWXY ¬76 R is a right angle and R Q
has length a, but
5. XYZ is isosceles with YZX YXZ. there is no other information given to determine
mYZX mYXZ mXYZ ¬180 the y-coordinate of P, so let the y-coordinate be b.
2(mYZX) 128 ¬180 So, the coordinates of P are (0, b).
2(mYZX) ¬52 6. Vertex Q is on the x-axis, so its y-coordinate is 0.
mYZX ¬26 PQN is equilateral and the y-axis bisects side
N
Q . The x-coordinate of N is 2a, so the
x-coordinate of Q is 2a. So, the coordinates of Q
are (2a, 0).
4-7 Triangles and Coordinate Proof 7. Vertex N is on the y-axis and no information is
given to determine its y-coordinate, so the
coordinates of N are (0, b) for some b. Vertex Q is
Page 224 Check for Understanding on the x-axis, so its y-coordinate is 0. NRQ is
1. Place one vertex at the origin, place one side of Q
isosceles and the y-axis bisects its base R . The
the triangle on the positive x-axis. Label the x-coordinate of R is a, so the x-coordinate of Q is
coordinates with expressions that will simplify a. So, the coordinates of Q are (a, 0).
the computations.
111 Chapter 4
8. Given: ABC is a right y • Since MNP is equilateral, the x-coordinate of
triangle with B(0, 2b) P is halfway between 0 and 2a, or a. We cannot
hypotenuse BC. determine the y-coordinate in terms of a, so call
M
M is the midpoint it b.
of B C. y
P (a, b)
Prove: M is equidistant A(0, 0) C(2c, 0) x
from the vertices.
C
Proof: The coordinates of M, the midpoint of B ,
will be 22
c
, 22b
(c, b).
M (0, 0) N (2a, 0) x
The distance from M to each of the vertices can be
found using the Distance Formula. 12. • Use the origin as vertex L of the triangle.
MB (c ) 02 (b
2b)2 c2 b2 M
• Place leg L of the triangle along the positive
MC (c c)
2b2 ( 0)2 c
2 b2 x-axis.
MA (c ) 02 (b
0)2 c2 b2 • Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
Thus, MB MC MA, and M is equidistant from • Since M is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
the vertices. x-coordinate is c because each leg is c units
long.
9. Given: ABC y
B(2, 8) • Since J is on the y-axis, its x-coordinate is 0. Its
Prove: ABC is isosceles.
y-coordinate is c because each leg is c units long.
y
J(0, c)
L(0, 0) M (c, 0) x
A(0, 0) C (4, 0) x
13. • Use the origin as vertex W of the triangle.
Proof: Use the Distance Formula to find AB • Place side W Z of the triangle along the positive
and BC. x-axis.
AB (2
) 02 (8
0)2 4 64 or 68 • Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
BC (4) 22 (0
8)2 4 64 or 68 • Since Z is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
Since AB BC, AB
B C
. Since the legs are
x-coordinate is b2 because each side of the
congruent, ABC is isosceles.
triangle is 1
b units long.
2
• Since WXZ is equilateral, the x-coordinate of X
Pages 224–226 Practice and Apply is halfway between 0 and b b
2, or 4. We cannot
10. • Use the origin as vertex Q of the triangle. determine the y-coordinate in terms of b, so call
• Place the base of the triangle along the positive it c.
y
x-axis. X(1–4b,c)
• Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
• Since R is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
x-coordinate is b because the base Q R is b units
long.
• Since QRT is isosceles, the x-coordinate of T is W(0, 0) Z (1–2b, 0) x
halfway between 0 and b or b 2. We cannot 14. • Use the origin as vertex P of the triangle.
determine the y-coordinate in terms of b, so call • Place side PW
of the triangle along the positive
it c. x-axis.
y T (b–2, c) • Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
• Since W is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
x-coordinate is a b because the base is a b
units long.
• Since PWY is isosceles, the x-coordinate of Y is
a b
Q (0, 0) R(b, 0) x halfway between 0 and a b or 2 . We
cannot determine the y-coordinate in terms of a
11. • Use the origin as vertex M of the triangle. and b, so call it c.
• Place side MN
of the triangle along the positive y
x-axis. Y (a 2 b , c)
• Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
• Since N is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
x-coordinate is 2a because each side of the
triangle is 2a units long.
P(0, 0) W(a b, 0) x
Chapter 4 112
15. • Use the origin as vertex Y of the triangle. 24. Since NPQ is right isosceles, N Q P Q
and
Z
• Place leg Y of the triangle along the positive Q
N P Q
. Then Q and P have the same
x-axis. x-coordinate, so the x-coordinate of Q is a. Q is on
• Position the triangle in the first quadrant. the x-axis, so the coordinates of Q are (a, 0).
• Since X is on the y-axis, its x-coordinate is 0. Its 25. Given: isosceles ABC y
y-coordinate is b because X Y
is b units long. C(2a, 2b)
with ACB C
• Since Z is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its R and S are
x-coordinate is 2b because XY b and ZY R S
midpoints of
2(XY) or 2b. legs AC
and BC.
y Prove: ASB R A(0, 0) B(4a, 0) x
X(0, b) Proof: The coordinates of R are
2a 0 2b 0
2, 2 or (a, b).
Y (0, 0) Z(2b, 0) x
The coordinates of S are 2a
2
, 2b 2
4a 0
or (3a, b).
16. Since PQR is equilateral, the x-coordinate of R BR ¬(4a a)2 )
(0 b2
is halfway between 0 and 2a, or a. So, the ¬(3a)
2 (b)2 or 9a 2 b2
coordinates of R are (a, b). AS ¬(3a 0)2 )
(b 02
17. Since LPQ is right isosceles, L P
P Q and ¬(3a)
2 (b)2 or 9a
2 b2
P
L P Q
. Then Q and P have the same Since BR AS, A SB R.
x-coordinate, so the x-coordinate of P is a. P is on 26. Given: isosceles ABC y C(a, b)
the x-axis, so its y-coordinate is 0. The distance with BCA C
from L to P is a units. The distance from P to Q R, S, and T are
must be the same. So, the coordinates of Q are R S
midpoints of their
(a, a) and the coordinates of P are (a, 0). respective sides.
18. JKN is isosceles, so J KJ N. The distance from Prove: RST is isosceles. A(0, 0) T B(2a, 0) x
J to K is 2a units. The distance from J to N must
be the same. N is on the y-axis, so the coordinates Proof:
of N are (0, 2a). Midpoint R is
a
0 b0 a b
2 , 2 or 2, 2 .
19. CDF is equilateral, so the x-coordinate of F is
halfway between 0 and the x-coordinate of D. So Midpoint S is 2, 2 or
a 2a b 0
2 , 2 .
3a
b
the x-coordinate of D is 2b. D is on the x-axis, so Midpoint T is 2a
2, 2 or (a, 0).
0 00
the coordinates of D are (2b, 0).
RT ¬ a2 a 2 0
2 2
20. BCE is isosceles and the y-axis intersects side b
C
B at its midpoint. The distance from the origin
¬ a2 2
2 b 2
to C is the same as the distance from the origin to
B. B is on the x-axis to the left of 0, so the
¬ a2 b2
2 2
coordinates of B are (a, 0). E is on the y-axis,
and we cannot determine the y-coordinate in
ST ¬ 32a a b2
0
2 2
terms of a, so call it b. The coordinates of E
are (0, b).
¬ a2 b2
2 2
21. MNP is isosceles and the y-axis intersects side
N
M at its midpoint. The distance from the origin
to M is the same as the distance from the origin RT ST and RTS T and RST is isosceles.
to N. N is on the x-axis, so the coordinates of N 27. Given: ABC y
C(b, c)
are (2b, 0). P is on the y-axis, and we cannot S is the midpoint of
A
C.
determine the y-coordinate in terms of b, so call it T is the midpoint of
BC.
c. The coordinates of P are (0, c). Prove: ST
AB
S T
22. JHG is isosceles and the y-axis intersects side
JH at its midpoint. The distance from the origin A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x
to J is the same as the distance from the origin to
Proof:
H. H is on the x-axis, so the coordinates of H are
(b, 0). G is on the y-axis, and we cannot determine
the y-coordinate in terms of b, so call it c. The
b
Midpoint S is 0 c0
b c
2 , 2 or 2, 2 .
coordinates of G are (0, c). Midpoint T is 2 , 2 or
a
0
b c
2 , 2 .
a
b c
113 Chapter 4
28. Given: ABC y 32. Given: JCT
C(b, c)
S is the midpoint of AC. Prove: JCT is a right triangle.
T is the midpoint of
BC. y T(300, 500)
S T
Prove: ST 1
AB
2
J
A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x (–500, 300)
b
Midpoint S is c
0
2 , 2
0
or b
c
2, 2 .
x
C(0, 0)
Midpoint T is 2, 2 or
a b 0 c
2 , 2 .
a b c
300 0 3
C
500 0 or 5 .
Proof: ST ¬ 2 2 2
Proof: The slope of J
c c
2 2
a b
b 2 0
500
C
The slope of T 5
300 0 or 3 .
a2
2
¬ 0 2 The slope of TC is the opposite reciprocal of the
C
slope of J . T
JC C, so TCJ is a right angle.
¬ 2 or 2
2
a a JCT is a right triangle.
AB ¬(a ) 02 (0
0)2 33. Use the Distance Formula to find the distance
¬a 2 02
or a between J(500, 300) and T(300, 500).
JT ¬[300
0)]
(50 2
(500 )3002
ST ¬1
2 AB ¬680,0
00
29. Given: ABD, FBD y
¬824.6
AF 6, BD 3 B(3, 4) The distance between Tami and Juan is 680,0 00
Prove: ABD FBD
or approximately 824.6 feet.
A(0, 1) 34. X is at the origin, so place Y(a, b) in the first
F(6, 1) quadrant. Draw a perpendicular segment from Y
D(3, 1)
O x to the x-axis, label the intersection point Z. Z has
the same x-coordinate as Y, or a. Z is on the
Proof: ¬B
BD D by the Reflexive Property. x-axis, so the coordinates of Z are (a, 0).
AD ¬(3 ) 0 2 (1
1)2 9 0 or 3 y
DF ¬(6 ) 3 2 (1
1)2 9 0 or 3
Since AD DF, A DD F .
AB (3) 02 (4 1)2 9 9 or 32 Y (a, b)
BF (6) 32 (1 4)2 9 9 or 32
Since AB BF, A BB F .
ABD FBD by SSS.
30. Given: BPR y B(800, 800)
PR 800, O X (0, 0) Z (a, 0) x
BR 800
35. X is at the origin, so place Y(a, b) in the first
Prove: BPR is
A(1600, 0) quadrant. XYZ is isosceles, so place Z on the
an isosceles
x-axis so that the x-coordinate of Y is halfway
right triangle. P(0, 0) R(800, 0) x
between 0 and the x-coordinate of Z. So, the
coordinates of Z are (2a, 0).
Proof: Since PR and BR have the same measure,
y
R
PB R
.
0 0
The slope of PR
800 0 or 0.
800 0
The slope of BR
800 800 , which is undefined.
PR BR, so PRB is a right angle. BPR is an Y (a, b)
isosceles right triangle.
31. Given: BPR, y B(800, 800)
BAR x
PR 800, O X (0, 0) Z (2a, 0)
BR 800,
RA 800 A(1600, 0)
Prove: PB BA P(0, 0) R(800, 0) x
Proof:
PB (800
0)2
(800 0)2 or 1,280
,000
BA (800
1600)00
2 (8) 02 or 1,280
,000
PB BA, so P
BB A.
Chapter 4 114
36. Sample answer: X is at the origin, so place Y(a, b) 42. Given: isosceles triangle K M
in the first quadrant. XYZ is scalene, so place Z JKN with vertex 2
4
on the x-axis so that the x-coordinate c is such that N, JK
L M
N
XZ YZ XY. So, the coordinates of Z are (c, 0). Prove: NML is isosceles 3
1
y J L
Proof:
115 Chapter 4
46. h j; Sample answer: The angle in the figure whose 19. MN ¬(7) 3 2 (4 2)2
measure is 111 is congruent to the angle on the ¬16 4 or 20
other side of line h such that the angles are vertical QR ¬[4
(2)]2 (7 3)2
angles. Then 111 69 180, so h j because ¬4 16 or 20
consecutive interior angles are supplementary. NP ¬(6) 7 2 (6 4)2
47. l m; 2 lines to the same line are parallel ¬1 4 or 5
RS ¬[6
(4)]2 (6 7)2
¬4 1 or 5
MP ¬(6) 3 2 (6 2)2
Chapter 4 Study Guide and Review ¬9 16 or 5
QS ¬[6
(2)]2 (6 3)2
Page 227 Vocabulary and Concept Check ¬16 9 or 5
1. h 2. g 3. d Each pair of corresponding sides has the same
4. j 5. a 6. c measure. Therefore, MNP QRS by SSS.
7. b 8. f 20. Given:
DF bisects D
CDE, C ED F.
Prove: DGC DGE
Chapter 4 116
23. PQU is isosceles with base P U. PRT is 27. • Use the origin as vertex B of the triangle.
isosceles with base PT
. D
• Place side B along the positive x-axis.
Step 1 The base angles of PQU are congruent. • Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
Let x represent mP and mQUP. • Since D is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
mP mQUP mPQU ¬180 x-coordinate is 6m because each side length is
x x 40 ¬180 6m units long.
2x ¬140 • Since BCD is equilateral, the x-coordinate of C
x ¬70 is halfway between 0 and 6m, or 3m. We cannot
So, mP mQUP 70. determine the y-coordinate in terms of m, so call
Step 2 The base angles of PRT are congruent. it n.
By Step 1 we know mP 70, so mT y
C(3m, n)
70. Let y represent mR.
mP mT mR ¬180
70 70 y ¬180
y ¬40
So, mR 40. B(0, 0) D(6m, 0) x
24. RQS is isosceles with base Q S. The base angles
28. • Use the origin as vertex K of the triangle, the
of RQS are congruent, so RQS RSQ. We
right angle.
are given mRQS 75, so mRSQ 75. Let y
L
• Place leg K along the positive x-axis.
represent mR.
K
• Place leg J along the positive y-axis.
mRQS mRSQ mR ¬180
• Since L is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
75 75 y ¬180
x-coordinate is a because one of the leg lengths
y ¬30
is a units.
So, mR 30.
• Since J is on the y-axis, its x-coordinate is 0. Its
25. RQS is isosceles with base Q S. RPT is y-coordinate is b because the other leg length is
isosceles with base PT
. b units.
Step 1 The base angles of RQS are congruent, y
and mRQS 80 so mRSQ 80. Let x J(0, b)
represent mR.
mRQS mRSQ mR ¬180
80 80 x ¬180
x ¬20 K(0, 0) x
L(a, 0)
So, mR 20.
Step 2 The base angles of RPT are congruent.
Let y represent mP and mT.
mP mT mR ¬180 Chapter 4 Practice Test
y y 20 ¬180
2y ¬160
y ¬80
Page 231
So, mP mT 80. 1. b 2. a 3. c
26. • Use the origin as vertex T of the triangle. 4. PCD is obtuse because PCD has measure
• Place the base of the triangle along the positive greater than 90.
x-axis. 5. PAC is isosceles because P
APC
.
• Position the triangle in the first quadrant. 6. PBA, PBC, and PBD are right triangles
• Since I is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its because PBA D
, so PBA and PBD are right
x-coordinate is 4a because the base of the angles.
triangle is 4a units long. 7. m1 100 ¬180
• Since TRI is isosceles, the x-coordinate of R is m1 ¬80
halfway between 0 and 4a, or 2a. We cannot 8. m2 75 ¬180
determine the y-coordinate in terms of a, so call m2 ¬105
it b.
9. m3 m1 ¬m2
y R(2a, b) m3 80 ¬105
m3 ¬25
10. D P, E Q, F R, D EP Q
,
F
E Q R, D
FP R
T(0, 0) I(4a, 0) x 11. F H, M N, G J, F M
H N
,
G
M N J, F
G
H J
12. X Z, Y Y, Z X, X YZ
Y,
Z
Y YX, and X
Z
Z X
117 Chapter 4
13. JK ¬[2 1)]
( 2 [3)]
(22 17. Given: ABE, BCE A B C
¬9 1 or 10
AB 22, AC 44,
MN ¬[2 (6)]2 [1)]
(72 AE 36, CD 36
¬164 6 or 80 A and C are
KL ¬(3 ) 22 [1)]
(32 right angles.
¬1 16 or 17 Prove: ABE CBD
NP ¬[5 2)]
( 2 (3
1)2 E D
¬49 4 or 53
JL ¬[3 1)]
( 2 [1
(2)]2 Proof: We are given that AB 22 and AC 44.
¬16 9 or 5 By the Segment Addition Postulate,
MP ¬[5 6)]
( 2 [3
(7)]2 AB BC ¬AC
¬121
100 or 221
22 BC ¬44 Substitution
Corresponding sides are not congruent, so JKL BC ¬22 Subtract 22 from each side.
is not congruent to MNP. Since AB BC, then by the definition of
14. Given: JKM JNM congruent segments, A BB C.
K
Prove: JKL JNL We are given that AE 36 and CD 36. Then
also by the definition of congruent segments,
E
A C D
.
J L We are additionally given that both A and C
M
are right angles. Since all right angles are
congruent, A C.
N B
Since A B C, A C, and A E
C D, then by
Proof: SAS, ABE CBD.
JKM JNM 18. C; JGH is isosceles with base J H
.
Given Step 1 FGH is a right triangle, so the sum of
the measures of the two acute angles
JK JN is 90.
KJL NJL mF mH ¬90
CPCTC 28 mH ¬90
mH ¬62
JKL JNL JL JL Step 2 The base angles of JGH are congruent,
SAS Reflexive Prop. so H HJG. Then mHJG mH
62. Let x represent mJGH.
15. FJH is isosceles with base J H
. The base angles mH mHJG mJGH ¬180
are congruent, so mJ mFHJ. Let x represent 62 62 x ¬180
mJ and mFHJ. x ¬56
mJ mFHJ mJFH ¬180 So, mJGH 56.
x x 34 ¬180
2x ¬146
x ¬73
So, mJ mFHJ 73. Chapter 4 Standardized Test Practice
16. JFH is isosceles with base J H
. FGH is
H
isosceles with base F . Pages 232–233
Step 1 The base angles of FGH are congruent. 1. B; find when the populations will be equal. Let x
Let x represent mGFH and mGHF. represent the number of years after 2002.
mGFH mGHF mG ¬180 2010 150x ¬1040 340x
x x 32 ¬180 2010 ¬1040 190x
2x ¬148 970 ¬190x
x ¬74 5.1 ¬x
So, mGFH mGHF 74. The populations will be equal about 5 years after
Step 2 GHF FHJ GHJ by the Angle 2002, or 2007.
Addition Postulate. Since the population of Shelbyville is growing at a
mGHF mFHJ ¬mGHJ faster rate than the population of Capitol City, the
74 mFHJ ¬152 following year, 2008, the population of Shelbyville
mFHJ¬78 will be greater than the population of Capitol
Step 3 The base angles of JFH are congruent, City.
so J FHJ. Then mJ mFHJ 2. C; grams measure mass, feet and meters measure
78. Let y represent mJFH. length, and liters measure volumes of liquid.
mJ mFHJ mJFH ¬180
78 78 y ¬180
y ¬24
So, mJFH 24.
Chapter 4 118
3. B; let x represent the length of the shadow. Use 12. The angle adjacent to the 105° angle has measure
the Pythagorean Theorem to solve for x to the 180 105 or 75. The tower is an isosceles
nearest foot. triangle, so its base angles are congruent. Let x
122 ¬92 x2 represent the measure of the angle at the top of
144 ¬81 x2 the tower.
63 ¬x2 x 75 75 180
8 ¬x x 30
The shadow is about 8 feet long. The measure of the angle at the top of the tower
4. D is 30.
5. D; the slope of the line in Kris’s graph can be 13. BCA EFD since all right angles are
found using points (0, 3) and (4, 11). congruent. ACD F
since the planes are
(y2 y1) 11 3 equidistant from the ground. CAB FDE
4 0 or 2
(x2 x1) since the planes descend at the same angle. So,
The slope of the line in Mitzi’s graph is the same ABC DEF by ASA.
as the slope of the line in Kris’s graph, or 2. So 14. Let x represent mA. A B
B C so A C and
the line in Mitzi’s graph has equation y 2x b, mC mA x. Also, mB 3(mA) or 3x.
or 2x y b. The only answer of this form is x x 3x ¬180
2x y 1, so b 1 or b 1. 5x ¬180
6. B; mEFG ¬mFDE mFED x ¬36
9x 7 ¬5x 5x mC x
9x 7 ¬10x 36
7 ¬x 15a. The railroad ties that run across train tracks are
mEFG 9(7) 7 parallel. So, x 90 because the angle whose
70 measure is x is supplementary to an angle that
7. C; ABD CBD, so CBD is a flip of ABD corresponds to the angle whose measure is
over the x-axis. Corresponding points have the known to be 90.
same x-coordinate and opposite y-coordinates. 15b. Perpendicular lines, because the ties are
8. A; if we know BCC E
then ACB DCE by parallel and the tracks are parallel so all angles
SAS. are 90° angles.
9. 3s2(2s3 7) 6s5 21s2 15c. They are congruent. Sample answers: Both are
10. Brian’s second statement was the converse of his right angles; they are supplementary angles;
original statement. they are corresponding angles.
11. Explore: Creston (C) and Dixville (D) are 16a. Sample answer:
endpoints of the base of an isosceles triangle A
formed by Creston, Dixville, and Milford. We are 5x
looking for the coordinates (x, 1) to satisfy these
conditions.
y
(4x 1) (3x 13)
M(1, 3) B C
16b. From the Angle Sum Theorem, we know that
x mA mB mC 180. Substituting the
given measures, 5x 4x 1 3x 13 180.
Solve for x to find that x 14. Substitute 14 for x
C(1, 1) D(x, 1) to find the measures: 5x 5(14) or 70, 4x 1
4(14) 1 or 55, and 3x 13 3(14) 13 or 55.
16c. If two angles of a triangle are congruent, then
Solve: The x-coordinate of the vertex angle is the sides opposite those angles are congruent
halfway between the x-coordinates of C and D. (Converse of the Isosceles Triangle Theorem).
(1 x) Since two sides of this triangle are congruent, it
So, 1 ¬ 2 is an isosceles triangle (Definition of Isosceles
2 ¬1 x
Triangle).
3 ¬x
Examine: C and D are the base vertices of the
isosceles triangle formed by C, D, and M.
119 Chapter 4
Chapter 5 Relationships in Triangles
Page 235 Getting Started 3.
B
x1 x2 y1 y2
1. 2 2
12 4 5 15
, ¬ 2, 2 O M
¬(4, 5)
x y y
2.
1
x
2
,
1
2
2
2 2
22 10 25 10
¬ 2, A N C
¬(6, 7.5)
x1 x2 y1 y2
3. , ¬ 2, 2
2 2
19 (20) 7 (3)
4. They intersect at the same point.
5.
¬(0.5, 5)
B F
4. m1 104 ¬180 E
m1 ¬76 H
5. m2 36 ¬104
m2 ¬68 A C
D
6. m3 104 ¬180
m3 ¬76 6. They intersect at the same point.
7. m4 40 7.
B
8. m5 m4 ¬104
m5 40 ¬104 N L
m5 ¬64
M
9. m5 m6 ¬90 C
64 m6 ¬90 A
m6 ¬26
8. They intersect at the same point.
10. m7 40 ¬180
9. See students’ work.
m7 ¬140
10. Acute: all intersect inside the triangle; obtuse:
11. m8 m6 ¬m4
perpendicular bisectors and altitudes intersect
m8 26 ¬40
outside the triangle; medians and angle bisectors
m8 ¬14
intersect inside the triangle; right: perpendicular
12. Let p and q represent the parts of the statement. bisectors intersect on the hypotenuse, medians
p: the three sides of one triangle are congruent to intersect inside the triangle, altitudes intersect on
the three sides of a second triangle the vertex of the right angle, and angle bisectors
q: the triangles are congruent intersect inside the triangle.
Statement (1): p → q
11. For an isosceles triangle, the perpendicular
Statement (2): q
bisector and median of the side opposite the
No conclusion can be reached because the truth of
vertex are the same as the altitude from the
p is unknown.
vertex angle and the angle bisector of the vertex
13. Let p and q represent the parts of the statement. angle. In an equilateral triangle, the
p: a polygon is a triangle perpendicular bisector and median of each side is
q: the sum of the measures of the angles is 180 the same as the altitude to each side and the
Statement (1): p → q angle bisector of the angle opposite each side.
Statement (2): p
Since the given statements are true, use the Law
of Detachment to conclude that the sum of the
measures of the angles of polygon JKL is 180. 5-1 Bisectors, Medians, and
Altitudes
Pages 236–237 Geometry Activity: Bisectors,
Medians, and Altitudes Page 242 Check for Understanding
1. B 1. Sample answer: Both pass through the midpoint
R T of a side. A perpendicular bisector is
P D perpendicular to the side of a triangle, and does
N not necessarily pass through the vertex opposite
S U the side, while a median does pass through the
A M C vertex and is not necessarily perpendicular to the
Q side.
Chapter 5 120
2. Sample answer: 5. Given:
XYX
Z
M
Y and Z
N
are medians.
M
Prove: Y ZN
X
M N
Z Y
3. Sample answer: An altitude and angle bisector of Proof:
a triangle are the same segment in an equilateral Statements Reasons
triangle. 1.
XYXZ
, Y
M
and Z
N
1. Given
4. Find an equation of the perpendicular bisector are medians.
B
of A.
Z
2. M is the midpoint of X . 2. Def. of median
y Y
N is the midpoint of X.
A (3, 3)
B (3, 2) 3. XY XZ 3. Def. of
M
4. XM
Z
, X
N
N
Y
4. Midpoint
Theorem
x 5. XM MZ, XN NY 5. Def. of
6. XM MZ XZ, 6. Segment
XN NY XY Addition
C (1, 4) Postulate
1
is 6, so the slope of the
B
The slope of A 7. XM MZ XN NY 7. Substitution
B
perpendicular bisector is 6. The midpoint of A 8. MZ MZ NY NY 8. Substitution
is 0, 5
2 . 9. 2MZ 2NY 9. Addition
y y1 ¬m(x x1) Property
10. MZ NY 10. Division
y 5
2 ¬6(x 0)
Property
y 5
2 ¬6x
Z
11. MN
Y
11. Def. of
y ¬6x 5
2 12. XZY XYZ 12. Isosceles
Find an equation of the perpendicular bisector of Triangle
C
B . The slope of BC
is 3, so the slope of the Theorem
perpendicular bisector of B C is 1
3 . The midpoint Z
13. YY
Z
13. Reflexive
C
of B is (2, 1). Property
y y1 ¬m(x x1) 14. MYZ NZY 14. SAS
y (1) ¬1
3 (x 2)
M
15. YZ
N 15. CPCTC
y 1 ¬1
3x 3
2 6. Find x.
1 1 TQ ¬TR
y ¬3x 3
2x ¬8
Solve a system of equations to find the point of x ¬4
intersection of the perpendicular bisectors. Find y.
Find x.
PT ¬TR
y ¬6x 5
2
3y 1 ¬8
1 1 5
3x 3 ¬6x 2 3y ¬9
2x 2 ¬36x 15 y ¬3
Find z.
17 ¬38x Line bisects P
R
, so z 4 7, or z 3.
17
¬x
38
17 Pages 243–245 Practice and Apply
Replace x with
38 in one of the equations to 7. Find an equation of the median from D(4, 0) to
find the y-coordinate. F
the midpoint of E . The midpoint of E
F
is (1, 5).
y ¬6
38 2
17
5 The slope of the median is 1.
7 y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y ¬38 y 0 ¬1(x 4)
The coordinates of the circumcenter of ABC y ¬x 4
are 38 , 38 .
17 7
121 Chapter 5
y Find x.
E (2, 4) F (0, 6) y ¬x 4
y ¬3
2x 6
3 x 6 ¬x 4
2
6 ¬52x 4
5
x 2 ¬2 x
D (4, 0) 4
5 ¬x
Replace x with 4
5 in one of the equations to find
the y-coordinate.
Find an equation of the median from F(0, 6) to the
midpoint of D E
. The midpoint of DE
is (1, 2). The y ¬4
5 4
slope of the median is 4. y ¬4 4
5
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
The coordinates of the orthocenter are 4
5 , 4 5 .
4
y 6 ¬4(x 0)
y 6 ¬4x 9. y
y ¬4x 6 E (2, 4) F (0, 6)
Solve a system of equations to find the point of
intersection of the medians.
Find x.
y ¬x 4
y ¬4x 6 x
4x 6 ¬x 4 D (4, 0)
6 ¬3x 4
2 ¬3x
2 ¬x
3 Find an equation of the perpendicular bisector
Replace x with 2
3 in one of the equations to find E
of D . The slope of D is 2
E
3 , so the slope of the
the y-coordinate.
3
y 2 perpendicular bisector is 2. The midpoint of D E
3 4
is (1, 2).
y 3 1
3 y y1 ¬m(x x1)
The coordinates of the centroid are 2
3 , 3 3 .
1 y 2 ¬3
2 (x 1)
8. y
y 2 ¬3 3
2x 2
E (2, 4) F (0, 6) 3
y ¬2 x 1
2
Find an equation of the perpendicular bisector of
F
E . The slope of E
F
is 1, so the slope of the
perpendicular bisector is 1. The midpoint of EF
x is (1, 5).
D (4, 0) y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 5 ¬1[x (1)]
y 5 ¬x 1
y ¬x 4
Find an equation of the altitude from D(4, 0) to
Solve a system of equations to find the point of
F
E . The slope of E
F
is 1, so the slope of the
intersection of the perpendicular bisectors.
altitude is 1.
Find x.
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 0 ¬1(x 4) y ¬x 4
y ¬x 4 y ¬3 1
2x 2
Find an equation of the altitude from F(0, 6) to
x 4 ¬3 1
2x 2
E
D . The slope of D
E is 2
3 , so the slope of the
altitude is 3 7 ¬5x
2. 2 2
y y1 ¬m(x x1) 7 ¬5x
y 6 ¬3
2 (x 0)
7 ¬x
5
y 6 ¬3
2x Replace x with 7
5 in one of the equations to find
the y-coordinate.
y ¬3
2x 6
Solve a system of equations to find the point of y ¬7
5 4
intersection of the altitudes. 13
y ¬5
The coordinates of the circumcenter are
75, 153 or 1 25, 2 35.
Chapter 5 122
10. Given: is the perpendicular bisector of A
CD B
. 12. Given:
GL is a median of EGH.
D
E is a point on C. M
J is a median of IJK.
Prove: EB EA EGH IJK
C L
Prove: G J M
E B E I
D L M
A
Proof: H K
D
C is the perpendicular bisector of A
B. By G J
definition of perpendicular bisector, D is the Proof:
midpoint of A B. Thus, A
D
B D
by the Midpoint Statements Reasons
Theorem. CDA and CDB are right angles by 1.
GL is a median of EGH, 1. Given
definition of perpendicular. Since all right angles M
J is a median of IJK,
are congruent, CDA CDB. Since E is a point and EGH IJK.
D
on C , EDA and EDB are right angles and
are congruent. By the Reflexive Property, 2.
GHJ
K, GHL 2. CPCTC
D
E E D
. Thus, EDA EDB by SAS. JKM, E
H
IK
B
E E A
because CPCTC, and by definition of 3. EH IK 3. Def. of
congruence, EB EA.
11. Given: UVW is isosceles with vertex angle UVW. L
4. EL
H, IM
M
K
4. Def. of median
V
Y is the bisector of UVW. 5. EL LH, IM MK 5. Def. of
Prove: Y V is a median. 6. EL LH EH, IM 6. Segment
U MK IK Addition
Y V Postulate
W 7. EL LH IM MK 7. Substitution
Proof: 8. LH LH MK MK 8. Substitution
Statements Reasons 9. 2LH 2MK 9. Addition
1. UVW is an isosceles 1. Given Property
triangle with vertex angle
10. LH MK 10. Division
UVW, YV is the bisector
Property
of UVW.
H
11. LM
K
11. Def of
V
2. U W V 2. Def. of isosceles
12. GHL JKM 12. SAS
3. UVY WVY 3. Def. of angle L
13. GJ
M
13. CPCTC
bisector
4. Y
V
Y V
4. Reflexive 13.
MS is an altitude of MNQ, so MSQ is a right
Property angle.
5. UVY WVY 5. SAS m1 m2 ¬90
3x 11 7x 9 ¬90
Y
6. UW
Y
6. CPCTC
10x 20 ¬90
W
7. Y is the midpoint of U. 7. Def. of midpoint 10x ¬70
x ¬7
V
8. Y is a median. 8. Def. of median
m2 ¬7(7) 9
¬58
S
14. M is a median of MNQ, so QSSN
.
3a 14 ¬2a 1
a 14 ¬1
a ¬15
mMSQ ¬7a 1
¬7(15) 1
¬106
S
M is not an altitude of MNQ because
mMSQ 106.
123 Chapter 5
P
15. W is an angle bisector, so mHWP 23.
PX is an altitude of PQR, so PXR is a
1mHWA. right angle.
2
mPXR ¬90
x 12 ¬1
2 (4x 16)
2a 10 ¬90
x 12 ¬2x 8 2a ¬80
12 ¬x 8 a ¬40
20 ¬x Z
24. R bisects PRQ, so mPRZ mZRQ.
P
W is a median, so AP
P H. 4b 17 ¬3b 4
3y 11 ¬7y 5 b 17 ¬4
11 ¬4y 5 b ¬13
16 ¬4y mPRZ ¬4(13) 17
4 ¬y ¬35
mPAW ¬3x 2 Y
25. Q is a median, so PY YR.
¬3(20) 2 2c 1 ¬4c 11
¬58 1 ¬2c 11
mPWA mHWP because W P is an angle 10 ¬2c
bisector. 5 ¬c
So, mPWA ¬x 12 PR ¬PY YR
¬20 12 or 32 ¬2(5) 1 4(5) 11
mWPA mPAW mPWA ¬180 ¬10 1 20 11
mWPA 58 32 ¬180 ¬18
mWPA ¬90
26.
QY is perpendicular to PR, so QYR is a right
WPA is a right angle, so W P is also an altitude.
angle.
16. P
W bisects AH
, so A
PP H. mQYR ¬90
6r 4 ¬22 3r 7b 6 ¬90
3r 4 ¬22 7b ¬84
3r ¬18 b ¬12
r ¬6 27. X is the midpoint of ST
.
P
W is perpendicular to AH, so mHPW 90. y
mWHA mHWP mHPW ¬180
8q 17 10 q 90 ¬180
T (1, 8)
9q 117 ¬180 S (1, 6)
9q ¬63
q ¬7
mHWP ¬10 q
¬10 7 R (3, 3)
¬17
17. Always; each median is always completely x
contained in the interior of the triangle, so the
x x y y 1
, 6
2 2 2
1 8
intersection point must also be inside the 1
2 1
, 2
¬
2
triangle. ¬(0, 7)
18. sometimes; true for a right triangle but false for
an equilateral triangle 28. d (x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
19. Never; an angle bisector lies between two sides of y
the triangle and is contained in the triangle up to T (1, 8)
the point where it intersects the opposite side.
so, the intersection point of the three angle S (1, 6)
bisectors must also be inside the triangle.
20. sometimes; true for an obtuse triangle but false
for an acute triangle
R (3, 3)
21. S
P is a median of PQR, so Q SS R
.
10x 7 ¬5x 3
x
5x 7 ¬3
5x ¬10 RX ¬
(0 3
)2 (7
3)2
x ¬2
¬
9 16 or 5 units
22. D
A is an altitude of ABC, so ADC is a right
angle.
mADC ¬90
4x 6 ¬90
4x ¬96
x ¬24
Chapter 5 124
(y y )
29. m
2
1
(x2 x1) 13. mCEA mCEA 13. Substitution
7 3 4 180
0 3 or 3
y 14. 2(mCEA) 180 14. Substitution
15. mCEA 90 15. Division
T (1, 8)
Property
S (1, 6) 16. CEA and CEB are 16. Def. of rt.
rt. .
D
17. CA
B
17. Def. of
R (3, 3) 18.
CD is the perpendicular 18. Def. of
B
bisector of A. bisector
x 19. C and D are on the 19. Def. of points
perpendicular bisector on a line
30. No, RX is not an altitude of RST. The slope B
of A.
T
of S is 1. The product of the slopes of S
T
and R
X
32. Given: BAC, P is in the interior of BAC,
is 4, not 1. Thus, the segments are not
3 PD PE
perpendicular.
Prove:
AP is the angle bisector of BAC
y
D
A B
T (1, 8) P
S (1, 6) E
C
Proof:
R (3, 3) Statements Reasons
1. BAC, P is in the interior 1. Given
x of BAC, PD PE
D
2. P PE
2. Def. of
31. Given:
CAC B, A
DBD
D
3. PA
B
, P
E
AC 3. Distance from a
Prove: C and D are on the perpendicular point to a line is
B
bisector of A. measured along
C segment from
the point to the
line.
A
E B 4. ADP and AEP are 4. Def. of
rt.
D 5. ADP and AEP are 5. Def. of rt.
Proof: rt. s
Statements Reasons P
6. AA
P
6. Reflexive
Property
A
1. CC
B
, A
D
B
D
1. Given
7. ADP AEP 7. HL
D
2. CC
D
2. Reflexive
Property 8. DAP EAP 8. CPCTC
3. ACD BCD 3. SSS is the angle bisector
9. AP 9. Def. of bisector
4. ACD BCD 4. CPCTC of BAC
E
5. CC
E
5. Reflexive
Property
6. CEA CEB 6. SAS
E
7. AB
E
7. CPCTC
B
8. E is the midpoint of A. 8. Def. of
midpoint
9. CEA CEB 9. CPCTC
10. CEA and CEB form 10. Def. of linear
a linear pair. pair
11. CEA and CEB are 11. Supplement
supplementary. Theorem
12. mCEA mCEB 12. Def. of suppl.
180
125 Chapter 5
,
33. Given: ABC with angle bisectors AD BE, and Page 245 Maintain Your Skills
, K
CF P
AB, K
Q
B C
, K
RA C 43. Sample answer:
Prove: KP KQ KR • Use the origin as vertex A of the triangle.
A • Place side AB along the positive x-axis.
R
P E • Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
F K • Since B is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0.
D Its x-coordinate is n because AB is n units long.
B C • Since ABC is equilateral, the x-coordinate of C
Q
is halfway between 0 and n, or n
2 . We cannot
Proof: determine the y-coordinate in terms of n,
Statements Reasons so call it m.
1. ABC with angle bisectors 1. Given y
C (n–2, m)
,
AD , K
BE, and CF P
A B,
Q
KB C, K
R
A C
2. KP KQ, KQ KR, 2. Any point on
KP KR the bisector is A(0, 0) B(n, 0) x
equidistant
from the sides 44. Sample answer:
of the angle. • Use the origin as vertex D of the triangle.
3. KP KQ KR 3. Transitive • Place the base of the triangle along the positive
Property x-axis.
• Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
34. The flag is located at the intersection of the angle • Since F is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0.
bisector between Amesbury and Stearns Roads Its x-coordinate is a because the base of the
and the perpendicular bisector of the segment triangle is a units long.
joining Grand Tower and the park entrance. • Since DEF is isosceles, the x-coordinate of E is
16 2
(6) halfway between 0 and a, or a
2 . We cannot
35. 3 4
determine the y-coordinate in terms of a, so call
8 4
12 it b.
36. 3 8
y
37. C (–6, 12) y E(a–2, b)
12
E(5, 10)
A(16, 8)
8
D(–2, 8)
F (9, 6)
4
B(2, 4) D(0, 0) F(a, 0) x
H(0, 0) G(x, 0) x
41. C; GJ JH, so J is the midpoint of GH and 46.
MTM R
by the converse of the Isosceles
J
F is a median of FGH. Triangle Theorem.
42. D; 3x ¬0.3y 47. 5 11 by the Isosceles Triangle Theorem.
10.0x ¬y
y 48. 7 10 by the Isosceles Triangle Theorem.
10.0 ¬x
L
49. M M N by the converse of the Isosceles
Triangle Theorem.
50. It is everywhere equidistant.
Chapter 5 126
5
51. 3 3
8 16 because 8 1
6
6. 2. A
5 5
52. 2.7 3 because 3 1.6
.
19 19 C B
53. 4.25 4 because 4 4.75.
18 19 18 Sample answer: mCAB, mACB, mABC; B C
,
54.
25 27 because 25 0.72 and
B
A , A
C
19
27 0.7
03
. 3. Grace; she placed the shorter side with the
smaller angle and the longer side with the larger
angle.
Page 246 Reading Mathematics: Math Words 4. Explore: Compare the measure of 2 to the
and Everyday Words measures of 1 and 4
Plan: Use properties and theorems of real
1. Sample answer: A median of a triangle is a
numbers to compare the angle measures.
segment that has one endpoint at a vertex and
Solve: Compare m1 to m2.
the other at the midpoint of the opposite side; the
By the Exterior Angle Theorem, m2 m1
everyday meaning says it is a paved or planted
m4. Since angle measures are positive numbers
strip in the middle of a highway.
and from the definition of inequality,
2. Sample answer: the intersection of two or more m2 m1.
lines or curves, the top of the head, the highest Compare m4 to m2.
point Again, by the Exterior Angle Theorem,
3. Sample answer: in a trapezoid, the segment m2 m1 m4. The definition of inequality
joining the midpoints of the legs; the middle value states that if m2 m1 m4 then
of a set of data that has been arranged into an m2 m4.
ordered sequence Examine: m2 is greater than m1 and m4.
4. Sample answer: a separate piece of something; a Therefore, 2 has the greatest measure.
portion cut off from a geometric figure by one or 5. Explore: Compare the measure of 3 to the
more points, lines, or planes. measures of 2 and 5.
Plan: Use properties and theorems of real
numbers to compare the angle measures.
Solve: Compare m2 to m3.
5-2 Inequalities and Triangles By the Exterior Angle Theorem, m3 m2
m5. Since angle measures are positive numbers
and from the definition of inequality,
Page 249 Geometry Activity: Inequalities for m3 m2.
Sides and Angles of Triangles Compare m5 to m3.
1. Sample answer: It is the greatest measure. Again, by the Exterior Angle Theorem, m3
2. Sample answer: It is the least measure. m2 m5. The definition of inequality
3. See students’ work. states that if m3 m2 m5 then
4. Sample answer: The measures of the angles m3 m5.
opposite the sides are in the same order as the Examine: m3 is greater than m2 and m5.
lengths of the respective sides. Therefore, 3 has the greatest measure.
6. Explore: Compare the measure of 3 to the
Page 251 Check for Understanding measures of 1, 2, 4, and 5.
1. never; Plan: Use properties and theorems of real
numbers to compare the angle measures.
L Solve: From Exercise 4, m2 m1 and
m2 m4.
From Exercise 5, m3 m2 and m3 m5.
Then by transitivity, m3 m1 and
K J m3 m4.
Examine: m3 is greater than m1, m2, m4,
J is a right angle. and m5. Therefore, 3 has the greatest
Since mJ = 2 mK, 90 ¬2 mK measure.
45 ¬mK 7. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
mL 180 90 45 45 m1 m4 and m1 m5 m6
mL mK, so LKJ is isosceles, and KJ LJ. so m1 m5 and m6. Thus, the measures of
Let KJ LJ 1. If the statement in the problem 4, 5, and 6 are all less than m1.
is true, then LK 2. Since LKJ is a right
8. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
triangle, the Pythagorean Theorem applies.
m1 m5 m6 and m7 m5 m6
12 12 ¬22
so m1 m6 and m7 m6. Thus, the
2 ¬4
measures of 1 and 7 are greater than m6.
This is a false statement, so the statement in the
problem is never true.
127 Chapter 5
9. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, 19. Explore: Compare the measure of 7 to the
m7 m2 m3 and m7 m5 m6, measures of 3 and 5.
so m7 m2, m7 m3, m7 m5, Plan: Use properties and theorems of real
and m7 m6. Thus, the measures of 2, 3, numbers to compare angle measures.
5, and 6 are less than m7. Solve: Compare m7 to m3.
10. The side opposite WXY is longer than the side By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
opposite XYW, so mWXY mXYW. m7 m3.
11. The side opposite XZY is shorter than the side Compare m7 to m5.
opposite XYZ, so mXZY mXYZ. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
m7 m5.
12. The side opposite WYX is shorter than the side
Examine: m7 is greater than m3 and m5.
opposite XWY, so mWYX mXWY.
Therefore, 7 has the greatest measure.
E
13. A is opposite a 30° angle, and EB
is opposite a
20. Explore: Compare the measure of 1 to the
110° angle. If one angle of a triangle has a greater
measures of 2 and 6.
measure than another angle, then the side
Plan: Use properties and theorems of real
opposite the greater angle is longer than the side
numbers to compare angle measures.
opposite the lesser angle, so AE EB.
Solve: Compare m1 to m2.
E
14. C is opposite CDE, and mCDE By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
180 (50 55) or 75. CD
is opposite a 55° angle. m1 m2.
If one angle of a triangle has a greater measure Compare m1 to m6.
than another angle, then the side opposite the By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
greater angle is longer than the side opposite the m1 m6.
lesser angle, so CE CD.
Examine: m1 is greater than m2 and m6.
C
15. B is opposite BEC, and mBEC Therefore, 1 has the greatest measure.
180 (40 100) or 40. EC is opposite a 40°
21. Explore: Compare the measure of 7 to the
angle. Thus, BC EC.
measures of 5 and 8.
16. Second base; the angle opposite the side from Plan: Use properties and theorems of real
third base to second base is smaller than the numbers to compare angle measures.
angle opposite the side from third to first. Solve: Compare m7 to m5.
Therefore, the distance from third to second is By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
shorter than the distance from third to first. m7 m5.
Compare m7 to m8.
Pages 252–253 Practice and Apply By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
17. Explore: Compare the measure of 1 to the m7 m8.
measures of 2 and 4. Examine: m7 is greater than m5 and m8.
Plan: Use properties and theorems of real Therefore, 7 has the greatest measure.
numbers to compare angle measures. 22. Explore: Compare the measure of 2 to the
Solve: Compare m1 to m2. measures of 6 and 8.
By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, Plan: Use properties and theorems of real
m1 m2. numbers to compare angle measures.
Compare m1 to m4. Solve: Compare m2 to m6.
By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
m1 m4. m2 m6.
Examine: m1 is greater than m2 and m4. Compare m2 to m8.
Therefore, 1 has the greatest measure. Let x be the measure of the third angle of the
18. Explore: Compare the measure of 2 to the triangle whose other angles are 3 and 4. Then,
measures of 4 and 6. by the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
Plan: Use properties and theorems of real m2 (x m8). Since angle measures are
numbers to compare angle measures. positive numbers and from the definition of
Solve: Compare m2 to m4. inequality, m2 m8.
By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, Examine: m2 is greater than m6 and m8.
m2 m4. Therefore, 2 has the greatest measure.
Compare m2 to m6. 23. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, m5 m7, m5 m10, and
m2 m6. m5 m2 m8 so m5 m2 and
Examine: m2 is greater than m4 and m6. m5 m8. Thus, the measures of 2, 7, 8,
Therefore, 2 has the greatest measure. and 10 are all less than m5.
24. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
m4 m6, m1 m6 m9 so m1 m6
and m11 m6 m9 so m11 m6. Thus,
the measures of 1, 4, and 11 are all greater
than m6.
Chapter 5 128
25. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, 36. Given:
PRP
Q; QR QP
m3 m10 and m5 m10. Thus, the Prove: mP mQ
measures of 3 and 5 are greater than m10. R
26. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
m1 m3, m1 m6, and m1 m9.
Thus, the measures of 3, 6, and 9 are all less
than m1.
Q P
27. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
Proof:
m8 m9, m7 m9, m3 m9, and
m1 m9. Thus, the measures of 8, 7, 3, Statements Reasons
and 1 are all greater than m9. 1. QR QP 1. Given
28. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, 2. mP mR 2. If one side of a is
m8 m2, m8 m4, m8 m5, and longer than another,
m8 m9. Thus, the measures of 2, 4, 5, then the opp. the
and 9 are all less than m8. longer side is greater
29. The side opposite KAJ is shorter than the side than the opposite
opposite AJK, so mKAJ mAJK. the shorter side.
30. The side opposite MJY is longer than the side R
3. P P
Q 3. Given
opposite JYM, so mMJY mJYM.
4. Q R 4. Isosceles Theorem
31. The side opposite SMJ is longer than the side
opposite MJS, so mSMJ mMJS. 5. mQ mR 5. Def. of
32. The side opposite AKJ is longer than the side 6. mP mQ 6. Substitution
opposite JAK, so mAKJ mJAK.
33. The side opposite MYJ is shorter than the side 37.
ZY is opposite a 45° angle. Y
R is opposite YZR,
opposite JMY, so mMYJ mJMY. and mYZR 180 (95 45) or 40. If one angle
34. The side opposite JSY is longer than the side of a triangle has a greater measure than another
opposite JYS, so mJSY mJYS. angle, then the side opposite the greater angle is
longer than the side opposite the lesser angle, so
35. Given: J
JM L
ZY YR.
L
JK L
Prove: m1 m2 R
38. S is opposite a 43° angle. Z
S is opposite ZRS,
L and mZRS 180 (43 97) or 40. If one angle
of a triangle has a greater measure than another
2 angle, then the side opposite the greater angle is
longer than the side opposite the lesser angle, so
1 SR ZS.
K M
J Z
39. R is opposite a 97° angle. S
R is opposite a 43°
Proof: angle. If one angle of a triangle has a greater
measure than another angle, then the side
Statements Reasons
opposite the greater angle is longer than the side
M
1. JJL
, J
L
KL
1. Given opposite the lesser angle, so RZ SR.
2. LKJ LJK 2. Isosceles Y
40. Z is opposite a 45° angle. R
Z is opposite a 95°
Theorem angle. If one angle of a triangle has a greater
3. mLKJ mLJK 3. Def. of measure than another angle, then the side
4. m1 mLKJ 4. Ext. Inequality opposite the greater angle is longer than the side
Theorem opposite the lesser angle, so ZY RZ.
Y
41. T is opposite TZY. mTZY mZYT 91, so
5. m1 mLJK 5. Substitution
mTZY 91 66 or 25. Z Y
is opposite an 89°
6. mLJK m2 6. Ext. Inequality angle. If one angle of a triangle has a greater
Theorem measure than another angle, then the side
7. m1 m2 7. Trans. Prop. of opposite the greater angle is longer than the side
Inequality opposite the lesser angle, so TY ZY.
Y
42. T is opposite TZY. mTZY mZYT 91, so
mTZY 91 66 or 25. Z T
is opposite a 66°
angle. If one angle of a triangle has a greater
measure than another angle, then the side
opposite the greater angle is longer than the side
opposite the lesser angle, so TY ZT.
129 Chapter 5
43. KL ¬ (1 3)2 (5 2)2 48. mP mQ mR ¬180
¬ 16 9 or 5 9n 4 4n 16 68 2n ¬180
11n 48 ¬180
LM ¬ [3 (1)]
2 (7 5)2
11n ¬132
¬ 4 14
4
n ¬12
¬ 148
mP ¬9(12) 4 or 104
¬12.2 mQ ¬4(12) 16 or 32
KM ¬ (3 3)2 (7 2)2 mR ¬68 2(12) or 44
¬ 36 8
1 mQ mR mP, so the sides of PQR in
¬ 117 R
order from shortest to longest are P , P
Q
, QR.
¬10.8 49. mP mQ mR ¬180
The side lengths in order from least to greatest 3n 20 2n 37 4n 15 ¬180
are KL, KM, LM, so the angles in order from the 9n 72 ¬180
least to the greatest measure are M, L, K. 9n ¬108
n ¬12
44. Sample answer: Draw a triangle that satisfies the
given information. Then draw the medians and mP ¬3(12) 20 or 56
measure them to find their lengths. mQ ¬2(12) 37 or 61
mR ¬4(12) 15 or 63
C mP mQ mR, so the sides of PQR in
N R
order from shortest to longest are Q , P
R,
PQ.
M
50. mP mQ mR ¬180
4n 61 67 3n n 74 ¬180
A O B 2n 202 ¬180
2n ¬22
In ABC, AB AC BC. Measure A M, B
N, and
n ¬11
CO . In this triangle CO BN AM.
mP ¬4(11) 61 or 17
45. 8x 4 11x 37 5x 21 ¬180
mQ ¬67 3(11) or 100
24x 12 ¬180
mR ¬11 74 or 63
24x ¬192
mP mR mQ, so the sides of PQR in
x ¬8
R
order from shortest to longest are Q , P
Q, P
R.
8x 4 ¬8(8) 4 or 68
11x 37 ¬11(8) 37 or 51 51. The angle opposite the side with length 3x inches
5x 21 ¬5(8) 21 or 61 has measure 180 163 or 17. The angle opposite
the side with length 2(y 1) inches has measure
68 61 51, so the lengths of the legs of the trip x
180 (17 75) or 88. Thus, 2(y 1) 3.
in order from greatest to least are Phoenix to x
2(y 1) ¬3
Atlanta, Des Moines to Phoenix, Atlanta to
x
Des Moines. y 1 ¬6
46. mP mQ mR ¬180 x
y ¬6 1
9n 29 93 5n 10n 2 ¬180
x 6
14n 124 ¬180 y ¬¬ 6
14n ¬56 52. A
n ¬4
mP ¬9(4) 29 or 65
mQ ¬93 5(4) or 73 C
B
mR ¬10(4) 2 or 42 T M
mR mP mQ, so the sides of PQR in Given: ABC is scalene; A M is the median from
order from shortest to longest are PQ
, Q
R, P
R
. C
A to B ; A
T
is the altitude from A to B
C.
47. mP mQ mR ¬180 Prove: AM AT
12n 9 62 3n 16n 2 ¬180 ATB and ATM are right angles by the
25n 55 ¬180 definition of altitude and mATB mATM
25n ¬125 because all right angles are congruent. By the
n ¬5 Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
mP ¬12(5) 9 or 51 mATB mAMT. So, mATM mAMT by
mQ ¬62 3(5) or 47 Substitution. If one angle of a triangle has a
mR ¬16(5) 2 or 82 greater measure than another angle, then the
mQ mP mR, so the sides of PQR in side opposite the greater angle is longer than the
order from shortest to longest are PR
, Q
R
, PQ
. side opposite the lesser angle. Thus, AM AT.
Chapter 5 130
53. mA mB mC ¬180
2 2
2 2
2y 12 y 18 4y 12 ¬180 BF ¬ 9 71 12
101
7y 6 ¬180
7y ¬174
y ¬25
¬ 9
4 4
1
8
2 2
2 2
mC mA so 3x 15 ¬4x 7 DF ¬ 12 71 3
101
15 ¬x 7
CB 0, so 4x 7 ¬0
8 ¬x
¬ 9 8
4 4
1
4x ¬7 ¬
90
4
7
x ¬4 90
7 2
Thus, 4 x 8.
BF DF, so B
FD F and F is the midpoint of
54. Sample answer: The largest corner is opposite the
D
B. Therefore, E
F
is a perpendicular bisector of
longest side. Answers should include the
D
B.
following. ab
0
• the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem 60. x 3 ¬ a
3
b
131 Chapter 5
68. true; a c ¬2 6 or 8 3. Sample answer: ABC is scalene.
a b ¬2 5 or 7 Given: ABC; AB BC; BC AC; AB AC
a c ¬a b since 8 7 Prove: ABC is scalene.
A
Page 254 Practice Quiz 1
1. BD ¬DC C
B
4x 9 ¬7x 6
Proof:
9 ¬3x 6
Step 1 Assume ABC is not scalene.
15 ¬3x
Case 1: ABC is isoceles.
5 ¬x
If ABC is isosceles, then AB BC,
2. D
A B C, so mADC 90. BC AC, or AB AC.
2y 6 ¬90 This contradicts the given information, so
2y ¬96 ABC is not isosceles.
y ¬48 Case 2: ABC is equilateral.
3. Never; a median is a segment from one vertex to In order for a triangle to be equilateral, it
the side opposite the vertex and never intersects must also be isosceles, and Case 1 proved
any other vertex. that ABC is not isosceles. Thus, ABC
4. Always; an angle bisector lies between two sides is not equilateral.
of the triangle and is contained in the triangle up Therefore, ABC is scalene.
to the point where it intersects the opposite side. 4. x 5
So, the intersection point of the three angle 5. The lines are not parallel.
bisectors must also be inside the triangle.
6. The lines are not parallel.
5. sometimes; true for an obtuse triangle but false
7. Given: a 0
for an acute triangle 1
Prove: a 0
6. sometimes; true for right triangles but false for
other triangles Proof:
1
7. No triangle; by Exercise 4, the angle bisectors Step 1 Assume a
0.
1 1
always intersect at a point in the interior of the Step 2 a
0; a a
0 a, 1
0
triangle. Step 3 The conclusion that 1
0 is false, so the
1
8. mT mS mU, so the sides of STU in assumption that a
0 must be false.
1
order from longest to shortest are SU, T
U
, ST. Therefore, a 0.
9. mQ mR mS ¬180 8. Given: n is odd.
3x 20 2x 37 4x 15 ¬180 Prove: n2 is odd.
9x 72 ¬180 Proof:
9x ¬108 Step 1 Assume n2 is even.
x ¬12 Step 2 n is odd, so n can be expressed as 2a 1.
mQ ¬3(12) 20 or 56 n2 ¬(2a 1)2 Substitution
mR ¬2(12) 37 or 61 ¬(2a 1)(2a 1) Multiply.
mS ¬4(12) 15 or 63 ¬4a2 4a 1 Simplify.
¬2(2a2 2a) 1 Distributive Property
10. mQ mR mS, so the sides of QRS in
Step 3 2(2a2 2a) 1 is an odd number. This
order from shortest to longest are RS, Q
S, Q
R
.
contradicts the assumption, so the
assumption must be false. Thus n2 is odd.
9. Given: ABC
5-3 Indirect Proof Prove: There can be no more than
one obtuse angle in ABC.
B
Pages 257–258 Check for Understanding
1. If a statement is shown to be false, then its A C
opposite must be true. Proof:
2. Sample answer: Indirect proofs are proved using Step 1 Assume that there can be more than one
the contrapositive, showing Q → P. In a direct obtuse angle in ABC.
proof, it would be shown that P → Q. For example, Step 2 An obtuse angle has a measure greater
indirect reasoning can be used to prove that a than 90. Suppose A and B are obtuse
person is not guilty of a crime by assuming the angles. Then mA mB 180 and
person is guilty, then contradicting evidence to show mA mB mC 180.
that the person could not have committed the crime. Step 3 The conclusion contradicts the fact that
the sum of the measures of the angles of a
triangle equals 180. Thus, there can be at
most one obtuse angle in ABC.
Chapter 5 132
10. Given: m
n 16. A median of an isosceles triangle is not an
Prove: Lines m and n intersect at exactly altitude.
one point. 17. Points P, Q, and R are noncollinear.
m 18. The angle bisector of the vertex angle of an
n isosceles triangle is not an altitude of the triangle.
Proof: 1
19. Given: a 0
Case 1: m and n intersect at more than one point.
Prove: a is negative.
Step 1 Assume that m and n intersect at more
Proof:
than one point.
Step 1 Assume a 0. a 0 since that would
Step 2 Lines m and n intersect at points P and Q. 1
make a undefined.
Both lines m and n contain P and Q.
Step 2 1
a¬ 0
Step 3 By postulate, there is exactly one line
through any two points. Thus the 1
a a ¬ (0)a
assumption is false, and lines m and n
1¬ 0
intersect in no more than one point.
Step 3 1 0, so the assumption must be false.
Case 2: m and n do not intersect. Thus, a must be negative.
Step 1 Assume that m and n do not intersect.
20. Given: n2 is even.
Step 2 If lines m and n do not intersect, then
Prove: n2 is divisible by 4.
they are parallel.
Proof:
Step 3 This conclusion contradicts the given Step 1 Assume n2 is not divisible by 4. In other
information. Therefore the assumption is words, 4 is not a factor of n2.
false, and lines m and n intersect in at Step 2 If the square of a numbers is even, then
least one point. Combining the two cases, the number is also even. So, if n2 is even,
lines m and n intersect in no more than then n must be even.
one point and no less than one point. So Let n ¬2a.
lines m and n intersect in exactly one n ¬2a
point. n2 ¬(2a)2 or 4a2
11. Given: ABC is a right triangle; C is a right Step 3 4 is a factor of n2, which contradicts the
angle. assumption.
Prove: AB BC and AB AC 21. Given:
PQP R
A 1 2
Prove: PZ is not a median of PQR.
P
C B 12
Proof:
Step 1 Assume that the hypotenuse of a right Q Z R
triangle is not the longest side. That is,
Proof:
AB BC or AB AC.
Step 1 Assume P Z is a median of PQR.
Step 2 If AB BC, then mC mA. Since Z
Step 2 If P is a median of PQR, then Z is the
mC 90, mA 90. So, mC midpoint of Q R, and Q
ZR Z
. P
Z
P Z by
mA 180. By the same reasoning, if the Reflexive Property. PZQ PZR by
AB AC, then mC mB 180. SSS. 1 2 by CPCTC.
Step 3 Both relationships contradict the fact that Step 3 This conclusion contradicts the given fact
the sum of the measures of the angles of a 1 2. Thus, P Z
is not a median of
triangle equals 180. Therefore, the PQR.
hypotenuse must be the longest side of a 22. Given: m2 m1
right triangle. Prove:
m
12. Given: x y 270
t
Prove: x 135 or y 135 1
Proof: 3
Step 1 Assume x
135 and y
135. 2
m
Step 2 x y
270
Step 3 This contradicts the fact that x y 270.
Therefore, at least one of the stages was Proof:
longer than 135 miles. Step 1 Assume that
m.
Step 2 If
m, then 1 2 because they are
Pages 258–260 Practice and Apply corresponding angles. Thus, m1 m2.
13.
PQST
Step 3 This contradicts the given fact that
14. x
4 m1 m2. Thus the assumption
m is false. Therefore,
m.
15. 6 cannot be expressed as a
b.
133 Chapter 5
23. Given: a 0, b 0, and a b Case 2: If BC AC, then there must be a point D
a
Prove: 1 between A and C so that D C
B C. Draw
b
Proof: the auxiliary segment B D
. Since DC
Step 1 Assume that ab
1.
BC, by the Isosceles Triangle Theorem
Step 2 BDC DBC. Now BDC is an
Case 1 Case 2 exterior angle of BAD, and by the
a¬¬1 a¬ 1 Exterior Angles Inequality Theorem (the
b b
a¬¬b a¬ b measure of an exterior angle of a triangle
Step 3 The conclusion of both cases contradicts is greater than the measure of either
the given fact a b. corresponding remote interior angle)
a mBDC mA. By the Angle Addition
Thus, 1.
b Postulate, mABC mABD
24. Given:
AB C
A
mDBC. Then by the definition of
Prove: 1
2 inequality, mABC mDBC. By
A Substitution and the Transitive Property
of Inequality, mABC mA. But this
contradicts the given statement that
mA mABC. In both cases, a
C 1 2
B contradiction was found, and hence our
Proof: assumption must have been false.
Step 1 Assume that 1 2. Therefore, BC AC.
Step 2 If 1 2, then the sides opposite the
27. Use r dt, t 3, and d 175.
angles are congruent.
Thus A B
A C
. Proof:
Step 3 The conclusion contradicts the given Step 1 Assume that Ramon’s average speed was
information. Thus 1 2 is false. greater than or equal to 60 miles per hour,
Therefore, 1
2. r 60.
25. Given: ABC and ABD are equilateral. Step 2
ACD is not equilateral. Case 1 Case 2
Prove: BCD is not equilateral. r ¬60 r ¬60
17
5 17
5 ?
C 60 ¬
3 ¬60
3
A 60 ¬58.3 58.3 ¬60
Step 3 The conclusions are false, so the
B assumption must be false. Therefore,
D Ramon’s average speed was less than 60
Proof: miles per hour.
Step 1 Assume that BCD is an equilateral
28. A majority is greater than half or 50%.
triangle.
Proof:
Step 2 If BCD is an equilateral triangle, then
Step 1 Assume that the percent of college-bound
C
B C DD B. Since ABC and ABD
seniors receiving information from
C
are equilateral triangles, AA B
B C
guidance counselors is less than 50%.
and AD
A B
D B. By the Transitive
Step 2 By examining the graph, you can see that
C
Property, AA DC D
. Therefore,
56% of college-bound seniors received
ACD is an equilateral triangle.
information from guidance counselors.
Step 3 This conclusion contradicts the given
Step 3 Since 56% 50%, the assumption is false.
information. Thus, the assumption is false.
Therefore, a majority of college-bound
Therefore, BCD is not an equilateral
seniors received information from
triangle.
guidance counselors.
26. Given: mA mABC
29. 1500 15% ¬225
Prove: BC AC
1500 0.15 ¬225
D A 225 ¬225
30. teachers and friends; 15% 18% 33%, 33%
C B 31%
Proof: Assume BC AC. By the Comparison 31. Yes; if you assume the client was at the scene of
Property, BC AC or BC AC. the crime, it is contradicted by his presence in
Case 1: If BC AC, then ABC A by the Chicago at that time. Thus, the assumption that
Isosceles Triangle Theorem (If two sides he was present at the crime is false.
of a triangle are congruent, then the 32. See students’ work.
angles opposite those sides are
congruent.) But, ABC A contradicts
the given statement that
mA mABC. So, BC AC.
Chapter 5 134
33. Proof: 40. Given:
QT is a median. QRS is isosceles with
Step 1 Assume that 2 is a rational number. base RS
.
Step 2 If 2 is a rational number, it can be T
Prove: Q bisects SQR
written as a
b , where a and b are integers Q
with no common factors, and b 0. If
2
2 a
a
b , then 2 b2 , and 2b a . Thus a
2 2 2
D
6. CC
D
6. Reflexive Prop. 11. mABG mDEH 11. Division
C
8. AB
C
8. CPCTC 13. ABG DEH 13. ASA
9. ABC is isosceles. 9. Def. of isosceles G
14. BE
H
14. CPCTC
135 Chapter 5
42. mR mS mA ¬180 8. Let the measure of the third side be n.
41 109 mA ¬180 7 12¬ n 7 n¬ 12 12 n¬ 7
150 mA ¬180 19¬ n or n 19 n¬ 5 n¬ 5
mA ¬30 Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
43. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 3 ¬2(x 4) 5 3 1 0 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19
44. y y1 ¬m(x x1) n¬ 19
y (2) ¬3(x 2)
y 2 ¬3(x 2) 5 3 1 0 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19
45. y y1 ¬m(x x1) n¬ 5
y (9) ¬11[x (4)]
y 9 ¬11(x 4) 5 3 1 0 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19
?
46. true; 19 10¬ 11 n¬ 5
9¬ 11
? 5 3 1 0 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19
47. false; 31 17¬ 12
Find the intersection.
14¬ 12
? The range of values that fit all three inequalities
48. true; 38 76¬ 109 is 5 n 19.
114¬ 109
9. Let the measure of the third side be n.
14 23¬ n 14 n¬ 23 23 n¬ 14
37¬ n or n 37 n¬ 9 n¬ 9
5-4 The Triangle Inequality Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
9 6 3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36 3739
Pages 263–264 Check for Understanding n¬ 37
1. Sample answer: If the lines are not horizontal,
then the segment connecting their y-intercepts is 9 6 3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36 39
not perpendicular to either line. Since distance is n¬ 9
measured along a perpendicular segment, this
segment cannot be used. 9 6 3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36 39
2. Jameson; 5 10 13 but 5 8 13. n¬ 9
3. Sample answer: 2, 3, 4 and 1, 2, 3
9 6 3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 36 3739
3
2 Find the intersection.
The range of values that fit all three inequalities
4 2
1 is 9 n 37.
3 10. Let the measure of the third side be n.
4. Check each inequality. 22 34¬ n 22 n¬ 34 34 n¬ 22
?
5 4¬ 3
?
4 3¬ 5
?
5 3¬ 4 56¬ n or n 56 n¬ 12 n¬ 12
9¬ 3 ✓ 7¬ 5 ✓ 8¬ 4 ✓ Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
All of the inequalities are true, so 5, 4, and 3 can
12 6 0 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54 56
be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
? n¬ 56
5. 5 10¬ 15
15¬ 15 12 6 0 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54
Because the sum of two measures equals the n¬ 12
third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle.
?
6. 30.1 0.8¬ 31 12 6 0 6 12 18 24 30 36 42 48 54
Chapter 5 136
Graph the inequalities on the same number line. 18. Check each inequality.
? ? ?
18 32¬ 21 18 21¬ 32 32 21¬ 18
3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33
50¬ 21 ✓ 39¬ 32 ✓ 53¬ 18 ✓
n 33 All of the inequalities are true, so 18, 32, and 21
can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33
19. Check each inequality.
n3 ? ? ?
9 21¬ 20 9 20¬ 21 20 21¬ 9
3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 30¬ 20 ✓ 29¬ 21 ✓ 41¬ 9 ✓
n 3 All of the inequalities are true, so 9, 21, and 20
can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18 21 24 27 30 33 ?
20. 5 9¬ 17
Find the intersection. 14¬ 17
The range of values that fit all three inequalities Because the sum of two measures is less than the
is 3 n 33. third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle.
12. Given: PQ plane M 21. Check each inequality.
Prove: PQ is the shortest segment from P to ? ?
17 30¬ 30 30 30¬ 17
plane M.
47¬ 30 ✓ 60¬ 17 ✓
P All of the inequalities are true, so 17, 30, and 30
can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
M
Q 22. Check each inequality.
? ? ?
8.4 7.2¬ 3.5 8.4 3.5¬ 7.2 3.5 7.2¬ 8.4
Proof: By definition, PQ is perpendicular to 15.6¬ 3.5 ✓ 11.9¬ 7.2 ✓ 10.7¬ 8.4 ✓
plane M if it is perpendicular to every line in M All of the inequalities are true, so 8.4, 7.2, and 3.5
that intersects it. But since the perpendicular can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
segment from a point to a line is the shortest 23. Check each inequality.
segment from the point to the line, that ? ? ?
4 0.9¬ 4.1 4 4.1¬ 0.9 4.1 0.9¬ 4
perpendicular segment is the shortest segment 4.9¬ 4.1 ✓ 8.1¬ 0.9 ✓ 5¬ 4 ✓
from the point to each of these lines. Therefore, All of the inequalities are true, so 4, 0.9, and 4.1
Q
P is the shortest segment from P to M. can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
13. B; Let x be the length of each of the congruent ?
sides of the triangle. 24. 2.2 12¬ 14.3
x x¬ 10 x 10¬ x 14.2¬ 14.3
2x¬ 10 10¬ 0 true for all x Because the sum of two measures is less than the
x¬ 5 third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle.
The side length x is a whole number greater ?
25. 0.18 0.21¬ 0.52
than 5. The smallest number x for which this is 0.39¬ 0.52
true is 6. Thus, the answer is choice B. Because the sum of two measures is less than the
third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle.
26. Let the measure of the third side be n.
Pages 264–265 Practice and Apply 5 11¬ n 5 n¬ 11 11 n¬ 5
?
14. 1 2¬ 3 16¬ n or n 16 n¬ 6 n¬ 6
3¬ 3 Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
Because the sum of two measures equals the
6 4 2 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle.
? n 16
15. 2 6¬ 11
8¬ 11 6 4 2 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
Because the sum of two measures is less than the n6
third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle.
16. Check each inequality. 6 4 2 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
? ?
8 8¬ 15 8 15¬ 8 n 6
16¬ 15 ✓ 23¬ 8 ✓
All of the inequalities are true, so 8, 8, and 15 can 6 4 2 0 2 4 6 8 10 12 14 16
137 Chapter 5
27. Let the measure of the third side be n.
7 9¬ n 7 n¬ 9 9 n¬ 7 30 20 10 0 10 20 26 30 40 50 60 70 80
Chapter 5 138
34. Let the measure of the third side be n. Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
57 55¬ n 57 n¬ 55 55 n¬ 57
112¬ n or n 112 n¬ 2 n¬ 2 100 80 60 40 20 0 20 40 60 80 100 101 120
Graph the inequalities on the same number line. n¬ 101
75 60 45 30 15 0 15 30 45 60 75 83 90
G
n¬ 83 F
Proof:
75 73 60 45 30 15 0 15 30 45 60 75 90
Statements Reasons
n¬ 73
E
1. HE
G
1. Given
75 60 45 30 15 0 15 30 45 60 73 75 90 2. HE EG 2. Def. of segments
n¬ 73
3. EG FG EF 3. Triangle Inequality
75 60 45 30 15 0 15 30 45 60 73 75 83 90 4. HE FG EF 4. Substitution
Find the intersection.
The range of values that fit all three inequalities
is 73 n 83.
37. Let the measure of the third side be n.
99 2¬ n 99 n¬ 2 2 n¬ 99
101¬ n or n 101 n¬ 97 n¬ 97
139 Chapter 5
40. Given: ABC 42. LM ¬[22 (2 4)]2 [20 (19 )]2
Prove: AC BC AB ¬ 4 1521
A
¬ 1525
¬39.1
MN ¬ [5 (22)] 2 ( 2
7 20)
D C B ¬ 289 729
Proof: ¬ 1018
Statements Reasons ¬31.9
1. Construct CD so 1. Ruler Postulate LN ¬ [5 (24 )]2 [
7 (19) ]2
that C is between B ¬ 361 144
and D and C D
.
AC ¬ 505
2. CD AC 2. Definition of ¬22.5
? ?
3. CAD ADC 3. Isosceles Triangle LM MN¬ LN LM LN¬ MN
? ?
Theorem 39.1 31.9¬ 22.5 39.1 22.5¬ 31.9
4. mCAD mADC 4. Definition of 71¬ 22.5 ✓ 61.6¬ 31.9 ✓
?
angles LN MN¬ LM
?
5. mBAC 5. Angle Addition 22.5 31.9¬ 39.1
mCAD mBAD Postulate 54.4¬ 39.1 ✓
All of the inequalities are true, so the coordinates
6. mBAC 6. Substitution can be the vertices of a triangle.
mADC mBAD
43. XY ¬ (16 0)2 [12 (8 )]2
7. mADC mBAD 7. Definition of ¬ 256 16
inequality ¬ 272
8. AB BD 8. If an angle of a ¬16.49
triangle is greater YZ ¬ (28 16)2 [15 2
(12)]
than a second angle,
¬ 144 9
then the side
opposite the greater ¬ 153
angle is longer than ¬12.37
the side opposite XZ ¬ (28 0)2 [15 (8 )]2
the lesser angle. ¬ 784 49
9. BD BC CD 9. Segment Addition ¬ 833
Postulate
¬28.86
10. AB BC CD 10. Substitution
XY YZ¬ XZ
?
Chapter 5 140
?
RS RT¬ ST 8; 2, 3, 7; 2, 4, 6; and 2, 5, 5. Check each of these
?
16.5 16.5¬ 33 triples using the Triangle Inequality.
219
33¬ 33 228
Because the sum of two measures equals the 237
third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle 246
and so the coordinates cannot be the vertices of 2 5 5 and 5 5 2, so there could be a
a triangle. triangle with side lengths 2, 5, and 5 units.
45. Consider all possible triples using the lengths Determine whether any triangle can have a side
3, 4, 5, 6, and 12. with 3 segments. If one side has length 3, then
? ? ?
3 4¬ 5 4 5¬ 3 3 5¬ 4 the possible triples of side lengths are 3, 1, 8; 3, 2,
7¬ 5 ✓ 9¬ 3 ✓ 8¬ 4 ✓ 7; 3, 3, 6; and 3, 4, 5. Check each of these triples
? ? ? using the Triangle Inequality.
3 4¬ 6 4 6¬ 3 3 6¬ 4
7¬ 6 ✓ 10¬ 3 ✓ 9¬ 4 ✓ 318
3 4¬ 12 327
7¬ 12 336
? ? ? 3 4 5 and 3 5 4 and 4 5 3, so there
4 5¬ 6 4 6¬
5 5 6¬ 4
could be a triangle with side lengths 3, 4, and
9¬ 6 ✓ 10¬ 5 ✓ 11¬ 4 ✓
? 5 units.
4 5¬ 12 Determine whether any triangle can have a side
9¬ 12 with 4 segments. If one side has length 4, then
? ? ?
3 5¬ 6 5 6¬ 3 3 6¬ 5 the possible triples of side lengths are 4, 1, 7; 4, 2,
8¬ 6 ✓ 11¬ 3 ✓ 9¬ 5 ✓ 6; 4, 3, 5; and 4, 4, 4. Check each of these triples
?
3 5¬ 12 using the Triangle Inequality. Note that we have
8¬ 12 already shown that there can be a triangle with
? sides 4, 3, and 5 units.
3 6¬ 12
9¬ 12 417
? 426
4 6¬ 12
4 4 4, so there could be a triangle with side
10¬ 12
? lengths 4, 4, and 4 units.
5 6¬ 12 By examining all of the triples we have
11¬ 12 considered to this point, we can see that all
Of all possible triples, 4 of them satisfy the possible triples have been listed and checked.
triangle inequality, so there are 4 possible Therefore, there are 3 triangles that can be
triangles. formed using the rope shown in the figure.
46. 3 4 5 12, which is divisible by 3 48. 14¬ m 17, so m is either 15 or 16 feet.
3 4 6 13, which is not divisible by 3 13¬ n 17, so n is 14, 15, or 16 feet.
4 5 6 15, which is divisible by 3 Check all possible triples using the triangle
3 5 6 14, which is not divisible by 3 inequality.
Carlota could make 2 different triangles with a ? ? ?
2 15¬ 14 2 14¬ 15 14 15¬ 2
perimeter that is divisible by 3.
17¬ 14 ✓ 16¬ 15 ✓ 29¬ 2 ✓
47. The rope has 13 knots that determine 12 ? ?
2 15¬ 15 15 15¬ 2
segments of the rope. We need to determine how
17¬ 15 ✓ 30¬ 2 ✓
many triangles there are whose perimeter is 12. ? ? ?
First determine whether any triangle can have a 2 15¬ 16 2 16¬ 15 15 16¬ 2
side with 1 segment. If one side has length 1, then 17¬ 16 ✓ 18¬ 15 ✓ 31¬ 2 ✓
?
the possible triples of side lengths are 1, 1, 10; 1, 2 16¬ 14 2 14¬ 16
2, 9; 1, 3, 8; 1, 4, 7; and 1, 5, 6. Check each of these 18¬ 14 ✓ 16¬ 16
? ? ?
triples using the Triangle Inequality. 2 16¬ 15 2 15¬ 16 15 16¬ 2
1 1 10 18¬ 15 ✓ 17¬ 16 ✓ 31¬ 2 ✓
129 ?
2 16¬ 16
?
16 16¬ 2
138 18¬ 16 ✓ 32¬ 2 ✓
147 The possible triangles that can be made from
156 sides with measures 2 ft, m ft, and n ft are (2 ft,
Therefore, there is no possible triangle with one 15 ft, 14 ft), (2 ft, 15 ft, 15 ft), (2 ft, 15 ft, 16 ft),
side of length 1 and perimeter 12. and (2 ft, 16 ft, 16 ft).
Determine whether any triangle can have a side
49. Of the 4 possible triangles listed in Exercise 48, 2
with 2 segments. If one side has length 2, then 2 1
the possible triples of side lengths are 2, 1, 9; 2, 2, are isosceles, so the probability is 4 or 2.
141 Chapter 5
50. Sample answer: The length of any side of a Page 266 Maintain Your Skills
triangle is greater than the differences between 54. Given: P is a point not on line .
the lengths of the other two sides.
Prove:
PQ is the only line through P
Paragraph Proof:
perpendicular to .
By the Triangle Inequality Theorem, for ABC
with side measures a, b, and c, a b c, b
c a, and c a b. Using the Subtraction 1 Q
Property of Inequality, a c b, b a c, and P
c b a. 2 R
51. Sample answer: You can use the Triangle
Inequality Theorem to verify the shortest route Proof:
between two locations. Answers should include Statements Reasons
the following. is not the only line 1. Assumption
• A longer route might be better if you want to 1. PQ
collect frequent flier miles. through P
perpendicular to .
• A straight route might not always be available.
2. 1 and 2 are right 2. lines form 4 rt. .
52. D; If the perimeter is 29, the measure of the third angles.
side is 10.
?
7 10¬ 12
?
7 12¬ 10
?
10 12¬ 7 3. m1 90, m2 90 3. Def. of rt.
17¬ 12 ✓ 19¬ 10 ✓ 22¬ 7 ✓ 4. m1 m2 4. The sum of in a
So, 7, 12, and 10 could be the sides of a triangle mQPR 180 is 180.
with perimeter 29. 5. 90 90 mQPR 5. Substitution
If the perimeter is 34, the measure of the third 180
side is 15. 6. mQPR 0 6. Subtraction Property
? ? ?
7 15¬ 12 7 12¬ 15 12 15¬ 7
22¬ 12 ✓ 19¬ 15 ✓ 27¬ 7 ✓ This contradicts the fact that the measure of an
So, 7, 12, and 15 could be the sides of a triangle is the only line
angle is greater than 0. Thus, PQ
with perimeter 34. through P perpendicular to .
If the perimeter is 37, the measure of the third 55. mP mQ mR¬ 180
side is 18. 7x 8 8x 10 7x 6¬ 180
? ? ?
7 18¬ 12 7 12¬ 18 12 18¬ 7 22x 4¬ 180
25¬ 12 ✓ 19¬ 18 ✓ 30¬ 7 ✓ 22x¬ 176
So, 7, 12, and 18 could be the sides of a triangle x¬ 8
with perimeter 37. mP¬ 7(8) 8 or 64
If the perimeter is 38, the measure of the third mQ¬ 8(8) 10 or 54
side is 19. mR¬ 7(8) 6 or 62
?
7 12¬ 19 mP mR mQ, so the sides of PQR in
19¬ 19 order from longest to shortest are Q R, P
Q, P
R
.
So, 7, 12, and 19 cannot be the sides of a triangle. 56. mP mQ mR¬ 180
53. A; If the graphs of the equations do intersect, 3x 44 68 3x x 61¬ 180
then we can solve the system of equations and x 173¬ 180
find the coordinates of any points of intersection. x¬ 7
Substitute x for y in the equation (x 5)2 mP 3(7) 44 or 65
( y 5)2 4 and solve for x. mQ 68 3(7) or 47
(x 5)2 [(x) 5]2¬ 4 mR 7 61 or 68
x 10x 25 x2 10x 25¬ 4
2 mR mP mQ, so the sides of PQR in
2x2 50¬ 4 order from longest to shortest are P Q
, QR, P
R
.
2x2¬ 46 57. JK ¬ (0 0)2 (0 5)2
x2¬ 23 ¬ 0 25 or¬5
Because there is no real number x whose square PQ ¬ (4 4
)2 (3 8)2
is equal to 23, there are no points of
¬ 0 25¬or¬5
intersection.
KL ¬ (2 0)2 (0 0)2
¬ 4 0¬or¬2
QR ¬ (6 4)2 (3 3)2
¬ 4 0¬or¬2
JL ¬ (2 0)2 (0 5)2
¬ 4 25¬or 29
PR ¬ (6 4)2 (3 8)2
¬ 4 25¬or 29
The corresponding sides have the same measure
and are congruent. JKL PQR by SSS.
Chapter 5 142
58. JK ¬ (1 6)2 (6 4)2 4. Given:
MO¬ O
N
¬ 25 1 00 or 125 P
M ¬ N
P
Prove: MOP NOP
PQ (5 0)2 (3 7)2
¬ 25 1 00 or 125 O
KL ¬ (9 1)2 [5 (
6)]2 M
¬ 100 121 or 221
P
QR ¬ (15 5)2 2
[8 (3)] N
¬ 100 121 or 221
Proof:
JL ¬ (9 6)2 (5 4)2
Step 1 Assume that MOP NOP.
¬ 225 1 or 226
Step 2 We know that M OO N, and O
P
O P by
PR ¬ (15 0)2 (8 7)2 the Reflexive Property. If MOP NOP,
¬ 225 1 or 226 then MOP NOP by SAS. Then, M P
The corresponding sides have the same measure P
N by CPCTC.
and are congruent. JKL PQR by SSS. Step 3 The conclusion that MPN P
contradicts
59. JK ¬ [1 (
6)]2 [5 (3)]2 the given information. Thus, the
¬ 49 6 4 or 113 assumption is false. Therefore, MOP
NOP.
PQ ¬ (5 2)2 [4 ( 11)]2
5. Given: mADC mADB
¬ 9 49 or 58
D
Prove: A is not an altitude of ABC.
KL ¬ (2 1)2 (2 5)2
A
¬ 1 49 or 50
QR ¬ (10 5)2 [10 (4)] 2
¬ 25 3 6 or 61
JL ¬ [2 (
6)]2 [2 (3 )]2 C D B
¬ 64 1 or 65 Proof:
PR ¬ (10 2)2 [10 (1 1)]2
Statements Reasons
¬ 64 1 or 65
1.
AD is an altitude of 1. Assumption
The corresponding sides are not congruent, so the
ABC.
triangles are not congruent.
2. ADC and ADB are 2. Def. of altitude
60. 3x 54¬ 90
right angles.
3x¬ 36
x¬ 12 3. ADC ADB 3. All rt are .
61. 8x 14¬ 3x 19 4. mADC mADB 4. Def. of angles
5x 14¬ 19
5x¬ 33 This contradicts the given information that
x¬ 6.6 mADC mADB. Thus, A D
is not an altitude
62. 4x 7¬ 180 of ABC.
4x¬ 173 6. Check each inequality.
? ? ?
x¬ 43.25 7 24¬ 25 7 25¬ 24 24 25¬ 7
31¬ 25 ✓ 32¬ 24 ✓ 49¬ 7 ✓
All of the inequalities are true, so 7, 24, and 25
Page 266 Practice Quiz 2 can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
?
1. The number 117 is not divisible by 13. 7. 25 35¬ 60
2. mC mD 60¬ 60
Because the sum of two measures equals the
3. Step 1 Assume that x
8.
third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle.
Step 2 7x¬ 56
x¬ 8 8. Check each inequality.
? ? ?
Step 3 The solution of 7x 56 contradicts the 3 18¬ 20 18 20¬ 3 3 20¬ 18
assumption. Thus, x
8 must be false. Therefore, 21¬ 20 ✓ 38¬ 3 ✓ 23¬ 18 ✓
x 8. All of the inequalities are true, so 20, 3, and 18
can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
9. Check each inequality.
? ? ?
5 10¬ 6 5 6¬ 10 6 10¬ 5
15¬ 6 ✓ 11¬ 10 ✓ 16¬ 5 ✓
All of the inequalities are true, so 5, 10, and 6 can
be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
143 Chapter 5
10. Let the measure of the third side be n. Also, the measure of any angle is always greater
57 32¬ n 57 n¬ 32 32 n¬ 57 than 0.
89¬ n or n 89 n¬ 25 n¬ 25 7x 4¬ 0
Graph the inequalities on the same number line. 7x¬ 4
x¬ 4
7
30 20 10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
The two inequalities can be written as the
n¬ 89
compound inequality 47 x 7 .
13
6
30 25 20 10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90 7. Given: P Q
S Q
n¬ 25 Prove: PR SR
P S
30 20 10 0 10 20 25 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
n¬ 25 T
30 20 10 0 10 20 25 30 40 50 60 70 80 89 90
5-5 R
2. QQ
R
2. Reflexive Property
Inequalities Involving Two
3. mPQR mPQS 3. Angle Addition
Triangles mSQR Postulate
4. mPQR mSQR 4. Def. of inequality
Pages 270–271 Check for Understanding 5. PR SR 5. SAS Inequality
1. Sample answer: A pair of scissors illustrates the
SSS inequality. As the distance between the tips 8. Given:
TUUS
; U
S
S
V
of the scissors decreases, the angle between the Prove: ST UV
blades decreases, allowing the blades to cut. S
2. The SSS Inequality Theorem compares the angle
between two sides of a triangle for which the two
sides are congruent and the third side is different.
The SSS Postulate states that two triangles that T U V
have three sides congruent are congruent.
3. In BDC and BDA, B CA D
, B
DB D
, and Proof:
mBDA mCBD. The SAS Inequality Theorem Statements Reasons
allows us to conclude that AB CD. U
1. TU
S
, U
S
S
V
1. Given
4. In PQS and RQS, R QP Q
, Q
S
Q S
, and 2. mSUT mUSV 2. Ext. Inequality
PS RS. The SSS Inequality Theorem allows us Theorem
to conclude that mPQS mRQS.
3. ST UV 3. SAS Inequality
5. The upper triangle is equilateral and so all angles
are 60 degrees. The SAS inequality allows us to 9. Sample answer: The pliers are an example of the
conclude that x 5 3x 7. SAS inequality. As force is applied to the handles,
x 5¬ 3x 7 the angle between them decreases causing the
5¬ 2x 7 distance between them to decrease. As the
12¬ 2x distance between the ends of the pliers decreases,
6¬ x more force is applied to a smaller area.
Also, the measure of any side is greater than 0.
3x 7¬ 0
3x¬ 7 Pages 271–273 Practice and Apply
x¬ 7
3 10. From the figure, AB 9 and FD 6, so AB FD.
The two inequalities can be written as the 11. In BDC and FDB, F D
D C, B
DBD, and
compound inequality 7 3 x 6.
BC BF. The SSS Inequality allows us to
6. Because 12 8, the SSS Inequality allows us to conclude that mBDC mFDB.
conclude 140 7x 4. 12. In BFA and DBF, A BBD, B
FBF, and
140¬ 7x 4 AF FD. The SSS Inequality allows us to
136¬ 7x conclude that mFBA mDBF.
13
6
7 ¬ x 13. In ABD and CBD, B C
B A, B
D
B D, and
mABD mCBD. The SAS Inequality allows
us to conclude that AD DC.
Chapter 5 144
14. In ABO and CBO, A BC B
, O
BO B, and 20. Given: ABC, A
B
C
D
mCBO mABO. The SAS Inequality allows Prove: BC AD
us to conclude that OC OA. B
15. In ABC, A BC B so ABC is isosceles with 2
base angles of measure 1 2 [180 (40 60)] or 40.
mAOB ¬180 (mOAB mABO)
1
¬180 (40 60) A C
D
¬80
mAOD ¬180 mAOB Proof:
¬100 Statements Reasons
Therefore, mAOD mAOB. 1. ABC, A
B
C
D
1. Given
16. By the SAS Inequality, 10 3x 2. D
2. BB
D
2. Reflexive Property
10¬ 3x 2
12¬ 3x 3. m1 m2 3. If an is an ext. of a
4¬ x or x 4 , then its measure is
greater than the
17. The triangle on the left is equilateral, so all
measure of either remote
angles have measure 60. Then by the SAS
int. .
inequality, x 2 2x 8.
x 2¬ 2x 8 4. BC AD 4. SAS Inequality
2¬ x 8
10¬ x Q
21. Given: P R
S, QR PS
The measure of any side is always greater than 0. Prove: m3 m1
2x 8¬ 0 Q R
2x¬ 8 1 2
x¬ 4
The two inequalities can be written as the 3
4
compound inequality 4 x 10. P S
C
18. M M C , so by the SSS Inequality m1 m2. Proof:
5x 20¬ 8x 100
Statements Reasons
20¬ 3x 100
120¬ 3x Q
1. PR
S
1. Given
40¬ x 2.
QSQS
2. Reflexive Property
The measure of any angle is always greater 3. QR PS 3. Given
than 0.
4. m3 m1 4. SSS Inequality
8x 100¬ 0
8x¬ 100
x¬ 12.5
The two inequalities can be written as the
compound inequality 12.5 x 40.
19. RTV TRV, so RVT is isosceles and
V
R T V
. S
VS V and RS ST, so by the SSS
Inequality, mRVS mSVT.
15 5x¬ 10x 20
15¬ 5x 20
35¬ 5x
7¬ x
The measure of SVT is less than 180.
10x 20¬ 180
10x¬ 200
x¬ 20
The two inequalities can be written as the
compound inequality 7 x 20.
145 Chapter 5
R
22. Given: P P
Q
, SQ SR 7. AE AF 7. Def. of segments
Prove: m1 m2
8. AE EC AE FB 8. Add. Prop. of
P
Inequality
9. AE EC AF FB 9. Substitution
S
1 2 10. AE EC AC, AF 10. Segment Add. Post.
R 4 3
Q FB AB
11. AC AB 11. Substitution
Proof:
Statements Reasons
S
24. Given: R ¬ U
W
R
11. PPQ
11. Given
T
S¬ WV
12. PRQ PQR 12. If two sides of RT¬ UV
are , the angles Prove: mS mW
opposite the
sides are . R U
13. mPRQ m1 13. Angle Add. Post.
m4, mPQR
m2 m3 S T W V
14. mPRQ mPQR 14. Def. of angles
15. m1 m4 m2 15. Substitution Indirect Proof:
m3 Step 1 Assume mS
mW.
16. SQ SR 16. Given Step 2 If mS
mW, then either mS mW
or mS mW.
17. m4 m3 17. If one side of a
is longer than Case 1: If mS mW, then RT UV by the
another side, SAS Inequality.
then the Case 2: If mS mW, then RST UWV by
opposite the SAS, and R T
U V
by CPCTC. Thus
longer side is RT UV.
greater than the Step 3 Both cases contradict the given RT UV.
opposite the Therefore, the assumption must be false,
shorter side. and the conclusion, mS mW, must be
true.
18. m4 m3 x 18. Def. of inequality
25. As the door is opened wider, the angle formed
19. m1 m3 x 19. Substitution increases and the distance from the end of the
m2 m3 door to the door frame increases.
10. m1 x m2 10. Subtraction Prop. 26. By the SAS Inequality Theorem, if the tree
11. m1 m2 11. Def. of inequality started to lean, one of the angles of the triangle
formed by the tree, the ground, and the stake
23. Given:
EDD F; m1 m2; D is the midpoint would change, and the side opposite that angle
B
of C; A
E
A F
. would change as well. However, with the stake in
Prove: AC AB the ground and fixed to the tree, none of the sides
of the triangle can change length. Thus, none of
A the angles can change. This ensures that the tree
E will stay straight.
F
27. As the vertex angle increases, the base angles
2 1 decrease. Thus, as the base angles decrease, the
B C altitude of the triangle decreases.
D
0.78s 1.67
Proof: 28. v ¬
1.17
h
Statements Reasons 0.78(1.0)1.67
¬
0.851.17
1. D
ED F; D is the 1. Given
¬0.94 m/s
B
midpoint of D.
0.78s 1.67
2. CD BD 2. Def. of midpoint v ¬
1.17
h
0.78(1.2) 1.67
D
3. CB
D
3. Def. of segments ¬
1.17
0.85
4. m1 m2 4. Given ¬1.28 m/s
5. EC FB 5. SAS Inequality
E
6. AA
F
6. Given
Chapter 5 146
29.
0.78s 1.67 D
39. Given: A bisects B
E
; A
B
D
E
.
Stride (m) v
1.17 Velocity (m/s) Prove: ABC DEC
h
0.78(0.25)1.67 B
0.25 0.07 D
1.11.17
0.78(0.50)1.67 C
0.50 0.22
1.11.17 A
E
0.78(0.75)1.67
0.75 0.43
1.11.17 Proof:
0.78(1.00)1.67
Statements Reasons
1.00 0.70
1.11.17 1.
AD bisects B
E
; 1. Given
0.78(1.25)1.67 B
A
DE.
1.25 1.01
1.11.17 C
2. BE
C
2. Def. of seg. bisector
0.78(1.50)1.67
1.50 1.37 3. B E 3. Alt. int. Thm.
1.11.17
4. BCA ECD 4. Vert. are .
30. As the length of the stride increases, the angle
5. ABC DEC 5. ASA
formed at the hip increases.
31. Sample answer: A backhoe digs when the angle M
40. Given: O bisects LMN; L
MM
N
.
between the two arms decreases and the shovel Prove: MOL MON
moves through the dirt. Answers should include
the following. N
• As the operator digs, the angle between the O
arms decreases.
• The distance between the ends of the arms M L
increases as the angle between the arms
increases, and decreases as the angle decreases. Proof:
32. B; AD BD by definition of a median. Statements Reasons
AC BC since m1 m2 and by the SAS 1.
OM bisects LMN; 1. Given
Inequality. M
LM N.
m1 mB because if an is an
2. LMO NMO 2. Def. of bisector
ext. of a , then its measure is greater than the
measure of either remote int. . M
3. OO
M
3. Reflexive Prop.
mADC m1 and mBDC m2, and m1
4. MOL MON 4. SAS
m2 is given, so mADC mBDC.
The correct answer is B.
41. EF ¬
(4 4
)2 (1
1 6)2
1(99.50 88.95 95.90 102.45)
33. B;
2
4 48.35 ¬
0 25 or 5
FG ¬
(9 4)
2 (6
11)2
¬ or 50
25 25
Page 273 Maintain Your Skills EG ¬
(9 4)
2 (6
6)2
34. no; 1 21 25
? ? ? ¬25 0 or 5
35. yes; 16 6¬ 19 6 19¬ 16 16 19¬ 6 EFG is isosceles.
22¬ 19 ✓ 25¬ 16 ✓ 35¬ 6 ✓
42. EF ¬
[15
(7)]2
(0
10)2
36. no; 8 7 15
D
37. A is a not a median of ABC. ¬
484
100 or 584
38. The triangle is not isosceles. FG ¬
(2
15)2
(1
0)2
¬
289
1 or 290
EG ¬
[2
(7)]2
(
1 10
)2
¬ or 146
25 121
EFG is scalene.
43. EF ¬
(7 1
6)2
(6 1
4)2
¬ or 145
81 64
FG ¬
(5
7)2
(14
6)2
¬
144
400 or 544
EG ¬
(5
16)2
(14
14)2
¬441 784 or 35
EFG is scalene.
147 Chapter 5
44. EF ¬
(12
9)2
(14
9)2 15. mQDR mRDS ¬180
mQDR 110 ¬180
¬
9 25 or 34
mQDR ¬70
FG ¬
(14
12)2 2
(6 14) mQRD mQDR mRQD ¬180
¬
4 64 or 68
mQRD 70 73 ¬180
EG ¬
(14
9)2
(6 9)2 mQRD ¬37
The angle opposite D Q
has a smaller measure
¬25 9 or 34 than the angle opposite D R, so DQ DR.
EFG is isosceles.
16. mQRP ¬37 (see exercise 15)
45. Let p, q be the parts of the statement.
mQPR ¬27
p: it has to be special
In PQR, the angle opposite P Q
has a greater
q: it has to be Wildflowers
measure than the angle opposite Q R
, so PQ QR.
The statement p is true, so it follows that
Catalina should go to Wildflowers by the Law of 17. mSRQ ¬mSRD mDRQ
Detachment. ¬34 37
¬71
The angle opposite S R
has a greater measure
than the angle opposite S Q
, so SR SQ.
Chapter 5 Study Guide and Review 18. 2 is a rational number.
19. The triangles are not congruent.
20. Assume that Miguel completed at most 20 passes
Page 274 Vocabulary and Concept Check in each of the five games in which he played. If
1. incenter we let p1, p2, p3, p4, and p5 be the number of
2. median passes Miguel completed in games 1, 2, 3, 4,
3. Triangle Inequality Theorem and 5, respectively, then
4. centroid p1 p2 p3 p4 p5 ¬the total number of
5. angle bisector passes Miguel completed
¬101.
6. perpendicular bisectors
Because we have assumed that he completed at
7. orthocenter most 20 passes in each of the five games,
p1
20 and p2
20 and p3
20 and p4
20 and
p5
20.
Pages 274–276 Lesson-by-Lesson Review Then, by a property of inequalities,
8. mACQ ¬mQCB p1 p2 p3 p4 p5
20 20 20 20 20
mQCB ¬1
or 100 passes.
2 mACB But this says that Miguel completed at most
42 x ¬1
2 (123 x)
100 passes this season, which contradicts the
42 x ¬61.5 2x information we were given, that he completed
101 passes. So our assumption must be false.
42 3
2 x ¬61.5
Thus, Miguel completed more than 20 passes in at
3x ¬19.5 least one game this season.
2
?
x ¬13 21. no; 7 5 ¬20
mACQ 42 13 or 55 12 ¬20
9. AR RB Because the sum of two measures is less than the
3x 6 ¬5x 14 third measure, the sides cannot form a triangle.
6 ¬2x 14 22. Check each inequality.
? ? ?
20 ¬2x 16 20¬ 5 16 5¬ 20 20 5¬ 16
10 ¬x 36¬ 5 ✓ 21¬ 20 ✓ 25¬ 16 ✓
AB ¬AR AB All of the inequalities are true, so 16, 20, and 5
¬3(10) 6 5(10) 14 can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
¬72 23. Check each inequality.
? ? ?
10. mAPC ¬90 18 20¬ 6 18 6¬ 20 20 6¬ 18
72 x ¬90 38¬ 6 ✓ 24¬ 20 ✓ 26¬ 18 ✓
x ¬18 All of the inequalities are true, so 18, 20, and 6
11. The side opposite DEF is longer than the side can be the lengths of the sides of a triangle.
opposite DFE, so mDEF mDFE. 24. In BAM and DAM, A B
A D
, AM
A M, and
12. The side opposite GDF is shorter than the side BM DM. The SSS Inequality allows us to
opposite DGF, so mGDF mDGF. conclude that mBAC mDAC.
13. The side opposite DEF is longer than the side 25. In BMC and DCM, B M
C D, MCM C , and
opposite FDE, so mDEF mFDE. mBMC mDCM. The SAS Inequality allows
14. R
The angle opposite S has a greater measure us to conclude that BC MD.
D
than the angle opposite S, so SR SD.
Chapter 5 148
26. Using the SSS Inequality, 54 28 so 41 x 20 But this says that Marcus spent less than one
or 21 x. x 20 0, so x 20. The two and one-half hours on a teleconference over the
inequalities can be written as the compound three days, which contradicts the information we
inequality 20 x 21. were given. So we must abandon our assumption.
27. In the upper triangle, the bottom angle has Thus, Marcus spent at least one half-hour on a
measure 90 60 or 30, so the upper left angle has teleconference, on at least one of the three days.
measure 180 (95 30) or 55. Then by the SAS 13. Let the measure of the third side be n.
Inequality, 5x 3 3x 17. 1 14¬ n 1 n¬ 14 14 n¬ 1
5x 3¬ 3x 17 15¬ n or n 15 n¬ 13 n¬ 13
2x 3¬ 17 Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
2x¬ 14
x¬ 7 15 12 9 6 3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18
n¬ 15
15 12 9 6 3 0 3 6 9 12 13 15 18
15 13 12 9 6 3 0 3 6 9 12 15 18
Page 277 n¬ 13
1. b
15 12 9 6 3 0 3 6 9 12 13 15 18
2. c
3. a Find the intersection.
The range of values that fit all three inequalities
4. HP PJ
is 13 n 15.
5x 16 ¬3x 8
2x 16 ¬8 14. Let the measure of the third side be n.
2x ¬24 14 11¬ n 14 n¬ 11 11 n¬ 14
x ¬12 25¬ n or n 25 n¬ 3 n¬ 3
HJ ¬HP PJ Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
¬5(12) 16 3(12) 8
3 1 0 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25
¬88
n¬ 25
5. mGJN ¬mNJH
6y 3 ¬4y 23 3 1 0 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25
2y 3 ¬23 n¬ 3
2y ¬26
y ¬13 3 1 0 1 3 5 7 9 11 13 15 17 19 21 23 25
149 Chapter 5
17. x 7¬ 11 7 11 20, so 7, 11, 20 cannot be the measures
x¬ 4 of the sides of the triangle.
7 11¬ 2x 9 13 26, so 9, 13, 26 cannot be the measures
18¬ 2x of the sides of the triangle.
9¬ x 9. The ramp rises 2 feet as it runs 24 feet, so the
4x9 slope is 2 1
24 or
12.
18. In the two triangles, each has a side of measure
10. x 55¬ 90
12 and the shared side is congruent to itself. The
x¬ 35
hypotenuse of the right triangle has a length of
13.86, which is shorter than the third length of C
11. The point P is the midpoint of B with
8
8 2 10
the other triangle, 14. So the SSS Inequality
allows us to conclude that x 90. In any triangle,
coordinates
2 , 2 (8, 6).
Chapter 5 150
Chapter 6 Proportions and Similarity
Page 281 Getting Started
1. 2
6-1 Proportions
3 y 4 ¬6
2 y ¬10
3
y ¬3
Pages 284–285 Check for Understanding
2 (10) or 15
1. Cross multiply and divide by 28.
5 x
¬ 4
2. 2. Sample answer: 5 0 5 4
1
4 8 , 10 8
6 12
x
12 5
6 ¬12 12
4
3. Suki; Madeline did not find the cross products
10 ¬x 4 correctly.
14 ¬x number of goals
9
4. 12 or 3 : 4
y2 number of games
3. 4 ¬
3 y1 height of replica
10 in
ches
5. ¬ 10 feet
4(y 1) ¬3(y 2) height of statue
4y 4 ¬3y 6 ¬10 in
ches
y 4 ¬6 120 inches
y ¬10 1
¬
12
2y 32
4. 4 ¬y
6. x ¬
11
5 35
2y2 ¬128 35x ¬5(11)
y2 ¬64 35x ¬55
y ¬8 11
x ¬
7
(y y ) 2.3
2
5. m ¬ 1
x
4 ¬ 3.7
7.
(x2 x1)
2.3(3.7) ¬4x
5
¬ 013 8.51 ¬4x
6
¬3
2.1275 ¬x
¬2 x
2 4
8. 2 ¬5
(y y )
2
6. m ¬
1 5(x 2) ¬2(4)
(x2 x1) 5x 10 ¬8
3 (3) 5x ¬18
¬ 2 (
6)
0 x ¬3.6
¬8
9. Rewrite 9 : 8 : 7 as 9x : 8x : 7x and use those
¬0 measures for the sides of the triangle. Write an
2 (y y )
1 equation to represent the perimeter of the
7. m ¬
(x2 x1) triangle as the sum of the measures of its sides.
¬2 4 9x 8x 7x ¬144
2 (
3) 24x ¬144
¬6
5
x ¬6
8. yes; congruent alternate exterior angles Use this value of x to find the measures of the
sides of the triangle.
9. yes; congruent alternate interior angles
9x 9(6) or 54 units
10. No; 5 and 3 do not have a relationship that 8x 8(6) or 48 units
could be used to determine whether the lines are 7x 7(6) or 42 units
parallel.
10. Rewrite 5 : 7 : 8 as 5x : 7x : 8x and use those
11. 21 2 measures for the angles of the triangle. Write an
22 4 equation to represent the sum of the angle
23 8 measures of the triangle.
24 16 5x 7x 8x ¬180
12. 12 2 1 2 1 20x ¬180
22 2 4 2 2 x ¬9
32 2 9 2 7 Use this value of x to find the measures of the
42 2 16 2 14 angles of the triangle.
13. 31 2 3 2 1 5x 5(9) or 45
32 2 9 2 7 7x 7(9) or 63
33 2 27 2 25 8x 8(9) or 72
34 2 81 2 79
151 Chapter 6
scale on map (cm) distance on map (cm) 21. Rewrite 3 : 4 : 5 as 3x : 4x : 5x and use those
11. ¬ measures for the sides of the triangle.
distance represented (mi) actual distance (mi)
1.5 2.4 3x 4x 5x ¬72
0 ¬x
20 12x ¬72
1.5x ¬200(2.4) x ¬6
1.5x ¬480 Use this value of x to find the measures of the
x ¬320 sides of the triangle.
The cities are 320 miles apart. 3x 3(6) or 18 in.
4x 4(6) or 24 in.
5x 5(6) or 30 in.
Pages 285–287 Practice and Apply 22. Rewrite 1
1 1 x x x
2 : 3 : 5 as 2 : 3 : 5 and use those
number of hits 8
number of games
12. 10 or 4 : 5 measures for the sides of the triangle.
number of boys 76 x x x ¬6.2
13. or 76 : 89
165 76
2 3 5
number of girls
number of rands 208
30 2x 3x 5x ¬30(6.2)
number of dollars
14. 18 or 104 : 9 15x 10x 6x ¬186
44,125
number of students 31x ¬186
15.
number of teachers or about 25.3 : 1
1747 x ¬6
AC 20 0
16.
BH 70 10
Use this value of x to find the measures of the
20 sides of the triangle.
60 or 1 : 3
x 6
2 2 or 3 cm
17. Rewrite 3 : 4 as 3x : 4x and use those measures
for the two lengths of cable. x 6 or 2 cm
3 3
3x 4x ¬42 x 6
5 5 or 1.2 cm
7x ¬42
height of the door 15
x ¬6 23. 3
Alice’s height in Wonderland 10 or 2
Use this value of x to find the measures of the two
height of the door
lengths of cable. 24.
Alice’s height in Wonderland
3x 3(6) or 18 ft
4x 4(6) or 24 ft height of door in Alice’s normal world
¬
Alice’s normal height
18. Rewrite 2 : 5 : 3 as 2x : 5x : 3x and use those 15 x
¬
measures for the angles of the triangle. 10 50
2x 5x 3x ¬180 15(50) ¬10x
10x ¬180 750 ¬10x
x ¬18 75 ¬x
Use this value of x to find the measures of the The height of the door in Alice’s normal world
angles of the triangle. would be about 75 inches.
2x 2(18) or 36 Lincoln’s height in model 8 i
n.
25. ¬
5x 5(18) or 90 Lincoln’s height in theater 6 ft 4 in.
3x 3(18) or 54 8 in.
¬
76
in.
19. Rewrite 6 : 9 : 10 as 6x : 9x : 10x and use those ¬2 : 19
measures for the angles of the triangle. number of people in United States
6x 9x 10x ¬180 26.
number of pounds of ice cream consumed
25x ¬180
number of people in Raleigh, NC
x ¬7.2 ¬
number of pounds of ice cream
Use this value of x to find the measures of the 255,082,000 276,000
angles of the triangle. 44,800 ¬x
4,183,3
6x ¬6(7.2) or 43.2 255,082,000x ¬1,154,603,165,000,000
9x ¬9(7.2) or 64.8 x ¬4,526,400
10x ¬10(7.2) or 72
The people of Raleigh, North Carolina, might
20. Rewrite 8 : 7 : 5 as 8x : 7x : 5x and use those consume 4,526,400 pounds of ice cream.
measures for the sides of the triangle.
number of people in United States
8x 7x 5x ¬240 27.
number of pounds of ice cream consumed
20x ¬240
1 person
x ¬12 ¬
number of pounds of ice cream
Use this value of x to find the measures of the 255,082,000 1
sides of the triangle. 44,800 ¬x
4,183,3
8x 8(12) or 96 ft 255,082,000x ¬4,183,344,800
7x 7(12) or 84 ft x ¬16.4
5x 5(12) or 60 ft One person consumed about 16.4 pounds of ice
cream.
Chapter 6 152
28. 3 ¬5
x 38c. The ratio 4 : 5 : 4 : 5 indicates that there are four
8
3(5) 8x sides, and opposite sides are congruent. This
15 ¬8x description fits a rectangle or a parallelogram.
15 39. Sample answer: It appears that Tiffany used
8 ¬x
rectangles with areas that were in proportion as a
a ¬1
29.
5.18 4 background for this artwork. Answers should
4a ¬5.18(1) include the following.
a ¬1.295 • The center column pieces are to the third
3x 48 column from the left pieces as the pieces from
30. 3 ¬
2
92 the third column are to the pieces in the outside
3x(92) ¬23(48) column.
276x ¬1104 • The dimensions are approximately 24 inches by
x ¬4 34 inches.
13 2
6
49 ¬ 7x
31. 1.6
18 12
40. 1 ¬ x
13(7x) ¬49(26)
1.618x¬ 12
91x ¬1274
x ¬7.4 cm
x ¬14
41. D; the ratio of wheat to rice to oats is 3 : 1 : 2, so
2x 13 4
32. 28 ¬7 the ratio of wheat to oats is 3 : 2.
(2x 13)(7) ¬28(4) 3 ¬x
2 120
14x 91 ¬112
3(120) ¬2x
14x ¬21
360 ¬2x
x ¬3
2 180 ¬x
4x 3
33.
12 ¬5
4
180 pounds of wheat will be used. The answer is D.
(4x 3)(4) ¬12(5)
16x 12 ¬60
16x ¬48 Page 287 Maintain Your Skills
x ¬3 42. always; m1 m2 ¬180
b 1 3x 50 x 30 ¬180
5
b 1 ¬ 6
34.
4x 20 ¬180
(b 1)(6) ¬(b 1)(5) 4x ¬200
6b 6 ¬5b 5 x ¬50
b 6 ¬5 m1 ¬3(50) 50
b ¬11 ¬150 50 or 100
3x 1 2 m2 ¬50 30 or 80
2 ¬
35. x
2
(3x 1)(x 2) ¬4 So, m1 m2, and by the SAS Inequality
3x2 6x x 2 ¬4 LS SN.
3x2 5x 2 ¬0 43. Always; PNO is an exterior angle of SNO, so
(3x 2)(x 1) ¬0 mPNO m2. Then by the SAS Inequality,
3x 2 ¬0 or x10 OP SN.
3x ¬2 x 1 44. never; m1 m2 ¬180
2
x ¬ 3
3x 50 x 30 ¬180
4x 20 ¬180
36. The larger dimension of the photograph is
4x ¬200
27.5 cm, so reducing this dimension to 10 cm will
x ¬50
give the maximum dimensions of the reduced
photograph. 45. Let the measure of the third side be x.
27
.5 21
.3 16 31 ¬x 16 x ¬31 31 x ¬16
10 ¬ x
47 ¬x or x 47 x ¬15 x ¬15
27.5x ¬10(21.3) Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
27.5x ¬213
x ¬7.75 15 10 5 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 35 40 45 47 50
153 Chapter 6
Find the intersection. YZ (6 4)2 (3 3)2
The range of values that fit all three inequalities 22 02
is 15 x 47. 4 or 2
46. Let the measure of the third side be x. SU (2 0)2 (0 5)2
26 40 ¬x 26 x ¬40 40 x ¬26 (2)2 (5)2
66 ¬x or x 66 x ¬14 x ¬14 29
Graph the inequalities on the same number line. XZ (6 4)2 (3 8)2
2 (
2 5) 2
20 10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 66 70 80 90
29
x 66
STU XYZ by SSS.
20 10 0 10 14 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
49. Start at P(3, 4). Move up 3 units and then
x 14 move right 5 units. Draw the line through this
point and P.
20 14 10 0 10 20 30 40 50 60 70 80 90
y
x 14
20 10 0 10 14 20 30 40 50 60 66 70 80 90
O x
Find the intersection.
The range of values that fit all three inequalities
is 14 x 66. P( 3, 4)
47. Let the measure of the third side be x.
11 23 ¬x 11 x ¬23 23 x ¬11 .
50. Plot points A(5, 3) and B(1, 8). Draw line AB
34 ¬x or x 34 x ¬12 x ¬12 y
Graph the inequalities on the same numer line.
B
( 1, 8)
15 10 5 0 5 10 15 20 25 30 34 35 40
x 34
15 10 5 0 5 10 12 15 20 25 30 35 40
A(5, 3)
x 12
O x
Chapter 6 154
Start at S(8, 1). Move down 5 units and then 2. See students’ drawings. Sample counterexample:
move right 4 units. Draw the line through this A rectangle with consecutive sides of 4 in. and
point and S. 12 in. would not have sides proportional to a
y rectangle with consecutive sides of 6 in. and 8 in.
because 4 12
6 8 .
3. If two polygons are congruent, then they are
similar. All of the corresponding angles are
congruent, and the ratio of measures of the
corresponding sides is 1. Two similar figures have
S (8, 1) congruent angles, and the sides are in proportion,
O x
but not always congruent. If the scale factor is 1,
then the figures are congruent.
53. Yes; 100 km and 62 mi are the same length, so
4. PQR and GHI each have two angles with
AB CD. By the definition of congruent
measure 60, so the third angle of each triangle
segments, AB
C D
.
must also have measure 60. Thus, P Q R
54. d ¬(x
x )2 (y2
y1)2 PQ QR
RP
2 1
G H I and 3
GH HI IG 7 ,
AB ¬
(8 12)2 (3 3
)2 so PQR GHI.
¬
(20)2 0 2
5. From the diagram, A E, B F,
¬400
or 20.0 C G, and D H.
55. d ¬
(x2
x1)2 (y2 y1)2 AD CB
4 2
EH GF 6 or 3
CD ¬
(5 0)
2 (1
2 0)2 DC BA 3 or 2
G
FE
H 9 3
¬
5 12
2 2 2
¬169
or 13.0 The ratios of the measures of the corresponding
sides are equal, and the corresponding angles are
56. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2
congruent, so parallelogram ABCD parallelogram
2 45
2
(1)
2 2
1 EFGH.
EF ¬
6. Use the congruent angles to write the
¬1.22 0.52
corresponding vertices in order: ACB DFE.
¬1.69
or 1.3 Write a proportion to find x.
57. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 AC C
B
F ¬
D FE
2
GH ¬ (4 3)2 2
3
7 7
21 27
x ¬ 18
¬1
2
2
5
7
21(18) ¬27x
378 ¬27x
25
¬ 1
49
14 ¬x
So, DF 14.
¬
74
AC 21 3
The scale factor is
DF
49 14 or 2 .
¬1.2 7. Use the congruent angles to write the corres-
ponding vertices in order: polygon ABCD
polygon EFGH. Write a proportion to find x.
DA BA
Page 288 Spreadsheet Investigation: Fibonacci HE ¬ FE
Sequence and Ratios 10 14
3 ¬ x 5
x
1. It increases also.
10(x 5) ¬(x 3)(14)
2. odd-odd-even
10x 50 ¬14x 42
3. It approaches 1.618. 10x 92 ¬14x
4. The increase in terms confirms the original 92 ¬4x
observations. 23 ¬x
5. As the number of terms increases, the ratio of EF x 5
each term to its preceding term approaches the 23 5 or 28
golden ratio. EH x 3
23 3 or 20
GF EF
CB AB
6-2 Similar Polygons GF 28
16
14
G
F
2, so GF 2(16) or 32.
16
Pages 292–293 Check for Understanding DA 10 1
1. Both students are correct. One student has
The scale factor is
HE
20 or 2 .
inverted the ratio and reversed the order of the
comparison.
155 Chapter 6
8. Write proportions for finding side measures. DB 2 3
MP 513 or 8
new length → x 1
original length → 60 4 BC 4 3
PN 1023 or 8
4x ¬60
CD
3
NM 8
x ¬15
new height → y 1 The ratios of the measures of the corresponding
original height → 40 4 sides are equal, and the corresponding angles are
4y ¬40 congruent, so BCD PNM.
y ¬10 2
height of replica 3503 feet
The new length is 15 cm, and the new height is 15. 1052 feet
height of actual tower
10 cm.
1
3
9. Write proportions for finding side measures.
new first side → x The scale factor is 1
3.
5
original first side → 3 8
16. The first copy is 80% or
10 of the original. The
x 15
second copy must be 100% or 1 of the original.
new second side → y
5 second copy 1
original second side → 5 8
first copy 10
y 25 10
new third side → z
8
5 1.25
original third side → 4
z 20 Use a scale factor of 1.25 or 125%.
The new side lengths are 15 m, 25 m, and 20 m, 17. Use the congruent angles to write the
so the perimeter is 15 m 25 m 20 m 60 m. corresponding vertices in order: polygon ABCD
polygon EFGH. Write a proportion to find x.
10. See students’ drawings. The drawings will be
AB CD
EF ¬ GH
similar since the measures of the corresponding
sides will be proportional and the corresponding x 1 x
8 ¬5 1
angles will be congruent.
(x 1)(5) ¬8(x 1)
5x 5 ¬8x 8
5 ¬3x 8
13 ¬3x
6.56 cm 13
3 ¬x
AB x 1
13 1
6
3 1 or 3
Chapter 6 156
19. Use the congruent angles to write the 22. The enlargement process E can be represented by
corresponding vertices in order: ABE ACD.
Write a proportion to find x.
the equation E 5
5
4 4x .
AB AE 23. 5
5 25
4 4 16
AC ¬ AD
10 6.25 24. Explore: Every millimeter represents 1 meter.
10 x 2 ¬ 6.25 x 1
The dimensions of the field are about 69 meters
10
¬ 6.2 5 by 105 meters.
x 12 x 5.25
Plan: Create a proportion relating each
10(x 5.25) ¬(x 12)(6.25)
measurement to the scale to find the
10x 52.5 ¬6.25x 75
measurements in millimeters. Then make a scale
3.75x 52.5 ¬75
drawing.
3.75x ¬22.5
Solve:
x ¬6 millimeters → 1 x ← millimeters
BC x 2
meters → 1 69 ← meters
6 2 or 8
69 x
ED x 1
The width of the field should be 69 millimeters in
6 1 or 5
AB AB 10 the drawing.
AC AB BC 10 8
The scale factor is millimeters → 1 y ← millimeters
10
5
18 or 9 . meters → 1 105 ← meters
20. Use the congruent angles to write the 105 y
corresponding vertices in order: RST EGF. The length of the field should be 105 millimeters
Write a proportion to find x. in the drawing.
R T ST 105 mm
EF ¬ GF
1 5
¬ 1 0 69 mm
11.25 x
15x ¬11.25(10) Figure is not shown actual size.
15x ¬112.5
x ¬7.5 Examine: The scale is 1 : 1, so it is clear that the
GF x dimensions in the drawing are reasonable.
7.5 25. Explore: Every 1
4 inch represents 4 feet. The
EG GF dimensions of the basketball court are 84 feet by
SR ¬ ST
50 feet.
EG 7.
5
.7 ¬
20
Plan: Create a proportion relating each
10
measurement to the scale to find the
(EG)(10) ¬(20.7)(7.5)
measurements in inches. Then make a scale
(EG)(10) ¬155.25
drawing.
EG ¬15.525
ST 10 Solve:
4
GF 7.5 or 3 .
The scale factor is inches → 1 x ← inches
4
21. Write proportions for finding side measures.
feet → 4 84 ← feet
first new length → x 5
1(84) ¬4x
original length → 2.5 4 4
21 ¬4x
4x ¬2.5(5) 5.25 ¬x
4x ¬12.5
The length of the court should be 5.25 inches in
x ¬3.125
second new length → y 5
the drawing.
inches 1 y ← inches
first new length → 3.125 4 4
4y ¬3.125(5) feet 4 50 ← feet
4y ¬15.625 1(50) ¬4y
4
y ¬3.9 12.5 ¬4y
first new width → z 5
3.125 ¬y
original width → 4 4 The width of the court should be 3.125 inches in
4z ¬4(5) the drawing.
4z ¬20
5 1–4 in.
z ¬5
second new width → w 5
3 1–8 in.
first new width → 5 4
4w ¬5(5) Figure is not shown actual size.
4w ¬25
Examine: The scale is 1
4 : 4. The dimensions in
w ¬6.25
the drawing are reasonable.
After both enlargements the dimensions were
about 3.9 inches by 6.25 inches.
157 Chapter 6
26. Explore: Every 1
8 inch represents 1 foot. The 35. L ¬S
dimensions of the tennis court are 36 feet by 78 mL ¬mS
feet. 30 ¬x
Plan: Create a proportion relating each K ¬R
measurement to the scale to find the mK ¬mR
measurements in inches. Then make a scale mK ¬180 (mQ mS)
drawing. y ¬180 (80 30)
Solve: y ¬180 110
inches → 1 x ← inches y ¬70
8
¬
feet → 1 36 ← feet AB BC
FE ¬ EH
36.
1 (36) ¬x x 2 8
8 5 ¬
1 10
4.5 ¬x
(x 2)(10) 15(8)
The width of the court should be 4.5 inches in the 10x 20 ¬120
drawing. 10x ¬100
inches → 1 y ← inches
8
x ¬10
feet → 1 78 ← feet DC BC
GH ¬
EH
1(78) ¬y y3
8 8
¬ 1
9.75 ¬y 5 0
The length of the court should be 9.75 inches in (y 3)(10) ¬5(8)
the drawing. 10y 30 ¬40
10y ¬70
9 3–4 in.
y ¬7
x 3 12
16 ¬8
4 1–2 in. 37.
(x 3)(8) ¬16(12)
Figure is not shown actual size. 8x 24 ¬192
Examine: The scale is 1
8 : 1. The dimensions in
8x ¬216
the drawing are reasonable. x ¬27
27. Always; the corresponding angles are congruent y1 12
¬8
and the ratios of the measures of the 10
corresponding sides are all 1. (y 1)(8) ¬10(12)
8y 8 ¬120
28. Always; all angles are right angles and so all are
8y ¬112
congruent, and the ratios of the measures of the
y ¬14
corresponding sides are all the same.
2x 20
2 ¬
1
29. Never; the number of angles and sides of the 38.
15
figures must be the same for the figures to be 2x(15) ¬12(20)
compared. 30x ¬240
30. sometimes; true when corresponding angles are x ¬8
congruent and ratios of measures of y4 15
¬
20
corresponding sides are equal, false when one of 12
these does not hold (y 4)(20) ¬12(15)
20y 80 ¬180
31. sometimes; true when the ratios of the measures
20y ¬100
of the corresponding sides are equal, false when
y ¬5
they are not.
RS TS
32. sometimes; true when corresponding angles are 39.
WU ¬VW
congruent and ratios of measures of x 49
corresponding sides are equal, false when one of
29 ¬
20
these does not hold 20x ¬29(49)
33. Always; all angles have measure 60 and are 20x ¬1421
congruent, and the ratios of the measures of the x ¬71.05
corresponding sides are all the same. RT TS
UV ¬
VW
34. G ¬L y3 49
¬
mG ¬mL 21 20
87 ¬x 4 (y 3)(20) ¬21(49)
91 ¬x 20y 60 ¬1029
J ¬O 20y ¬969
mJ ¬mO y ¬48.45
y 30 ¬60 AD 12 12 8
AG 12 4.5 7.5 5
40.
y ¬30
Chapter 6 158
41. AG AD GD Sides opposite 23º angle.
12 4.5 PR 12.5
2.5
7.5 NM 5
The ratios of the measures of the corresponding
DC AD
GF ¬ AG
42. sides are equal, and the corresponding angles are
D C 1 2 congruent, so NMO PRS.
¬
14 7.
5 49. y
7.5(DC) 14(12) 8
7.5(DC) 168
C B
DC ¬22.4 4
43. mADC mAGF D M N
108 O A 4 8 12 x
BC AD 4
EF ¬ AG
44.
B C 1
8 ¬ 2
7.
8
5
7.5(BC) 8(12)
7.5(BC) 96 DA 4 and MN 8 so the scale factor is 8
4 or 2.
BC ¬12.8 To move from point A to point B, move up 4 units
and then move 2 units to the right. Because the
45. AB BC CD AD 26 12.8 22.4 12 73.2
scale factor is 2, to move from N to L, move up 8
AE AG
AB ¬ AD
46. units and move 4 units to the right. So the
AE 7.5 coordinates of L could be (16, 8). Similarly the
6 ¬
2
12 coordinates of P could be (8, 8)
12(AE) ¬26(7.5) Another similar polygon can be obtained by
12(AE) ¬195 moving down and to the right. To move from N to
AE ¬16.25 L, move down 8 units and move 4 units to the
AE EF FG AG 16.25 8 14 7.5 right. So the coordinates of L could also be
45.75 L(16, 8). The coordinates of P could be (8, 8).
73
.2 8 50.
47. 5 5
y
45.7 8
48. ABC IHG JLK and NMO PRS; B
A I J because each one measures 53º. N 4
B H L because each one is a right angle. A M C
C G K because each one measures 8 4 O 4 8x
90º-53º or 37º. 4
D
So all corresponding angles are congruent. Now
determine whether corresponding sides are 8
proportional.
Sides opposite 90º angle. AD
[2 (7)]2
(
4 1)2
AC 5 1 AC 5 IG 10 2
5 (5)2
4 8
IG 10 2 JK 1.25 JK 1.25 50
or 52
2 (3)
7 1
Sides opposite 53º angle. 2 2
BC 4 1
BC 4
4
HG 8
8
NM 11
2
HG 8 2 LK 1 LK 1
2
5
2 2
Sides opposite 37º angle. 5 2
AB 3 1 AB 3 IH 6
4 8
IH 6 2 JL 0.75 JL 0.75 5
0 5
4 or 2 2
52
The ratios of the measures of the corresponding MN 2
The scale factor is AD 1
2.
sides are equal, and the corresponding angles are 52
congruent, so ABC IHG, ABC JLK, and To move from point A to point B, move up 4 units
IHG JLK. and then move 9 units to the right. Because the
N P because each one measures 67º. scale factor is 1
2 , to obtain L from N move up 2
M R because each one is a right angle. units and then move 4.5 units to the right. So the
O S because each one measures 90º-67º or 23º.
So all corresponding angles are congruent. Now
1
coordinates of L could be 1, 1
2 . Similarly, the
determine whether corresponding sides are coordinates of P could be 2, 3.
3
proportional.
Another similar polygon can be obtained by
Sides opposite 90º angle.
moving down and to the left. To move from N to L
PS 32.5
2.5 move down 2 units and then move 4.5 units to the
NO 13
Sides opposite 67º angle.
RS 30
left. So the coordinates of L could be 10, 3
2 .
2.5
MO 12 1
Similarly, the coordinates of P could be 5
2 , 1 .
159 Chapter 6
3 62. B; rewrite 5 : 3 as 5x : 3x.
1 in
ch 4 inch
et ¬
51. 5x 3x ¬32
24 fe x feet
8x ¬32
x ¬24 3
4 x ¬4
x ¬18 5x 5(4) or 20
5
inch
3x 3(4) or 12
1 in
ch 8
There are 20 12 or 8 more girls than boys. The
24 feet ¬ y feet
answer is B.
y ¬24 5
8 63. D;
y ¬15 180 (51 85) 44
The living room has dimensions 18 feet by 15 feet. 180 (51 44) 85
Corresponding angles are congruent.
1 12 9.
3
14 inches
4 3 and 3.1 3, so the ratios of two pairs of
1 in
ch
et
52.
24 fe x feet
corresponding sides are equal, so the triangles are
x 24(1.25) similar.
x 30 x ¬
9.
3
2.8 3.1
3
inch
1 in
ch 8
3.1x ¬2.8(9.3)
24 feet y feet
3.1x ¬26.04
y 24 3
8 x ¬8.4
The answer is D.
y9
The deck has dimensions 30 feet by 9 feet. 64. Multiply each coordinate by 2.
53. The sides are in a ratio of 4 : 1, so if the length of A
has coordinates (0 2, 0 2) (0, 0).
WXYZ is x then the length of ABCD is 4x, and if B
has coordinates (8 2, 0 2) (16, 0).
the width of WXYZ is y then the width of ABCD is C
has coordinates (2 2, 7 2) (4, 14).
(4x)(4y) 16xy 65.
4y. Then the areas are in a ratio of y C
xy xy
or 16 : 1. 12
4(3)
54. 4 12 4
1 1(3) 3 or 1 . The ratio is still 4 : 1.
8
55. The ratio of the areas is still 16 : 1 since the ratio C
of the sides is still 4 : 1. 4
56. No; the corresponding sides are not in proportion. B B
The ratio of the widths is 1 to 1 but the ratio of AA 4 8 12 16x
the heights is 2 to 1.
57. The widths are the same but the height of the
36% rectangle is twice the height of the 18% 66. AB ¬(8 0)2 (0 0)2
2w ¬
8 0
2 2
rectangle, so the ratio of the areas is w or 2 : 1. ¬64
or 8
36
% 0.3
6
18% 0.18 or 2 : 1, so
The ratio of the percents is A
B
(16 0)2 (0 0)2
the ratios are the same.
16
2 0 2
53
61. Sample answer: Artists use geometric shapes in
patterns to create another scene or picture. The A
C
(4 0)2 (14 0)2
included objects have the same shape but are
4 1
2 4 2
Chapter 6 160
68. You could use the slope formula to find that 83. m2 m5 180 (supplementary consecutive
C
B
B
C
. Thus, ABC A
B
C
and interior )
ACB A
C
B
because of corresponding 62 m5 180
angles. A A
because of the Third Angle m5 118
Theorem. 84. mABD m1 ( corresponding )
69. The sides are proportional and the angles are 118
congruent, so the triangles are similar. 85. m6 m4 180 (supplementary consecutive
interior )
Page 297 Maintain Your Skills m6 118 180
b 2
m6 62
7.8 ¬ 3
70. 86. m7 m6 ( alternate interior )
3b ¬7.8(2) 62
3b ¬15.6 87. m8 m4 ( corresponding )
b ¬5.2 118
c 2 5
c 3 ¬ 4
71.
(c 2)(4) ¬(c 3)(5)
4c 8 ¬5c 15 6-3 Similar Triangles
c 8 ¬15
c ¬23
c ¬23 Page 298 Geometry Activity: Similar Triangles
4 FD 4
ST 7 0.57
2 1.
72.
4y 5 ¬ y
2y ¬(4y 5)(4) EF 2.
5
S
4.4 0.57
R
2y ¬16y 20 ED 4.
3
RT 7.6 0.57
18y ¬20
10 All of the ratios equal about 0.57.
y ¬9
2. Yes, all sides are in the same ratio.
73.
BC B A, B
OB O
, and mOBC mOBA. By
3. Sample answer: Either all sides proportional or
the SAS Inequality, OC AO.
two corresponding angles congruent.
74. ABC is isosceles with base angles
1[180 (68 40)] 36. Then mAOB 180
2
(40 36) 104 and mAOD 180 104 76 so, Page 301 Check for Understanding
mAOD mAOB. 1. Sample answer: Two triangles are congruent by
75. mABD mADB because if one side of a the SSS, SAS, and ASA Postulates and the AAS
triangle is longer than another side, then the Theorem. In these triangles, corresponding parts
angle opposite the longer side has a greater must be congruent. Two triangles are similar by
measure than the angle opposite the shorter side. AA similarity, SSS Similarity, and SAS Similarity.
76. x 52 35 180 In similar triangles, the sides are proportional and
x 93 the angles are congruent. Congruent triangles are
77. x 32 57 180 always similar triangles. Similar triangles are
x 91 congruent only when the scale factor for the
proportional sides is 1. SSS and SAS are common
78. x 40 25 180
relationships for both congruence and similarity.
x 115
2. Yes; suppose RST has angles that measure 46°,
79. m1 ¬m2
54°, and 80°, ABC has angles that measure 39°,
10x 9 ¬9x 3
63°, and 78°, and EFG has angles that measure
x 9 ¬3
39°, 63°, and 78°. So ABC is not similar to
x ¬12
RST and RST is not similar to EFG, but
m1 10(12) 9 ABC is similar to EFG.
120 9 or 111
3. Alicia; while both have corresponding sides in a
m2 9(12) 3 ratio, Alicia has them in proper order with the
108 3 or 111 numerators from the same triangle.
80. m1 m4 ( alternate interior ) 4. A D and F C, so by AA Similarity,
118) ABC DEF.
81. m2 m4 180 (supplementary consecutive DE FE
AB ¬ CB
interior )
x 3
m2 118 180 5 ¬
4 15
m2 62 15x ¬45(3)
82. m3 m4 180 (linear pair) 15x ¬135
x ¬9
m3 118 180
DE x 9
m3 62
161 Chapter 6
5. A D and B E, so by AA Similarity, Pages 302–305 Practice and Apply
ABC DEF. 10. If the measures of the corresponding sides are
AB B C
E ¬
proportional, then the triangles are similar.
D EF
QR QP
x 5 7 or 1,
10 R
or 1, P 15
or 1
x 4 3 NO 21 3 NM 30 3 OM 45 3
QR QP R P
3x ¬5(x 4) , so by SSS Similarity,
NO NM OM
3x ¬5x 20 MNO PQR.
2x ¬20
x ¬10 11. If the measures of the corresponding sides are
AB x 10 proportional, then the triangles are similar.
DE x 4 QR SR
7 1
QS
3 1
U V 14 or 2 and TU 6 or 2
TV
10 4 or 6
QR SR QS
U V TU , so by SSS Similarity,
6. Triangles EFD and BCA are right triangles. To TV
determine whether corresponding sides are QRS TVU.
proportional, find AB. EF EG
12. F J and 4
IJ IA 5 , but SSA is not a
(AB)2 ¬(AC)2 (BC)2
valid justification for similarity. There is not
(AB)2 ¬102 52 100 25 enough information to determine whether the
AB ¬125
or 55 triangles are similar.
D
E 8 and EF 4
AB ¬ 5 C 5
B 13. mR mS mT ¬180
5
8 4, so the triangles are not similar because mR 120 20 ¬180
55 5 mR ¬40
corresponding sides are not proportional.
mJ mK mL ¬180
7. If the measures of the corresponding sides are 40 120 mL ¬180
proportional, then the triangles are similar. mL ¬20
DF 25 S K and R J, so RST JKL by AA
9 DE FE 2
1
AB 3 or 3, AC 81 or 3, BC 7 or 3
3 Similarity.
DF D E FE
AB AC BC , so by SSS Similarity,
14. ST XV, UT WV, and T V,
DEF ACB. so STU XVW by SAS Similarity.
8. Triangles ABC and EDF are isosceles triangles AB
3 1 BC 5 1
JK 9 or 3 and KL 15 or 3 , and B K.
15.
because they each have a pair of congruent sides.
ABC JKL by SAS Similarity.
Base angles of isosceles triangles are congruent,
so B C and D F. From the figure, 16. Since AE
BD, EAC DBC and AEC
B D, so by transitivity B F and BDC because they are corresponding angles. By
D C. So ABC EDF by AA Similarity. AA Similarity, AEC BDC.
9. tower 17. If the measures of the corresponding sides are
proportional, then the triangles are similar.
ST 6 3 SR 10
.5 3.5
BA
20 or and
10 BC 30 or 10
ST SR
x ft post
BA
BC, so RST is not similar to CBA
because the sides are not proportional.
4 ft 6 in.
18.
D
AE C, so A C and E D because they
100 ft 3 ft 4 in.
are alternate interior angles. By AA Similarity,
Assuming that the sun’s rays form similar ABE CBD.
triangles, the following proportion can be written. AB EB
CB ¬ DB
height of tower (ft) tower shadow (ft)
x 3 5
height of post (ft) post shadow (ft) ¬
2x 8 3
Substitute the known values and let x be the 3(x 3) ¬5(2x 8)
height of the cell phone tower. 3x 9 ¬10x 40
x ¬
1
100
1 7x 9 ¬40
42 33 7x ¬49
31
3
x ¬ 41 (100)
2
x ¬7
AB x 3
1
33 x ¬450
7 3 or 10
x ¬135
BC 2x 8
The cellphone tower is 135 feet tall.
2(7) 8 or 6
Chapter 6 162
19.
DC
EB
, so ADC AEB and ACD ABE AB 62
2 1 2 180
or 65
because they are corresponding angles. By AA BC 62 3 45
2 or 35
Similarity, ABE ACD. CA |7 (8)| 15
AB AE
AC ¬ AD
ST |6 (4)| 10
x 2 8 5 TB 82 42 80
or 45
x 2 6 ¬8
8(x 2) ¬(x 8)(3) BS 22 42 20
or 25
8x 16 ¬3x 24 CA 15 6
5
3 AB or 3, and
ST 10 or 2 , TB 45
5x 16 ¬24 2
BC
3
5
3.
5x ¬8 or
BS 25 2
x ¬8
C A A B BC
ST TB BS , ABC TBS by SSS
Since
5
AB x 2 Similarity.
8
3
5 2 or 3 5 23. The perimeter of ABC is 65 35 15 or
AC x 2 6 15 95. The perimeter of TBS is 45
8 3
5 2 6 or 9 5
25 10 or 10 65
.
15
95
3(5 35
)
20. ABD and FEC are right triangles with or 3
10 65 2(5 35
) 2
A F and right angles B and E. Because all
right angles are congruent, ABD FEC by AA 24. False; this is not true for equilateral or isosceles
Similarity. triangles.
BD AB 25. True; similarity of triangles is transitive.
CE ¬ FE
x 1 26. QRS and STR are right angles, so
3
x 2 ¬ 8
QRS STR. Q Q, so QRS QTR by
8(x 1) ¬3(x 2) AA Similarity. S S, so QRS RTS by AA
8x 8 ¬3x 6 Similarity. Therefore, QTR RTS by
5x 8 ¬6 transitivity.
5x ¬14 27. AB
FD, so BAE AFC and ABE ECF
14
x ¬5
because they are alternate interior angles. Then
BD ¬x 1 EAB EFC by AA Similarity. A D
B C, so
14 9
ADF ECF because they are corresponding
¬5 1 or 5 angles. F F, so EFC AFD by AA
EC ¬x 2 Similarity. Then EAB AFD by transitivity.
14 24
¬5 2 or 5
28. PSY and PQR are right angles and so they are
21. ABC and ARS are right triangles with congruent. P P, so PSY PQR by AA
A A and right angles ASR and ACB. R
Similarity. P
W
X , so YWX WYP because
Because all right angles are congruent, they are alternate interior angles.
ABC ARS by AA Similarity. WYX YSP because they are right angles, so
A
S
¬SR WYX YSP by AA Similarity.
AC CB
PY
¬PS
X
x 6
12 ¬ 9 XW Y
9x ¬72 P Y 3
0 ¬6
1
x ¬8
6(PY) ¬10(3)
AB ¬x 7
6(PY) ¬30
¬8 7 or 15
PY ¬5
AS ¬x
SY PS
¬8 ¬
YW X Y
22. y SY
¬3
8 6
C ( 2, 7) S(0, 6)
6(SY) ¬8(3)
6(SY) ¬24
B(4, 4) SY ¬4
PQ PR
¬
PS PY
PQ 5
3 ¬ 5
5
O x
5(PQ) ¬3(10)
5(PQ) ¬30
PQ ¬6
T (0, 4) 29.
PR
KL, so RQM LNM, PQM KNM,
L QRM, and K QPM, since these are
all pairs of corresponding angles. LNM, KNM,
RQM, PQM, and LMK are all right angles,
A( 2, 8)
so each is congruent to the others.
163 Chapter 6
NM 9
Since LMK MNK and K K, 8 ¬6
LMK MNK by AA Similarity. 6(NM) ¬8(9)
LK MK
M K ¬
NK 7
NM ¬ 2
6 or 12
16 9 KP
2(KP)
KP ¬
2(KP) Since L QRM and LNM RQM,
9
25 3(KP) QRM NLM by AA Similarity.
3(KP) ¬9 QR RM
¬
25(9) ¬9(KP)2 NL LM
25 ¬(KP)2 3
2
3 3
4
0
5 ¬KP 16 ¬
LM
KM KP PM
KP 2(KP)
32
4
3 (LM) ¬16 3
0
40 3
3(KP) LM ¬16 3 32
3(5) or 15 LM ¬20
PM 2(KP) 2(5) or 10 IJ HJ
Since L QRM and K QPM, 30.
XJ
YJ and J J,
LKM RPM by AA Similarity. so IJH XJY by SAS Similarity.
LK KM mJXY 180 mWXJ
RP ¬ PM
180 130
25 15
RP ¬
10 50
25(10) ¬15(RP) mJIH mJXY by corr.
25
0 50
15 ¬RP
50 mYIZ mJIH by vert.
3 ¬RP
50
Since KNM PQM and K QPM, mJYX mYIZ + mWZG
KNM PQM by AA Similarity. 50 20
KN KM 70
PQ ¬ PM
because exterior angle sum of remote interior
9 15
¬
PQ 10 angles
9(10) ¬15(PQ) mJHI mJYX 70 by corr.
90 ¬15(PQ) mJ mJXY mJYX ¬180
6 ¬PQ mJ 50 70 ¬180
RP RQ PQ mJ ¬60
50 mJHG mJHI ¬180 Linear pair
3 RQ 6
mJHG 70 ¬180
50
3 6 RQ
mJHG ¬110
32 31. RST is a right angle, so mRST 90.
3 RQ
mRTS 47.
mMQP mQPM mPMQ ¬180 mRTS mR mRST ¬180
90 mQPM mPMQ ¬180 47 mR 90 ¬180
mQPM mPMQ ¬90 mR ¬43
Since RMP is a right angle, UVT is a right angle, so mUVT 90.
mRMQ mPMQ 90 mUVT mTUV mUTV ¬180
mQPM mPMQ mRMQ mPMQ 90 mTUV 47 ¬180
mQPM mRMQ, so QPM RMQ. mTUV ¬43
Therefore, RQM MQP by AA Similarity. RUS is a right angle, so mRUS 90.
RQ MQ mRUS mR mRSU ¬180
MQ ¬
QP 90 43 mRSU ¬180
32
3 MQ mRSU ¬47
MQ ¬6
SUT is a right angle, so mSUT 90.
32
(MQ)2 ¬3 6
mSUV mTUV ¬90
(MQ)2 ¬64 mSUV 43 ¬90
MQ ¬8 mSUV ¬47
RM QM 32. Assuming that the sun’s rays form similar
MP ¬ QP
triangles, the following proportion can be written.
RM 8
0 ¬6
1 height of pyramid (ft)
height of staff (paces 3)
6(RM) ¬10(8)
RM ¬80
40
pyramid shadow length (paces 3)
6 or 3
staff shadow length (paces 3)
Since KNM PQM,
NM KN
QM ¬ PQ
Chapter 6 164
Substitute the known values and let x be the P
35. Given: L
M
N
L P
height of the pyramid. LJ PJ J
Prove:
JN
JM
x ¬(125
114)(3)
2(3) 3(3) Proof:
x 71
¬7 M N
6 9
9x ¬6(717) Statements Reasons
9x ¬4302
P
1. L
M
N
1. Given
x ¬478
The pyramid was about 478 feet tall at that time.
2. PLN LNM, 2. Alternate Interior
D
33. x must equal y. If B
A E, then CBD CAE
LPM PMN Theorem
because they are corresponding angles and
C C so BCD ACE by AA Similarity. 3. LPJ NMJ 3. AA Similarity
B C DC 2 x
Then AC EC . Thus, 4 x y . Cross multiply
LJ PJ 4. Corr. sides of s
JN JM
4.
and solve for y. are proportional.
2 ¬x
4 xy 36. Given: A
EB C
, B
H
AE
,
2(x y) ¬4x E
J
CA E
2x 2y ¬4x J
a. Prove: ABH DCB
2y ¬2x H D
y ¬x
34. Given: B E; Q P
BC
; Q
PE F
;
AB BC
DE
EF A B C
Proof:
Prove: ABC DEF
AHB, AJC, and EBC are right angles
A because perpendicular lines form right angles.
D
Since all right angles are congruent,
Q P AHB AJC EBC. Since A A by the
B C E F Reflexive Property, ABH ACJ, by AA
Proof: Similarity. Likewise, since C C,
Statements Reasons ACJ DCB. By the Transitive Property,
ABH DCB.
1. B E, Q
P
B
C
; 1. Given BC
b. Prove: BD
AB BC BE BA
P
QE
F
;
DE
EF Proof:
2. APQ C 2. Corresponding From part a, A CDB by definition of similar
Postulate triangles. ABE DBC because all right angles
AQP B
are congruent. Thus, ABE DBC by AA
Similarity.
3. AQP E 3. Transitive BC BD
BE BA from definition of similar triangles.
Prop. of
4. ABC AQP 4. AA Similarity 37. Given: BAC and EDF are right triangles.
AB AC
E
AB BC 5. Def. of s D DF
5.
AQ QP Prove: ABC DEF
6. AB QP AQ BC 6. Cross products B
E
AB EF DE BC
7. QP EF 7. Def. of A C D F
segments Proof:
8. AB EF AQ BC 8. Substitution Statements Reasons
1. BAC and EDF are 1. Given
9. AQ BC DE BC 9. Substitution right triangles.
10. AQ DE 10. Div. Prop. 2. BAC and EDF are 2. Def. of rt.
right angles.
Q
11. AD
E
11. Def. of
segments 3. BAC EDF 3. All rt. are .
AB AC
DE DF
4.
12. AQP DEF 12. SAS 4. Given
165 Chapter 6
38. Reflexive Property of Similarity 40. If the side of DEF that is 36 cm corresponds to
Given: ABC the shortest side of ABC, then we can find the
Prove: ABC ABC lengths of the other sides of DEF using
F proportions.
36 x
4 ¬ 6
C
D E
36(6) ¬4x
A B I 216 ¬4x
54 ¬x
36 y
4 ¬ 9
G H
36(9) ¬4y
Proof: 324 ¬4y
Statements Reasons 81 ¬y
1. ABC 1. Given The perimeter of DEF is 36 54 81 or
171 cm.
2. A A, B B 2. Reflexive Prop.
41. Assume the lines of sight create similar triangles.
3. ABC ABC 3. AA Similarity x 87
.6
1.92 ¬
0.4
Symmetric Property of Similarity 0.4x ¬1.92(87.6)
Given: ABC DEF 0.4x ¬168.192
Prove: DEF ABC x ¬420.48
Proof: The tower is about 420.5 m tall.
Statements Reasons 42. It is difficult to measure shadows within a city.
1. ABC DEF 1. Given 43. Assume that ADFE is a rectangle.
D G
2. A D, B E 2. Def. of polygons
Chapter 6 166
PS SR
46. If ABC ADE then AB BC ¬D
AD
AD C
DE . Plot point E
PS 0.
7
C
so that B
D
E
and the proportion is true. 2.2 ¬ 1.4
AB ¬
[2
(10)]2 (
4 6)2 1.4(PS) ¬2.2(0.7)
1.4(PS) ¬1.54
¬8
2
2 (2)
PS ¬1.1
¬68
or 217 SR 0.
7
The scale factor is 1
CD 1.4 or 2 .
AD ¬
[6 (10)]2 (2
6)2
52. Use the congruent angles to write the
¬16
2
(4)2 corresponding vertices in order. EFG XYZ
¬272
or 417 XY YZ
AB 2
17
or 1
EF ¬
FG
2 , so DE 2(BC). To get
AD
4
17 22
.5 7.
5
6x ¬ 10
from point B to point C, move down 6 units and
then move left 2 units. To get from point D to 22.5(10) ¬6x(7.5)
point E, move down 12 units and then move left 225 ¬45x
4 units. Locate point E at (2, 10). 5 ¬x
EF 6x
47. ABC ACD by AA Similarity.
6(5) or 30
ABC CBD by AA Similarity. XZ YZ
ACD CBD by AA Similarity.
EG ¬
FG
XZ 7.
5
25 ¬
48. Sample answer: Engineers use triangles, some the
10
same shape, but different in size, to complete a
10(XZ) ¬25(7.5)
project. Answers should include the following.
10(XZ) ¬187.5
• Engineers use triangles in construction because
XZ ¬18.75
they are rigid shapes. FG 10 4
YZ 7.5 or 3 .
The scale factor is
• With the small ground pressure, the tower does
not sink, shift, lean, or fall over. 53. 1y ¬3
15
AE AB
49. A; ABE ACD by AA Similarity, so
AD
AC . 15 ¬3y
10 4 x 2 5 ¬y
10 ¬ x 2 5
¬ xx
6 2 54. 6
7
8 ¬ b
10 3
6b ¬8(7)
6(x 3) ¬10(x 2)
6b ¬56
6x 18 ¬10x 20 28
18 ¬4x 20 b ¬ 3
38 ¬4x 20
m
28 ¬ 21
55.
9.5 ¬x
20(21) ¬28m
50. B;
x 3 x 420 ¬28m
6 ¬ x 2 15 ¬m
(x 3)(x 2) ¬6x 16 9
x2 2x 3x 6 ¬6x 56. 7 ¬ s
x2 x 6 ¬6x 16s ¬7(9)
x 5x 6 ¬0
2 16s ¬63
(x 6)(x 1) ¬0 63
s ¬16
x 6 ¬0 or x 1 ¬0
x ¬6 x ¬1 57. Find the coordinates of T.
y
12
B
Page 306 Maintain Your Skills 8
51. Use the congruent angles to write the
corresponding vertices in order. 4
PQRS ABCD x
PQ SR
¬
AB DC
4 4 8 12
C
x ¬.
0 7 4
3.2 1.4
1.4x ¬3.2(0.7) 8
1.4x ¬2.24 A
x ¬1.6 12
BC CD
AT is a median from A to B
C
, so T is the midpoint
QR ¬
RS
B C 1.4
C
of B . Then T has coordinates
7 ¬
0. 5
9 11 (1)
0.7
0.7(BC) ¬0.7(1.4)
2 , 2 (7, 5).
1 11 12
BC ¬1.4 C
The slope of B is 9 5 4 or 3.
167 Chapter 6
5 (9) 14 PR QR
T
The slope of A is 3)
7 ( 7 ¬
10 or 5 . TR SR
¬
PT x 10 5
3 7
5 1, so A
T
is not perpendicular to x
10
40
PT 3 ¬
15
C
B. A
T
is not an altitude. 4
0 10
3
58. p: you are at least 54 inches tall
q: you may ride the roller coaster 4
10 PT 0
4
0
3 ¬ 3 (15)
Adam is 5 feet 8 inches tall, or 5 12 8 40
10(PT) 0 60 0
3 ¬ 3
68 inches, so he can ride the roller coaster by the
200
Law of Detachment. 10(PT) ¬3
2
9 15 11 20
59. 2 , 2 ¬2, 2
11 26 PT ¬ 3
¬(5.5, 13) scale on map (cm)
5.
distance on map (cm)
4 4 (12) 2 8 distance on map (mi) actual distance (mi)
60.
2 ,
2
2 ¬ 2, 2 1 .5 29.2
100 ¬x
¬(1, 4)
1.5x ¬100(29.2)
7 8 (13)
0 7 5
61.
2 , 2 ¬ 2, 2 1.5x ¬2920
x ¬1947
¬(3.5, 2.5)
The cities are about 1947 miles apart.
3. D B and AED CEB, so ADE CBE Pages 311–312 Check for Understanding
by AA Similarity. 1. Sample answer: If a line intersects two sides of a
DE AD triangle and separates sides into corresponding
BE ¬ CB
segments of proportional lengths, then it is
3x 2
6 ¬ 10
15 parallel to the third side.
15(3x 2) ¬6(10) 2. Sample answer:
45x 30 ¬60 m n
45x ¬90 A B
x ¬2
AE
AD
¬ D
CE CB
A E 10 C
12 ¬ 15
15(AE) ¬12(10)
15(AE) ¬120 m n
AE ¬8 A B
DE 3x 2
D
3(2) 2 or 4
C
4.
ST
Q
P
, so TSR PQR. R R, so
PQR TSR by AA Similarity.
PQ QR 3. Given three or more parallel lines intersecting
TS ¬
SR two transversals, Corollary 6.1 states that the
25 10 5
TS ¬ parts of the transversals are proportional.
10
25(10) ¬(10 5)(TS) Corollary 6.2 states that if the parts of one
transversal are congruent, then the parts of every
250 ¬15(TS)
50 transversal are congruent.
3 ¬TS
W
4. L
T
S
, so by the Triangle Proportionality
(SR) (TR)2 ¬(TS)2
2
LT WS
0 2 Theorem, L
R
5 . Substitute the known
102 x2 ¬ 3
RW
measures.
2500
100 x2 ¬ 9
5 6
5 ¬
9
16 00 RW
x2 ¬9
4(RW) ¬5(6)
40
x ¬3 4(RW) ¬30
RW ¬7.5
Chapter 6 168
5.
LW
TS
, so by the Triangle Proportionality To find y:
T
L WS
Theorem, LR RW . Substitute the known y ¬3
5y 2
measures. 2
y ¬2
5
8
3 WS
3 ¬6 y ¬5
6(5) ¬3(WS) 12. To find x:
30 ¬3(WS) 1x 2 ¬2x 4
3 3
10 ¬WS
1
3 x 2 ¬4
6. Use the Midpoint Formula to find the midpoints
B
of A and A
C
. 1
3 x ¬6
10 (2) 0 6 x ¬18
D 2,
2 D(4, 3) To find y:
4 (2) 0 6
E2, 2 E(3, 3) 5y ¬7
3y 8
E
7. If the slopes of D and B
C
are equal, D
E
B
C
. 8y ¬8
3
E 33
y ¬3
slope of D 3
4 or 0
00 13. The streets form a triangle cut by a Walkthrough
C
slope of B
10
(4) or 0 that is parallel to the bottom of the triangle. Use
Because the slopes of D E
and BC
are equal, the Triangle Proportionality Theorem.
DE
B C. Talbot Rd. Woodbury Ave.
8. First, use the Distance Formula to find BC and Entrance to Walkthrough Entrance to Walkthrough
DE. Walkthrough to Clay Rd. Walkthrough to Clay Rd.
8 8 0 x
BC ¬ [10 (4)]2
(0 0)2 14 08 ¬
17
60
¬ 196 0 880(1760) ¬1408x
¬14 1,548,800 ¬1408x
1100 ¬x
DE ¬ (3 4)2
(3 3)2
The distance from the entrance to the
¬ 49 0 Walkthrough along Woodbury Avenue is 1100
¬7 yards.
DE 7 1
BC 14 or 2
DE 1 1
BC 2 , then DE 2 BC.
If
Pages 312–315 Practice and Apply
9. MQ ¬MR RQ 14.
MN
YZ
, so by the Triangle Proportionality
12.5 ¬4.5 RQ M
Y N
Z
Theorem, XM XN . Substitute the known
8 ¬RQ measures.
MY 9
4 ¬ 6
MP ¬MN NP
25 ¬9 NP 6(MY) ¬4(9)
16 ¬NP 6(MY) ¬36
N
In order to show R
Q
P
, we must show that MY ¬6
MR MN XY XM MY
RQ NP .
4 6 or 10
MR 4.5 9
RQ ¬ 8 or 16
15.
MN
Y Z , so by the Triangle Proportionality
M Y NZ
MN 9 Theorem, . Substitute the known
NP ¬ 16
XM XN
measures.
MR MN 9 10 t
RQ NP 16 . Since the sides have
Thus, 2
¬ 1
2 t2
N
proportional lengths, R
Q
P
. 8(t 2) ¬2(t 1)
B
10. In order to show D
A
E
, we must show that 8t 16 ¬2t 2
ED AB 6t 16 ¬2
DC BC .
6t ¬18
ED 8 2 t ¬3
DC 20 or 5
AB 12 E
16. D
B
C
, so by the Triangle Proportionality
BC
25 D
B EC
Theorem, AD AE . Substitute the known
ED AB
, so the sides do not have proportional
DC BC measures.
B
lengths and D is not parallel to A
E
. 24 18
AD ¬
3
11. To find x:
24(3) ¬18(AD)
20 5x ¬2x 6
72 ¬18(AD)
20 ¬7x 6
4 ¬AD
14 ¬7x
2 ¬x
169 Chapter 6
B
17. E
D
C
, so by the Triangle Proportionality 6(x 4) ¬12(8)
ED BC 6x 24 ¬96
AE AB . Substitute the known
Theorem,
6x ¬120
measures.
x ¬20
2x 3 6
3 ¬2 J
21. In order to have G
F
K
, it must be true that
2(2x 3) ¬3(6) HG HJ
GF JK .
4x 6 ¬18
4x ¬24 x 4 x 5
18 ¬ 15
x ¬6
15(x 4) ¬18(x 5)
ED 2x 3 15x 60 ¬18x 90
2(6) 3 or 9 3x 60 ¬90
18.
E
BC D, so by the Triangle Proportionality 3x ¬30
BE CD x ¬10
Theorem, AB AC . Substitute the known
measures. J
22. In order to have G
F K
, it must be true that
20 x
5 HG HJ
16 ¬ x 3
GF JK .
20(x 3) ¬16(x 5) x 3.5 x 8.5
21 (x 3.5) ¬7 (x
8.5)
20x 60 ¬16x 80 x 3.5 x 8.5
4x 60 ¬80
17.5 x ¬15.5 x
4x ¬140 (x 3.5)(15.5 x) ¬(17.5 x)(x 8.5)
x ¬35 15.5x x2 54.25 3.5x ¬17.5x 148.75
AC x 3 ¬ x2 8.5x
35 3 or 32 x 12x 54.25 ¬x2 26x 148.75
2
CD x 5 12x 54.25 ¬26x 148.75
35 5 or 40 54.25 ¬14x 148.75
19.
C
BF E and AC
DF
, so by the Triangle 203 ¬14x
BC FE 14.5 ¬x
Proportionality Theorem, AB AF and
A F C D T
23. In order to show Q
R
S
, we must show that
FE DE . Substitute the known measures.
PQ PT
R
Q
10
x x
3 TS .
6 ¬ 8 PQ 9
R ¬
Q 30 9
10
8x ¬6 x 3
¬9
21 or 3
7
8x ¬6x 20 PT 12
2x ¬20 ¬
TS 18 12
x ¬10 12
¬
6 or 2
y PQ PT
8 ¬
R
Because T is not parallel to R
S
.
1
x 3
0 2y 3 Q TS , Q
8 ¬
y
T
24. In order to show Q
R
S
, we must show that
10 2y 3
10 3 PQ PT
R
Q
y TS .
8 ¬
40 2y 3 PQ 65 22
R ¬
Q
3 22
40 43
8(2y 3) ¬
3 y ¬
22
40 Let TS x. Then SP 3x and PT 3x x or 2x.
16y 24 ¬
3 y
24 ¬8 PT x
2
TS x 2
3y
9 ¬y PQ PT
BC x
Because
QR T
TS , Q is not parallel to R
S
.
10 T
25. In order to show Q
R
S
, we must show that
10
FE ¬x PQ PT
QR
3
10 TS .
¬10 1
3 or 13 3 Let RQ x. Then PQ 2x.
CD y x
PQ 1
9
Q
2
R ¬ x or 2
DE 2y 3 PT 12.9 8.6
TS ¬
2(9) 3 or 15
8.6
J
F
K
, it must be true that 4.3 1
20. In order to have G ¬
8.6 or 2
HG H
J
. PQ PT
GF JK
R 1
6 8
Thus,
Q TS 2 . Since the sides have
¬ x 4
12 T
proportional lengths, Q
R
S
.
Chapter 6 170
T
26. In order to show Q
R
S
, we must show that 30. Use the Distance Formula to find DE and AB.
PQ PT
QR
TS . y
PQ 34.
88 43
6 A 8
QR ¬
18.32 or 229
PT 33.25 11.45 4
TS ¬
11.45
21
.8 43
6 x
¬
11.4 5 or 229 8 4 4 8
PQ PT 43
6
Thus,
QR TS 229 . Since the sides have
B 4
T
proportional lengths, Q
R
S
. C
8
27.
DE is a midsegment of ABC and D
E
BC
, so by
the Triangle Midsegment Theorem, DE 1
2 BC.
Then BC 2DE.
32 3
4 2
2 2
DE ¬
1
DE ¬ (4 1)2 (3
1)2
¬ 94
¬ 9 81
4 4
¬13
¬3
2 10
BC ¬2DE
¬213 AB ¬ [4 (1)]
2 (
3 6)2
¬ 4 13 or 52
¬9 81
M
28. If the slopes of W and T
S
are equal, W
M
T
S
. ¬310
12
slope of WM 14 So, 3
10
1
) and thus DE 1
2 (310
2 AB.
5 3 or 1
2
20 26 31.
slope of TS
17 11 or 1 y
A (2, 12)
M
Because the slopes of W and T
S
are equal, C
M
W
T S.
M
W is a midsegment of RST if W is the
T
midpoint of R and M is the midpoint of RS.
1 11 8 26
T
The midpoint of R is
2, 2 (5, 17).
These are not the coordinates of W.
1 17 8 20
S
The midpoint of R is
2, 2 (8, 14).
D B (5, 0) x
These are not the coordinates of M.
M
W is not a midsegment because W and M are Graph
AB. We can find segments of AB with
not midpoints of their respective sides. lengths in a ratio of 2 to 1 by considering a second
29.
DE is a midsegment of ABC. Use the Midpoint line and parallel lines that intersect this line and
Formula to find the coordinates of D and E. .
AB
Graph C(0, 12) and D(0, 0) and lines CA and
DB.
y
CA and DB are horizontal lines and are parallel
A lines intersecting transversals CD (the y-axis) and
8
. We can find P by finding a third parallel line
AB
4 intersecting
CD and AB so that this line
separates CD into two parts with a ratio of 2 to 1.
x
8 4 4 8 CD is 12 units, so if a horizontal line intersects
at (0, 4) or (0, 8) then this line separates CD
CD
B 4 into two parts with a ratio of 2 to 1. These
C horizontal lines intersect AB at (4, 4) and (3, 8).
8 into parts with a ratio of
These points cut off AB
2 to 1, so P could have coordinates (4, 4) or (3, 8).
1 6 (5)
D
2 ,
7
1
2 D 3, 2
4 3 (5)
E
2 ,
7
2 E2, 4
3
E
Find the slopes of D and A
B
.
1
4
E
slope of D
3
2 or 3
3
2
36
B
slope of A
4
(1) or 3
E
Both D and A
B
have slope 3, so D
E
is parallel
B
to A.
171 Chapter 6
32. y N To find y:
2y 6 ¬3y 9
P
6 ¬y 9
15 ¬y
34. To find x:
2x 3 ¬6 x
R 3x 3 ¬6
3x ¬3
x x ¬1
To find y:
4y 1 ¬2y
3
1 ¬2
3y
3
¬y
2
35. The poles form parallel line segments and the
wires are transversals cutting through the ends of
the parallel segments.
L is on
PN and M is on
RN so graph N, P, and R D
and extend PN
and R
N so that P
R
divides N
L
LP 2
N
and M.
PN 1 , and P
R
divides N
L
and M
N
MR 2
proportionally so RN 1 . Then LP 2(PN)
and MR 2(RN). Starting at N(8, 20), move to A
P(11, 16) by moving down 4 units and then right
50 ft
3 units. Locate L by moving from P down 8 units
C
and then right 6 units. The coordinates of L are
(17, 8). Now starting at N(8, 20), move to R(3, 8) 30 ft
by moving down 12 units and then left 5 units. a ft
Locate M by moving from R down 24 units and
then left 10 units. The coordinates of M are F
(7, 16). B E
x ft
Verify that LP 2(PN) and MR 2(RN). 40 ft
PN ¬ (11 8)2 (16 20)2
¬ 9 16
CFE is a right angle, so CFE ABE and
¬25 or 5
CFB DEB. Also, CEF AEB, so
LP ¬(11 17)2
(16
8)2 AEB CEF by AA Similarity. CBF DBE,
36 64
so CBF DBE by AA Similarity.
100
or 10 x a
0 ¬
So, LP 2(PN). 4 3
0
30x ¬40a
RN
(8 3)
2 (2
0 8)2 30
40 x ¬a
25 144
169
or 13 40
a ¬ x
50 40
MR [3 (
7)]2
[8 2
(16)] 40a ¬50(40 x)
100
576 30
40 x ¬2000 50x
40
676
or 26
So, MR 2(RN). 30x ¬2000 50x
80x ¬2000
33. To find x:
x ¬25
The sides of the large triangle are cut in equal
So, the distance from C to the taller pole is
parts by the segment whose length is labeled
25 feet.
x 2, so this segment is a midsegment and its
x
length is half the length of the segment whose 36. a ¬ 40
30
length is labeled 5 30x ¬40a
3 x 11.
30(25) ¬40a
1
5
x 2 ¬2 3x 11 750 ¬40a
x 2 ¬5 11 18.75 ¬a
6x 2
The coupling is 18.75 feet above the ground.
1x 2 ¬ 11
6 2
1x ¬7
6 2
x ¬21
Chapter 6 172
37. Let y represent the length of the wire from the B
39. Given: D is the midpoint of A. E is the midpoint
smaller pole. C
of A.
302 402 ¬y2 E
Prove: D
B ; DE 1
C
2 BC
900 1600 ¬y2
A
2500 ¬y2 E
D
50 ¬y
Let z represent the length of the wire from the B C
top of the smaller pole to the coupling. Proof:
40 Statements Reasons
z ¬ 25
50 z 25
25z ¬15(50 z) B
1. D is the midpoint of A . 1. Given
25z ¬750 15z C
E is the midpoint of A.
40z ¬750 D
2. A D B, A
E
E C 2. Midpoint
z ¬18.75 Theorem
The coupling is 18.75 feet down the wire from the 3. AD DB, AE EC 3. Def. of
top of the smaller pole. segments
DB EC
AD AE
38. Given: 4. AB AD DB,
4. Segment
E
Prove: D
BC
AC AE EC Addition
Postulate
A
E 5. AB AD AD, 5. Substitution
D
AC AE AE
B C
Proof: 6. AB 2AD, AC 2AE 6. Substitution
Statements Reasons AB
7. AC
2, 2 7. Division Prop.
AD AE
1.
DB EC 1. Given
AD AE
AB AC
8. 8. Transitive
AD D
B AE EC AD AE
Prop.
AD AD AE AE
2. 2. Addition Prop.
9. A A 9. Reflexive Prop.
AD
DB AE
EC
3. AD AE 3. Substitution
10. ADE ABC 10. SAS Similarity
4. AB AD DB, 4. Segment Addition
11. ADE ABC 11. Def. of
AC AE EC Postulate
polygons
AB
5. AC
5. Substitution
AD AE E
12. D
B
C
12. If corr. are ,
then the lines
6. A A 6. Reflexive Prop.
are parallel.
7. ADE ABC 7. SAS Similarity BC AB 13. Def. of
DE AD
13.
8. ADE ABC 8. Def. of polygons polygons
BC 14. Substitution
E
9. D
B
C
9. If corr. are ,
14.
DE 2
Prop.
then the lines
15. 2DE BC 15. Mult. Prop.
are
.
16. DE 1
2 BC
16. Division Prop.
41. A B C D E
42. A B C
173 Chapter 6
a b
43. The total length of the lots along Lake Creek 47. 2 ¬18
Drive is 20 22 25 18 28 or 113 meters. a b ¬36
The lines dividing the lots are perpendicular to a ¬36 b
Lake Creek Drive, so they are all parallel. Write a ¬5
proportions to solve for each variable. b 4
36
b ¬5
b
total lake frontage 4
total length of lots along street 4(36 b) ¬5b
individual lake frontage 144 4b ¬5b
144 ¬9b
individual length along street
135
.6 16 ¬b
u
113 ¬ 20
a 36 b
135.6(20) ¬113u 36 16 or 20
2712 ¬113u a b 20 16 or 4
24 ¬u
48a. See students’ work. EF
GH, F
G
E H
, E
F
G H,
135
.6 w G
E H
113 ¬ 22
F
135.6(22) ¬113w 48b. No, there will be an odd number of sides so it is
2983.2 ¬113w not possible to pair opposite sides.
26.4 ¬w
135
.6 x
113 ¬ 25
Page 315 Maintain Your Skills
135.6(25) ¬113x 49. Yes, by AA Similarity; the parallel lines determine
3390 ¬113x congruent corresponding angles.
30 ¬x 9
50. Yes, by SSS Similarity; 6 12
3
y 8 12 16 4
135
.6
113 ¬ 18
51. No; corresponding angles are not congruent. The
135.6(18) ¬113y third angles have measure 180 (72 66) 42
2440.8 ¬113y and 180 (66 38) 76.
21.6 ¬y x 7
52. 0 ¬
2 14
135
.6 z
113 ¬ 28
14x ¬20(7)
135.6(28) ¬113z 14x ¬140
3796.8 ¬113z x ¬10
33.6 ¬z y 14
9 ¬
7
44. Use the Triangle Proportionality Theorem in 7y ¬126
DCA. y ¬18
AB DG DG DE
G
B
A D
, so
BC
GC . Also, in DCF, GC EF .
x 14
53.
18 ¬
Using the Transitive Property of Equality, 21
AB DE 21x ¬252
BC EF .
x ¬12
y 14
9 ¬
F 21
E 21y ¬126
D
y ¬6
G 54. If one side of a triangle is longer than another
A
B side, then the angle opposite the longer side has a
C greater measure than the angle opposite the
shorter side. In ADB, ADB is opposite a side
45. Sample answer: City planners use maps in their whose measure is 15, and ABD is opposite a
work. Answers should include the following. side whose measure is 12. 15 12, so
• City planners need to know geometry facts mADB mABD.
when developing zoning laws. 55. If one side of a triangle is longer than another
• A city planner would need to know that the side, then the angle opposite the longer side has a
shortest distance between two parallel lines is greater measure than the angle opposite the
the perpendicular distance. shorter side. In ADB, ABD is opposite a side
12
x
18 ¬ 42 x
46. B; whose measure is 12, and BAD is opposite a
12(42 x) ¬18x side whose measure is 9. 12 9, so
504 12x ¬18x mABD mBAD.
504 ¬30x
16.8 ¬x
Chapter 6 174
56. If one side of a triangle is longer than another 4. Let x represent the perimeter of WZX.
side, then the angle opposite the longer side has a WX perimeter of WZX
ST ¬
greater measure than the angle opposite the
perimeter of SRT
shorter side. In BDC, BCD is opposite a side
5 ¬x
1
whose measure is 9, and CDB is opposite a side 6 5
whose measure is 13. 9 13, so 75 ¬6x
mBCD mCDB. 12.5 ¬x
57. If one side of a triangle is longer than another The perimeter of WZX is 12.5 units.
side, then the angle opposite the longer side has a x 6.
5
greater measure than the angle opposite the
5.
12 ¬
13
shorter side. In BDC, CBD is opposite a side 13x ¬78
whose measure is 10, and BCD is opposite a x ¬6
side whose measure is 9. 10 9, so 20 16
mCBD mBCD.
6. x ¬
12
58. There are 6 equilateral triangles. 240 ¬16x
15 ¬x
59. There are 18 obtuse triangles in the figure, 3 in
x
each equilateral triangle. 7. 9 ¬ 18
24
60. True; the hypothesis is false, so we cannot say 24x ¬162
that the statement is false. x ¬6.75
61. False; the hypothesis is true, but the conclusion is AB m
8. Given: ABC DEF and E n
D
false.
perimeter of ABC m
62. True; the hypothesis is false, so we cannot say Prove: n
perimeter of DEF
that the statement is false.
63. True; the hypothesis is true and the conclusion is B
true. A
64. A D, B E, C F, A BD E,
C E
C
B E F
, A
CD F
D
65. R X, S Y, T Z, R SX Y,
F
T
S Y Z
, R
T
X Z
AB BC AC
Proof: Because ABC DEF,
DE
EF DF .
66. P K, Q L, R M, P QK L,
BC AC m
EF DF n . Cross products yield
So
R
Q L M
, PR
K M
AB DE m m m
n , BC EF n , and AC DF n .
Using substitution, the perimeter of
6-5 Parts of Similar Triangles ABC DE m
m
m
n EF n DF n , or
m(DE EF DF). The ratio of the two
n
Page 319 Check for Understanding perimeters
1. ABC MNQ and A D and M R are altitudes, m(DE EF DF)
n
m
angle bisectors, or medians. DE EF DF or n .
2. Sample answer: The perimeters are in the same height of Tamika distance from camera
24 9. ¬
proportion as the side measures, which is 2 height of image length of camera
36 or 3 .
165
¬x
So if the smaller triangle has side lengths 6, 8, 5 10
and 10 (so that its perimeter is 6 8 10 24), 1650 ¬5x
then the larger triangle has side lengths 330 ¬x
3 (6), 3(8), and 3 (10) or 9, 12, and 15. Tamika should be 330 cm or 3.3 m from the
2 2 2
3. Let x represent the perimeter of DEF. The camera.
perimeter of ABC 5 6 7 or 18.
DE perimeter of DEF
AB ¬
Pages 320–322 Practice and Apply
perimeter of ABC
10. Let x represent the perimeter of BCD. The
3 ¬x
1
5 8 perimeter of FDE 4 5 8 or 17.
54 ¬5x CD perimeter of BCD
DE ¬
10.8 ¬x perimeter of FDE
The perimeter of DEF is 10.8 units. 12 x
8 ¬17
204 ¬8x
25.5 ¬x
The perimeter of BCD is 25.5 units.
175 Chapter 6
11. Let x represent the perimeter of ADF. The 18. Let x represent EG.
perimeter of BCE 24 12 18 or 54. AD AC
¬
perimeter of ADF EH EG
DF
CE ¬
15 1 7
perimeter of BCE ¬
7.5 x
21
x 15x ¬127.5
18 ¬ 54
x ¬8.5
1134 ¬18x
Thus, EG 8.5.
63 ¬x
The perimeter of ADF is 63 units. 19. Let x represent EH.
BG B
C
EH EF
12. Let x represent the perimeter of CBH. The
perimeter of FEH 11 6 10 or 27. ADEG is 4
3
x
2
D
a parallelogram, so A
GE and BCH HFE. 12
H
so C corresponds to FH
. 3 6
x 3
CH perimeter of CBH
FH ¬
9 6x
perimeter of FEH
7 x 3 x
10 ¬
2
2
7
189 ¬10x Thus, EH 3
2.
18.9 ¬x FB
FG
¬
20. SA ST
The perimeter of CBH is 18.9 units.
7 x
¬x5
13. Let x represent the perimeter of DEF. 2
DF perimeter of DEF 7x x2 ¬10
FC ¬
0 ¬x2 7x 10
perimeter of CBF
6 ¬
x 0 ¬(x 5)(x 2)
8 27 x 5 ¬0 or x 2 0
162 ¬8x x ¬5 x2
20.25 ¬x We must choose x 5 because otherwise FB 5
The perimeter of DEF is 20.25 units. and so FB FG, but the hypotenuse must be
14. Let x represent the perimeter of ABC. The longer than either leg. Thus, x 5 and FB 2.
perimeter of CBD 3 4 5 or 12. DG D
C
JM JL
perimeter of ABC 21.
CB
B ¬ perimeter of CBD
D 6x
2
x 4
5 ¬x
3 12 8 6x x2
60 ¬3x x2 6x 8 0
20 ¬x (x 4)(x 2) 0
The perimeter of ABC is 20 units. x40 or x20
15. Let x represent the perimeter of ABC. CBD is x4 x2
a right triangle, so use the Pythagorean Theorem We must choose x 2 because otherwise JM 4
to find BD. and so JM JL, but the hypotenuse must be
(CD)2 (BD)2 (CB)2 longer than either leg. Thus, x 2 and DC 4.
122 (BD)2 31.22 12 x 5
32 ¬ 2x 3
22.
144 (BD)2 973.44
(BD)2 829.44 24x 36 ¬32x 160
BD 28.8 36 ¬8x 160
The perimeter of CBD 31.2 28.8 12 or 72. 124 ¬8x
AB
perimeter of ABC
¬ 15.5 ¬x
CB perimeter of CBD
11 20 x
23. 14 ¬ x
52 8.8 x
.2 ¬
31 7
2 11x ¬280 14x
33.8(72) ¬31.2x 25x ¬280
2433.6 ¬31.2x
78 ¬x x ¬11 1
5
The perimeter of ABC is 78 units. x
3 x
24. 6 4
16. The original picture is similar to the enlarged
4x 12 6x
picture, so the dimensions and perimeters are
12 2x
proportional. The perimeter of the original picture
6x
is 2(18) 2(24) or 84 cm. The perimeter of the
enlarged picture is 0.30(84) 84 or 109.2 cm. The x 9
25. 8 2x
enlarged picture will take approximately 109.2 cm
2x2 72
of cord, so 110 cm will be enough.
x2 36
17. Yes, the perimeters are in the same proportion as x6
300
the sides, 1
600 or 2 . x represents a length, which must be positive. So,
x 6.
Chapter 6 176
26.
TA and W
B
are medians, so RA AS and 31. Given: ABC RST, A D is a median of ABC.
UB BV. Then RS 2(RA) and UV 2(UB). U
R is a median of RST.
TA RS AD AB
WB UV Prove:
RU
RS
8 2(3)
3x 6 2(x
2) A R
8 6
3x 6
2x 4
16x 32 18x 36 T S
C B U
32 2x 36 D
68 2x Proof:
34 x Statements Reasons
UB x 2
34 2 or 36 1. ABC RST 1. Given
D
A is a median of
F
27. B bisects ABC, so by the Angle Bisector
ABC.
AF BA
Theorem,
C F
BC . Let x represent CF. Then U
R is a median of
AF ¬9 x. RST.
9 x 6 2. CD DB; TU US
x ¬
7.5
2. Def. of median
67.5 7.5x ¬6x AB CB 3. Def. of polygons
RS TS
3.
67.5 ¬13.5x
5 ¬x 4. CB CD DB; 4. Segment Addition
Thus, CF 5. TS TU US Postulate
C
A
ED
, so BED BFC. FBC EBD, so AB CD DB
RS TU US
5. 5. Substitution
by AA Similarity, EBD FBC. Let y represent
AB DB DB B)
2(D
RS US US or 2(US)
6.
BD. 6. Substitution
BD ED
C ¬
B AB D
B
RS US
FC 7. 7. Substitution
y 9
¬
7.5 5 8. B S 8. Def. of polygons
5y ¬67.5
y ¬13.5 9. ABD RSU 9. SAS Similarity
Thus, BD 13.5 AD AB
RU RS
10. 10. Def. of polygons
height of person distance from camera
28.
height of image
¬ length of camera 32. Given:
CD bisects ACB. By construction
x 7 12 E
A
CD.
2 ¬
1
15 AD AC
Prove:
B
15x ¬1008 DB C
x ¬67.2 E
The person is 67.2 inches or about 5 feet 7 inches C
tall.
29. xy z2; ACD CBD by AA Similarity. Thus, 3 1 2
CD AD z x
BD CD or y z . The cross products yield xy z .
2
A D B
30. Given: ABC PQR Proof:
BD BA Statements Reasons
Prove:
QS
QP
1.
CD bisects ACB. 1. Given
Q
B By construction,
E
A
CD.
AD EC 2. Triangle Propor-
A
D
C P
S
R 2.
DB
BC
tionality Theorem
Proof: Since ABC PQR, A P. BDA 3. 1 2 3. Definition of Angle
QSP because they are both right angles created Bisector
by the altitude drawn to the opposite side and all
4. Alternate Interior
right angles are congruent. Thus ABD PQS 4. 3 1
BD BA
Angle Theorem
by AA Similarity and QS QP by the definition
5. 2 E 5. Corresponding
of similar polygons.
Angle Postulate
6. 3 E 6. Transitive Prop.
C
7. EA
C
7. Isosceles Th.
8. EC AC 8. Def. of congruent
segments
AD AC
9. B
D BC 9. Substitution
177 Chapter 6
33. Given: ABC PQR, B D is an altitude of 36. Given:
RU bisects SRT.
ABC. Q
S
is an altitude of PQR. U
V
R T
QP QS SV SR
Prove:
Prove: BA BD VR RT
B Q S
V U
A C P R T
D R
S Proof:
Proof: A P because of the definition of Statements Reasons
D
similar polygons. Since B and Q
S
are
1.
RU bisects SRT. 1. Given
C
perpendicular to A and PR
, BDA QSP. So,
QP QS U
V
R T
ABD PQS by AA Similarity and BA
BD
2. S S 2. Reflexive Prop.
by definition of similar polygons.
34. Given: C BDA 3. SUV STR 3. Corresponding
AC AD Postulate
Prove:
DA
BA
4. SUV STR 4. AA Similarity
C
B SV SR 5. Def. of s
VU RT
5.
A
D
6. URT VUR 6. Alternate Interior
C BDA Theorem
Given AC
— AD
— 7. VRU URT 7. Def. of bisector
ADB ACD DA BA
A A AA Similarity Def. of
polygons 8. VUR VRU 8. Transitive Prop.
Reflexive Prop.
U
9. VV
R
9. If 2 of a are
35. Given: bisects EFG.
JF , the sides opp.
H
E
FG
, EF
H
G these are .
EK G
J
KF JF
Prove: 10. VU VR 10. Def. of segments
J SV SR
11.
VR RT 11. Substitution
Chapter 6 178
38. Sample answer: The geometry occurs inside the PQ 2x 1
camera as the image is formed on the film. 2(7) 1 or 15
Answers should include the following. 46. The line goes through (3, 0) and (0, 3).
• 3 0
lens m 0 3 or 1
film object
y mx b
y 1x (3)
• The triangles are similar because the SAS
yx3
Similarity Theorem holds. The congruent angles
are the vertical angles and the corresponding sides 47. y y1 m(x x1)
are the congruent sides of the isosceles triangles. y (1) 2[x (1)]
y 1 2x 2
39. Let x represent DF.
y 2x 1
AC
AB
DF ¬
DE 48. 5 12 19 26 33
10
.5 6.5
x ¬ 8 7 7 7 7
179 Chapter 6
4. XZ XW WZ Stage 4:
33.25 XW 11.45
21.8 XW
Z
In order to show Y
V
W
, we must show that
XV XW XV 34.
88 43
6 XW 21.8 43
6
VY WZ . VY 18.32 or 229 . WZ 11.45 or 229 .
XV XW 43
6
VY WZ 229 . Since the sides have
Thus,
Z
proportional lengths, Y
VW
.
5. Let x represent the perimeter of DEF. The
perimeter of GFH 2 2.5 4 or 8.5.
EF perimeter of DEF
FH ¬
perimeter of GFH
6 ¬ x
4 8.5
51 ¬4x
12.75 ¬x
6. Let x represent the perimeter of RUW. The There are 81 nonshaded triangles at Stage 4.
perimeter of STV 12 18 24 or 54.
perimeter of RUW 2. Stage 0: 16 16 16 or 48 units
UW
VT perimeter of STV
Stage 1: 8 8 8 or 24 units
21
x Stage 2: 4 4 4 or 12 units
18 54
Stage 3: 2 2 2 or 6 units
1134 18x Stage 4: 1 1 1 or 3 units
63 x
3. The perimeter will be divided by 2 from stage to
18 x 10
7. x ¬
14 stage, getting smaller and smaller and
252 14x ¬10x approaching zero.
252 ¬24x 4. Yes, DFM is equilateral with 2 units on each
10.5 ¬x side. Yes, BCE, GHL, and IJN are
4 6 equilateral with 1 unit on each side.
8. x
x 3
5. yes, by AA Similarity because each triangle has
4x 12 6x
all angles of measure 60
12 2x
6x 6. 3, each sharing a side with the shaded triangle in
Stage 1.
9. 25
x 10
¬x 7.
2x2 ¬50
x2 ¬25
x ¬5
Because x represents length, x cannot be negative.
So, x 5.
10. Let x represent the longest side of the second
garden.
53
.5 25 8. Three copies of the Stage 4 Sierpinski triangle
32.1 ¬ x
combine to form a Stage 5 triangle (just as three
53.5x ¬802.5 copies of a Stage 2 triangle combine to form a
x ¬15 Stage 3 triangle).
The longest side of the second garden is 15 feet.
9. 9 copies: 3 to make a Stage 5 triangle, and
3 copies of the Stage 5 triangle, so a total of 3 3
or 9 Stage 4 triangles
Page 324 Geometry Activity: Sierpinski Triangle
1. Stage 3:
Chapter 6 180
4. Stage 1: 2, Stage 2: 6, Stage 3: 14, Stage 4: 30 14. Stage Number of Dots Pattern
1 1 10
2 3 21
3 6 33
4 10 46
The formula is the stage number plus the number
of dots in the previous stage: An n An 1.
So, in the seventh stage, the number of dots is
Stage 3 Stage 4
A7 7 A6, where A6 6 A5 and A5 5 A4
5. Stage Number of Branches Pattern 5 10 or 15. Then A6 6 15 or 21 and A7 7
1 2 2(21 1) 21 or 28. So there are 28 dots.
2 6 2(22 1) 15. 1, 3, 6, 10, 15…; Each difference is 1 more than
3 14 2(23 1) the preceding difference.
4 30 2(24 1)
16. The triangular numbers are the numbers in the
The formula is twice the difference of 2 to a power
diagonal.
that is the stage number and 1: An 2(2n 1).
17. The result is similar to a Stage 3 Sierpinski
6. No, the base of the tree or segment of a branch triangle.
without an end does not contain a replica of the
entire tree. 1
1 1
7. 2 ¬1.4142… 1 0 1
¬1.1892…
2 1 1 1 1
1 0 0 0 1
8. 2 1.0905…; the results are getting closer 1 1 0 0 1 1
to 1, so the result after 100 repeats approaches 1. 1 0 1 0 1 0 1
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
9. Yes, the procedure is repeated over and over
again. 18. It is similar to a Stage 1 Sierpinski triangle.
10. First, write an equation to find the balance after
one year. 1
current balance (current balance interest rate) 1 1
new balance 1 2 1
4000 (4000 0.011) 4044 1 0 0 1
4044 (4044 0.011) 4088.48 1 1 0 1 1
1 2 1 1 2 1
4088.48 (4088.48 0.011) 4133.45
4133.45 (4133.45 0.011) 4178.92 1 0 0 2 0 0 1
After compounding interest four times, Jamir will
1 1 0 2 2 0 1 1
have $4178.92 in the account.
19. All of the numbers in the outside diagonal of
Pascal’s triangle are 1, so the sum of 25 1’s is 25.
Pages 328–331 Practice and Apply 20. The second diagonal consists of the natural
11. 9 holes
numbers, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5,…, 50. The sum is
1 2 3 4 46 47 48 49 50
50 (1 49) (2 48) (3 47)
(24 26) 25
50 24(50) 25
1275
12. 73 holes
181 Chapter 6
21. Given: ABC is equilateral. CD 1
3 CB and
n
CE 1
CA
3
28. P 3 4
3 ; as the stages increase, the
perimeter increases and approaches infinity.
Prove: CED CAB
29. The original triangle and the new triangles are
A equilateral and thus, all of the angles are equal to
60. By AA Similarity, the triangles are similar.
30. x 12 3.46410… 1.8612… 1.3642… 1.168…
E
x
3.46410… 1.8612… 1.3642… 1.168… 1.0807…
B C
D The numbers converge to 1.
Proof: 31. x 5 0.2 5 0.2 5
Statements Reasons
1
x 0.2 5 0.2 5 0.2
1. ABC is 1. Given
equilateral. The numbers alternate between 0.2 and 5.
CD 1
3 CB
32. x 0.3 0.6694… 0.8747… 0.9563… 0.9852…
1
CE 3CA 1
0.6694… 0.8747… 0.9563… 0.9852… 0.9950…
x3
C
2. AB
C
2. Def. of equilateral The numbers converge to 1.
3. AC BC 3. Def. of segments 33. x 0 1 2 4 16
4. 1 1
3 AC 3 CB
4. Mult. Prop. 2x 1 2 4 16 65,536
CD CE 2x 1 3 7 15
CB CA
7. 7. Substitution
35. x 5 0 5
8. C C 8. Reflexive Prop.
9. CED CAB 9. SAS Similarity x5 0 5 10
22. 36. x 2 3 8
x2 1 3 8 63
37. x 4 6 24
3(2 x) 6 24 66
current current interest 100
balance
balance rate payment
23. Yes; the smaller and smaller details of the shape
new
have the same geometric characteristics as the
balance
original form.
1250 (1250 0.015) 100 ¬1168.75
24. Stage 1: 6 1168.75 (1168.75 0.015) 100 ¬1086.28
Stage 2: 36 1086.28 (1086.28 0.015) 100 ¬1002.57
25. Stage Number of Segments Pattern The balance after 3 months will be $1,002.57.
0 1 40 39. 0.200 0.64 0.201 0.6423…
1 4 41 0.64 0.9216… 0.6423… 0.9188…
2 16 42 0.9216… 0.2890… 0.9188… 0.2981…
3 64 43
0.2890… 0.8219… 0.2981… 0.8369…
The formula is 4 to the power of the stage
0.8219… 0.5854… 0.8369… 0.5458…
number: An 4n.
So in Stage 8 there are 48 65,536 segments. 0.5854… 0.9708… 0.5458… 0.9916…
26. Stage 0: 1 unit, Stage 1: 1
1
3 unit, Stage 2: 9 unit,
0.9708… 0.1133… 0.9916… 0.0333…
1 0.1133… 0.4019… 0.0333… 0.1287…
Stage 3:
27 unit; as the stages increase, the
0.4019… 0.9615… 0.1287… 0.4487…
length of the segments will approach zero.
0.9615… 0.1478… 0.4487… 0.9894…
27. Stage 0: 3 units, Stage 1: 3 4
3 or 4 units, Stage 2:
2 3
3 4
4 4
3 3 3 3 or 5 1
4
3 units, Stage 3: 3 3 or Yes, the initial value affected the tenth value.
7 1
40. A small difference in initial data can have a large
9 units effect in later data.
Chapter 6 182
41. Sample answer: The leaves in the tree and the Page 331 Maintain Your Skills
branches of the trees are self-similar. These self- 21 3x 6
14 x 4
48.
similar shapes are repeated throughout the
painting. 21x 84 42x 84
42a. The flower and mountain are computer- 84 21x 84
generated; the feathers and moss are real. 168 21x
8x
42b. The fractals exhibit self-similarity and iteration.
x 16
17 20
49.
43. See students’ work.
44. 20x 272
x 13 3
5
50. 36
x
8x
3x2 48
x2 16
x 4
Reject x 4 because x represents length, which
is positive. So, x 4.
7 2x 1
51. x
15
105 2x2 x
In Stage 1, the shaded triangle has legs 3 and
0 2x2 x 105
4 units. The hypotenuse has length c, where
(x 7)(2x 15) 0
c2 32 42, or c 9 16 or 5. So, the
x 7 0 or 2x 15 0
perimeter of the triangle is 3 4 5 or 12 units.
x7 2x 15
In Stage 2, there are three small shaded triangles
x 7.5
and the larger shaded triangle from Stage 1. Each
Reject x 7.5 because x represents length,
of the small shaded triangles has legs 2 and
which is positive. So, x 7.
1.5 units. The hypotenuse has length d, where
d2 22 1.52, or d 4 2.25
or 2.5. So, the AK BL
JA JB
52.
perimeter of all shaded triangles in Stage 2 is 18 (JA) 9
3(2 1.5 2.5) 12 or 30 units.
JA
27 9
18
(JA)
9
45. Sample answer: Fractal geometry can be found in JA 18
the repeating patterns of nature. Answers should 324 18(JA) 9(JA)
include the following. 324 27(JA)
• Broccoli is an example of fractal geometry 12 JA
because the shape of the florets is repeated
JB AB
JL KL
53.
throughout; one floret looks the same as the
stalk. 1
3 8
JL
10
• Sample answer: Scientists can use fractals to
study the human body, rivers, and tributaries, 130 8(JL)
and to model how landscapes change over time. 16 1
4 JL
46. Suppose the 24-inch side of the larger triangle AK B
L
JA ¬ JB
54.
corresponds to the smallest side of the smaller
10 1
4
25 ¬ JB
triangle. Let P represent the perimeter of the
larger triangle.
24
10(JB) ¬350
P
3 368
JB ¬35
24(3 6 8) 3P 55. If one side of a triangle is longer than another
408 3P side, then the angle opposite the longer side has
136 P a greater measure than the angle opposite the
The maximum perimeter is 136 inches. shorter side. The sides of the triangle in order
47. C; Let x be the number of minutes the repair from least to greatest are 965, 1038, and 1042.
technician worked in excess of 30 minutes. So, the angles opposite these sides in the same
170 ¬80 2x order are arranged from least to greatest. That
90 ¬2x order is Miami, Bermuda, and San Juan.
45 ¬x 56. P 5s
The repair technician worked 30 45 or 60 5s
75 minutes. 12 s
Each side has measure 12 cm.
183 Chapter 6
4 x 16
57. P 2 2w 14. 3 x ¬ 25
54 2(2x 1) 2(x 2) 25(4 x) ¬16(3 x)
54 4x 2 2x 4 100 25x ¬48 16x
54 6x 6 100 ¬48 41x
48 6x 52 ¬41x
8x 52
41 ¬x
x 2 8 2 or 10
2x 1 2(8) 1 or 17 x 12 x
7
15. 6 ¬4
The sides of the polygon have measures 10 feet,
4(x 12) ¬6(x 7)
10 feet, 17 feet, and 17 feet.
4x 48 ¬6x 42
58. P n 2(n 2) 2n 7 48 ¬10x 42
57 n 2n 4 2n 7 6 ¬10x
57 5n 3 3 ¬x
60 5n 5
12 n number of total bases from hits
16.
number of total at-bats
n 2 12 2 or 14 26
3
2n 7 2(12) 7 or 17 416
The sides of the polygon have measures 17, 14, 0.632
14, and 12 units. 17. Rewrite 2 : 7 as 2x : 7x and use those measures
as the lengths of the pieces of the board after
cutting it.
2x 7x 108
Chapter 6 Study Guide and Review 9x 108
x 12
2x 2(12) or 24
Page 332 Vocabulary and Concept Check 7x 7(12) or 84
1. true The two pieces have lengths 24 inches and
2. false, proportional 84 inches.
3. true 18. In similar polygons, corresponding sides are in
TU 6 or 2. But
UV
4. false, sides proportion.
VW 9 3 UV 1, so two of
5. false, iteration the sides are in a 2 : 3 ratio while two others are
6. false, one-half equal in length. Thus, the triangles are not
7. true similar.
8. true 19. The figures are rectangles, so all angles are
LK 24 3 LM 30 3
congruent. 16 or 2 and PQ 20 or 2 , so
9. false, parallel to RQ
the sides are in a 3 : 2 ratio. Opposite sides are
congruent, so all sides are in a 3 : 2 ratio. Thus,
the figures are similar.
Pages 332–336 Lesson-by-Lesson Review
3 x 20. ABCD AEFG
10. 4 12 AD AB
AG ¬ AE
3(12) 4x
36 4x x x2
7.5 ¬
x x 25
9x x x 2
11. 7 28 x 7.5 ¬ x 3
3 z
x(x 3) ¬(x 7.5)(x 2)
7z 3(28) x2 3x ¬x2 2x 7.5x 15
7z 84 x2 3x ¬x2 5.5x 15
z 12 3x ¬5.5x 15
x
2 14 2.5x ¬15
12. 5 ¬
10 x ¬6
10(x 2) ¬5(14)
AB x 2
10x 20 ¬70
6 2 or 4
10x ¬50
AG x 7.5
x ¬5
6 7.5 or 13.5
13. 3 7
y
AD x 6 4
7 3 AG x 7.5 13.5 or 9 .
The scale factor is
3(y 3) 7(7)
3y 9 49
3y 58
58
y3
Chapter 6 184
21.
PT
SR, so P R and T S because they L
27. In order to show that G
H
K
, we must show
are alternate interior angles. PQT SQR IH IK
that HG KL .
because they are vertical angles. Thus, IH 2 1 3 IK 1
5
G 5
14 or 2 , and KL 9 or 3 .
PQT RQS.
H
PQ TQ Because the side lengths are not proportional,
RQ SQ L
G
H
K
.
6 x 3
6x 3x
28. IL IK KL
(6 x)(3 x) (6 x)(3) 36 28 KL
18 6x 3x x2 18 3x 8 KL
18 3x x2 18 3x In order to show that G L
HK, we must show
IH IK
18 x2 18 that
HG
KL .
x2 0 IH 35 7 IK 28 7
x0
HG
10 or 2 , and KL 8 or 2 .
IH IK
HG KL , so GL
H
K.
PQ 6 x
6 0 or 6 L
29. In order to show that G
HK, we must show
QS 3 x IH IK
HG KL . Let KL x. Then IL 3x and
that
3 0 or 3
TQ
3 3 IK 3x x or 2x.
SQ 3 x 3 0 or 1.
The scale factor is
IK x
2 IH 22 IK IH
KL x or 2, and HG 11 or 2. KL HG . Thus,
22. Triangles ABC and DFE are isosceles triangles.
A D, and BA CA and FD ED so L
G
H
K
.
BA C
A
FD ED . Thus, ABC DFE by SAS 30. In order to show that GL
H K
, we must show
IH IK
Similarity. that
HG
KL . Let HI x. Then IG 3x, so
I
J
23. H K
, so GHI GJK and GIH GKJ HG 3x x or 2x.
because they are corresponding angles. Thus, IH x 1 IK 1
8
HG 2x or 2 , and KL 6 or 3. So the sides are
GHI GJK by AA Similarity.
24. mL mQ mLMQ ¬180 not proportional and G
H
L K
.
35 85 mLMQ ¬180 31. From the Triangle Proportionality Theorem,
mLMQ ¬60 BC ED
AB AE .
LMQ NMP, so mNMP 60.
Substitute the known measures.
mN mP mNMP 180
mN 40 60 180 4
ED
9
6
mN 80 4(9) 6(ED)
LMQ is not similar to PMN because the 36 6(ED)
angles of the triangles are not congruent. 6 ED
25. Since A B
D E, B E and A D because 32. From the Triangle Proportionality Theorem,
BC ED
AB AE .
they are alternate interior angles. By AA
Similarity, ABC DEC. Using the definition
BC AC Substitute the known measures.
EC DC .
of similar polygons, 16 12 5
x3
1
2
AE
1
2 6
11x 4 5
6(x 3) 1(11x 2) 12
AE
6x 18 11x 2 4(AE) 12(5)
18 5x 2 4(AE) 60
20 5x AE 15
4x E
33. Since B
C D
, ABE ACD and AEB
26. V UST and T T, so by AA Similarity, ADC by the corresponding angles postulate.
RVT UST. Using the definition of similar Then ABE ACD by the AA Similarity. Using
RT V
T
UT ST .
polygons, CD AD
BE AE .
the definition of similar polygons,
2x 4 3 x2
x2
Substitute the known measures.
4
2x 4 x5 CD 84
x 2 4 6 8
4(2x 4) (x 2)(x 5) CD 12
8x 16 x2 5x 2x 10
6 8
8x 16 x2 7x 10 8(CD) 6(12)
16 x2 x 10 8(CD) 72
0 x2 x 6 CD 9
0 (x 3)(x 2)
x 3 0 or x 2 0
x3 x 2
Reject x 2 because otherwise UT x 2
2 2 or 0. So x 3.
185 Chapter 6
E
34. Since B
C D
, ABE ACD and AEB 39. Stage 2 is not similar to Stage 1.
ADC by the corresponding angles postulate.
Then ABE ACD by the AA Similarity. Using
AC CD
the definition of similar polygons,
AB
BE .
Substitute the known measures. 40.
33 BC 32 x 2 4 60
33
24 x3 4 4 60 215,996
24(33 BC) 33(32)
792 24(BC) 1056 41. x 4 8 20
24(BC) 264
BC 11 3x 4 8 20 56
Chapter 6 186
9. Using corresponding angles, MAD MCB. 17. CMA ACB and A A, so
AM
DM ABC ACM by AA Similarity.
CM BM (AM)2 62 102
25 3
x
x 20
12 (AM)2 36 100
300 3x2 60x (AM)2 64
0 3x2 60x 300 AM 8
0 x2 20x 100 BC AC
CM AM
0 (x 10)(x 10) B C 1 0
6
x 10 0 8
x 10 8(BC) 60
DM 3
x 3(10) 30 BC 7.5
The scale factor is BM 12
12 12 or
5 : 2. B
C AB
CM ¬
AC
PQ 5 1
10.
ML 10 or 2 7.5 8 MB
6 ¬ 10
PR 6 1
MN 12 or 2 75 ¬448 6(MB)
QR
3 or 1
27 ¬6(MB)
LN 6 2 4.5 ¬MB
Corresponding sides are proportional, so the The perimeter of ABC is 10 7.5 8 4.5 or
triangles are similar by SSS Similarity. 30.
11. PTS QTR since they are vertical angles. 18. x 3 12 87
mPTS mQTR 90.
mPTS mS mP 180 5x 27 12 87 462
90 62 mP 180 height of fence shadow of fence
mP 28 19.
height of backboard
shadow of backboard
mQTR mR mQ 180 4ft 20
in.
90 66 mQ 180
x ¬ 65 in.
mQ 24 48 20
x ¬
65
Since only one pair of corresponding angles is 3120 ¬20x
congruent, the triangles are not similar. 156 ¬x
D
12. E
C B
so AED ACB and ADE ABC The height of the top of the backboard is
because corresponding angles are congruent. Then 156 inches, or 13 feet.
the triangles are similar by AA Similarity. X Y
20. B; X Y is spent, which is X as part of the
GK GH weekly salary.
KJ HI
13.
8
KJ 12
KJ 4
4(8 KJ) 12(KJ)
32 4(KJ) 12(KJ) Chapter 6 Standardized Test Practice
32 16(KJ)
2 KJ
GK GH
Pages 338–339
KJ
14. 1. B; |8 2| |6| 6
HI
GK 7
6
2. B; d
[5
(3)]2
(2
17)2
14 7
GK 7 (2)
2
(1
5)2
6 7
7(GK) 42
4 225
GK 6 229
miles
GK GH 3. A
KJ HI
15.
6 9 4. D
H
4 I 1.5
cm 11.25cm
5. A; 2 ft ¬ x ft
6(HI) 36
HI 6 1.5x ¬22.5
GI GH HI x ¬15 ft
9 6 or 15 45 5
6. B; 63 7 , so the dimensions could be 7 inches by
16. Let x represent the perimeter of DEF. 5 inches.
CB perimeter of ACB
EF
perimeter of DEF 7. C; us pr because side UT corresponds to side RQ
10 7 10 13 and side ST corresponds to side PQ.
14
x
8. D
10 30
14 x
9. counterexample
10x 420
x 42
The perimeter of DEF is 42 units.
187 Chapter 6
10. y y1 m(x x1) 13d. The new monthly rate will be $25 per month, so
y 2 3(x 2) the equation will be y 25x 40. The graph will
y 2 3x 6 have a less steep slope.
y 3x 4 14a. Using the Triangle Proportionality Theorem, if a
11. PQ 1
2 EF
line is parallel to one side of a triangle and
intersects the other two sides in two distinct
20 1
2 (3x 4)
points, then it separates these sides into
20 3
2x 2
segments of proportional length, so AE AD
AC AB .
18 3
2x
Since the corresponding sides are proportional
12 x and the included angle, A, is the same, by SAS
Similarity Theorem we know that the triangles
20
cm perimeter of model
40 m ¬
12. 23 40 46 are similar.
20
x 14b. If B is between A and D and C is between A and
40 ¬ 109
AB AD
E, then BC DE .
2180 ¬40x
54.5 ¬x 3500 3500
1500
1400 ¬
DE
The perimeter of the model is 54.5 cm. 3500 5000
1400 ¬ DE
(160 40)
13a. m
(4 0) 3500(DE) ¬7,000,000
120 DE ¬2000
4
30 If D is between A and B and E is between A and
AB
AD
13b. The slope represents the monthly flat rate, so C, then BC DE.
the company charges a flat rate of $30 per 3500 3500
1500
1400 ¬
DE
month. 3500 2000
1400 ¬ DE
13c. y y1 m(x x1)
y 40 30(x 0) 3500(DE) ¬2,800,000
y 40 30x DE ¬800
y 30x 40 So, DE is 2000 feet or 800 feet.
Chapter 6 188
Chapter 7 Right Triangles and Trigonometry
Page 341 Getting Started
1. 3 12 7-1 Geometric Mean
4 ¬ a
3a ¬48
a ¬16 Page 343 Geometry Software Investigation
2. 5c ¬8
3 1. See students’ work.
3c ¬40 2. They are equal.
c ¬13.33
e 6 3. They are equal.
20 ¬ 5
3.
4. They are similar.
5e ¬120
e ¬24
6 ¬f
5 10 Pages 345–346 Check for Understanding
60 ¬5f 1. Sample answer: 2 and 72.
12 ¬f Let x represent the geometric mean.
4. 4
6
3 ¬ y 2 ¬x
x 72
4y ¬18 x2 ¬144
y ¬4.5 x ¬ 144 or 12
4 ¬1
z
3
2. C
4z ¬3
z ¬0.75
A
5. c2 52 122 D B
c2 25 144 169 For leg CB
, D
B is the segment of the hypotenuse
c 13 that shares an endpoint. Thus, it is the adjacent
6. c2 62 82 segment. The same is true for leg A C
and segment
c2 36 64 100 D
A .
c 10 3. Ian; his proportion shows that the altitude is the
7. c2 152 152 geometric mean of the two segments of the
c2 225 225 450 hypotenuse.
c 21.21 4. Let x represent the geometric mean.
9 x
8. c2 142 272 ¬
x 4
c2 196 729 925 x ¬36
2
c 30.41 x ¬ 36 or 6
9. 8 42 5. Let x represent the geometric mean.
4
2 2
2 36 x
x ¬
4
9
10. 102 100
52 25
x2 ¬1764
75
25 3
x ¬1764
or 42
25
3 53
6. Let x represent the geometric mean.
11. 39
2
362
1521
129 6
225 15 6 ¬x
x 8
7 72 x2 ¬48
12.
2
2
2 x ¬ 48 or 4
3
7
2 7 2
2
x ¬6.9
4
13. x 44 38 ¬180 7. Let x represent the geometric mean.
x 82 ¬180 2
¬x
2
x ¬98 x 32
x2 ¬12
14. x 40 155
x 115 x ¬12
or 23
x ¬3.5
15. x 2x 21 90 ¬180
3x 111 ¬180 8. Let x CD.
3x ¬69 AD
¬ CD
CD BD
x ¬23
2 ¬x
x 6
x2 ¬12
x ¬12
or 23
x ¬3.5
189 Chapter 7
9. Let x EH. 15. Let x represent the geometric mean.
GH EH
45 x
x ¬ 80
EH ¬ FH
16 12
x ¬ x x2 ¬3600
12
x2 ¬48 x2 ¬60
x ¬48
or 43 x ¬60 or 215
x ¬6.9 x ¬7.7
BD CD BA CA 16. Let x represent the geometric mean.
CD ¬ AD
10. CA ¬ DA
28
¬x
x
y
8 x
x ¬3
8 3
y ¬ 1372
3
x2 ¬24 y2 ¬33 x2 ¬38,41
6
x ¬24
y ¬33
x2 ¬196
x ¬26 x ¬196
or 14
BD CD BA BC 17. Let x represent the geometric mean.
CD ¬ DA
11. ¬
BC BD 3
x 2
¬ 3 x 2 y
y ¬x
5 x
23 2 x ¬1
6 2 y
2x ¬12 y ¬6 x2 ¬53
x ¬6 y2 ¬48
y ¬48
or 43
x ¬ 3
5
3
x
12. Z 5
15
x ¬
5
x ¬0.8
18. Let x represent the geometric mean.
8
3
¬x
5
x
6 3
5
144
x2 ¬25
wall
x ¬
14
25
4
1 44
x ¬
Y 2 5
X 1
x ¬ 2
5 or 2.4
5 ft
19. Let x represent the geometric mean.
2
2
6 x
12 ft W x ¬
5
2
6
Draw a diagram. Let Y X
be the altitude drawn 20
x2 ¬
36
from the right angle of WYZ.
WX YX
YX ¬ ZX
20
x ¬
36
5 1
¬ 2
2 0
12 ZX x ¬
3 6
5ZX ¬144 2
5
ZX ¬28.8 x ¬
6
Khaliah estimates that the wall is about 5 28.8 5
or 33.8 feet high. x ¬
3
x ¬0.7
Pages 346–348 Practice and Apply 20. Let x represent the geometric mean.
13
13. Let x represent the geometric mean. 7 x
x ¬
5
5 x
x ¬6
7
x2 ¬30 65
x2 ¬
49
x ¬ 30
x ¬5.5
65
x ¬
49
14. Let x represent the geometric mean.
65 65
24 x x ¬
x ¬ 25
49 7
x ¬600
2
x ¬1.2
x ¬ 600 or 106
x ¬24.5
Chapter 7 190
y
21. Let x ¬AD. x ¬
y 6
BD AD
¬
AD CD
y2 6x
5
x 5
y2 6 0
3
x ¬9
x2 ¬45 y2 100
x ¬45 or 35
y ¬100
x ¬6.7 y ¬10
22. Let x ¬EH. x ¬ z
x
z 6
FH EH z2 x2 6x
¬
EH GH 2
12 x z2 3 6 3
50 5
0
x ¬
12
2500
x2 ¬144 z2 9 100
x ¬144
or 12 16
z2 00
9
23. Let x ¬LM.
JM
¬
LM
LM
KM
1600
z ¬ 4
9 or 3
0
8 x 29. z2 52 ¬152
x ¬
16 z2 25 ¬225
x2 ¬128 z2 ¬200
x ¬128
or 82 z ¬200 or 102
x ¬11.3 z ¬14.1
15 z
z ¬x
24. Let x QS.
PS Q S 15x ¬z2
S ¬
Q RS
15x ¬(10
2
2)
21 x
x ¬7
15x ¬200
x2 ¬147 40
x ¬3
x ¬147
15 5
5 ¬ y
x ¬12.1
15y 25
25. Let x UW.
VW
¬ UW
y ¬5
3
UW TW
2 x 30. x2 42 ¬102
x ¬
13 x2 16 ¬100
x2 ¬26 x2 ¬84
x ¬26
x ¬84 or 221
x ¬5.1 x ¬9.2
y4 10
26. Let x ZN. ¬4
10
YN ZN
ZN ¬ XN
4y 16 ¬100
2.5 x 4y ¬84
x ¬
1
0 y ¬21
x2 ¬25 zy4
x ¬25
or 5 z 21 4 25
3 8 x 6x 36
27. x ¬8
31. 6 ¬x
3
x2 ¬88 6x2 ¬1296
x ¬88
or 222
x2 ¬216
x ¬9.4 x ¬216 or 66
3
8 y x ¬14.7
y ¬3 6x x y
y ¬
y2 ¬33 x
y2 ¬7x2
y ¬33
y2 ¬7(66)2
y ¬5.7
y ¬1512
2
8 z
z ¬3 y ¬1512 or 642
z2 ¬24 y ¬38.9
z ¬24
or 26 6x x
z ¬6z
x
z ¬4.9 z2 ¬42x2
6 ¬ 8 z2 ¬42(66)2
28. 8 x 6
z ¬9072
2
6x 36 ¬64
z ¬9072 or 367
6x ¬100
50 z ¬95.2
x ¬3
191 Chapter 7
12 x
32. x ¬8 40. Sample answer: The golden ratio occurs when the
x2 ¬96 geometric mean is approximately 1.62.
x ¬ 96 or 46
41. Let x be the length of the brace. Let y be the
x ¬9.8 segment of the hypotenuse adjacent to the leg
12 8 y with measure 3 yards.
y ¬8
y2 ¬32
y ¬32
or 42
y ¬5.7
12 z
z ¬
12 8
z ¬48
2
5 yd 4 yd
z ¬48 or 43
z ¬6.9
a 17
33. ¬ y x
17
b
ab ¬17
3 yd
7b ¬17
17 5 ¬3
b ¬
7
3 y
5y ¬9
x 12
34. ¬
12
y y ¬9
5
xy ¬12 y x
¬
5
x3 ¬12 x y
12 x2 ¬5y y2
x ¬ or 43
2
3 x2 ¬59
5 5
9
x ¬6.9 81
x2 ¬9
25
35. Never; let x and x 1 be consecutive positive 144
x (x 1) x2 ¬
integers. The average of the numbers is 25
2
2x
or 2
1 x ¬
14
4 1
25 or 5
2
2x 1
x ¬
2 x ¬2.4
2x 1
x1 The brace is 2.4 yards long.
2 2 4x 1
4x
x x ¬
2
4 42. Let x be the geometric mean.
The number of players from Indiana is 10, and
x2 x ¬x2 x 1
4 the number of players from North Carolina is 7.
1 10
0 ¬4 x
x ¬ 7
Chapter 7 192
AD CD
¬
44.
CD BD
47. Given: ADC is a right D
12 C D B
angle. D is an
¬4
CD altitude of ADC.
(CD)2 ¬48 A
B AD A C
Prove:
AD
AC , B
CD ¬48 or 43 BC D C
(CB)2 (CD)2 (DB)2
DC
AC
(CB)2 (43)2 42 Proof:
(CB) 48 16
2
Statements Reasons
(CB)2 64
1. ADC is a right 1. Given
CB 64 or 8 B
angle. D is an
AB CB
CED ACB, so CD
DE. altitude of ADC.
12 4 8
¬ DE 2. ADC is a right 2. Definition of right
43
triangle. triangle
16DE ¬323
3. ABD ADC 3. If the altitude is
DE ¬23
DBC ADC drawn from the
45. Given: PQR is a ≈ right Q vertex of the rt. to
angle. QS
is an the hypotenuse of a
altitude of PQR. 2 rt. , then the 2 s
Prove: PSQ PQR P 1 R formed are similar to
S
PQR QSR the given and to
PSQ QSR each other.
Proof: AB AD 4. Definition of similar
4.
AD AC ,
BC DC
polygons
Statements Reasons
DC
AC
1. PQR is a right 1. Given
angle. 48. Sample answer: The geometric mean can be used
S
Q is an altitude of to help determine the optimum viewing distance.
PQR. Answers should include the following.
• If you are too far from a painting, you may not
S
2. Q R P
2. Definition of altitude
be able to see fine details. If you are too close,
3. 1 and 2 are 3. Definition of you may not be able to see the entire painting.
right angles. perpendicular lines
• A curator can use the geometric mean to help
4. 1 PQR 4. All right are . determine how far from the painting the roping
2 PQR should be.
5. P P 5. Congruence of angles 49. C; 6x ¬6
10
R R is reflexive.
10x ¬36
6. PSQ PQR 6. AA Similarity x ¬3.6
PQR QSR (statements 4 and 5) y 8
¬
7. PSQ QSR 7. Similarity of triangles 8 10
is transitive. 10y ¬64
y ¬6.4
46. Given: ADC is a right D 50. B; 5x2 405 ¬1125
B
angle. D is an 5x2 ¬720
altitude of ADC. x2 ¬144
AB D
B A C x ¬144
Prove: B
D CB B
x ¬12
Proof: It is given that ADC is a right angle and
B
D is an altitude of ADC. ADC is a right
triangle by the definition of a right triangle. Page 348 Maintain Your Skills
Therefore, ADB DCB, because if the altitude 51.
is drawn from the vertex of the right angle to the x 12 15 18
hypotenuse of a right triangle, then the two x3 15 18 21
triangles formed are similar to the given
AB DB 52.
x 4 14 44
triangle and to each other. So DB CB by
definition of similar polygons. 3x 2 14 44 134
53.
x 3 7 47
x2 2 7 47 2207
54.
x 1 4 14
2(x 3) 4 14 34
193 Chapter 7
55. The smallest angle is opposite the side with the 66. c2 32 52
smallest measure, 20. Let x and 20 x be the c2 9 25
measures of the segments formed by the angle c2 34
bisector. By the Angle Bisector Theorem, c 34
x ¬24
c 5.8
20 x 30 .
x 24 The length of the hypotenuse is about 5.8 inches.
¬
20 x 30
30x ¬480 24x
54x ¬480
Page 349 Geometry Activity: The Pythagorean
80 8
x ¬9 or 8 9 Theorem
10 0 1 1. yes
20 x ¬ 9 or 11 9
2. a2 b2 c2
The segments have measures 8 8 1
9 and 11 9 . 3. Sample answer: The sum of the areas of the two
56. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, smaller squares is equal to the area of the largest
m8 m6, m8 m3 m4, and square.
m8 m2. Thus, the measures of 6, 4, 2,
and 3 are all less than m8.
57. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
m1 m5 and m1 m7. Thus, the 7-2 The Pythagorean Theorem and
measures of 5 and 7 are greater than m1. Its Converse
58. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem,
m1 m7 and m6 m7. Thus, the
measures of 1 and 6 are less than m7. Pages 353–354 Check for Understanding
59. By the Exterior Angle Inequality Theorem, 1. Maria; Colin does not have the longest side as the
m2 m6, m7 m6, and m8 m6. value of c.
Thus, the measures of 2, 7, and 8 are all 2. Since the numbers in a Pythagorean triple satisfy
greater than m6. the equation a2 b2 c2, they represent the sides
60. y mx b of a right triangle by the converse of the
y 2x 4 Pythagorean Theorem.
8 0 3. A
61. m 02 3 5
8 3
2 or 4 C B
D 6
y mx b
y 4x (8) 6 5
6
y 4x 8
06
62. m
1
2
F
12
E
6
3 or 2 Sample answer: ABC DEF, A D,
y y1 ¬m(x x1) B E, and C F, A B corresponds to D
E,
y 6 ¬2(x 2) C
B corresponds to EF , A
C
corresponds to DF.
y 6 ¬2x 4 The scale factor is 2
1 . No; the measures of the
y ¬2x 2 sides do not form a Pythagorean triple since 6 5
and 3 5 are not whole numbers.
63. y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y (3) ¬4[x (2)] 4. x2 62 ¬102
y 3 ¬4(x 2) x2 36 ¬100
y 3 ¬4x 8 x2 ¬64
y ¬4x 11 x ¬64 or 8
2 2
64. c2 ¬32 42 5. x2 4
7 ¬ 7
5
c2 ¬9 16 16 25
c2 ¬25 x2 49 ¬ 49
9
c ¬ 25 or 5 x2 ¬
49
The length of the hypotenuse is 5 cm.
65. c2 52 122
x ¬
9
49 or 7
3
Chapter 7 194
7. y Pages 354–356 Practice and Apply
K (1 , 6 ) 12. The altitude divides the side of measure 14 into
two congruent segments of measure 7 because the
L(3, 5) triangle is an isosceles triangle.
x2 72 ¬82
x2 49 ¬64
J (2 , 2 )
x2 ¬15
O x x ¬ 15
x ¬3.9
13. x2 42 ¬82
JK
[1 (2)]2 (6
2)2
x2 16 ¬64
12 42 or 17
x2 ¬48
KL
[3 (1)]2
(5
6)2 x ¬48 or 4 3
4 (
2 1) or 17
2 x ¬6.9
JL
[3 (2)] 2
(5
2)2 14. 202 282 ¬x2
52 32 or 34
400 784 ¬x2
JK 2 KL2 ¬JL2 1184 ¬x2
2 2 2 1184 ¬x
17
17 ¬34 4 74 ¬x
17 17 ¬34 34.4 ¬x
34 ¬34
15. 402 322 ¬x2
Yes; JKL is a right triangle since the sum of the
1600 1024 ¬x2
squares of two sides equals the square of the
2624 ¬x2
longest side.
2624 ¬x
8. Since the measure of the longest side is 39, 39 8 41 ¬x
must be c, and a or b are 15 and 36. 51.2 ¬x
a2 b2 ¬c2 16. x2 252 ¬332
152 362 ¬392 x2 625 ¬1089
225 1296 ¬1521 x2 ¬464
1521 ¬1521 x ¬ 464
These segments form the sides of a right triangle x ¬4 29
since they satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem. The x ¬21.5
measures are whole numbers and form a
17. x2 152 ¬252
Pythagorean triple.
x2 225 ¬625
9. Since the measure of the longest side is 21, 21 x2 ¬400
must be c, and a or b are 40 and 20. x ¬ 400 or 20
a2 b2 ¬c2 18. y
2
40
202 ¬212
40 400 ¬441 R(1, 6)
440 ¬441
Since 400 441, segments with these measures
cannot form a right triangle. Therefore, they do
not form a Pythagorean triple.
10. Since the measure of the longest side is 108, O S(9, 0)
108 must be c, and a or b are 44 and 8. Q(1, 0) x
a2 b2 ¬c2 QR (1 1)2 (6
0)2
2 2
44 82 ¬ 108 02 62
44 64 ¬108 36 or 6
108 ¬108 RS (9 1)2 (0
6)2
Since 108 108, segments with these measures 82 (
6)2
form a right triangle. However the three numbers 100 or 10
are not all whole numbers. Therefore, they do not QS (9 1)2 (0
0)2
form a Pythagorean triple. 8 0
2 2
195 Chapter 7
19. y RS
[6 (4)]2 [9 (
4)]2
R (0, 6)
(2)
2 (5) or 29
2
S (6, 6)
QS [6 (9)]2 [ 9 (
2)]2
3 (
2 7) or 58
2
QR2 RS2 ¬QS2
Q (3, 2) (29) (
2
29) ¬(
2
58)
2
29 29 ¬58
x 58 ¬58
QR
(0 3)
2 (6
2)2 Since the sum of the squares of two sides equals
(3)2
42 the square of the longest side, QRS is a right
triangle.
25 or 5
22. Since the measure of the longest side is 17, 17
RS
(6 0)2 (6
6)2
must be c, and a or b are 8 and 15.
6 0
2 2
a2 b2 ¬c2
36 or 6 82 152 ¬172
QS (6 3)2 (6
2)2 64 225 ¬289
32 42 289 ¬289
25 or 5 These segments form the sides of a right triangle
QR QS2 ¬RS2
2 since they satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem. The
52 52 ¬62 measures are whole numbers and form a
25 25 ¬36 Pythagorean triple.
50 ¬36 23. Since the measure of the longest side is 25, 25
Since the sum of the squares of two sides is not must be c, and a or b are 7 and 24.
equal to the square of the longest side, QRS is a2 b2 ¬c2
not a right triangle. 72 242 ¬252
20. 49 576 ¬625
y
625 ¬625
R (2, 11) These segments form the sides of a right triangle
Q ( 4, 6) since they satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem. The
measures are whole numbers and form a
Pythagorean triple.
24. Since the measure of the longest side is 31, 31
x must be c, and a or b are 20 and 21.
S (4, 1) a2 b2 ¬c2
20 212 ¬312
2
QR
[2 (4)]2
(11
6)2 400 441 ¬961
6 5 or 61
2 2 841 ¬961
RS
(4 2)
2 (
1 11)2 Since 841 961, segments with these measures
2 (
2 12) or 148
2 cannot form a right triangle. Therefore, they do
not form a Pythagorean triple.
QS
[4 (4)]2
(1
6)2
8 (
2 7) or 113
2 25. Since the measure of the longest side is 37, 37
must be c, and a or b are 12 and 34.
QR2 QS2 ¬RS2
2 2 2 a2 b2 ¬c2
61
113
¬148
122 342 ¬372
61 113 ¬148 144 1156 ¬1369
174 ¬148 1300 ¬1369
Since the sum of the squares of two sides is not Since 1300 1369, segments with these measures
equal to the square of the longest side, QRS is cannot form a right triangle. Therefore, they do
not a right triangle. not form a Pythagorean triple.
21. y
x
Q (9, 2)
R (4, 4)
S (6, 9)
QR
[4
(9)]2
[
4 (
2)]2
5 (
2 2) or 29
2
Chapter 7 196
26. Since the measure of the longest side is 7
4
, 33. Sample answer: They consist of any number of
35
74 1 1
similar triangles.
must be c, and a or b are and .
35 5 7 34. Yes; the measures of the sides are always
a2 b2 ¬c2 multiples of 5, 12, and 13.
2 2
7 2
1
1
7 ¬ 35
4 35a. Find multiples of the triple 8, 15, 17.
5
1 1 74 8 2 ¬16
25 49 ¬
1225 15 2 ¬30
74
¬ 74
17 2 ¬34
1225 1225
162 302 ¬342
These segments form the sides of a right triangle 256 900 ¬1156
since they satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem. 1156 ¬1156
However, the three numbers are not whole
8 3 ¬24
numbers. Therefore, they do not form a
15 3 ¬45
Pythagorean triple.
17 3 ¬51
35
27. Since the measure of the longest side is
36 , 242 452 ¬512
35 3 2 576 2025 ¬2601
36 must be c, and a or b are 2 and 3 . 2601 ¬2601
a2 b2 ¬c2 Two triples are 16-30-34 and 24-45-51.
2 32 ¬3356
3 2 2 2
b. Find multiples of the triple 9, 40, 41.
9 2 ¬18
3 2 ¬
122
5 40 2 ¬80
4 9 1296
35 1225 41 2 ¬82
36 ¬ 1296
182 802 ¬822
35 122 5 324 6400 ¬6724
36 1296 , segments with these measures
Since
6724 ¬6724
cannot form a right triangle. Therefore, they do
not form a Pythagorean triple. 9 3 ¬27
40 3 ¬120
28. Since the measure of the longest side is 1, 1
41 3 ¬123
must be c, and a or b are 3
4
5 and 5 . 272 1202 ¬1232
a b ¬c
2 2 2
729 14,400 ¬15,129
2 2
5
3
4
5 ¬1
2 15,129 ¬15,129
9 16 Two triples are 18-80-82 and 27-120-123.
25
25 ¬1
c. Find multiples of the triple 7, 24, 25.
25
25 ¬1
7 2 ¬14
24 2 ¬48
These segments form the sides of a right triangle
25 2 ¬50
since they satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem.
142 482 ¬502
However, the three numbers are not all whole
196 2304 ¬2500
numbers. Therefore, they do not form a
2500 ¬2500
Pythagorean triple.
10 1
0 7 3 ¬21
29. Since the measure of the longest side is
7 , 7 24 3 ¬72
6
8
must be c, and a or b are 7 and 7 . 25 3 ¬75
a2 b2 ¬c2 212 722 ¬752
2 2 2
441 5184 ¬5625
7
6
8
1
7 ¬ 7
0
36 64 100
5625 ¬5625
49 49 ¬ 49
Two triples are 14-48-50 and 21-72-75.
100 100 36. d (105 122)2
(40
38)2
49 ¬ 49
100 100 (17) 2 22
197 Chapter 7
38. Given: ABC with m 41. Let x be the hypotenuse of the triangle with
sides of measure a, A F height 26 12 or 38 and base 1
2 (9) or 4.5.
b, and c, where 4.5 38 ¬x
2 2 2
c2 a2 b2 b c b x
20.25 1444 ¬x2
Prove: ABC is a 1464.25 ¬x2
right triangle. C a B D a E 1464. 25 ¬x
The length of wire needed is 2x 2 1464.25 or
Proof: Draw DE on line with measure equal to
about 76.53 feet.
a. At D, draw line m DE. Locate point F on m
so that DF b. Draw F E and call its measure x. 42. Let s represent the side of each square stone.
Because FED is a right triangle, a2 b2 x2. s2 (2s)2 ¬x2
But a2 b2 c2, so x2 c2 or x c. Thus, ABC s2 4s2 ¬152
FED by SSS. This means C DE. 5s2 ¬225
Therefore, C must be a right angle, making s2 ¬45
ABC a right triangle. s ¬45 or 3
5
The area of each square stone is s2 45, so the
39. Given: ABC with right angle at C, AB d
area of the walkway is 6 45 or 270 in2.
Prove: d (x2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2
43. Let x represent the number of miles away from
y
the starting point.
62 122 ¬x2
A(x1, y1) 36 144 ¬x2
d 180 ¬x2
B (x2, y2) 180 ¬x
C (x1, y2) 13.4 ¬x
O x The trawler traveled about 13.4 miles out of the
way.
Proof: 44. AD BC 6
AD2 AB2 ¬BD2
Statements Reasons
62 82 ¬BD2
1. ABC with right angle at 1. Given 36 64 ¬BD2
C, AB d 100 ¬BD2
2. (CB)2 (AC)2 (AB)2 2. Pythagorean 100 ¬BD
Theorem 10 ¬BD
3.
x2 x1
CB 3. Distance on a HD BF 8
y2 y1
AC number line
DM 1
2 (BD)
4.
x2 x1
2
y2 y1
2 d2 4. Substitution
5. (x2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2 d2 5. Substitution 1
2 (10)
6.
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 d 6. Take the 5
square root HD2 DM2 ¬HM2
of each side. 82 52 ¬HM2
64 25 ¬HM2
7. d
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 7. Reflexive
Property 89 ¬HM2
89 ¬HM
9.4 ¬HM
40. First, use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
length of the ladder, represented by y. HM EM FM GM because HD EA FB
122 162 ¬y2 GC and AC DB so AM BM CM DM.
144 256 ¬y2 45. Sample answer: The road, the tower that is
400 ¬y2 perpendicular to the road, and the cables form the
400 ¬y right triangles. Answers should include the
20 ¬y following.
The ladder is 20 feet long. • Right triangles are formed by the bridge, the
(2 12)2 x2 ¬202 towers, and the cables.
142 x2¬202 • The cable is the hypotenuse in each triangle.
196 x2 ¬400 46. A; let B(8, 0) be the vertex of right triangle ABE.
x2 ¬204 AB2 BE2 ¬AE2
x ¬204 82 h2 ¬102
x ¬251 64 h2 ¬100
x ¬14.3 h2 ¬36
The ladder reaches about 14.3 feet up the side of h ¬ 36
the house. h ¬6
Chapter 7 198
47. C; x2 36 ¬(9 x)2 57.
x2 36 ¬81 18x x2 x 1 3 27
36 ¬81 18x
45 ¬18x 3x 3 27 7.6 1012
2.5 ¬x
48. 3-4-5, 6-8-10, 12-16-20, 24-32-40, 27-36-45 The sequence of numbers approaches positive
infinity.
49. 3 4 5 60
6 8 10 480 58.
x 4 2 1.41... 1.18... 1.09... 1.04...
8 60
12 16 20 3840 1
x2
2 1.41... 1.18... 1.09... 1.04... 1.02...
64 60
The sequence of numbers converges to 1.
24 32 40 30,720
59.
512 60 x 4 0.25 4 0.25
27 36 45 43,740
729 60 1 0.25 4 0.25 4
x
Yes, the conjecture holds true. The sequence of numbers alternates between 0.25
and 4.
60. No; 12 13 25, so the sides do not satisfy the
Page 356 Maintain Your Skills Triangle Inequality.
7
50. Let x represent the geometric mean. 3
61. 7 3
3
3
3
3 ¬x
x 12
2
18 2 18 2
x2 ¬36 62. 92
2
2
x ¬36 or 6 14
2
28
63. 2
51. Let x represent the geometric mean.
2 2
9 x 27
x ¬12 2 7
x ¬108
2
3
3
11 3 33
33
x ¬ 108 or 63 64. 3
3 3
x ¬10.4 24
2 24 122
2
65.
2
52. Let x represent the geometric mean.
2 2
66. 3
11 x 12 3
x ¬ 7
12 3 43
3 3
x2 ¬77
2
x ¬ 77 67.
6 3
2
18
3 3
3
x ¬8.8
6
2
3 22
53. Let x represent the geometric mean.
6 x
x ¬9 15
3 15
3
3 53
68.
x2 ¬54 3
3
x ¬ 54 or 3 2
8 2
8
6 69. 8
8 8
x ¬7.3
42
2
54. Let x represent the geometric mean. 8 2
2 x
x ¬7 25
1 0 25
10 5
10
70. 10 2
x2 ¬14 10
10
x ¬ 14
x ¬3.7
55. Let x represent the geometric mean.
7-3 Special Right Triangles
2 ¬x
x 5
x2 ¬10
x ¬ 10 Page 360 Check for Understanding
x ¬3.2 1. Sample answer: Construct two perpendicular
56. lines. Use a ruler to measure 3 cm from the point
x 5 10
2.51... 2.24... 2.11... of intersection on one ray. Use the compass to
copy the 3 cm segment. Connect the two
2x 10
2.51... 2.24... 2.11... 2.05... endpoints to form a 45°-45°-90° triangle with
sides of 3 cm and a hypotenuse of 3 2 cm.
The sequence of numbers converges to 2.
199 Chapter 7
2. Sample answer: Draw a line using a ruler. Then Graph A and B. A B
lies on a vertical gridline of
use a protractor to measure a 90° angle. On one the coordinate plane. Since B D will be
ray mark a 2 cm length, and at that endpoint use perpendicular to A B
, it lies on a horizontal
the protractor to measure a 30° angle toward the gridline.
other ray. Where this ray intersects the other ray AB
3 0
3
should form a 60° angle, completing the 30°-60°- B
A is the shorter leg. B
D is the longer leg.
90° triangle with sides 2 cm, 2 3cm, and a BD 3(AB)
hypotenuse of 4 cm. BD 3(3) or 33
3. The diagonal is twice as long as its width w, so Point D has the same y-coordinate as B. D is
the diagonal forms a 30°-60°-90° triangle with the located 3 3 units to the right of B or to the left of
length and the width w. Then the length of the B. So, the coordinates of D are (8 3 3, 3) or
rectangle is 3 times the width, or 3w. about (13.20, 3) or (8 3 3, 3) or about (2.80, 3).
4. The triangle is a 45°-45°-90° triangle. The legs are 10. y
congruent, so x 3. The length of the hypotenuse D (2, 6 4 3)
is 2 times the length of the leg, so y 32.
5. The triangle is a 45°-45°-90° triangle. The legs are
congruent, so x y. The length of the hypotenuse
is 2 times the length of the leg.
10 ¬x 2 B (2, 6) A(6, 6)
10
¬x
2
10 2
¬x
2
2
10 2
¬x
2
52
¬x O x
So, x 52
and y 52. Graph A and B. A B lies on a horizontal gridline of
the coordinate plane. Since B D
will be
6. The triangle is a 30°-60°-90° triangle. y is the
perpendicular to A B, it lies on a vertical gridline.
measure of the hypotenuse and x is the measure
AB
2 6
4
of the longer leg.
B
A is the shorter leg. BD is the longer leg.
y 2(8) or 16 BD 3(AB)
x 8 3 BD 3(4) or 4 3
7. ABC is a 30°-60°-90° triangle with hypotenuse c, Point D has the same x-coordinate as B. D is
shorter leg a and longer leg b. located 4 3 units above B. So, the coordinates of
c 2a D are (2, 6 4 3) or about (2, 12.93).
8 2a 11. The length of each leg of the 45°-45°-90° triangle
4a formed by homeplate, first base, and second base
b 3(a) is 90 feet. The distance d is the hypotenuse and is
b 3(4) or 4 3 2 times as long as a leg. Then d 902 or
8. ABC is a 30°-60°-90° triangle with hypotenuse c, about 127.28 feet.
shorter leg a and longer leg b.
b ¬3(a)
18 ¬ 3(a) Pages 360–362 Practice and Apply
18
¬a 12. The figure is a square, so each triangle is a
3
45°-45°-90° triangle. Thus, x 45. The length of
18
3
¬a the hypotenuse is 2 times the length of a leg of
3
3
18
3
the triangle. Therefore, y 2(9.6) or 9.62.
¬a
3 13. The figure is a square, so each triangle is a
63 ¬a 45°-45°-90° triangle. Thus, y 45. the length of
c 2a the hypotenuse is 2 times the length of a leg of
c 2(63) the triangle.
c 123 17 ¬x 2
9. y 17
¬x
D (8 3 3, 3) B (8, 3) D (8 3 3, 3) 2
17
2
¬x
2 2
17
2 ¬x
O A(8, 0) x 2
Chapter 7 200
14. The triangle is a 30°-60°-90° triangle where x is 18. In BCE, a is the measure of the hypotenuse and
the measure of the shorter leg and y is the E
C is the longer leg.
measure of the longer leg. a ¬2(BE)
18 ¬2x 10 3 ¬2(BE)
9 ¬x 5 3 ¬BE
y ¬3(x) CE ¬ 3(BE)
y ¬3(9) or 9 3 CE ¬ 3 (5 3)
15. C CE ¬5 3 or 15
In CEA, AE is the longer leg.
y 3(CE)
y 3(15) or 15 3
y
12 19. In BEC, a is the measure of the hypotenuse and
x is the measure of the shorter leg.
60
a 2x
D a 2(73 )
a 143
A x B CE 3 (x)
ABC is equilateral because C D bisects the base CE 3 (73 )
D
and C is an altitude. Therefore ADC is a CE 7 3 or 21
30°-60°-90° triangle with hypotenuse y and In ACE, y is the measure of the longer leg and b
shorter leg 2x. is the measure of the hypotenuse.
x 3
¬12 y 3 (CE)
2 y 3 (21) or 213
x ¬12 2 b 2(CE)
3
24
3 b 2(21) or 42
x ¬
3
3
20. The altitude is the longer leg of a 30°-60°-90°
24
3 triangle. Let x represent the length of the shorter leg.
x ¬
3 12 3 (x)
x ¬83
12
x
3
y 2 2x
12
3
x
yx
3 3
y 83 12
3
x
3
16. x is the shorter leg and y is the longer leg of the 43x
30°-60°-90° triangle. Then the hypotenuse, which is a side of the
2x ¬11 equilateral triangle, has measure 2x 2(43 ) or
11 13.86 feet.
x ¬
2 or 5.5
83
y ¬3
(x) 21. The perimeter is 45, so each congruent side has
45
y ¬3
(5.5) or 5.53 measure
3 or 15 cm. An altitude is the longer leg
17. F of a 30°-60°-90° triangle. Let x represent the length
15
of the shorter leg. Then x
2 or 7.5. The altitude
5 has measure 3 (x) 7.53 or about 12.99 cm.
y
22. Each side of the square is a leg of a 45°-45°-90°
45
triangle. The length of the hypotenuse, 222 mm,
G is 2 times as long as a leg. So each leg has
D E
measure 22. Then the perimeter of the square is
x 4(22) or 88 mm.
In DEF, D E
is the hypotenuse so x 52. In 23. The altitude is the longer leg of a 30°-60°-90°
FGE, F G
is a leg and F
E
is the hypotenuse. triangle. Let x represent the length of the shorter leg.
2(y) ¬5 7.4 3 (x)
7.4
y ¬
5 x
2
3
7.4
3
5
y ¬
2 x
3 3
2
2
7.4
3
5
2 x
y ¬2
3
Then the hypotenuse, which is a side of the
equilateral triangle, has measure 2x 2
7.4
3
3
3
14.8
or 3 . Thus, the perimeter of the equilateral
triangle is 3 3
14.8 3
14.83 or about 25.63 m.
201 Chapter 7
24. c d 4 4 5 (1)
30
30
a 30
P has the same y-coordinate as the midpoint of
60
120
H
G . P is located 3 units to the left or right of the
6 6 midpoint of GH. So, the coordinates of P are
f 60
60
(4 3, 2) (1, 2) or (4 3, 2) (7, 2).
29. y
The diagonals determine equilateral triangles D(3, 7)
with sides equal to half the length of each
diagonal, or 6 inches. So e f 6, and e f 3.
Then a 3 (e) or 33, so c d 33 . Then the
perimeter of the rectangle is 2(6) 2(33 33 )
or 12 123 32.78 inches.
25. Each side has measure
256
4 or 8. The length of a
x
diagonal is 2 times as long as a side of the square.
So the measure of a diagonal is 82 11.31.
26. 8 2x
4x
y 3 (x) P(10.5, 6) C (3, 6)
y 3 (4) or 43
z6 Graph C and D. C D lies on a vertical gridline of
Each leg of the 45°-45°-90° triangle has length x, the coordinate plane. Since P C
will be
or 4. Then CB 42 . So, the perimeter of ABCD perpendicular to CD, it lies on a horizontal
is 43 6 4 42 6 8 43 42 gridline.
24, or about 36.59 units. CD
7 (6)
13
27. y P (4, 8) D
C is the longer leg. P
C is the shorter leg. So,
CD 3 (PC).
13 3(PC)
13
PC
3
13
3
PC
3 3
13
3
PC
3
A (3, 1 ) B ( 4, 1)
Point P has the same y-coordinate as C. P is
x 13
3
located
3 units to the left of C. So, the
Graph A and B. A B
lies on a horizontal gridline of coordinates of P are 3 13
3
3 , 6 or about
the coordinate plane. Since P B
will be (10.51, 6).
perpendicular to AB
, it lies on a vertical gridline. 30. y
AB
4 (3)
7
AB and PB are congruent, so PB 7. Point P has
the same x-coordinate as B. P is located 7 units
P (8, 1.5) x
above B. So, the coordinates of P are (4, 1 7) or
(4, 8).
28. y
Chapter 7 202
CP is the hypotenuse of 30°-60°-90° triangle CPQ. d¬ 3 (c)
Q
C is the longer side and PQ is the shorter side. d¬ 3 (3 )
2(PQ) CP d¬ 3
2(PQ) 43 d¬ 2e
PQ 23 3¬ 2e
3(PQ) CQ 1.5¬ e
3(23 ) CQ f¬ 3 (e)
2(3) CQ f¬ 1.53
6 CQ f¬ 2g
Q is on CD 6 units to the right of C, so Q has 1.53¬ 2g
coordinates (2 6, 5) (8, 5). P is 23 units 0.753 ¬ g
above Q, so P has coordinates (8, 5 23 ). x¬ 3 (g)
31. T
S is the shorter leg of a 30°-60°-90° triangle. x¬ 3 (0.753)
SP 2(ST) x¬ 0.75 3 2.25
63 2(ST) 39. The hexagon consists of six equilateral triangles.
33 ST So, mUXY 60. WY bisects a 60° angle, so
Then c 33 . PT is a vertical line segment, so mXYW 30. WY is twice the length of the
a c 33 . longer side of a 30°-60°-90° triangle.
PT 3 (ST)
PT 3 (33 )
1
WY ¬2 2
2 3
PT 3 3 or 9 ¬123
Then b 9. PQS R
, so PQ is a horizontal line ¬20.78 cm
segment. Thus d b 9. 40. Find CB.
32. 12 triangles AB 2 (CB)
33. The smaller angle is rotated, so it is the 30° angle. 347 2(CB)
34
7
34. There are no gaps because when a 30° angle is CB
2
rotated 12 times, it rotates 360°. 347
2
CB
35. Sample answer: 2 2
347 2
CB
2
2
347
The center fielder is standing 2 or about
245.4 feet from home plate.
41. 24
A E B
60
8
36. 2x 8
45
x4
D F C
y 3(x)
y 3(4) or 43
Draw altitudes C E and AF
. BEC is a
y 2(z) 30°-60°-90° triangle and DAF is a
2
43 (z) 45°-45°-90° triangle.
4
3 In BEC, CB is the hypotenuse and EC
is the
z
2 longer leg.
4
3
2
z CB 2(EB)
2 2
4
6 8 2(EB)
z 4 EB
2
26z EC 3 (EB)
37. BD 3 (DH) EC 43
3
83 (DH) AF EC, so AF 43 .
8 DH DF AF, so DF 43 .
BH 2(DH) AD 2 (DF)
BH 2(8) AD 2 (43)
BH 16 AD 46
FC AE
38. 4¬ 2a a
c AB EB
2¬ a
24 4
b¬ 3 (a) 30
e 20
b¬ 23 b 30
d
4 The perimeter of ABCD is AB BC DF FC
b¬ 2c
30
f AD 24 8 43 20 46 or 52 43
23¬ 2c g
30
46 units.
3¬ c
x
203 Chapter 7
42. Sample answer: Congruent triangles of different 48. a2 b2¬ c2
color can be arranged to create patterns. Answers 202 482¬ 522
should include the following. 400 2304¬ 2704
• 5, 9, 15, and 17; 3, 4, 6, 7, 10, 11, and 12 2704¬ 2704
• Placing 45° angles next to one another forms Since 2704 2704, the measures satisfy the
90° angles, which can be placed next to each Pythagorean Theorem. So the sides can be the
other, leaving no holes. sides of a right triangle. All side lengths are whole
43. C; 2x 4x 90 numbers, so the measures form a Pythagorean
6x 90 triple.
x 15 49. a2 b2¬ c2
mA 4x 72 242¬ 252
4(15) 49 576¬ 625
60 625¬ 625
mB 2x Since 625 625, the measures satisfy the
2(15) Pythagorean Theorem. So the sides can be the
30 sides of a right triangle. All side lengths are whole
BC 3 (AC) numbers, so the measures form a Pythagorean
6 3(AC) triple.
6 AC 50. a2 b2¬ c2
3
6
3 122 342¬ 372
AC 144 1156¬ 1369
3 3
6
3 1300¬ 1369
3 AC
Since 1300 1369, the measures do not satisfy
23 AC the Pythagorean Theorem. So the sides cannot be
AB 2(AC) the sides of a right triangle. The measures do not
AB 2(23) 43
form a Pythagorean triple.
2 2
44. (3 ★ 4)(5 ★ 3)¬ 3 5 z 10
42 32 51. 1
0 ¬ 4
52 4z¬ 100
¬ 42
z¬ 25
25
¬
16 y¬ z 4
y¬ 25 4 or 21
y x
¬ 4
x
Page 363 Maintain Your Skills 4y¬ x2
45. a2 b2¬ c2 4(21)¬ x2
32 42¬ 52 84¬ x2
9 16¬ 25 84¬ x
25¬ 25 221
¬ x
Since 25 25, the measures satisfy the 9.2¬ x
12
Pythagorean Theorem, so the sides can be the 52. ¬ x
x 8
sides of a right triangle. All side lengths are whole
96¬ x2
numbers, so the measures form a Pythagorean
96
¬ x
triple.
46
¬ x
46. a2 b2¬ c2 9.8¬ x
92 402¬ 412 8¬
y
81 1600¬ 1681 y 12 8
1681¬ 1681 y2¬ 32
Since 1681 1681, the measures satisfy the y¬ 32
Pythagorean Theorem. So the sides can be the y¬ 42
sides of a right triangle. All side lengths are whole y¬ 5.7
numbers, so the measures form a Pythagorean 12
z
z ¬ 12 8
triple.
z2¬ 48
47. a2 b2¬ c2 z¬ 48
202 212¬ 312 z¬ 43
400 441¬ 961 z¬ 6.9
841¬ 961
Since 841 961, the measures do not satisfy the
Pythagorean Theorem. So the sides cannot be the
sides of a right triangle. The measures do not
form a Pythagorean triple.
Chapter 7 204
15 5 13
53.
5 ¬ y 62. 0.2 g
15y¬ 25 0.2g 13
y¬ 5
g 65
3
7
x¬ 15 y 63. n 0.25
x¬ 15 5
7 0.25n
3
40 28 n
x¬ m
3 64. 9 0.8
15 z
z¬ x 7.2 m
15x¬ z2 24
65. x 0.4
40
15
3 ¬ z
2
24 0.4x
200¬ z2 60 x
200
¬ z 35
66. y¬ 0.07
102
¬ z 35¬ 0.07y
14.1¬ z 500¬ y
54. In ALK and ALN, A L
A L, N
KL L
, and
AK AN. Then mALK mALN by the SSS
Inequality.
Page 363 Practice Quiz 1
55. In ALK and NLO, A L OL,
KL N
L
, and 1. Let x represent the measure of the altitude.
AK NO. So, mALK mNLO by the SSS 21 x
x¬ 7
Inequality.
x2¬ 147
56. In OLK and NLO, L O LO,
KL N
L, and
x¬ 147 or 73
KO NO. So, mOLK mNLO by the SSS
x¬ 12.1
Inequality.
2. Let x represent the measure of the altitude.
57. In KLO and ALN, K L NL,
LO A
L
, and
9 x
N
A K O
. KLO ALN by SSS Congruence. x¬ 5
So mKLO¬ mALN by CPCTC and the x2¬ 45
definition of congruent angles. x¬ 45 or 35
58. JK [1 (3)]2 (5
2)2 x¬ 6.7
2 2 3
2 3. AB (4 2)2 (0 1)2
13
2 2
(1) 2
RS [4 (6)]2
(3
6)2 5
2 2
(3) 2 BC (5 4)2 (7 0)2
13 1 2 7
2
KL [4 (
1)]2
(4
5)2 50
5 2
(1) 2 AC (5 2)2 (7 1)2
26 3 2 6
2
ST
[1 (4)] 2
(4
3)2 45
5 2 12 AB2 AC2¬ BC2
26 (5 )2 (45 )2¬ (50 )2
JL [4 (3)]2
(4
2)2 5 45¬ 50
7 2 2
2 50¬ 50
53
The triangle is a right triangle because the side
lengths satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem.
RT [1 (
6)]2
(4
6)2
4. x 3
72)
2 ( 2
y (2 )3 or 32
53
5. x 2(6) or 12
JKL RST by SSS.
y 3 (6) or 63
59. 5¬ 3x
15¬ x
60. 9x 0.14
x 1.26 7-4 Trigonometry
10
61. 0.5¬ k
0.5k¬ 10 Page 365 Geometry Activity: Trigonometric
k¬ 20 Ratios
1. They are similar triangles because corresponding
sides are proportional.
205 Chapter 7
opposite leg
2. In AED In AGF In ABC 6. sinA
hypotenuse
DE FG BC ac
AD 0.6114 AF 0.6114 AC 0.6114
sin A
8
17 0.47
AE AG
0.7913 AB
cos A AF 0.7913 AC 0.7913
AD adjacent leg
cosA
hypotenuse
DE FG BC
AE 0.7727 AG 0.7727 AB 0.7727
tanA bc
15
3. Sample answer: Regardless of the side lengths,
17 0.88
the trigonometric ratio is the same when opposite leg
tanA
adjace
nt leg
comparing angles in similar triangles.
a
b
4. mA is the same in all triangles.
8
15 0.53
opposite leg
sinB
hypotenuse
Pages 367–368 Check for Understanding
1. The triangles are similar, so the ratios remain the bc
same. 15
17 0.88
2. Sample answer: adjacent leg
C cosB
hypotenuse
15 ac
35 8
B A
17 0.47
mB 90, mC 55, b 26.2, c 21.4 tanB
opposite leg
adjacent leg
3. All three ratios involve two sides of a right triangle. b
The sine ratio is the measure of the opposite side a
divided by the measure of the hypotenuse. The 15
8 1.88
cosine ratio is the measure of the adjacent side
divided by the measure of the hypotenuse. The 7. KEYSTROKES: SIN 57 ENTER
tangent ratio is the measure of the opposite side sin57° 0.8387
divided by the measure of the adjacent side. 8. KEYSTROKES: COS 60 ENTER
4. The tan is the ratio of the measure of the opposite cos60° 0.5000
side divided by the measure of the adjacent side for 9. KEYSTROKES: COS 33 ENTER
a given angle in a right triangle. The tan1 is the
cos33° 0.8387
measure of the angle with a certain tangent ratio.
opposite leg 10. KEYSTROKES: TAN 30 ENTER
5. sinA
hypotenuse tan30° 0.5774
ac 11. KEYSTROKES: TAN 45 ENTER
14
tan45° 1.0000
50 0.28
adjacent leg 12. KEYSTROKES: SIN 85 ENTER
cosA
hypotenuse sin85° 0.9962
bc 13. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 1.4176 ENTER
48 mA 54.8
50 0.96
opposite leg 14. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 0.6307 ENTER
tanA adjacent leg
a
mB 39.1
b 15. y
14
48 0.29
C(0, 6)
opposite leg
sinB
hypotenuse
b
c
48
50 0.96
A(6, 0)
B(4, 2)
adjacent leg
cosB
hypotenuse x
a
c
14 Explore: You know the coordinates of the vertices
50 0.28
of a right triangle and that C is the right angle.
opposite leg
tanB adjacent leg You need to find the measure of one of the angles.
b Plan: Use the Distance Formula to find the measure
a
of each side. Then use one of the trigonometric ratios
48
14 3.43
to write an equation. Use the inverse to find mA.
Chapter 7 206
Solve: AB (4 6)2 (2 0)2 KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 1 2 ENTER
100
4 mB 26.56505118
The measure of B is about 26.6.
104
or 226
Examine: Use the sine ratio to check the answer.
BC [0 (
4)] 2 (6 2)2 AC
sinB
16
6 1 AB
32
or 42 sinB 4 or 1
4
5
5
AC (0 6)
36
6 3
2 (6 0)2
5
B sin 1 1
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 1 2nd [2 ] 5
72
or 62
ENTER
Use the tangent ratio.
BC mB 26.56505118
tanA
AC The answer is correct.
4
2
tanA or 2
17. Let x be Maureen’s distance from the tower in
62 3
feet.
A tan12
3
1815
tan31.2
x
KEYSTROKES: 2nd 2 3 ENTER
[TAN1] 1815
x
tan 3
mA 33.69006753 1.2
The measure of A is about 33.7. KEYSTROKES: 1815 TAN 31.2 ENTER
Examine: Use the sine ratio to check the answer. Maureen is about 2997 feet from the tower.
BC
sinA
AB
4
2
sinA
2
26 Pages 368–370 Practice and Apply
2
4
A sin 1
2
26
18. sinP
opposite leg
hypotenuse
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 4 2nd [2
] 2 ) p
r
( 2 2nd [2 ] 26 ) ) ) 12
37 0.32
mA 33.69006753
adjacent leg
The answer is correct. cosP
hypotenuse
16. q
y
B(7 , 5 ) r
35
37 0.95
opposite leg
tanP adjace
nt leg
p
q
x 12
35 0.34
opposite leg
sinQ
hypotenuse
A(3 , 3 ) C(7 , 3 ) q
r
Explore: You know the coordinates of the vertices
35
of a right triangle and that C is the right angle. 37 0.95
You need to find the measure of one of the angles. adjacent leg
cosQ
hypotenuse
Plan: Use the Distance Formula to find the measure
p
of each side. Then use one of the trigonometric r
ratios to write an equation. Use the inverse to 12
37 0.32
find mB.
opposite leg
Solve: AB (7 3)2 [5
(3)]2 tanQ adjace
nt leg
164 6 q
p
80 or 45 35
12 2.92
BC (7 ) 732 ( 5)2
0 64 or 8
AC (7 3)2 [
3 ( 3)]2
160 or 4
Use the tangent ratio.
AC
tanB
BC
tanB 4
1
8 or 2
B tan12
1
207 Chapter 7
opposite leg opposite leg
19. sinP
hypotenuse
sinQ
hypotenuse
p q
r r
6 2 3
3
2
32 2 3
3 3
3 0.58 2 0.87
adjacent leg
cosP adjacent leg
hypotenuse cosQ
hypotenuse
a
r p
r
2
3
2
3
32 2
2
3
6
3 0.82
opposite leg 1
2 0.50
tanP adjace nt leg opposite leg
p tanQ
adjace
nt leg
q q
p
6
3
23 3 3
3
2
2
2 0.71 3
2
sinQ
opposite leg
3
1.73
hypotenuse opposite leg
q
r 21. sinP
hypotenuse
p
2
3
2 r
32 2
2
3
6
3 0.82
33
adjacent leg 2
3 0.67
cosQ
hypotenuse adjacent leg
p cosP
r hypotenuse
q
r
6
2
32 2 15
3
3 33 3
3 0.58
5
opposite leg 3 0.75
tanQ adjace nt leg opposite leg
q tanP adjace
p nt leg
p
2 q
3
6
6 6 2
2
1.41 3
15
15 15
opposite leg 2 5
20. sinP
hypotenuse
5 0.89
p opposite leg
r sinQ hypotenuse
3 q
2 r
3
15
3
1
2 0.50
33 3
adjacent leg 5
cosP 3 0.75
hypotenuse
ar cosQ
adjacent leg
hypotenuse
3
3 p
2 r
3
2
3
3
2 0.87 33
2
tanP
opposite leg 3 0.67
adjace
nt leg
opposite leg
p
q tanQ adjace nt leg
q
3
2
p
3
3
15
3
2
3 23 3
3 0.58
5
2 1.12
Chapter 7 208
opposite leg
22. KEYSTROKES: SIN 6 ENTER 36. tanx°
adjace
nt leg
sin6° 0.1045 25
5
23. KEYSTROKES: TAN 42.8 ENTER
5.0000
tan42.8° 0.9260
37. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 0.7245 ENTER
24. KEYSTROKES: COS 77 ENTER mB 46.42726961
cos77° 0.2250 The measure of B is about 46.4.
25. KEYSTROKES: SIN 85.9 ENTER 38. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [COS1] 0.2493 ENTER
sin85.9° 0.9974 mC 75.56390633
26. KEYSTROKES: TAN 12.7 ENTER The measure of C is about 75.6.
tan12.7° 0.2254 39. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 9.4618 ENTER
27. KEYSTROKES: COS 22.5 ENTER mE 83.96691253
cos22.5° 0.9239 The measure of E is about 84.0.
opposite leg
28. sinA¬
40. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 0.4567 ENTER
hypotenuse mA 27.17436867
26 The measure of A is about 27.2.
¬
26
¬ 0.1961 41. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [COS1] 0.1212 ENTER
opposite leg mD 83.03863696
29. tanB
adjace
nt leg The measure of D is about 83.0.
5
26
or 5 42. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 0.4279 ENTER
126 1
5.0000 mF 23.16608208
adjacent leg The measure of F is about 23.2.
30. cosA¬
hypotenuse x
43. tan24°
19
26
5
¬ 26 19tan24° x
¬ 0.9806 KEYSTROKES: 19 TAN 24 ENTER
opposite leg x 8.5
31. sinx°¬
hypotenuse 12
25 44. sinx°
17
¬
526 x° sin1
17
12
25
26
¬
526 26 KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 12 17
25
26 ENTER
¬ 5(26) x 44.9
5
26
¬ cos62° x
26 45. 60
¬ 0.9806 60cos62° x
adjacent leg KEYSTROKES: 60 COS 62 ENTER
32. cosx°¬
hypotenuse x 28.2
5 x
¬ cos31°
526 46. 34
5
¬
2
6 34cos31° x
526 26 KEYSTROKES: 34 COS 31 ENTER
26 x 29.1
¬
26
6.6
¬ 0.1961 47. sin17° x
6.
6
33. tanA
opposite leg x
adjace
nt leg sin 17°
2 6 KEYSTROKES: 6.6 SIN 17 ENTER
x 22.6
5
26
1
5
15
48. tanx°
18
0.2000 x° tan1
18
15
adjacent leg
34. cosB¬
hypotenuse KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 15 18
26 ENTER
¬
26 x 39.8
¬ 0.1961
opposite leg
35. siny°¬
hypotenuse
1
¬
26
¬ 1 2
6
26
26
¬ 226
6
¬ 0.1961
209 Chapter 7
49. Let x represent the vertical change of the plane
after climbing at a constant angle of 3° for 60 41
5
J sin 1
ground miles. KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 5 2nd [2
] 41
x
tan3° 60
ENTER
60tan3° x mJ 51.34019175
The answer is correct.
KEYSTROKES: 60 TAN 3 ENTER
x 3.1 53.
D(1 , 2 ) y
The plane is about 3.1 1 or 4.1 miles above
sea level.
50. Let x represent the maximum height. x
x
sin75°¬ 20
20sin75°¬ x
KEYSTROKES: 20 SIN 75 ENTER C(6 , 5 )
x 19.32 B(1 , 5 )
The ladder can reach a maximum height of about
19.32 feet.
Explore: You know the coordinates of the vertices
51. Let x represent the distance from the base of the
of a right triangle and that B is the right angle.
ladder to the building.
x You need to find the measure of one of the angles.
cos75° 20 Plan: Use the Distance Formula to find the measure
20cos75° x of each side. Then use one of the trigonometric ratios
KEYSTROKES: 20 COS 75 ENTER to write an equation. Use the inverse to find mC.
x 5.18 Solve: BC [6 (1)]2 [ 2
5 (5)]
The base of the ladder is about 5.18 feet from the 25 0 or 5
building.
BD [1 (1)]2 [2 2
(5)]
52. y 0 49 or 7
J(2, 2) CD [1 (6)]2 [2 2
(5)]
259 4
74
x BD
tanC
B
C
C(2, 2) L(7 , 2 ) tanC 7
5
C tan17
5
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 7 5 ENTER
Explore: You know the coordinates of the vertices mC 54.46232221
of a right triangle and that C is the right angle. The measure of C is about 54.5.
You need to find the measure of one of the angles. Examine: Use the sine ratio to check the answer.
Plan: Use the Distance Formula to find the BD
measure of each side. Then use one of the sinC
CD
trigonometric ratios to write an equation. Use the 7
sinC
inverse to find mJ. 74
Solve: JC (2 2)
2 (
2 2)2 74
7
C sin 1
0 16 or 4 KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 7 2nd [2
] 74
CL (7 2
)2 [ 2
2 (2)] ENTER
25
0 or 5 mC 54.46232221
The answer is correct.
JL (7 2
)2 (
2 2)2
25
6 1 54. y
41
Z(0 , 35)
CL
tanJ JC
tanJ 5
4
J tan15
4
X(5 , 0 ) Y(7 , 0 )
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 5 4 ENTER
x
mJ 51.34019175
The measure of J is about 51.3.
Examine: Use the sine ratio to check the answer. Explore: You know the coordinates of the vertices
CL of a right triangle and that Z is the right angle.
sinJ
JL
You need to find the measure of one of the angles.
sinJ 5
41
Chapter 7 210
6
5
Plan: Use the Distance Formula to find the tany°
24
measure of each side. Then use one of the
5
tany° 4
trigonometric ratios to write an equation. Use the
inverse to find mX. y° tan14
5
Solve: XY
[7 (5)]2 (0
0)2 KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 2nd [2
] 5 )
144
0 or 12 4 ENTER
YZ (0 7)
2 ( 0
35 )2 y 29.2
x
49
5 3 57. tan55°¬
1
2
84
or 221 12tan55°¬ x
XZ
[0 (5)] 2
(35 0)2
KEYSTROKES: 12 TAN 55 ENTER
25
5 3 x 17.1
60
or 215 sin47° xy
XZ x
cosX
XY y
sin 47°
cosX
15
2 15
KEYSTROKES: 12 TAN 55 ) SIN 47
12 or 6
ENTER
15
X cos16
y 23.4
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [COS1] 2nd [2 ] 15 ) 24
58. tan32° x
6 ENTER
24
mX 49.79703411 x
tan
32°
The measure of X is about 49.8. KEYSTROKES: 24 TAN 32 ENTER
Examine: Use the sine ratio to check the answer. x 38.4
YZ y
sinX
XY
cos32° x
21
2 21
xcos32° y
sinX 12 or 6 KEYSTROKES: 24 TAN 32 ) COS 32
X sin 1
21
6
ENTER
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 2nd [2
] 21 ) y 32.6
6 ENTER 59. Let d represent the distance between Alpha
mX 49.79703411 Centauri and the sun.
1
The answer is correct. tan0.00021 d
1
55. A d
tan0.00021
KEYSTROKES: 1 TAN 0.00021 ENTER
d 272,837
35
211 Chapter 7
63. C; (AC)2 32 52 73. a2 b2¬ c2
(AC)2 9 25 52 122¬ 132
(AC)2 16 25 144¬ 169
AC 16 or 4 169¬ 169
AC Since the side measures satisfy the Pythagorean
cosC BC
Theorem, they can be the sides of a right triangle.
cosC 4
5 The measures are all whole numbers, so they do
64. B; x2 152 242 15(24) form a Pythagorean triple.
x2 225 576 360 74. a2 b2¬ c2
x2 441 92 122¬ 152
x 441
81 144¬ 225
x 21 225¬ 225
65. cscA 5 5 4 5
3 ; secA 4 ; cotA 3 ; cscB 4 ; Since the side measures satisfy the Pythagorean
secB 5 3
3 ; cotB 4
Theorem, they can be the sides of a right triangle.
The measures are all whole numbers, so they do
13 1
3 5 1
3
66. cscA
12 ; secA 5 ; cotA 12 ; cscB 5 ;
form a Pythagorean triple.
13
secB 12 75. a2 b2¬ c2
12 ; cotB 5
82 122¬ 162
67. cscA 8
4 or 2; secA
8 or
2
3
3 ; 64 144¬ 256
4
3
3
4
cotA ; cscB 8 or
4 or 3
2
3
3 ;
208¬ 256
4
3 Since 208 256, the measures cannot be the
secB 8 4 or
4 or 2; cotB 4
3
3
sides of a right triangle because they do not
3
68. cscA 4 or 2 ; secA 4 or 2
; satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem. The measures
22 22 do not form a Pythagorean triple.
2
2 4
cotA or 1; cscB or 2 ; 76. Rewrite 4 : 11 as 4x : 11x and use those values for
22 22
4 2
2 the number of minutes of commercials and actual
secB or 2 ; cotB or 1
22 22 show.
4x 11x¬ 30
15x¬ 30
Page 370 Maintain Your Skills x¬ 2
69. b 3a 4x 4(2) or 8
b 3(4) or 43 8 minutes are spent on commercials.
c 2a 77. m15 117 vertical
c 2(4) or 8 78. m7 30 corresponding
70. b 3a 79. m3 30 180 linear pair
3 3a m3 150
3 a
3 80. m12 117 180 linear pair
3
3
a m12 63
3 3 81. m11 m12 alternate interior
3a
m11 63
c 2a
c 23 82. m4 30 180 linear pair
m4 150
71. c¬ 2a
5¬ 2a
2.5¬ a
b¬ 3 a 7-5 Angles of Elevation and
b¬ 3 (2.5) or 2.53
Depression
72. a2 b2¬ c2
42 52¬ 62
16 25¬ 36 Page 373 Check for Understanding
41¬ 36 1. Sample answer: ABC
Since 41 36, the measures cannot be the sides A
B
of a right triangle because they do not satisfy the
Pythagorean Theorem. The measures do not form
a Pythagorean triple.
C
Chapter 7 212
2. Sample answer: An angle of elevation is called 7. The angle of depression between the top of the
that because the angle formed by a horizontal line tower and the horizontal is 12°. Find the distance
and a segment joining two endpoints rises above along the ground from the plane to the tower.
the horizontal line. D A
12
50 mi
tanx°¬
AC
10,0
00
tanx°¬
264,000 75 m
x¬ tan1 10,0
264,0 00
00
x¬ 2.2
C B A
The angle of elevation should be about 2.2°.
5. sun The parasailer is at P and the boats are at A and
B. PCB and PCA are right triangles. The
A
distance between the boats is AB or AC BC.
Because PD and CA are horizontal lines, they are
7.6 m parallel. Thus, DPA PAC and DPB
PBC because they are alternate interior angles.
This means that mPAC 7 and mPBC 12.5.
x
75
B C tan7°¬ AC
18.2 m
ACtan7°¬ 75
Let x represent mACB. 75
AC¬ tan7°
AB
tanx°¬
BC
AC¬ 610.83
75
tanx°¬ 7.6 tan12.5°¬
18.2 BC
BCtan12.5°¬ 75
x¬ tan1 .2
7.6
18 75
BC¬ tan 1
2.5°
x¬ 22.7
The angle of elevation is 22.7°. BC¬ 338.30
AC BC 610.83 338.30 or about 273.
6. The angle of depression between the ship and the
The distance between the boats is about 273 m.
horizontal is 13.25°. Find the length along the
ocean floor. 9. The angle of elevation between the green and the
horizontal is 12°.
A B
ship 13.25
213 Chapter 7
60
10. H G tan8°¬
AF
500 m AFtan8°¬ 60
P
Q 60
11 km AF¬
tan8°
AF¬ 426.92
The angle of depression between the horizontal 60
and the flight of the helicopter H to the landing tan11°¬
AM
pad P is GHP. AMtan11°¬ 60
60
The ground and the horizontal from the helicopter AM¬¬
tan11°
are parallel. Therefore, mGHP mHPQ since AM¬ 308.67
they are alternate interior angles. Let AF AM 426.92 308.67 or about 118.2 yards.
x mHPQ. The merry-go-round and the Ferris wheel are
0.
5
tanx°¬
11 about 76.4 yards apart.
x¬ tan1
11
0.
5 vertical rise140
horizontal distance 2000
14.
x¬ 2.6 0.07 or 7%
The angle of depression is about 2.6°. The grade of the highway is 7%.
11. A D 15. A
300 yd
27.6 yd
x C 140 ft x
B C
B 2000 ft
The angle of depression between the horizontal
Let x represent mACB.
and the sledding run is DAC. 140
The horizontals from the top of the run and the tanx° ¬2000
bottom of the run are parallel. Therefore, x ¬tan1140
2000
mDAC mACB since they are alternate
interior angles. Let x mACB. x ¬4.00
27
.6 The angle of elevation is about 4°.
sinx°¬
300 16. A
x¬ sin1
300
27
.6
x¬ 5.3
The angle of depression is about 5.3°. 1100 ft
12. A
24.4
635 ft B C
369.39 ft 1100
sin24.4° ¬
AC
x ACsin24.4° ¬1100
B C
1100
AC ¬
sin 2
4.4°
Let x represent mACB.
369
.39 AC ¬2663¬
sinx°¬ 635 The ski run is about 2663 feet.
x¬ sin1 635
369
.39
17. S
x¬ 35.6
The angle of elevation (incline) is about 35.6°.
13. R 175 ft
B
8
11
K E
60 yd 6 ft
F 200 ft G
A M F
KE and F
G are parallel, so KF EG. Since SG is
175 feet and EG is 6 feet, SE is 169 feet. Let
RAM and RAF are right triangles. The
x represent mSKE.
distance between the merry-go-round M and the
16
9
Ferris wheel F is MF or AF AM. tanx° ¬
200
Because RB and AF are horizontal lines, they are 16
x ¬tan1 9
200
parallel. Thus, BRF RFA and BRM
RMA because they are alternate interior angles. x ¬40.2¬
This means that mRFA 8 and mRMA 11. The angle of elevation is about 40.2°.
Chapter 7 214
18. S The raised end of the treadmill is about 8.3 inches
off the floor.
22. R
123 ft
K 37
E F
P
6 ft
G RP 10 and RF 48. Let x mRFP.
F
RP
sinx° ¬
and F
KE G are parallel, so KF EG. Since SG is RF
10
123 feet and EG is 6 feet, SE is 117 feet. sinx° ¬
48
11
7
tan37° ¬ 10
x ¬sin1
48 ¬
KE
KEtan37° ¬117 x ¬12¬
11
7
KE ¬
tan 37° ¬ The incline of the treadmill is about 12°.
KE ¬155.3¬ 23. Let xi represent the rise at each stage i, i 1, 2,
KE FG, so the distance between kirk and the 3, 4, 5. The length of the treadmill is 48 inches.
geyser is about 155.3 feet. Suppose the incline at the beginning of the exam
19. D is 10°.
x1
Stage 1: sin10°
48
x1 48sin10°
x1 8.3351
60
30
x
Stage 2: sin12°
2
C A B 48
200 ft x2 48sin12°
x2 9.9798
DC
tan60° ¬ x
AC Stage 3: sin14°
3
ACtan60° ¬DC 48
x3 48sin14°
DC
tan30° ¬
BC x3 11.6123
ACta
n60° x
tan30° ¬ BC Stage 4: sin16°
4
48
BCtan30° ¬ACtan60° x4 48sin16°
AC ta
n 60° x4 13.2306
BC ¬ tan 30° x
Stage 5: sin18°
5
tan60°
AC 200 ¬AC tan 30° 48
x5 48sin18°
AC 200 ¬AC(3) x5 14.8328
200 ¬3AC AC x2 x1 9.9798 8.3351
200 ¬2AC 1.6447
100 ¬AC x3 x2 11.6123 9.9798
BC ¬AC 200 1.6325
¬100 200 or 300 x4 x3 13.2306 11.6123
The observers are 100 feet and 300 feet from the 1.6183
base of the tree. x5 x4 14.8328 13.2306
20. Let x represent the distance from the spotlight to 1.6026
the base of the cloud formation. No, the end of the treadmill does not rise the same
x
tan62.7° ¬ 8
3 distance each time. The changes in the rise of the
83tan62.7° ¬x treadmill between stages are only approximately
160.8 ¬x the same, about 1.6 inches.
The ceiling is about 160.8 1.5 or 162.3 meters. 24. D
21. R
15.85
25.6
P F C B 0.5 km A
RF 48 and mRFP 10. Find RP.
RP
sin10° ¬
RF
D
tan25.6° ¬ C
BC
RP
sin10° ¬
48 BCtan25.6° ¬DC
48sin10° ¬RP¬ D
tan15.85° ¬ C
AC
8.3 ¬RP¬
215 Chapter 7
ACtan15.85° ¬DC tan
AD ¬DC 52°
tan 33°
ACtan15.85° ¬BCtan25.6°
tan
7 DC ¬DC 52°
tan 33°
AC ¬BC tan 25.6°
.85°
tan 15
Change AC to meters.
tan
7 ¬DC 52°
tan 33° DC
0.5 km 500 m tan
7 ¬DC
tan 33° 1
52°
tan 25.6°
500 BC ¬BC tan 15 .85° DC
tan52°
7
tan 33° 1
¬
t a n 25 .6°
500 ¬BC tan 15 .85° BC
7
tan 25.6°
500 ¬BC tan 15 .85° 1 BD ¬
tan
52°
1
tan52°
tan 33°
500
BC ¬ BD ¬3.0
tan 25.6°
tan 15.85° 1
The balloon is about 3.0 miles above the ground.
BC ¬727 27. Answers should include the following.
DC ¬BCtan25.6° • Pilots use angles of elevation when they are
¬348 ascending and angles of depression when
Ayers Rock is about 348 meters high. descending.
25. E A • Angles of elevation are formed when a person
16
looks upward and angles of depression are
29
formed when a person looks downward.
3 mi
28. B; let x represent the distance from the ship to
the foot of the tower.
D C n B 12
tan25° ¬ 0
x
f xtan25° ¬120
Find f n. 120
x ¬
tan
A
E is parallel to D
B
, so EAD ADB and 25°
EAC ACB because they are alternate x ¬257.3
interior angles. Then mADB 16 and The ship is about 257.3 meters from the tower.
mACB 29. y
¬
x
29. A;
28 1
6
tan16° ¬3f 16y ¬28x
f tan16° ¬3 161
2 ¬28x
3
f ¬tan16° 8 ¬28x
3 8
tan29° ¬ n
28 ¬x
ntan29° ¬3 2
¬x
7
3
n ¬
tan29°
3 3
f n ¬tan16°
tan29°
Page 376 Maintain Your Skills
f n ¬5.1
30. cosA ¬0.6717
The crater is about 5.1 miles across.
A ¬cos1(0.6717)
26. B A ¬47.8
31. sinB ¬0.5127
B ¬sin1(0.5127)
B ¬30.8
32. tanC ¬2.1758
C ¬tan1(2.1758)
A
33
52
C C ¬65.3
D 33. cosD ¬0.3421
7 mi
D ¬cos1(0.3421)
BD
tan33° ¬ D ¬70.0
AD
ADtan33° ¬BD 34. sinE ¬0.1455
BD E ¬sin1(0.1455)
tan52° ¬
DC E ¬8.4
DCtan52° ¬BD 35. tanF ¬0.3541
ADtan33° ¬DCtan52° F ¬tan1(0.3541)
F ¬19.5
Chapter 7 216
28
7
36. 12 ¬x2
47. 15 ¬ x
12
¬x 28x ¬15(7)
2
28x ¬105
12
2
x x ¬3.75
2 2
122 x 3
2
¬x 48.
40 ¬
26
62 ¬x 26x ¬40(3)
y ¬x 26x ¬120
60
y ¬62 x ¬
13
37. x 143
y 2(14) or 28
38. 20 2y 7-6 The Law of Sines
10 y
x ¬y3
x ¬103 Pages 380–381 Check for Understanding
39. Let be the length of the model. 1. Felipe; Makayla is using the definition of the sine
length of model wingspan of model ratio for a right triangle, but this is not a right
length of plane
wingspan of plane triangle.
36
78 ¬
90 2. F
90 ¬78(36)
90 ¬2808
e d
¬31.2
The length of the model is 31.2 cm.
40a. 1 2 D E
f
40b. AAS
Sample answer: Let mD 65, mE 73, and
X
40c. F G X sin 65°
d 15. Then
15 is the fixed ratio or scale
40d. CPCTC
factor for the Law of Sines extended proportion.
40e. 4 3
sin 65° sin 73°
The length of e is found by using 15
40f. Isosceles Triangle Theorem e.
x The mF is found by evaluating 180 (mD
41. 6 ¬ 35
42 mE). In this problem mF 42. The length of f
42x ¬6(35) sin 65° sin 42°
is found by using 15
42x ¬210 f.
x ¬5 3. In one case you need the measures of two sides
and the measure of an angle opposite one of the
3
x ¬
5
42. 45 sides. In the other case you need the measures of
3(45) ¬5x two angles and the measure of a side.
135 ¬5x sinX sin Y
x ¬y
4.
27 ¬x
sin 37°
sin 68°
¬
y
12 24
17 ¬ x
43. 3
12x ¬17(24) ysin37° ¬3sin68°
12x ¬408 3 sin68°
y ¬sin 37°
x ¬34
y ¬4.6
24
x
36 ¬ 15
44. 5. mX mY mZ ¬180
24(15) ¬36x 57 mY 72 ¬180
360 ¬36x mY ¬51
10 ¬x X
sin sin Y
x ¬y
12 48
13 ¬ x
45. sin 57° sin 5 1°
x ¬
12.1
12x ¬13(48)
12.1sin57° ¬xsin51°
12x ¬624
12.1 si
n 57°
sin 51° ¬x
x ¬52
x 5 13.1 ¬x
46.
18 ¬8
8x ¬18(5)
8x ¬90
x ¬11.25
217 Chapter 7
Y
sin sin Z
6. y ¬z 10. mP mQ mR ¬180
sin
Y sin 37° 33 mQ 58 ¬180
7 ¬ 11
mQ 91 ¬180
11sinY ¬7sin37° mQ ¬89
7sin
37° sinP sinQ
sinY ¬ 11 p ¬q
7sin
Y ¬sin1 37°
11
sin 33° sin 89°
p ¬ 22
Y ¬23°
22sin33° ¬psin89°
sinY sin Z
7. y ¬¬z 22 sin
33°
sin 89° ¬p
sin 92° sinZ
17 ¬ 14
12.0 ¬p
14sin92° ¬17sinZ
R
sin sin Q
14sin92°
¬sinZ
r ¬q
17 sin 58° sin 89°
sin114sin 92° r ¬
¬Z
17 22
22sin58° ¬rsin89°
55° ¬Z
22 sin
58°
sin 89° ¬r
8. mP mQ mR ¬180
mP 59 66 ¬180 18.7 ¬r
mP 125 ¬180 sinP sin Q
mP ¬55
11. p ¬q
sin 1
20° sinQ
sinP sin Q ¬
p ¬q
28 22
sin 55° sin 59° 22sin120° ¬28sinQ
72 ¬ q
22sin120°
28 ¬sinQ
qsin55° ¬72sin59°
72 sin
59°
22si
sin1 n
¬Q120°
q ¬sin 55°
28
43° ¬Q
q ¬75.3
mP mQ mR ¬180
sinP sin R
p ¬r 120 43 mR ¬180
sin 55° sin 66° 163 mR ¬180
72 ¬ r
mR ¬17
rsin55° ¬72sin66° P
sin sin R
p ¬r
72 sin
66°
r ¬sin 55° sin 1
20° sin 17°
28 ¬ r
r ¬80.3
rsin120° ¬28sin17°
sinP sin R
p ¬r
9. 28 sin
r ¬ 17°
sin 120°
sin 1
05° sinR
32 ¬11 r ¬9.5
11sin105° ¬32sinR 12. mP mQ mR ¬180
11sin105°
¬sinR 50 65 mR ¬180
32
115 mR ¬180
sin111sin
¬R
32
105°
mR ¬65
19° ¬R sinP sin Q
p ¬q
mP mQ mR ¬180 sin 50° sin 65°
12 ¬ q
105 mQ 19 ¬180
mQ 124 ¬180 qsin50° ¬12sin65°
mQ ¬56 12 sin
65°
q ¬sin 50°
P
sin sinQ
p ¬q q ¬14.2
sin 1
05° sin 56°
32 ¬ q sinP sin R
p ¬r
qsin105° ¬32sin56°
sin 50° sin 65°
12 ¬ r
32 sin56°
q ¬sin 105°
rsin50° ¬12sin65°
q ¬27.5
12 sin
65°
r ¬sin 50°
r ¬14.2
Chapter 7 218
Q
sin sin R sinK sinM
13. q ¬r 18. k ¬m
sin 110.7° sin
R sin 73° sin
M
17.2 ¬9.8
18.2 ¬ 10.5
9.8sin110.7° ¬17.2sinR 10.5sin73° ¬18.2sinM
9.8sin 110.7° 10.5 sin 73°
17.2 ¬sinR
18.2 ¬sinM
9.8si
sin1
¬Rn
17.2
110.7°
10.5
sin1 s
¬Mi
18.2
n 73°
32° ¬R 33° ¬M
mP mQ mR ¬180 mM ¬33
mP 110.7 32 ¬180 sinK sinM
mP 142.7 ¬180
19. k ¬m
sin 96° sin M
10 ¬ 4.8
mP ¬37
sinP sin Q 4.8sin96° ¬10sinM
p ¬q
4.8sin96°
sin 37° sin 11
0.7° ¬sinM
p ¬ 17.2 10
17.2sin37° ¬psin110.7°
4.8s
sin1 i
¬M
10
n96°
17.2 sin 37° 29° ¬M
sin 110.7° ¬p
mM ¬29
11.1 ¬p
14.
ADBC, so DAC BCA because they are 20. mK mL mM ¬180
alternate interior angles. Thus, mDAC 88. 31 88 mM ¬180
sin 32° sin88° 119 mM ¬180
¬
6 D
C mM ¬61
DCsin32° ¬6sin88° sinL sinM
¬m
6 sin88°
DC ¬ sin 32° sin 88° sin 61°
DC ¬11.3
¬
5.4
5.4sin88° ¬sin61°
ABCD is a parallelogram, so A D
B
C and
5.4 si
n 88°
sin 61° ¬
C
D A B. The perimeter of ABCD is
2(6) 2(11.3), or 34.6 units. 6.2 ¬
15. mA mB mC ¬180 sinM sin L
m ¬
21.
55 mB 62 ¬180
mB 117 ¬180 sin 59° sinL
14.8 ¬ 8.3
mB ¬63
8.3sin59° ¬14.8sinL
sin 63° sin 62°
240 ¬ AB
8.3 sin 59°
14.8 ¬sinL
ABsin63° ¬240sin62°
240 si
n 62° sin1 8.3 sin
¬L
14.8
59°
AB ¬ sin 63°
29° ¬L
AB ¬237.8 feet mL ¬29
sinX sin Y
x ¬y
22.
sin 41° sin 71°
Pages 381–382 Practice and Apply x ¬
7.4
K
sin sinL
k ¬
16. 7.4sin41° ¬xsin71°
sin 63° sin 45° 7.4 si
n 41°
sin 71° ¬x
k ¬
22
22sin63° ¬ksin45° 5.1 ¬x
22 sin
63° mW mX mY ¬180
sin 45° ¬k
mW 41 71 ¬180
27.7 ¬k
mW 112 ¬180
sinK sin L mW ¬68
17. k ¬
W
sin sin Y
w ¬y
sin 70° sin 52°
3.2 ¬
sin 68° sin 71°
sin70° ¬3.2sin52° w ¬
7.4
3.2 si
n 52°
¬ sin 70° 7.4sin68° ¬wsin71°
7.4 si
n 68°
¬2.7
sin 71° ¬w
7.3 ¬w
219 Chapter 7
sinY sin X sinW sin X
23. y ¬x w ¬x
sin 96° sinX sin 38° sin27°
23.7 ¬ 10.3 8.5 ¬ x
10.3sin96° ¬23.7sinX xsin38° ¬8.5sin27°
10.3 si
n 96° 8.5 si
n 27°
23.7 ¬sinX x ¬ sin 38°
sin110.3 si n 96° x ¬6.3
¬X
23.7 sinW sin Y
25.6° ¬X w ¬y
sin 38° sin115°
mW mX mY ¬180
8.5 ¬
y
mW 25.6 96 ¬180 ysin38° ¬8.5sin115°
mW 121.6 ¬180 8.5 sin
115°
mW ¬58.4 y ¬ sin 38°
W
sin sin Y y ¬12.5
w ¬y
sin5
8.4° sin 96° 27. mW mX mY ¬180
¬
w 23.7 36 mX 62 ¬180
23.7sin58.4° ¬wsin96° mX 98 ¬180
23.7 sin
58.4°
¬w mX ¬82
sin 96°
sinW sin X
20.3 ¬w w ¬x
24. mW mX mY ¬180 sin 36° sin 82°
3.1 ¬ x
52 25 mY ¬180
xsin36° ¬3.1sin82°
77 mY ¬180
3.1 si
n 82°
mY ¬103 x ¬ sin 36°
W
sin sin Y x ¬5.2
w ¬y
sin 52° sin 1
03° sinW sin Y
w ¬y
w ¬
15.6
15.6 sin52° ¬wsin103° sin 36° sin 62°
3.1 ¬ y
15.6 si
n 52°
sin 103° ¬w
ysin36° ¬3.1sin62°
12.6 ¬w 3.1 si
n 62°
y ¬ sin 36°
sinX sin Y y ¬4.7
x ¬y
W
sin sin Y
w ¬y
sin 25° sin 1
03° 28.
x ¬
15.6
sin 1
07° sinY
15.6sin25° ¬x sin103°
30 ¬9.5
15.6 si
n 25° 9.5sin107° ¬30sinY
sin 103° ¬x
9.5sin 107°
6.8 ¬x
30 ¬sinY
X
sin sin Y 9.5si
sin1
¬Yn 107°
x ¬y
25. 30
sin
X sin 1
12° 17.6° ¬Y
20 ¬ 56
56sinX ¬20sin112° mW mX mY ¬180
20sin
112° 107 mX 17.6 ¬180
sinX ¬ 56 mX 124.6 ¬180
20sin
X ¬sin1 112° mX ¬55.4
56
W
sin sinX
X ¬19.3° w ¬ x
mW mX mY ¬180 sin 1
07° sin5
¬ 5.4°
30 x
mW 19.3 112 ¬180
xsin107° ¬30sin55.4°
mW 131.3 ¬180
30 sin
55.4°
mW ¬48.7 x ¬sin 107°
W
sin sin Y x ¬25.8
w ¬y
sinW sin X
w ¬
sin4
8.7° sin 1
12° 29.
w ¬ 56 x
sin 88° sin X
21 ¬ 16
56sin48.7° ¬wsin112°
56 sin
48.7° 16sin88° ¬21sinX
sin 112° ¬w
16sin88°
45.4 ¬w
21 ¬sinX
26. mW mX mY ¬180 16s
sin1 in
¬X
21
88°
38 mX 115 ¬180
49.6° ¬X
mX 153 ¬180
mX ¬27
Chapter 7 220
mW mX mY ¬180 33. P
88 49.6 mY ¬180
137.6 mY ¬180 b a
mY ¬42.4
sinW sin Y
w ¬y A
43
48
B
sin 88° sin42.4° 20 mi
21 ¬
y
mA mB mP ¬180
y sin88° ¬21sin42.4°
43 48 mP ¬180
21 sin
42.4°
y ¬ sin 88° 91 mP ¬180
y ¬14.2 mP ¬89
sinP sinA
20 ¬ a
30. Let x be the measure of each base angle.
x x 44 ¬180 sin 89° sin 43°
20 ¬ a
2x 44 ¬180
2x ¬136 asin89° ¬20sin43°.
20 sin
43°
x ¬68 a ¬sin 89°
Let y be the measure of each of the congruent a ¬13.6
sides. sinP sinB
20 ¬ b
sin 44° sin 68°
46 ¬ y
sin 89° sin 48°
20 ¬ b
y sin44° ¬46sin68° bsin89° ¬20sin48°
46 sin
68°
y ¬¬sin 44° b ¬20 sin
48°
sin 89°
y ¬61.4 b ¬14.9
The perimeter of the triangle is about The first station is about 14.9 miles from the
46 61.4 61.4 or 168.8 cm. plane, and the second station is about 13.6 miles
sin 28° sin 40° from the plane.
12 ¬ AB
31.
34. T
ABsin28° ¬12sin40°
12 sin40°
AB ¬
sin28°
AB ¬16.43
AB
DC and
AD
BC, so the perimeter of ABCD
is 2(16.43) 2(12) or 56.9 units.
32. Z
b d a
x y
78
44
80
85
Y 26 ft X A B
315 ft
mX mY mZ ¬180 mA mB mT ¬180
44 78 mZ ¬180 80 85 mT ¬180
122 mZ ¬180 165 mT ¬180
mZ ¬58 mT ¬15
sin 44° sin 58°
x ¬ sinT sinA
315 ¬ a
26
26sin44° ¬xsin58° sin 15° sin 80°
315 ¬ a
26 sin
44°
sin 58° ¬x
asin15° ¬315sin80°
21.3 ¬x 315 si
a ¬ n 80°
sin 15°
sin 78° sin 58°
y ¬ 26
a ¬1198.6
26sin78° ¬ysin58° B
sin sin 90°
d ¬a
26 sin
78°
sin 58° ¬y
sin 85° sin 90°
d ¬
1198.6
30 ¬y 1198.6sin85° ¬dsin90°
The length of fence needed is about 30 21.3 1198.6sin 85°
sin 90° ¬d
26 or 77.3 feet.
1194.0 ¬d
The distance across the gorge is about 1194 feet.
221 Chapter 7
35. The plot of land is an isosceles triangle. Let x 39. See art for Exercise 38.
represent the measure of one of the base angles. B
sin sinC
b ¬ 60
x x 85 ¬180
sin124° sin 29°
2x 85 ¬180
b ¬
60
2x ¬95 60sin124° ¬bsin29°
x ¬47.5 60 sin124°
sin 29° ¬b
Let y represent the length of the base of the
triangle. 102.6 ¬b
sin 4
7.5° sin 85° 60 a 60 56.2 or 116.2
160 ¬ y
116.2 102.6 13.6
y sin47.5° ¬160sin85° Keisha added about 13.6 miles to the flight.
160 si
n85° A
sin C
sin
y ¬sin 47.5° 40. Yes; in right ABC, a c where C is the
y ¬216 asi
nC
right angle. Then sinA c . Since mC ¬90,
The perimeter of the property is about 160 asin90°
160 216 or 536 feet, so 536 feet of fencing then sinA c . Since sin90° 1, then
material is needed. sinA ac, which is the definition of the sine ratio.
36. P 41. Sample answer: Triangles are used to determine
distances in space. Answers should include the
j k following.
• The VLA is one of the world’s premier
40
27
astronomical radio observatories. It is used to
K 1433 m J make pictures from the radio waves emitted by
mK mJ mP ¬180 astronomical objects.
40 27 mP ¬180 • Triangles are used in the construction of the
67 mP ¬180 antennas.
mP ¬113 42. mX mY mZ ¬180
sin
P sinJ 48 112 mZ ¬180
1433 ¬ j
sin 1
13° sin 27° 160 mZ ¬180
1433 ¬ j
mZ ¬20
jsin113° ¬1433sin27° sinX sin Y
x ¬y
1433s in 27°
j ¬ sin 48° sin1 12°
12 ¬
sin 113°
y
j ¬706.8 ysin48° ¬12sin112°
Kayla and Paige are about 706.8 meters apart. 12 sin112°
y ¬ sin 48°
37. See art for Exercise 36.
y ¬15.0
sin
P sin K
3 ¬k sinX sin Z
x ¬z
143
sin 1
13° sin 40°
1433 ¬ k
sin 48° sin 20°
12 ¬ z
ksin113° ¬1433sin40° zsin48° ¬12sin20°
1433s in 40°
k ¬ sin 113° 12 sin
z ¬ 20°
sin 48°
k ¬1000.7 z ¬5.5
Jenna and Paige are about 1000.7 meters apart. 9 8 77 31
43. A; Metropolis Grill: 4 4 7.75
38. b A 10 8 35 26
C Le Circus: 4
4 6.5
27
8 9 46 27
Aquavent: 4 4 6.75
a 60 mi 7 9 47 2
7
124
Del Blanco’s: 4 4 6.75
B Metropolis Grill has the best average rating of the
four restaurant choices.
mA mB mC ¬180
27 124 mC ¬180
151 mC ¬180
mC ¬29 Page 383 Maintain Your Skills
A
sin sinC 44. Find x so that the angle of elevation is 73.5°.
a ¬60 6 1
sin 27° sin 29°
tan73.5° ¬ x
a ¬
60 xtan73.5° ¬7
60sin27° ¬asin29° 7
x ¬
tan73.5°
60 sin
27°
sin 29° ¬a
x ¬2.07
56.2 ¬a The overhang should be about 2.07 feet long.
Keisha must fly about 56.2 miles.
Chapter 7 222
c2 a
2 b2 102 7
2 82
45. Let y represent the amount of the window that 53. 2ab ¬
2(7)(8)
will get direct sunlight. 100 4
9 64
7y ¬ 112
tan26.5° ¬
2.07 13 13
¬ 12 ¬
1
2.07tan26.5° ¬7 y 112
y ¬7 2.07tan26.5° c2 a
2 b2 62 4
2 92
54. 2ab ¬ 2(4)(9)
y ¬5.97 36 16 81
¬
72
About 5.97 feet of the window will get direct
6
1 6
1
sunlight. ¬
72 ¬ 72
cosJ k
j j
46. sinJ tanJ c2 a
55.
2 b2 102 5
¬
2 82
k 2ab 2(5)(8)
8 15 8
sinJ cosJ tanJ 100 2
5 64 1
1
17 17 15 ¬ 80 ¬
80
sinJ 0.47 cos J 0.88 tan J 0.53
c2 a
2 b2 132 1
62 42
56. ¬
sinL k tanL j
j 2ab 2(16)(4)
cosL
k
169 256 16
15 8 15 ¬
128
sinL 17
cosL
17 tanL 8
1
03 10
3
sinL 0.88 cos L 0.47 tanL 1.88 ¬
128 ¬ 128
cosJ k
j j c2 a
2 b2 92 32
102
47. sinJ tanJ 57. ¬
k 2ab 2(3)(10)
20 21 20 81 9
100
sinJ
29
cosJ
29 tanJ
21
¬ 60
sinJ 0.69 cos J 0.72 tan J 0.95 2
¬ 8 7
60 ¬ 15
sinL k tanL j
j
cosL c2 a
2 b2 112 5
2 72
k 58. ¬
21 20 21 2ab 2(5)(7)
sinL cosL tanL
29 29 20 121 2
5 49 47
¬ 70 ¬
70
sinL 0.72 cos L 0.69 tanL 1.05
cosJ k
j j
48. sinJ tanJ
k
sinJ 12 12
cosJ
3
tanJ 12
Page 383 Practice Quiz 2
24 24 123 16
1. tanx° ¬
10
sinJ 1
2
cosJ 2
3
tanJ 3
3
16
x ¬tan1
10
sinJ 0.50 cos J 0.87 tan J 0.58
x ¬58.0
sinL k tanL j
j
cosL x
k 2. cos17° ¬
9.7
12
3 12 12
3
sinL
24 cosL 24
tanL
12 9.7cos17° ¬x
sinL
3
cosL 1 tanL 3
9.3 ¬x
2 2 32
sinL 0.87 cos L 0.50 tanL 1.73 3. cos53° ¬x
xcos53° ¬32
cosJ k
j j
49. sinJ tanJ
k 32
x ¬
7
2 7
2 7
2 cos 53°
sinJ cosJ tanJ x ¬53.2
14 14 7
2
2
2
sinJ 2 cosJ 2 tanJ 1.00 4.
5m
sinJ 0.71 cos J 0.71
sinL k tanL j
j
cosL
k
7
2 7
2 7
2
sinL cosL tanL 15
14 14
72 15
2
2
sinL 2 cosL 2 tanL 1.00
sinL 0.71 cos L 0.71 500 m
50. m1 54 120 Exterior Angle Theorem
m1 66
51. m2 54 alternate interior
52. m2 m3 36 ¬180 Angle Sum Theorem
54 m3 36 ¬180 x x
m3 90 ¬180 x
tan15° ¬
500
5
m3 ¬90
495tan15° ¬x
132.6 ¬x
The distance is about 132.6 meters.
223 Chapter 7
D
sin sinF
5. EF ¬DE 5. a2 ¬b2 c2 2bccosA
sin
D sin 82° a2 ¬1072 942 2(107)(94)cos105°
8 ¬ 12
a2 ¬20,285 20,116 cos105°
12sinD ¬8sin82° a ¬20,28
5 ,116
20os105c°
8sin
82°
sinD ¬ 12 a ¬159.7
8sin
D ¬sin1 s2 ¬r2 t2 2rtcosS
12
82° 6.
652 ¬332 562 2(33)(56)cos S
D ¬41°
4225 ¬4225 3696 cosS
mD mE mF ¬180 0 ¬3696 cosS
41 mE 82 ¬180 0 ¬cosS
mE 123 ¬180 S ¬cos1(0)
mE ¬57 S ¬90°
E
sin sinD r2 ¬s2 t2 2stcosR
DF ¬
7.
EF
sin5 7° sin 41° 2.22 ¬1.32 1.62 2(1.3)(1.6)cos R
DF ¬8 4.84 ¬4.25 4.16 cosR
8sin57° ¬DF sin41° 0.59 ¬4.16 cosR
8 sin57° 0.5
9
4.16 ¬cosR
sin 41° ¬DF
10.2 ¬DF R ¬cos1
4.16
0.5
9
R ¬98°
8. We know the measures of three sides (SSS), so
Page 384 Geometry Software Investigation: use the Law of Cosines.
The Ambiguous Case of the Law x2 ¬y2 z2 2yzcosX
of Sines 52 ¬102 132 2(10)(13)cos X
1. BD, AB, and mA 25 ¬269 260 cosX
2. Sample answer: There are two different triangles. 244 ¬260 cosX
2
44
260 ¬cosX
3. Sample answer: The results are the same. In each
case, two triangles are possible. 2
X ¬cos1 44
260
4. Sample answer: Circle B intersects
AC at only one
point. See students’ work. X ¬20°
5. Yes; sample answer: There is no solution if circle X
sin sin Y
B does not intersect
AC.
x ¬y
sin 20°
sin
¬ Y
5 10
10sin20° ¬5sinY
10sin20°
7-7 The Law of Cosines
5
¬sinY
sin110sin20°
¬Y
5
Pages 387–388 Check for Understanding 43° ¬Y
1. Sample answer: Use the Law of Cosines when you mX mY mZ ¬180
have all three sides given (SSS) or two sides and 20 43 mZ ¬180
the included angle (SAS). mZ ¬117
R Y 9. We know the measures of two sides and the
6 8 10 included angle (SAS), so use the Law of Cosines.
Q S X 38
Z 2 ¬k2 m2 2kmcosL
12 15 2 ¬202 242 2(20)(24)cos47°
2. If you have all three sides (SSS) or two sides and 2 ¬976 960 cos47°
the included angle (SAS) given, then use the Law ¬976
os47°
960 c
of Cosines. If two angles and one side (ASA or ¬17.9
AAS) or two sides with angle opposite one of the sinL sin K
sides (SSA) are given, then use the Law of Sines.
¬k
sin 47° sinK
17.9 ¬ 20
3. If two angles and one side are given, then the
Law of Cosines cannot be used. 20sin47° ¬17.9sin K
4. b2 ¬a2 c2 2accosB 20 sin47°
¬sinK
17.9
b2 ¬52 (2 )2 2(5)(2
)cos45°
b ¬27 102
2 cos45° sin120 sin
¬K
17.9
47°
b ¬ 27 102 c
os45° 55° ¬K
b ¬4.1 mK mL mM ¬180
55 47 mM ¬180
mM ¬78
Chapter 7 224
10. Let n, d, and q be the measures of the sides 16. e2 ¬f2 g2 2fgcosE
opposite N, D, and Q, respectively. 142 ¬192 322 2(19)(32)cos E
n 1 1 196 ¬1385 1216cos E
2 (10) 2 (24) or 17 mm
1189 ¬1216cos E
d 1
1
2 (24) 2 (22) or 23 mm 11
89
1216 ¬cosE
q 1 1
2 (10) 2 (22) or 16 mm
118
E ¬cos1
1216
9
n2 ¬d2 q2 2dqcosN
E ¬12°
172 ¬232 162 2(23)(16)cos N
289 ¬785 736cos N 17. f 2 ¬e2 g2 2egcosF
496 ¬736cos N 1982 ¬3252 2082 2(325)(208)cos F
4
96 39,204 ¬148,889 135,200cos F
736 ¬cosN
109,685 ¬135,200cos F
4
N ¬cos1 96
736 109,685
¬cosF
135
,200
N ¬47.6° 109,685
F ¬cos1 200
135,
q2 ¬n2 d2 2ndcosQ
162 ¬172 232 2(17)(23)cos Q F ¬36°
256 ¬818 782 cosQ 18. g2 ¬e2 f 2 2efcosG
562 ¬782 cosQ 102 ¬21.92 18.92 2(21.9)(18.9)cos G
5
62 100 ¬836.82 827.82cosG
782 ¬cosQ
736.82 ¬827.82cosG
5
Q ¬cos1 62
782 736.82
827.82 ¬cosG
Q ¬44.1° 736
G ¬cos1 .82
827.82
mQ mD mN ¬180
44.1 mD 47.6 ¬180 G ¬27°
mD ¬88.3 H
sin sin F
19. h ¬0f
sin
H sin 40°
8 ¬ 10
Pages 388–390 Practice and Apply 10sinH ¬8sin40°
11. u2 ¬t2 v2 2tvcosU 8sin
40°
sinH ¬
u2 ¬9.12 8.32 2(9.1)(8.3)cos32° 10
u2 ¬151.7 151.06 cos32° 8sin
H ¬sin1¬ 40°
10
u ¬151.7
.06 151s32°co
H ¬31°
u ¬4.9
12. v2 ¬t2 u2 2tucosV mF mG mH ¬180
v2 ¬112 172 2(11)(17)cos78° 40 mG 31 ¬180
v2 ¬410 374 cos78° mG ¬109
v ¬410
os78°
374 c G
sin F
sin
g ¬0 f
v ¬18.2 sin109° sin 40°
¬
13. t2 uu2 v2 2uvcosT g 10
t2 ¬112 172 2(11)(17)cos105° 10sin109° ¬gsin40°
t2 ¬410 374 cos105° 10 sin109°
sin 40° ¬g
t ¬410
os105
374 c°
t ¬22.5 14.7 ¬g
14. t2 uu2 v2 2uvcosT 20. um2 q2 2mqcosP
p2
t2 ¬172 112 2(17)(11)cos59° p2 ¬112 102 2(11)(10)cos38°
t2 ¬410 374 cos59° p2 ¬221 220 cos38°
t ¬410
os59°
374 c p ¬221
os38°
220 c
t ¬14.7 p ¬6.9
sinM P
sin
f 2 ¬e2 g2 2egcosF m ¬0 p
15.
8.32 ¬9.12 16.72 2(9.1)(16.7)cosF sin
M sin 38°
11 ¬ 6.9
68.89 ¬361.7 303.94 cosF
292.81 ¬303.94 cos F 6.9sin M ¬11sin38°
292.81 11sin
sinM ¬ 38°
303.94 ¬cosF
6.9
292
F ¬cos1
11sin
M ¬sin1 38°
303.94
.81
6.9
F ¬16° M ¬79°
mM mP mQ ¬180
79 38 mQ ¬180
mQ ¬63
225 Chapter 7
sinA sin B
21. b2 ¬c2 d2 2cdcosB a ¬b
182 ¬152 112 2(15)(11)cos B sin 30° sinB
15 ¬ 19
324 ¬346 330cos B
22 ¬330cos B 19sin30° ¬15sinB
22 19sin30°
330 ¬cosB
¬sinB
15
B ¬cos12
2
330 sin119sin
¬B30°
15
B ¬86° 39° ¬B
sinB C
sin mA mB mC ¬180
b ¬0 c
sin 86° sinC 30 39 mC ¬180
18 ¬ 15
mC ¬111
15sin86° ¬18sinC A
sin sin C
15sin86°
25. a ¬c
¬sinC sin
18 a53° sin 2
¬ 8°
14.9
sin115sin
18
86°
¬C 14.9sin53° ¬asin28°
56° ¬C 14.9 si
n 53°
sin 28° ¬a
mB mC mD ¬180
25.3 ¬a
86 56 mD ¬180
mD ¬38 mA mB mC ¬180
53 mB 28 ¬180
A
sin sinC
a ¬ c
22. mB ¬99
sin 42° sin 77° B
sin sin C
b ¬c
a ¬6
6sin42° ¬asin77° sin 99° sin 28°
b ¬
14.9
6 sin42°
sin 77° ¬a
14.9 sin 99° ¬b sin 28°
4.1 ¬a 14.9 si
n 99°
sin 28° ¬b
mA mB mC ¬180 31.3 ¬b
42 mB 77 ¬180
26. Find mDAB and mBCD.
mB ¬61
B
sin sinC DB2 ¬AB2 AD2 2(AB)(AD)cos(DAB)
b ¬ c
2
sin 61° sin 77° 723 ¬52 52 2(5)(5)cos(DAB)
b ¬6 52
9
9 ¬50 50cos(DAB)
6sin61° ¬bsin77°
79
9 ¬50cos(DAB)
6 sin61°
sin 77° ¬b
5.4 ¬b
5
1 79
0 9 ¬cos(DAB)
23. c2 ¬a2 b2 2abcosC
c2 ¬10.32 9.52 2(10.3)(9.5)cos37°
mDAB ¬cos1 1
5
79
0 9
c2 ¬196.34 195.7cos37° mDAB ¬100
c ¬ 196.3
4 19
5.7cos
37° BD2 ¬BC2 DC2
c ¬6.3 2(BC)(DC)cos(BCD)
2
A
sin sin
a ¬ c
C 723 ¬82 82 2(8)(8)cos(BCD)
sin
A sin 37° 529
9 ¬128 128cos(BCD)
10.3 ¬ 6.3
6.3sin A ¬10.3sin37° 623
9 ¬128cos(BCD)
10.3 si
n37°
sinA ¬ 6.3 1
128 623
9 ¬cos(BCD)
A ¬sin1
10.3 si
n37°
A ¬80°
6.3
mBCD ¬cos1 1
128
62
9
3
mBCD ¬57
mA mB mC ¬180
80 mB 37 ¬180 sinL sinM
27. ¬m
mB ¬63 sin 23° sin
M
54 ¬ 44
24. a2 ¬b2 c2 2bccosA
152 ¬192 282 2(19)(28)cos A 44sin23° ¬54sinM
225 ¬1145 1064cos A 44sin23°
¬sinM
920 ¬1064cos A 54
920 sin144sin
¬M23°
1064 ¬cosA
54
18.6° ¬M
A ¬cos1 92
0
1064
A ¬30°
Chapter 7 226
sinM sin N
mL mM mN ¬180 m ¬n
23 18.6 mN ¬180 sin 46° sin 79°
mN ¬138.4
m ¬ 16
N
sin sin L 16sin46° ¬msin79°
n ¬ 16 sin
46°
sin 79° ¬m
sin138.4° sin 23°
n ¬ 54
11.7 ¬m
54sin138.4° ¬nsin23° 31. 2 ¬m2 n2 2mncosL
54sin 1
38.4°
sin 23° ¬n 4232 ¬2562 2882 2(256)(288)cosL
91.8 ¬n 178,929 ¬148,480 147,456cos L
28. m2 ¬2 n2 2ncosM 30,449 ¬147,456cos L
30,449
,456 ¬cosL
18 ¬242 302 2(24)(30)cos M
2
147
L ¬cos1 ,456
324 ¬1476 1440cos M 30,449
147
1152 ¬1440cos M L ¬101.9°
11
52
1440 cosM
sinL sinM
¬m
M ¬cos1 115
2
1440 sin 10
1.9° sin
¬ M
423 256
M ¬36.9° 256sin101.9° ¬423sin M
sinM sin L
m ¬
256sin101.9°
423 ¬sinM
sin 3
6.9° sinL
¬ sin1
18 24 256sin
¬M
423
101.9°
24sin36.9° ¬18sinL 36.3° ¬M
24sin36.9°
18 ¬sinL mL mM mN ¬180
sin1 101.9 36.3 mN ¬180
24sin
¬L
18
36.9°
mN ¬41.8
53.2° ¬L
32. m2 ¬2 n2 2ncosM
mL mM mN ¬180
m2 ¬6.32 6.72 2(6.3)(6.7)cos55°
53.2 36.9 mN ¬180
m2 ¬84.58 84.42cos55°
mN ¬89.9
m ¬ 84.58 84.42cos
55°
29. 2 ¬m2 n2 2mncosL m ¬6.0
2 ¬192 282 2(19)(28)cos49°
sinM sin L
m ¬
2 ¬1145 1064cos49°
¬ 1145 1064
cos49° sin 55°
sin
¬ L
¬21.1 6 6.3
6.3sin55° ¬6sinL
sinL sinM
¬m
6.3sin55°
6 ¬sinL
sin 49° sin
M
21.1 ¬ 19
sin1
6.3si
¬L
6
n55°
19sin49° ¬21.1sin M
59.3° ¬L
19 sin49°
21.1 ¬sinM
mL mM mN ¬180
sin1 19 sin
21.1
49°
¬M 59.3 55 mN ¬180
mN ¬65.7
42.8° ¬M
33. m2 ¬2 n2 2ncosM
mL mM mN ¬180
m2 ¬52 102 2(5)(10)cos27°
49 42.8 mN ¬180
m2 ¬125 100cos27°
mN ¬88.2
m ¬ 125 100cos27°
30. mL mM mN ¬180 m ¬6.0
55 46 mN ¬180 sin
L sinM
mN ¬79
¬m
sin
L sin 27°
5 ¬ 6
sinL sin N
¬n
sin 55° sin 79° 6sinL ¬5sin27°
¬ 16
5sin27°
16sin55° ¬ sin79° sinL ¬ 6
16 sin
55° L ¬sin1
5sin27°
sin 79° ¬
6
13.4 ¬ L ¬22.2°
mL mM mN ¬180
22.2 27 mN ¬180
mN ¬130.8
227 Chapter 7
sinL sin N
34. 2 ¬m2 n2 2mncosL 37. ¬n
142 ¬202 172 2(20)(17)cos L sin 51° sinN
40 ¬ 35
196 ¬689 680cos L
493 ¬680cos L 35sin51° ¬40sinN
4
93 35sin
51°
¬sinN
680 ¬cosL
40
L ¬cos1
680
49
3 sin1
35sin
¬N
40
51°
L ¬43.5° 42.8° ¬N
sinL sinM mL mM mN ¬180
¬ m
sin 43.5° sin M 51 mM 42.8 ¬180
¬ mM ¬86.2
14 20
20sin43.5° ¬14sinM sinL sinM
¬m
20sin43.5° sin 51° sin 86.2°
¬sinM
40 ¬
14 m
sin120sin
¬M
14
43.5°
msin51° ¬40sin86.2°
40 sin
86.2°
79.5° ¬M m ¬ sin 51°
mL mM mN ¬180 m ¬51.4
43.5 79.5 mN ¬180 38. 2 ¬m2 n2 2mncosL
mN ¬57.0 102 ¬112 122 2(11)(12)cos L
35. m2 ¬2 n2 2ncosM 100 ¬265 264cos L
m2 ¬142 212 2(14)(21)cos60° 165 ¬264cos L
m2 ¬637 588cos60° 1
65
264 ¬cosL
m ¬ 637 588co
s60°
m ¬18.5 L ¬cos1
264
16
5
sin
L sinM
¬m L ¬51.3°
sinL sinM
¬m
sin
L sin 60°
14 ¬ 18.5
sin 51.3° sin
M
18.5sinL ¬14sin60° ¬
10 11
14 sin
60°
sinL ¬ 18.5 11sin51.3° ¬10sinM
11sin 51.3°
L ¬sin1 14 sin
18.5
60°
¬sinM
10
L ¬40.9° sin1
11sin
10
51.3°
¬M
mL mM mN ¬180 59.1° ¬M
40.9 60 mN ¬180 mL mM mN ¬180
mN ¬79.1 51.3 59.1 mN ¬180
36. 2 ¬m2 n2 2mncosL mN ¬69.6
142 ¬152 162 2(15)(16)cos L 39. BC2 ¬BP2 PC2 2(BP)(PC)cos(BPC)
196 ¬481 480cos L 2 2
285 ¬480cos L BC2 ¬1
2 214 2 188
1
2
85
480 ¬cosL
21
2 214 2 188 cos70°
1
L ¬cos1
480
28
5 BC2 ¬20,285 20,116 cos70°
L ¬53.6° BC ¬20,28
5 ,116
20os70°
c
sinL sinM BC ¬115.8
¬ m
AB2 ¬AP2 BP2 2(AP)(BP)cos(APB)
sin 5
3.6° sin
M
¬ 2 2
14 15 AB2 ¬1
2 188 2 214
1
15sin53.6° ¬14sinM
15sin53.6° 21
2 188 2 214 cos(180 70)°
1
14 ¬sinM
AB2 ¬20,285 20,116 cos110°
sin115sin
53.6°
14
¬M
AB ¬20,28
5 ,116
20os110c°
59.6° ¬M AB ¬164.8
mL mM mN ¬180 AB DC and AD BC, so the perimeter of ABCD
53.6 59.6 mN ¬180 is 2(115.8) 2(164.8) or 561.2 units.
mN ¬66.8 40. QS2 ¬PQ2 PS2 2(PQ)(PS)cosP
QS2 ¬7212 7562 2(721)(756)cos58°
QS2 ¬1,091,377 1,090,152cos58°
QS ¬1,091
,377
,152
1,090os58°
c
QS ¬716.7
Chapter 7 228
sin(PQS) ¬sin P
¬
PS Q
S 242 ¬302 222 2(30)(22)cos A
sin(PQS)
5
¬sin 58°
¬ 576 ¬1384 1320cos A
7 6 716 .7
808 ¬1320cos A
716.7 sin(PQS) ¬756sin58° 808
1320 ¬cosA
756 sin 58°
sin(PQS) ¬716
.7
A ¬cos1
1320
80
8
mPQS ¬sin1 716.7
756 si
n 58°
A ¬52.3°
mPQS ¬63.5 Adam has a greater angle, which is 52.3°.
QS2 ¬QR2 RS2 2(QR)(RS)cos R 43a. Pythagorean Theorem
716.72 ¬5472 5932 2(547)(593)cosR 43b. Substitution
513,658.89 ¬650,858 648,742 cos R 43c. Pythagorean Theorem
137,199.11 ¬648,742 cos R 43d. Substitution
137,199.11
¬cosR 43e. Def. of cosine
648,742
43f. Cross products
R ¬cos1
648,742
137,199.11
43g. Substitution
R ¬77.8° 43h. Commutative Property
41. A 44. AB
[10 (6)]2 [4 (8)]2
162 42
272
174 ft 180 ft BC
(6 10)2 2
[8 (4)]
(4)
2 12 2
160
AC
[6 (6)]2
[8 (8)]2
C
186 ft
B
12
2 16 2
a2 ¬b2 c2 2bccosA
400 or 20
1862 ¬1742 1802 2(174)(180)cosA AC2 ¬BC2 AB2 2(BC)(AB)cos B
2 2
34,596 ¬62,676 62,640cos A 202 ¬160
272
28,080 ¬62,640 cos A
28,080
¬2160
272
cosB
¬cosA
62,640 400 ¬432 243,52
0 cosB
A ¬cos1
62,640
28,080
32 ¬243,52
0 cosB
A ¬63.4° 3
2
¬cosB
sinA sin B 2
43,52
0
a ¬b
sin 6
3.4° sin
¬ B 2
B ¬cos1 32
43,520
186 174
B ¬85.6°
174sin63.4° ¬186sin B So, mABC 85.6°.
174sin63.4°
186 ¬sinB CB2 ¬AB2 AC2 2(AB)(AC)cos A
2 2
sin1 174sin
186
63.4°
¬B 160
¬272
202 2272
(20)cosA
56.8° ¬B 160 ¬672 40272
cosA
mA mB mC ¬180
63.4 56.8 mC ¬180 512 ¬40272
cosA
mC ¬59.8 512
¬cosA
40272
42. Let C represent Carlos’s angle and A represent
Adam’s angle. 402
A ¬cos1 51
2
72
242 ¬402 502 2(40)(50)cos C A ¬39.1°
576 ¬4100 4000cos C mDCA mB mA
3524 ¬4000cos C 85.6 39.1 or 124.7
35
24 45. Sample answer: Triangles are used to build
4000 ¬cosC
supports, walls, and foundations. Answers should
C ¬cos1
4000
352
4
include the following.
C ¬28.2° • The triangular building was more efficient with
the cells around the edge.
• The Law of Sines requires two angles and a side
or two sides and an angle opposite one of those
sides.
229 Chapter 7
46. B; d2 ¬e2 f 2 2efcosD B
53. To show that A
C
D
, we must show that
d2 ¬122 152 2(12)(15)cos75° AB
AE.
d2 ¬369 360cos75° CD CE
AB 8 AE
or 2, and 9. Since the side lengths
d ¬369 360cos75°
CD 4 CE 4
d ¬16.6 B
are not proportional, A is not parallel to C
D
.
47. C; earnings base salary commission
B
54. To show that A
C
D
, we must show that
Let s represent her sales for the month.
4455 ¬1280 0.125s AB
BE
CD DE.
3175 ¬0.125s AB
or 9, and
5.4 BE
E
D
18 9
25,400 ¬s CD 3 5 10 or 5 .
Her sales that month were $25,400. AB BE
Thus,
CD D E . Since the sides have proportional
B
lengths, A
C
D
.
Page 390 Maintain Your Skills 55. Given: JFM EFB
X
sin sinY LFM GFB
x ¬ y
48.
sin 22° sin 49°
Prove: JFL EFG
¬
x 4.7 H G
4.7sin22° ¬x sin49° L
4.7 sin 22° E J
¬x F
sin 49°
2.3 ¬x M C
D
sinX Y
sin
x ¬ y
49.
A B
sin 50° sin
Y
14 ¬ 10
Proof:
Since JFM EFB and LFM GFB, then
10sin50° ¬14sinY
10sin50°
by the definition of similar triangles,
14 ¬sinY JF M
F MF LF
F BF and BF GF . By the Transitive
E
sin1 10sin 50°
1
4
¬Y JF LF
33° ¬Y
Property of Equality,
EF
GF . F F by the
Reflexive Property of Congruence. Then, by SAS
50. Similarity, JFL EFG.
x 56. Given: J
M
E
B
23
M
L
G
B
1.55 m Prove: JL
E
G
100 m H G
x
L
tan23° ¬ E J
100 F
100tan23° ¬x M C
D
42.45 ¬x
x 1.55 ¬42.45 1.55 or 44.0 A B
The height of the building is about 44.0 meters. Proof:
B
51. To show that A
C
D
, we must show that M
Since J
E
B and L
M
G
B
, then MJF BEF
AC BD and FML FBG because if two parallel lines
CE DE .
are cut by a transversal, corresponding angles are
AC
or 7, and
8.4 BD 6.
3 congruent. EFB EFB and BFG BFG
DE 4.5
CE 6 5
by the Reflexive Property of Congruence. Then
or 7
AC
BD
5 . Thus, CE DE . Since the sides have
EFB JFM and FBG FML by AA
B
C
D
. JF MF MF LF
Similarity. Then
EF BF , BF GF by the
proportional lengths, A
B
C
D
, we must show that JF LF
definition of similar triangles.
EF G
52. To show that A
F by the
AC BD
CE
DE .
Transitive Porperty of Equality and
EFG EFG by the Reflexive Property of
CE AE AC 15 7 or 8.
AC 7
Congruence. Thus, JFL EFG by SAS
So,
CE 8. Similarity and FJL FEG by the definition of
DE BE BD 22.5 10.5 or 12. L
similar triangles. J
E
G because if two lines are
BD 10
.5 cut by a transversal so that the corresponding
7 AC BD
DE 12 or 8 . Thus, CE DE . Since the
So,
angles are congruent, then the lines are parallel.
B
sides have proportional lengths, A
C
D
.
Chapter 7 230
57. y y 4 ¬4x 8
Z(0 , 1 2 ) y ¬4x 12
Solve a system of equations to find the point of
intersection of the medians.
Y(4, 8 ) x 8 ¬4x 12
3x 8 ¬12
3x ¬4
x ¬4
3
X(8 , 0 ) x
Replace x with 4
3 in one of the equations to find
the y-coordinate.
Find an equation of the altitude from X to Y Z
.
Z
The slope of Y is 12
8 y 4
3 8
0 (4) or 1, so the slope of
the altitude is 1. 20
y3
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y 0 ¬1(x 8)
The coordinates of the centroid are 4
2
0
3 , 3 or
y ¬x 8 about (1.3, 6.7).
Find an equation of the altitude from Z to X Y
. 59. y
80
Y
The slope of X is or 2, so the slope of Z(0 , 1 2 )
4 8 3
the altitude is 3
2.
y y1 ¬m(x x1) Y(4 , 8 )
y 12 ¬3
2 (x 0)
3
y ¬2 x 12
Solve a system of equations to find the point of X(8 , 0 ) x
intersection of the altitudes.
x 8 ¬3
2 x 12
Find an equation of the perpendicular bisector
Z
of Y.
8 ¬5
2 x 12
5
Z
The midpoint of Y is 4
2 ,
8
0
2
12
or (2, 10).
4 ¬2x 12 8
The slope of YZ is
0 (4) or 1, so the slope of
8
5 ¬x
the perpendicular bisector is 1.
Replace x with 8 y y1 m(x x1)
5 in one of the equations to find
the y-coordinate. y 10 1[x (2)]
y 10 x 2
y 85 8
y x 8
48
y
5
Find an equation of the perpendicular bisector of
The coordinates of the orthocenter are 8
48
5 , 5 or Y
X .
The midpoint of XY 8 (4)
is
, 0 8
or (2, 4).
(1.6, 9.6). 2 2
80
Y
is 2
4 8 or 3 , so the slope of
58. y The slope of X
3
Z(0 , 1 2 ) the perpendicular bisector is 2.
y y1 m(x x1)
Y(4, 8 ) y 4 3
2 (x 2)
y 3
2x 3 4
y 3
2x 1
X(8 , 0 ) x Solve a system of equations to find the point of
intersection of the perpendicular bisectors.
Find an equation of the median from X to Y Z
. x 8¬ 3
2x 1
Z
The midpoint of Y is 4
2
,
0 8
2
12
or (2, 10).
8¬ 5
2x 1
10 0
2 8 or 1.
Then the slope of the median is
7¬ 5
2x
y y1 ¬m(x x1)
1
4
y 0 ¬1(x 8) 5 ¬ x
y ¬x 8 Replace x with 14
5 in one of the equations to find
Y
Find an equation of the median from Z to X. the y-coordinate.
Y
The midpoint of X 8 (4)
is 2
, 0
2
8
or (2, 4). y 14
5 8
4 12 2
y 6
Then the slope of the median is 2 0 or 4. 5
y y1 ¬m(x x1) The coordinates of the circumcenter are 5 , 5
14 26
y 4 ¬4 (x 2) or (2.8, 5.2).
231 Chapter 7
Page 391 Geometry Activity: Trigonometric 9. Let x represent the geometric mean.
Identities 4 x
x 81
1. Sample answer: It is of the form a2 b2 c2, x2 324
where c 1. x 324
1 1 x 18
cos sec; tan cot
2.
10. Let x represent the geometric mean.
sin
cos tan
3. Original equation 20
x
y x ¬ 35
y y
r x sin r, cos xr, tan yx x2¬ 700
x x¬ 700
r
y y
rxr x Multiply by the reciprocal of xr. x¬ 26.5
y y 11. Let x represent the geometric mean.
Multiply. 18
x x x
cos x ¬ 44
4.
sin cot Original equation x2¬ 792
sin yr, cos xr, cot xy
x
r
x x¬ 792
y y
r x¬ 28.1
x r x
ry y Multiply by the reciprocal of yr. 12. Let x¬ RS.
PS
RS
x x Multiply. RS ¬ QS
y y
8 x
¬
5. tan2 1 sec2 Original equation x 14
y 2 2 y x2¬ 112
x 1 xr tan x, sec xr
y2 2 x¬ 112
or 47
1 r2 Evaluate exponents. x¬ 10.6
x2 x
2 y2
2
x 2 1 (x2)xr2 Multiply each side by x2. So RS¬ 10.6.
x
13. 152 202¬ x2
y2 x2 r2 Simplify.
225 400¬ x2
r2 r2 Substitution; y2 x2 r2 625¬ x2
6. cot 1 csc2
2 Original equation 625
¬ x
2 2
x
y 1 yr cot xy, sec yr 25¬ x
2 2
14. x2 7 ¬
17
xy 1
yr
5 13
1
2 2
2 2 Evaluate exponents.
25 169
x2 289 ¬
y xy 1
(y )yr
2 2 289
2 2 Multiply each side by y2.
2 2
14
4
x2¬
x2 y2 r2 Simplify. 289
r2 r2 Substitution; x2 y2 r2 x¬
14
4
289
12
x¬
17
15. x2 132¬ 212
Chapter 7 Study Guide and Review x2 169¬ 441
x2¬ 272
Page 392 Vocabulary and Concept Check x¬ 272
or 417
1. true x¬ 16.5
2. false; opposite; adjacent 16. x 9
3. false; a right y 92
4. true 17. 13 x2
13
x
5. true
2
6. false; 45°-45°-90° 13
2
x
2 2
7. false; depression
132
2 x
yx
Pages 392–396 Lesson-by-Lesson Review 132
y
2
8. Let x represent the geometric mean. 18. x 2(6) or 12
4 x y 63
x 16
x2 64 19. z 183
x 64 a 2z
x8 a 2(183 ) or 363
Chapter 7 232
20. 14 z3
26. B
14
z
3 x
60 ft
A
14
3
z 500 yd C
3 3
143 Let x represent mBAC.
3 z
60
tanx°¬
500 3
a 2z
60
a2
143
3
or
283
3
tanx°¬
1500
z y3
x¬ tan11500
60
143 x¬ 2.3
3 y3
The angle of elevation must be greater than 2.3°.
143 1
y 27. A D
3 3
14
3 y
b 2y 100 ft
b 23 or 3
14
28
x
C 240 ft B
21. sinF ac
9 3 Let x represent mABC.
15 or 5 The ground and the horizontal level with the top
0.60
of the escalator are parallel. Therefore,
cosF bc mDAB mABC since they are alternate
12 4
15 or 5
interior angles.
0.80 10
0
tanx°¬
240
tanF a
b x¬ tan1
240
10
0
9
12 or 3
4 x¬ 22.6
0.75 The angle of depression is about 22.6°.
sinG bc 28. A D
12 4
15 or 5 50 ft
x
0.80
C 1000 ft
B
cosG ac
9 3 Let x represent mABC.
15 or 5
0.60 The ground and the horizontal level with the
b initial point of the balloon are parallel. Therefore,
tanG ¬a
mDAB mABC since they are alternate
12 4
¬ 9 or 3 interior angles.
¬1.33 tanx°¬ 50
1000
22. sinF ac cosF bc tanF¬¬a
7
24
b
7
¬ 24
x¬ tan1 50
1000
25 25 x¬ 2.9
0.28 0.96 ¬0.29
The angle of depression is about 2.9°.
sinG bc cosG ac b
tanG ¬a
29. A
24 7 24
25 25 ¬
7
0.96 0.28 ¬3.43
23. sinP 0.4522
30 yd
P sin1(0.4522)
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [SIN1] 0.4522 ENTER
mP 26.9
24. cosQ 0.1673 44
Q cos1(0.1673) C x B
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [COS1] 0.1673 ENTER
mQ 80.4 Let x represent the length of the shadow of the
building, BC.
25. tanR 0.9324 30
R tan1(0.9324) tan44°¬ x
KEYSTROKES: 2nd [TAN1] 0.9324 ENTER xtan44°¬ 30
mR 43.0 30
x¬
tan44°
x¬ 31.1
The shadow is about 31.1 yards long.
233 Chapter 7
sin
A sin B
30. C 35. a ¬ b
30 ft sin 2
9° sin
B
x
4.8 ¬ 8.7
A 400 ft B 8.7sin29°¬ 4.8sin B
Let x represent mCAB. 8.7si
n 29°
4.8 ¬ sinB
3
0
tanx°¬ 400
x¬ tan1 3
0
sin1 8.7s i
¬ B
4.8
n 29°
400 61°¬ B
x¬ 4.3
mA mB mC 180
The angle of elevation of the track is about 4.3°.
29 61 mC 180
sin
F sin
G mC 90
31. f ¬ g
C
sin sin A
c ¬ a
sin 82°
sin 4
8°
f ¬ 16
sin 90°
sin 29°
16sin82°¬ fsin48° c¬
4.8
16 sin
82° 4.8sin90°¬ csin29°
sin 48° ¬ f
4.8 si
n 90°
21.3¬ f sin 29° ¬ c
H
sin sin
G 9.9¬ c
32. h ¬ g
sin
H sin 65° 36. mA mB mC 180
10.5 ¬ 13 29 64 mC 180
13sinH¬ 10.5sin65° mC 87
10.5 si
n65° sin
A sin
B
sinH¬ a ¬ b
13
sin 29° sin 6 4°
10.5 si
H¬ sin1 13
n65°
a¬
18.5
18.5sin29°¬ asin64°
H¬ 47°
18.5 si
n 29°
sin
A B
sin sin 64° ¬ a
33. a ¬ b 10.0¬ a
sin 6
4° sin
B sinB sin C
15 ¬ 11
b ¬ c
11sin64°¬ 15sinB sin 6
¬ 4° sin 87°
11sin64° 18.5 c
¬ sinB csin64°¬ 18.5sin87°
15
sin1 11sin 64°
¬ B
15 18.5 si
c¬ n 87°
sin 64°
41°¬ B c¬ 20.6
mA mB mC 180 37. z2¬ x2 y2 2xycosZ
64 41 mC 180 z2¬ 7.62 5.42 2(7.6)(5.4)cos51°
mC 75 z2¬ 86.92 82.08cos51°
sin C
c¬ asin A z¬ 86.92
08cos
82.51°
sin 75° sin 64° z¬ 5.9
c¬
15 38. y2¬ x2 z2 2xzcosY
15sin75°¬ csin64° y2¬ 212 162 2(21)(16)cos73°
15 sin
75° y2¬ 697 672cos73°
sin 64° ¬ c
y¬ 697
s73°
672co
16.1¬ c
sinC sinA
y¬ 22.4
34.
c ¬ a 39. a2¬ b2 c2 2bccosA
sin 6
7° sin 55°
a2¬ 132 182 2(13)(18)cos64°
12 ¬ a
asin67°¬ 12sin55° a2¬ 493 468cos64°
12 sin
55° a¬ 493
s64°
468co
a¬ sin 67° a¬ 17.0
A
sin sin B
a ¬ b
a¬ 10.7
mA mB mC¬ 180 sin 64° sin
B
55 mB 67¬ 180 17 ¬ 13
mB¬ 58 13sin64°¬ 17sinB
sin B sin
b ¬ c C 13sin
64°
17 ¬ sinB
sin 58°
sin 6
b¬ 12
7°
sin1 13sin 64°
¬ B
17
12sin58°¬ bsin67° 43°¬ B
12 sin
58° mA mB mC 180
sin 67° ¬ b
11.1¬ b 64 43 mC 180
mC 73
Chapter 7 234
B
sin sin C
40. b ¬ c 10. 19 x2
sin
B sin 5
3° 19
x
5.2 ¬ 6.7 2
6.7sin B¬ 5.2sin53° 19
2
x
5.2si
n 53°
2 2
sinB¬ 6.7 192
2 x
B¬ sin1
5.2si
n 53°
6.7 yx
B¬ 38° 192
y
2
mA mB mC¬ 180
11. This is a 30°-60°-90° triangle with hypotenuse of
mA 38 53¬ 180
length 12, shorter leg with length of y and longer
mA¬ 89
A
sin B
sin leg with length of x.
a ¬ b 12 2y
sin 89° sin 38°
a¬
5.2 6y
5.2sin89°¬ asin38° x y3
5.2 si
n 89° x 63
sin 38° ¬ a 12. x2 82 162
8.4¬ a
x2 64 256
x2 192
x 192
Chapter 7 Practice Test x 83
8
siny°
16
Page 397 y sin18
16
1. 2abcosC
c2 a2 b2 y 30
2. Yes; two perfect squares can be written as a a BC
13. cosB
and b b. Multiplied together, we have a a b b. AB
15
5
Taking the square root, we have ab, which is
21 7
rational. BC
14. tanA
3. Sample answer: 2, 23 , 4 AC
15
4. Let x represent the geometric mean.
16
7 x
x
63 BC
15. sinA
AB
x2 441 15
5
x 441 or 21 21 7
5. Let x represent the geometric mean. sin
F sin G
16. f ¬ g
6 x
x
24 sin 5
9° sin 71°
x 144
2 13 ¬ g
x 144 or 12 gsin59°¬ 13sin71°
13 sin
71°
6. Let x represent the geometric mean. g¬ sin 59°
10 x
x
50 g¬ 14.3
x2 500 sinF sin H
f¬ ¬h
17.
x 500 or 105
sin 5 2° sin
H
7. x 5 ¬ 6
2 2 2
10
¬
12.5
x2 25¬ 36 12.5sin52° ¬10sinH
x2¬ 11 12.5 si
n52°
¬sinH
x¬ 11 10
x¬ 3.32 sin1
12.5 si
10
¬H
n52°
235 Chapter 7
20. c2¬ a2 b2 2abcosC since they are alternate interior angles.
c2¬ 152 172 2(15)(17)cos45° Let x represent CD, the horizontal distance to the
c2¬ 514 510cos45° city.
c¬ 514
s45°
510co 0.5
tan9°¬ x
c¬ 12.4 xtan9°¬ 0.5
C
sin sin
A
c ¬ a x¬ 0.5
sin 4 5° sin
A tan 9°
12.4 ¬ 15 x¬ 3.2
15sin45°¬ 12.4sinA The horizontal distance to the city is about
15 sin45° 3.2 miles.
12.4 ¬ sinA
24.
sin1 12.4 ¬ A
15 sin45° C
x
59°¬ A 10
A
mA mB mC¬ 180 5 mi B
59 mB 45¬ 180
Let x represent CB, the height of the incline.
mB¬ 76
A
sin sinB tan10°¬ 5x
21.
a ¬ b 5tan10°¬ x
sin
A sin 4
8°
12.2 ¬ 10.9 0.9¬ x
10.9 sin A¬ 12.2sin48° The height of the incline is about 0.9 mile.
12.2 si
sinA¬ n 48° 25. D; Let y represent the unknown side length in the
10.9 triangle.
A¬ sin1
12.2 si
10.9
n 48°
52 y2¬ 132
A¬ 56° 25 y2¬ 169
mA mB mC¬ 180 y2¬ 144
56 48 mC¬ 180 y¬ 144
mC¬ 76 y¬ 12
12
sin
C sin B tanX¬
c ¬ b
5
sin 76°
sin 48°
c¬
10.9
10.9sin76°¬ csin48°
10.9 si
n 76° Chapter 7 Standardized Test Practice
sin 48° ¬ c
14.2¬ c Pages 398–399
22. a2¬ b2 c2 2bccosA 1. C; there is no information to support choices A, B,
192¬ 23.22 212 2(23.2)(21)cos A or D. 1 and 4 are vertical angles, and 2 and
361¬ 979.24 974.4cos A 3 are vertical angles.
618.24¬ 974.4cos A 2. D; AD¬ CD
618
.24
974.4 ¬ cosA 3x 5¬ 5x 1
A¬ cos1974.4
618
.24 5¬ 2x 1
6¬ 2x
A¬ 51°
sinA sin B 3¬ x
a ¬ b AC AD CD
sin 5
1° sin
B AC 3x 5 5x 1
19 ¬ 23.2
23.2sin51°¬ 19sinB AC 3(3) 5 5(3) 1
23.2 si
n51° AC 28
¬ sinB
19 SR PT
3. B;
DC AE
sin
1 23.2 ¬ B
sin51°
S R 6
19 8
11
72°¬ B
mA mB mC¬ 180 11(SR) 48
48 4
51 72 mC¬ 180 SR
11 or 4 11
mC¬ 57 A B A C
4. C;
AC ¬ AD
23. 12
3 AC
A B
AC ¬
12
9
(AC)2¬ 180
0.5 mi
AC¬ 180
AC¬ 13.4
5. B; mRTS 180 135 or 45.
C x D RT (ST)2
52
The ground and the horizontal level with the
plane are parallel. Therefore, mBAD mADC
Chapter 7 236
6. D; the height of the original tower is AB BC. 10. y y1¬ m(x x1)
60
sin36°¬
BC y 32¬ 9
5 (x 0)
BCsin36°¬ 60 y¬ 9
5 x 32
60
BC¬ sin 36° YZ XZ
BC¬ 102
11.
UV
TV
6
AB BC¬ 60 102 or 162 feet. 10 or 3
5
sin
R sin S
7. C; r ¬ s 12. Let x represent Dee’s height above the water.
x
sin 3
4° sin
S sin41°¬ 50
14 ¬ 21 0
21sin34°¬ 14sinS 500sin41°¬ x
21sin34° 328¬ x
¬ sinS
14 Dee is about 328 feet above the water.
sin1
21s ¬ S
in
14
34°
13. Since Sasha is equidistant from Toby and Rani,
57°¬ S T
S and SR are congruent and STR is an
isosceles triangle. According to the Isosceles
8. mC mBDC mDBC¬ 180
Triangle Theorem, T and R are also
90 mBDC 55¬ 180
congruent. S X is perpendicular to T
R
, so SXT
mBDC¬ 35
and SXR are both right angles and congruent.
mADB mBDC¬ mADC
Two corresponding angles and the corresponding
mADB 35¬ 61
nonincluded sides are congruent (AAS Theorem),
mADB¬ 26
so STX and SRX are congruent triangles.
mA mABD mADB 180
Since these triangles are congruent, the
69 mABD 26 180
corresponding sides T X
and R
X are congruent and
mABD 85
mABC mABD mDBC have equal length; therefore when Sasha is
85 55 jumping at Point X she will be at the midpoint
140 between Toby and Rani.
y y
9. m
x
2
x
1
2 1
50 32
10 0
18 9
10 or 5
237 Chapter 7
Chapter 8 Quadrilaterals
y y
Page 403 Getting Started 9. The slope is given by m
2
1
.
x2 x1
1. The angles measuring x° and 50° are 0
a
m
b0
supplementary. Find x.
mx 50 180 a
b
mx 130
The slope is a
b.
So, x is 130.
y2 y1
2. x° is the measure of the exterior angle of the 10. The slope is given by m .
x2 x1
triangle so its measure is the sum of the two ac
m ¬
c (a)
remote interior angles or 25 20. So, x 45.
ac
3. The measure of an internal angle of an ¬
c a
equilateral triangle is 60. The angle measuring x° a c
¬
a c or 1
is supplementary to one of the angles. Find x.
mx 60 180 The slope is 1.
mx 120
So, x is 120.
y y
4. The slope is given by m
2
1
. 8-1
x2 x1 Angles of Polygons
10 3 7
S
R:
1 4 ¬ 5
10
20 1
0
S
T:
1 13 ¬ 14
Page 406 Geometry Activity: Sum of the
¬5
Exterior Angles of a Polygon
7
S
R and T
S are perpendicular since their slopes 1. sum of
number of
are opposite inverses. measure of
Polygon exterior
y y exterior
5. The slope is given by m
2
1
. angles angles
x2 x1
8
6 2 triangle 3 360
S
R :
3 (9) 12
quadrilateral 4 360
1
6
8
20 12 pentagon 5 360
S
T: 31 2
hexagon 6 360
6
S
R and T
S
are perpendicular since their slopes heptagon 7 360
are opposite inverses.
2. The sum of the measures of the exterior angles is
y y
6. The slope is given by m
2
1
. 360.
x2 x1
3 (
1) 4
S
R:
5 (6) 11
5 3 2
S
T:
2 5 3 Page 407 Check for Understanding
RS and T
S are not perpendicular since their 1. A concave polygon has at least one obtuse angle,
slopes are not opposite inverses. which means the sum will be different from the
y y formula.
7. The slope is given by m
2
1
.
x2 x1 2. Yes; an irregular polygon can be separated by the
84 4
S
R: (6) 3
3 diagonals into triangles so the theorems apply.
82 6 3. Sample answer:
S
T : 5 8
3
regular quadrilateral:
3
4
S
R and TS
are perpendicular since their slopes
are opposite inverses.
y y
8. The slope is given by m
2
1
. The sum of the interior angles is 360°.
x2 x1
d d2
m quadrilateral that is not regular:
c 2c
d
2
32c
3d
c
The slope is 3d
c.
The sum of the interior angles is 360°.
Chapter 8 238
4. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem. 10. The sum of the measures of the exterior angles is
S 180(n2) 360. There are 6 congruent exterior angles.
180(5 2) 6n 360
540 n 60
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of The measure of each exterior angle is 60. Since
a pentagon is 540. each exterior angle and its corresponding interior
5. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem. angle form a linear pair, the measure of the
S 180(n 2) interior angle is 180 60 or 120.
180(12 2) 11. The sum of the measures of the exterior angles is
1800 360. There are 18 congruent exterior angles.
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of 18n 360
a dodecagon is 1800. n 20
6. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an The measure of each exterior angle is 20. Since
equation to solve for n, the number of sides. each exterior angle and its corresponding interior
S ¬180(n 2) angle form a linear pair, the measure of the
(60)n ¬180(n 2) interior angle is 180 20 or 160.
60n ¬180n 360 12. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
0 ¬120n 360 S 180(n 2)
360 ¬120n 180(5 2)
3 ¬n 540
The polygon has 3 sides. The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
7. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an the base of the fish tank is 540.
equation to solve for n, the number of sides.
S ¬180(n 2)
(90)n ¬180(n 2) Pages 407–409 Practice and Apply
90n ¬180n 360 13. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
0 ¬90n 360 S 180(n 2)
360 ¬90n 180(32 2)
4 ¬n 5400
The polygon has 4 sides. The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
8. Since n 4, the sum of the measures of the a 32-gon is 5400.
interior angles is 180(4 2) or 360. Write an 14. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
equation to express the sum of the measures of S 180(n 2)
the interior angles of the polygon. 180(18 2)
360 mT mU mV mW 2880
360 x (3x 4) x (3x 4) The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
360 8x 8 an 18-gon is 2880.
368 8x 15. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
46 x S 180(n 2)
Use the value of x to find the measure of each 180(19 2)
angle. 3060
mT 46, mU 3 46 8 or 134, mV 46, The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
and mW 3 46 8 or 134. a 19-gon is 3060.
9. Since n 6, the sum of the measures of the 16. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
interior angles is 180(6 2) or 720. Write an S 180(n 2)
equation to express the sum of the measures of 180(27 2)
the interior angles of the polygon. 4500
720 mJ mK mL mM mN The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
mP a 27-gon is 4500.
720 2x (9x 30) (9x 30) 2x
17. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
(9x 30) (9x 30)
S 180(n 2)
720 40x 120
180(4y 2)
600 40x
720y 360
15 x
360(2y 1)
Use the value of x to find the measure of each
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
angle.
a 4y-gon is 360(2y 1).
mJ 30, mK 9 15 30 or 165,
mL 9 15 30 or 165, mM 30, 18. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
mN 9 15 30 or 165, and mP 9 15 30 S 180(n 2)
or 165. 180(2x 2)
360(x 1)
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
a 2x-gon is 360(x 1).
239 Chapter 8
19. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem. 26. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an
S 180(n 2) equation to solve for n, the number of sides.
180(8 2) S ¬180(n 2)
1080 (176.4)n ¬180(n 2)
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of 176.4n ¬180n 360
the octagonal garden is 1080. 0 ¬3.6n 360
20. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem. 360 ¬3.6n
S 180(n 2) 100 ¬n
180(6 2) The polygon has 100 sides.
720 27. Since n 4, the sum of the measures of the
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of interior angles is 180(4 2) or 360. Write an
the hexagonal gazebos is 720. equation to express the sum of the measures of
21. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an the interior angles of the polygon.
equation to solve for n, the number of sides. 360 mM mP mQ mR
S ¬180(n 2) 360 x 4x 2x 5x
(140)n ¬180(n 2) 360 12x
140n ¬180n 360 30 x
0 ¬40n 360 Use the value of x to find the measure of each
360 ¬40n angle.
9 ¬n mM 30, mP 4 30 or 120, mQ 2 30
The polygon has 9 sides. or 60, and mR 5 30 or 150.
22. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an 28. Since n 5, the sum of the measures of the
equation to solve for n, the number of sides. interior angles is 180(5 2) or 540. Write an
S ¬180(n 2) equation to express the sum of the measures of
(170)n ¬180(n 2) the interior angles of the polygon.
170n ¬180n 360 540 mE mF mG mH mJ
0 ¬10n 360 540 x (x 20) (x 5) (x 5) (x 10)
360 ¬10n 540 5x 30
36 ¬n 510 5x
The polygon has 36 sides. 102 x
23. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an Use the value of x to find the measure of each
equation to solve for n, the number of sides. angle.
S ¬180(n 2) mE 102, mF 102 20 or 122,
(160)n ¬180(n 2) mG 102 5 or 107, mH 102 5 or 97,
160n ¬180n 360 and mJ 102 10 or 112.
0 ¬20n 360 29. Since n 4, the sum of the measures of the
360 ¬20n interior angles is 180(4 2) or 360. Since a
18 ¬n parallelogram has congruent opposite angles, the
The polygon has 18 sides. measures of angles M and P are equal, and the
24. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an measures of angles N and Q are equal. Write an
equation to solve for n, the number of sides. equation to express the sum of the measures of
S ¬180(n 2) the interior angles of the parallelogram.
(165)n ¬180(n 2) 360 mM mN mP mQ
165n ¬180n 360 360 10x 20x 10x 20x
0 ¬15n 360 360 60x
360 ¬15n 6x
24 ¬n Use the value of x to find the measure of each
The polygon has 24 sides. angle.
25. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an mM 10 6 or 60, mN 20 6 or 120,
equation to solve for n, the number of sides. mP 10 6 or 60, and mQ 20 6 or 120.
S ¬180(n 2) 30. Since n 4, the sum of the measures of the
(157.5)n ¬180(n 2) interior angles is 180(4 2) or 360. Write an
157.5n ¬180n 360 equation to express the sum of the measures of
0 ¬22.5n 360 the interior angles of the isosceles trapezoid.
360 ¬22.5n 360 mT mW mY mZ
16 ¬n 360 20x 20x 30x 30x
The polygon has 16 sides. 360 100x
3.6 x
Use the value of x to find the measure of each
angle.
mT 20 3.6 or 72, mW 20 3.6 or 72,
mY 30 3.6 or 108, and mZ 30 3.6 or 108.
Chapter 8 240
31. Since n 10, the sum of the measures of the 37. The sum of the measures of the exterior angles is
interior angles is 180(10 2) or 1440. The sum of 360. A regular nonagon has 9 congruent exterior
the given measures is 10x 440. Find x. angles.
1440 10x 440 9n 360
1000 10x n 40
100 x The measure of each exterior angle is 40. Since
The measures of the interior angles of the each exterior angle and its corresponding interior
decagon are 105, 110, 120, 130, 135, 140, 160, 170, angle form a linear pair, the measure of the
180, and 190. interior angle is 180 40 or 140.
32. Since n 5, the sum of the measures of the 38. The sum of the measures of the exterior angles is
interior angles is 180(5 2) or 540. Write an 360. A regular octagon has 8 congruent exterior
equation to express the sum of the measures of angles.
the interior angles of the polygon. 8n 360
540 mA mB mC mD mE n 45
540 6x (4x 13) (x 9) (2x 8) (4x 1) The measure of each exterior angle is 45. Since
540 17x 13 each exterior angle and its corresponding interior
527 17x angle form a linear pair, the measure of the
31 x interior angle is 180 45 or 135.
Use the value of x to find the measure of each 39. Since n 11, the sum of the measures of the
angle. interior angles is 180(11 2) or 1620. A regular
mA 6 31 or 186, mB 4 31 13 or 137, 11-gon has 11 congruent interior angles. Let the
mC 31 9 or 40, mD 2 31 8 or 54, and measure of one of these angles be x.
mE 4 31 1 or 123. 1620 11x
33. Sample answer: Since n 4, the sum of the 147.3 x
measures of the interior angles is 180(4 2) or To the nearest tenth, the measure of each interior
360. Write an equation to express the sum of the angle of the 11-gon is 147.3. Since each interior
measures of the interior angles of the quadrilateral. angle and its corresponding exterior angle form a
360 x 2x 3x 4x linear pair, the measure of the exterior angle is
360 10x about 180 147.3 or 32.7.
36 x 40. Since n 7, the sum of the measures of the
The measures of the interior angles of the interior angles is 180(7 2) or 900. A regular
quadrilateral are 36, 2 36 or 72, 3 36 or 108, 7-gon has 7 congruent interior angles. Let the
and 4 36 or 144. measure of one of these angles be x.
34. Since n 4, the sum of the measures of the 900 7x
interior angles is 180(4 2) or 360. Write an 128.6 x
equation to express the sum of the measures of To the nearest tenth, the measure of each interior
the interior angles of the quadrilateral. angle of the 7-gon is 128.6. Since each interior
360 x (x 10) (x 20) (x 30) angle and its corresponding exterior angle form a
360 4x 60 linear pair, the measure of the exterior angle is
300 4x about 180 128.6 or 51.4.
75 x 41. Since n 12, the sum of the measures of the
The measures of the interior angles of the interior angles is 180(12 2) or 1800. A regular
quadrilateral are 75, 75 10 or 85, 75 20 or 95, 12-gon has 12 congruent interior angles. Let the
and 75 30 or 105. measure of one of these angles be x.
35. The sum of the measures of the exterior angles is 1800 12x
360. A regular decagon has 10 congruent exterior 150 x
angles. The measure of each interior angle of the 12-gon
10n 360 is 150. Since each interior angle and its
n 36 corresponding exterior angle form a linear pair,
The measure of each exterior angle is 36. Since the measure of the exterior angle is about 180
each exterior angle and its corresponding interior 150 or 30.
angle form a linear pair, the measure of the 42. Consider the sum of the measures of the exterior
interior angle is 180 36 or 144. angles, N, for an n-gon.
36. The sum of the measures of the exterior angles is N sum of measures of linear pairs sum of
360. A regular hexagon has 6 congruent exterior measures of interior angles
angles. 180n 180(n 2)
6n 360 180n 180n 360
n 60 360
The measure of each exterior angle is 60. Since So, the sum of the exterior angle measures is 360
each exterior angle and its corresponding interior for any convex polygon.
angle form a linear pair, the measure of the
interior angle is 180 60 or 120.
241 Chapter 8
9y
43. Since n 5, the sum of the measures of the 48. Since 9, y 2x. Substitute this result into
2x
interior angles is 180(5 2) or 540. A regular
pentagon has 5 congruent interior angles. Let the the other equation relating x and y. Then solve
measure of one of these angles be x. for x.
540 5x 6x 3y ¬48
108 x 6x 3(2x) ¬48
The measure of each interior angle of the 6x 6x ¬48
Pentagon is 108. Since each interior angle and its 12x ¬48
corresponding exterior angle form a linear pair, x ¬4
the measure of the exterior angle is 180 108
or 72.
44. Yes; both the dome and the architectural elements Page 409 Maintain Your Skills
are based upon a regular octagon.
49. Use the Law of Cosines to find mC since the
Since n 8, the sum of the measures of the
measures of all three sides are known.
interior angles is 180(8 2) or 1080. A regular
c2 ¬a2 b2 2ab cosC
octagon has 8 congruent interior angles. Let the
measure of one of these angles be x. 112 ¬62 92 2(6)(9)cos C
1080 8x 121 ¬36 81 108 cosC
135 x 4 ¬108 cosC
4
The measure of each interior angle is 135. Since
108 ¬cosC
each interior angle and its corresponding exterior C ¬cos11
27
angle form a linear pair, the measure of the
exterior angle is about 180 135 or 45. C ¬92.1
180(n 2) 180n 360 To the nearest tenth, the measure of angle C is
45. n
n 92.1.
n
180 360
n n 50. Use the Law of Cosines to find mB since the
360 measures of all three sides are known.
180 n
The two formulas are equivalent. b2 ¬a2 c2 2ac cos B
23.62 ¬15.52 25.12 2(15.5)(25.1)cos B
46. Sample answer: The outline of a scallop shell is 556.96 ¬240.25 630.01 778.1 cos B
a convex polygon that is not regular. The lines
313.3 ¬778.1 cos B
in the shell resemble diagonals drawn from one
31
3.3
778.1 ¬cos B
vertex of a polygon. These diagonals separate the
polygon into triangles. Answers should include
the following.
B ¬cos1
313
.3
778.1
• The Interior Angle Sum Theorem is derived B ¬66.3
from the pattern between the number of sides To the nearest tenth, the measure of angle B is
in a polygon and the number of triangles. The 66.3.
formula is the product of the sum of the
measures of the angles in a triangle, 180, and 51. Use the Law of Cosines to find mA since the
the number of triangles the polygon contains. measures of all three sides are known.
a2 ¬b2 c2 2ab cos A
• The exterior angle and the interior angle of a
polygon are a linear pair. So, the measure of an 472 ¬532 562 2(53)(56) cos A
exterior angle is the difference between 180 and 2209 ¬2809 3136 5936 cos A
the measure of the interior angle. 3736 ¬5936 cos A
37
36
5936 ¬cos A
47. B; since the unknown polygon is regular, its
interior angles are congruent. The sum of the
measures of the interior angles of the square,
A ¬cos1
46
7
742
pentagon, and unknown regular polygon is 360. A ¬51.0
Let the measure of each interior angle of the To the nearest tenth, the measure of angle A
unknown polygon be x. Find x using the fact that is 51.0.
the measures of the interior angles of squares and
52. Use the Law of Cosines to find mC since the
regular pentagons are 90 and 108, respectively.
measures of all three sides are known.
360 x 90 108
162 x c2 ¬a2 b2 2ab cos C
The sum of the measures of the interior angles is 162 ¬122 142 2(12)(14)cos C
given by S 180(n 2), the Interior Angle Sum 256 ¬144 196 336 cos C
Theorem. This is equal to 162n, where, in both 84 ¬336 cos C
cases, n is the number of sides. Solve for n. 84
36 ¬cos C
3
162n ¬180(n 2)
162n ¬180n 360 C ¬cos1 1
4
0 ¬18n 360 C ¬75.5
360 ¬18n To the nearest tenth, the measure of angle C is
20 ¬n 75.5.
The polygon has 20 sides.
Chapter 8 242
53. Use the Law of Sines since we know the measures 56. Use the Law of Sines since we know the measures
of two sides and an angle opposite one of the of two sides and an angle opposite one of the
sides. sides.
sinH sinG
h ¬ g
G
sin sinF
g ¬ f
sinH sin 65°
32.4 ¬ 30.7
sin
G sin 54°
17 ¬ 15
32.4 si
n 65°
17sin
sin G ¬ 54° sin H ¬ 30.7
15
G ¬sin1 17sin
15
54°
H ¬sin1
32.4 si
30.7
n 65°
G ¬66° H ¬73°
Use the Angle Sum Theorem to find mH. Use the Angle Sum Theorem to find mF.
mF mG mH ¬180 mF mG mH ¬180
54 66 mH ¬180 mF 65 73 ¬180
mH ¬60 mF ¬42
Use the Law of Sines to find h. Use the Law of Sines to find f.
F
sin H
sin
f ¬ h
sinG sin F
g ¬ f
sin 5 4° sin 60°
15 ¬ h
sin 6 5° sin 42°
30.7 ¬ f
15 sin
60°
h ¬ 30 .7 si
n 42°
sin 54° f ¬ sin 65°
h ¬16.1
f ¬22.7
Therefore, mG 66, mH 60, and h 16.1.
Therefore, mH 73, mF 42, and f 22.7.
54. Use the Angle Sum Theorem to find mG.
mF mG mH ¬180 L
57. Given: J K
M
, J
K
L
M
47 mG 78 ¬180 Prove: JKL MLK
mG ¬55 J K
Use the Law of Sines to find f and h.
sinG sin F
g ¬f
sin 55° sin 47° L M
31 ¬ f
31 sin
47° Proof:
f ¬sin 55° Statements Reasons
f ¬27.7
1. K
JL M
, J
K
L
M
1. Given
sinG sin H
g ¬h 2. MKL JLK, 2. Alt. int. are .
sin 55° sin 78° JKL MLK
31 ¬ h
31 sin
78°
L
3. K KL
3. Reflexive Property
h ¬sin 55° 4. JKL MLK 4. ASA
h ¬37.0 58. Line b is the transversal that forms 3 and 11
Therefore, mG 55, f 27.7, and h 37.0. where it intersects lines m and n. 3 and 11 are
55. Use the Angle Sum Theorem to find mF. corresponding angles.
mF mG mH ¬180 59. Line m is the transversal that forms 6 and 7
mF 56 67 ¬180 where it intersects lines b and c. 6 and 7 are
mF ¬57 consecutive interior angles.
Use the Law of Sines to find f and h. 60. Line c is the transversal that forms 8 and 10
sinG sin F
g ¬f where it intersects lines m and n. 8 and 10 are
sin 56° sin 57° alternate interior angles.
63 ¬ f
61. Line n is the transversal that forms 12 and 16
63 sin 57°
f ¬
sin 56 ° where it intersects lines b and c. 12 and 16 are
alternate exterior angles.
f ¬63.7
62. 1 and 4, 1 and 2, 2 and 3, and 3 and
sinG sin H
g ¬h 4 are consecutive interior angles.
sin 56° sin67° 63. 3 and 5, and 2 and 6 are alternate interior
63 ¬ h
angles.
63 sin
67°
h ¬sin 56° 64. 1 and 5, and 4 and 6 are corresponding
h ¬70.0 angles.
Therefore, mF 57, f 63.7, and h 70.0. 65. None; there are no pairs of alternate exterior
angles.
243 Chapter 8
Page 410 Spreadsheet Investigation: Angles of 6. Since consecutive angles in parallelograms are
Polygons supplementary, TSR is supplementary to STQ
1. For a regular polygon, the measure of each and SRQ.
interior angle in the polygon can be found by 7. MJK KLM because opposite angles in a
dividing the sum of the measures of the interior parallelogram are congruent. Find mKLM.
angles by the number of sides of the polygon. mKLM mKLR mMLR
So, the formula to find the measure of each 70 30 100
interior angle in the polygon is “C2/A2”. So, mMJK 100.
2. For a regular polygon, the sum of the measures of 8. Consecutive angles in a parallelogram are
the exterior angles of the polygon can be found by supplementary. So, mJML 180 mKLM.
multiplying the number of sides by the measure mJML 180 100 or 80.
of the exterior angles. So, the formula to find the 9. Consecutive angles in a parallelogram are
sum of the measures of the exterior angles of the supplementary. So, mJKL 180 mKLM.
polygon is “A2*E2”. mJKL 180 100 or 80.
3. The formula for the sum of the measures of the 10. KJL JLM because they are alternate
interior angles is “(A2-2)*180”, which gives interior angles. The measure of JLM is 30. So,
180 for 1 side and 0 for 2 sides. mKJL 30.
4. No, a polygon is a closed figure formed by 11. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent,
coplanar segments. so their measures are equal.
Find a.
5. A 15-sided polygon has 13 triangles.
JM ¬KL
6. The measure of the exterior angle of a 15-sided 3a ¬21
polygon is 24. a ¬7
7. The measure of the interior angle of a 110-sided 12. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent,
polygon is about 176.7. so their measures are equal. Find b.
8. Each interior angle measures 180. This is not JK ¬ML
possible for a polygon. 2b 3 ¬45
2b ¬42
b ¬21
13. Given: VZRQ and WQST
8-2 Parallelograms Prove: Z T
Q
R
Pages 411–412 Geometry Activity: Properties of S
Parallelograms W
1.
FGH J
P Q
R S and F
J
G HP S
Q R
. T
2. F P H R and J G Q S. V
Z
3. Opposite angles are congruent; consecutive angles
Proof:
are supplementary.
Statements Reasons
1. VZRQ and 1. Given
Page 414 Check for Understanding WQST
1. Opposite sides are congruent; opposite angles are 2. Z Q, 2. Opp. of a are
congruent; consecutive angles are supplementary; Q T .
and if there is one right angle, there are four right 3. Z T 3. Transitive Prop.
angles.
14. Given: XYRZ, WZ
W
S
2. Diagonals bisect each other; each diagonal forms
Prove: XYR S
two congruent triangles in a parallelogram.
3. Sample answer: W
x X Y
2x
Z R S
4.
SVV Q because diagonals of parallelograms Proof: Opposite angles of a parallelogram are
bisect each other. congruent, so Z XYR. By the Isosceles
5. Since diagonals bisect each other and opposite Triangle Theorem, since WZ
W S, Z S. By
sides of parallelograms are congruent, VRS the Transitive Property, XYR S.
VTQ by SSS.
Chapter 8 244
J
15. C; G and H
K are the diagonals. Since the 30. The diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each
diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each other, the other, so MQ QP. Find w.
J
intersection point is the midpoint of G and H
K. MQ ¬QP
Find the intersection of the diagonals by finding 4w 3 ¬11.1
J
the midpoint of G . 4w ¬14.1
x1 x2 y1 y2 w ¬3.5
2, 2
3
2 ,
3
2
4 (5)
31. The diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each
(0, 0.5) other, so RQ QN. Find z.
The diagonals intersect at (0, 0.5). RQ ¬QN
3z 3 ¬15.4
3z ¬18.4
Pages 415–416 Practice and Apply z ¬6.1
16. DAB BCD because opposite angles of a
32. The diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each
parallelogram are congruent.
other, so EJ JG. Find x.
17. ABD CDB because alternate interior angles EJ ¬JG
are congruent. 2x 1 ¬3x
B
18. A DC
because opposite sides of a parallelogram 1 ¬x
are parallel. EG EJ JG
G
19. B G D
because the diagonals of a [2(1) 1] 3(1)
parallelogram bisect each other. 6
20. ABD CDB because the diagonal B D
33. The diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each
separates the parallelogram into two congruent other, so HJ JF. Find y.
triangles. HJ ¬JF
21. ACD BAC because alternate interior angles 1y 2 ¬y 1
2 2
are congruent.
2 1 1
2 ¬y 2 y
22. RNP NRM because they are alternate
interior angles. So, mRNP 38. Find mMNP. 5 ¬1 y
2 2
mMNP mMNR mRNP
5 ¬y
33 38
FH HJ JF
71
23. NRP MNR because they are alternate ¬ 1
1
2 (5) 2 5 2
interior angles. So, mNRP 33. ¬9
24. RNP MRN because they are alternate
34. Since the diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each
interior angles. So, mRNP 38.
other, the drawer pulls are at the intersection
25. RMN is supplementary to MNP. Find point of the diagonals.
mRMN.
35.
mRMN mMNP ¬180 A B
mRMN 71 ¬180 3a
2b
mRMN ¬109 18 a
26. MQN is supplementary to PQN. Find mMQN.
180 mMQN mPQN P
1
180 mMQN 83 3 b 12a
97 mMQN
27. MQR PQN because they are vertical angles. D C
So, mMQR 83. Since ABCD is a parallelogram, the diagonals
28. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent, bisect each other. So AC 2(AP)
so their measures are equal. Find x. AC 12a and AP 3a 18
MN ¬RP 12a ¬2(3a 18)
3x 4 ¬20 12a ¬6a 36
3x ¬24 6a ¬36
x ¬8 a ¬6
29. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent, DP PB
so their measures are equal. Find y. 3b 1 a 2b
NP ¬MR 3b 1 6 2b
2y 5 ¬17.9 b5
2y ¬12.9 DB 2(3b 1)
y ¬6.45 2(3 5 1)
2(16) 32
So, a 6, b 5, and DB 32.
245 Chapter 8
36. A 2x 5 B 40. They are all congruent parallelograms. Since A, B
2y and C are midpoints, A C
, A
B
, and BC
are
120
midsegments. The midsegment is parallel to the
21 third side and equal to half the length of the third
side. So, each pair of opposite sides of ACBX,
ABYC, and ABCZ are parallel.
41. Given: PQRS
Prove: P QR S
R
Q S P
D 21 C P Q
1 3
Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent, 2
4
B
so A C D
and AB CD. S R
Find x. Proof:
AB ¬CD Statements Reasons
2x 5 21
2x ¬16 1. PQRS 1. Given
x ¬8 2. Draw an auxiliary 2. Diagonal of PQRS
Consecutive angles in a parallelogram are segment P R
and
supplementary, so B is supplementary to label angles 1, 2, 3,
BAD and mBAD mCAD mBAC. and 4 as shown.
Find y. Q
3. P SR, P
S
Q R 3. Opp. sides of are .
mBAD mB ¬180 4. 1 2, and 4. Alt. int. are .
mCAD mBAC mB ¬180 3 4
21 2y 120 ¬180 R
5. P P R 5. Reflexive Prop.
2y ¬39
6. QPR SRP 6. ASA
y ¬19.5
Q
7. PR S and 7. CPCTC
37. The Distance Formula is
R
Q S P
d (x 2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2.
The diagonals bisect each other if EQ QG and 42. Given: GKLM
HQ QF. Prove: G and K are supplementary.
Find these measures. K and L are supplementary.
EQ (3 0) 2 (1 5)2 L and M are supplementary.
5 M and G are supplementary.
QG (6 3) 2 (3 1)2 G K
5
HQ (3 0) 2 [1 2
(1)]
M L
13
Proof:
QF (6 3) 2 (3 1)2
13 Statements Reasons
The diagonals do indeed bisect each other. 1. GKLM 1. Given
38. If EG FH, the diagonals are congruent. Use the K
2. GM
L
,
GMK
L
2. Opp. sides of
Distance Formula to find EG and FH. are .
d (x2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2 3. G and K are 3. Cons. int. are
EG (6 0) 2 (3 5)2 supplementary. suppl.
10 K and L are
FH (0 6) 2 (1 3)2 supplementary.
52 L and M are
2 13 supplementary.
M and G are
No, the diagonals are not congruent, since EG FH.
supplementary.
H
39. E is vertical, so its slope is undefined. Find the
F
slope of E .
y y
m ¬
2
1
x2 x1
3 5
¬
60
¬1
3
No, the consecutive sides are not perpendicular
because the slopes of the sides are not opposite
reciprocals of each other.
Chapter 8 246
43. Given: MNPQ 4. HFG and DJK 4. lines form four rt.
M is a right angle. are rt. . .
Prove: N, P and Q are right angles 5. HFG and DJK 5. Def. of rt.
M N are rt. s.
6. HFG DJK 6. HA
Q P
47. Given: BCGH, HDF
D
N
Proof: By definition of a parallelogram, M Q P.
Prove: F GCB
Since M is a right angle, M
QM N. By the
Perpendicular Transversal Theorem, M QQ P. H
B
Q is a right angle, because perpendicular lines
G
form a right angle. N Q and M P
because opposite angles in a parallelogram are D F
C
congruent. P and N are right angles, since all Proof:
right angles are congruent.
Statements Reasons
44. Given: ACDE is a parallelogram.
Prove: EC bisects A
D
. A
D
bisects E
C. 1. BCGH 1. Given
HDFD
A C
B 2. F H 2. Isosceles Triangle
Theorem
E D 3. H GCB 3. Opp. of are .
Proof: It is given that ACDE is a parallelogram.
4. F GCB 4. Congruence of angles
Since opposite sides of a parallelogram are is transitive.
congruent, E
AD C. By definition of a
parallelogram, EA
D C. AEB DCB and 48. MSR PST because they are vertical angles.
EAB CDB because alternate interior angles NMP MPQ because they are alternate
are congruent. EBA CBD by ASA. E BB C interior angles. So, MSR is similar to PST.
and AB
B D by CPCTC. By the definition of N
M Q P because opposite sides of a
C
segment bisector, E bisects A
D and AD bisects parallelogram are congruent. TP 1
2 QP is given,
C
E .
so TP 1
2 MN.
45. Given: WXYZ
M.
S
Prove: WXZ YZX Find
SP
MS MR
SP TP
W X
1
MN
4
1
Z Y MN
2
Proof:
1
2
Statements Reasons
The ratio of MS to SP is 1
2.
1. WXYZ 1. Given
49. Sample answer: The graphic uses the illustration
X
2. WZY
, W
Z
XY
2. Opp. sides of are . of wedges shaped like parallelograms to display
3. ZWX XYZ 3. Opp. of are . the data. Answers should include the following.
4. WXZ YZX 4. SAS • The opposite sides are parallel and congruent,
the opposite angles are congruent, and the
46. Given: DGHK is a parallelogram.
consecutive angles are supplementary.
H
FGD
• Sample answer:
J
D H
K
100
Prove: DJK HFG 79%
80
Use the Web
Percent That
G F D 60%
60
40 29%
H J K 20
Proof: 0
1998 1999 2000
Statements Reasons Year
1. DGHK is a 1. Given 50. Consecutive angles of a parallelogram are
parallelogram. supplementary. Find x
H
FG D, D
JH
K
(3x 42) (9x 18) ¬180
2. G K 2. Opp. of are . 12x 24 ¬180
H
3. G D K 3. Opp. sides of are . 12x ¬156
x ¬13
3(13) 42 81
9(13) 18 99
The measures of the angles are 81 and 99.
247 Chapter 8
51. B; the perimeter p is equal to the sum of the 57. Since the measures of two sides and an angle
measures of the sides. Find y. opposite one of the sides are known, use the
2x 2y ¬p Law of Sines.
y
2 2y ¬p C
sin sin
c ¬ b
B
5
2y 2y ¬p sin
C sin 57°
14 ¬ 12.5
5
12y 14 sin
57°
¬p sinC ¬ 12.5
5
5p
y ¬
12 C ¬sin1 12.5
14 sin
57°
mC ¬69.9
Use the Angle Sum Theorem.
Page 416 Maintain Your Skills mA mB mC ¬180
52. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem. mA 57 69.9 ¬180
S 180(n 2) mA ¬53.1
180(14 2) sinB A
sin
b ¬ a
2160
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of sin 57° sin53.1°
12.5 ¬
a
a 14-gon is 2160.
12.5 sin
53.1°
53. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem. a ¬ sin 57°
S 180(n 2) a ¬11.9
180(22 2)
58. Since the measures of two sides and the included
3600
angle are known, use the Law of Cosines.
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
c2 a2 b2 2ab cos C
a 22-gon is 3600.
c2 212 242 2(21)(24) cos 78°
54. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem. c ¬ 212 242 2(21)(24) cos
78°
S 180(n 2) c ¬28.4
180(17 2)
2700 a2 ¬b2 c2 2bc cos A
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of 212 ¬242 28.42 2(24)(28.4) cos A
a 17-gon is 2700. 941.56 ¬1363.2 cos A
941 .56
1363.2 ¬cos A
55. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
S 180(n 2)
941
.56
180(36 2) cos1
1363.2 ¬A
6120 46.3 ¬mA
The sum of the measures of the interior angles of
Use the Angle Sum Theorem.
a 36-gon is 6120.
mA mB mC ¬180
56. Since the measures of two sides and the included 46.3 mB 78 ¬180
angle are known, use the Law of Cosines. mB ¬55.7
a2 b2 c2 2bc cos A
59. The numbers of the outside diagonals are all ones,
a2 112 132 2(11)(13) cos 42°
so the first thirty numbers sum to 30.
a 112 132
2(11)(13) cos
42°
a 8.8 60. The second diagonal consists of the natural
numbers, 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, . . . , 70.
b2 ¬a2 c2 2ac cos B
The sum is 1 2 3 4 . . . 67 68 69 70
112 ¬8.82 132 2(8.8)(13) cos B
¬(1 70) (2 69) (3 68) . . . (35 + 36)
125.44 ¬2(8.8)(13) cos B
¬35(71)
125 .44
228.8 ¬cos B
¬2485
cos1228.8 ¬B
125
.44 The sum of the first 70 numbers is 2485.
56.8 ¬mB
Use the Angle Sum Theorem.
mA mB mC ¬180
42 56.8 mC ¬180
mC ¬81.2
Chapter 8 248
61. y 5. Opposite sides are parallel and congruent,
8 opposite angles are congruent, or consecutive
B 4 angles are supplementary.
E D
D
D
C is a side. Find the slope of C
D
.
y y
m
2
1
C
x2 x1
9 (2) B O x
1 2
7
3
If the opposite sides of a quadrilateral are
parallel, then it is a parallelogram.
y y
C
slope of B
2
1
8-3 x2 x1
Tests for Parallelograms 1
0
40
Parallelogram 4 5
E
slope of D 26
1. They appear to be parallel.
1
4
2. The quadrilaterals formed are parallelograms.
4
0
3. The measures of pairs of opposite sides are equal. E
slope of B 20
4. Opposite angles are congruent, and consecutive 2
5
1
angles are supplementary. D
slope of C64
2
249 Chapter 8
C
Since opposite sides have the same slope, B D
E
11. Given: P
TT
R
and BE
CD. Therefore, BCDE is a parallelogram TSP TQR
by definition. Prove: PQRS is a parallelogram.
9. Yes; P Q
y T
C S R
D Proof:
Statements Reasons
B 1.
PTT
R
, 1. Given
A O x TSP TQR
2. PTS RTQ 2. Vertical angles are
congruent.
First use the Distance Formula to determine 3. PTS RTQ 3. AAS
whether the opposite sides are congruent.
S
4. P Q
R 4. CPCTC
AD
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 S
5. P Q
R
5. If alternate interior
[6 (4)]2 (3 0)2 angles are congruent,
13 lines are parallel.
BC (1 3
)2 (4 1)2 6. PQRS is a 6. If one pair of opposite
parallelogram. sides is parallel and
13
congruent, then the
Since AD BC, A DB C
.
quadrilateral is a
Next, use the Slope Formula to determine
parallelogram.
whether AD B
C.
y y 12. If one pair of opposite sides is congruent and
D
slope of A
2
1
x2 x1 parallel, the quadrilateral is a parallelogram.
30
6 (4)
3
2 Pages 421–423 Practice and Apply
4
slope of B 11
C
3 13. Yes; each pair of opposite angles is congruent.
3 14. Yes; the diagonals bisect each other.
2
AD and BC have the same slope, so they are 15. Yes; opposite angles are congruent.
parallel. Since one pair of opposite sides is 16. No; none of the tests for parallelograms are
congruent and parallel, ABCD is a parallelogram. fulfilled.
10. No; 17. Yes; one pair of opposite sides is parallel and
y
congruent.
G 18. No; none of the tests for parallelograms are
H fulfilled.
19. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent.
x Find x and y.
O
2x ¬5x 18
F 18 ¬3x
E 6 ¬x
3y ¬96 y
If the midpoints of the diagonals are the same, 4y ¬96
the diagonals bisect each other. If the diagonals of y ¬24
a quadrilateral bisect each other, then the 20. Diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each other.
quadrilateral is a parallelogram. Find x and y.
Find the midpoints of EG and F
H. 2x 3 ¬5x
x x y y 3 (3) 3 ¬3x
G
E:
1
2 1 2 4 2
2, 2 ¬2, 2 1 ¬x
¬(1, 0) 4y ¬8y 36
x1 x2 y1 y2 4 (6) 1 2 36 ¬4y
H
F:
2, 2 ¬ 2, 2 9 ¬y
¬1, 1
2
The midpoints of EG
and F
H
differ, so EFGH is
not a parallelogram.
Chapter 8 250
21. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent. 25. Yes;
Find x and y. G y E
y 2x ¬4
y ¬2x 4
5y 2x ¬3y 2x
2y ¬4x O x
y ¬2x
Find x.
B C
2x ¬2x 4
4x ¬4 If the opposite sides of a quadrilateral are
x ¬1 parallel, then it is a parallelogram.
So, y 2(1) or 2. y y
C
slope of B
x
2
x
1
22. Since the opposite sides of a parallelogram are 2 1
parallel, there are two pairs of alternate interior 3 (3)
¬
2 (6)
angles formed by the diagonal of the
parallelogram. Find x and y. ¬0
4 4
25x ¬100 G
slope of E
4 4
x ¬4 ¬0
10y ¬40 4 (3)
G
slope of B
4 (6)
y ¬4
¬7
2
23. Since the opposite sides of a parallelogram are
4 (3)
parallel, there are two pairs of alternate interior E
slope of C
42
angles formed by the diagonal of the
parallelogram. Find y in terms of x. ¬7
2
1 y ¬x 12 C
Since opposite sides have the same slope, B EG
2 G
and B C E. Therefore, BCEG is a parallelogram
y ¬2x 24 by definition.
Opposite angles of a parallelogram are congruent. 26. No;
Find another equation for y in terms of x.
y
3y 4 ¬4x 8 8
S
3y ¬4x 4 4
y ¬4 4
3x 3
T R
A
If both pairs of opposite sides of a quadrilateral
are congruent, then the quadrilateral is a
251 Chapter 8
parallelogram. Use the Distance Formula to 30. No;
determine whether the opposite sides are y
congruent. 8
H
AD ¬ (x2
x1)2 (y2 y1)2 4
¬ [4 (5)]2 [2 2
(4)] J
¬ 37 O 4 8 x
BC ¬ (4 3
)2 [4 (2)]2 4 L
K
¬ 37 8
AB ¬ [3 (
5)]2
[2 2
(4)]
¬ 68 If both pairs of opposite sides of a quadrilateral
are congruent, then the quadrilateral is a
CD ¬ (4 4)2 (2 4
)2
parallelogram. Use the Distance Formula to
¬ 68 determine whether the opposite sides are
Since the measures of both pairs of opposite sides congruent.
are equal, ABCD is a parallelogram. HJ ¬ (x2
x1)2 (y2 y1)2
28. Yes; ¬ (9 5
) (0
2 6)2
y ¬ 52
KL ¬ (3 8
)2 [2 (5)]2
OY x
¬ 34
Z
Since HJ KL, H J
K L
. Therefore, HJKL is not
a parallelogram.
X 31. Yes;
W
S y T
x x y y
G 8 y : 2, 2 ¬
T
W 1
2 , 2
2 3
2 3
8 1 2
4 H ¬5
2, 2
11
V
The midpoints of S and W
T
are the same, so
STVW is a parallelogram.
4 O 4 8 12 x
J 32. Yes;
4
y
K
8 C
D
First use the Distance Formula to determine
whether the opposite sides are congruent. O x
GH ¬ (x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
¬
[4 (
2)]2
(4
8)2 G F
¬ 52
JK ¬ (1 6)2 [7 (3)]2 First use the Distance Formula to determine
whether the opposite sides are congruent.
¬ 65
CD ¬ (x2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2
Since GH JK, G H
J K. Therefore, GHJK is not
a parallelogram. ¬ [3 (7)]
2 (2
3)2
¬ 17
Chapter 8 252
FG ¬ (4 0)2
[3 (4)]2
slope of MR slope of N
P
¬ 17 8 y (1)
1 ¬ x (1)
Since CD FG, C DFG
. 8 y1
Next, use the Slope Formula to determine
1 ¬ x 1
whether CD
F G. Again, x 0 and y 9.
y2 y1 So, move P to (0, 9).
D
slope of C x2 x1
2 3 N
Move R: slope of M slope of P
R
¬
3 (7) y (4)
7
5 ¬ x (
2)
¬1
4
y4
7
5 ¬ x 2
3 (4)
G
slope of F ¬4 0
1
¬ 4
x 7 and y 3.
D
C and FG have the same slope, so they are R
slope of M slope of N
P
parallel. Since one pair of opposite sides is y6 3
x (6) ¬1
congruent and parallel, CDFG is a parallelogram. y6 3
33. y
x 6 ¬1
M
Again, x 7 and y 3.
So, move R to (7, 3).
34. y
Q
O x
S
N
R x
O
P
W
Sample answer: Hold N, P, and R fixed. Let M be T
N
M(x, y). Find the slopes of M and MR so that
they equal those of PR
and NP
, respectively.
N
slope of M slope of P
R Hold S, T, and W fixed. Let Q be Q(x, y). Find the
1 y 2 (4) S
slopes of Q and Q
W so that they equal those of
x ¬
1
5 (2) W
T and ST, respectively.
1y 2
1 x ¬
3 S
slope of Q slope of TW
1y 1 (2)
If x 4 and y 1, then M
N
P
R
.
4 x ¬
5 (1)
R
slope of M slope of N
P 1y 1
2 y 4 (1)
4 x ¬
4
x ¬
5
2 (1) 1y 1
2y
4 x ¬4
3
5 x ¬1 If x 0 and y 2, then Q
S
T
W
.
If x 4 and y 1, then M
RN P. W
slope of Q slope of ST
Move M to (4, 1) to make both pairs of opposite 1 y 2 1
x ¬
5
1 4
sides parallel. Then MNPR is a parallelogram. 1y 3
Perform the same process for the other vertices.
5 x ¬5
1y 3
Move N: slope of MN slope of P
R
5 x ¬5
y6 2
x (6) ¬
3 If x 0 and y 2, then Q
W
S T. Move Q to (0, 2)
y6 2 to make both pairs of opposite sides parallel. Then
x 6 ¬3 QSTW is a parallelogram.
x 3 and y 4. Perform the same process for the other vertices.
R
slope of M slope of N
P
S
Move S: slope of Q slope of T
W
2 6 4 y y3 1
(6) ¬
5 2
x
x (3) ¬4
4 y y3 1
3 ¬4
8
1 ¬ 2 x
x
Again, x 3 and y 4. x 1 and y 2.
So, move N to (3, 4). W
slope of Q slope of S
T
1 3 2 y
N
Move P: slope of M slope of P
R
(3) ¬
5 1
x
1 6 2 y 4 2y
¬
(6) ¬
1 5
x 2 1x
7 2y Again, x 1 and y 2.
5 ¬
5x
So, move S to (1, 2).
x 0 and y 9.
253 Chapter 8
S
Move T: slope of Q slope of T
W
D
slope of C slope of A
B
1
3 1 y y (1) 5
4
3) ¬ 5 x 4 ¬
4 ( x 71
2 1y y1
7 ¬ 5
1
x x 4 ¬6
x 2 and y 3. For (10, 0) and (2, 2), CDA B.
W
slope of Q slope of S
T
C
slope of B ¬2
y1
4 ¬
x Suppose D is (2, 2).
2 4
y1 4 (2)
4
¬ slope of
DA ¬
2 x4 1 (2)
¬2
Again, x 2 and y 3.
So
DAB C.
So, move T to (2, 3)
So, (2, 2), (4, 10), and (10, 0) are the
S
Move W: slope of Q slope of T
W
possibilities for the fourth vertex. Any of these
2 y (2) values results in both pairs of opposite sides being
7 ¬ x (
1)
y2 parallel, and thus, the four points form a
2
7 ¬x1 parallelogram.
Again, x 8 and y 0. 36. y
W
slope of Q slope of S
T
y3 2 1
x (3) ¬
1 4 Q
y3 3 R
x 3 ¬
5
x 8 and y 0. O x
So, move W to (8, 0). S
35. y
B
A The fourth vertex can have one of three possible
positions to complete the parallelogram.
Let T(x, y) be the fourth vertex.
Find the slopes of ST
and RT so that they equal
R
those of Q and QS, respectively.
O x T
slope of S slope of Q
R
C y (1) 1
2
1) ¬
x ( 1 (2)
The fourth vertex can have one of three possible y1 1
x 1 ¬3
positions to complete the parallelogram.
Let D(x, y) be the fourth vertex. For (2, 2) and (4, 0), S
TQ
R
.
1 2
Find the slopes of BD
and CD
so that they equal S
slope of Q ¬
1 (2)
C
those of A and A
B, respectively. ¬3
D
slope of B slope of AC
Suppose T is (2, 2).
y5 1 4
7 ¬
x 4 1 T
slope of R 2 1
¬
21
y5 5
7 ¬3
x ¬3
D
For (10, 0) and (4, 10), BA
C
. S
So QR
T
.
54 1 1
B
slope of A ¬ S
slope of R ¬
71 1 1
¬1 ¬1
6
Suppose D is (10, 0). Suppose T is (4, 0).
0 (1) 02
slope of CD ¬ T
slope of Q ¬
10 4 4 (2)
1
¬ ¬1
6
B
So AC
D
. T
So QR
S.
1 5 T
slope of R slope of Q
S
slope of BC ¬
47
y1 1 2
¬2 1 ¬
x 1 (2)
Suppose D is (4, 10). y1 3
10 4
1 ¬1
x
D
slope of A ¬
41
¬2
D
So AB
C
.
Chapter 8 254
For (2, 2) and (0, 4), R
TQ S. 41. Given:
ABD
C
1 (1) B
A D
C
slope of S R ¬
1 (1)
¬1 Prove: ABCD is a parallelogram.
Suppose T is (0, 4). A 1 B
4 2
T
slope of Q ¬0 (2) 2
¬1 D C
So S
RQ T. Proof:
So, (2, 2), (4, 0), and (0, 4) are the possibilities Statements Reasons
for the fourth vertex. Any of these values results B
1. AD C, A
B
D
C
1. Given
in both pairs of opposite sides being parallel, and
C
2. Draw A 2. Two points determine
thus, the four points form a parallelogram.
a line.
37. JKLM is a parallelogram because K M and JL
are
diagonals that bisect each other. 3. 1 2 3. If two lines are
parallel, then
38. If both pairs of opposite sides are parallel and
alternate interior
congruent, then the watchbox is a parallelogram.
angles are congruent.
39. Given: A D
B C A B
3 4.
ACA C 4. Reflexive Property
B
AD C 2
Prove: ABCD is a
1
4 5. ABC CDA 5. SAS
D C 6. D
A B C 6. CPCTC
parallelogram.
Proof: 7. ABCD is a 7. If both pairs of
Statements Reasons parallelogram. opposite sides are
congruent, then the
D
1. AB C
, A
B
D
C
1. Given quadrilateral is a
B
2. Draw D. 2. Two points determine parallelogram.
a line.
3.
DBDB
3. Reflexive Property 42. This theorem is not true. ABCD is a
4. ABD CDB 4. SSS
parallelogram with diagonal BD, ABD
CBD.
5. 1 2, 3 4 5. CPCTC A D
6. D
ABC
, A
BDC
6. If alternate interior
angles are congruent, B C
lines are parallel. 43. Given: ABCDEF is a regular hexagon.
7. ABCD is a 7. Definition of Prove: FDCA is a parallelogram.
parallelogram. parallelogram A B
40. Given:
AEE
C, D
EE B
F C
Prove: ABCD is a parallelogram.
A B
E E D
1 3 2
4 Proof:
D C Statements Reasons
Proof: 1. ABCDEF is a 1. Given
Statements Reasons regular hexagon.
1.
AEE C, D
E
EB
1. Given B
2. A D E
, B
C
E F 2. Definition of a
2. 1 2 2. Vertical are . E B, FACD regular hexagon
3 4 3. ABC DEF 3. SAS
3. ABE CDE 3. SAS C
4. A D F
4. CPCTC
ADE CBE 5. If both pairs of
5. FDCA is a .
B
4. A D C 4. CPCTC opposite sides are
D
A B C congruent, then the
5. ABCD is a 5. Definition of quadrilateral is a
parallelogram. parallelogram parallelogram.
44. Sample answer: The roofs of some covered bridges
are parallelograms. The opposite sides are
congruent and parallel. Answers should include
the following.
• We need to know the length of the sides, or the
measures of the angles formed.
• Sample answer: windows or tiles
255 Chapter 8
45. B; 51. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an
y equation to solve for n, the number of sides.
S ¬180(n 2)
(135)n ¬180(n 2)
(8, 2) 135n ¬180n 360
(2, 2)
0 ¬45n 360
O x 360 ¬45n
8 ¬n
( 1 , 6 ) The polygon has 8 sides.
52. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an
equation to solve for n, the number of sides.
By plotting choices A, C, and D on the graph, it is S ¬180(n 2)
obvious that they cannot be the fourth vertex. (144)n ¬180(n 2)
Choice B is the only possibility. 144n ¬180n 360
(2, 2) and (8, 2) have the same y-component. 0 ¬36n 360
These are the endpoints of a horizontal segment 360 ¬36n
10 units long. 10 ¬n
(11, 6) and (1, 6) have the same y-component. The polygon has 10 sides.
These are also the endpoints of a horizontal
53. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an
segment 10 units long.
equation to solve for n, the number of sides.
These two sides of the quadrilateral are
S ¬180(n 2)
congruent and parallel, so the quadrilateral is a
(168)n ¬180(n 2)
parallelogram.
168n ¬180n 360
46. C; use the Distance Formula to find the distance 0 ¬12n 360
between X and Y. 360 ¬12n
XY ¬ (x 2 x1)2 (y2
y1)2 30 ¬n
¬
(3
5)2
(4
7)2 The polygon has 30 sides.
¬ 185
54. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an
equation to solve for n, the number of sides.
S ¬180(n 2)
(162)n ¬180(n 2)
Page 423 Maintain Your Skills 162n ¬180n 360
47. The diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each 0 ¬18n 360
other, so ML LQ. 360 ¬18n
Find w. 20 ¬n
ML ¬LQ The polygon has 20 sides.
w ¬12
55. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an
48. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent, equation to solve for n, the number of sides.
so their measures are equal. S ¬180(n 2)
Find x. (175)n ¬180(n 2)
NQ ¬MR 175n ¬180n 360
3x 2 ¬4x 2 0 ¬5n 360
4 ¬x 360 ¬5n
49. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent, 72 ¬n
so their measures are equal. The polygon has 72 sides.
Find x. 56. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an
NQ ¬MR equation to solve for n, the number of sides.
3x 2 ¬4x 2 S ¬180(n 2)
4 ¬x (175.5)n ¬180(n 2)
So, NQ is 3(4) 2 or 14 units. 175.5n ¬180n 360
50. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent, 0 ¬4.5n 360
so their measures are equal. 360 ¬4.5n
Find y. 80 ¬n
QR ¬MN The polygon has 80 sides.
3y ¬2y 5 57. The legs of this right triangle have equal lengths,
y ¬5 so it is a 45°-45°-90° triangle. The hypotenuse of a
So, QR is 3(5) or 15 units.
45°-45°-90° triangle is 2 times the length of the
legs. Therefore, x 45 and y 12 2.
58. The hypotenuse of this right triangle is twice the
length of one of its legs, so it is a 30°-60°-90°
triangle. The longer leg is 3 times the length of
the shorter leg. Therefore, x 10 3 and y 30.
Chapter 8 256
59. Two angles are given, 60° and 90°, so this is a 2. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent,
30°-60°-90° triangle. The shorter leg is half the so their measures are equal. Find x.
length of the hypotenuse, and the longer leg is WZ ¬XY
3 times the length of the shorter leg. Therefore, x2 ¬42 x
x 16 3 and y 16. 0 ¬x2 x 42
0 ¬(x 6)(x 7)
60. Determine the slopes of AB and B
C.
y y 0 x 6 or 0 x 7
B
slope of A ¬
x
2
x
1
6 x 7x
2 1
3
¬ 5 x 6 or 7, so x2 36 or 49.
62 So, WZ is 36 or 49.
¬1
2 3. YXZ XZW because they are alternate
7
3 interior angles. So, mYXZ is 54 and mWXY is
C
slope of B
86
54 60 or 114. WXY and XYZ are
2
supplementary, so mXYZ is 180 114 or 66.
B
The product of the slopes of A and BC
is 1, so
4. Opposite angles of a parallelogram are congruent.
B
AB C. Find x and y.
B
61. Determine the slopes of A and B
C. 5x 19 ¬3x 9
y y
B
slope of A ¬
x
2
x
1 2x ¬28
2 1
7
2 x ¬14
¬
0 (1) 6y 57 ¬3y 36
¬5 3y ¬93
1
7 y ¬31
C
slope of B 40
5. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent.
3
2 Find x and y.
B
The product of the slopes of A and B C
is not 1, 2x 4 ¬x 4
B
so A is not perpendicular to BC
. x ¬8
B
62. Determine the slopes of A and BC. 4y 8 ¬3y 2
y y y ¬6
B
slope of A ¬
x
2
x
1
2 1
7
4
¬
50
¬3
5 8-4 Rectangles
3
7
C
slope of B
85
4
3 Pages 427–428 Check for Understanding
B
The product of the slopes of A and B C
is not 1, 1. If consecutive sides are perpendicular or
B
so A is not perpendicular to BC
. diagonals are congruent, then the parallelogram
B
63. Determine the slopes of A and BC. is a rectangle.
y y 2. Sample answer:
B
slope of A ¬
x
2
x
1
2 1
3 (5)
¬
1 (2)
2
¬3
0 (3)
C
slope of B
1 1 Yes, the opposite sides are congruent and parallel,
3 consecutive sides are perpendicular.
2
3. McKenna is correct. Consuelo’s definition is
B
The product of the slopes of A and B
C
is 1, so correct if one pair of opposite sides is parallel and
B
AB C. congruent.
4. The diagonals of a rectangle are congruent, so
C
A B D.
Page 423 Practice Quiz 1 C
A ¬B D
1. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem to write an AC ¬BD
equation to solve for n, the number of sides. 30 x ¬4x 60
S ¬180(n 2) 90 ¬5x
18 ¬x
147131n ¬180(n 2) 5. The diagonals of a rectangle bisect each other and
1620
11 n ¬180n 360
are congruent, so NP 1
2 NR and MP N P.
36
0 ¬ 0
11 n 360
NP ¬1
2 NR
360 ¬360 2x 30 ¬1
2 (2x 10)
11 n
11 ¬n x ¬35
The polygon has 11 sides. So, MP 2(35) 30 or 40.
257 Chapter 8
6. QRT RTS because they are alternate 11. The diagonals of a rectangle bisect each other, so
interior angles. Q
N Q K.
QRT ¬RTS Q
N ¬Q K
Q
mQRT ¬mRTS NQ ¬QK
x2 1 ¬3x 11 2x 3 ¬5x 9
x 3x 10 ¬0
2
12 ¬3x
(x 5)(x 2) ¬0 4 ¬x
x 5 0 or x 2 0 So, NQ 2(4) 3 or 11. J Q
N Q, so JQ 11.
x5 x 2
12. Opposite sides of a rectangle are congruent, so
So, x 5 or 2.
K
J N M.
7. QRT and SRT are complementary.
K
J ¬NM
mQRT mSRT ¬90 JK ¬NM
Use the values of x found in Exercise 6.
x2 1 ¬8x 14
[(2)2 1] mSRT ¬90
x2 8x 15 ¬0
5 mSRT ¬90
(x 3)(x 5) ¬0
mSRT ¬85
x 3 0 or x 5 0
or x3 x5
52 1 mSRT ¬90 So, x 3 or x 5. JK 32 1 or 10 or
26 mSRT ¬90 JK 52 1 or 26.
mSRT ¬64 13. The sum of the measures of NJM and KJM is
SRT RSQ and the sum of the measures of 90. Find x.
the interior angles of a triangle is 180. mNJM mKJM ¬90
Find mRPS. 2x 3 x 5 ¬90
mRPS mSRT mRSQ ¬180 3x ¬88
mRPS 2mSRT ¬180 x ¬291
3
mRPS 2(64) ¬180 14. KMN is a right triangle, so the sum of the
mRPS ¬52 measures of NKM and KNM is 90. Find x.
or mNKM mKNM ¬90
mRPS 2(85) ¬180 x2 4 x 30 ¬90
mRPS ¬10 x2 x 56 ¬0
8. The diagonals of a rectangle are congruent. Use (x 8)(x 7) ¬0
the Distance Formula to determine whether the x 8 0 or x 7 0
diagonals of quadrilateral EFGH are congruent. x 8 x7
EG ¬ (x2
x1)2 (y2
y1)2 So, x 8 or x 7. mKNM 8 30 or 22 or
mKNM 7 30 or 37. KNM JKN because
¬
[2 (
4)]2
[3
(3)]2 they are alternate interior angles, so mJKN
¬
72 22 or 37.
HF ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 15. The sum of the measures of JKN and NKM is
90. Find x.
¬
[3 (
5)]2
(1
1)2
mJKN mNKM ¬90
¬ 68 2x2 2 14x ¬90
The lengths of the diagonals are not equal, so 2x2 14x 88 ¬0
EFGH is not a rectangle. x2 7x 44 ¬0
9. The framer can make sure that the angles (x 4)(x 11) ¬0
measure 90 or that the diagonals are congruent. x 4 0 or x 11 0
x4 x 11
Since mNKM 14x, and the measure of an
angle must be positive, discard x 11.
Pages 428–430 Practice and Apply So, x 4.
10. The diagonals of a rectangle bisect each other and 16. m1 30.
Q
are congruent, so N Q M
.
17. 2 is complementary to 1 because consecutive
Q
N ¬Q
M sides of a rectangle are perpendicular. So, m2
NQ ¬QM 90 30 or 60.
5x 3 ¬4x 6 18. The diagonals of a rectangle are congruent and
x ¬9 bisect each other. So, the triangles formed by the
So, NQ 5(9) 3 or 42. NK is twice NQ or 84. diagonals of a rectangle are isosceles. Therefore,
2 3. From Exercise 17, m3 60.
19. 4 is complementary to 3 because consecutive
sides of a rectangle are perpendicular.
m4 m3 ¬90
m4 60 ¬90
m 4 ¬30
Chapter 8 258
20. 5 1 because they are alternate interior To determine if DFGH is a rectangle, the points must
angles. So, m5 30. be connected in the order given. When the points are
21. WXZ is a right triangle, so the sum of the plotted and connected, it is clear that DFGH is not a
measures of 1 and 6 is 90. Therefore, quadrilateral. So DFGH is not a rectangle.
m6 90 30 or 60. 29. If the opposite sides of a quadrilateral are parallel
22. 7 3 because they are alternate interior and the diagonals of the quadrilateral are
angles. From Exercise 18, m7 60. congruent, then the quadrilateral is a rectangle.
H
Find the slopes of D , FG, GH, and DF
.
23. 8 is complementary to 7.
m8 m7 ¬90 y
m8 60 ¬90 F 8
G
m8 ¬30
24. The sum of the interior angles of a triangle is 180. 4
m9 m7 m6 ¬180 x
m9 60 60 ¬180
8 4 4 8
m 9 ¬60 H
D 4
25. The contractor can measure the opposite sides
and the diagonals to make sure they are
congruent. y y
H
slope of D
x
2
x
1
2 1
26. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the 2 (3)
measure of the diagonal of the television screen. ¬
7 (4)
c ¬ a2 b2 1
¬
11
¬ 21
2 362 441 1296 G
slope of F 9
8
6 (5)
¬ 1737 1
¬42 11
9
2
The measure of the diagonal is about 42 in. H
slope of G
76
27. Opposite sides of a rectangle are parallel. Find 11
the slopes of DH
and F
G. 8 (3)
F
slope of D
5
(4)
y
8
F 11
G 4 H
So, DF G
and G
H
D F
. Use the Distance
Formula to determine whether the diagonals of
H x
quadrilateral DFGH are congruent.
8 4 O 4 8
D DG ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
4
¬
[6 (4)]2
[9
(3)]2
8
¬ 244
y2 y1
H
slope of D x2 x1 FH ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
1 (1)
¬ 6 9
¬
[7 (
5)]2
(2
8)2
¬ 2 ¬ 244
15
y2 y1 G
So, DF H, D
HF
G, and G
H
DF. Therefore,
G
slope of F x2 x1 DFGH is a rectangle.
¬5 5 30. Use the Distance y
6 9 Formula to find 8
¬0 WY and XZ. W Z
H
The slopes are not equal. Therefore, D and FG 4
are not parallel. So, DFGH is not a rectangle. X x
28. The diagonals of a rectangle are congruent. Use 8 4 4 8
the Distance Formula to determine whether the 4
diagonals of quadrilateral DFGH are congruent.
Y
y 8
8
G
4 WY ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
D H
x ¬
(1
2)2
(7
4)2
4 12 ¬ 130
F
4
XZ ¬ (x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
8 ¬
(3 0
)2 [9
(2
)]2
¬ 130
259 Chapter 8
31. See the figure in Exercise 30. Find the So by transitivity of parallel lines and
Y
coordinates of the midpoints of W and X
Z
. G
substitution, HE F and HG EF. So GHEF is
x x y y
2 (1) 4 (7)
a parallelogram. Since H and E are midpoints, by
Y
W:
1
2
2 ,
1
2
2, 2
2 the Triangle Midsegment Theorem, HE 1 2
(BD)
1
3
2, 2
and GF 12
(BD). Since AC BD, HE 1(AC)
2
x1 x2 y1 y2 and GF 21(AC). Therefore, HE GH GF EF.
Z
X:
2 , 2
2 9
2 , 2
0
3
EFGH is a parallelogram with all sides congruent.
7
3
2, 2 35. To make the diagonals the same, either A C must
32. The midpoints of the diagonals are not the same be shortened or BD must be lengthened. This can
(Exercise 31), so the diagonals do not bisect be accomplished by moving L and K until the
each other. Therefore, WXYZ is not a rectangle. length of the diagonals is the same.
36. Find the ratio of the length to the width of the
33. Consecutive sides of a rectangle are
rectangle.
B
perpendicular. Find the slopes of A, B
C
, C
D
, and
19.
42
12.01 1.617
A
D.
y Since 1.617 is close to 1.618, the rectangle is a
C golden rectangle. Use the Pythagorean Theorem
to find the length of the diagonal.
c a
2 b2
D x
19.422 2
12.01
O
B 22.83
The length of the diagonal is about 22.83 ft.
37. See students’ work.
A
y y 38. Parallelograms have opposite sides congruent and
B
slope of A
x
2
x
1
bisecting diagonals, so the minimal requirements
2 1
1 (4) to justify that a parallelogram is a rectangle are
2 (4) that diagonals are congruent or the parallelogram
1
2
has one right angle.
3 (1) 39. Sample answer:
C
slope of B
02 A B
2
03 D C
D
slope of C
6
0
ACBD
but ABCD is not a rectangle.
1
2 Y
40. Given: WXYZ is a rectangle with diagonals W
A4 0 Z
and X.
slope of D 4
(6) Y
Prove: W X Z
2
X Y
The consecutive sides are perpendicular.
Therefore, ABCD is a rectangle.
W Z
34. y Proof:
C
G Statements Reasons
F 1. WXYZ is a rectangle 1. Given
D O x Y
with diagonals W
and XZ
.
B
H X
2. W Z Y
2. Opp. sides of are
E .
A Z
3. W W Z 3. Reflexive Property
Draw diagonals AC and B
D. ABCD is a rectangle. 4. XWZ and YZW 4. Def. of rectangle
C
So AB D and AC BD. Since G and H are are right angles
midpoints, by the Triangle Midsegment Theorem 5. XWZ YZW 5. All right are .
G
HA and HG 1
C
2 (AC) 6. XWZ YZW 6. SAS
Since E and F are midpoints, Y
7. W X Z
7. CPCTC
F
EA and EF 1
C
2 (AC)
Chapter 8 260
X
41. Given: WYZ, X
YW Z, and W
Y
X
Z
43. Given: DEAC and FEAB are rectangles.
Prove: WXYZ is a rectangle. GKH JHK
J
G and H
K
intersect at L.
W X Prove: GHJK is a parallelogram.
Z Y MA N
E
Proof:
F
Statements Reasons BC D
K G
1.
WX Y Y
Z, XW Z
, 1. Given
and WYX Z J
L H
X
2. W W X 2. Reflexive Property
Proof:
3. WZX XYW 3. SSS
Statements Reasons
4. ZWX YXW 4. CPCTC
1. DEAC and FEAB 1. Given
5. mZWX mYXW 5. Def. of
are rectangles.
6. WXYZ is a 6. Def. of parallelogram GKH JHK
parallelogram J
G and HK
intersect
7. ZWX and YXW 7. Consec. of are at L.
are supplementary suppl. E
2. D A C
and 2. Def. of parallelogram
8. mZWX 8. Def. of suppl. E
FA B
mYXW 180 3. plane plane 3. Def. of parallel plane
9. ZWX and YXW 9. If 2 are and 4. G, J, H, K, L are in 4. Def. of intersecting
are right angles suppl., each is a the same plane. lines
rt. .
H
5. G K J
5. Def. of parallel lines.
10. WXYZ is a rectangle 10. Def. of rectangle
G
6. K H J
6. Alt. int. are .
42. Given: PQST is a rectangle. 7. GHJK is a 7. Def. of parallelogram
R
QVT parallelogram.
R
Prove: P V
S
44. Explore: We need to find the number of
Q R S rectangles that can be formed using four of the
twelve points as corners.
Plan: Count the number of rectangles with each
possible set of dimensions. Arrange the data in a
table
P V T Solve:
Proof: Dimensions Number
Statements Reasons length width of rectangles
1. PQST is a rectangle. 1. Given 32 1
R
Q V T
31 2
2. PQST is a 2. Def. of rectangle
22 2
parallelogram.
S
3. T P Q 3. Opp. sides of are 21 4
. 12 3
4. T and Q are 4. Definition of 11 6
rt. s. rectangle
There are 18 rectangles formed by using the rows
5. T Q 5. All rt. are .
and columns as sides.
6. RPQ VST 6. SAS There are 2 additional rectangles formed as
R
7. P V S 7. CPCTC shown.
261 Chapter 8
45. No; there are no parallel lines in spherical 57. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent,
geometry. so their measures are equal. Find x.
46. AC appears to be shorter than TR, so AC TR. AB ¬CD
5x ¬25
47. Since the sides would not be parallel in spherical
x ¬5
geometry, a rectangle cannot exist.
58.
ST is the altitude to side Q
R
in right triangle
48. Sample answer: The tennis court is divided
QSR so by Theorem 7.2, its measure is the
into rectangular sections. The players use the
geometric mean between the two segments of the
rectangles to establish the playing area. Answers
hypotenuse. Let x ST.
should include the following.
18 x
x ¬ 34
• Not counting overlap, there are 5 rectangles on
each side of a tennis court. x2 ¬612
• Measure each diagonal to make sure they are x ¬ 612
the same length and measure each angle to
x ¬24.7
make sure they measure 90.
59.
NP is the altitude to side M
O
in right triangle
B
49. A; since AC E, ADE BAD and
MNO so by Theorem 7.2, its measure is the
BDC ABD because they are alternate
geometric mean between the two segments of the
interior angles. It is given that ADE BAD, so
hypotenuse.
BAD ABD. Therefore, ABD is isosceles and
DB DA, so DB is 6. Let x NP.
11 x
50. D; since s is the shorter side of the playground, x ¬
2
7
s 10 is the longer side. The perimeter of the x2 ¬297
fence is 80 feet, and the perimeter of a rectangle
is equal to twice the width plus twice the length. x ¬ 297
Therefore, the equation to find s is x ¬17.2
2(s 10) 2s 80. B
60. The measure of the altitude to A is the
geometric mean between the two segments of the
hypotenuse of ABC.
Page 430 Maintain Your Skills Let x the measure of the altitude.
24 x
51. There are 31 parallelograms: 11 individual x ¬
1
4
parallelograms, 12 using two others, 6 using three x2 ¬336
others, and 2 using four others.
x ¬ 336
52. The sum of the measures of the internal angles of x ¬18.3
a triangle is 180. Find mAFD.
61. Use the Distance Formula to find the distance
mAFD mFDA mDAF ¬180 betweeen the given points.
mAFD 34 49 ¬180
mAFD ¬97 d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
Chapter 8 262
QM ¬
(3 0
)2 (0
3)2
8-5 Rhombi and Squares ¬
9 9 ¬3 2
Use slope to determine whether the consecutive
Page 434 Check for Understanding sides are perpendicular.
03
1. Sample answer: N
slope of M
3
0
Square 1
(rectangle 3 0
P
slope of N
0 (
3)
with 4
sides) 1
0
3
Rectangle Rhombus
Q
slope of P
03
( with ( with 4 1
1 right ) sides) 0
3
M
slope of Q
30
1
Parallelogram
(opposite sides || ) Since the slopes of MN and PQ
are opposite
P
reciprocals of the slopes of N and Q
M
,
2. Sample answer: consecutive sides are perpendicular. The lengths
of the four sides are the same, so the sides are
congruent. MNPQ is a rectangle, a rhombus, and
a square.
3. A square is a rectangle with all sides congruent. 9. y
4. The sides of a rhombus are congruent. Find x. N
AB ¬BC P
2x 3 ¬5x
3 ¬3x
M O x
1 ¬x
The value of x is 1. Q
5. From Exercise 1, x 1.
So, BC 5(1) or 5. AD is congruent to BC, so
AD 5. If the diagonals are congruent, then
6. The diagonals of a rhombus are perpendicular, so parallelogram MNPQ is either a rectangle or a
mAEB 90. square. If the diagonals are perpendicular, then
7. Consecutive angles of a rhombus are MNPQ is a square or a rhombus.
supplementary. Find mBCD. Use the distance formula to compare the lengths
mBCD mABC ¬180 of the diagonals.
mBCD 83.2 ¬180 MP
(4
2)2
(0 2)2
mBCD ¬96.8
36 4 40
8. y NQ
(3
1)2 2
[3 (1)]
M 32
16 16
Use slope to determine whether the diagonals are
perpendicular.
N O Q x 02
P
slope of M
4
2
1
3
P 1 3
Q
slope of N
1 (
3)
1
If the four sides are congruent, then
parallelogram MNPQ is either a rhombus or a The diagonals are not congruent or perpendicular.
square. If consecutive sides are perpendicular, MNPQ is not a rhombus, a rectangle, or a square.
then MNPQ is a rectangle or a square.
Use the distance formula to compare the lengths
of the sides.
MN ¬
(3
0)2
(0 3
)2
¬
9 9 3 2
NP ¬
[0 (3)]2
(3
0)2
¬
9 9 3 2
PQ ¬ [3
] 0
2 [03)]
(2
¬
9 9 3 2
263 Chapter 8
10. Given: KGH, HJK, GHJ, and JKG are 16. The diagonals of a rhombus are perpendicular, so
isosceles. mYVZ 90. The measure of the interior angles
Prove: GHJK is a rhombus. of a triangle is 180. Find mYZV.
G H mYVZ mYZV mWYZ ¬180
90 mYZV 53 ¬180
mYZV 143 ¬180
mYZV ¬37
K J
17. The diagonals of a rhombus bisect the angles, so
Proof: XYW WYZ and mXYW 53.
Statements Reasons 18. The diagonals of a rhombus bisect each other, so
1. KGH, HJK, 1. Given V
XZ V. Find a.
GHJ, and JKG V
X ¬Z
V
are isosceles. XV ¬ZV
G
2. KG H
, HJK
J
, 2. Def. of isosceles 5a 1
2a 2 ¬
H
G H J, K
G
KJ
4
8a 8 ¬5a 1
G
3. KH J
, GH
KJ
3. Transitive Property
G
4. KG H
, HJK
J
3a ¬9
4. Substitution
5. GHJK is a rhombus. 5. Def. of rhombus a ¬3
So, XV 2(3) 2 or 4 and XZ is twice XV or 8.
11. If the measure of each angle is 90 or if the
19. From Exercise 18, XV 4. VW 3.
diagonals are congruent, then the floor is a square.
The diagonals of a rhombus are perpendicular, so
mWVX 90 and WVX is a right triangle.
W
X is the hypotenuse of WVX. Use the
Pages 434–437 Practice and Apply Pythagorean Theorem.
12. Consecutive angles in a rhombus are (VW)2 (XV)2 ¬(XW)2
supplementary, so DAB and ADC are 32 42 ¬(XW)2
25 ¬(XW)2
supplementary. Find mDAB.
5 ¬XW
mDAB mADC ¬180 20. y
mDAB 1
2 mDAB ¬180
H
12
E
3 mDAB ¬180
2
8
mDAB ¬120
Opposite angles of a rhombus are congruent, so 4
BCD DAB. The diagonals of a rhombus
F G
bisect the angles, so mACD 1
2 mBCD or 60. 4 O 4 8 12 x
13. Consecutive angles in a rhombus are
supplementary, so DAB and ADC are If the diagonals are congruent, then
supplementary. Find mDAB. parallelogram EFGH is either a rectangle or a
square. If the diagonals are perpendicular, then
mDAB mADC ¬180 EFGH is a square or a rhombus.
mDAB 1
2 mDAB ¬180
Use the Distance Formula to compare the lengths
of the diagonals.
3 mDAB ¬180 EG ¬ (1 7
)2 (10 2)2
2
mDAB ¬120 ¬ 36 64 100
14. By definition, a rhombus has four congruent ¬10
A
sides, so DC B
and DA 6. FH ¬ (4 12)2 (0 12)2
15. Consecutive angles in a rhombus are ¬ 256 144 400
supplementary, so DAB and ADC are ¬20
supplementary. Find mADC. Use slope to determine whether the diagonals are
mDAB mADC ¬180 perpendicular.
10 2
2(mADC) mADC ¬180 G
slope of E ¬17
Chapter 8 264
The diagonals are not congruent. Since the slopes 23. y G
G
of E and F H
are opposite reciprocals of each
other, the diagonals are perpendicular. EFGH is a F
rhombus.
21. H y G H
O x
E
E F
If the diagonals are congruent, then
parallelogram EFGH is either a rectangle or a
O x square. If the diagonals are perpendicular, then
EFGH is a square or a rhombus.
If the diagonals are congruent, then Use the Distance Formula to compare the lengths
parallelogram EFGH is either a rectangle or a of the diagonals.
square. If the diagonals are perpendicular, then EG ¬ (2 1)2
(1 5)2
EFGH is a square or a rhombus. ¬ 9 36 45
Use the Distance Formula to compare the lengths FH ¬ (4 3)2
(3 1
)2
of the diagonals. ¬ 49 4 53
EG ¬ (7 1)2 (3 7
)2 Use slope to determine whether the diagonals are
¬ 64 16 80 perpendicular.
FH ¬ [2 (4)]
2 (3 7)2 G
slope of E 1
¬ 5
2 1
¬ 4 16 20
¬2
Use slope to determine whether the diagonals are 31
perpendicular. H
slope of F ¬
4
3
37
G
slope of E ¬
7 1 ¬2
7
¬1
2
The diagonals are not congruent or perpendicular.
37 EFGH is not a rhombus, a rectangle, or a square.
H
slope of F ¬ 2
(4)
¬2 24. Sample answer:
The diagonals are not congruent. Since the slopes
G
of E and F H
are opposite reciprocals of each
other, the diagonals are perpendicular. EFGH is a 3 cm
rhombus.
22. y H 3 cm
G
25. Sample answer:
E F
5 cm
265 Chapter 8
32. The width of the square base is 153
4 in. Since the 37. The width and length of the rectangular court are
width of the smaller boxes is one half the width of 6400 mm and 9750 mm, respectively. The
the square base, the dimensions of the smaller measure of the diagonal can be found using the
boxes are 77
7
8 in. by 7 8 in. Pythagorean Theorem with width and length as
33. The diagonals of a rhombus bisect each other and the legs of a right triangle.
are perpendicular, so along with the sides, they diagonal measure 6400 2 97502
form four congruent right triangles with legs 12
¬11,662.9
2 No; the diagram is not correct. The correct
16
or 6 cm and 2 or 8 cm. Find the length of one of
measure is about 11,662.9 mm.
the four congruent sides–the hypotenuse of one of
the right triangles–by using the Pythagorean 38. The side length of the square service boxes is
Theorem. 1600 mm. The length of the diagonal can be found
side length ¬ 62 82 using the Pythagorean Theorem with the side
¬ 36 64 10 length of the square service boxes as the legs of a
right triangle.
The side length is 10 cm, so the perimeter of the
diagonal length 16002 160
02
rhombus is 4(10) or 40 cm.
¬2263
34. ABCD is a rhombus; EFGH and JKLM are
The length of the diagonal of the square service
congruent squares.
boxes is about 2263 mm or 2.263 m.
35. Given: ABCD is a parallelogram.
39. The flag of Denmark contains four red rectangles.
C
A B D
The flag of St. Vincent and the Grenadines
Prove: ABCD is a rhombus.
contains a blue rectangle, a green rectangle, a
A B yellow rectangle, a blue and yellow rectangle, a
E yellow and green rectangle, and three green
rhombi. The flag of Trinidad and Tobago contains
two white parallelograms and one black
D C parallelogram.
Proof: We are given that ABCD is a 40. Given: WZY WXY
parallelogram. The diagonals of a parallelogram WZY and XYZ are isosceles.
E
bisect each other, so A E C
. B
EB E because Prove: WXYZ is a rhombus.
congruence of segments is reflexive. We are also W X
given that ACB D. Thus, AEB and BEC are P
right angles by the definition of perpendicular
lines. Then AEB BEC because all right Z Y
angles are congruent. Therefore, AEB CEB
Proof:
by SAS. ABB C by CPCTC. Opposite sides of
parallelograms are congruent, so A B
C D
and Statements Reasons
C
B A D
. Then since congruence of segments is 1. WZY WXY 1. Given
B
transitive, A C DB CA D. All four sides of WZY and XYZ are
ABCD are congruent, so ABCD is a rhombus by isosceles.
definition. Z
2. WW
X
, Z
Y
X
Y
2. CPCTC
36. Given: ABCD is a rhombus.
Prove: Each diagonal bisects a pair of Z
3. WZ
Y
, W
X
X
Y
3. Def. of isosceles
opposite angles. triangle
A B Z
4. WW
X
Z
Y
X
Y
4. Substitution Property
6 3
5 4 5. WXYZ is rhombus. 5. Def. of rhombus
Chapter 8 266
42. Given: LGK MJK • Sample answer: Since the angles of a rhombus
GHJK is a parallelogram. are not all congruent, riding over the same road
Prove: GHJK is a rhombus. would not be smooth.
K J 46. B; the side length of the square is 36
6 units.
M So, the perimeter of the square is 4(6) or
L 24 units. Since rectangle ABCD is contained
within the square, which itself is a rectangle,
G H ABCD cannot have a greater perimeter than the
square. Therefore, the perimeter of rectangle
Proof:
ABCD is less than 24 units.
Statements Reasons
47. C; test all four values.
1. LGK MJK 1. Given
GHJK is a parallelogram. x
1
x
x2
G
2. KK
J
2. CPCTC
0
1
2
J
3. KG
H
, K
G
J
H
3. Opp. sides of
1
2
are .
3
4
G
4. KJ
H
G
H
J
K
4. Substitution
4
5 21
Property 2 2
5. GHJK is a rhombus. 5. Def. of rhombus 3
has the greatest value.
43. Given: QRST and QRTV are rhombi.
Prove: QRT is equilateral.
Q R Pae 437 Maintain Your Skills
48. The diagonals of a rectangle bisect each other and
are congruent, so PJL J
.
V S J
P ¬LJ
T
Proof: PJ ¬LJ
Statements Reasons 3x 1 ¬2x 1
x ¬2
1. QRST and QRTV are 1. Given
So, x 2.
rhombi.
49. The interior angles of a rectangle are 90°. Find
V
2. Q VT T
R
QR
, 2. Def. of rhombus
mMLK.
T
Q TSRS
Q
R mMLK mPLM ¬mPLK
T
3. QT
R
Q
R
3. Substitution mMLK 90 ¬110
Property mMLK ¬20
4. QRT is equilateral. 4. Def. of equilateral Diagonals of a rectangle are congruent and bisect
triangle each other. So JL
J M
. Then LKMJ is a rhombus
because opposite sides of a parallelogram are
44. Hexagons 1, 2, 3, and 4 have 3, 12, 27, and 48
congruent. Since each diagonal of a rhombus
rhombi, respectively. Note that the numbers of
bisects a pair of congruent opposite angles,
rhombi are 3 3(1) 3(12), 12 3(4) 3(22),
KML MLK. The sum of the measures of the
27 3(9) 3(32), and 48 3(16) 3(42). So, the
interior angles of a triangle is 180. Find mLKM.
number of rhombi are given by 3x2, where x is the
mMLK mLKM mKML ¬180
hexagon number.
20 mLKM 20 ¬180
Number of mLKM ¬140
Hexagon
rhombi So, mLKM 140.
1 3 50. MJN is supplementary to PJN. Find mPJN.
2 12 mMJN mPJN ¬180
3 27 35 mPJN ¬180
4 48 mPJN ¬145
5 75 Since the diagonals of a rectangle are congruent
6 108 and bisect each other, PJN is isosceles with
x 3x2 J
sides P and JN
congruent. Since PJN is
isosceles, MPN PNL. The sum of the
45. Sample answer: You can ride a bicycle with
measures of the interior angles of a triangle is
square wheels over a curved road. Answers should
180. Find mMPN.
include the following.
mMPN mPNL mPJN ¬180
• Rhombi and squares both have all four sides
mMPN mMPN 145 ¬180
congruent, but the diagonals of a square are
2(mMPN) ¬35
congruent. A square has four right angles and
mMPN ¬17.5
rhombi have each pair of opposite angles
So, mMPN 17.5.
congruent, but not all angles are necessarily
congruent.
267 Chapter 8
51. Since the diagonals of a rectangle are congruent 54. No;
and bisect each other, LJ
J N
. Since the sides of y
a rhombus are congruent, L JM K. Therefore, H
K
M J N
.
Find x.
K
M ¬J N
J
MK ¬JN G
x
6x ¬14 x
7x ¬14 F
x ¬2
Once again, the sides of a rhombus are congruent, If both pairs of opposite sides of a quadrilateral
K
so M K L. Find y. are congruent, then the quadrilateral is a
K
M ¬KL parallelogram. Use the Distance Formula to
MK ¬KL determine whether the opposite sides are
6x ¬3x 2y congruent.
3x ¬y HJ ¬ (3 2)2 (4 1)2
2
Substituting the value of x from above, ¬ 34
3(2) ¬y FG ¬
[1 (4)] 2
(1 1)2
2
3 ¬y ¬ 29
So, x 2 and y 3. Since HJ FG, H J
F G
. Therefore, FGHJ is not
52. Since mLMP mPMN, the diagonal P M
a parallelogram.
bisects LMN. If the diagonals of a rectangle 55. No;
bisect its interior angles, the rectangle must be a y
square. The diagonals of a square are 8
M
perpendicular, so mPJL 90.
4
53. Yes; L
y
N
Q 8 4 4 8x
P 4
K
8
O R x
If the opposite sides of a quadrilateral are
S parallel, then it is a parallelogram. The slope of
N
K is undefined, since it is vertical. L
M
is clearly
not vertical. The opposite sides, KN
and LM, do
If both pairs of opposite sides of a quadrilateral not have the same slope, so they are not parallel.
are congruent, then the quadrilateral is a Therefore, KLMN is not a parallelogram.
parallelogram. Use the Distance Formula to 56. Yes;
determine whether the opposite sides are y
congruent. 8
C
PQ ¬ (0 6)2 (2
4)2
4
¬ 40 D
RS ¬ [4 (
2)]2 [0 (2)]2
8 A 4 8x
¬ 40
QR ¬ (6 4)2 (4
0)2 B
¬ 20 8
PS ¬ [0 (
2)]2 [2 (2)]2
If the opposite sides of a quadrilateral are
¬ 20 parallel, then it is a parallelogram.
Since the measures of both pairs of opposite sides 1 (5)
are equal, PQRS is a parallelogram. B
slope of A ¬
4 (2)
¬2
7
3
D
slope of C ¬
13
¬2
1 7
C
slope of A ¬
4 1
¬8
5
5 3
D
slope of B ¬
2 3
¬8
5
Chapter 8 268
B
Since opposite sides have the same slope, A CD
Page 438 Geometry Activity: Kites
C
and A B D. Therefore, ABDC is a parallelogram 1. The diagonals intersect at a right angle.
by definition. 2. QRS QTS
57. From the Triangle Proportionality Theorem, 3. R
See students’ work; NT N, but Q
N
N S
.
PS QP
. 4. 3 pairs: QRN QTN, RNS TNS,
ST RT
Substitute the known measures. QRS QTS
PS 24 5. J
9 ¬
16
PS(16) ¬24(9)
K M
16(PS) ¬216 P
PS ¬13.5
58. From the Triangle Proportionality Theorem, L
PS QS
.
PT
The diagonals intersect in a right angle; JKL
QR
Substitute the known measures. JML; K PP M
, JP
P L; 3 pairs:
y2 16 JPK JPM, KPL MPL, JKL JML.
¬
16
y3 12 6. One pair of opposite angles is congruent. The
4(y 2) ¬16(y 3) diagonals are perpendicular. The longer diagonal
4y 8 ¬16y 48 bisects the shorter diagonal. The short sides are
56 ¬12y congruent and the long sides are congruent.
42
3 ¬y
59. From the Triangle Proportionality Theorem,
TS RT
PS QP .
8-6 Trapezoids
Substitute the known measures.
TS 15
8 ¬
TS 21 Page 441 Geometry Activity: Median of a
21(TS) ¬15(TS 8) Trapezoid
6(TS) ¬120 1. See students’ work.
TS ¬20
2. The median is the average of the lengths of the
60. G
If A A C
, ACG is isosceles. Then AGC bases.
ACG. So, MN 1
2 (WX ZY).
61. J
If A AH, AJH is isosceles. Then AJH
AHJ.
62. If AFD ADF, ADF is isosceles. Then A F
Page 442 Check for Understanding
D
A . 1. Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel.
63. If AKB ABK, ABK is isosceles. Then A K
2. Properties Trapezoid Rectangle Square Rhombus
B
A .
diagonals are only
64. Solve for x. yes yes no
congruent isosceles
1
(8x 6x 7) ¬5
2 diagonals are
no no yes yes
8x 6x 7 ¬10 perpendicular
2x ¬17 diagonals
x ¬8.5 bisect each no yes yes yes
65. Solve for x. other
1(7x 3x 1) ¬12.5 diagonals
2 no no yes yes
7x 3x 1 ¬25 bisect angles
10x ¬24
3. Sample answer: The median of a trapezoid is
x ¬2.4
parallel to both bases.
66. Solve for x.
1(4x 6 2x 13) ¬15.5
2
4x 6 2x 13 ¬31
6x ¬12 trapezoid
x ¬2
67. Solve for x.
1(7x 2 3x 3) ¬25.5 isosceles trapezoid
2
7x 2 3x 3 ¬51
10x ¬50
x ¬5
269 Chapter 8
4. y 8. The perspective makes it appear that the
R S buildings are formed by trapezoids and
parallelograms.
ST ¬ (4 6
)2 (6 2)2 D
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, A
C
and B. So, ABCD is a trapezoid.
¬ 4 16 20
9b. y
Since the legs are congruent, QRST is an isosceles
trapezoid.
A D
6. Given: CDFG is an isosceles C D
trapezoid with bases
D
C and FG. x
Prove: DGF CFG O
Proof: G F
B C
CDFG is an isosceles
trapezoid with CG DF
Use the Distance Formula to determine whether
bases CD and GF. Def. isos. trap.
the legs are congruent.
Given
AB ¬ [3 (4)]2
[3 (
1)]2
CF DG GF GF ¬ 1 16
Diag. of isos. Reflex. Prop. ¬ 17
trap. are . CD ¬ (5 2
)2 (
1 3)2
CGF DFG ¬ 9 16
SSS ¬5
Since the legs are not congruent, ABCD is not an
DGF CFG isosceles trapezoid.
CPCTC
7. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
and its measure is one-half the sum of the
measures of the bases. Find x.
YZ ¬1
2 (EF HG)
13 ¬1
2 [(3x 8) (4x 10)]
26 ¬7x 2
28 ¬7x
4 ¬x
Chapter 8 270
0 ( 10)
10a.
J E
slope of F ¬
6 (4)
y ¬1
H 3 (10)
E
slope of D ¬5 (4)
¬7
K 10
x F
slope of C ¬
1
6
O
¬1
7
C
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, D
E
and F . So, CDEF is a trapezoid.
G
11b. 8 y
A quadrilateral is a trapezoid if exactly one pair
of opposite sides is parallel. Use the Slope Formula. 4
4 4
H
slope of G ¬
5 5 C F
¬4
5 8 4 O 4 8x
5 1 D 4
J
slope of K ¬0 (5)
¬4
5
8
1 (4)
K
slope of G ¬
5 (5) E
5
¬0 or undefined Use the Distance Formula to show that the legs
4 5 are congruent.
J
slope of H ¬50
1 DE ¬ [5 (4)]
2 [ 2
3 (10)]
¬5
J
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, K ¬ 1 49
H
and G . So, GHJK is a trapezoid. ¬ 50
10b. CF ¬ (1 6)2 (1 0)2
J
y ¬ 49 1
H ¬ 50
Since the legs are congruent, CDEF is an isosceles
K trapezoid.
x
O 12a. y
8
R
4
S
G Q
12 8 4 O x
Use the Distance Formula to determine whether
the legs are congruent. 4
T
GK ¬ [5 (5)]2
( 4 1)2
8
¬ 0 25
¬5 A quadrilateral is a trapezoid if exactly one pair
JH ¬ (0 5)
2 (5
4)2 of opposite sides is parallel. Use the Slope
Formula.
¬ 25 1 14
R
slope of Q ¬12 (9)
¬ 26
Since the legs are not congruent, GHJK is not an ¬1
4 3
isosceles trapezoid. S
slope of T ¬
11 (4)
11a. 8 y ¬1
1 (4)
T
slope of Q ¬
12 (11)
4
¬5
C F 43
8 4 O 4 8x S
slope of R ¬
9
(4)
D 4 ¬1
5
R
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, Q
8
S
and T. So, QRST is a trapezoid.
E
A quadrilateral is a trapezoid if exactly one pair
of opposite sides is parallel. Use the Slope
Formula.
3 1
C
slope of D ¬5 (1)
¬1
271 Chapter 8
12b. y So, AB 16.
8 Q and S are supplementary to T and R,
R
4 respectively. So, mQ 180 120 or 60 and
S mS 180 45 or 135.
Q
12 8 4 O x 17. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
4
and its measure is one-half the sum of the
T measures of the bases. First find AB.
8 AB ¬1
2 (RS QT)
Use the Distance Formula to show that the legs ¬1
2 (54 86)
are congruent. ¬70
QT ¬
[1 (4)]2 [1 2
2 (11)] So, AB 70.
¬ 25 1 Find GH.
¬ 26 GH ¬12 (RS AB)
RS ¬ (4 3
)2 [
9 (4)]2
¬1
2 (54 70)
¬ 1 25
¬ 26 ¬62
Since the legs are congruent, QRST is an isosceles So, GH 62.
trapezoid. 18. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
13. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases, and its measure is one-half the sum of the
and its measure is one-half the sum of the measures of the bases. Find AB.
measures of the bases. Find DE. From Exercise 17, AB 70.
Find JK.
XY ¬1
2 (DE HG)
JK ¬1
2 (QT AB)
20 ¬1
2 (DE 32)
¬1
2 (86 70)
40 ¬DE 32
¬78
8 ¬DE
So, JK 78.
14. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
19. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
and its measure is one-half the sum of the
and its measure is one-half the sum of the
measures of the bases. Find VT.
measures of the bases. Find RP.
AB ¬1
2 (VT RS)
RP ¬1
2 (JK LM)
15 ¬1
2 (VT 26)
30 ¬VT 26
5 x ¬1
1
2 2(x 3) 2 x 1
10 2x ¬2x 6 1
2x 1
4 ¬VT 1
5 ¬2x
15. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
and its measure is one-half the sum of the 10 ¬x
measures of the bases. Find the length of the x 10, so RP 5 10 or 15.
median and let it be x. 20. Since the two octagons are regular polygons with
x ¬1
2 (WZ XY)
the same center, the quadrilaterals are trapezoids
with one pair of opposite sides parallel.
¬1
2 (8 20)
21. Sample answer: triangles, quadrilaterals,
¬14 trapezoids, hexagons
The length of the median is 14. 22. A trapezoid must have exactly one pair of
Both base pairs of an isosceles trapezoid are opposite sides parallel. A parallelogram must
congruent, so mX 70 and mW mZ. The have both pairs of opposite sides parallel. A
sum of the measures of the interior angles of a square must have all four sides congruent and
quadrilateral is 360. consecutive sides perpendicular. A rhombus must
Find mW and mZ. have all four sides congruent. A quadrilateral has
mW mZ mX mY ¬360 four sides.
mW mW 70 70 ¬360 Use the Slope Formula to determine whether the
2(mW) ¬220 opposite sides are parallel.
mW ¬110 C
slope of B ¬2 4
mZ ¬110 14
16. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases, ¬2
3
and its measure is one-half the sum of the 1 (1)
E
slope of D ¬
52
measures of the bases. Find AB.
AB ¬1 ¬2
2 (TS QR)
3
4
1
¬1 D
slope of C ¬
2 (12 20)
45
¬16 ¬3
Chapter 8 272
2 (1) 1 (2)
E
slope of B ¬
12 P
slope of M ¬
3 (2)
¬3 ¬3
Use the distance formula to compare the lengths 3 (1)
O
slope of N ¬
13
of the sides.
¬2
BC ¬ (1 4
)2 (2 4)2
All four sides have different slopes. Therefore,
¬ 94
opposite sides are not parallel and the figure is a
¬ 13 quadrilateral.
DE ¬ (5 2)2 [1
(1)]2 25. A trapezoid must have exactly one pair of
¬ 94 opposite sides parallel. A parallelogram must
¬ 13 have both pairs of opposite sides parallel. A
CD ¬ (4 5)2 (4
1)2 square must have all four sides congruent and
¬ 19 consecutive sides perpendicular. A rhombus must
have all four sides congruent. A quadrilateral has
¬ 10
four sides.
BE ¬ (1 2
)2 [2 2
(1)]
Use the Slope Formula to determine whether the
¬ 19 opposite sides are parallel.
¬ 10 R ¬03
slope of Q 3 0
Opposite sides are parallel. Since the slopes of ¬1
consecutive sides are not negative reciprocals, 0 ( 3)
T
slope of S ¬ 30
consecutive sides are not perpendicular; there are
no right angles. Opposite sides are congruent, but ¬1
0 (3)
consecutive sides are not congruent. BCDE is a slope of QT ¬3 0
parallelogram. ¬1
3 0
23. A trapezoid must have exactly one pair of slope of RS ¬
03
opposite sides parallel. A parallelogram must ¬1
have both pairs of opposite sides parallel. A Use the distance formula to compare the lengths
square must have all four sides congruent and of the sides.
consecutive sides perpendicular. A rhombus must
QR ¬ (3 0)2 (0 3)2
have all four sides congruent.
A quadrilateral has four sides. ¬ 9 9 18
Use the Slope Formula to determine whether the ST ¬ (3 0
)2 [0 (3)]2
opposite sides are parallel. ¬ 9 9 18
22 QT ¬ (3 0)
2 [0 (
3)]2
H
slope of G ¬
2
4
¬0 ¬ 9 9 18
K
slope of J 1
¬ (1) RS ¬ (0 3
)2 (3 0)2
6 (4)
¬ 9 9 18
¬0
All four sides have the same length and are
2 (1)
K
slope of G ¬
2 (4) congruent. Opposite sides are parallel. Because
the slopes of consecutive sides are opposite
¬3
2 reciprocals, consecutive sides are perpendicular.
2 (1)
J
slope of H ¬
46
QRST is a square.
26. A quadrilateral is a trapezoid if exactly one pair
¬32
of opposite sides is parallel. Use the Slope
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, so Formula.
GHJK is a trapezoid. 4 1
R
slope of Q ¬
04
24. A trapezoid must have exactly one pair of
opposite sides parallel. A parallelogram must ¬3
4
have both pairs of opposite sides parallel. A 3 (
3)
S
slope of P ¬4 4
square must have all four sides congruent and
consecutive sides perpendicular. A rhombus must ¬3
4
have all four sides congruent. A quadrilateral has 34
Q
slope of P ¬
4
0
four sides.
Use the Slope Formula to determine whether the ¬1
4
opposite sides are parallel. 1 ( 3)
S
¬ 4
4 4 0 or undefined
13 slope of R
N
slope of M ¬3 1 R
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, Q
¬1
2 and PS
. So, PQRS is a trapezoid.
1 (2)
P
slope of O ¬
3 (2)
Use the Distance Formula to determine whether
the legs are congruent.
¬1
5
273 Chapter 8
PQ ¬ (4 0)2 (3 4
)2 31. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
and its measure is one-half the sum of the measures
¬ 16 1
of the bases. So, the length of
W
V is given by
¬ 17 WV 21(DG EF). Since DG and EF are vertical,
RS ¬ (4 4
)2 [1 2
(3)] their lengths are given by y1 y2. Find WV.
¬ 0 16 WV ¬1
2 (DG EF)
¬4
¬1
2 [2 (2) 5 (3)]
Since PQ RS, PQRS is not an isosceles
trapezoid. ¬6
27. Use the Midpoint Formula to find the coordinates So, WV 6.
Q
of the midpoints of P and RS
. 32. Given: HJ
GK
, HGK JKG
4 3
0 4 Prove: GHJK is an isosceles trapezoid.
Q
P:
2 , 2 ¬(2, 3.5)
H J
:
S
R 2 , 2 ¬(4, 1)
4
4 1 (3)
G K
Q
The coordinates of the midpoints of P and R
S
Proof:
are A(2, 3.5) and B(4, 1), respectively. HJ GK HGK JKG
Given Given
28. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
and its measure is one-half the sum of the
measures of the bases. So, the length of AB
is GHJK is a trapezoid. HG JK
given by AB 12 (QR PS). To find the lengths of
Def. of trapezoid CPCTC
the bases, recognize that the bases are the
hypotenuses of two special right triangles, 3-4-5
and 6-8-10. Find AB. GHJK is an isosceles trapezoid.
AB ¬1
2 (QR PS)
Def. of isosceles trapezoid
E
D
2
:
2 , 2
2
5 5
¬(1.5, 3.5)
Segment
Addition
Def. of Def. of
: ¬(1.5, 2.5)
2 2
5 (3) WX XY WP PZ WX WP
F
G
2 , 2 Substitution Subtraction
The coordinates of the midpoints of DE and GF
are W(1.5, 3.5) and V(1.5, 2.5), respectively. PWX is isosceles. WX WP
Def. of isos. Def. of
Chapter 8 274
D
35. Given: E and C are midpoints of A and D
B
. 39. 6
D
AD B R S
Prove: ABCE is an isosceles trapezoid.
D
M P
1 3
E C
2 4
X Y
A B
Proof:
V T
E and C are midpoints 3
of AD and DB. AD DB
Given Given
EC || AB A B
A segment joining the Isos. Th.
midpoints of two sides
of a triangle is parallel
to the third side. A
Extend R V and ST to intersect at A. Since RSTV
2 is suppl. to A, 2 4 is an isoceles trapezoid, R S. So RSA is
4 is suppl. to B. suppl. to isosceles. Then RA . RA RX XA and
SA
Consec. are suppl. are . SA SY YA. Since RA SA and RX SY,
XA YA. By the Converse of the Triangle
Proportionality Theorem, X YRS. Since R
SVT,
ABCE is an isos.
trapezoid. Y
X V T
. Let M and P be the midpoints of R X and
1
Def. of isos. trapezoid Y
S , respectively. Draw M P. RX 2(XV), so 2RX
1
XV. RM MX 2RX. So RM MX XV.
36. Given: ABCD is an isosceles trapezoid.
C
B A
D
Similarly, SP PY YT.
B
AC D
By an argument similar to the one above, MP R
S,
Prove: A D P
M XY, M
PV T. So XY
is the median of
ABC DCB isosceles trapezoid MPTV. And M P is the median
of isosceles trapezoid RSYX.
A 1 1
F B So, MP 2(RS XY) and XY 2(MP VT)
1 1
MP 2(6 XY) XY 2(MP 3)
E C 1
MP 3 2XY
D
Substitute this expression for MP into the second
Proof: Draw auxiliary segments so that B FA D
equation.
E
and C A D
. Since BC
A D
and parallel lines 1 1
are everywhere equidistant, B FC E. XY 2[(3 2XY) 3]
Perpendicular lines form right angles, so BFA 1 1
XY 2(6 2XY)
and CED are right angles. BFA and CED are 1
right triangles by definition. Therefore, XY 3 4XY
3
XY 3
BFA CED by HL. A D by CPCTC. 4
Since CBF and BCE are right angles and all XY 4
right angles are congruent, CBF BCE.
40. It is not possible. Since pairs of base angles of an
ABF DCE by CPCTC. So, ABC DCB
isosceles trapezoid are congruent, if two angles
by angle addition.
are right, all four angles will be right. Then the
37. Sample answer: quadrilateral would be a rectangle, not a
D C trapezoid.
41. Sample answer: Trapezoids are used in
A B monuments as well as other buildings. Answers
38. Sample answer: should include the following.
• Trapezoids have exactly one pair of opposite
2 cm sides parallel.
• Trapezoids can be used as window panes.
42. Quadrilateral WXYZ is a trapezoid because
X
exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, W
and Y Z
.
275 Chapter 8
43. B; points in the shaded region have the following 54. Solve the proportion for y.
characteristics: x 0, y
0, and y 5
3 x 5. The
5 ¬
20
y4 28
only choice that satisfies all three requirements is
B, (1, 3). 5(28) ¬20(y 4)
140 ¬20y 80
60 ¬20y
Page 445 Maintain Your Skills 3 ¬y
44. Opposite angles of a rhombus are congruent, so 55. Solve the proportion for y.
2y 52
QLM ¬QPM. Find x. ¬
9 36
QLM ¬QPM
mQLM ¬mQPM 36(2y) ¬52(9)
2x2 10 ¬8x 72y ¬468
2x2 8x 10 ¬0 13
x2 4x 5 ¬0 y ¬2
(x 5)(x 1) ¬0 56. Find the slope of a segment given the endpoints
x 5 0 or x 1 0 (0, a) and (a, 2a).
x5 x 1 y y
slope of segment ¬
2
1
Chapter 8 276
Page 445 Practice Quiz 2 Opposite sides are parallel. Since one diagonal is
1. BAD is a right angle, so BAC and CAD are vertical and the other is horizontal, they are
complementary. Find x. perpendicular. Since the slopes of consecutive
mBAC mCAD ¬90 sides are not opposite reciprocals, they are not
(2x 1) (5x 5) ¬90 perpendicular. So, MNPQ is a rhombus.
7x ¬84 4. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
x ¬12 and its measure is one-half the sum of the
2. ABD BDC because they are alternate measures of the bases. Find MN.
interior angles. Find y. MN ¬1
2 (TR VS)
ABD ¬BDC ¬1
2 (44 21)
mABD ¬mBDC
¬32.5
y2 ¬3y 10
5. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
y2 3y 10 ¬0
and its measure is one-half the sum of the
(y 5)(y 2) ¬0
measures of the bases. Find VS.
y 5 0 or y 2 0
y5 y 2 MN ¬1
2 (TR VS)
If y 5, mABD 52 or 25. If y 2, mABD 25 ¬1
2 (32 VS)
(2)2 or 4. ABD BAC because they are
base angles of an isosceles triangle, so their 50 ¬32 VS
measures are equal. 18 ¬VS
From Question 1, x 12.
So, mBAC 2(12) 1 or 25, therefore, y is 5.
Reject y 2 because it leads to a contradiction. Page 446 Reading Mathematics: Hierarchy of
3. Polygons
y
4 1. False; all jums are mogs and some mogs are jums.
N
x
Mogs is of a higher class than jums in the
hierarchy.
12 8 4 4
M Q 2. False; both jebs and jums are mogs, but no jebs
4
are jums. Jebs and jums are distinct members of
8 the same class.
P 3. True; all lems are jums because every element of
12 a class is contained within any class linked above
it in a hierarchy diagram.
If opposite sides are parallel, then MNPQ can be
4. True; some wibs are jums and some wibs are jebs.
a rhombus, a rectangle, or a square. If diagonals
Jums and jebs are members of the same class in
are perpendicular, then MNPQ can be a rhombus
the hierarchy. Wibs is a member of the class below
or a square. If consecutive sides are
and is directly linked to both jums and jebs.
perpendicular, then MNPQ is a rectangle or a
square. 5. True; all mogs are bips because every element of a
Use the Slope Formula to determine whether class is contained within any class linked above it
opposite sides are parallel and consecutive sides in a hierarchy diagram.
are perpendicular. 6. All triangles are polygons. Both isosceles and
3 3 scalene triangles are triangles. All equilateral
N
slope of M ¬
5 (2) triangles are isosceles triangles.
¬2 Polygons
9
(3)
Q
slope of P ¬2 1
¬2 Triangles
3 (
3)
Q
slope of N ¬2 1 Isosceles Scalene
¬2
3 (9) Equilateral
P
slope of M ¬
5 (2)
¬2
Use the Slope Formula to determine whether the
diagonals are perpendicular. 8-7 Coordinate Proof With
3 (9) Quadrilaterals
P
slope of N ¬
2 (2)
12
¬0 , which is undefined Page 448 Geometry Software Investigation:
3 (3) Quadrilaterals
Q
slope of M ¬ 5 1
¬0 1. See students’ work.
2. A parallelogram is formed by the midpoints since
the opposite sides are congruent.
277 Chapter 8
Pages 449–450 Check for Understanding 8. Given: D(195, 180), E(765, 180), F(533, 0),
1. Place one vertex at the origin and position the G(195, 0)
figure so another vertex lies on the positive x-axis. Prove: DEFG is a trapezoid.
2. Sample answer: y
y D (195, 180) E(765, 180)
D
C
B O G(195, 0) F(533, 0) x
O A x
Proof:
180 180
3. y E
Slope of D
765 195 or 0
C (a, a b) 0 0
D (0, a b) F
Slope of G
533 195 or 0
0
180 4
5
F
Slope of E
765 533 or 58
0
180
G
Slope of D 195 195 or undefined
E
D and G F
have the same slope, so exactly one
O A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x pair of opposite sides are parallel. Therefore,
4. The quadrilateral is a square. Opposite sides of a DEFG is a trapezoid.
square are congruent and parallel, and its interior
angles are all 90°. So, the x-coordinate of C is a
and the y-coordinate is a. Pages 450–451 Practice and Apply
The coordinates of C are (a, a). 9. y
5. The quadrilateral is a parallelogram. Opposite D (b, c) C (a b, c)
sides of a parallelogram are congruent and
parallel. So, the y-coordinate of D is b.
The length of A B is a, and the length of D
C
is a.
So, the x-coordinate of D is (a c) a or c. O A(0, 0) B(a 2b, 0) x
The coordinates of D are (c, b). 10. y
6. Given: ABCD is a parallelogram. D (a, b) C (c a, b)
Prove: AC and DB bisect each other.
y
D (b, c) C (a b, c) O A(0, 0) B(c, 0) x
11. The quadrilateral is a parallelogram. Opposite
sides of a parallelogram are congruent and
O A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x parallel. So, the y-coordinate of B is c.
Proof: The length of H G is a b , and the length of B
C
C
The midpoint of A 0 (a
¬ 2
b)
, 0
2
c is a b. So, the x-coordinate of B is a (a b)
or b.
¬ 2 , 2
a b c The coordinates of B are (b, c).
12. The quadrilateral is a square. Opposite sides of a
B
The midpoint of D 2 , 2
a b 0c
square are congruent and parallel, and its interior
angles are all 90°. So, the x-coordinate of A is b
¬ 2 , 2
a b c
and the y-coordinate is b, and the
C
A and D
B bisect each other. x-coordinate of E is b and the y-coordinate is b.
The coordinates of A and E are (b, b) and
7. Given: ABCD is a square.
(b, b), respectively.
C
Prove: AD B
y
13. The quadrilateral is a parallelogram. Opposite
C (a, a) sides of a parallelogram are congruent and
D (0, a)
parallel. So, the y-coordinates of E and G are c
and 0, respectively.
The length of H G is a, and the length of E
F
is a.
O A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x So, the x-coordinate of G is a, and the x-coordinate
of E is (a b) a or b.
Proof: The coordinates of G and E are (a, 0) and (b, c),
0 a
B
Slope of D
a 0 or 1
respectively.
0 a 14. The quadrilateral is an isosceles trapezoid. The
C
Slope of A 0 a or 1 top and bottom sides of the trapezoid are parallel,
C
The slope of A is the negative reciprocal of the so the y-coordinate of M is c.
B
slope of D, so they are perpendicular. The length of L M
is a 2b, so the x-coordinate of
M is (a b) (a 2b) or b.
The coordinates of M are (b, c).
Chapter 8 278
15. The quadrilateral is a rectangle. Opposite sides of D
19. Given: isosceles trapezoid ABCD with AB
C
a rectangle are congruent and parallel, and its D
Prove: B A C
interior angles are all 90°. So, the y-coordinates of y
T and W are c and c, respectively. D (b, c) C (a b, c)
The origin is at the center of the rectangle, so the
x-coordinates of T and W are both 2a (the
opposites of the x-coordinates of U and V). O A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x
The coordinates of T and W are (2a, c) and
Proof:
(2a, c), respectively.
BD ¬ (a b
)2 (0 c)2 (a b)2 c2
16. The quadrilateral is an isosceles trapezoid. The
right and left sides of the trapezoid are parallel, AC ¬ ((a
b) 0
)2 (c 0)2 (a b)2 c2
so the x-coordinates of T and S are 0 and a, BD ¬AC and B DA C
respectively. 20. Given: ABCD is a trapezoid with median X Y .
The length of QT is a, so the y-coordinate of T is Y
Prove: X A B
and XYD C
1
2 S
a. The length of R is 2a 2c, so the y
y-coordinate of S is (a c) (2a 2c) or a c. A( b, c) B(a b, c)
The coordinates of T and S are 0, 1
2 a and
X Y
(a, a c), respectively. O D(0, 0) C (a, 0) x
17. Given: ABCD is a rectangle. D
Proof: The midpoint of A is X. The coordinates
C
Prove: ADB
y are
b c
C
2 , 2 . The midpoint of B
2a
is Y
b c
2, 2 .
A(0, b) B(a, b) The slope of A B
0, the slope of X
Y
0 and the
C
slope of D 0. Thus, XY
A B
and XYDC.
21. Given: ABCD is a rectangle.
O D(0, 0) C (a, 0) x Q, R, S, and T are midpoints of their
respective sides.
Proof: Use the Distance Formula to find Prove: QRST is a rhombus.
AC a and BD
2 b2 a2 b2. A
C
and D
B
y C(a, b)
have the same length, so they are congruent. D(0, b) R
18. Given: ABCD and A C
B D
Prove: ABCD is a rectangle. Q S
O
y
A(0, 0) T B(a, 0) x
D (b, c) C (a b, c)
Proof:
O A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x
Midpoint Q is
0
0 b0 b
2 , 2 or 0, 2 .
Midpoint R is 2 , 2 or 2, 2 or 2, b
a 0 bb a 2b a
Proof:
AC (a b 0)2 (c
Midpoint S is 2 , 2 or 2, 2 or a, 2.
0)2 a a b0 2a b b
BD (b a) (c
2 0) 2
2ab ¬2ab
¬
2
b2
or
2
b2
2 2 2 2
4ab ¬0 a a
a 0 or b ¬0
ST
a a2
2 0
¬
2
b2
2 2 2 2
Because A and B are different points, a 0. Then b a
b 0. The slope of A D
is undefined and the slope
QT
2 0
0
2
2 2
B
of A 0. Thus A D
A B. DAB is a right angle a b
and ABCD is a rectangle.
¬
a2
b2
or
2
b2
2 2 2 2
a
QR RS ST QT
R
QR S
S T
QT
QRST is a rhombus.
279 Chapter 8
22. Given: RSTV is a quadrilateral. 24. y
D(c, d)
S
A, B, C, and D are midpoints of sides R,
T
S, T
V, and V
R
, respectively. C(a 4.5, b)
Prove: ABCD is a parallelogram.
y
T (2d, 2b)
S(2a, 2e) O
B A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x
C
A 25. No, there is not enough information given to
O prove that the sides of the tower are parallel.
R(0, 0) D V(2c, 0) x
26. From the information given, we can approximate
Proof: Place quadrilateral RSTV on the the height from the ground to the top level of the
coordinate plane and label coordinates as shown. tower.
(Using coordinates that are multiples of 2 will 27. Sample answer: The coordinate plane is used in
make the computation easier.) By the Midpoint coordinate proofs. The Distance Formula, Midpoint
Formula, the coordinates of A, B, C, and D are Formula and Slope Formula are used to prove
2a theorems. Answers should include the following.
2e
A 2 , 2 ¬(a, e); • Place the figure so one of the vertices is at the
B
2d
2 , 2e
2a
2
2b
¬(d a, e b); origin. Place at least one side of the figure on
the positive x-axis. Keep the figure in the first
C 2d
2
2c ¬(d c, b); and
, 22b quadrant if possible and use coordinates that
will simplify calculations.
D22 , 2 ¬(c, 0).
c 0 • Sample answer: Theorem 8.3: Opposite sides of
a parallelogram are congruent.
B
Find the slopes of A and D
C
. 28. D; ABCD is a parallelogram, so opposite sides are
B
Slope of A C
Slope of D parallel. BCAD and B
C lies along the
y y y y x-axis, so AD
is parallel to the x-axis and is
m ¬2
x x
1
m2
x x
1
2 1 2 1 horizontal. Therefore, D must have the same
(e b) e 0 b y-coordinate as A.
¬
(d a) a
c (d c)
Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent,
b
b b D
so A B C
and AD BC. According to the
¬d d or d
The slopes of AB and DC
are the same so the Distance Formula, BC (x 2 x1)2
(y2
y1)2
segments are parallel. Use the Distance Formula (c b
) 0 c b. So, the length of AD is
2
Chapter 8 280
31. Opposite angles of a rhombus are congruent and Chapter 8 Study Guide and Review
the diagonals of a rhombus bisect opposite angles,
so RMP MPR and their measures are equal.
Since RMP JMK and mJMK 55,
Page 452 Vocabulary and Concept Check
mMPR 55. 1. true
32. KJM and MLK are right angles and JKM 2. true
and KLM are right triangles because the 3. false; rectangle
interior angles of a rectangle are right angles. 4. true
Opposite sides of a rectangle are parallel, so 5. false; trapezoid
LKM JMK and their measures are equal 6. false; rhombus
because they are alternate interior angles.
7. true
Therefore, mLKM 55. The sum of the
measures of the interior angles of a triangle is 8. true
180. Find mKML.
mKLM mLKM mKML ¬180
90 55 mKML ¬180 Pages 452–456 Lesson-by-Lesson Review
mKML ¬35 9. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
33. KLM is a right angle because the interior angles S 180(n 2)
of a rectangle are right angles. Opposite angles of 180(6 2) 720
a rhombus are congruent, so MLP MRP and The measure of an interior angle of a hexagon is
their measures are equal. Therefore, mMLP 70. 72
0
6 or 120.
The measure of KLP is the sum of the measures
10. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
of KLM and MLP. Find mKLP.
S 180(n 2)
mKLP ¬mKLM mMLP
180(15 2) 2340
mKLP ¬90 70
mKLP ¬160 The measure of an interior angle of a regular
234 0
34. Let x represent the geometric mean. 15-gon is
15 or 156.
7 x 11. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
x ¬
1
4 S 180(n 2)
x2 ¬98
180(4 2) 360
x ¬ 98
The measure of an interior angle of a square is
x ¬9.9 36
0
The geometric mean of 7 and 14 is 98 or about 4 or 90.
9.9. 12. Use the Interior Angle Sum Theorem.
35. Let x represent the geometric mean. S 180(n 2)
2 ¬x
5 180(20 2) 3240
x
6 5 The measure of an interior angle of a regular
x2 ¬60 324
20-gon is 0
20 or 162.
x ¬ 60
13. Since n 4, the sum of the measures of the
x ¬7.7 interior angles is 180(4 2) or 360. Write an
The geometric mean of 2 5 and 6 5 is equation to express the sum of the measures of
60
or about 7.7. the interior angles of the polygon.
36. VXY is an exterior angle of WVX. So 360 mW mX mY mZ
mWVX mVXY.
37. VZ and XZ are equal, so V ZX Z
and VXZ is 1
360 2a 8 a (a 28) (a 2)
an isosceles triangle. The base angles of an 7
360 2a 18
isosceles triangle are congruent, so XVZ
VXZ and mXVZ mVXZ. 378 7
2a
38. WYV XYV because they are the same angle. 108 a
VXY and XYV are two interior angles of Use the value of a to find the measure of each angle.
VXY. The side of VXY opposite VXY
measures 6 6 or 12. The side of VXY opposite mW 1
2 (108) 8 or 62, mX 108, mY
XYV measures 8. According to Theorem 5.9, if 108 28 or 80, and mZ 108 2 or 110.
one side of a triangle is longer than another side,
then the angle opposite the longer side has a
greater measure than the angle opposite the
shorter side. Therefore, mXYV mVXY.
39. Z
X X Z
and VZY Z. XY VX, so
mXZY mXZV by the SSS Inequality
Theorem.
281 Chapter 8
14. Since n 5, the sum of the measures of the AD ¬ [2 (1)]2
[5 2
(2)]
interior angles is 180(5 2) or 540. Write an ¬
50
equation to express the sum of the measures of
BC ¬ (4 6
)2 [4 2
(3)]
the interior angles of the polygon.
¬
53
540 mA mB mC mD mE
540 (x 27) (1.5x 3) (x 25) AD BC, so ABCD is not a parallelogram.
(2x 22) x 22. Yes;
540 6.5x 33 y
507 6.5x
12
78 x
Use the value of x to find the measure of each 8
angle. J K
mA 78 27 or 105, mB 1.5 78 3 or 4
120, mC 78 25 or 103, mD 2 78 22 or H L
x
134, and mE 78.
4 8 12
15. BCD BAD because opposite angles in a
parallelogram are congruent. Find mBAD. If the midpoints of the diagonals are the same,
mBAD mCAD mBAC the diagonals bisect each other. If the diagonals of
20 32 a quadrilateral bisect each other, then the
52 quadrilateral is a parallelogram.
So, mBCD 52. Find the midpoints of HK and J
L.
16. The diagonals of a parallelogram bisect each
other, so AF and CF are equal. Therefore, AF 7.
K
H 0
:
5 46
5
2 , 2 ¬ 2, 5
Chapter 8 282
24. The diagonals of a rectangle bisect each other and S
So, RT V
and S
TV R. Use the Distance
are congruent, so AF 1
2 AC.
Formula to determine whether the diagonals of
quadrilateral RSTV are congruent.
AF ¬1
2 AC RT ¬ (0 4 )2 (0
7)2
2x 7 ¬1
2 (26) ¬ 16 4 9
2x ¬13 7 ¬ 65
x ¬3 SV ¬
[6 (2)] 2 (3 4)2
So, AF 2(3) 7 or 13. ¬ 64 1
25. The diagonals of a rectangle are congruent and ¬ 65
bisect each other. So, the triangles formed by the Since the opposite sides are parallel and the
diagonals of a rectangle are isosceles. Therefore, diagonals are congruent, RSTV is a rectangle.
2 1 and m2 52.
30. The diagonals of a rhombus bisect the angles, so
26. The diagonals of a rectangle bisect each other and 1 2. Find x.
are congruent, so CF
D F. Find x. 1 ¬2
¬D
CF F m1 ¬m2
CF ¬DF 2x 20 ¬5x 4
4x 1 ¬x 13 24 ¬3x
3x ¬12 8 ¬x
x ¬4 31. The diagonals of a rhombus bisect each other, so
27. The interior angles of rectangles are right angles, AF 1 1
2 AC 2 (15) or 7.5.
and the sum of the measures of the interior 32. The diagonals of a rhombus are perpendicular, so
angles of a triangle is 180. So, the sum of the m3 is 90. Find y.
measures of 2 and 5 is 90. Find m5. m3 ¬90
m2 m5 ¬90 y2 26 ¬90
(70 4x) (18x 8) ¬90 y2 ¬64
14x ¬28 y ¬8 or 8
x ¬2
33. C
B AD, so ADY and BCY are supplementary.
So, m5 18(2) 8 or 28.
Find mBCY.
S
28. Find the slopes of R , S
T
, T
V, and VR
. mBCY mADY ¬180
5
(5)
S
slope of R ¬3 0 mBCY 78 ¬180
¬0 mBCY ¬102
5 4 Both pairs of base angles of an isosceles trapezoid
T
slope of S ¬
0 (3) are congruent, so XBC BCY and mXBC
¬3 102.
4
4 34. The median of a trapezoid is parallel to the bases,
V
slope of T ¬
30
and its measure is one-half the sum of the
¬0 measures of the bases. Find JM.
4 (
5)
R
slope of V ¬ AB ¬1
2 (KL JM)
0 (3)
¬3
57 ¬1
2 (21 JM)
The slopes of consecutive sides are not negative
reciprocals, so consecutive sides are not 114 ¬21 JM
perpendicular. Therefore, RSTV is not a rectangle. 93 ¬JM
(Note: S T V
R
so RSTV is not even a 35. Given: ABCD is a square.
parallelogram. So it is not a rectangle.) C
Prove: A B D
29. If the opposite sides of a quadrilateral are parallel y
and the diagonals of the quadrilateral are C(a, a)
D(0, a)
congruent, then the quadrilateral is a rectangle.
Find the slopes of RS
, S
T, T
V
, and V
R
.
0
3
S
slope of R ¬
06 O A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x
¬1
2 Proof:
7
4 a 0
V
slope of T ¬ C
Slope of A
4 (2) a 0 or 1
¬1
a 0
2 D
Slope of B
0 a or 1
3
7 C
is the negative reciprocal of the
T
slope of S ¬
64
The slope of A
D
slope of B. Therefore, A
C
B D
.
¬2
40
R
slope of V ¬
2
0
¬2
283 Chapter 8
36. Given: ABCD is a y If the midpoints of the diagonals are the same,
parallelogram. D(b, c) C (a b, c) the diagonals bisect each other. If the diagonals of
Prove: ABC CDA a quadrilateral bisect each other, then the
quadrilateral is a parallelogram.
Find the midpoints of AC and B
D.
Proof:
O A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x
C
A
4
: 4
2 ,
3 (8)
2
4, 5
2
AB (a 0
)2 (0
0)2 a2 02 or a
:
D
B 6
2
2 ,
4, 5
0 (5)
DC
[(a
b) b]
2 (c
c)2
a2 02 or a 2 2
AD
(b 0
)2 (c
0)2
b2 c2 The midpoints of AC
and BD
are the same, so the
diagonals bisect each other and ABCD is a
BC
[(a
b) a
]2 (c
0)2
b2 c2
parallelogram.
AB and DC have the same measure, so A B
D C. 9. Yes;
AD and BC have the same measure, so A D
B C.
y
C
A A C by the Reflexive Property. Therefore, 12
ABC CDA by SSS. T
37. The quadrilateral is an isosceles trapezoid. The 8 V
top and bottom sides of the trapezoid are parallel, S
4
so the y-coordinate of P is c.
The length of M N is 4a, so the x-coordinate of P is W x
4a a or 3a. 8 4
O
4 8
The coordinates of P are (3a, c). 4
38. The quadrilateral is a parallelogram. Opposite
sides of a parallelogram are congruent and First use the Distance Formula to determine
parallel. So, the y-coordinate of U is c. whether the opposite sides are congruent.
The length of V W
is b (a) or a b. So the ST ¬ (2 2)2
(6 11)2
U
length of T is also a b. So, the x-coordinate of ¬ 41
U is (a b) 0 or a b.
VW ¬ [3 (
1)]2
(8 3)2
The coordinates of U are (a b, c).
¬ 41
Since ST VW, S TV W.
Next, use the Slope Formula to determine
Chapter 8 Practice Test whether S T
V W
.
6
11
T
slope of S ¬
2 2
Page 457
1. true ¬5
4
8
3
2. false; 3. false; W
slope of V ¬
3 (1)
¬5
4
ST and V
W have the same slope, so they are
parallel. Since one pair of opposite sides is
congruent and parallel STVW is a parallelogram.
4.
HKF G
because opposite sides of parallelograms 10. No;
are congruent. y
8
5. FKJ HGJ because alternate interior angles
are congruent. 4 H
J
6. FKH FGH because opposite angles of x
parallelograms are congruent. O
8 12
H
7. G F K
because opposite sides of parallelograms 4
G
are parallel. F
8. Yes; 8
y
If both pairs of opposite sides of a quadrilateral
4 are congruent, then the quadrilateral is a
A
B x parallelogram. Use the Distance Formula to
O determine whether the opposite sides are
4 8 12
4 D congruent.
8
C
Chapter 8 284
FG ¬ (7 4
)2 [ 2
3 (2)] 14. y
8
¬ 10 D
HJ ¬ (6 1
2)2
(4 2
)2 4
¬ 40 C A
GH ¬ (4 6)
2 (
2 4)2 O 4 8 12 x
¬ 40 4
FJ ¬ (7 1
2)2
(3 2)2
8 B
¬ 50
Since the measures of both pairs of opposite sides If the four sides are congruent, then
are not equal, they are not congruent. Therefore, parallelogram ABCD is either a rhombus or a
FGHJ is not a parallelogram. square. If consecutive sides are perpendicular,
11. Yes; then ABCD is a rectangle or a square.
y Y Use the Distance Formula to compare the lengths
X of the sides.
AB ¬ (12 6)2 2
[0 (6)]
¬ 36 36
Z ¬6 2
W BC ¬ (6 0)2 (
6 0)2
x
¬ 36 36
O
¬6 2
CD ¬ (0 6)2 (0
6)2
If both pairs of opposite sides of a quadrilateral
are congruent, then the quadrilateral is a ¬ 36 36
parallelogram. Use the Distance Formula to ¬6 2
determine whether the opposite sides are AD ¬ (12 6)2 (0 6
)2
congruent. ¬ 36 36
WX ¬ [4 (3)]2 (2 6)2 ¬6 2
¬ 17 Use the Slope Formula to determine whether the
YZ ¬ (2 1)2 (7 3)2 consecutive sides are perpendicular.
¬ 17 B
slope of A 0 (
¬ 6)
12 6
XY ¬ (3 2)2 (6 7)2
¬1
¬ 26
0
6
WZ ¬ (4 1)2 (2 3)2 C
slope of B ¬60
¬ 26 ¬1
Since the measures of both pairs of opposite sides 0
6
D
slope of C ¬
06
are equal, they are congruent. Therefore, WXYZ is
a parallelogram. ¬1
12. The diagonals of a rectangle bisect each other, so 06
D
slope of A ¬
12 6
P
Q P S. Find x.
P
Q ¬P
S ¬1
QP ¬PS Since the slopes of AB
and CD are negative
3x 11 ¬4x 8 C
reciprocals of the slopes of B and AD
,
3 ¬x consecutive sides are perpendicular. The lengths
Find QS. of the four sides are the same, so the sides are
QS QP PS congruent. Therefore, ABCD is a rectangle, a
(3x 11) (4x 8) rhombus, and a square.
7x 19
7(3) 19
40
So, QS 40.
13. Opposite sides of a rectangle are parallel, so
QTR SRT because they are alternate
interior angles. Find x2.
QTR ¬SRT
mQTR ¬mSRT
2x2 7 x2 ¬18
x2 ¬25
So, mQTR 2(25) 7 or 43.
285 Chapter 8
15. y 17. y
12
8 D(?, ?) C(?, ?)
B
A C
D
O x A(0, 0) x
4 8 12
4 b X a Y b B(a 2b, 0)
Chapter 8 286
Chapter 8 Standardized Test Practice 8. Set y equal to zero to find the x-coordinate at
which the graph crosses the x-axis.
y ¬4x 5
Pages 458–459 0 ¬4x 5
1. C; the length of the ramp is the hypotenuse of a 4x ¬5
right triangle with legs measuring 3 meters and 5
x ¬5
4
meters. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
length of the hypotenuse. The point at which the graph crosses the x-axis is
c ¬ a
2 b2
54, 0.
¬ 3 52
2
9. If one side of a triangle is longer than another
¬ 34 side, then the angle opposite the longer side has a
¬6 greater measure than the angle opposite the
To the nearest meter, the length of the ramp shorter side. The side representing the path from
should be 6 m. Candace’s house to the theater is opposite a 55°
angle, and the side representing the path from
2. D; the contrapositive of the statement “If an
Julio’s house to the theater is opposite a 40°
astronaut is in orbit, then he or she is weightless”
angle. Since 55
40, Julio’s house is closer to the
is “If an astronaut is not weightless, then he or
theater.
she is not in orbit.”
D
10. C is the altitude of right triangle ABC so, by
3. B; for the two rectangles to be similar, the
Theorem 7.2, its measure is the geometric mean
measures of their corresponding sides must
between the segments of the hypotenuse.
proportional. The ratio of the length to the width
Let x CD
of QRST is 7
4 or 7 : 4. The ratios of the choices, 4
x ¬
x
25
28 21
7 14
7 7
14 2, 12 4 , 4 2 , and 8 .
from A to D, are:
11. The sides of a rhombus are congruent, so A C
The dimensions, 21 cm by 12 cm, could be the separates rhombus ABCD into two isosceles
dimensions of a rectangle similar to QRST. triangles. The base angles of an isosceles triangle
4. C; the ladder, wall, and ground form a 30°-60°-90° are congruent, so ACD CAD.
right triangle. The ladder is the hypotenuse, the CDE is an exterior angle of ACD so mCDE
wall is the longer leg, and the ground is the mCAD mACD.
shorter leg. In a 30°-60°-90° triangle, the length of Substituting mACD for mCAD,
the hypotenuse is twice the length of the shorter 116 mACD mACD
leg, and the length of the longer leg is 3 times 116 2(mACD)
the length of the shorter leg. So, the shorter leg is 58 mACD
24 12a. MNR and PQR are both right angles and all
2 or 12 ft, and the longer leg is 12
3 ft. The
ladder reaches 12 3 ft up the side of the house. right angles are congruent, so MNR PQR.
Since congruence of angles is reflexive, R
5. B; the diagonals of a rectangle are congruent, so
R. MNR is similar to PQR because two
L
J K M. Find x.
angles are congruent (AA Similarity).
L
J ¬K
M
JL ¬KM 12b. The ratios of corresponding sides of similar
2x 5 ¬4x 11 MR PR
polygons are the same, so
MN
QP.
16 ¬2x
a
400 40
0
The proportion is 126 120 . Solve for a.
8 ¬x
6. C; the diagonals of a rhombus bisect each other a
400 40
0
126 ¬ 120
but are not necessarily congruent.
7. A; the bases of a trapezoid are parallel, so AB is
40
400 a ¬126 0
120
D
parallel to C . a ¬420 400
a ¬20
The distance across the sand trap, a, is 20 yards.
287 Chapter 8
c0 c
13a. Given: quadrilateral ABCD C
13b. The slope of A is a b 0 or
a b.
Prove: ABCD is a parallelogram c 0 c
D
The slope of B is
b a or
b a.
y
c c
D (b, c) C (a b, c) The product of the slopes is a b ba
c2
b2 a2 . Since c a b , the product of the
2 2 2
a
2 2
b
O A(0, 0) B(a, 0) x b2 a2 or 1, so the diagonals of ABCD
slopes is
Proof: are perpendicular.
c 0 c
D
The slope of A is C
b 0 or b . The slope of B is 13c. Since the diagonals are perpendicular, ABCD is a
c 0 c rhombus.
b D and B C
have the same slope
or . A
aba
so they are parallel.
AD (b 0)
2 (c 0)2 b .
2 c2
BC (a b a)
2 (c
0) b
2 .
2 c2
Chapter 8 288
Chapter 9 Transformations
Page 461 Getting Started 9. sin A ¬2
3
1. y A ¬sin1 2
3
A ¬41.8°
B( 1, 3) A(1, 3) The measure of angle A is approximately 41.8.
10. sin A ¬4
5
O x A ¬sin14
5
A ¬53.1°
2. y
The measure of angle A is approximately 53.1.
C( 3, 2) 9
11. cos A ¬12
O x A ¬cos1 9
12
A ¬41.4°
D( 3, 2) The measure of angle A is approximately 41.4.
15
3. y 12. cos A ¬17
A ¬cos117
15
E( 2, 1) A ¬28.1°
The measure of angle A is approximately 28.1.
O x
F( 1, 2)
13.
0 1
1 1
5
5 1
4
0(4) 1(1)
0(5)
1(5) (1)(5) 1(4) (1)(1)
1(5)
5 1
5
4. y
10
G(2, 5)
1 0
14.
1 1 2 3
0 2
15.
1 0 2 5 1
5. J( 7, 10) y 0 1 3 4 5
8
K( 6, 7)
1(3)0(2) 1(4)0(5) 1(5)0(1)
0(3)1(2) 0(4)1(5) 0(5)1(1)
4
2 5 1
12 8 4 O x 3 4 5
6. y
16. 10 10 13 3 3 2
1 2 1
1( 1) 0(3) 1( 3) 0( 1) 1( 3) 0( 2) 1(2) 0(1)
¬
0( 1) ( 1)(3) 0( 3) ( 1)( 1) 0( 3) ( 1)( 2) 0(2) ( 1)(1)
O x
3 3 2
L(3, 2) 31 1 2 1
M(6, 4)
Page 462 Geometry Activity: Transformations
7. tan A ¬3
4
1. Rotation; the figure has been turned around a
A ¬tan1 34 point.
A ¬36.9° 2. Dilation; the figure has been enlarged.
The measure of angle A is approximately 36.9. 3. Reflection or rotation; the figure has either been
8. tan A ¬5
8
flipped over a line or turned around a point.
A ¬tan15
8
4. Translation; the figure has been slid down and to
the left.
A ¬32.0°
The measure of angle A is approximately 32.0. 5. Dilation; the figure has been reduced.
6. Reflection; the figure has been flipped over a line.
7. Translation; the figure has been slid down and to
the left.
289 Chapter 9
8. Reflection or rotation; the figure has either been 8. y A
flipped over a line or turned around a point. B
9. Reflection; the figure has been flipped over a line.
10. Reflection; the figure has been flipped over a line.
11. Rotation, reflection, and translation result in an O x
image that is congruent to its preimage. They are
isometries.
B
A
9. A y A
9-1 Reflections
Chapter 9 290
Pages 467–469 Practice and Apply 25. Draw perpendiculars from P, R, S, T, and U to
15. X is on line , so it is its own reflection. Y is the line . Locate P, R, S, T, and U so that line is
image of W under a reflection in line . So, X Y
is the perpendicular bisector of P P
, R
R
, S
S
, T
T
,
the image of W X under a reflection in line . and UU. P, R, S, T, and U are the respective
images of P, R, S, T, and U. Connect vertices P,
16. Z is on line , so it is its own reflection. Y is the
R, S, T, and U.
image of W under a reflection in line . So, Y Z
is
the image of W Z under a reflection in line .
17. X and Z are on line , so they are their own S S
reflections. W is the image of Y under a reflection R R
in line . So, XZW is the image of XZY under a T T
reflection in line .
P U U P
18. T is on line m, so it is its own reflection.
19. U is on line m, so it is its own reflection. V is the 26. Since W is on line , W is its own reflection. Draw
image of Y under a reflection in line m. So, V U is segments perpendicular to line from X, Y, and Z.
the image of U Y under a reflection in line m. Locate X, Y, and Z so that is the
20. V is the image of Y, Y is the image of V, and X is perpendicular bisector of XX, Y
Y
, and Z
Z
. X,
the image of W under a reflection in line m. Y, and Z are the respective images of X, Y, and
So, VYX is the image of YVW under a reflection Z. Connect vertices W, X, Y, and Z.
in line m.
X Y
21. T is the image of U under a reflection in point Z.
22. U is the image of T, V is the image of X, and Z is
its own image under a reflection in point Z. So,
UVZ is the image of TXZ under a reflection in W
point Z. Z
PM Q N
B E
C D
291 Chapter 9
28. Plot rectangle GHIJ. Since G G
passes through y yx
the origin, use the horizontal and vertical B
C
distances from G to the origin to find G. From G
to the origin is 2 units up and 2 units to the right.
G is located by repeating that pattern from the
origin. Two units up and 2 units to the right O B
yields G(2, 2). x
G(2, 2) → G(2, 2) I(3, 3) → I(3, 3) D
D C
H(2, 0) → H(2, 0) J(2, 4) → J(2, 4)
J y
32. Plot KLM. Use the vertical grid lines to find a
I
corresponding point for each vertex so that the
G
line y 2 is equidistant from each vertex and its
H image. For K(4, 0), the vertical distance to the line
O H x y 2 is 2. To plot K, move up 2 units on the
vertical gridline so the image of K is K(4, 4).
G K(4, 0) → K(4, 4)
I L(2, 4) → L(2, 0)
J M(2, 1) → M(2, 3)
29. Plot square QRST. Use the vertical grid lines to y
find a corresponding point for each vertex so that L K
the x-axis is equidistant from each vertex and its
image. M
Q(1, 4) → Q(1, 4) S(3, 2) → S(3, 2) M
R(2, 5) → R(2, 5) T(0, 1) → T(0, 1) O K x
L
y R
Q
Chapter 9 292
y 41. Undo the reflections in turn. A(4, 7), B(10, 3),
X X and C(6, 8). Reflection in the origin: multiply
both coordinates by 1: (a, b) → (a, b):
A(4, 7), B(10, 3), and C(6, 8). Reflection in
Y Y the y-axis: multiply the x-coordinate by 1:
(a, b) → (a, b): A(4, 7), B(10, 3), and
O x
C(6, 8).
Z Z Reflection in the x-axis: multiply the y-coordinate
by 1 (a, b) → (a, b): A(4, 7), B(10, 3), and
C(6, 8).
35. 2; The figure has two lines of symmetry, each Undoing the transformations results in the
passing through opposite vertices. triangle ABC.
Yes; the figure has point symmetry with respect
42.
to its center.
36. 8; The figure has eight lines of symmetry, each cue ball
passing through opposite vertices.
Yes; the figure has point symmetry with respect eight ball
to its center.
37. 1; The figure has one line of symmetry, which reflected
passes horizontally through the center. pocket
No; the figure has no common point of reflection
and, thus, no point symmetry.
38. The preimage and final image have the same
shape and the same orientation.
m n 43. Consider point (a, b). Upon reflection in the
origin, its image is (a, b). Upon reflection in
the x-axis and then the y-axis, its image is
(a, b) → (a, b). The images are the same.
44. The diamond has numerous lines of symmetry,
39. The preimage and final image have the same including vertical and horizontal lines of
shape, but the final image is turned or rotated symmetry. It has a point of symmetry at the
with respect to the preimage. center.
n 45. The diamond has a vertical line of symmetry,
m
passing through its center.
46. The diamond has a vertical line of symmetry,
passing through its center.
47. The diamond has a vertical line of symmetry and
a horizontal line of symmetry. It has a point of
40. Apply the reflections in turn. D(1, 4), E(2, 8), symmetry at the center.
F(6, 5), and G(3, 1). Reflection in the x-axis: 48. Sample answer: Reflections of the surrounding
Multiply the y-coordinates by 1: (a, b) → vistas can be seen in bodies of water. Answers
(a, b): D(1, 4), E(2, 8), F(6, 5), and should include the following.
G(3, 1). Reflection in the line y x: Interchange • Three examples of line symmetry in nature are
the x- and y- coordinates (a, b) → (b, a): the water’s edge in a lake, the line through the
D(4, 1), E(8, 2), F(5, 6), and G(1, 3). middle of a pin oak leaf, and the lines of a four
y E yx leaf clover.
8
F • Each point above the water has a
D F corresponding point in the image in the lake.
E G The distance of a point above the water appears
G x
the same as the distance of the image below the
8 O G 8 water.
D
D
F
8
E
293 Chapter 9
49. D; x-axis reflection: (2, 5) → (2, 5) and 53. BE is the measure of the median of the trapezoid.
y-axis reflection: (2, 5) → (2, 5) AF CD
BE ¬ 2
or reflection in the origin: (2, 5) → (2, 5) 32 48
¬
50. B; a c ¬2a b 2c 2
25 45 ¬2(25) 18 2(45) ¬40
25 45 ¬158 AF
54. BE ¬ CD
2
32 48
¬ 2
Page 469 Maintain Your Skills ¬40
51. Given: Quadrilateral LMNP BE CD
XY ¬ 2
X, Y, Z, and W are midpoints of 40 48
¬
their respective sides. 2
W
Prove: Y and X Z bisect each other. ¬44
AF CD
y 55. BE ¬ 2
M(2d, 2e) 32 48
Y ¬ 2
N(2a, 2c)
X ¬40
Z AF BE
WZ ¬ 2
32 40
L(0, 0) W P(2b, 0) x ¬ 2
Proof: ¬36
is 2d
, 2e 56. mF mG mH ¬180
2 or
2a 2c
Midpoint Y of M N 2 mF 53 71 ¬180
(d a, e c). mF ¬56
2a
Midpoint Z of N is
P 2 , 2c 2
2b 0
or (a b, c). Use the Law of Sines to write a proportion
0 2b 0 0
is
L
Midpoint W of P 2 , 2 or (b, 0).
to find g.
sinF sinG
0 2d 0 2e f ¬g
is 2,
M
Midpoint X of L 2 or (d, e).
dab ec0 ¬fsinG
Midpoint of W is 2,
Y 2 or
g ¬
sinF
abdce
2, 2.
48
g ¬ sin
53°
sin 56°
d ab
is
Z
Midpoint of X 2 , e
2 or
c g ¬46.2
a bd Use the Law of Sines again to find the measure of
2 , c
2. X
e
Z
and W
Y
bisect each other. the third side.
52. Given: Isosceles trapezoid sinF sinH
f ¬h
D
A B C y fsinH
H, J, K, and G D(b, c) J C(a b, c) h ¬
sinF
are midpoints 48sin71°
of their
H K h ¬ sin56°
respective h ¬54.7
A(0, 0) G B(a, 0) x
sides. Therefore, mF 56, g 46.2, and h 54.7.
Prove: GHJK is a rhombus. 57. mF mG mH ¬180
Proof: 59 45 mH ¬180
a 2 2
b
2 2ab a
2 c2
mH ¬76
HJ b2 2 2 c ¬
c 2 ;
Use the Law of Sines to write a proportion
to find f.
GK 2
2c
2a b 2 2
2 a 0 sinG sinF
g ¬f
b
2 2ab a2
c2 gsinF
¬ 2 ; f ¬
sinG
b2 a2
2 0
b
2
ab a 21sin
59°
2 2 2 c
2 2
f ¬
HG c
¬ 2 ; sin45°
f ¬25.5
KJ 2
2 2 c
2a b a 2 c 2
b
2 2ab a2
c2
¬ 2 ;
HJ GK HG KJ, so HJ
G
K
H
G
K
J
and GHJK is a rhombus.
Chapter 9 294
Use the Law of Sines again to find the measure of
the third side. 9-2 Translations
G
sin sinH
g ¬ h
gsinH Page 472 Check for Understanding
h ¬
sinG 1. Sample answer: A(3, 5) and B(4, 7); start at 3,
21
h ¬ sin
76° count to the left to 4, which is 7 units to the left
sin45° or 7. Then count up 2 units from 5 to 7 or 2.
h ¬28.8 The translation from A to B is (x, y) →
Therefore, mH 76, f 25.5, and h 28.8. (x 7, y 2).
58. We know two sides and the measure of the angle 2. The properties that are preserved include
opposite one of the sides. Use the Law of Sines to betweenness of points, collinearity, and angle and
find the measure of the second angle. distance measure. Since translations are
composites of two reflections, all translations are
F
sin sinH
f ¬ h
isometries. Thus, all properties preserved by
fsinH reflections are preserved by translations.
sinF ¬
h 3. Allie; counting from the point (2, 1) to (1, 1) is
fsinH
F ¬sin1 right 3 and down 2 to the image. The reflections
h
would be too far to the right. The image would be
F ¬sin 13.n261°
1 14.5si
reversed as well.
F ¬74° 4. Yes; GHI is a translation of ABC. DEF is the
So, mF 74. image of ABC when ABC is reflected in line
Use the Angle Sum Theorem to find the measure m, and GHI is the image of DEF when DEF
of angle G. is reflected in line n.
mF mG mH ¬180 5. No; quadrilateral WXYZ is oriented differently
74 mG 61 ¬180 than quadrilateral NPQR.
mG ¬45 6. This translation moved every point of the
Use the Law of Sines and a proportion to find g. preimage 1 unit right and 3 units up.
H
sin sinG D(3, 4) → D(3 1, 4 3) or D(2, 1)
h ¬g
hsin G E(4, 2) → E(4 1, 2 3) or E(5, 5)
g ¬
sinH Graph D and E and connect. Graph D and E and
13.2sin 45° connect.
g ¬
sin61°
y E
g ¬10.7
Therefore, mF 74, mG 45, and g 10.7.
d ¬
(x
E
59. 2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
EF ¬
(2 3
)2 [0
(1
)]2
EF ¬
(1)
2
12 O x
D
EF ¬
2
60. d ¬
(x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
D
FG ¬
(3 2
)2 (3
0)2
7. This translation moved every point of the
FG ¬
1
2 32
preimage 3 units to the left and 4 units down.
FG ¬
10
K(5, 2) → K(5 3, 2 4) or K(2, 6)
61. d ¬
(x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 L(3, 1) → L(3 3, 1 4) or L(6, 5)
GH ¬
(5 3)
2 (4
3)2 M(0, 5) → M(0 3, 5 4) or M(3, 1)
GH ¬
22 12 Graph K, L, and M and connect to form KLM.
GH ¬
5
Graph K, L, and M to form KLM.
y
62. d ¬
(x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 8
HE ¬
(3 5)
2 (
1 4)2 M
4
HE ¬
(2)2
(5
)2 M
O
HE ¬
29
8 4 4 8x
L K
4
L K
8
295 Chapter 9
8. 1 → 2 (x, y 3) 18. This translation moved every point of the
2 → 3 (x 4, y) preimage 2 units to the right and 1 unit down.
3 → 4 (x 4, y) E(0, 4) → E(0 2, 4 1) or E(2, 5)
F(4, 4) → F(4 2, 4 1) or F(2, 5)
G(0, 2) → G(0 2, 2 1) or G(2, 1)
Pages 472–475 Practice and Apply Plot the vertices of the preimage and the image
9. Yes; it is one reflection after another with respect and connect the respective vertices to form the
to the two parallel lines. preimage and the image.
10. No; it is a reflection followed by a translation. y
11. No; it is a reflection followed by a rotation. G
12. No; it is a reflection followed by a translation. G
O x
13. Yes; it is one reflection after another with respect
to the two parallel lines.
14. No; it is a reflection followed by a translation. F E
15. For each endpoint of P Q
move left 3 units and up F
4 units to find the image. Connect P and Q. E
y
8 19. This translation moved every point of the
Q preimage 5 units to the left and 3 units up.
4 Q P(1, 4) → P(1 5, 4 3) or P(4, 7)
P Q(1, 4) → Q(1 5, 4 3) or Q(6, 7)
4 O 4 8 x
R(2, 4) → R(2 5, 4 3) or R(7, 1)
4 S(2, 4) → S(2 5, 4 3) or S(3, 1)
P
Plot the vertices of the preimage and the image
8
and connect the respective vertices to form the
B
16. For each endpoint of A move right 4 units and preimage and the image.
down 2 units. Connect A and B. Q P y
y
8
A
Q P
4 A
8 4 O 4 8x
4 O x
B B R S
8
Chapter 9 296
21. As a translation, the bishop moves left 3 squares y
and down 7 squares. 8
W
22. Sample answers: pawn: up two squares; rook: left
4 T
four squares; knight: down two squares, right y=1 Y
1 square; bishop: up three squares, right three Y
squares; queen: up five squares; king: right 8 4 T 4 8 x
1 square W
4
y = 4
23. Four triangle lengths is equivalent to a T
translation of 48 in. right. 8
Y
24. Two triangle lengths left and four triangle lengths
up and left (60° angle above horizontal) form one Examine: Notice that the image of W(7, 4) is
leg and the hypotenuse of a right triangle. Use W(7, 6) or point D. The line y 1 is equidistant
the Pythagorean Theorem to find the other leg from these points. The image of Y(9, 0) is Y(9, 2)
(direction up). or G. Again, the line y 1 is equidistant from
c2 ¬a2 b2 these points. So, two possible parallel lines are
(4 12)2 ¬a2 (2 12)2 y 4 and y 1.
2304 ¬a2 576 27. This translation moved every point of the
1728 ¬a2 preimage 2 units to the right and 4 units down.
24
3 ¬a
P(3, 2) → P(3 2, 2 4) or P(1, 6)
41.6 ¬a
Q(1, 4) → Q(1 2, 4 4) or Q(1, 0)
The translation is 24
3 41.6 in. up and 24 in. R(2, 2) → R(2 2, 2 4) or R(4, 6)
left.
Q y
25. The red line represents a translation of six
triangle lengths right and four triangle heights
down. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
triangle height. Q
c2 ¬a2 b2 O x
2
122 ¬a2 2
12 R
P
144 ¬a2 36
108 ¬a2
6
3 ¬a
Six lengths: 6(12) 72 P R
Four heights: 4(6
3 ) 24
3 41.6
The translation is 72 in. right and 28. First reflect RST in the line y 2. Use the
24
3 41.6 in. down. vertical grid lines to find images of the vertices
that are the same distance from y 2 as the
26. Sample answer:
preimage.
Explore: We are looking for two parallel lines
R(4, 1) → R(4, 5) R
such that TWY is reflected over each line to
S(1, 3) → S(1, 1) S, T y
result in the image BDG.
T(1, 1) → T(1, 3)
Plan: Once we choose any line to be the first
parallel line, there is only one possible line for the
second parallel line. x
Solve: Choose y 4 for the first parallel line. T, S
Use the vertical grid lines to determine the R
vertices of the image that are the same distance
from y 4 as the preimage. Since the
y-coordinate of W is 4, W is its own image.
T(3, 7) → T(3, 1)
Next reflect RST S y
Y(9, 8) → Y(9, 0)
over the line y 2
Now we need to find a line such that a reflection to get RST.
over that line has an image of BDG. We are R(4, 5) → R(4, 9)
looking for a line that is equidistant between S(1, 1) → S(1, 5) T
TWY and BDG. We are only looking at the T(1, 3) → T(1, 7) O x
y-coordinates. R
T(3, 1) → B(3, 3). The distance between the
y-coordinates is 1 3 4 so the parallel line S
that lies halfway between is 2 units above the line
y 1 or y 1.
T
R
297 Chapter 9
80
%
29. To find the image, “undo” the translation. To undo 33. 9 8.89% per person
(x 4, y 5), add 4 to the x-coordinate and 78
%
8 9.75% per person
subtract 5 from the y-coordinate.
A(8, 5) → A(8 4, 5 5) or A(4, 0) 70
%
7 10% per person
B(2, 7) → B(2 4, 7 5) or B(6, 2) 62
%
7 8.86% per person
C(3, 1) → C(3 4, 1 5) or C(7, 4)
y No; the percent per figure is different in each
category.
8 B
34. Sample answer: Every time a band member takes
A a step, he or she moves a fixed amount in a
4 B certain direction. This is a translation. Answers
A should include the following.
8 4 O C 8x • When a band member takes a step forward,
4 backward, left, right, or on a diagonal, this is a
C translation.
• To move in a rectangular pattern, the band
30. In order to find the coordinates of H and N we member starting at (0, 0) could move to (0, 5).
find the transformation from vertex F to vertex M. Moving from (0, 5) to (4, 5), from (4, 5) to (4, 0)
F(3, 9) → M(4, 2) and from (4, 0) back to the origin, the band
The translation in the x-direction is 1 unit to member would have completed the rectangle.
the right. The translation in the y-direction is
35. Translations and reflections preserve the
7 units down.
congruences of lengths and angles. The
G(1, 4) → N(x1, y1)
composition of the two transformations will
→ N(1 1, 4 7) or N (0, 3)
preserve both congruences. Therefore, a glide
H(x2, y2) → P(6, 3)
reflection is an isometry.
Undo the transformation by subtracting one and
adding 7. So the coordinates of H are 36. First, find the vertices of the image after the
H(6 1, 3 7) or H(5, 4). translation (x, y) → (x, y 2).
D(4, 3) → (4, 3 2) or (4, 1)
y F E(2, 2) → (2, 2 2) or (2, 4)
F(0, 1) → (0, 1 2) or (0, 1)
Now reflect the image in the y-axis. Use the
formula (a, b) → (a, b).
G (4, 1) → D(4, 1)
H (2, 4) → E(2, 4)
M (0, 1) → F(0, 1)
y
O x D
D F
N P F
x
The coordinate form of the translation
is (x, y) → (x 1, y 7). E
31. The categories that show a boy-girl-boy unit
translated within the bar are “more brains” and E
“more free time”.
32. “More friends” and “more athletic ability” are the
categories that show a boy-girl-boy unit reflected
(about a vertical line) within the bar.
Chapter 9 298
37. First, find the vertices of the image after the 41. Draw perpendiculars from P, R, S, T, and U
translation (x, y) → (x 3, y). to line m. Locate P, R, S, T, and U so that line
A(3, 2) → (3 3, 2) or (0, 2) m is the perpendicular bisector of P P
, R
R
, S
S
,
B(1, 3) → (1 3, 3) or (2, 3) T
T , and U
U. Points P, R, S, T, and U are the
C(2, 1) → (2 3, 1) or (5, 1) respective images of P, R, S, T, and U. Connect
Now reflect the image over the line y 1. vertices P, R, S, T, and U.
Use the horizontal grid lines to find the vertices S
of ABC such that each vertex of the image is
the same distance from the line y 1 as its T
preimage.
U
(0, 2) → A(0, 4)
(2, 3) → B(2, 5) R
(5, 1) → C(5, 3) P
m
y B P
A R
C
y=1 U
T
C x
A S
B
42. Since D is on line m, D is its own reflection.
Draw perpendiculars from E, F, G, H, and I
38. C; X(5, 4) → X(3, 1) X(5 2, 4 3) to line m. Locate E, F, G, H, and I so that line
So, (x, y) → (x 2, y 3). m is the perpendicular bisector of E E
, F
F
, G
G,
Y(3 2, 1 3) ¬Y(1, 4) H
H , and II. Points E, F, G, H, and I are the
Z(0 2, 2 3) ¬Z(2, 1) respective images of E, F, G, H, and I. Connect
y y vertices D, E, F, G, H, and I.
39. A; m ¬
2
1
x2 x1
H
1 5
¬
2 (2)
6 G
¬4 I m
F
¬3
2
E I
299 Chapter 9
45. Find the opposite side of the triangle, y. x 4 ¬x 2
y 6 ¬2x
tan 45° ¬
6 3 ¬x
6tan 45° ¬y
y ¬(3) 4
6 ¬y
¬3 4
Six yards is 18 feet. So, the height of the tree is
¬1
5 18 or 23 ft.
46. A certain shopper is not greeted when he walks The point of intersection is (3, 1).
through the door. Find the distance between the two points of
47. You did not fill out an application. intersection, (0, 4) and (3, 1).
48. y6 d ¬
(x2
x1)2 (y2 y1)2
49. The two lines are not parallel. ¬
(3 0)
2 [1 (4)]2
50. x 2 and x 5 are vertical lines. The distance ¬
99
between them can be measured along any ¬3
2
horizontal segment connecting them. The distance The distance between the lines is 3
2.
is 5 (2) 7. 54.
51. y 6 and y 1 are horizontal lines. The 30
distance between them can be measured along
any vertical segment between them. The distance 55.
is 6 (1) 5.
45
52. Let line be y 2x 3 and line m be y 2x 7.
The slope of the parallel lines is 2. The slope of a 56.
line perpendicular to the parallel lines is the
1
opposite reciprocal of 2, or 2. Use the y-intercept
52
of line m, (0, 7), as one of the endpoints of the
perpendicular segment, P. Find P. 57.
P: y y1 ¬m(x x1)
1
y (7) ¬2(x 0) 60
y 7 ¬1
2x
1 58.
y ¬2x 7
105
Solve the system of the equations of lines P and
to find where they intersect.
59.
1
2 x 7 ¬2x 3
150
x 14 ¬4x 6
5x ¬20
x ¬4
y ¬1(4) 7
2
¬2 7 9-3 Rotations
¬5
The point of intersection is (4, 5).
Page 477 Geometry Software Investigation:
Find the distance between the two points of
intersection, (0, 7) and (4, 5).
Reflections in Intersecting Lines
1. See students’ figures.
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2
2. The transformation is a rotation about P.
¬
(4 0)2 [5 (7)]2
3. See students’ work.
¬
16 4 4. See students’ work. The angle measure should be
¬2
5 twice the measure of the acute angle formed by
The distance between the lines is 2
5 . the intersecting lines.
53. Let line be y x 2 and line m be y x 4. 5. See students’ work. The angle measures should be
The slope of the parallel lines is 1. The slope of a the same as mAPA in Exercise 4.
line perpendicular to the parallel lines is the
6. Sample answer: The measure of the angle of
opposite reciprocal of 1, or 1. Use the y-intercept
rotation is twice the measure of the acute angle
of line m, (0, 4), as one of the endpoints of the
formed by the intersecting lines.
perpendicular segment, P. Find P.
P: y y1 ¬m(x x1)
y (4) ¬1(x 0)
y 4 ¬x
y ¬x 4
Solve the system of the equations of lines P and
to find where they intersect.
Chapter 9 300
Pages 478–479 Check for Understanding 5. First reflect parallelogram ABCD in line . Next,
1. Sample answer: reflect the image in line m. Parallelogram
y ABCD is the image of parallelogram ABCD
C under reflections in lines and m.
B m
A
O 90 x
A C B
A
B D C
B
ABC has vertices A(1, 0), B(4, 2), and C(2, 3).
A
ABC has vertices A(0, 1), B(2, 4), and C
C(3, 2). D
For a clockwise rotation of 90 degrees about the
origin, (x, y) → (y, x).
B C
B y
C
B A D
C 90
A 6. First reflect quadrilateral DEFG in line . Since E
O A x and F are on , each point is its own image. Next,
reflect the image in line m. Quadrilateral
DEF G is the image of quadrilateral DEFG
under reflections in lines and m.
ABC has vertices A(1, 0), B(4, 2), and C(2, 3).
D
ABC has vertices A(0, 1), B(2, 4), and
E
C(3, 2). For a counterclockwise rotation of 90
degrees about the origin, (x, y) → (y, x).
G m
2. A rotation image can be found by reflecting the
image in a line, then reflecting that image in a D
second of two intersecting lines. The second F
method is to rotate each point of the given figure G
using the angle of rotation twice the angle formed G
between the intersecting lines. Use the D
intersection point of the two lines as the point of
rotation. F
B
G
C 60 Y(0, 3)
Y
45
O x
B
301 Chapter 9
8. First graph PQR. Draw a segment from the
origin O to point P. Use a protractor to measure a E
90° angle counterclockwise with OP as one side. B R F
Draw OX. Use a compass to copy OP onto
OX. 110
Name the segment O P. Repeat with points Q and
C F D
R. PQR is the image of PQR under a 90°
counterclockwise rotation about the origin. B
P(1, 8) y C
D E
4
Q (2, 4) 13. Draw a segment from Q to M. Use a protractor to
measure a 180° angle counterclockwise with QM
P (8, 1) 90 as one side. Draw
QX. Use a compass to copy QM
12 4 O x
4 8
onto
QX. Name the segment Q M. Repeat with
Q (4, 2)
4 points N and P. MNP is the image of MNP
R (7, 4)
R(4, 7) under a 180° counterclockwise rotation about
8 point Q.
M
9. The regular hexagon has rotational symmetry of N P
order 6 because there are 6 rotations less than Q
360° (including 0 degrees) that produce an image
indistinguishable from the original. 180˚
360°
magnitude ¬ ord
er
P N
M
360°
¬ 6 14. First graph XYZ and point P. Draw a segment
¬60°
from point P to point X. Use a protractor to
The magnitude of the symmetry is 60°.
measure a 90° angle counterclockwise with P X
as
10. The regular octagon has rotational symmetry of one side. Draw
PR. Use a compass to copy P X
order 8 because there are 8 rotations less than . Name the segment P
onto PR X
. Repeat with
360° (including 0 degrees) that produce an image points Y and Z. XYZ is the image of XYZ
indistinguishable from the original. under a 90° counterclockwise rotation about
360°
magnitude ¬ order point P.
36
0° y Z
¬8 Y
¬45°
The magnitude of the symmetry is 45°. Z
11. The left, center, and right fans have rotational P X Y
symmetry of orders 5, 4, and 3, respectively, 90
because there are 5, 4, and 3 rotations less than o x
360° (including 0 degrees) that produce images X
indistinguishable from the originals.
The magnitude of the symmetry is given by 15. First graph RST and point P. Draw a segment
360°
order . So, the magnitudes of the symmetries from point P to point R. Use a protractor to
for the left, center, and right fans are 72°, 90°, and measure a 90° angle clockwise with PR as one
120°, respectively. . Use a compass to copy P
side. Draw PX R
onto
. Name the segment P
PX R
. Repeat with points
S and T. RST is the image of RST under a
Pages 479–481 Practice and Apply 90° clockwise rotation about point P.
12. Draw a segment from R to B. Use a protractor to y T
measure a 110° angle counterclockwise with RB
as one side. Draw B
RX. Use a compass to copy R R 90
onto
RX. Name the segment R B
. Repeat with
points C, D, E, and F. Pentagon BCDEF is the T
image of pentagon BCDEF under a 110° R S
O x
counterclockwise rotation about point R.
S
Chapter 9 302
16. The Ferris wheel has rotational symmetry of 23. M y L
order 20 because there are 20 rotations less than
360° (including 0 degrees) that produce an image M
indistinguishable from the original.
360°
magnitude ¬
order O K x
36
0°
¬20 L
¬18°
The magnitude of the symmetry is 18°.
K
17. From Exercise 16, the magnitude of the
symmetry is 18°. Seat 1 is moved 4 positions, Reflection in line y x: K(5, 0) → K(0, 5)
or 4(18°) 72°. L(2, 4) → L(4, 2)
18. From Exercise 16, the magnitude of the symmetry M(2, 4) → M(4, 2)
is 18°. Divide 144° by the magnitude of the Reflection in x-axis: K(0, 5) → K(0, 5)
rotational symmetry. L(4, 2) → L(4, 2)
M(4, 2) → M(4, 2)
144°
18° 8 positions
The angle of rotation is 90° clockwise.
Seat 1 is moved 8 positions, or to the original 24. y
Z Y
position of seat 9.
19. m
Y t
X
Z X' O X x
X Z'
Y'
Y Z
Reflection in line y x: X(5, 0) → X(0, 5)
20. S' P' Y(3, 4) → Y(4, 3)
m t Z(3, 4) → Z(4, 3)
R' Q' R S Reflection in line y x: X(0, 5) → X(5, 0)
Y(4, 3) → Y(3, 4)
Q P Z(4, 3) → Z(3, 4)
The angle of rotation is 180°.
25. y
21. J K t ( 3 , 1)
N L
M
30˚
x
(2, 0)
M' N'
L' J'
K'
m
22. y x 2cos 30°
U
3
V y 2sin 30°
1
T , 1).
The coordinates of the image are (
3
O T x
V
U
303 Chapter 9
26. The CD changer has rotational symmetry of order 44. Reflection is an indirect isometry because the
5 because there are 5 rotations less than 360° image of the transformed figure cannot be found
(including 0 degrees) that produce an image by moving it intact within the plane.
indistinguishable from the original. 45. Translation is a direct isometry because the
360°
magnitude
ord
er
image of the transformed figure is found by
moving it intact within the plane.
36
0°
¬5 46. Rotation is a direct isometry because the image of
¬72° the transformed figure is found by moving it
The magnitude of the symmetry is 72°. intact within the plane.
27. Yes; it is a proper successive reflection with
respect to the two intersecting lines.
28. Yes; it is a proper successive reflection with Page 482 Maintain Your Skills
respect to the two intersecting lines. 47. Yes; it is one reflection after another with respect
29. Yes; the teacups are rotating. to the two parallel lines.
30. Yes; the scrambler is rotating. 48. No; it is a rotation followed by a reflection with
31. No; the roller coaster is not rotating. respect to line a.
32. The letters H, I, N, O, S, X, and Z produce the 49. Yes; it is one reflection after another with respect
same letter after being rotated 180°. to the two parallel lines.
36
0° 50. C is the image of A in a reflection across line p.
40°/reflection 9 reflections
33.
G is its own image. So, the image of A G
reflected
34. Angles of rotation with measures 90 or 180 would
G
across line p is C .
be easier on a coordinate plane because of the
grids used in graphing. 51. C is the image of F reflected across point G.
35. In each case, y-coordinates become x-coordinates 52. H is the image of E reflected across line q. G is its
and the opposite of the x-coordinates become own image. So, the image of G E
reflected across
y-coordinates, or (x, y) → (y, x). H
line q is G .
36. The 80° clockwise rotation and then 53. A and F are the images of C and D, respectively,
150° counterclockwise rotation about the origin is in a reflection across line p. G is its own image.
equivalent to a 70° counterclockwise rotation. So, the image of CGD reflected across line
p is AGF.
37. Any point on the line of reflection is invariant.
38. The center of rotation is the only invariant point. R
54. Q P S because opposite sides are parallel.
39. There are no invariant points. Every point is T
55. P T R because diagonals bisect each other.
translated a units in the x-direction and b units 56. SQR QSP because alternate interior angles
in the y-direction. are congruent.
40. Sample answer: The Tilt-A-Whirl sends riders 57. QPS QRS because opposite angles are
tipping and spinning on a circular track. Answers congruent.
should include the following. 58. Let y be the opposite side of the right triangle
• The Tilt-A-Whirl shows rotation in two ways. formed by the eye of the surveyor, the top of the
The cars rotate about the center of the ride as building, and the side of the building at the eye
the cars go around the track. Each car rotates level of the surveyor (100 meters from the eye).
around a pivot point in the car.
tan 23° ¬y
• Answers will vary but the Scrambler, Teacups, 100
and many kiddie rides use rotation. 100tan 23° ¬y
360° 42.45 ¬y
41. B; the central angle of the octagon is 8 45°.
So, the height of the building is about
The triangle is moved three positions clockwise, or 42.45 1.55 44.0 m.
3(45)° 135°.
59. Use the triangle inequality.
5 y and y 3 z, so x 5 3 z 15 z, or
42. D; x 2
1 2 1 2 ?
6 8 16
15 15 14
16 no
z 2 x 2 (6) 45.
43. 60. Use the triangle inequality.
Transformation reflection translation rotation ?
12 17 20
angle measure yes yes yes 29 20 yes
61. Use the triangle inequality.
betweenness ?
yes yes yes 22 23 37
of points
45 37 yes
orientation no yes no 62. 180a 360
36
0
collinearity yes yes yes a ¬
180
distance a ¬2
yes yes yes
measure
Chapter 9 304
63. 180a 90b ¬360 Page 482 Practice Quiz 1
2a b ¬4 1. For a reflection in the origin, (a, b) → (a, b)
b ¬2a 4 D(1, 1) → D(1, 1)
Use a table. E(1, 4) → E(1, 4)
a b F(3, 2) → F(3, 2)
0 4 y E
1 2
2 0 F
D
Three values are (0, 4), (1, 2), and (2, 0). O x
D
64. 135a 45b ¬360 F
3a b ¬8
b ¬3a 8
Use a table. E
a b 2. For a reflection in the line y x, (a, b) → (b, a)
0 8 A(0, 2) → A(2, 0)
B(2, 2) → B(2, 2)
1 5
C(3, 0) → C(0, 3)
2 2 D(1, 1) → D(1, 1)
Three values are (0, 8), (1, 5), and (2, 2). y
65. 120a 30b ¬360 C
B
4a b ¬12 A B
b ¬4a 12
D C
Use a table. O x
A
a b D
0 12
1 8
2 4 3. The translation moved each endpoint 3 units to
3 0 the left and 4 units up.
P(1, 4) → P(1 3, 4 4) or P(2, 0)
Four values are (0, 12), (1, 8), (2, 4), and (3, 0).
Q(4, 1) → Q(4 3, 1 4) or Q(1, 3)
66. 180a 60b ¬360
y
3a b ¬6
b ¬3a 6 Q
Use a table.
a b O
P x
0 6
Q
1 3
2 0
P
Three values are (0, 6), (1, 3), and (2, 0).
4. The translation moved each vertex 1 unit to the
67. 180a 30b ¬360
right and 4 units down.
6a b ¬12
K(2, 0) → K(2 1, 0 4) or K(1, 4)
b ¬6a 12
L(4, 2) → L(4 1, 2 4) or L(3, 2)
Use a table.
M(0, 4) → M(0 1, 4 4) or M(1, 0)
a b y
0 12 M
1 6 L
2 0 O M
Three values are (0, 12), (1, 6), and (2, 0). K x
L
305 Chapter 9
5. The 36-horse carousel has rotational symmetry of 4. Let m1 represent one interior angle of the
order 36 because there are 36 rotations less than regular decagon. Use the Interior Angle Formula.
360° (including 0 degrees) that produce an image 180(n 2)
m1 n
indistinguishable from the original.
180(10 2)
36
magnitude ¬ 0° ¬ 10
order
36
0° ¬144
¬36 Since 144 is not a factor of 360, a decagon will not
¬10° tessellate the plane.
The magnitude of the symmetry is 10°. 5. Let m1 represent one interior angle of the
regular decagon. Use the Interior Angle Formula.
180(n 2)
m1 n
9-4 Tessellations 180(30
¬ 2)
30
¬168
Page 483 Geometry Activity: Tessellations of Since 168 is not a factor of 360, a decagon will not
Regular Polygons tessellate the plane.
1. equilateral triangle, square, and hexagon 6. Yes; Use the algebraic method to determine
whether a semi-regular tessellation can be
2. The measure of an interior angle of an equilateral
created using squares and triangles of side length
triangle is 60; of a square, 90; of a hexagon, 120.
1 unit.
The sum of the measures of the angles at each
Each interior angle of a square measures 90°, and
vertex must be 360. The expressions are:
each interior angle of a triangle measures 60°.
6(60) 360; 4(90) 360; 3(120) 360.
Find whole number values for h and t so that
3. The measure of an interior angle of a pentagon is 90h 60t 360.
108; of a heptagon, about 128.57; of an octagon, Let h 2.
135. 90(2) 60t ¬360
36
0 1 360 36
0 2 180 60t ¬360
108 3 3 ; 128.57 2.8; 135 2 3
60t ¬180
108, 128.57, and 135 are not factors of 360, so the
t ¬3
pentagon, the heptagon, and the octagon do not
When h 2 and t 3, there are two squares with
tessellate the plane.
three triangles at each vertex.
Regular Measure of Does It
Polygon One Interior Angle Tessellate? 60
60 60
triangle 60 yes 90 90
square 90 yes
pentagon 108 no 7. Yes; Use the algebraic method to determine
hexagon 120 yes whether a semi-regular tessellation can be
created using squares and octagons of side length
heptagon 128.57 no
1 unit.
octagon 135 no Each interior angle of a square measures 90°, and
each interior angle of an octagon measures
4. If a regular polygon has an interior angle with a 180(8 2)
or 135°.
measure that is a factor of 360, then the polygon 8
will tessellate the plane. Find whole number values for h and t so that
90h 135t 360.
Pages 485–486 Check for Understanding Let h 1.
90(1) 135t ¬360
1. Semi-regular tessellations contain two or more
90 135t ¬360
regular polygons, but uniform tessellations can be
135t ¬270
any combination of shapes.
t ¬2
2. Sample answer: When h 1 and t 2, there is one square with
two octagons at each vertex.
90
135 135
Chapter 9 306
8. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the 16. No; let m1 represent one interior angle of the
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°. regular 36-gon. Use the Interior Angle Formula.
The tessellation is uniform because at every 180(n 2)
m1 n
vertex there is the same combination of shapes
180(36 2)
and angles. ¬
36
9. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the ¬170
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°. Since 170 is not a factor of 360, a 36-gon will not
The tessellation is not uniform because the tessellate the plane.
number of angles at the vertices varies. 17. No; A rhombus is not a regular polygon, so a semi-
10. Each “postage stamp” is a square that has been regular tessellation cannot be created from
tessellated and 90 is a factor of 360. It is a regular octagons and rhombi.
regular tessellation since only one polygon is 18. Yes; Use the algebraic method to determine
used. whether a semi-regular tessellation can be
created using regular dodecagons and equilateral
triangles of side length 1 unit.
Pages 486–487 Practice and Apply Each interior angle of a dodecagon measures
180(12 2)
11. No; let m1 represent one interior angle of the or 150°, and each interior angle of an
12
regular nonagon. Use the Interior Angle Formula. equilateral triangle measures 60°.
180(n 2)
m1 n
Find whole number values for h and t so that
150h 60t 360.
180(9 2)
¬ 9 Let h 2.
¬140 150(2) 60t ¬360
Since 140 is not a factor of 360, a nonagon will 300 60t ¬360
not tessellate the plane. 60t ¬60
t ¬1
12. Yes; let m1 represent one interior angle of the
When h 2 and t 1, there are two dodecagons
regular nonagon. Use the Interior Angle Formula.
with one triangle at each vertex.
180(n 2)
m1 n
180(6 2)
¬ 6
¬120 60 150
Since 120 is a factor of 360, a hexagon will
tessellate the plane. 150
13. Yes; let m1 represent one interior angle of the
equilateral triangle. Use the Interior Angle
Formula.
180(n 2)
m1 n
19. Yes; Use the algebraic method to determine
whether a semi-regular tessellation can be
180(3 2)
¬ 3 created using regular dodecagons, squares, and
¬60 equilateral triangles of side length 1 unit.
Since 60 is a factor of 360, an equilateral triangle Each interior angle of a dodecagon measures
180(12 2)
will tessellate the plane. or 150°, and each interior angle of
12
14. No; let m1 represent one interior angle of the squares and equilateral triangles measures
regular dodecagon. Use the Interior Angle 90° and 60°, respectively.
Formula. Find whole number values for h, s, and t so that
180(n 2) 150h 90s 60t 360.
m1 n Let h 1 and s 1.
180(12 2) 150(1) 90(1) 60t ¬360
¬ 1
2
¬150 150 90 60t ¬360
60t ¬120
Since 150 is not a factor of 360, a dodecagon will
t ¬2
not tessellate the plane.
When h 1, s 1, and t 2, there are one
15. No; let m1 represent one interior angle of the dodecagon, one square, and two triangles at each
regular 23-gon. Use the Interior Angle Formula. vertex.
180(n 2)
m1 n 60
180(23 2) 60
¬ 2
3
90
¬164.3 150
Since 164.3 is not a factor of 360, a 23-gon will
not tessellate the plane.
307 Chapter 9
20. No; Use the algebraic method to determine 23. yes; tessellation:
whether a semi-regular tessellation can be
created using regular heptagons, squares, and
equilateral triangles of side length 1 unit.
Each interior angle of a heptagon measures
180(7 2) 900
7 7 or approximately 128.6°, and
each interior angle of squares and equilateral
triangles measures 90° and 60°, respectively.
Find whole number values for h, s, and t so that
The pattern is a tessellation because at the
90
0
7 h 90s 60t 360.
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°.
Let s 1 and t 1. The tessellation is not uniform because the
90
0 number of angles at the vertices varies.
7 h 90(1) 60(1) 360
24. No; use the algebraic method to determine
90
0
7 h 90 60 ¬360
whether the combination of a regular pentagon
90
0 and a square with equal side length tessellates
7 h ¬210
the plane.
h ¬1.63
Each interior angle of a square measures 90°, and
Let s 1 and t 2. each interior angle of a pentagon measures
90
0
7 h 90(1) 60(2) 360
180(5 2)
5 or 108°.
90
0
7 h 90 120 ¬360
Find whole number values for h and t so that
90
0 90h 108t 360.
7 h ¬150
Let h 1.
h ¬1.17
90(1) 108t 360
Let s 2 and t 1. 90 108t ¬360
90
0
7 h 90(2) 60(1) 360 108t ¬270
90
0 t ¬2.5
7 h 180 60 ¬360
Let h 2.
90
0
7 h ¬120
90(2) 108t 360
h ¬0.93 180 108t ¬360
There are no more reasonable possibilities. So, a 108t ¬180
semi-regular tessellation cannot be created from t ¬1.67
regular heptagons, squares, and equilateral Let h 3.
triangles. 90(3) 108t 360
21. yes; tessellation: 270 108t ¬360
108t ¬90
t ¬0.83
No combination of a regular pentagon and a
square with equal side length can be formed such
that the total of the measures of the angles at a
vertex is 360°. So, the combination does not
The pattern is a tessellation because at the tessellate the plane.
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°. 25. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the
The tessellation is uniform because at every different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°.
vertex there is the same combination of shapes The tessellation is not uniform because the
and angles. number of angles at the vertices varies.
22. yes; tessellation: 26. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°.
The tessellation is not uniform because the
number of angles at the vertices varies.
27. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°.
The tessellation is uniform because at every
vertex there is the same combination of shapes
and angles. The tessellation is also regular since
The pattern is a tessellation because at the it is formed by only one type of regular polygon.
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°. 28. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the
The tessellation is uniform because at every different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°.
vertex there is the same combination of shapes The tessellation is uniform because at every
and angles. vertex there is the same combination of shapes
and angles. The tessellation is also semi-regular
since more than one regular polygon is used.
Chapter 9 308
360(12 2) 180 180(10) 180
29. The tessellation is semi-regular since more than 41. A; 12 12
2(12) 12
one regular polygon is used. The tessellation is 1800 180
also uniform because at every vertex there is the ¬
12
same combination of shapes and angles. 1620
¬
12
30. Always; the sum of the measures of the interior
angles of a triangle is 180°. If each angle is used ¬135
twice at each vertex, the sum of the angles is
360°.
31. Never; semi-regular tessellations have the same Page 488 Maintain Your Skills
combination of shapes and angles at each vertex 42. First graph ABC and point P. Draw a segment
like uniform tessellations. The shapes for semi- from point P to point A. Use a protractor to
regular tessellations are just regular. measure a 90° angle counterclockwise with P A
as
. Use a compass to copy P
one side. Draw PR A
32. Sometimes; when the combination of shapes are . Name the segment P
onto PR A
. Repeat with
regular polygons, then the uniform tessellation
points B and C. ABC is the image of ABC
becomes semi-regular.
under a 90° counterclockwise rotation about
33. Always; the sum of the measures of the angles of point P.
a quadrilateral is 360°. So if each angle of the
y
quadrilateral is rotated at the vertex, then that A (1, 12)
equals 360 and the tessellation is possible.
34. Never; the measure of an interior angle is 8
180(16 2) B (6, 6)
or 157.5, which is not a factor of 360.
16 90 4 A
35. Yes; the measure of each angle is 90°. PO x
36. None of these; the tessellation is not uniform 4 C 8
C (2, 0)
because the number of angles at the vertices
varies. It is not regular since more than one
B
polygon is used. It is not semi-regular since not
all of the polygons are regular. 43. First graph DEF and point P. Draw a segment
37. The tessellation is uniform because at every from point P to point D. Use a protractor to
vertex there is the same combination of shapes measure a 90° angle clockwise with PD as one
. Use a compass to copy P
side. Draw PR D
onto
and angles. The tessellation is also regular since
PR. Name the segment P D
. Repeat with points E
only one regular polygon is used.
and F. DEF is the image of DEF under a
38. Sample answers:
90° clockwise rotation about point P.
y F
D
90 x
135 135 O F (8, 1)
90
90 90 P
E
309 Chapter 9
45. First graph rectangle KLMN and point P. Draw a 50. 12, 16, 20
segment from point P to point K. Use a protractor Since the measure of the longest side is 20,
to measure a 90° angle counterclockwise with PK
20 must be c, and a and b are 12 and 16.
. Use a compass to copy P
as one side. Draw PR K
a2 b2 ¬c2
. Name the segment P
onto PR K
. Repeat with 122 162 ¬202
points L, M, and N. Rectangle KLMN is the 144 256 ¬400
image of KLMN under a 90° counterclockwise 400 ¬400
rotation about point P. These segments form the sides of a right triangle
y since they satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem. The
M (2, 9) measures are whole numbers and form a
8 Pythagorean triple.
L 4 L N (6, 3)
51. 9, 10, 15
(5, 5) Since the measure of the longest side is 15,
PO M x 15 must be c, and a and b are 9 and 10.
4 4 8 a2 b2 ¬c2
90 K
4 (3, 1) 92 102 ¬152
K 81 100 ¬225
8 181 ¬225
N
Since 181 225, segments with these measures
46. The move is a translation 15 feet out from the cannot form a right triangle. Therefore, they do
wall and 21 feet to the left, then a rotation of not form a Pythagorean triple.
90° clockwise. 52. 2.5, 6, 6.5
47. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent. Since the measure of the longest side is 6.5,
Set the expressions for opposite sides equal and 6.5 must be c, and a and b are 2.5 and 6.
solve. a2 b2 ¬c2
y y2 2.52 62 ¬6.52
0 y2 y 6.25 36 ¬42.25
0 y(y 1) 42.25 ¬42.25
0 y or 0 y 1 Since 42.25 42.25, segments with these
y0 y1 measures form a right triangle. However, only one
Since y represents a side length, which must be of the three numbers is a whole number.
positive, y 1. Therefore, they do not form a Pythagorean triple.
6x ¬4x 8 53. 14, 14
3, 28
2x ¬8 Since the measure of the longest side is 28,
x ¬4 28 must be c, and a and b are 14 and 14
3 .
So, when x is 4 and y is 1, the quadrilateral is a a2 b2 ¬c2
parallelogram. 142 (14
3 )2 ¬282
48. Opposite sides of a parallelogram are congruent. 196 588 ¬784
Set the expressions for opposite sides equal and 784 ¬784
solve. Since 784 784, segments with these measures
5y ¬2y 36 form a right triangle. However, only two of the
3y ¬36 three numbers are whole numbers. Therefore,
y ¬12 they do not form a Pythagorean triple.
6x 2 ¬64 54. 14, 48, 50
6x ¬66 Since the measure of the longest side is 50,
x ¬11 50 must be c, and a and b are 14 and 48.
So, when x is 11 and y is 12, the quadrilateral is a a2 b2 ¬c2
parallelogram. 142 482 ¬502
49. Opposite angles of a parallelogram are congruent 196 2304 ¬2500
and the sum of its interior angles is 360°. 2500 ¬2500
2x 8 ¬120 These segments form the sides of a right triangle
2x ¬112 since they satisfy the Pythagorean Theorem. The
x ¬56 measures are whole numbers and form a
120 120 2(5y) ¬360 Pythagorean triple.
10y ¬120
y ¬12
So, when x is 56 and y is 12, the quadrilateral is a
parallelogram.
Chapter 9 310
55. 1
1 1
2, 3, 4 59. y Q
Since the measure of the longest side
is 1
1 1 1
2 , 2 must be c, and a and b are 3 and 4 .
a2 b2 ¬c2 R
2 2 2 P
13 14 ¬12
1 1
1
1
6 ¬4
x
9
25 1
14 4 ¬4
S
25 1 From Exercise 58, slope of PQ
1 slope of
Since 144 4, segments with these measures S
R 1, slope of Q
R
1, and slope of P
S 1.
cannot form a right triangle. Therefore, they do Since the product of the slopes of adjacent sides
not form a Pythagorean triple. of quadrilateral PQRS is 1, the adjacent sides
56. By the Triangle Midsegment Theorem, are perpendicular.
B
AE and AB 1
F C
2 EF, BD and BC 1
F
2 DF,
60. y Q
and ACDE and AC 1
2 DE. So, EF 30,
DF 22, DE 26, and the perimeter
is 30 22 26 78. R
P
57. By the Triangle Midsegment Theorem,
AB FC, AC 1
2 DE, and BC DA. So, AB 7,
x
BC 10, and AC 9. S
58. y Q Use the distance formula to find the length of
each side.
d ¬
(x
2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2
R PQ ¬
(1 5)2 (6 2)2
P ¬
(4)
2 42
x
¬
32
QR ¬
(3 1)2 (2 6)2
S ¬
(4)
2 (4 )2
Q
P and R
S
are opposite sides. ¬
32
y y RS ¬
[1 (3)]2
(2 2)2
Q
slope of P ¬
x
2
x
1
¬
4 2 (
2 1
6
2 4)2
¬
15 ¬
32
4
¬
4 PS ¬
(1 5)2 ( 2 2)2
¬1 ¬
(4)
2 (4 )2
2 2 ¬
32
S
slope of R ¬
1 (
3)
4 61. The measures of the sides of quadrilateral PQRS
¬4 are equal. Opposite sides are parallel and
¬1 adjacent sides are perpendicular. PQRS is a
R
Q and P
S
are opposite sides. square.
26
R
slope of Q ¬
3
1
62. Corresponding sides of similar polygons are
4 proportional.
¬
4 AB
scale factor ¬
WX
¬1
8
2 2 ¬
S
slope of P ¬15
12
4 ¬2
¬
4
3
¬1 The scale factor is 2
3.
The opposite sides of quadrilateral PQRS have
the same slopes. Therefore, the sides are parallel.
311 Chapter 9
AB 8 2
63. The scale factor is
WX 12 3.
The ratios of the measures of the corresponding 9-5 Dilations
sides of similar polygons are equal.
AB BC
WX ¬XY
Pages 493–494 Check for Understanding
2
¬10
X
1. Dilations only preserve length if the scale factor is
3 Y
3 1 or 1. So for any other scale factor, length is not
XY ¬ 2 (10)
preserved and the dilation is not an isometry.
XY ¬15 2. Sample answer:
AB 8 2
64. The scale factor is
WX 12 3. A B
The ratios of the measures of the corresponding
sides of similar polygons are equal. A B
AB CD A B
WX ¬YZ
2 10
¬
3 YZ D C
YZ ¬32
(10) D C
YZ ¬15 D C
AB 8 2
65. The scale factor is
WX 12 3. 3. Trey; Desiree found the image using a positive
The ratios of the measures of the corresponding scale factor.
sides of similar polygons are equal.
4. Since |4| 1, the dilation is an enlargement.
AB AD , CW
, CV
, and CU. Since r is positive,
X ¬
W W Z Draw CX
2 ¬ 15
X, W, V, and U will lie on the continuation of
3 WZ the sides of the quadrilateral.
3
WZ ¬ 2 (15)
Locate X, W, V, and U so that CX 4(CX),
CW 4(CW), CV 4(CV), and CU 4(CU).
WZ ¬22.5
Draw quadrilateral XWVU.
5. Since
1
5
1, the dilation is a reduction. Draw
, CR
CP , CS , CT
, CU
, CV
. Locate P, R, S, T, U,
CV 1
5 (CV). Draw hexagon PRSTUV.
R
4.
P S
R S
5. P T
C
V U
V T
Chapter 9 312
6. Since |2| 1, the dilation is an enlargement. 10. Find K, L, and M using the scale factor, r 3.
Draw C E, C
D
, C
G, and CF. Since r is negative,
Preimage Image
E, D, G, and F will lie on rays that are opposite (x, y) (3x, 3y)
to
CE,
CD,
CG, and
CF, respectively. Locate E,
D, G, and F so that CE 2(CE), CD 2(CD), K(5, 8) K(15, 24)
CG 2(CG), and CF 2(CF). Draw L(3, 4) L(9, 12)
quadrilateral EDGF.
E M(1, 6) M(3, 18)
D y K
24
L
12 K
L
F
24 12 12 24 x
12
M
G
M
C
G 24
F
11. For ease, compare diagonals of the figures.
D image length
E scale factor ¬
preimage length
7. AB 3, r 4 8 un
r ¬ its
Use the Dilation Theorem. 4 units
AB |r|(AB) r ¬2
AB (4)(3) Since the scale factor is greater than 1, the
AB 12 dilation is an enlargement.
8. AB 8, r 2
5
12. Compare the vertical sides of the triangles.
image length
Use the Dilation Theorem. scale factor ¬
preimage length
AB ¬|r|(AB) 4 un
its
r ¬
8 ¬2
5 (AB)
6 units
r ¬2
20 ¬AB 3
9. Find P and Q using the scale factor, r 1
Since 0 |r| 1, the dilation is a reduction.
3.
13. C; The drawing and the garden are similar.
Image 12ft x
18 ft ¬ 8 in.
Preimage
y
(x, y) x3,
3 2 ¬ x
3 8 in.
P(9, 0) P(3, 0) 5 1
3 in. ¬x
Q(0, 6) Q(0, 2)
y
Pages 494–496 Practice and Apply
Q
14. Since |3| 1, the dilation is an enlargement.
Draw CX,
CY, and
CZ. Since r is positive, X, Y,
Q and Z will lie on the continuation of the sides of
the triangle.
Locate X, Y, and Z so that CX 3(CX),
O P P x CY 3(CY), and CZ 3(CZ). Draw XYZ.
X X
C
Y Z
Y Z
313 Chapter 9
15. Since |2| 1, the dilation is an enlargement. 18. Since |1| 1, the dilation is a congruence
Draw CT,
CS,
CR, and CP. Since r is positive, T, transformation. Draw CE,
CD,
CA, and CB. Since
S, R, and P will lie on the continuations of the r is negative, E, D, A, and B will lie on rays
sides of the quadrilateral. Locate T, S, R, and that are opposite to
CE,
CD,
CA, and CB. Locate
P so that CT 2(CT), CS 2(CS), CR 2(CR), E, D, A, and B so that CE CE, CD CD,
and CP 2(CP). Draw quadrilateral TSRP. CA CA, and CB CB. Draw quadrilateral
T S EDAB.
A
T S E
C B
D
D
B C
P R
P R
E
16. Since
21
1, the dilation is a reduction. Draw C
K
, A
, C
CL M
, and CN. Since r is positive, the reduction
will have the same orientation. Locate 19. Since
1 4
1, the dilation is a reduction. Draw
K, L, M, and N so that CK 1
2 (CK), L
C, CM
, and C N
. Since r is negative, L, M, and
CL 1 1 1 , CM
, and
2 (CL), CM 2 (CM), and CN 2 (CN).
N lie on rays that are opposite to CL
CN, respectively. Locate L, M, and N so that
Draw quadrilateral KLMN.
N CL 1 1 1
4 (CL), CM 4 (CM), and CN 4 (CN).
Draw LMN.
K N M
K
C
L
M
L M
C N
L N
L
17. Since
2
5
1, the dilation is a reduction. Draw
M
20. ST 6, r 1
R
C, CS
, and C T. Since r is positive, the reduction
Use the Dilation Theorem.
will have the same orientation. Locate R, S, and
ST |r|(ST)
T so that CR 2 2
5 (CR), CS 5 (CS), and
2 ST (1)(6)
CT 5(CT). Draw RST. ST 6
R 21. ST 4 3
5, r 4
T R Use the Dilation Theorem.
T C ST |r|(ST)
S
S ST 3
4 5
4
ST 3
5
22. ST 12, r 2
3
Use the Dilation Theorem.
ST ¬|r|(ST)
12 ¬2
3 (ST)
18 ¬ST
12 3
23. ST 5 , r 5
Use the Dilation Theorem.
ST ¬|r|(ST)
1
2
3
5 ¬ 5 (ST)
4 ¬ST
Chapter 9 314
24. ST 32, r 5
4 Find X, Y, and Z using the scale factor, r 1
2.
Use the Dilation Theorem.
Preimage Image
ST |r|(ST)
ST 5
(x, y) 12x, 12y
4 (32)
ST 40 X(1, 2) X1
2 , 1
25. ST 2.25, r 0.4
Y(4, 3) Y2, 3
2
Use the Dilation Theorem.
ST |r|(ST)
Z(6, 1) Z3, 1
2
ST (0.4)(2.25)
ST 0.9
y
26. Find F, G, and H using the scale factor, r 2. x
OX Z
Preimage Image Z
Y
(x, y) (2x, 2y)
F(3, 4) F(6, 8) X
G(6, 10) G(12, 20)
Y
H(3, 5) H(6, 10)
Find F, G, and H using the scale factor, r 1
2. 28. Find P, Q, R, and S using the scale factor, r 2.
Preimage Image
16
(x, y) 12x, 12y
12
P(1, 2) P1
2 , 1
H 8
F
Q(3, 3) Q3
2, 2
3
4
G
H
F R(3, 5) R3
2, 2
5
4 O 4 8 12 x
S(1, 4) S1
2 , 2
27. Find X, Y, and Z using the scale factor, r 2.
Preimage Image y R
(x, y) (2x, 2y)
S
X(1, 2) K(2, 4)
315 Chapter 9
29. Find K, L, M, and N using the scale factor, r 2. 33. Compare QT and QT. Use the Pythagorean
Theorem to find the side lengths.
Preimage Image image length
(x, y) (2x, 2y) scale factor ¬
preimage length
K(4, 2) K(8, 4)
4
r ¬
3
2 2
13 units
L(4, 6) L(8, 12)
42 12 units
M(6, 8) M(12, 16)
17
3
r ¬
N(6, 10) N(12, 20)
17
1
Find K, L, M, and N using the scale factor, r ¬ 3
r 21. Since 0 |r| 1, the dilation is a reduction.
34. Compare YZ and YZ. Note that the scale factor
Preimage Image is negative since the image appears on the
(x, y) 12x, y opposite side of the center with respect to the
preimage. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find
K(4, 2) K(2, 1) the side lengths.
L(4, 6) L(2, 3) image length
scale factor ¬
preimage length
M(6, 8) M(3, 4)
N(6, 10) N(3, 5)
1
r ¬
23 2
4 units
42 32 units
L y
25
12 4
r ¬
25
8 1
r ¬4
K
4 Since 0 |r| 1, the dilation is a reduction.
L K
35. Compare BD and BD. Note that the scale factor
12 8 4 O 4 8 12 x is negative since the image points appear on the
4 opposite side of the center with respect to the
M N preimage points. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to
8 find the side lengths.
image length
scale factor ¬
12 preimage length
42 12 units
16 r ¬
M
2
2
2
1 2
units
20
N
17
r ¬
17
30. Compare sides of the squares. 2
image length r ¬2
scale factor ¬
preimage length
Since |r| 1, the dilation is an enlargement.
6 un
its
r ¬
2 units 36. Determine the width in inches of the actual
r ¬3 wingspan of the SR-71.
12
in.
Since the scale factor is greater than 1, the (55 ft)1 ft 7 in. 660 in. 7 in.
dilation is an enlargement. 667 in.
31. Compare the vertical sides of the triangles. Find the scale factor by dividing the wingspan of
image length the model by the wingspan of the plane.
scale factor ¬ 14 1 1
preimage length
667 7
66 48
2 un
its 14
r ¬4 units 1
The scale factor is about .
r ¬1
2
48
37. Each dimension is reduced by a factor of 0.75.
Since 0 |r| 1, the dilation is a reduction.
0.75(10) 7.5
32. By inspection, we see that the scale factor is 1. 0.75(14) 10.5
This is a congruence transformation. The new dimensions are 7.5 in. by 10.5 in.
Chapter 9 316
38. Find the ratio of the area of the image to that of 44. The width and height of the photograph are
the preimage. increased by 150%, or a factor of 1.5.
area of image 0.75(10) 0.75(14) 1.5(480) 720
¬ 10 14
area of preimage 1.5(640) 960
¬0.752 The dimensions of the image are 960 pixels by
¬0.5625 720 pixels.
9 45. The original width is 640 pixels. To reduce it
¬
16
9 to 32 pixels, Dinah must use a scale factor
The area of the image is 16 that of the preimage. 3
2 1
640 20 .
of
39. Each side of the rectangle is lengthened by a
factor of 4, so the perimeter is four times the 46. The original height is 480 pixels. To enlarge it to
600 5
original perimeter. 600 pixels, Dinah used a scale factor of 480 4 .
40. Find the ratio of the areas. 47. The dimensions of the photograph are 10 cm by
area of image (4b)(
4h)
bh
12 cm. The space available is 6 cm by 8 cm.
area of preimage
6 0.6 and 8 0.67, so a scale factor of 0.6 is
16 10 12
required for the photograph to be as large as
The area is 16 times the original area.
possible on the page. So, she should save the
41. Given: dilation with center C and scale factor r image file at 60%.
Prove: ED r(AB)
48. Use the distance formula to find the length of
A E each side.
C
d
(x2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2
B CD
(3 7)2 (8
7)2
D
16 1
17
Proof:
BC
(7 5)2 [7
(1)]2
CE r(CA) and CD r(CB) by the definition of
CE CD CE CD
4 64
CA r and CB r. So, CA CB
a dilation.
2
17
by substitution. ACB ECD, since congruence AB
[5 (
1)]2 (1 1)2
of angles is reflexive. Therefore, by SAS
36 4
Similarity, ACB is similar to ECD. The
2
10
corresponding sides of similar triangles are
ED CE CE AD
[3 (
1)]2 (8 1)2
proportional, so AB CA . We know that CA r,
16 49
E D
so AB r by substitution. Therefore, ED r(AB)
65
by the Multiplication Property of Equality. Find the perimeter.
42. First dilation: (x, y) → (rx, ry) P ¬
17
2
17 2
10
65
Second dilation: (rx, ry) → (r2x, r2y) ¬26.8
Find r2 using the x-values of A and A. The perimeter is about 26.8 units.
3 r2(12) 49. Find A, B, C, and D using the scale factor,
1
r2 r 2.
4
1 r Preimage (x, y) Image (2x, 2y)
2
So, the scale factor is 1. A(1, 1) A(2, 2)
2 B(5, 1) B(10, 2)
43. Use the distance formula to find XY and XY.
C(7, 7) C(14, 14)
d
(x2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2
D(3, 8) D(6, 16)
XY
(0 4
)2 (5 2)2
16 9 y D
5 8 C
XY
(12 6)2 (11 3)2
4
36 64 B
10 A
Find the absolute value of the scale factor. 12 8 4 O 4 B 8x
image length A
r 4
preimage length
10
5
8
2
12
The absolute value of the scale factor is 2.
C 16
D
317 Chapter 9
50. Use the distance formula to find the length of Dilation with scale factor of 1
3:
each side. x y
(x, y) → 3, 3
dz
(x2x1)2 (y2
y1)2
AB
(10
2)2
[2
(2)]2 (10, 4) → T 1
0 4
3 , 3
144 16
4
10
(7, 7) → U 7
7
3, 3
BC
[14
(10)] 2 (14 2)2
16 256
(3, 1) → V 1, 1
3
4
17
y
CD
[6
(14)] 2 [
16 (14
)]2
64 4
2
17
AD
(6 2)2 [16 (2)]2 U
64 196
2
65 V T x
Find the perimeter.
P ¬4
10 4
17 2
17 2
65
¬53.5
The perimeter of quadrilateral ABCD is about
53.5 units, so it is twice the perimeter of
quadrilateral ABCD.
51. T(6, 5), U(3, 8), V(1, 2)
Reflection in the x-axis:
(x, y) → (x, y) 52. Translate the points so that the center is the
T(6, 5) → (6, 5) origin.
U(3, 8) → (3, 8) (x, y) → (x 3, y 5)
V(1, 2) → (1, 2) G(3, 5) → (0, 0)
H(7, 4) → (4, 9)
y
I(1, 0) → (4, 5)
y
12
8
G
4
x
I x
V 12 8 4 4 8 12
4 H
T 8
12
U 16
Translation with (x, y) → (x 4, y 1):
(6, 5) → (10, 4) 20
(3, 8) → (7, 7)
(1, 2) → (3, 1) Dilate the figure using the scale factor 2.
(x, y) → (2x, 2y)
y
(0, 0) → (0, 0)
(4, 9) → (8, 18)
(4, 5) → (8, 10)
Chapter 9 318
y 55. A; find the slope of 3x 5y 12.
12 3x 5y¬ 12
5y¬ 3x 12
8 y¬ 3
5x 5
1
2
12
Page 497 Maintain Your Skills
16 56. No; use the algebraic method to determine
whether a semi-regular tessellation can be
20
created using equilateral triangles and regular
Translate the points back so that the center is at pentagons of side length 1 unit.
(3, 5). Each interior angle of an equilateral triangle
(x, y) → (x 3, x 5) measures 60°, and each interior angle of a regular
180(5 2)
(0, 0) → G(3, 5) pentagon measures 5
or 108°.
(8, 18) → H(11, 13) Find whole number values for h and t so that
(8, 10) → I(5, 5) 60h 108t 360.
y Let h 1.
12 60(1) 108t¬ 360
60 108t¬ 360
8 108t¬ 300
G
t¬ 2.8
4
Let h 2.
x 60(2) 108t¬ 360
12 8 4 4 8 12 120 108t¬ 360
4 108t¬ 240
I t¬ 2.2
8 Let h 3.
60(3) 108t¬ 360
12 180 108t¬ 360
H 108t¬ 180
16
t¬ 1.7
20 Let h 4.
60(4) 108t¬ 360
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are 240 108t¬ 120
G(3, 5), H(11, 13) and I(5, 5). 108t¬ 120
53. Sample answer: Yes; a cut and paste produces an t¬ 1.1
image congruent to the original. Answers should Let h 5.
include the following. 60(5) 108t¬ 360
• Congruent figures are similar, so cutting and 300 108t¬ 360
pasting is a similarity transformation. 108t¬ 60
• If you scale both horizontally and vertically by t¬ 0.6
the same factor, you are creating a dilation. There are no more reasonable possibilities. So, a
semi-regular tessellation cannot be created from
54. B; the pentagons are similar. Find the scale factor
equilateral triangles and regular pentagons.
by dividing the length of the radius of the larger
pentagon by that of the smaller pentagon. 57. No; use the algebraic method to determine
6 6 whether a semi-regular tessellation can be
Scale factor 6
12
created using regular octagons and hexagons of
6 side length 1 unit.
2 Each interior angle of a regular octagon measures
So, the perimeter of the larger pentagon is twice 180(8
2)
8
or 135°, and each interior angle of a
that of the smaller pentagon (5n). The perimeter 180(6 2)
regular hexagon measures 6
or 120°.
of the larger pentagon is 10n.
319 Chapter 9
Find whole number values for h and t so that 60. First graph ABC and point P. Draw a segment
135h 120t 360. from point P to point A. Use a protractor to
Let t 1. measure a 90° angle counterclockwise with P A
as
135h 120(1)¬ 360 one side. Draw
PR. Use a compass to copy P A
135h 120¬ 360 . Name the segment P
onto PR A
. Repeat with
135h¬ 240 points B and C. ABC is the image of ABC
t¬ 1.8 under a 90° counterclockwise rotation about
Let t 2. point P.
135h 120(2)¬ 360 y A
135h 240¬ 360
135h¬¬120
t¬ 0.9 B
There are no more reasonable possibilities. So, a
semi-regular tessellation cannot be created from
regular octagons and hexagons. C
58. Yes; use the algebraic method to determine C
whether a semi-regular tessellation can be
P 90
created using squares and equilateral triangles of
side length 1 unit.
Each interior angle of a square measures 90°, and
each interior angle of a triangle measures 60°. O B x
Find whole number values for h and t so that A
90h 60t 360.
61. First graph parallelogram DEFG and point P.
Let h 2.
Draw a segment from point P to point D. Use a
90(2) 60t 360
protractor to measure a 90° angle clockwise with
180 60t 360
P as one side. Draw
D PR. Use a compass to copy
60t 180
P onto
D PR. Name the segment P D. Repeat with
t3
points E, F, and G. Parallelogram DEFG is the
When h 2 and t 3, there are two squares with
image of DEFG under a 90° clockwise rotation
three triangles at each vertex.
about point P.
60 y
60 60 E
90 90 F
O x
59. No; use the algebraic method to determine
whether a semi-regular tessellation can be D
created using regular hexagons and dodecagons of
side length 1 unit. 90 G
Each interior angle of a regular hexagon D
180(6 2) P E
measures 6
or 120°, and each interior
180(12 2)
angle of a regular dodecagon measures 12
or 150°.
Find whole number values for h and t so that
120h 150t 360.
Let h 1. G
F
120(1) 150t¬ 360
120 150t¬ 360 62. Yes; the opposite sides of a rectangle are
150t¬ 240 congruent, and the diagonals are congruent.
t¬ 1.6 63. Given: J L
Let h 2. B is the midpoint of JL
.
120(2) 150t¬ 360 Prove: JHB LCB
240 150t¬ 360 J
150t¬ 120
t¬ 0.8 B H
C
There are no more reasonable possibilities. So, a
semi-regular tessellation cannot be created from
regular hexagons and dodecagons. L
Proof: It is known that J L. Since B is the
midpoint of JL
, J
B
LB
by the Midpoint
Theorem. JBH LBC because vertical angles
are congruent. Thus, JHB LCB by ASA.
Chapter 9 320
64. Use the tangent ratio. 5. Find A, B, and C using the scale factor, r 1
2.
BC
tan A y
AC
2
Preimage (x, y) Image x
2, 2
tan A 3
A(10, 2) A(5, 1)
A tan1 2
3
B(1, 6) B(1
2 , 3)
Use a calculator to find mA.
mA 33.7 C(4, 4) C(2, 2)
65. Use the tangent ratio. y
BC 8
tan A
AB
B
28 C
tan A 7
4
A tan1 4 A
Use a calculator to find mA. A O 4 8 x
mA 76.0 C
B
66. Use the cosine ratio.
AC
cos A
AB
20
cos A
32
A cos1 5
8
9-6 Vectors
Use a calculator to find mA.
mA 51.3
Page 501 Geometry Activity:
Comparing Magnitude and
Page 497 Practice Quiz 2 Components of Vectors
1. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the 1. See students’ work.
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°. 2. The components of b are twice the components of a .
The tessellation is uniform because at every 3. The components of b are three times the
vertex there is the same combination of shapes components of a .
and angles. 4. Sample answer: The magnitude is n times greater
The tessellation is semi-regular because it is than the magnitude of x, y, and the direction is
composed of more than one type of regular the same.
polygon.
2. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°.
Pages 502–503 Check for Understanding
The tessellation is uniform because at every
1. Sample answer: 7, 7
vertex there is the same combination of shapes
and angles. y
3. Since 3
4 1, the dilation is a reduction. 4, 4 3, 3
Draw CD, C
F
, and C
E. Locate D, F, and E on
D
C, C
F
, and CE so that CD 3
4 (CD), O x
CF 3
(CF), and CE 3(CE). Draw DFE.
4 4 2. Two equal vectors must have the same magnitude
D
D and direction, but parallel vectors have the same
direction. The magnitude of parallel vectors can
C be different.
E 3. Sample answer: Using a vector to translate a
F F figure is the same as using an ordered pair
E
because a vector has horizontal and vertical
4. Since 2 1, the dilation is an enlargement. components which can be represented by ordered
Since r is negative, P, R, S, T, and U will lie pairs.
on rays that are opposite to
CP, CR,
CS,
CT, and 4. Find the change in x-values and the
CU respectively. Locate P, R, S, T, and U so corresponding change in y-values.
that CP 2(CP), CR 2(CR), CS, 2(CS), AB x2 x1, y2 y1
CT 2(CT), and CU 2(CU). Draw PRSTU.
1 (4), 3 (3)
R 5, 6
T U P
S
C S
R P
U
T
321 Chapter 9
y y
5. Find the change in x-values and the tan A
x
2
x
1
2 1
corresponding change in y-values. 4 0
CD x2 x1, y2 y1 12 (6)
0 (4), 1 4 2
3
4, 3
mA tan1 2
3
6. Find the magnitude using the distance formula.
33.7
AB ¬
(x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2 A vector in standard position that is equal to AB
¬
(3 2)2 (3 7
)2 forms a 33.7° angle with the negative x-axis in
¬
41
the third quadrant. So it forms a 180 33.7 or
¬6.4 213.7° angle with the positive x-axis.
Graph AB to determine how to find the direction. Thus, AB has a magnitude of 2
13 or about
Draw a right triangle that has AB as its 7.2 units and a direction of about 213.7°.
hypotenuse and an acute angle at A. 8. Find the magnitude using the Pythagorean
y Theorem.
A v
x2 y2
2
82 (15)
17
Vector v lies in the fourth quadrant. Find the
B direction.
y
tan
x
x
15
8
tan A
y y m
tan1 8
15
x
2 1
2x 1
3 7 61.9
3 2 v forms a 61.9° angle with the positive x-axis in
4
5 the fourth quadrant. So, it forms a 360 61.9 or
mA tan1 4
5
298.1° angle with the positive x-axis.
38.7 Thus, v has a magnitude of 17 units and a
A vector in standard position that is equal to AB direction of about 298.1°.
forms a 38.7° angle with the negative x-axis in 9. First, graph JKL. Next, translate each vertex
the third quadrant. So it forms a 180 38.7 or by t , 1 unit left and 9 units up. Connect the
218.7° angle with the positive x-axis. vertices to form JKL.
Thus, AB has a magnitude of
41 or about L y
6.4 units and a direction of about 218.7°. 16
Chapter 9 322
11. First, graph WXYZ. Next, translate each can be found by adding the two vectors. Find the
vertex by e , 1 unit left and 6 units up. Finally, components of the current vector.
translate each vertex by f , 8 units right and x, y 3cos(30°), 3sin(30°)
5 units down. Connect the vertices to form
WXYZ.
3
2
3
2
, 3
10 3
2 , 0 2 10 1.5
3
3
, 1.5
4 Z O 4 8 12 Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
Y
4 magnitude.
Y W
W 10 1.5
3, 1.5
8 X
(10 1.5
) (1.5
X 2
3 )2
12. Find the resultant vector. 12.7
g h 4 0, 0 6 The resultant vector lies in the fourth quadrant.
Find the direction.
4, 6 y
Find the magnitude to the resultant vector. tan
x
1
.5
g h
x2 y2
10 1.5
3
42 62
m
tan1
1.5
2
13 10 1.5
3
6.8
7.2
The speed of the boat is about 12.7 knots, at a
The resultant vector lies in the first quadrant.
direction of about 6.8° south of due east.
Find the direction.
y
tan
x
6
4 Pages 503–505 Practice and Apply
3
2
15. Find the change in x-values and the
corresponding change in y-values.
m
tan1 3
2 AB x2 x1, y2 y1
56.3
3 1, 3 (3)
The resultant vector forms a 56.3° angle with the
2, 6
positive x-axis in the first quadrant. Thus, g h
has a magnitude of 2
13 or about 7.2 units and a 16. Find the change in x-values and the
direction of about 56.3°. corresponding change in y-values.
CD x2 x1, y2 y1
13. Find the resultant vector.
t u 0 12, 9 9 3 (2), 4 0
12, 18 1, 4
Find the magnitude of the resultant vector. 17. Find the change in x-values and the
t u
x2 y2 corresponding change in y-values.
122 (18)2 EF x2 x1, y2 y1
6
13 3 4, 1 3
21.6 7, 4
The resultant vector lies in the fourth quadrant. 18. Find the change in x-values and the
Find the direction. corresponding change in y-values.
y
tan
x GH x2 x1, y2 y1
1
8 2 (3), 4 4
12
5, 0
3
2 19. Find the change in x-values and the
m
tan1 3 2
corresponding change in y-values.
56.3 LM x2 x1, y2 y1
The resultant vector forms a 56.3° angle with 1 4, 3 (2)
the positive x-axis in the fourth quadrant. So, it 3, 5
forms a 360 56.3 or 303.7° angle with the 20. Find the change in x-values and the
positive x-axis. corresponding change in y-values.
Thus, t u has a magnitude of 6
13 or about NP x2 x1, y2 y1
21.6 units and a direction of about 303.7°.
1 (4), 1 (3)
14. The initial path of the boat is due east, so a vector 3, 2
representing the speed of the boat lies on the
21. Find the magnitude using the distance formula.
positive x-axis and is 10 units long. The current is
flowing 30° south of east, so a vector representing CD
(x 2x1)2
(y2
y1)2
the speed of the current will be 30° below the
(9 4
)2 (2
2)2
positive x-axis 3 units long. The resultant speed 5
323 Chapter 9
Since CD 5, 0, it is along the positive x-axis. Thus, CD has a magnitude of 2
5 or about
Thus, CD has a magnitude of 5 units and a 4.5 units and a direction of 296.6°.
direction of 0°. 24. Find the magnitude using the distance formula.
22. Find the magnitude using the distance formula. CD
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
CD
(x
2 x1)2
(y2 y1)2
(2 0)2 [4 (7)]2
[2 (2)]2
(5
1)2
13
4
2 3.6
5.7 Graph CD to determine how to find the direction.
Graph CD to determine how to find the direction. Draw a right triangle that has CD as its
Draw a right triangle that has CD as its hypotenuse and an acute angle at C.
hypotenuse and an acute angle at C. y
y x
D(2, 5)
C
x C
y y
tan C ¬
x
2
x
1
y2 y1 2 1
tan C ¬
x2 4 (7)
x1 ¬2
0
5
1 ¬ 1.5
¬
2 (2)
¬1 mC tan1 (1.5)
mC tan1 1 56.3
45 A vector in standard position that is equal to CD
A vector in standard position that is equal to CD forms a 56.3° angle with the negative x-axis in
forms a 45° angle with the positive x-axis in the the second quadrant. So it forms a 180 56.3
first quadrant. or 123.7° angle with the positive x-axis.
Thus, CD has a magnitude of 4
2 or about Thus, CD has a magnitude of
13 or about
5.7 units and a direction of 45°. 3.6 units and a direction of 123.7°.
25. Find the magnitude using the distance formula.
23. Find the magnitude using the distance formula.
CD
(x
CD
(x
2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2
2x1)2 (y2 y1)2
[6 (
8)]2
[0 (7)]2
[3 (5)]2 (6 10)2
7
5
2
5 15.7
4.5
Graph CD to determine how to find the direction.
Graph CD to determine how to find the direction.
Draw a right triangle that has CD as its
Draw a right triangle that has CD as its
hypotenuse and an acute angle at C.
hypotenuse and an acute angle at C.
C y
y
D x
D
C
x y y
tan C ¬
x
2
x
1
y2 y1 2 1
tan C ¬
x2 x1 0 (7)
¬
6 (8)
6 10
¬
3 (5) ¬0.5
¬2 mC tan1 (0.5)
mC tan1 (2) 26.6
63.4 A vector in standard position that is equal to CD
A vector in standard position that is equal to CD forms a 26.6° angle with the positive x-axis in the
forms a 63.4° angle with the positive x-axis in the first quadrant.
fourth quadrant. So it forms a 360 63.4 or Thus, CD has a magnitude of 7
5 or about
296.6° angle with the positive x-axis. 15.7 units and a direction of 26.6°.
Chapter 9 324
y
26. Find the magnitude using the distance formula. tan θ x
CD
(x
2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2 15
1
2
(2
10)2
[2
(3)]2
5
145
4
12.0 mθ tan1 5 4
Graph CD to determine how to find the direction. 51.3
Draw a right triangle that has CD as its u forms a 51.3° angle with the negative x-axis in
hypotenuse and an acute angle at C. the second quadrant. So, it forms a 180 51.3
y or 128.7° angle with the positive x-axis.
Thus, u has a magnitude of 3
41 or about
x 19.2 units and a direction of about 128.7°.
D 29. Find the magnitude using the Pythagorean
C Theorem.
v
x2 y2
(25)
220) (2
5
41
32.0
y y Vector v lies in the third quadrant. Find the
tan C ¬
x
2
x
1
direction.
2 1
2 (3) y
¬ tan θ x
2 10
1 2
0
¬
25
12
mC tan1 1
12 4
5
4.8 mθ tan1 45
A vector in standard position that is equal to CD 38.7
forms a 4.8° angle with the negative x-axis in the v forms a 38.7° angle with the negative x-axis in
second quadrant. So it forms a 180 4.8 or 175.2° the third quadrant. So, it forms a 180 38.7 or
angle with the positive x-axis. 218.7° angle with the positive x-axis.
Thus, CD has a magnitude of
145 or about Thus, v has a magnitude of 5
41 or about
12.0 units and a direction of 175.2°. 32.0 units and a direction of about 218.7°.
27. Find the magnitude using the Pythagorean 30. Find the magnitude using the Pythagorean
Theorem. Theorem.
t
x2 y2 w
x
2 y2
72 242
36
2 (15)2
25 39
Vector t lies in the first quadrant. Find the
Vector w lies in the fourth quadrant. Find the
direction.
y direction.
tan θ x y
tan θ x
24
1
5
7
36
mθ tan1 7
24
5
73.7 12
v forms a 73.7° angle with the positive x-axis in mθ tan1 5
12
the first quadrant. 22.6
Thus, v has a magnitude of 25 units and a w forms a 22.6° angle with the positive x-axis in
direction of about 73.7°. the fourth quadrant. So, it forms a 360 22.6 or
28. Find the magnitude using the Pythagorean 337.4° angle with the positive x-axis.
Theorem. Thus, w has a magnitude of 39 units and a
direction of about 337.4°.
u
x
2 y2
31. Find the magnitude using the Distance Formula.
(12)
2 152
3
41
MN
(x 2x1)2 (y2 y1)2
19.2
[9
(3)]
2 (9 3)2
Vector u lies in the second quadrant. Find the 6
2
direction. 8.5
Graph MN to determine how to find the
direction. Draw a right triangle that has MN as
its hypotenuse and an acute angle at M.
325 Chapter 9
N Graph MN to determine how to find the direction.
y
Draw a right triangle that has MN as its
hypotenuse and an acute angle at M.
y
M M
x x
N
y y
tan M ¬
x
2
x
1
2 1
9 3
¬
9 (3) y y
¬1 tan M ¬
x
2
x
1
2 1
M
x x
y y
tan M ¬
x
2
x
1
2 1 N
51
¬
2 8
2 y y
¬3 tan M ¬
x
2
x
1
2 1
Chapter 9 326
35. Find the magnitude using the Distance Formula. 37. First, graph ABC. Next, translate each vertex by
MN
(x
2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2 a , 6 units down. Connect the vertices to form
ABC.
[11)]
( 2 2(1) 102
y A
2
122
22.1 4
Graph MN to determine how to find the C A
direction. Draw a right triangle that has MN as 8 4 O 4 8x
its hypotenuse and an acute angle at M.
4
y C
B
12 8
M
12
B
4 x 38. First, graph DEF. Next, translate each vertex by
b, 3 units left and 9 units down. Connect the
vertices to form DEF.
N
y E
D
y2 y1 4
tan M ¬
x2 x1
12 10
¬
1 (1) 12 8 4 O 4 x
¬11 4 E F
D
mM tan1 (11)
84.8 8
A vector in standard position that is equal to MN
forms an 84.8° angle with the positive x-axis in 12
F
the fourth quadrant. So it forms a 360 84.8 or
275.2° angle with the positive x-axis.3 39. First, graph square GHIJ. Next, translate each
Thus, MN has a magnitude of 2
122 or about vertex by c , 3 units right and 8 units down.
22.1 units and a direction of 275.2°. Connect the vertices to form square GHIJ.
36. Find the magnitude using the Distance Formula. J y
4
MN
(x 2x1)2 (y2 y1)2 I G
O
[6 (4)]2
(4 0)2 12 8 4 x
J
2
5 H 4
4.5
Graph MN to determine how to find the direction. I 8
G
Draw a right triangle that has MN as its
H
hypotenuse and an acute angle at M.
40. First, graph quadrilateral KLMN. Next, translate
y
M each vertex by x, 10 units left and 2 units up.
x Connect the vertices to form quadrilateral
KLMN.
K y
N L N K
N 8
L
4
y y 12 8 4 O 4 x
tan M ¬
x
2
x
1
M M
2 1
4 0
¬6 (4)
¬2
mM tan1 (2)
63.4
A vector in standard position that is equal to MN
forms a 63.4° angle with the negative x-axis in
the third quadrant. So it forms a 180 63.4 or
243.4° angle with the positive x-axis.
Thus, MN has a magnitude of 2
5 or about
4.5 units and a direction of 243.4°.
327 Chapter 9
41. First, graph pentagon OPQRS. Next, translate 45. First, graph quadrilateral EFGH. Next, translate
each vertex by y, 5 units left and 11 units up. each vertex by p, 6 units left and 10 units up.
Connect the vertices to form pentagon Finally, translate each vertex by q, 1 unit right
OPQRS. and 8 units down. Connect the vertices to form
S y quadrilateral EFGH.
12
O G 16 y
K G
8 12
P F
Q S F
4 8
O
R
O x 4
8 4 4
4
P E H
Q 12 8 4 O 4 x
H
42. First, graph hexagon TUVWXY. Next, translate E
each vertex by z , 18 units left and 12 units up. 46. First, graph pentagon STUVW. Next, translate
Connect the vertices to form hexagon each vertex by p, 4 units left and 5 units up.
TUVWXY. Finally, translate each vertex by q, 12 units right
y and 11 units up. Connect the vertices to form
V W 18 pentagon STUVW.
U
y T U
12 24
T X
Y 6 V 20 V
U W S W
12 6 O T 6 x 16
X
6 Y 12
T U
43. First, graph ABCD. Next, translate each 8
vertex by p, 11 units right and 6 units up. Finally, V
4
translate each vertex by q, 9 units left and 3 S W
units down. Connect the vertices to form
ABCD. O 4 8 12 x
y 47. Find the resultant vector.
a b 5 0, 0 12
8 4 O 4 8x 5, 12
A
Find the magnitude of the resultant vector.
D A B
a b
x2 y2
D C B
52 122
C 12 13
The resultant vector lies in the first quadrant.
Find the direction.
44. First, graph XYZ. Next, translate each vertex by y
p, 2 units right and 2 units up. Finally, translate tan θ x
each vertex by q, 4 units left and 7 units down. 12
5
Connect the vertices to form XYZ.
mθ tan1 5
12
y Y
4 67.4
The resultant vector forms a 67.4° angle with the
Y
O x positive x-axis in the first quadrant.
4 8 12
Z Thus, a b has a magnitude of 13 units and a
4 direction of about 67.4°.
X
Z 48. Find the resultant vector.
8
c d 0 (8), 8 0
X 8, 8
Find the magnitude of the resultant vector.
c d
x2 y2
(8)2 (8)2
8
2
11.3
Chapter 9 328
The resultant vector lies in the third quadrant. The resultant vector lies in the first quadrant.
Find the direction. Find the direction.
y y
tan θ x tan θ x
8
8 2
4
1
1
mθ tan1 (1) 2
45 mθ tan1 1 2
The resultant vector forms a 45° angle with the 26.6
negative x-axis in the third quadrant. So it forms The resultant vector forms a 26.6° angle with the
a 180 45 or 225° angle with the positive x-axis. positive x-axis in the first quadrant.
Thus, c d has a magnitude of 8
2 or about Thus, w x has a magnitude of 2
5 or about
11.3 units and a direction of 225°. 4.5 units and a direction of about 26.6°.
49. Find the resultant vector. 52. Find the resultant vector.
e f 4 7, 0 (4) y z 9 (10), 10 (2)
3, 4 1, 12
Find the magnitude of the resultant vector. Find the magnitude of the resultant vector.
e f
x2 y2 y z
x2 y2
32 (
4)2
(1)2 (12)2
5
145
The resultant vector lies in the fourth quadrant. 12.0
Find the direction. The resultant vector lies in the third quadrant.
y Find the direction.
tan θ x y
4 tan θ x
3 1
2
mθ tan1 4 3
1
53.1 12
The resultant vector forms a 53.1° angle with the mθ tan1 (12)
positive x-axis in the fourth quadrant. So it forms 85.2
a 360 53.1 or 306.9° angle with the positive The resultant vector forms an 85.2° angle with
x-axis. the negative x-axis in the third quadrant. So it
Thus, e f has a magnitude of 5 units and a forms a 180 85.2 or 265.2° angle with the
direction of about 306.9°. positive x-axis.
50. Find the resultant vector. Thus, y z has a magnitude of
145 or about
u v 12 0, 6 6 12.0 units and a direction of about 265.2°.
12, 12 53. The first path of the freighter is due east, so a
Find the magnitude of the resultant vector. vector representing the path lies on the positive
u v
x2 y2 x-axis and is 35 units long. The second path of the
freighter is due south, so a vector representing
122 122
this path begins at the tip of the first vector and
12
2 stretches 28 units in the negative y-direction. Add
17.0 the two vectors, 35, 0 and 0, 28.
The resultant vector lies in the first quadrant. 35 0, 0 (28) 35, 28
Find the direction. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
y
tan θ x magnitude.
12 35, 28
352 (28)2
12 44.8
1 The resultant vector lies in the fourth quadrant.
mθ tan1 (1) Find the direction.
45 y
tan θ x
The resultant vector forms a 45° angle with the
2
8
positive x-axis in the first quadrant.
35
Thus, u v has a magnitude of 12
2 or about 4
17.0 units and a direction of 45°. 5
mθ tan1 4
5
51. Find the resultant vector.
w x 5 (1), 6 (4) 38.7
4, 2 The distance the freighter traveled is about 44.8 mi,
Find the magnitude of the resultant vector. at a direction of about 38.7° south of due east.
w x
x2 y2
4 2 22
2
5
4.5
329 Chapter 9
54. Let the initial direction of the swimmer be the 59. Sample answer: Quantities such as velocity are
positive x-direction, and the direction that the vectors. The velocity of the wind and the velocity
current flows by the positive y-direction. The of the plane together factor into the overall flight
speed and direction of the swimmer can be plan. Answers should include the following.
represented by the vector 4.5, 0, and those of the • A wind from the west would add to the velocity
current can be represented by the vector 0, 2. contributed by the plane resulting in an overall
Add the vectors. velocity with a larger magnitude.
4.5 0, 0 2 4.5, 2 • When traveling east, the prevailing winds add
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the to the velocity of the plane. When traveling
magnitude. west, they detract from it.
4.5, 2
4.52
22 60. B; find the sum of the vectors.
4.9
r
q 5, 10 3, 5
The resultant vector lies in the first quadrant.
Find the direction. 8, 15
y Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
tan θ x
magnitude of the vector sum.
2
4.5 q
r
82 1
52
4
17
9
The magnitude is 17.
mθ tan1 4
9
61. D; 5b 125
24
5b 53
The swimmer is traveling about 4.9 mph at an
So, b 3.
angle of 24°.
4b 3 43 3
55. Add the vectors representing the velocities of the 64 3
wind and jet. 192
100, 0 450, 450 100 450, 0 450
350, 450
The resultant vector for the jet is 350, 450 mph. Page 505 Maintain Your Skills
56. From Exercise 55, the resultant vector is 62. AB 8, r 2
350, 450. Use the Dilation Theorem.
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the AB r(AB)
magnitude. AB (2)(8)
350, 450
(350)2 4502 AB 16
570.1 63. AB 12, r 1
2
The magnitude of the resultant is about 570.1 mph. Use the Dilation Theorem.
57. From Exercise 55, the resultant vector is
AB r(AB)
350, 450.
Find the direction. AB 1
2 (12)
y AB 6
tan θ x
450 64. AB 15, r 3
350 Use the Dilation Theorem.
9
7 AB r(AB)
mθ tan1 9
7
15 (3)(AB)
52.1 5 AB
The direction of the resultant is about 52.1° north 65. AB 12, r 1
4
of due west. Use the Dilation Theorem.
58. Sample answer: Let one vector be 1, 0. Then AB r(AB)
the x-components of the other two vectors must
12 1
4 (AB)
sum to 1, the y-components must cancel, and
the magnitudes of the other two vectors must 48 AB
be 1. Try 1
2 for the x-components. Find the 66. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the
y-components. different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°.
2
2 The tessellation is uniform because at every
1 ¬ 1
y 2
vertex there is the same combination of shapes
1 ¬1 and angles. The tessellation is also semi-regular
4 y
2
since more than one regular polygon is used.
3
¬y2
4
3
2 ¬y
Three vectors with equal magnitude, the sum of
which is 0, 0, are 1, 0, 1,
2
3
2
, and
12,
23 .
Chapter 9 330
2 2 2 8 8 8
67. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the
74.
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°. 7 2 5 1 1 1
The tessellation is not uniform because the
number of angles at the vertices varies. 2 8 2 8 2 8
7 1 2 1 5 1
68. The opposite angles of the rhombus are
10 6 10
6 1 4
congruent.
WZY WXY and XYZ XWZ.
mXYZ mXWZ mWZY mWXY ¬360
2mXYZ 2mWZY ¬360
75. 3 99 51 15 3(9)
3(9)
3(5) 3(1)
3(1) 3(5)
2mXYZ 21 5 mXYZ ¬360
12
27
27
15 3
3 15
5 mXYZ ¬360
mXYZ ¬150 1(4) 1(5) 1(0) 1(2)
4 5 0 2
69. The measures of all sides of the rhombus are equal. 76. 1
2
4 4 6 0
2
1(4)
2
1(4)
2
1(6)
2
1(0)
So, WX YZ 12. 2 2 2 2
70. mXYZ ¬5mWZY
150 ¬5mWZY
22 2.52
0 1
3 0
30 ¬mWZY
mXZY ¬1
2 mWZY
77. 42 42 238 74
¬1
2 (30)
¬15
42 42 2(3) 2(7)
2(8) 2(4)
331 Chapter 9
2 2 2 2
9. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the y-axis
3. Sample answer:
1 1 1 1
is 10 0
1
.
4. The vertex matrix for ABC is 5 3
4 1
0
2
. The vertex matrix for HIJK is
13 5
3
3 3
0 0
. 10. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
0 1
The translation matrix is 06 0 0 0
.
rotation of 90° is
1 0.
6 6 6
Find the vertex matrix for the image. M
The vertex matrix for L is
3
5
. 21
1 5 3 3 1 5 13 3
3 3 0 0
0 0 0 0
6 6 6 6
9 9 6 6 M
Multiply the vertex matrix for L by the rotation
matrix to find the vertex matrix of the image.
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
0 1 2 3
D(1, 9), E(5, 9), F(3, 6), and G(3, 6). 1 0
1 5
1 5
2 3
6. The vertex matrix for XYZ is
3 6 3
4 10 5
. The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
L(1, 2) and M(5, 3).
Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to 11. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
find the vertex matrix of the image.
6 12 6 rotation of 270° is
0 1
.
2 3 6 3
4 10 5
8 20 10 1 0
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are The vertex matrix for PQR is 63 6 2
7 7
.
X(6, 8), Y(12, 20), and Z(6, 10).
Multiply the vertex matrix for PQR by the
7. The vertex matrix for ABCD is
1 3 3 1
2 3 5 4
. rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
image.
Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
find the vertex matrix of the image. 0 1
1 0 3 7 7
6 6 2
3 7
6 6 2
7
1 3 3 1
4 4 4 4
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
1
4
1 3 3 1
2 3 5 4
1
3 5
2 4 4 1
P(3, 6), Q(7, 6), and R(7, 2).
12. The vertex matrix for quadrilateral STUV is
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
4 2 0 2
A1 .
4 , 2 , B 4 , 4 , C 4 , 4 , and
1 3 3 3 5 1 2 1 2
Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
D 1
4 , 1 .
find the vertex matrix of the image.
4 2 0 2 8 4 0 4
8. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the x-axis 2 1 2 1 2
2 4 2 4
is 1 0
0 1
. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
0 1
rotation of 90° is .
F
The vertex matrix for E is
5
1
. 24 1 0
Multiply the vertex matrix of the image due to
F
Multiply the vertex matrix for E by the reflection dilation to find the vertex matrix of the final
matrix to find the vertex matrix of the image. image.
2 5 2 5
1 0
0 1 4 1
4 1 0 1
1 0
8 4 0 4
2 4 2 4
2 4 2 4
8 4 0 4
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
E(2, 4) and F(5, 1). S(2, 8), T(4, 4), U(2, 0) and V(4, 4).
Chapter 9 332
13. The rose bed must be dilated by a scale factor Find the vertex matrix for the image.
of 1
6 2 6 6 6 6
2.
The vertex matrix of the rose bed is 23 6
2 1 1
2 2 2 2
13 37 75 51.
0
41
0 8
0 3 1
Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
find the vertex matrix of the new rose bed plan. R(4, 1), S(0, 0), T(0, 3), and U(8, 1).
3 7 5 1
1
3 7 5 1
2 1 3 7 5
2 2 2 2 19. The vertex matrix for ABC is 65 4 3
5 7
.
1 3 7
2 2 2 5
2
Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
The new coordinates are (1.5, 0.5), (3.5, 1.5), find the vertex matrix of the image.
(2.5, 3.5), and (0.5, 2.5).
14. All dimensions have been reduced by 1
2 , so the
2 65 4 3
5 7
12 8 6
10 10 14
coordinates of the center after the changes have The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
been made will be 12 (4, 4) (2, 2).
A(12, 10), B(8, 10), and C(6, 14).
1 0 2
20. The vertex matrix for DEF is
4 1 3
.
Pages 509–511 Practice and Apply Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
4 1
F
15. The vertex matrix for E is . find the vertex matrix of the image.
1 3 0 3 1 2
1
The translation matrix is 25 25.
1
3 2
3 4
0
1
3
4 1
3 3 1
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
Find the vertex matrix for the image.
4 1 2 2 6 3 D 1
4
1
2
3 , 3 , E 0, 3 , and F 3 , 1 .
1 3
5 5
6 8 21. The vertex matrix for quadrilateral GHIJ is
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are 4 4 6
E(6, 6) and F(3, 8). 2 6 8 10
6
.
3 4 7
16. The vertex matrix for JKL is
5 8 5
. Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
find the vertex matrix of the image.
The translation matrix is
3 3
4 4
. 3
4 1
2 42 46 6
8
6
10
2 2
1 3
3 3
4 5
Find the vertex matrix for the image.
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
35 4
8
7
5
3 3 3
4 4 4
6
1 1
4
4
1 G(2, 1), H(2, 3), I(3, 4), and J(3, 5).
22. The vertex matrix for pentagon KLMNO is
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
J(6, 1), K(1, 4), and L(4, 1).
2 2 2 2 21 3 6 4 3
1 1 3 3
.
17. The vertex matrix for MNOP is
7 9 7 5
. Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
The translation matrix is
3 3 3 3
6 6 6 6
. find the vertex matrix of the image.
333 Chapter 9
10 2 4
0 2 4 Find the vertex matrix for the image.
1 2 1 2 1 3 4 4 4 7 3 1
The coordinates of the vertices of the image
3
1
3 2
3
1 1 1
2 2 3
are X(2, 2), and Y(4, 1). The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
24. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the line V(7, 2), W(3, 2), and X(1, 3).
0 1 29. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
y x is .
0 1
1 0
5 0 1
rotation of 90° is
1 0
.
The vertex matrix for ABC is 3 5 3
.
Multiply the vertex matrix for ABC by the
The vertex matrix for VWX is 33 1 3
3 2.
reflection matrix to find the vertex matrix of the Multiply the vertex matrix for VWX by the
image. rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
0 1 3 5 3 image.
01 10 35 0 1 3 1 3 3 2
5 3 5 0 1
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
1 0
3 3 2
3
3
1 3
A(3, 5), B(5, 0), and C(3, 1). The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
25. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the x-axis V(3, 3), W(3, 1), and X(2, 3).
is
1
0 1
0
. 30. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the line
9 2 4 2
.
The translation matrix is 23 3 3 3 3
2 2 2 2
.
1 6 3 4
Find the vertex matrix for the image.
Multiply the vertex matrix for quadrilateral HIJK
1 4 2 0 2
by the reflection matrix to find the vertex matrix
of the image.
1 1 4 4 1
3
3 3 3 3
2 2 2 2 2
1 0
9 2 4 2
0 1 1 6 3 4
9 2 4 2
1 6 3 4 32 1
1
1
2
3 5
2 1
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
H(9, 1), I(2, 6), J(4, 3), and K(2, 4). P(2, 3), Q(1, 1), R(1, 2), S(3, 2),
3 1 and T(5, 1).
27. The vertex matrix for VWX is
3 3 2
3
. 32. The vertex matrix for polygon PQRST is
1 4 2 0 2
Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
find the vertex matrix of the image. 1 1 4 4 1
.
2 2
2 Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
3
2
3 3
1 3
3 2
2
3
4
2 3
find the vertex matrix of the image.
1 4 2 0 2 0 6
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are 3
1 1 4 4 1
3 12 6
3 3 12 12 3
V(2, 2), W 2 4
3 , 2 , and X 2, 3 .
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
P(3, 3), Q(12, 3), R(6, 12), S(0, 12),
28. The vertex matrix for VWX is 33 1 3
3 2. and T(6, 3).
Chapter 9 334
33. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the y-axis 37. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
1 0 0 1
is 0 1
. rotation of 90° is
1 0
.
21
The vertex matrix for polygon PQRST is 6 5 1
The vertex matrix for STUV is .
1 4 2 0 2 1 3 3
1 1 4 4 1
. Multiply the vertex matrix for STUV by the
Multiply the vertex matrix for PQRST by the rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
reflection matrix to find the vertex matrix of the iamge.
0 1 1 1 3 3
image. 2 6 5 1
1 0 1 4 2 0 2 0 1 1 3 3
1 2 6 5 1
0 1 1 1 4 4 1 The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
0 2 S(1, 2), T(1, 6), U(3, 5), and V(3, 1).
11 4
1
2
4 4 1 38. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
P(1, 1), Q(4, 1), R(2, 4), S(0, 4),
rotation of 270° is
0 1
1 0
.
and T(2, 1). The vertex matrix for pentagon ABCDE is
1 4 4 5
34. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
1 0
1
6
0 8 10 3
.
rotation of 180° is
0 1 . Multiply the vertex matrix for pentagon ABCDE
The vertex matrix for polygon PQRST is by the rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of
the image.
1 4 2 0 2
1 1 4 4 1
. 0 1 1
6 4 4 5
1 0 1 0 8 10 3
Multiply the vertex matrix for PQRST by the
8 10 3
rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
image.
11 0
6
4 4 5
10 1 4 2
0 0 2 The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
1 1 4 A(1, 1), B(0, 6), C(8, 4), D(10, 4),
1 4 1
and E(3, 5).
4 2 0 2
11
1 4 4 1 39. The vertex matrix for polygon ABCDEF is
3 2 2 3 2 2
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
P(1, 1), Q(4, 1), R(2, 4), S(0, 4),
1 4 4 1 2 2
.
and T(2, 1). Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
find the vertex matrix of the image.
35. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
3 2 2 3 2 2
rotation of 90° is
0 1
1 0 . 1
3 1 4 4 1 2 2
3 1 2 2 2 2
N
The vertex matrix for M is
10
. 121
3 3 1 3 3
1 4
4 2
1 2
N
Multiply the vertex matrix for M by the rotation 3 3 3 3 3 3
matrix to find the vertex matrix of the image. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the x-axis
0 1 12 3 1 10
1
0 1 10
12 3 is 10
1
0
.
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are Multiply the vertex matrix of the image by the
M(1, 12), and N(10, 3). reflection matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
36. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise final image.
1 0 1 2 2 2 2
rotation of 180° is
0 1
. 1 0
0 1
3 3 1 3 3
1 4 4 1 3 2
2
3 3 3 3 3
The vertex matrix for PQR is
5
1 1
.
1 2 4 1 3 2
2
3
1 2
3 23
Multiply the vertex matrix for PQR by the
1
3 4 4
3 3 3
1 2
3
2
3
rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
image. The coordinates of the vertices of the final image
1 0 5 1 1
5 1
0 1 1 2 4
1
1 2
4
are A 1, 1 2 4
2 4
3 , B 3 , 3 , C 3 , 3 ,
D1, 1
3 , E 3 , 3 , and F 3 , 3 .
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
2 2 2 2
P(5, 1), Q(1, 2), and R(1, 4).
335 Chapter 9
40. The vertex matrix for polygon ABCDEF is Multiply the vertex matrix for ABCDEF by the
rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
31 2
4
3 2 2
2
1 2 2
4
. image.
rotation of 90° is
0 1
. 62 4
8
4
8
6 4 4
2 4 4
1 0
Multiply the vertex matrix of the image by the The coordinates of the vertices of the final
rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the image are A(6, 2), B(4, 8), C(4, 8), D(6, 2),
final image. E(4, 4), and F(4, 4).
0 1 8 7 3 2 3 7
1 0 3 6 6 3 0 0 43. Each footprint is reflected in the y-axis, then
translated up two units.
3
6 6 3 0 0
8
7 3 2 3 7 44. Reflect in the y-axis using the matrix 10 0
1.
The coordinates of the vertices of the final image Translate up 2 units using
0
2
.
are A(3, 8), B(6, 7), C(6, 3),
D(3, 2), E(0, 3), and F(0, 7). Combine the two operations into
1 0
41. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the line
0 1 y
x
0
2
.
y x is
0 1
1 0
. 45. Imagine the y-axis in the middle of the plan. Then
a reflection in the y-axis could be used to create a
The vertex matrix for polygon ABCDEF is
floor plan with the garage on the left. The
3 2 2 3 2 2
1 4 4 1 2 2
. reflection matrix is
1 0
.
0 1
Multiply the vertex matrix for ABCDEF by the
46. A counterclockwise rotation of 90° could be used
reflection matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
to create a floor plan with the house facing east.
image.
0 1
0 1
1 0
3 2 2 3 2 2
1 4 4 1 2 2 The rotation matrix is
1 0
.
47. A reflection in the line y x transforms (x, y)
1 2 2
31 4
2
4
2 3 2 2 into (y, x). The matrix that performs this
0 1
operation is
1 0
.
The translation matrix is 14 1 1 1 1 1
4 4 4 4 4
. 48. Matrices make it simpler for movie makers to
Find the vertex matrix for the final image. move figures. Answers should include the
4 4 1 2 2 following.
1
3 2 2 3 2 2
1 1 1 1 1 1
4 4 4 4 4 4 • By using a succession of matrix
transformations, an object will move about in a
2 1 1
21 5
2
5
6 7 6 2 scene.
• Sample answer: programming the animation in
The coordinates of the vertices of the final image a screen saver
are A(2, 1), B(5, 2), C(5, 6), D(2, 7), E(1, 6), 49. The rotation matrix for a 90° clockwise rotation is
and F(1, 2). equivalent to a 270° counterclockwise rotation, or
10
42. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise 1
.
1 0
rotation of 180° is
0 1 . 0
50. B; since 26% are action movies and 14% are
The vertex matrix for polygon ABCDEF is comedies, 60% of the movie titles are neither
3 2 2 3 2 2 action movies nor comedies.
1 4 4 1 2 2
. 0.60(2500) 1500
So, 1500 movie titles are neither action movies
nor comedies.
Chapter 9 336
180(n 2) 180(8 2)
Page 511 Maintain Your Skills ¬
n 8
51. First, graph ABC. Next, translate each vertex by ¬135
, 1 unit left and 5 units down. Connect the
v 57. The measure of an exterior angle of a regular
vertices to form ABC. 360
polygon is given by n. The measure of an
y B 360
8 exterior angle of a 10-sided polygon is
10 or 36.
Use the Interior Angle Formula to find the
4
B interior angle of a regular 10-sided polygon.
A 180(n 2) 180(10 2)
¬
8 4 O 4 8x n 10
A ¬144
4 C
58. The two right triangles are similar. So, using the
DE CD
AB BC .
definition of similar polygons,
8
C
Solve for DE.
DE CD
AB BC
52. First, graph quadrilateral DEFG. Next, translate
CD
, 7 units left and 8 units up.
each vertex by w DE (AB)
BC
Connect the vertices to form quadrilateral 34
DE (1.75) .5
DEFG. 0.75
DE 80.5
E y
The tree is 80.5 m tall.
8
F
D 4
E
G Chapter 9 Study Guide and Review
8 4 O 4 x
F
4 D Vocabulary and Concept Check
1. false; center
G
2. true
53. Compare WX and WX. Note that the scale factor 3. false; component form
is negative since the image appears on the
4. false; magnitude
opposite side of the center with respect to the
preimage. 5. false; center of rotation
image length 6. true
scale factor ¬preimagelength 7. false; scale factor
2un
its
r ¬ 4units
8. false; resultant vector
r ¬1
2
Lesson-by-Lesson Review
Since 0 r 1, the dilation is a reduction. 9. Use the vertical grid lines to find images of each
54. The measure of an exterior angle of a regular vertex of ABC so that each vertex of the image
360
polygon is given by n. The measure of an is the same distance from the x-axis as the
360 vertex of the preimage or use (a, b) → (a, b)
exterior angle of a 5-sided polygon is 5 or 72.
Use the Interior Angle Formula to find the A(2, 1) → A(2, 1)
interior angle of a regular 5-sided polygon. B(5, 1) → B(5, 1)
180(n 2) 180(5 2) C(2, 3) → C(2, 3)
¬
n 5 Draw triangles ABC and ABC.
¬108
y C
55. The measure of an exterior angle of a regular
360
polygon is given by n. The measure of an B
36
0
exterior angle of a 6-sided polygon is 6 or 60.
A
Use the Interior Angle Formula to find the O A x
B
interior angle of a regular 6-sided polygon.
180(n 2) 180(6 2)
¬ C
n 6
¬120
56. The measure of an exterior angle of a regular
360
polygon is given by
n . The measure of an
36
0
exterior angle of a 8-sided polygon is 8 or 45.
Use the Interior Angle Formula to find the
interior angle of a regular 8-sided polygon.
337 Chapter 9
10. Use the transformation (a, b) → (b, a). 14. This translation moved each vertex 1 unit to the
W(4, 5) → W(5, 4) Y(3, 3) → Y(3, 3) right and 3 units down.
X(1, 5) → X(5, 1) Z(6, 3) → Z(3, 6) X(2, 5) → X(2 1, 5 3) or X(3, 2)
Draw parallelograms WXYZ and WXYZ. Y(1, 1) → Y(1 1, 1 3) or Y(2, 2)
y Z(5, 1) → Z(5 1, 1 3) or Z(6, 2)
W X
Draw XYZ and XYZ.
y X
Z Y
X
O X x
Y Z
Y O x
W Y Z
15. y
Z B
11. Use the vertical grid lines to find images of each
vertex of rectangle EFGH such that each vertex of D C
the image is the same distance from the line x 1
as the vertex of the preimage.
E(4, 2) → E(6, 2) G(0, 4) → G(2, 4) O x
F(0, 2) → F(2, 2) H(4, 4) → H(6, 4)
Draw rectangles EFGH and EFGH. C D
y x 1
x
B
O
E F F E Reflection in x-axis: B(3, 5) → (−3, −5)
C(3, 3) → (3, 3)
H D(5, 3) → (5, 3)
H G G
Reflection in the y-axis: (3, 5) → B(3, 5)
12. This translation moved each vertex 4 units to the
(3, 3) → C(3, 3)
left and 4 units down.
(5, 3) → D(5, 3)
E(2, 2) → E(2 4, 2 4) or E(2, 2)
The angle of rotation is 180°.
F(6, 2) → F(6 4, 2 4) or F(2, 2)
G(4, 2) → G(4 4, 2 4) or G(0, 6) 16. y y x
H(1, 1) → H(1 4, 1 4) or H(3, 5) F
Draw quadrilaterals EFGH and EFGH.
y E
H
F O G
G x
H
OH x
F
E
F G
Reflection in line y x: F(0, 3) → (3, 0)
H G(1, 0) → (0, 1)
G H(4, 1) → (1, 4)
13. This translation moved each vertex 2 units to the Reflection in line y x: (3, 0) → F(0, 3)
right and 4 units up. (0, 1) → G(1, 0)
S(3, 5) → S(3 2, 5 4) or S(1, 1). (1, 4) → H(4, 1)
T(1, 1) → T(1 2, 1 4) or T(1, 3) The angle of rotation is 180°.
Draw ST and S
T
.
y T
T O x
S
Chapter 9 338
17. y 24. No; let m1 represent one interior angle of the
N regular pentagon. Use the Interior Angle
M Formula.
180(n 2)
m1 ¬n
N
180(5 2)
M ¬5
L L
¬108
O x Since 108 is not a factor of 360, a pentagon will
not tessellate the plane.
25. Yes; the measure of an interior angle of an
equilateral triangle is 60, which is a factor of 360,
so an equilateral triangle will tessellate the plan.
26. No; let m1 represent one interior angle of the
regular decagon. Use the Interior Angle Formula.
Reflection in line y x: L(2, 2) → (2, 2) 180(n 2)
m1 ¬n
M(5, 3) → (3, 5)
180(10 2)
N(3, 6) → (6, 3) ¬10
Reflection in the x-axis: (2, 2) → L(2, 2) ¬144
(3, 5) → M(3, 5) Since 144 is not a factor of 360, a decagon will not
(6, 3) → N(6, 3) tessellate the plane.
The angle of rotation is 90° counterclockwise. 27. CD 8, r 3
18. The figure has rotational symmetry of order 9 Use the Dilation Theorem.
because there are 9 rotations less than 360° CD r(CD)
(including 0 degrees) that produce an image CD (3)(8)
indistinguishable from the original. CD 24
magnitude ¬360°
order
28. CD 23 , r 6
36 0° Use the Dilation Theorem.
¬9
CD r(CD)
¬40°
CD (6)23
The magnitude of the symmetry is 40°.
36
0°
CD 4
19. magnitude ¬ order 29. CD 24, r 6
360°
¬ 9
Use the Dilation Theorem.
¬40° CD ¬r(CD)
The magnitude of the symmetry is 40°. 24 ¬(6)(CD)
4 ¬CD
Vertex 2 is moved 5 positions, or 5(40°) 200°. 10
30. CD 60, r 3
360°
20. magnitude ¬ order Use the Dilation Theorem.
360° CD ¬r(CD)
¬ 9
¬40° 1
60 ¬ 0
3 (CD)
The magnitude of the symmetry is 40°.
18 ¬CD
Divide 280° by the magnitude of the rotational
31. CD 12, r 5
6
symmetry.
280° Use the Dilation Theorem.
40° 7 positions
CD r(CD)
Vertex 5 is moved 7 positions, or to the original
position of vertex 7. CD 5
6 (12)
21. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the CD 10
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°. 32. CD 55 5
The tessellation is not uniform because the 2 ,r 4
Use the Dilation Theorem.
number of angles at the vertices varies.
CD ¬r(CD)
22. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°.
5
5
5
2 ¬ 4 (CD)
The tessellation is uniform because at every 22 ¬CD
vertex there is the same combination of shapes
33. Find P, Q, and R using the scale factor, r 2.
and angles. The tessellation is also regular since
it is formed by only one type of regular polygon. Preimage (x, y) Image (2x, 2y)
23. Yes; the pattern is a tessellation because at the P(1, 3) P(2, 6)
different vertices the sum of the angles is 360°. The Q(2, 2) Q(4, 4)
tessellation is uniform because at every vertex there
R(1, 1) R(2, 2)
is the same combination of shapes and angles.
339 Chapter 9
34. Find E, F, G, and H using the scale factor, Graph AB to determine how to find the direction.
r 2. Draw a right triangle that has AB as its
Preimage (x, y) Image (2x, 2y) hypotenuse and an acute angle at A.
E(3, 2) E(6, 4) y
F(1, 2) F(2, 4)
A
G(1, 2) G(2, 4)
H(3, 2) H(6, 4)
35. Find the change in x-values and the x
corresponding change in y-values. B
AB ¬x2 x1, y2 y1
¬0 (3), 2 (2)
¬3, 4 y y
36. Find the change in x-values and the tan A ¬
x
2
x
1
2 1
corresponding change in y-values. 2 5
¬
5 8
CD ¬x2 x1, y2 y1 7
¬
13
¬4 4, 2 (2)
7
¬8, 4 mA ¬tan1
13
37. Find the change in x-values and the ¬28.3
corresponding change in y-values. A vector in standard position that is equal to AB
EF ¬x2 x1, y2 y1 forms a 28.3° angle with the negative x-axis in
the third quadrant. So it forms a 180 28.3 or
¬1 1, 4 (4)
208.3° angle with the positive x-axis.
¬0, 8
Thus, AB has a magnitude of
218 or about
38. Find the magnitude using the Distance Formula. 14.8 units and a direction of about 208.3°.
AB ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2 40. Find the magnitude using the Distance Formula.
¬
[9 (6)]
2 (3 4)2 AB ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2
¬
58 ¬
[15 (14
)]2 ( 2
5 2)
¬7.6 ¬
890
Graph AB to determine how to find the direction. ¬29.8
Draw a right triangle that has AB as its
Graph AB to determine how to find the direction.
hypotenuse and an acute angle at A.
Draw a right triangle that has AB as its
y
hypotenuse and an acute angle at A.
A
y
10
x x
A
10 20
10 B
B
y y
tan A ¬
x
2
x
1
2 1 y y
3 4 tan A ¬
x
2
x
1
¬
9
(6) 2 1
5 2
¬
15 (
¬7
3
14)
7
¬
mA ¬tan1 7
3
29
¬66.8 mA ¬tan1 7
29
A vector in standard position that is equal to AB ¬13.6
forms a 66.8° angle with the negative x-axis in A vector in standard position that is equal to AB
the third quadrant. So it forms a 180 66.8 or forms a 13.6° angle with the positive x-axis in
246.8° angle with the positive x-axis. the fourth quadrant. So it forms a 360 13.6 or
Thus, AB has a magnitude of
58 or about 346.4° angle with the positive x-axis.
7.6 units and a direction of about 246.8°. Thus, AB has a magnitude of
890 or about
39. Find the magnitude using the Distance Formula. 29.8 units and a direction of about 346.4°.
AB ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2 41. Find the magnitude using the Distance Formula.
AB ¬
(x
2x1)2
(y2 y1)2
¬
(5
8)2
(2
5)2
¬
218
¬
(45
16)2
(0
40)2
¬14.8 ¬
5321
¬72.9
Chapter 9 340
Graph AB to determine how to find the direction.
Draw a right triangle that has AB as its
The vertex matrix for DEF is 3
2
0 2
5 4
.
hypotenuse and an acute angle at A. Multiply the vertex matrix for DEF by the
y A rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
20 image.
3 0 2 2 5 4
10 0 1
1 0
2 5 4
3 0 2
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
B 10 10 20x
D(2, 3), E(5, 0), and F(4, 2).
10
20
46. The vertex matrix for PQR is
9 1 4
2 1 5 .
y2 y1
tan A ¬
x2 x1
The translation matrix is 52 2 2
5 5
.
0 40 Find the vertex matrix of the image.
¬
45 16
40
¬
61 92 1
1
4
5
2 2 2
5 5 5
11 3
3 6 6
0
40
mA ¬tan1 61
The reflection matrix for a reflection in the x-axis
¬33.3
A vector in standard position that is equal to AB
is
1 0
0 1
.
forms a 33.3° angle with the negative x-axis in Multiply the vertex matrix of the image by the
the third quadrant. So it forms a 180 33.3 or reflection matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
213.3° angle with the positive x-axis. final image.
Thus, AB has a magnitude of
5321 or about
72.9 units and a direction of about 213.3°. 10 1
0
11 3 6
3 6 0
11 3 6
3 6 0
3 0 2
42. The vertex matrix for DEF is 2 5 4 . The coordinates of the vertices of the final image
are P(11, 3), Q(3, 6), and R(6, 0).
The translation matrix is
3 3
6 6
.3
6 47. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
1 0
Find the vertex matrix for the image.
rotation of 180° is 0 1
.
3 0 2 3 3 3 6 3 1 The vertex matrix for WXYZ
2 5 4 6 6 6 8 1 10 8 2 1 6
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
is 1 3 0 3
.
D(6, 8), E(3, 1), and F(1, 10). Multiply the vertex matrix for WXYZ by the
3 0 2 rotation matrix to find the vertex matrix of the
43. The vertex matrix for DEF is 2 5 4 . image.
1 0 8 2 1 6
Multiply the vertex matrix by the scale factor to
find the vertex matrix of the image.
0 1
1 3 0 3 1 3 0 3
8 2 1 6
Multiply the vertex matrix of the image by the
12 8
3 0
0 2 5 5 scale factor to find the vertex matrix of the final
4
5 2 5 4 8 16 image.
5 4 5
16 4 2 12
8 2 1 6
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are 2 1 3 0 3
2 6 0 6
D 5 , 5 , E(0, 4), and F 5 , 5 .
12
8 8 1
6
The coordinates of the vertices of the final image
44. The reflection matrix for a reflection in the line are W(16, 2), X(4, 6), Y(2, 0), and
Z(12, 6).
y x is
0 1
1 0
.
3 0 2
The vertex matrix for DEF is 2 5 4 . Chapter 9 Practice Test
Multiply the vertex matrix for DEF by the
reflection matrix to find the vertex matrix of the Page 517
image. 1. isometry 2. uniform
3 0 2 2 5 4
0 1
1 0
2 5 4
3 0 2 3. scalar 4. E
C
5. D 6. BCA
The coordinates of the vertices of the image are
D(2, 3), E(5, 0), and F(4, 2).
45. The rotation matrix for a counterclockwise
rotation of 270° is
0 1
1 0
.
341 Chapter 9
7. First, graph PQR. Next, translate each vertex 11. y A
right 3 units and up 1 unit. Connect the vertices C B
to form PQR.
P(3, 5) → P(3 3, 5 1) or P(0, 6) x
Q(2, 1) → Q(2 3, 1 1) or Q(1, 2) B C
R(4, 2) → R(4 3, 2 1) or R(1, 3) A
Chapter 9 342
18. MN 36, r 3 24. The distance Gunja must travel can be found by
Use the Dilation Theorem. multiplying the distance measured on the map by
MN ¬r(MN) the scale factor.
36 ¬(3)(MN) 150
2.25 in. mi
1 in. 337.5 mi
12 ¬MN
Gunja must travel 337.5 mi.
19. MN 9, r 1
5 25. A; A reflection of (3, 4) in the x-axis gives (3, 4).
Use the Dilation Theorem. A reflection of (3, 4) in the origin gives (3, 4).
MN r(MN) A reflection of (3, 4) in the y-axis gives (3,4).
MN 1
5 (9)
A reflection of (3, 4) in the origin gives (3, 4).
Only choice A, a reflection in the x-axis,
MN 9
5 gives (3, 4).
20. MN 20, r 2
3
Use the Dilation Theorem.
MN ¬r(MN)
20 ¬2 Chapter 9 Standardized Test Practice
3 (MN)
343 Chapter 9
11. Given:
ABA
C
, A 12b. Find Q, R, S, and T using the scale factor,
D
A A
E r 2.
Prove: ABD ACE Preimage (x, y) Image (2x, 2y)
Proof: Q(2, 2) Q(4, 4)
B D E C R(2, 4) R(4, 8)
Statements Reasons S(3, 2) S(6, 4)
B
1. AA
C
, A
D
A
E
1. Given T(3, 4) T(6, 8)
2. ABD ACE 2. Isos. Thm. R y
8
ADE AED
Q
4
3. ADB and ADE 3. If 2 form a linear
are supplementary. pair, then they are
AEC and AED suppl. 8 4 O 4 8x
are supplementary. 4
S
4. ADB AEC 4. suppl. to 8
are . T
12c. Multiply the x- and y-coordinates of each vertex
5. ABD ACE 5. AAS by the scale factor; Q(2, 2) becomes (2 2, 2 2)
or Q(4, 4).
12a. y
8 12d. Enlargements and reductions preserve the shape
of the figure. Congruence transformations
R 4
Q preserve collinearity, betweenness of points, and
angle and distance measures.
8 4 O 4 8x
S 4
T
8
Chapter 9 344
Chapter 10 Circles
Page 521 Getting Started 10. x2 4x ¬10
x2 4x 10 ¬0
1. 4p ¬72
9 Use the Quadratic Formula.
9 4p ¬9(72)
4 9 4
a 1, b 4, c 10
b
b
4ac 2
p ¬162 x ¬ 2a
2. 6.3p ¬15.75 (4)
(4)2 )
4(1)(10
x ¬
2(1)
6.3p 15.
75
¬
6.3 6.3 4
56
x ¬
2
p ¬2.5
4 2
14
3. 3x 12 ¬8x x ¬ 2
3x 12 3x ¬8x 3x x ¬2 14
12 ¬5x x ¬5.7, 1.7
12 5x 11. 3x2 2x 4 0
5 ¬ 5
Use the Quadratic Formula.
12
5 ¬x or x ¬2.4
a 3, b 2, c 4
4. 7(x 2) ¬3(x 6) b b
x
4ac
2
7x 14 ¬3x 18 2a
7x 3x ¬18 14 (2)
(2)
4(3)(4)
2
x 2(3)
4x ¬32
32 2
52
4x x 6
4 ¬ 4
13
2 2
x
x ¬8 6
5. C ¬2pr 1
13
x 3
2pr
C ¬ x 1.5, 0.9
2p 2p
C
¬r 12. x2 ¬x 15
2p x2 x 15 ¬0
C
6. r ¬
6.28
Use the Quadratic Formula.
a 1, b 1, c 15
6.28r ¬6.28C
6.28 b b
4ac
2
x
6.28r ¬C 2a
7. c2 ¬a2 b2 (1)
(1)
2 )
4(1)(15
x 2(1)
172 ¬82 x2
289 ¬64 x2 1
61
x 2
225 ¬x2
x 4.4, 3.4
¬
225 x2
13. 2x2 x ¬15
15 ¬x
2x2 x 15 ¬0
8. c2 ¬a2 b2 Use the Quadratic Formula.
102 ¬62 x2 a 2, b 1, c 15
100 ¬36 x2
b b
4ac
2
64 ¬x2 x
2a
¬x
64 2 1 5)
1 4(2)(1
2
x 2(2)
8 ¬x
c2 ¬a2 b2 1
121
9. x 4
(6x)2 ¬722 722
1 11
36x2 ¬5184 5184 x 4
36x2 ¬10,368 x 2.5, 3
2
36x 10,368
36 ¬ 36
x2 ¬288
x ¬288
10-1 Circles and Circumference
x ¬17.0
345 Chapter 10
Pages 525–526 Check for Understanding 18. Two chords are shown: B E or C
D.
1. Sample answer: The value of is calculated by E
19. B is the only chord that goes through the center,
dividing the circumference of a circle by the E
so B is a diameter.
diameter. A
20. F is a radius not contained in a diameter.
2. d 2r, r 1
2d 21. The circle has its center at R, so it is named circle
3. Except for a diameter, two radii and a chord of a R, or R.
circle can form a triangle. The Triangle Inequality 22. Six radii are shown: RT, R
U
, RV, R
W, R
X, or R
Z
.
Theorem states that the sum of two sides has to
23. Three chords are shown: Z V, T
X
, or W
Z .
be greater than the third. So, 2r has to be greater
than the measure of any chord, but 2r is the X
24. T or W
Z are the chords that go through the
measure of the diameter. So the diameter has to X
center, so T and W
Z are diameters.
be longer than any other chord of the circle. U
25. R and RV are radii not contained in a diameter.
4. The circle has its center at E, so it is named circle 26. d 2r
E, or E. d 2(2) or 4 ft
5. Four radii are shown: EA, E
B
, EC
, or ED. 27. r 1
2d
6. Three chords are shown: A B, A
C, or BD
.
r 1
2 (5) or 2.5 ft
C
7. A and BD
are chords that go through the center,
C
so A and BD are diameters. 28. TR 1
2 (TX)
8. r 1
2d TR 1
2 (120) or 60 cm
r 1
29. ZW 2RZ
2 (12) or 6
ZW 2(32) or 64 in. or 5 ft 4 in.
The radius is 6 mm.
R
30. U and R
V are both radii.
9. d 2r
RV UR
d 2(5.2) or 10.4
RV 18 in.
The diameter is 10.4 in.
T
31. X is a diameter and UR is a radius.
10. Since the radius of Z is 7, XZ 7.
Z
Y is part of radius X
Z
. UR 1
2 XT
XY YZ ¬XZ UR 1
2 YZ ¬7 2 (1.2) or 0.6 m
YZ ¬5 32. AZ CW
AZ 2
11. Since the radius of W is 4, IW 4 and WY 4.
IX
is part of diameter IY
. X
33. A is a radius of A, and Z
X is part of A
X
.
IX XY ¬IW WY AZ ZX ¬AX
IX 2 ¬4 4 2 ZX ¬1
2 (10)
IX ¬6
ZX ¬3
12. IC IW WY XZ ZC XY
34. is a radius of B, and B
BZ X
is part of B
Z
.
IC 4 4 7 7 2
ZX BX ¬BZ
IC 20
13. d 2r 3 BX ¬1
2 (30)
d 2(5) or 10 m 3 BX ¬15
C d
BX ¬12
C (10) or about 31.42 m
35. BY BX
14. C ¬d
BY 12
2368 ¬d
2368 36. YW ZX
¬d
YW 3
753.76 ¬d 37. AC AZ ZW WC
d ¬753.76 ft AC 2 30 2 or 34
r ¬1
2d 38. FG GH
FG 10
r ¬1
2 (753.76) or 376.88 ft 39. FH FG GH
15. B; C d FH 10 10 or 20
C ¬(9) or 9 mm
40. GL GH
GL 10
L
41. G is a diameter of J, so GL 10.
Pages 526–527 Practice and Apply J
G is a radius of J.
16. The circle has its center at F, so it is named circle
F, or F. GJ 1
2 (GL)
17. Three radii are shown: FA, F
B
, or FE. GJ 1
2 (10) or 5
Chapter 10 346
L
42. J is a radius of J. 53. The diameter of the circle is the same as the
hypotenuse of the right triangle.
JL 1
2 (10) or 5
d2 32 42
43. is a diameter of K, so JL 5.
JL
d2 25
K
J is a radius of K.
d 25 or 5 ft
JK 1
2 JL C d
JK 1
2 (5) or 2.5 C (5) or 5 ft
44. d ¬2r 54. The diameter of the circle is the same as the
d ¬2(7) or 14 mm hypotenuse of the right triangle.
C ¬d d2 102 102
C ¬(14) or about 43.98 mm d2 200
45. r ¬1
2d d 200 or 102 in.
r ¬1
C d
2 (26.8) or 13.4 cm
C ¬d C (102 ) or 102 in.
C ¬(26.8) or about 84.19 cm 55. The diameter of the circle is the same as the
hypotenuse of the right triangle.
46. C ¬d
26 ¬d d2 (4 2)2 (4 2)2
26 ¬d or d 26 mi d 64
2
r ¬1
d 64 or 8 cm
2d
C d
r ¬1
2 (26) or 13 mi C (8) or 8 cm
47. C ¬d
56. 1; This description is the definition of a radius.
76.4 ¬d
76
.4
57. 0; The longest chord of a circle is the diameter,
¬d
which contains the center.
24.32 d or d 24.32 m 58. C 2r
r 1
2d
C 2(800) or about 5026.5 ft
59. 800 200 600
r 1
2 (24.32) or 12.16 m 800 300 500
48. r 1
2d
The range of values for the radius of the explosion
circle is 500 to 600 ft.
2 12 2 or 6 4 yd
r 1
1 1
60. C 2r
C d C 2(500) or about 3142
C 121
2 or about 39.27 yd
C 2(600) or about 3770
49. d 2r The least and maximum circumferences are
3142 ft and 3770 ft, respectively.
d 263
4 or 13 2 in.
1 61. Let r the radius of O.
C d x2 y2 ¬r2
p2 t2 ¬r2
C 131
2 or about 42.41 in.
x2 y2 p2 t2 ¬288
50. r 1
2d Substitute r2 for x2 y2 and r2 for p2 t2.
r2 r2 ¬288
r 1
2 (2a) or a 2r2 ¬288
C d r2 ¬144
C (2a) or about 6.28a r ¬12
51. d 2r C 2r
C 2(12) or 24 units
d 2a
6 or about 0.33a 62. Sample answer: about 251.3 feet. Answers should
C 2r include the following.
C 2a
6 or about 1.05a
• The distance the animal travels is
approximated by the circumference of the circle.
52. The diameter of the circle is the same as the
hypotenuse of the right triangle. • The diameter for the circle on which the animal
is located becomes 80 2 or 78. The
d2 162 302
circumference of this circle is 78. Multiply by
d2 1156 22 to get a total distance of 22(78) or
d 1156
or 34 m 5391 feet. This is a little over a mile.
C d
C (34) or 34 m
347 Chapter 10
63. Let r the radius of C. Then 2r the radius mC ¬tan1 1
2
of B, and 4r the radius of A.
¬27
sum of circumferences ¬2r 2(2r) 2(4r)
42 ¬2r 4r 8r The magnitude is about 44.7 and the direction is
42 ¬14r about 27°.
3 ¬r 70. AB |k|(AB)
AC r 2(2r) 4r AB 6(5)
AC 3 2(2 3) 4(3) AB 30
AC 3 12 12 or 27 71. AB |k|(AB)
100d
64. A; AB 1.5(16)
k% of gasoline has been pumped. AB 24
65. Small circle: C 2r
72. AB ¬|k|(AB)
C 2(5) or 10
23
¬1
2
Medium circle: r 5 5 or 10
C 2r ¬1
3
C 2(10) or 20
Q
73. Given: R bisects SRT R
Large circle: r 5 5 5 or 15 Prove: mSQR mSRQ
C 2r
C 2(15) or 30
The circumferences from least to greatest are S Q T
10, 20, and 30.
Proof:
Statements Reasons
1. bisects SRT.
RQ 1. Given
Page 528 Maintain Your Skills 2. SRQ QRT 2. Def. of bisector
| ¬1
66. |AB
2 42
3. mSRQ mQRT 3. Def. of
¬17
4. mSQR 4. Exterior Angle
¬4.1 mT mQRT Theorem
mA ¬tan1 4
5. mSQR mQRT 5. Def. of Inequality
1
6. mSQR mSRQ 6. Substitution
¬76
The magnitude is about 4.1 and the direction is
about 76°.
| ¬4
67. |V
2 92 F
74. a is the midpoint of O . Therefore, the missing
coordinates are (2a, 0).
¬97
75. x 2x ¬180 Linear pair
¬9.8
3x ¬180
mV ¬tan1 9
4 x ¬60
¬66 76. 2x 3x ¬90 Lines are perpendicular.
The magnitude is about 9.8 and the direction is 5x ¬90
about 66°. x ¬18
| ¬
68. |AB (7 4
)2 (2
2 2)2 77. (3x x) 2x ¬180 Linear pair
¬ 3 2
2 0 2 6x ¬180
x ¬30
¬409
78. 3x 5x ¬180 Linear pair
¬20.2
8x ¬180
22 2
tanA ¬
74
x ¬22.5
20
¬ 79. 3x ¬90 lines form 2 rt .
3
20 x ¬30
mA ¬tan1
3 80. x x x ¬360
¬81 3x ¬360
The magnitude is about 20.2 and the direction is x ¬120
about 81°.
| ¬
69. |CD (40
0)2 2
(0 (20))
¬ 40
2 20 2
¬2000
¬44.7
0 (20)
tanC ¬
40 0
20 1
¬
40 or 2
Chapter 10 348
12. C 2r
10-2 Angles and Arcs C 2(12) or 24
Let arc length.
60
Pages 532–533 Check for Understanding 0 ¬
36 24
60
360 (24) ¬
1. Sample answer: A
4 ¬
The length of
90 110
C TR is 4 units or about 12.57 units.
160 B
13. Sample answer:
25%(360°) 90°, 23%(360°) 83°,
AB,
BC,
AC,
ABC,
BCA, 110,
CAB; mAB 28%(360°) 101°, 22%(360°) 79°,
mBC 160, mAC 90, mABC 270, 2%(360°) 7°
250, mCAB 200
mBCA
2. A diameter divides the circle into two congruent
arcs. Without the third letter, it is impossible to
Pages 533–535 Practice and Apply
know which semicircle is being referenced.
14. AGC and CGB are a linear pair.
3. Sample answer: Concentric circles have the same mAGC mCGB ¬180
center, but different radius measures; congruent 60 mCGB ¬180
circles usually have different centers but the mCGB ¬120
same radius measure.
15. AGC and BGE are vertical angles.
4. MCN and NCL are a linear pair. mBGE mAGC
mMCN mNCL ¬180 mBGE 60
60 mNCL ¬180
16. AGD is a right angle.
mNCL ¬120
mAGD 90
5. MCR and RCL are a linear pair.
17. One way to find mDGE is by using AGD and
mMCR mRCL ¬180
BGE. AGB is a straight angle.
(x 1) (3x 5) ¬180
mAGD mDGE mBGE ¬mAGB
4x 4 ¬180
90 mDGE 60 ¬180
4x ¬176
mDGE ¬30
x ¬44
Use the value of x to find mRCL. 18. CGD is composed of adjacent angles, CGA and
AGD.
mRCL ¬3x 5
mCGD mCGA mAGD
¬3(44) 5
mCGD 60 90
¬132 5 or 137
mCGD 150
6. Use the value of x to find mRCM.
19. AGE is composed of adjacent angles, AGD and
From Exercise 5, x ¬44.
DGE.
mRCM ¬x 1
mAGE mAGD mDGE
¬44 1 or 43
mAGE 90 30
7. RCN is composed of adjacent angles, RCM mAGE 120
and MCN.
20. ZXV and YXW are vertical angles.
mRCN mRCM mMCN
mZXV ¬mYXW
43 60 or 103
2x 65 ¬4x 15
8.
BC is a minor arc, so mBC mBAC.
50 ¬2x
BAC ¬EAD 25 ¬x
mBAC ¬mEAD Use the value of x to find mZXV.
¬mEAD
mBC
¬42 mZXV 2x 65
mBC 2(25) 65
9. CBE is a semicircle. 50 65 or 115
180
mCBE 21. Use the value of x to find mYXW.
is by using
10. One way to find mEDB EDC and CB. From Exercise 20, x 25.
EDC is a semicircle. mYXW 4x 15
mEDC mCB
mEDB 4(25) 15
mEDB 180 42 or 222 100 15 or 115
is by using
11. One way to find mCD CDE and DE. 22. ZXY and ZXV are a linear pair.
CDE is a semicircle. mZXY mZXV ¬180
mDE ¬mCDE
mCD mZXY 115 ¬180
mCD 42 ¬180 mZXY ¬65
¬138
mCD 23. ZXY and VXW are vertical angles.
VXW ¬ZXY
mVXW ¬mZXY
mVXW ¬65
349 Chapter 10
24. mBOC. 33. WZV and UZY are vertical angles.
BC is a minor arc, so mBC
B
Since A is a diameter and AOC is a right WZV ¬UZY
angle, mAOB 180 and mAOC 90. mWZV ¬mUZY
¬mUY
mBOC mAOC ¬mAOB mWV
mBOC 90 ¬180 mWV ¬76
mBOC ¬90
34. mWX mWZX
¬90 2x
mBC mWX
mAOC. From Exercise 32, x 26.
25. AC is a minor arc, so mAC
2(26) or 52
AOC is a right angle. mWX
¬mAOC
mAC 35. XZY ¬WZX
¬90
mAC mXZY ¬mWZX
¬mWX
26. mAOE. mXY
AE is a minor arc, so mAE
AOE and BOC are vertical angles. mXY ¬52
AOE ¬BOC mXY
36. mWUY 360 mWX
mAOE ¬mBOC
mWUY 360 52 52 or 256
¬mBOC
mAE 360 mWX mXY
¬90 37. mYVW
mAE
mYVW 360 52 52 or 256
27. mEOB. 360 mXY
EB is a minor arc, so mEB 38. mXVY
EOB and AOC are vertical angles.
mXVY 360 52 or 308
EOB ¬AOC 360 mWX
39. mWUX
mEOB ¬mAOC
¬mAOC mWUX 360 52 or 308
mEB
¬90
mEB 40. C d
C (32) or 32
B
28. Since A is a diameter, mAOB 180.
mAOB Let arc length.
mACB
180 10
0
360 ¬ 32
mACB
10
0
360 (32) ¬
29. Since BOD DOE EOF FOA,
mBOD mDOE mEOF mFOA.
80
9 ¬
Since mAOB 180, each of the four angles The length of
80
DE is 9 units or about
18
0
measures 4 or 45. 27.93 units.
AD is composed of adjacent arcs,
DE,
EF, and
FA. 41. C d
C 32
mAD mDE mEF mFA
mDOE mEOF mFOA 360 mDCE
mAD mDHE
45 45 45 or 135
mAD 360 90 or 270
mDHE
30.
CBF is composed of adjacent arcs,
CB,
BD,
DE, Let arc length.
and
EF. 27
0
360 ¬ 32
mCB mBD mDE mEF
mCBF
27
0
360 (32) ¬
mCBF mCOB mBOD mDOE
mEOF 24 ¬
90 45 45 45 or 225
mCBF The length of
DHE is 24 units or about
360 mAC 75.40 units.
31. mADC
360 mHCF
mADC 360 mAOC 42. mHDF
360 90 or 270
mADC 360 125 or 235
mHDF
32. Find the value of x. Let arc length.
VY is a diameter,
Since VUY is a semicircle.
VUY 23
5
360 ¬ 32
and UY. VU is a
is composed of adjacent arcs, VU 23
5
mVZU. UY
minor arc, so mVU is a minor arc, 360 (32) ¬
so mUY mUZY. 188
9 ¬
mUY mVUY
mVU The length of 188
HDF is
9 units or about
mVZU mUZY 180 65.62 units.
4x (2x 24) 180
43. Let arc length.
6x 24 180
45
6x 156
360 ¬
32
x 26 4 5
.
36 0 (32) ¬
Use the value of x to find mUY 4 ¬
mUY 2x 24
2(26) 24 The length of
HD is 4 units or about 12.57 units.
mUY
52 24 or 76 44. Sample answer: 76%(360°) 273°,
mUY
16%(360°) 58°, 5%(360°) 18°, 3%(360°) 11°
Chapter 10 350
45. The first category is a major arc, and the other 56. Sample answer: The hands of the clock form
three categories are minor arcs. central angles.
46. How many free files Answers should include the following.
have you collected? • The hands form acute, right, and obtuse angles.
101 to 500 • Some times when the angles formed by the
16% minute and hour hand are congruent are 1:00
500 to 1000 and 11:00, 2:00 and 10:00, 3:00 and 9:00, 4:00
5%
and 8:00, and 5:00 and 7:00. They also form
100 or less more than 1000
76% congruent angles many other times of the day,
3%
such as 3:05 and 8:55.
47. always 57. B; C 2r or about 6.3r
P 2 2w
48. Sometimes; the central angle of a minor arc can
P 2(2r) 2r or 6r
be greater than 90°.
Since 6.3r 6r, the circumference of the circle is
49. Never; the sum of the measures of the central greater than the perimeter of the rectangle.
angles of a circle is always 360.
58. Rewrite 3:5:10 as 3x:5x:10x and use these
50. always measures for the measures of the central angles
51. Let m1 2x, then m2 3x and m3 4x. of the circle.
m1 m2 m3 ¬360 3x 5x 10x ¬360
2x 3x 4x ¬360 18x ¬360
9x ¬360 x ¬20
x ¬40 The measures of the angles are 3(20) or 60, 5(20)
Therefore, m1 2(40) or 80, m2 3(40) or or 100, and 10(20) or 200.
120, and m3 4(40) or 160.
52. C d
C (12) or 12 in. Page 535 Maintain Your Skills
The measure of the angle from the minute hand 59. d 2r
to the hour hand at 2:00 is 60. d 2(10) or 20
Let arc length. C d
6
0
360 ¬ 12 C (20) or about 62.83
6
0 60. r 1
2d
360 (12) ¬
2 ¬ r 1
2 (13) or 6.5
The arc length is 2 in. or about 6.3 in. C d
53. C 2r C (13) or about 40.84
C 2(12) or 24 61. C ¬d
Let arc length. 28 ¬d
27
0 28 d or d 28
360 ¬ 24
27
0 r 1
2d
360 (24) ¬
18 ¬ r 1
2 (28) or 14
The length of the arc is 18 ft or about 56.5 ft. 62. C ¬d
54. Given: BAC DAE B C 75.4 ¬d
Prove:
BC DE D 75
.4
¬d
A
E d ¬24.00
r 1
2d
Proof: r 1
2 (24.00) or 12.00
Statements Reasons 63. magnitude (72) 2
(45)2 or about 84.9
45
1. BAC DAE 1. Given direction tan1
72 or about 32
2. mBAC mDAE 2. Def. of The magnitude is about 84.9 newtons and the
mDE 3. Def. of arc measure direction is about 32° northeast.
3. mBC
Def. of arcs 12 10
4. BC DE 4. 64.
18 x ¬x
55. No; the radii are not equal, so the proportional 12x ¬10(18 x)
part of the circumferences would not be the same. 12x ¬180 10x
Thus, the arcs would not be congruent. 22x ¬180
2
x ¬8
11
351 Chapter 10
26
.2 17.3
65. x ¬
24.2 2 75. 2x 2x x ¬180
26.2(24.22) ¬17.3x 5x ¬180
634.564 ¬17.3x x ¬36
36.68 ¬x 76. 3x ¬180
66. Construct a line perpendicular to the line with x ¬60
the equation y 7 0 through point Q(6, 2).
y
y70
10-3 Arcs and Chords
V
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
X
2 0
2 3
2 2
7 1
¬
W
¬24.5
Y
The distance between the lines is 24.5
units. Proof: Because all radii are congruent,
68. 90 57.5 ¬32.5 U
X X VX W
X Y
. You are given that
180 57.5 ¬122.5 V
U W Y, so UVX WYX, by SSS. Thus,
The measures of the complement and supplement UXV WXY by CPCTC. Since the central
are 32.5 and 122.5, respectively. angles have the same measure, their intercepted
69. If ABC has three sides, then ABC is a triangle. arcs have the same measure and are therefore,
70. Both are true. congruent. Thus, UV WY.
bisects 1mAB.
71. x 42 since the triangle is isosceles. Y
5. O AB, so mAY 2
1
mAY 2mAB
72. x x 30 180 by the Angle Sum Theorem
2x ¬150 1(60) or 30
mAY 2
x ¬75 Y
6. O bisects A, so AX 1
B
2 (AB).
73. 40 40 x ¬180
AX 1
2 (AB)
x ¬180 80 or 100
74. x x 90 ¬180 AX 1
2 (10) or 5
2x ¬90
x ¬45
Chapter 10 352
7. Draw radius O A. Radius OA
is the hypotenuse of 22.
TZ bisects X
Y
, so XV VY.
OXA. XY XV VY
(OX)2 (AX)2 ¬(OA)2 XY 5 5 or 10
(OX)2 52 ¬102 mBC mCD mDE
mEF
23. mAB
(OX)2 25 ¬100 mGH mHA 36
0
mFG or 45
(OX)2 ¬75 8
OX ¬ 75 or 53 mMJ
mJK
mKL
36
0
24. mLM 4 or 90
B
8. A and CE
are equidistant from P, so AB
C E
. 25. 2x x 2x x ¬360
QE 1
2
(CE), so CE 2(20) or 40. 6x ¬360
B
A C E, so AB 40. x ¬60
9. (PE)2 ¬(PQ)2 (QE)2 2x ¬120
mRQ 120;
(PE)2 ¬102 202 mNP
60
(PE)2 ¬100 400 mNR mPQ
(PE)2 ¬500 26. (LK) (FL)2 ¬(FK)2
2
353 Chapter 10
Therefore CD 5x. 3. AN 1
3. Def. of bisector
(CD)2 (BD)2 (BC)2 2 MN;
(5x)2 (5x)2 ¬102 BQ 1
2 PQ
25x2 25x2 ¬100 4. MN PQ 4. Def. of segments
50x2 ¬100
5. 1 1
2 MN 2 PQ
5. Mult. Prop.
x2 ¬2
x ¬ 2 or about 1.41 units 6. AN BQ 6. Substitution
36a. Given N
7. AB Q
7. Def. of segments
36b. All radii are congruent. N
8. O
OQ 8. All radii of a circle
36c. Reflexive Property are .
36d. Definition of perpendicular lines 9. AON BOQ 9. HL
36e. ARP BRP A
10. OO
B 10. CPCTC
36f. CPCTC
39. Let x width of largest square. Use the
36g. If central angles are congruent, intercepted arcs
Pythagorean Theorem.
are congruent.
x2 x2 ¬42
37. Given: O, O S RT
,
R S T 2x2 ¬16
V
O UW ,
x2 ¬8
S
OO V O
W x ¬ 8 or about 2.82
Prove: R T
U W The width is about 2.82 in.
V
Proof: U 40. C
Statements Reasons 34 m
30 m
T
1. OO
W
1. All radii of a A xm B
are . 30 m
2.
OS RT,
O
V
U
W, 34 m
2. Given
S
O O V
3. OST, OVW are 3. Def. of lines D
right angles. Let x distance from the center to the chord. Use
4. STO VWO 4. HL the Pythagorean Theorem.
T
5. S V W
5. CPCTC x2 302 ¬342
6. ST VW 6. Definition of x2 900 ¬1156
segments x2 ¬256
7. 2(ST) 2(VW) 7. Multiplication x ¬16
Property The chord is 16 m from the center of the circle.
8.
OS bisects R
T
; 8. Radius to a chord 41. B
24 in.
V
O bisects U
W. bisects the chord. 30 in.
9. RT 2(ST), 9. Def. of seg. bisector
UW 2(VW) A
E x F C
10. RT UW 10. Substitution
30 in.
T
11. RU W 11. Definition of
segments D
Since the diameter is 60 inches, the radius is 30
38. Given: O, M
N
P Q
M N inches. Let x distance from the center to the
N
O and O
Q are radii. A
chord. Use the Pythagorean Theorem.
A
OMN; O
B
P Q
O Q x2 242 ¬302
A
Prove: O OB
B x2 576 ¬900
x2 ¬324
Proof: P x ¬18
The chord is 18 in. from the center of the circle.
Statements Reasons
1. O, MNP Q
, O
N
1. Given
Q
and O are radii,
A
O M N,
B
O P Q
A
2. O bisects MN
; O
B 2.
OA and OB
are
Q
bisects P. contained in radii.
A radius to a chord
bisects the chord.
Chapter 10 354
42. A 51. Sample answer: The grooves of a waffle iron are
chords of the circle. The ones that pass
10 cm horizontally and vertically through the center are
48 cm
diameters. Answers should include the following.
C
x cm
A F B
B
Let r the radius of the circle. Use the E
Pythagorean Theorem. C D
102 242 ¬r2
100 576 ¬r2
676 ¬r2
26 ¬r • If you know the measure of the radius and the
The radius is 26 cm. distance the chord is from the center, you can
use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the length
43.
of half of the chord and then multiply by 2.
• There are four grooves on either side of the
16 yd 11 yd diameter, so each groove is about 1 in. from the
x yd center. In the figure, EF 2 and EB 4
because the radius is half the diameter. Using
the Pythagorean Theorem, you find that
FB 3.464 in. so AB 6.93 in. Approximate
lengths for other chords are 5.29 in. and
Since the diameter is 32 yards, the radius is 16
7.75 in., but exactly 8 in. for the diameter.
yards. Let x half of the length of the chord. Use
the Pythagorean Theorem. B
52. C; D bisects A
C and OA OC
x2 112 ¬162 53. Bridgeworth population in 2010 1.2(204,000) or
x2 121 ¬256 244,800
x2 ¬135 Sutterly population in 2010 1.2(216,000) or
x ¬135 259,200
The length of the chord is 2135 or about 23.24 yd. In 2010, 259,200 244,800 or 14,400 more people
44. The line through the midpoint bisects the chord will live in Sutterly than in Bridgeworth.
and is perpendicular to the chord, so the line is a
diameter of the circle. Where two diameters meet
would locate the center of the circle. Page 543 Maintain Your Skills
45. Let r be the radius of P. Draw radii to points D 54.
KTR is a semicircle.
mKTR mTR
and E to create triangles. The length, DE, is r 3 mKT
r
3 1 mKT 180 mTSR
and AB 2r; 2r
2. 180 42 or 138
mKT
46. Inscribed regular hexagon; the chords and the
55. ERT is a semicircle.
radii of the circle are congruent by construction. 180
mERT
Thus, all triangles formed by these segments are is by using mKT .
56. One way to find mKRT
equilateral triangles. That means each angle of
mKRT 360 mKT
the hexagon measures 120°, making all angles of 360 138 or 222
mKRT
the hexagon congruent and all sides congruent.
U
57. S is a chord that is not a diameter.
47. Inscribed equilateral triangle; the six arcs making
up the circle are congruent because the chords 58. MD is a radius and RI is a diameter.
intercepting them were congruent by RI 2(MD)
construction. Each of the three chords drawn RI 2(7) or 14
intercept two of the congruent chords. Thus, the M
59. All radii are congruent: R, AM
, D
M
, IM
three larger arcs are congruent. So, the three 1x ¬120
60. 2
chords are congruent, making this an equilateral
triangle. x ¬240
mCD 1x ¬25
48. mAB 61. 2
49. No; congruent arcs must be in the same circle or x ¬50
congruent circles, but these are in concentric
62. 2x ¬1
2 (45 35)
circles.
B
50. A C D; in the smaller circle, O
X
OY because 2x ¬1
2 (80)
they are radii. This means that in the larger 2x ¬40
B
circle, A and C D
are equidistant from the center,
x ¬20
making them congruent chords.
355 Chapter 10
63. 3x ¬1
2 (120 60)
SC 1
2 CT
3x ¬1
2 (60) SC 1
2 AC
3x ¬30 SC 1
2 (42) or 21
x ¬10 2
10. 1
2 x 5 ¬13
2 2
64. 45 ¬1
2 (4x 30)
2
x4 25 ¬169
45 ¬2(4x) 1
1
2 (30) 2
x4 ¬144
45 ¬2x 15
30 ¬2x x2 ¬576
15 ¬x x ¬24
65. 90 ¬1
2 (6x 3x)
90 ¬1
2 (9x) 10-4 Inscribed Angles
90 ¬4.5x
20 ¬x
Page 544 Geometry Activity: Measure of
Inscribed Angles
Page 543 Practice Quiz 1 1. See students’ work.
2(mXYZ)
C
1. B, B
D
, and B
A
are radii. 2. mXZ
3. The measure of an inscribed angle is one-half the
2. and C
BD B
are radii, so BD CB.
measure of its intercepted arc.
BD ¬CB
3x ¬7x 3
4x ¬3
x ¬3
Pages 548–549 Check for Understanding
4
1. Sample answer: C
2BD
AC is a diameter, so AC
AC 2BD D
AC 2(3x)
AC 6x B
AC 63
4 or 4.5
A
180. 2. The measures of an inscribed angle and a central
3. ADC is a semicircle, so mADC
angle for the same intercepted arc can be
mAD mADC mCD
180 mCBD calculated using the measure of the arc. However,
mAD
180 85 or 95
mAD the measure of the central angle equals the
measure of the arc, while the measure of the
4. C 2r
inscribed angle is half the measure of the arc.
C 2(3) and mNP . mQP mMN 120
C 6 or about 18.8 in. 3. First find mQP
and mNP mMQ 60 because the central angles
5. The degree measure of an arc connecting two
are congruent vertical angles.
360
consecutive rungs is 40 or 9. 1 60 30
m1 1mNP
2 2
6. C 2r
m2 1 1
C 2(3) or 6 2 mQP 2 120 60
mCA mAD 1 120 60
mCAD m3 1mMN
2 2
mCAD 180 mABD 1 1
180 150 or 330
mCAD m4 2mNP 2 60 30
Let arc length m5 1 1
2 MQ 2 60 30
33
0
360 ¬ 6
m6 1 1
2 MN 2 120 60
33
0
360 (6) ¬
m7 1 1
2 QP 2 120 60
5.5 ¬
m8 1 1
The length of
CAD is 5.5 or about 17.3 units. 2 MQ 2 60 30
7. mCAM mNTM 4. Given: Quadrilateral ABCD B C
mCAM 28 is inscribed in P.
mC 1 mB A
8. mHMN 180 2(40) or 100 22(mDAB ) P
mHN Prove: mCDA
mES
mES mHMN D
100
mES
Proof: Given mC 1
2 (mB) means that
9. CT AC
mB 2(mC). Since mB 1
2 (mCDA)
Chapter 10 356
and mC 1 m1 1 1
2 (mDAB), the equation becomes 2 mQR 2 120 60
) 2 1(mDAB
) . Multiplying each side 1 45 22.5
1(mCDA
2
2 m2 1mPS
2 2
by 2 results in mCDA 2(mDAB). m3 1 1
2 mSR 2 75 37.5
5. Angle PTS is a right angle because it intercepts a m4 1 1
semicircle. 2 mPQ 2 120 60
1 45 22.5
m1 m2 mPTS ¬180 m5 1mPS
2 2
(6x 11) (9x 19) 90 ¬180
m6 2mQR 1
1
2 120 60
15x 120 ¬180
15x ¬60 1 1
m7 2mSR 2 75 37.5
x ¬4
m8 1 1
Use the value of x to find the measures of 1 2 mPQ 2 120 60
2(mBDC)
and 2. 9. mBC
2(25) or 50
m1 6x 11 m2 ¬9x 19 mBC
mBC mCD
mAD ¬360
6(4) 11 ¬9(4) 19 mAB
120 50 130 mAD ¬360
35 ¬55
¬60
Because PQ mRS
RS, mPQ . mAD
m3 m4 because they are inscribed angles 1
m1 ¬2mAD
intercepting congruent arcs, PQ and RS.
¬1
2 (60) or 30
4y 25 ¬3y 9
y ¬16 m2 m1 or 30
Use the value of y to find the measures of 3
m3 ¬1 mBC
2
and 4.
m3 4y 25 m4 ¬3y 9 ¬1
2 (50) or 25
4(16) 25 ¬3(16) 9 10. m1 m6 1
39 ¬39 2 mXZ
6. 1
2 (100) or 50
X
, XS
Y
Since X S T SY, and m8 m11.
m1 m11 ¬90
50 m11 ¬90
m11 ¬40
W
m8 ¬40
m2 m8 ¬90
V m2 40 ¬90
m2 ¬50
W
Since ZS ,
T ZT TW, and m9 m10.
Y m10 m6 ¬90
m10 50 ¬90
If a quadrilateral is inscribed in a circle, then its m10 ¬40
opposite angles are supplementary. V and X m9 ¬40
are opposite angles, so m9 m4 ¬90
mV mX 180 40 m4 ¬90
mV 28 180 m4 ¬50
mV 152 XZW is a right angle because it intercepts a
W and Y are opposite angles, so semicircle.
mW mY 180 m3 m4 ¬90
110 mY 180 m3 50 ¬90
mY 70 m3 ¬40
7. Since XZY is a semicircle, XZY is a right angle. YXZ is a right angle because it intercepts a
So, the probability is 1. semicircle.
m2 m5 ¬90
50 m5 ¬90
Pages 549–551 Practice and Apply m5 ¬40
and mQR. mPQ
¬mQR
. m5 m3 m7 ¬180
8. First find mPQ 40 40 m7 ¬180
mPS mSR mQR mPQ ¬360 m7 ¬100
mPQ
45 75 mPQ ¬360
¬360
120 2mPQ
¬240
2mPQ
¬120
mPQ
¬120
mQR
357 Chapter 10
11. Given:
AB
DE,
AC mAB 120, and mBC
.
CE B D mAD ¬mCD
Prove: ABC EDC mAB mAD mBC mCD ¬360
1 2 mBC
120 120 mBC
A E ¬360
2mBC ¬120
mBC ¬60
C
mCD ¬60
Proof: 1
m4 2 mCD
Statements Reasons 1
2 (60) or 30
1.
AB DE, AC
CE 1. Given 1
m7 mBC
mCE
2. Def. of arcs
2
2. mAB mDE, mAC
, 1
2 (60) or 30
3. 1mA
2 AB 1mDE
2
3. Mult. Prop.
m4 30
1mAC 1mCE m4 m5 ¬90
2 2
4. mACB 1 4. Inscribed 30 m5 ¬90
2 mAB,
Theorem m5 ¬60
mECD 1
2 mDE, m6 ¬60
, m2 1mCE
m1 21mAC 15. KPR is a right angle because
KPR is a
2
semicircle.
5. mACB mECD, 5. Substitution
m2 ¬90
m1 m2
mR mK mP ¬180
6. ACB ECD, 1 2 6. Def. of mR mK 90 ¬180
B
7. ADE 7. arcs have mR mK ¬90
chords.
1x 5 1x ¬90
8. ABC EDC 8. AAS 3 2
5x ¬85
6
12. Given: P A
Prove: AXB CXD x ¬102
C 1 m3 mR 1
3x 5
2 X
B 1
3 (102) 5 or 39
P
Chapter 10 358
23. mPSR 1
2 (mPQ mQR)
18. W
1
2 (72 72) or 72
1 mST mTP
)
24. mPQR 2(mRS
1
2 (72 72 72) or 108
25. mPTS mPT mTS
72 72 or 144
mBZA or 104
26. mBA
360 (mBA mCB)
R 27. mADC
Z
360 (104 94) or 162
T
28. mBDA 1mBA2
If a quadrilateral is inscribed in a circle, then its
opposite angles are supplementary. W and T 1
2 (104) or 52
mCB
are opposite angles, so 29. 2(mZAC) 180 ¬mBA
mW mT ¬180 2(mZAC) 180 ¬104 94
45 mT ¬180 2(mZAC) 180 ¬198
mT ¬135 2(mZAC) ¬18
R and Z are opposite angles, so mZAC ¬9
mR mZ ¬180 2mABC
30. mAC
100 mZ ¬180 2(50) or 100
mZ ¬80
mDEF 1mDBF
2
19.
1
2 (128) or 64
40, then mPQS
360 40 or 320. If T
31. If mPS
A D
is located in PQS, then
mPTS 1mPS 2
1
2 (40) or 20.
B C The probability that mPTS 20 is the same
as the probability that T is contained in
PQS,
Since ABCD is a trapezoid A D
B C
. A and B
32
0 8
are consecutive interior angles so they are 360 or 9 .
supplementary. 110, then mPQR 360 110 or 250.
32. If mPSR
mA mB ¬180
If T is located in PQR, then
60 mB ¬180
mB ¬120 mPTR 1mPSR 2
If a quadrilateral is inscribed in a circle, then its 1
2 (110) or 55.
opposite angles are supplementary. A and C
The probability that mPTR 55 is the same
as the probability that T is contained in
are opposite angles, so
PQR,
mA mC ¬180
25
0 25
60 mC ¬180 360 or 36 .
mC ¬120 33. No matter where T is selected, mSTQ 1
2 (180)
B and D are opposite angles, so or 90 because
SPQ is a semicircle. Therefore, the
mB mD ¬180 probability that mSTQ 90 is 1.
120 mD ¬180
360.
34. mPTQ can never equal 180 since mPQ
mD ¬60 Therefore, the propability that mPTQ 180 is 0.
20. Sample answer: P Q is a diagonal of PDQT and a
diameter of the circle.
21. Sample answer: E F is a diameter of the circle and
a diagonal and angle bisector of EDFG.
22. Since pentagon PQRST is equilateral,
Q
P Q R
R S
S TT P
and
PQ QR RS ST TP.
36
0
mQR or 72
5
359 Chapter 10
35. Given: T lies inside PRQ. K 37. Given: inscribed MLN and N
K
R is a diameter of T. P Q CED, CD
MN D
M
Prove: mPRQ 1mPKQ Prove: CED MLN
2 O
T C
L E
Proof: R Proof:
Statements Reasons Statements Reasons
1. mPRQ mPRK 1. Addition Th. 1. MLN and CED are 1. Given
mKRQ
mPK
mKQ inscribed;
CD
MN
2. mPKQ 2. Arc Addition ;
2. mMLN 1 2
mMN 2. Measure of an
Theorem
1mPK
1 inscribed
3. 1mPKQ 3. Multiplication Prop. mCED 2mCD
2 2 half measure of
1
mKQ intercepted arc.
2
3. mCD mMN 3. Def. of arcs
4. mPRK 1 4. The measure of an
2 mPK, 4. 1 1mMN
mCD
inscribed whose 4. Mult. Prop.
2 2
mKRQ 1
2 mKQ side is a diameter is 5. mCED mMLN 5. Substitution
half the measure of
6. CED MLN 6. Def. of
the intercepted arc
(Case 1).
38. Given: PQR is a semicircle. P Q
5. 1
2 mPKQ mPRK 5. Subst. (Steps 3, 4) Prove: PQR is a right angle.
mKRQ
C
6. 1
2 mPKQ mPRQ 6. Substitution
S
(Steps 5, 1) R
36. Given: T lies outside PRQ. K P Proof: Since PSR is a semicircle,
PSR is also
180. PQR is an
K
R is a diameter of T. Q a semicircle and mPSR
Prove: mPRQ 1 inscribed angle, and mPQR 1
2 mPQ 2 (mPSR ) or 90,
T making PQR a right angle.
39. Given: quadrilateral A
ABCD inscribed
Proof: R in O B
Prove: A and C are O
Statements Reasons supplementary.
B and D are D
1. mPRQ 1. Angle Addition C
mKRQ mPRK Theorem, Subtraction supplementary.
Property
mKQ
mKP Proof: By arc addition and the definitions of arc
2. mPQ 2. Arc Addition measure and the sum of central angles,
Theorem, mDAB 360. Since mC 1mDAB
mDCB 2
Subtraction Property
1(mKQ
, mC mA 1(mDCB
3. 1
mPQ 3. Division Property and mA 1mDCB
2 2
2 2
), but mDCB
mDAB
360, so
mKP) mDAB
4. mPRK 1 4. The measure of an mC mA 1
2 (360) or 180. This makes C
2 mKP,
inscribed whose
mKRQ 1 and A supplementary. Because the sum of the
2 mKQ side is a diameter is
measures of the interior angles of a quadrilateral
half the measure of
is 360, mA mC mB mD 360. But
the intercepted arc
mA mC 180, so mB mD 180,
(Case 1).
making them supplementary also.
5. mPRQ 21mKQ 5. Subst. (Steps 1, 4) 36
0
40. There are 8 congruent arcs, so each measures
1mKP
8
2 or 45.
6. mPRQ 21(mKQ 6. Distributive 41. Isosceles right triangle because sides are congruent
) Property radii making it isosceles and AOC is a central
mKP
1 angle for an arc of 90°, making it a right angle.
7. mPRQ 2mPQ 7. Substitution 42. Square because each angle intercepts a semicircle,
(Steps 6, 3) making them 90° angles. Each side is a chord of
congruent arcs, so the chords are congruent.
Chapter 10 360
43. Square because each angle intercepts a 51. C 2r
semicircle, making them 90° angles. Each side is a C 2(12) or 24
chord of congruent arcs, so the chords are Let length of
QR.
congruent. 60
360 ¬¬
24
44. Use the properties of trapezoids and inscribed 60
quadrilaterals to verify that ABCD is isosceles.
360 (24) ¬
4 ¬
The length of
A
QR is 4 units.
B
52. C 2r
D C 2(16) or 32
C Let length of
QR.
mA mD 180 (same side interior angles 90
180)
360 ¬
32
mA mC 180 (opposite angles of inscribed 90
360 (32) ¬
quadrilaterals 180) 8 ¬
mA mD mA mC (Substitution) The length of QR is 8 units.
mD mC (Subtraction Property)
53. always
D C (Def. of s)
Trapezoid ABCD is isosceles because the base 54. sometimes
angles are congruent. 55. sometimes
45. Sample answer: The socket is similar to an 56. Use the converse of the Pythagorean Theorem.
inscribed polygon because the vertices of the a2 b2 ¬c2
hexagon can be placed on a circle that is 42 52 ¬62
concentric with the outer circle of the socket. 16 25 ¬36
Answers should include the following. 41
¬36
• An inscribed polygon is one in which all of its It is not a right triangle.
vertices are points on a circle. 57. Use the converse of the Pythagorean Theorem.
• The side of the regular hexagon inscribed in a a2 b2 ¬c2
circle 3
3
4 inch wide is 8 inch.
32 82 ¬102
9 64 ¬100
46. C; mAOB 2mACB, so the ratio is 1 : 2.
73
¬100
47. There are 18 even-numbered pages and 18 It is not a right triangle.
odd-numbered pages, so there are 18 6 18 7
58. Use the converse of the Pythagorean Theorem.
or 234 articles.
a2 b2 ¬c2
282 452 ¬532
784 2025 ¬2809
Page 551 Maintain Your Skills 2809 ¬2809
48. Since AB 60, CD 30. Since DE 48, FD 24. It is a right triangle.
(FD)2 (CF)2 ¬(CD)2
242 (CF)2 ¬302
(CF)2 ¬324
CF ¬18 10-5 Tangents
49. Draw a line from C to E. Since AB 32, CE 16.
Draw CE. Use the Pythagorean Theorem.
(FE)2 (FC)2 (CE)2 Page 552 Geometry Software Investigation:
(FE)2 112 ¬(16)2 Tangents and Radii
FE2 ¬135 1.
WX is a radius.
FE ¬135 2. WX WY
FE ¬11.62 3. It doesn’t, unless Y and X coincide.
50. Since DE 60, FD 30. Use the Pythagorean 4. X
W XY
Theorem.
5. Sample answer: The shortest distance from the
(FD)2 (FC)2 ¬(CD)2
center of a circle to the tangent is the radius of
302 162 ¬(CD)2
the circle, which is perpendicular to the tangent.
1156 ¬(CD)2
34 ¬CD
Since AB 2(CD), AB 2(34) or 68.
Page 555 Check for Understanding
1a. Two; from any point outside the circle, you can
draw only two tangents.
1b. None; a line containing a point inside the circle
would intersect the circle in two points. A
tangent can only intersect a circle in one point.
361 Chapter 10
1c. One; since a tangent intersects a circle in exactly 10. Determine whether JGH is a right triangle.
one point, there is one tangent containing a point (JG)2 (GH)2 ¬(JH)2
on the circle. 52 122 ¬142
2. If the lines are tangent at the endpoints of a 169
¬196
diameter, they are parallel and thus, not Because the converse of the Pythagorean Theorem
intersecting. did not prove true in this case, JGH is not a
3. Sample answer: right triangle.
polygon circumscribed about a circle No; GH is not tangent to J.
11. Determine whether KLM is a right triangle.
(KL)2 (LM)2 ¬(KM)2
2
102 62 ¬ 136
136 ¬136
Because the converse of the Pythagorean Theorem
is true, KLM is a right triangle with right angle
polygon inscribed in a circle KLM and L MK L
.
L
Yes; K is tangent to M.
For Exercises 12–15, use the Pythagorean
Theorem.
12. (NO)2 (NP)2 ¬(OP)2
62 x2 ¬102
36 x2 ¬100
4. Triangle MPO is a right triangle with hypotenuse x2 ¬64
O
M . Use the Pythagorean Theorem. x ¬8
(MP)2 (PO)2 ¬(MO)2 13. (QR) (RS) ¬(QS)2
2 2
162 x2 ¬202 122 x2 ¬(12 8)2
256 x2 ¬400 144 x2 ¬400
x2 ¬144 x2 ¬256
x ¬12 x ¬16
5. If PRO is a right triangle, then 14. (WU)2 (UV)2 ¬(WV)2
R
P is tangent to O. Use the converse of the 122 72 ¬x2
Pythagorean Theorem. 144 49 ¬x2
(PR)2 (PO)2 ¬(RO)2 193 ¬x2
52 122 ¬132 193
¬x
25 144 ¬169 15. (AC)2 (AB)2 ¬(BC)2
169 ¬169 82 x2 ¬172
R
Yes, P is tangent to O. 64 x2 ¬289
6. 4(3) 4x ¬32 x2 ¬225
4x ¬20 x ¬15
x ¬5 16. DE ¬DF
7. Each side of the square is 2(72) or 144 feet. The x 2 ¬14
total length of fence is 4(144) or 576 feet. x ¬16
17. HJ ¬HN
HJ ¬2
Pages 556–558 Practice and Apply HK ¬HJ JK
8. Determine whether ABC is a right triangle. 5 ¬2 JK
(AB)2 (BC)2 ¬(AC)2 3 ¬JK
162 302 ¬342 KL ¬JK
1156 ¬1156 KL ¬3
Because the converse of the Pythagorean Theorem 18. RS RQ
is true, ABC is a right triangle with right angle 6
ABC and A BB C. ST ¬TU
C
Yes; B is tangent to A. 4
9. Determine whether DEF is a right triangle. RT ¬RS ST
(EF)2 (DF)2 ¬(DE)2 x ¬6 4 or 10
32 42 ¬52 AC
25 ¬25 19. sin B ¬
BC
Because the converse of the Pythagorean Theorem 15
sin 30° ¬ x
is true, DEF is a right triangle. Since
DE is the
15
longest side, F is the right angle. E is not a x ¬
sin
30° or 30
right angle, so
DE is not perpendicular to
EF.
No; DE is not tangent to F.
Chapter 10 362
20. (DG)2 (DE)2 ¬(EG)2 26. CF ¬CE
x2 162 ¬(12 x)2 6(3 x) ¬3x
x2 256 ¬144 24x x2 18 6x ¬3x
112 ¬24x 18 ¬9x
2 ¬x
4 2
3 ¬x
CE 3x CF ¬6(3 x)
21. See students’ work. 3(2) or 6 ¬6(3 2) or 6
22. Given: AB B BE ¬BD
B
A is a radius of A. 4y ¬12y 4
Prove: is tangent to A. A 4 ¬8y
1 ¬y
2
Proof: Assume is not tangent to A. Since
touches A at B, it must touch the circle in BE 4y BD ¬12y 4
another place. Call this point C. Then AB AC. ¬41
2 or 2
¬121
2 4 or 2
B
But if A , AB must be the shortest distance AF ¬AD
between A and . There is a contradiction. 10(z 4) ¬2z
Therefore, is tangent to A. 10z 40 ¬2z
23. Let r the radius of M. 40 ¬8z
(PL)2 (ML)2 ¬(PM)2 5 ¬z
102 r2 ¬(r 2)2 AF 10(z 4) AD ¬2z
100 r2 ¬r2 4r 4 10(5 4) or 10 ¬2(5) or 10
96 ¬4r CE CF BE BD AF AD 6 6
24 ¬r 2 2 10 10 or 36
PL ML MN NP 10 24 24 2 or 60 The perimeter is 36 units.
The perimeter is 60 units. 27. Given: AB is tangent B
24. R to X at B.
x C
A is tangent X A
x to X at C.
Prove: ABA C
C
5 13 Proof:
O
Statements Reasons
5 5
1.
AB is tangent to X 1. Given
S 5 13
T C
at B, A is tangent to
X at C.
18
2. Draw B X, C
X, and A
X
. 2. Through any two
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to write an points, there is one
equation for RST. line.
(x 5)2 182 ¬(x 13)2 B
3. A B X, A
CC X
3. Line tangent to a
x 10x 25 324 ¬x2 26x 169
2
circle is to the
180 ¬16x radius at the pt. of
11.25 ¬x tangency.
11.25 5 18 13 11.25 ¬58.5 4. ABX and ACX are 4. Def. of lines
The perimeter is 58.5 units. right angles.
25. d 5, r 2.5, GY EG 2.5. Since C
B
is a X
5. B C X
5. All radii of a circle
tangent, AEB is a right angle and GEB is a are .
right triangle. Use the Pythagorean Theorem.
X
6. A A X
6. Reflexive Prop.
(EG)2 (EB)2 ¬(GB)2
(2.5)2 (EB)2 ¬(2.5 2.5)2 7. ABX ACX 7. HL
6.25 (EB)2 ¬25 B
8. A A C
8. CPCTC
(EB)2 ¬18.75
28. Let a the radius of the roll of film, b the
EB ¬ 18.75
amount of film exposed, and c the distance from
EB EC DC DA FA FB
the center of the roll to the intake of the holding
6EB 6 18.75 or 15 3
chamber. Since the diameter of the roll of film is
The perimeter is 15 3 units.
25, a 12.5. Use the Pythagorean Theorem.
a2 b2 ¬c2
12.52 b2 ¬1002
156.25 b2 ¬10,000
b2 ¬9843.75
b ¬99
About 99 millimeters of film would be exposed.
363 Chapter 10
E
29. A and B
F
mAFC ¬1
2 mAC
D
30. A and B
C ¬1
2 (90) or 45
31. 12;
BD ¬AC
G N
mBED ¬mAFC
4 4
mBED ¬45
5Q L
13 38. Connect L to J to form a right triangle. Use the
P Pythagorean Theorem.
(LJ)2 ¬x2 52
102 ¬x2 52
Draw PG, N
L, and P
L
. Construct LQ
G P, thus 100 ¬x2 25
LQGN is a rectangle. GQ NL 4, so QP 5. 75 ¬x2
Using the Pythagorean Theorem, (QP)2 (QL)2 53 ¬x or x 8.7
(PL)2. So, QL 12. Since GN QL, GN 12. 39. KB 5 2 or 3
32. Sample answer: Many of the field events have the Use the Pythagorean Theorem.
athlete moving in a circular motion and releasing 32 x2 ¬52
an object (discus, hammer, shot). The movement of 9 x2 ¬25
the athlete models a circle and the path of the x2 ¬16
released object models a tangent. x ¬4
Answers should include the following. 40. Connect O to A to form a right triangle; OA 8.
• The arm of the thrower, the handle, the wire, Let x 1
2 AP.
and hammer form the radius defining the circle
Use the Pythagorean Theorem.
when the hammer is spun around. The tangent
42 x2 ¬82
is the path of the hammer when it is released.
16 x2 ¬64
• The distance the hammer was from the athlete
x2 ¬48
was about 70.68 meters.
x ¬4 3
33. A AP 24 3 or 8
3 13.9
x x 41. Sample answer:
R Given: ABCD is a rectangle. E is the midpoint
S
x B
of A .
y y
19
D(0, b) C(2a, b)
B
D
y
A(0, 0) E(a, 0) B(2a, 0) x
P Q
6 y Prove: CED is isosceles.
Proof: Let the coordinates of E be (a, 0). Since E
14
C is the midpoint and is halfway between A and B,
PB RB ¬19 x the coordinates of B would be (2a, 0). Let the
CP CQ ¬14 y coordinates of D be (0, b), so the coordinates of
PB CP ¬6 C would be (2a, b) because it is on the same
(19 x) (14 y) ¬6 horizontal as D and the same vertical as B.
33 x y ¬6 ED (a 0)2 (0 b)2
27 ¬x y a b
2 2
AD ¬27 EC
(a 2a) 2 (0 b )2
34. B; 2 12 22 92 470 a b
2 2
102 112 122 192 1470
Since ED EC, E D
E C. DEC has two
Chapter 10 364
44. 2x 4 1
2 [(x 20) 10]
1 10-6 Secants, Tangents, and Angle
2x 4 2(x 10)
Measures
2x 4 1
2x 5
3
x ¬1
2 Page 564 Check for Understanding
x ¬2
3
1. Sample answer: A tangent intersects the circle in
1 only one point and no part of the tangent is in the
45. x 3 2[(4x 10) 45] interior of the circle. A secant intersects the circle
x 3 1
2 (4x 35)
in two points and some of its points do lie in the
interior of the circle.
35
x 3 2x
2 2. Sample answer:
41
2 ¬x or x 20.5
A T
365 Chapter 10
A
10. Since S
LK, ASL and SLK are 23. 25 ¬1
2 (90 5x)
supplementary consecutive interior angles. 50 ¬90 5x
So mASL 180 78 or 102 and mAKL
40 ¬5x
2(mASL) 2(102) or 204. 8 ¬x
mAK mKL
mAKL
24. 360 (160 34 106) ¬60
204 ¬110 mKL (See Exercise 9.)
x ¬1
2 (60 34)
94 ¬mKL
mSL¬360
11. mSA mAK mKL x ¬1
2 (26) or 13
46 110 94 mSL¬360
¬360 25. x ¬1
2 (7x 20)
250 mSL
¬110
mSL 2x ¬7x 20
20 ¬5x
4 ¬x
Pages 564–567 Practice and Apply 26. x ¬1
2 (10x 40)
12. m3 ¬1
2 (100 120)
x ¬5x 20
1 20 ¬4x
2(220) or 110
5 ¬x
13. m4 1
2 (45 75)
27. x 2.5 ¬1
2 [(4x 5) 50]
1
2(120) or 60 2x 5 ¬4x 45
14. m5 1 50 ¬2x
2 [360 (110 150)]
25 ¬x
1
¬2(360 260) 28. 90 60 ¬30
¬1 30 ¬1
2 (105 5x)
2 (100) or 50
15. 5a 3a 6a 4a ¬360 60 ¬105 5x
18a ¬360 5x ¬45
a ¬20 x ¬9
m6 1(5a 6a) 29. 50 ¬1
2 [(360 x) x]
2
¬1
100 ¬360 2x
2 (11a) 2x ¬260
¬1
2 (11 20)
x ¬130
¬1
30. 30 ¬1
2 [x (360 x)]
2 (220) or 110
60 ¬2x 360
16. m7 1
2 (196) or 98 420 ¬2x
17. m8 1
210 ¬x
2 (180) or 90
18. m9 1 31. 3x 1
2 [(4x 50) 30]
2 (360 120)
1
1
3x 2(4x 20)
2 (240) or 120
3x 2x 10
19. m10 ¬1
2 [360 (100 160)]
x ¬10
1
¬2(360 260) 32. 40 ¬1
2 [(x 12x) (x 2x)]
2 2
¬1
2 (100) or 50
1
40 ¬2(10x)
20. 65 ¬1 40 ¬5x
2 (mAC 72)
8 ¬x
130 ¬mAC 72
33. mC 1
2 (116 38)
58 ¬mAC
21. x 1
2 (90 30)
1
2(78) or 39
1 mBH )
¬2(60) or 30 mC ¬1(mBAH
2
1
22. x ¬1
2 [20 (180 20 150)]
39 ¬ 2 [(360 mBH) mBH]
1
¬2(20 10) 39 ¬1
2 (360 2mBH)
¬1 39 ¬180 mBH
2 (10) or 5
mBH ¬141
Chapter 10 366
2mEFB
34. mBE 40b. Given:
DG is a tangent to the circle.
DF is a
2(30) or 60 secant to the circle.
Prove: mFDG 1
mFGE 180 52 or 128 2 mFG mGE
mFGE mEFB mGEF ¬180 F
128 30 mGEF ¬180
E
mGEF ¬22
2mGEF
mCF D G H
2(22) or 44 Proof:
360 (mAB mBE
mFE mCF
)
mAC
360 (108 60 118 44) Statements Reasons
360 330 or 30 is a tangent to the 1. Given
1. DG
44 (See Exercise 34.)
35. mCF is a secant
circle. DF
36. mEDB ¬1
2 (mBE mAC)
to the circle.
¬1 2. mDFG 1 2. The meas. of an
2 (60 30)
2 mGE,
inscribed 1
¬1
mFGH 1 mFG 2
2 (30) or 15 2
the meas. of its
37. mAMB ¬23.5 intercepted arc.
mAMB ¬1
2 (mBC mAB) 3. mFGH 3. Exterior
23.5 ¬1
2 (mBC 71) mDFG mFDG Theorem
47 ¬mBC 71 1mGE
4. 1mFG
2 2
4. Substitution
118 ¬mBC
mFDG
38. mABC mAB mBC
5. 1 1
2 mFG 2 mGE
mABC 71 118 or 189 5. Subtraction Prop.
No, its measure is 189, not 180. mFDG
39. C d
6. 1
2 mFG mGE
6. Distributive Prop.
C (100) 314.2 feet
11
8 mFDG
360 314.2 103
You would walk about 103 ft. 40c. Given:
HI and
HJ are tangents to the circle.
and AT
are secants to the circle. Prove: mIHJ 1
40a. Given: AC 2 (mIXJ mIJ)
mBR )
Prove: mCAT 1(mCT 2 I X
C
B
A
R T H J K
Proof: Proof:
Statements Reasons
Statements Reasons
1.
HI and
HJ are 1. Given
1.
AC and
AT are 1. Given
tangents to the circle.
secants to the circle.
2. mCRT 1 2. mIJK 1 2. The measure of an
2 mCT,
2. The meas. of an 2 mIXJ,
1 1
inscribed 2
mACR 1mBR inscribed 1 mHIJ 2mIJ
2 2
the meas. of its the measure of its
intercepted arc. intercepted arc.
3. mCRT 3. Exterior 3. mIJK mHIJ 3. Ext. Th.
mACR mCAT Theorem mIHJ
1mIJ
1mBR
4. 1mCT 4. Substitution 4. 1mIXJ
2 2 4. Substitution
2 2
mCAT mIHJ
1
5. 1 1
5. 1
2 mCT 2 mBR
5. Subtraction Prop. 2 mIXJ 2 mIJ 5. Subtr. Prop.
mCAT mIHJ
6. 1
6. 1
2 mCT mBR
6. Distributive Prop. 2 (mIXJ mIJ) 6. Distrib. Prop.
mIHJ
mCAT
367 Chapter 10
41. The diagonals of a rhombus are perpendicular. 1mCA
1mDC by substitution.
2 2
Let x side length of rhombus.
mDAC 1
52 122 ¬x2 2 mDC since DAC is inscribed, so
25 144 ¬x2
substitution yields 1 1
2 mDC mCAB 2 mDC
169 ¬x2 . By Subtraction Prop., mCAB 1mCA
.
13 ¬x 21mCA 2
y is a tangent to O.
43b. Given: AB
is a secant to O. CAB is obtuse.
AC
r Prove: mCAB 1
5 2 mCDA
D
12 5 C O
x E A B
Let r radius of inscribed circle. Proof: CAB andCAE form a linear pair, so
The radius forms two right triangles. One triangle mCAB mCAE 180. Since CAB is
has a hypotenuse of 5. Let y measure of the obtuse, CAE is acute and Case 1 applies, so
portion of the side of the rhombus that is a leg of . mCA mCDA
360, so
mCAE 1mCA
2
this triangle. The second right triangle has a
hypotenuse of length 12. Its second leg has measure 1mCDA
1mCA 180 by Division Prop., and
2 2
13 y. 180 by substitution. By
1mCAE 1mCDA
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to write an 2 2
equation for each triangle. the Transitive Prop., mCAB mCAE
r2 (13 y)2 122
r2 y2 ¬52 } mCAE 1mCDA
2
, so by Subtraction Prop.,
r2 ¬25 y2 mCAB 1
2 mCDA.
Substituting for r2,
25 y2 (13 y)2 ¬144 44. Let x the measure of the angle of view.
25 y2 169 26y y2 ¬144 360 54 306
194 26y ¬144 x 1
2 (306 54)
26y ¬50 1
x 2(252) or 126
y ¬1.9
r2 25 1.92 , m1 1mRQ
so
45. 3, 1, 2; m3 mRQ 2
r2 21.39 mTP
)
r 4.6 m3 m1, m2 1(mRQ
2
The radius of the inscribed circle is approximately 1mTP
1mRQ , which is less than 1mRQ
,
2 2 2
4.6 cm.
so m2 m1.
42. Let x measure of intercepted arc.
46. Sample answer: Each raindrop refracts light from
86.5 ¬1
2 [(360 x) x]
the sun and sends the beam to Earth. The
173 ¬360 2x raindrop is actually spherical, but the angle of the
2x ¬187 light is an inscribed angle from the bent rays.
x ¬93.5 Answers should include the following.
43a. Given: AB is a tangent to O. • C is an inscribed angle and F is a secant-
is a secant to O. CAB is acute.
AC secant angle.
• The measure of F can be calculated by finding
Prove: mCAB 1mCA 2 and the
the positive difference between mBD
D
measure of the small intercepted arc containing
point C.
O C
47. A; let x the measure of the common intercepted
arc of A and B.
A B
mA ¬1
2 (x 15)
Proof: DAB is a right with measure 90, and
10 ¬1
2 (x 15)
DCA is a semicircle with measure 180, since if a
line is tangent to a , it is to the radius at the 20 ¬x 15
point of tangency. Since CAB is acute, C is in 35 ¬x
the interior of DAB, so by the Angle and Arc
mB 1
2 (95 35)
Addition Postulates, mDAB mDAC
mDC mCA . By 1
mCAB and mDCA ¬2(60) or 30
substitution, 90 mDAC mCAB and
48. C; the set of data can be represented by the linear
1
180 mDC mCA. So, 90 1 2 mDC 2 mCA equation y 12 x 1.
by Division Prop., and mDAC mCAB
Chapter 10 368
Page 568 Maintain Your Skills 57. x2 6x 40 ¬0
49. The tangent forms a right angle with the radius. (x 4)(x 10) ¬0
Use the Pythagorean Theorem. x 4 0 or x 10 ¬0
(2x)2 242 ¬(16 24)2 x ¬4 x 10
4x2 576 ¬1600 58. 2x2 7x 30 ¬0
4x2 ¬1024 (2x 5)(x 6) 0
x2 ¬256 2x 5 0 or x 6 0
x ¬16 x 5
x 6
2
50. Both tangents to the circle on the left have the 1
x 22
same measure. Both tangents to the circle on the
right have the same measure. Both tangents to 59. 3x2 24x 45 ¬0
the circle in the middle have the same measure. 3(x2 8x 15) 0
Because the left tangent to the middle circle is 3(x 3)(x 5) ¬0
also tangent to the left circle and the right x 3 0 or x 5 0
tangent to the middle circle is also tangent to the x3 x5
right circle, the tangents to the left and right
circles have the same measure. Page 568 Practice Quiz 2
12x 10 ¬74 4x 1. Each central angle has a measure of 36
0
8 or 45.
16x ¬64 Therefore, the remaining 2 angles in each triangle
x ¬4 180 45
each measure 2
or 67.5.
51. EGN is an inscribed angle.
2. Inscribed angles of the same arc are congruent.
mEGN 1mEN
2 m1 m2 1
2 (68) or 34
1
2 (66) or 33 3. x 2(6) or 12
¬mGE mEN
52. mGEN
4. x 1
2 (60 34)
180 ¬mGE 66
114 ¬mGE 1
2 (26) or 13
mGME 1mGE
2 5. 360 129 231
1
2 (114) or 57
x 1
2 (231) or 115.5
89
53. mGM
GNM is an inscribed angle that intercepts
GM.
1
mGNM (mGM)
2 10-7 Special Segments in a Circle
1
2 (89) or 44.5
vertical rise Page 569 Geometry Activity: Intersecting
54. slope
horizontal run
1 Chords
slope
12 1. PTS RTQ (vertical are );
1
The slope is
12. P R ( intercepting same arc are );
55. 30 feet 30 12 or 360 in. S Q ( intercepting same arc are )
Let x the height of the ramp. 2. They are similar by AA Similarity.
(12x)2 x2 3602 PT ST
RT TQ or PT TQ RT ST
3.
145x2 ¬129,600
x2 ¬893.8
x ¬30
Pages 571–572 Check for Understanding
The ramp is about 30 in. high.
1. Sample answer: The product equation for secant
56. Given: ACB F
segments equates the product of exterior segment
Prove: AB CF measure and the whole segment measure for each
F secant. In the case of secant-tangent, the product
B C involving the tangent segment becomes (measure
A of tangent segment)2 because the exterior
Proof: By definition of congruent segments, segment and the whole segment are the same
AC BF. Using the Segment Addition Postulate, segment.
we know that AC AB BC and BF BC 2. Latisha; the length of the tangent segment
CF. Since AC BF, this means that AB BC squared equals the product of the exterior secant
BC CF. If BC is subtracted from each side of segment and the entire secant, not the interior
this equation, the result is AB CF. secant segment.
369 Chapter 10
3. Sample answer: x 2 ¬0 or x 10 ¬0
B x ¬2 x ¬10
A Disregard the negative value.
x ¬2
C 12. x2 ¬3(9 3)
x2 ¬36
D x ¬6
4. 9x ¬3(6) 13. 42 ¬2(x 2)
9x ¬18 16 2x 4
x ¬2 12 2x
5. 312 ¬20(20 x) 6 ¬x
961 ¬400 20x 14. 162 ¬x(x x 16)
561 ¬20x 256 ¬x(2x 16)
28.1 ¬x 256 ¬2x2 16x
6. x(10 x) ¬3(3 5) 0 ¬2x2 16x 256
10x x2 ¬24 0 ¬x2 8x 128
x 10x 24 ¬0
2 0 ¬(x 16)(x 8)
(x 2)(x 12) ¬0 0 ¬x 16 or 0 ¬x 8
x 2 ¬0 or x 12 ¬0 16 ¬x 8 ¬x
x ¬2 x ¬12 Since the length of a segment cannot be negative,
Since x represents a length, it must be positive. reject x ¬16. So x ¬8.
Reject the negative value. So x 2. 15. (9.8)2 7.1(2x 7.1)
7. Draw a model using a circle. Let x represent the 96.04 14.2x 50.41
unknown measure of the segment of diameter AB. 45.63 14.2x
Use the products of the lengths of the intersecting 3.2 x
chords to find the length of the diameter. 16. 4(4 2) 3(3 x)
A 24 ¬3(3 x)
8 ¬3 x
3 5 ¬x
E 17. x(5 x) ¬3(3 9)
D C 5x x2 ¬36
3.5 3.5
x 5x 36 ¬0
2
x (x 4)(x 9) ¬0
x 4 ¬0 or x 9 ¬0
x ¬4 x ¬9
B
Disregard the negative value.
AE EB ¬DE EC x ¬4
3x ¬3.5 3.5 18. x(x 5 x) 5(5 5 x)
x ¬4.08 x(5 2x) ¬5(10 x)
AB ¬AE EB 5x 2x2 ¬50 5x
AB ¬3 4.08 or 7.08 2x2 ¬50
7.08
The radius of the circle is about
2 or 3.54. x2 ¬25
The ratio of the arch width to the radius of the x ¬5
circle is about 7:3.54.
19. x(x 3x) ¬8(8 x 2)
x(4x) ¬8(10 x)
4x2 ¬80 8x
Pages 572–574 Practice and Apply 4x 8x 80 ¬0
2
8. 2x ¬4(5) 4(x 2x 20) ¬0
2x ¬20 (2) (2)
2 )
4(1)(20
x ¬10 x 2(1)
9. 6 6 x 9 2 84
36 ¬9x x
2
4 ¬x x 5.6 or x 3.6
10. 7 2 ¬3 x Disregard the negative value. So x 5.6.
14 ¬3x
14
3 ¬x or x 4.7
11. x(x 8) ¬5 4
x2 8x ¬20
x2 8x 20 ¬0
(x 2)(x 10) 0
Chapter 10 370
20. Let r the radius of the circle. 2x(2x 24) ¬y(y 12.25)
2(3)(2 3 24) ¬y2 12.25y
180 ¬y2 12.25y
0 ¬y2 12.25y 180
2
12.25 (12.25
) 80)
2 4(1)(1
y ¬
2(1)
4.25 x
2 y ¬8.6 or y ¬20.9
Disregard the negative value. So y ¬8.6.
27. 3(3 x) ¬4(4 9)
Let x represent the unknown measure of the 9 3x ¬52
segment of the diameter. Use the products of the 3x ¬43
lengths of the intersecting chords to find the x ¬14.3
length of the diameter. 28. 102 ¬y(6 y)
4.25x ¬2 2 100 ¬6y y2
x ¬0.94 0 ¬y2 6y 100
d ¬4.25 0.94 or 5.19 mm 6 6 00)
2 4(1)(1
y ¬
2(1)
r ¬1 1
2 d ¬ 2 (5.19) or 2.6 mm
y ¬7.4 or y ¬13.4
21. Given:
WY and ZX
W Disregard the negative value. So y ¬7.4.
intersect at T. X 29. Let r the radius of the circle. Draw a model
Prove: WT TY ZT TX using a circle. Let x represent the unknown
T
measure of the segment of the diameter. Use the
Y products of the lengths of the intersecting chords
Proof: Z
to find the diameter.
Statements Reasons 60x ¬100 100
a. W Z, a. Inscribed angles that
x ¬166.6
X Y intercept the same
arc are congruent. 60
b. WXT ZYT b. AA Similarity
100 100
WT TX c. Definition of similar
ZT TY
c.
triangles x
d. WT TY ZT TX d. Cross products
2x ¬3y Proof:
2x ¬3(15)
2x ¬45 Statements Reasons
x ¬22.5 1.
EC and E
B are 1. Given
25. 10(10 8) ¬9(9 x) secant segments.
180 ¬81 9x 2. DEC AEB 2. They name the same
99 ¬9x angle. (Reflexive Prop.)
11 ¬x 3. ECD EBA 3. Inscribed that
26. 92 ¬x(x 24) intercept the same
81 ¬x2 24x arc are .
0 ¬x2 24x 81 4. ABE DCE 4. AA Similarity
0 ¬(x 3)(x 27) EA EB
0 ¬x 3 or 0 ¬x 27 5.
ED
EC 5. Definition of similar
3 ¬x 27 ¬x triangles
Disregard the negative value. So x ¬3. 6. EA EC ED EB 6. Cross Products
371 Chapter 10
S
31. Given: tangent R and secant
US Page 574 Maintain Your Skills
Prove: (RS)2 US TS R 36. 360 102 258
S m1 1
2 (258) or 129
37. m2 1
2 (85 230)
T 1
2 (315) or 157.5
1
2 (52) or 26
Statements Reasons
39. x 7
S
1. tangent R and 1. Given
S
secant U 40. Connect the center with the point of tangency,
forming a right triangle. Use the Pythagorean
2. mRUT 1 2 mRT
2. The measure of an
inscribed angle Theorem.
equals half the (12 x)2 ¬122 162
measure of its 144 24x x2 ¬144 256
intercepted arc. x2 24x 256 ¬0
(x 8)(x 32) ¬0
3. mSRT 1
2 mRT 3. The measure of an
x 8 ¬0 or x 32 ¬0
angle formed by a
x ¬8 x ¬32
secant and a tangent
Disregard the negative value. So x ¬8.
equals half the
measure of its 41. x 36
intercepted arc. 42. tan 67° ¬5x
4. mRUT mSRT 4. Substitution 5 tan 67° ¬x
5. SUR SRT 5. Definition of 12 ¬x
congruent angles The distance across the stream is about 12 feet.
6. S S 6. Reflexive Prop. 43. No two sides are congruent, and one angle is
greater than 90. The triangle is scalene and obtuse.
7. SUR SRT 7. AA Similarity
RS TS 44. Two sides are congruent and one angle is a right
8.
US
RS
8. Definition of similar angle. The triangle is isosceles and right.
triangles
45. All of the sides are congruent and all three angles
9. (RS)2 US TS 9. Cross Products congruent. The triangle is equilateral, acute or
equiangular.
32. ZY ¬XY
(WX)2 ¬XY XZ 46. d (x 2 x1)2
(y2 y1)2
(WX)2 ¬XY(XY ZY) d
(10 (2))2
(1
2 7)2
(WX)2 XY(2XY) d
144 25
(WX)2 ¬2(XY)2
d
169 or 13
WX ¬ 2(XY)2
WX ¬ 2 XY 47. d (x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
33. Sample answer: The product of the parts of one d
(3 1)
2 (4
7)2
intersecting chord equals the product of the parts d
4 9 or 13
of the other chord. Answers should include the
following. 48. d (x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
•AF,
FD,
E
F, F
B d
(15 9)2
(2
(4))2
• AF FD EF FB
d
36 4 or 40
34. D; x2 ¬20 x
x2 x 20 ¬0
(x 4)(x 5) ¬0
x 4 0 or x 5 ¬0
x ¬4 x ¬5
35. C; let x time working together.
x x
15
30 ¬1
30 x
5
1
x
0 ¬30(1)
3
2x x ¬30
3x ¬30
x ¬10
It will take them 10 minutes working together.
Chapter 10 372
The center is at (3, 0), and the radius is 4.
Equations of Circles y
O x
8. Explore: You are given three points that lie on a
circle.
Plan: Graph NMQ. Construct perpendicular
bisectors of two sides to locate the center. Find the
length of the radius. Use the center and radius to
2. A circle is the locus of all points in a plane write an equation.
(coordinate plane) a given distance (the radius) y
from a given point (the center). The equation of a
circle is written from knowing the location of the Q(2, 2)
given point and the radius.
3. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 O x
[x (3)]2 (y 5)2 ¬102
(x 3)2 (y 5)2 ¬100
4. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 M(2, 2)
(x 0)2 (y 0)2 ¬( 7)2 N(2, 2)
x2 y2 ¬7
5. First find the length of the diameter and radius. Solve: The center is at (0, 0).
d (x r
(0 2
)2 [0
(2
)]2 or 8
2 x1)2 (y2
y1)2
d
(6
2)2
(15
7)2 Write an equation.
(x 0)2 (y 0)2 (8
)2
d or 82
64 64 x2 y2 8
8
2
r or 42 y
2
The center is the midpoint of the diameter: Q (2, 2)
2
C 2(6)
, 7
2
15
or C(2, 11)
O
(x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 x
[x (2)]2 (y 11)2 ¬(42 )2
(x 2) (y 11) ¬32
2 2 M N(2, 2)
( 2, 2)
6. (x 5)2 (y 2)2 9
(x h)2 ¬(x 5)2 (y k)2 ¬(y 2)2
x h ¬x 5 y k ¬y 2 Examine: Verify the location of the center by
h ¬5 k ¬2 finding the equations of the two bisectors and
h ¬5 k ¬2 solving a system of equations.
r2 9, so r 3 bisector of M N: M
N is horizontal so its
The center is at (5, 2), and the radius is 3. bisector is vertical and goes through the midpoint
y N
of M : (0, 2).
Its equation is x 0.
bisector of Q N: Q
N is vertical so its bisector
is horizontal and goes through the midpoint of
( 5, 2) N
Q : (2, 0).
Its equation is y 0.
The intersection of x 0 and y 0 is the point
O x (0, 0).
So the center is correct.
9. The center is at (0, 0) and the radius is 4(10) or 40.
7. (x 3)2 y2 16 (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
Write the equation in standard form. (x 0)2 (y 0)2 ¬402
(x 3)2 (y 0)2 42 x2 y2 ¬1600
373 Chapter 10
Pages 578–580 Practice and Apply 22. If d 12, r 6.
10. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 The center is at (0 18, 0 7) or (18, 7).
(x 0)2 (y 0)2 ¬32 (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
x2 y2 ¬9 [x (18)]2 [y (7)]2 ¬62
11. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 (x 18)2 (y 7)2 ¬36
[x (2)]2 [y (8)]2 ¬52 23. Sketch a drawing of the two tangent lines.
(x 2)2 (y 8)2 ¬25 y
12. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 (7, 8)
(x 1)2 [y (4)]2 ¬( 17)2 5 units
(x 1) (y 4) ¬17
2 2
5 units
13. If d 12, r 6.
(x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
(x 0)2 (y 0)2 ¬62 y3
x2 y2 ¬36
14. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 x
(x 5)2 (y 10)2 ¬72 O
(x 5)2 (y 10)2 ¬49 x2
15. If d 20, r 10. The line x 2 is perpendicular to a radius. Since
(x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 x 2 is a vertical line, the radius lies on a
(x 0)2 (y 5)2 ¬102 horizontal line. Count 5 units to the right from
x2 (y 5)2 ¬100 x 2. Find the value of h.
16. If d 16, r 8. h 2 5 or 7
(x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 Likewise, the radius perpendicular to the line
[x (8)]2 (y 8)2 ¬82 y 3 lies on a vertical line. The value of k is 5
(x 8)2 (y 8)2 ¬64 units up from 3.
17. If d 24, r 12. k 3 5 or 8
(x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 The center is at (7, 8) and the radius is 5.
[x (3)]2 [y (10)]2 122 (x h)2 (y k)2 r2
(x 3)2 (y 10)2 ¬144 (x 7)2 (y 8)2 52
(x 7)2 (y 8)2 25
18. The distance between the center and the endpoint
24. x2 y2 25
of the radius is r [0 (
3)]2
(6 6)2 or 3.
Write the equation in standard form.
(x h) (y k) ¬r
2 2 2
(x 0)2 (y 0)2 52
[x (3)]2 (y 6)2 ¬32 The center is at (0, 0), and the radius is 5.
(x 3)2 (y 6)2 ¬9 y
19. The midpoint of the diameter is 2 (2)
2
, 2
2
2 8
Chapter 10 374
26. x2 y2 1 0 29. (x 1)2 (y 2)2 9
Write the equation in standard form. Compare each expression in the equation to the
x2 y2 1 standard form.
(x 0)2 (y 0)2 12 (x h)2 ¬(x 1)2 (y k)2 ¬(y 2)2
The center is at (0, 0), and the radius is 1. x h ¬x 1 y k ¬y 2
y h ¬1 k ¬2
h ¬1 k ¬2
r2 9, so r 3.
The center is at (1, 2), and the radius is 3.
y
O x
O x
( 1, 2)
27. x2 y2 49 0
Write the equation in standard form.
x2 y2 49
(x 0)2 (y 0)2 72
The center is at (0, 0), and the radius is 7. 30. Explore: You are given three points that lie on a
y circle.
8
Plan: Graph ABC. Construct the perpendicular
4 bisectors of two sides to locate the center. Find the
length of the radius. Use the center and radius to
write the equation.
8 4 O 4 8x
4 y
375 Chapter 10
31. Explore: You are given three points that lie on a so the slope of its bisector is 2
9 . The midpoint of
circle. C
B is (2, 3). Use the slope and the midpoint to
Plan: Graph ABC. Construct the perpendicular write an equation for the bisector of B C:
bisectors of two sides to locate the center. Find the y 2 2
3
9 x 9 . Solving the system of equations,
length of the radius. Use the center and radius to
write the equation. y 4x 5 and y 2
23
9 x 9 , yields (2, 3),
y which is the circumcenter. Let (2, 3) be D, then
DA DB DC 85 .
C(3, 3)
35. The center is at (0, 0) and the radius is 7.
(x h)2 (y k)2 r2
B(0, 0) (x 0)2 (y 0)2 72
x2 y2 49
A(6, 0) x
36. concentric circles
26
37. The radius is 2 or 13.
38. (x 6)2 (y 2)2 36
Solve: The center is at (3, 0). Find r by using
the center and a point on the circle, (0, 0). y
8
r (0 0)2 [0 (3)]2 or 3 y = 2x 2
write an equation. 4
[x (3)]2 (y 0)2 ¬32 x
(x 3)2 y2 ¬9 12
4 4 8
Examine: Verify the location of the center by
finding the equations of the two bisectors and 4
solving a system of equations.
The bisector of AB
is the vertical line with 8
equation x 3. Solve algebraically for the intersection of the two
Next find the equation of the bisector of A C
. graphs.
3 0
C
The slope of A 3 (6) 1. So the slope of Substitute 2x 2 for y in the equation of the circle.
the bisector is 1. (x 6)2 (2x 2 2)2 ¬36
Find the midpoint of A C
: 3
2 , 3
(6)
2
0
x2 12x 36 (2x)2 ¬36
9
3
2, 2 5x2 12x ¬0
x(5x 12) ¬0
Use the point-slope form. x 0 or 5x 12 0
y 3
9
2 ¬1 x 2 y 2x 2
x 2.4
y 3 9
2 ¬x 2
y 2(0) 2 or y 2(2.4) 2
2y 3 ¬2x 9 2 2.8
2x 2y ¬6 The line is a secant because it intersects the circle
x y ¬3 at (0, 2) and (2.4, 2.8).
Substitute x 3 to find the intersection. 39. x2 4x y2 8y ¬16
3 y 3 (x2 4x 4) (y2 8y 16) ¬16 4 16
y0 (x 2)2 (y 4)2 ¬36
The intersection is (3, 0) so the center is correct. (x 2)2 [y (4)]2 ¬62
The center is at (2, 4), and the radius is 6.
32. (x 2)2 (y 2)2 r2
The center is at (2, 2). 40. The center is at (58, 55), and the radius is 80.
Find r by using the Distance Formula with the (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
center and the point (2, 5). [x (58)]2 (y 55)2 ¬802
(x 58)2 (y 55)2 ¬6400
r
(2 2
)2 (5
2)2
41. See students’ work.
9 or 3 42. The center is at (0, 0), and the radius is
33. (x 5)2 (y 3)2 r2 185 1740 or 1925.
The center is at (5, 3). (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
Find r by using the Distance Formula with the (x 0)2 (y 0)2 ¬(1925)2
center and the point (5, 1). x2 y2 ¬3,705,625
r
(5 5
)2 (1
3)2
4 or 2
34. The slope of A is 1
C
4 , so the slope of its bisector
C
is 4. The midpoint of A is (0, 5). Use the slope
and the midpoint to write an equation for the
C
bisector of A: y 4x 5. The slope of B is 9
C
2,
Chapter 10 376
43a. y 44. Sample answer: Equations of concentric circles;
(0, 3) 2 2 answers should include the following.
x y 9
• (x h)2 (y k)2 r2
• x2 y2 9, x2 y2 36, x2 y2 81,
x2 y2 144, x2 y2 225
(3, 0) x 45. B; x2 y2 4x 14y 53 ¬81
(x2 4x) (y2 14y) ¬28
y x 3 (x 4x 4) (y2 14y 49) ¬28 4 49
2
x 1
2 (40) or 20
(0, 0)
54. A(3, 2) → A(3 3, 2 4) or A(6, 6)
B(4, 1) → B(4 3, 1 4) or B(1, 3)
(x3)2y 2 = 9 C(0, 4) → C(0 3, 4 4) or C(3, 0)
55. A(3, 2) → A(3, 2)
B(4, 1) → B(4, 1)
Since (x 3)2 y2 9 and (x 3)2 y2 9, C(0, 4) → C(0, 4)
(x 3)2 y2 ¬(x 3)2 y2
56. Each child needs 2(12) 2(10) 44 inches plus
(x 3)2 ¬(x 3)2
1 inch overlap, or 45 inches total. The teacher
x 6x 9 ¬x2 6x 9
2
1125
6x ¬ 6x needs 25 45 1125 inches, or 36 31.25 yards.
12x ¬0
x ¬0
Substitute x ¬0 into the equation of either circle. Chapter 10 Study Guide and Review
(0 3)2 y2 ¬9
32 y2 ¬9
9 y2 ¬9 Page 581 Vocabulary and Concept Check
y2 ¬0 1. a 2. j
y ¬0
3. h 4. i
The intersection point is (0, 0).
5. b 6. f
7. d 8. g
9. c 10. e
377 Chapter 10
Pages 581–586 Lesson-by-Lesson Review 20.
BCA is a semicircle.
180
11. r 1
2d
mBCA
mAGB.
21. AB is a minor arc, so mAB
r 1
2 (15) or 7.5 in.
mAB mAGB
30
C d mAB
C (15) 22. mAGC mCGD ¬90
C 47.12 in. mAGB mBGC ¬mAGC
12. d 2r 30 mBGC ¬90
d 2(6.4) or 12.8 m mBGC ¬60
¬60
C d mBC
C (12.8) mFGD.
23. FD is a minor arc, so mFD
C 40.21 m Vertical angles are congruent.
13. C ¬2r FGD ¬AGB
68 ¬2r mFGD mAGB
68 mFD ¬mAGB
2 ¬r
mFD ¬30
10.82 yd ¬r
24. CDF is composed of adjacent arcs,
d 2r CD and DF.
mCD mDF
mCDF
68
d2
2 90 30 or 120
mCDF
25. BCD is composed of adjacent arcs,
d 21.65 yd BC and CD.
mBC
mBCD mCD
14. r 1
2d
60 90 or 150
mBCD
r 1
2 (52) or 26 cm 26.
FAB is a semicircle.
180
C 2r mFAB
C 2(26) 27. C 2r
C 163.36 cm C 2(6) or 12
15. C ¬2r mDIG 180 2(mDGI)
138 ¬2r mDIG 180 2(24) or 132
13
8
Let arc length.
2 ¬r
13
2
360 ¬ 12
21.96 ft ¬r 13
2
360 (12) ¬
d 2r
22
5 ¬
13
d2 8
2
d 43.93 ft The length of 2
DG is 2
5 units.
16. d 2r 28. WN IW 5 and IW is a radius.
d 2(11) or 22 mm C 2r
C d C 2(5) or 10
C (22) Since IWN is equilateral, mWIN 60.
C 69.12 mm Let arc length.
mBPY mYPC mCPA ¬180 60
0 ¬
17.
36 10
3x (3x 3) (2x 15) ¬180 60
8x 12 ¬180
360 (10) ¬
8x ¬168 5 ¬
3
x ¬21
mYPC.
YC is a minor arc, so mYC The length of
WN is 5
3 units.
mYPC 29. SV 1
mYC 2 SU
3x 3
mYC
3(21) 3 or 60 SV 1
2 (20) or 10
mYC
18. mBPC.
BC is a minor arc, so mBC 30. WZ 1
2 YW
BC is composed of adjacent arcs,
BY and
YC. WZ 1
2 (20) or 10
mBC mBY mYC
mBPY mYPC 31. bisects S
RT U
, so UV SV.
mBC
3x (3x 3) UV SV
mBC
6x 3 UV 10
mBC
bisects
6(21) 3 or 123 2mYX .
mBC X
32. R YW, so mYW
360 mBCX mYW 2mYX
19. mBX 2(45) or 90
mYW
mBX 360 (3x 3x 3 2x 15 3x)
360 (11x 12)
mBX 33. SU YW and R X bisects bisects
T
YW, R SU.
360 [11(21) 12]
mBX mST mYX
360 243 or 117 45
mBX mST
Chapter 10 378
mYW. 45. 26 ¬12 (89 x)
34. Since SU YW, mSU
mSU mYW 52 ¬89 x
90
mSU x ¬37
35. m1 1 46. 33 ¬1 2 (x 51)
2 (96) or 48
36. 2 is a right angle because it intercepts a 66 ¬x 51
semicircle. 117 ¬x
m2 90 47. 7(7 x) ¬132
37. Inscribed angles of the same arc are congruent. 49 7x ¬169
m3 32 7x ¬120
x ¬17.1
38. m3 1 mGH
2
48. 8.1x ¬10.3(17)
1
2 (78) or 39 8.1x ¬175.1
m2 m3 ¬90 x ¬21.6
m2 39 ¬90 49. x(15 x) ¬8(8 12)
m2 ¬51 15x x2 ¬160
m1 m2 ¬90 x2 15x 160 ¬0
m1 51 ¬90 b b
2 4ac
x
2a
m1 ¬39
15 (15)2
4(1)(160)
39. m2 m3 ¬90 x
2(1)
2x x ¬90 15 29.4
x
3x ¬90 2
x ¬30 x 7.2 or x 44.4
m2 2x Disregard the negative value. So x 7.2.
2(30) or 60 50. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
m3 x or 30 (x 0)2 (y 0)2 ¬(5 )2
x2 y2 ¬5
m1 m2 ¬90
m1 60 ¬90 51. If d 6, r 3.
m1 ¬30 (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
[x (4)]2 (y 8)2 ¬32
40. m2 1
2 mJH (x 4)2 (y 8)2 ¬9
1
2 (114) or 57 52. The center is at the midpoint of the diameter.
m2 m3 ¬90
center 0
8 4 4
2 , 2 or (4, 4)
57 m3 ¬90 The radius is the distance from the center
m3 ¬33 to (0, 4).
m1 m2 ¬90 r (0 4)2 [
4 (4)]2
m1 57 ¬90 16 or 4
m1 ¬33 Write the equation.
41. x2 122 ¬152 (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
x2 144 ¬225 (x 4)2 [y (4)]2 ¬42
x2 ¬81 (x 4)2 (y 4)2 ¬16
x ¬9 53. Since x 1 is a vertical line, the radius lies on a
42. x2 92 ¬(6 9)2 horizontal line. Count horizontally from the point
x2 92 ¬152 (1, 4) to the line x 1 to find the radius. The
x2 81 ¬225 radius is 2.
x2 ¬144 y
x ¬12
43. 72 242 ¬(x 7)2
49 576 ¬x2 14x 49
0 ¬x2 14x 576
(x 18)(x 32) ¬0
x ¬18 ¬0 or x ¬32 ¬0 x
x ¬18 x ¬32
Disregard the negative value.
So x ¬18. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
44. x 1
2 (68 24)
[x (1)]2 (y 4)2 ¬22
1 (x 1)2 (y 4)2 ¬4
x 2(44) or 22
379 Chapter 10
54. x2 y2 2.25 midpoint of B C
. The equation is y 3.
Write the equation in standard form. The intersection of x 3 and y 3 is the
(x 0)2 (y 0)2 (1.5)2 point (3, 3). This is the center we found above so
The center is at (0, 0), and the radius is 1.5. the answer checks.
y 57. y
A(0, 6) C(6, 6)
O x
B(6, 0)
O x
Chapter 10 380
13. 62 ¬x(x 5) 23. Sample answer:
36 ¬x2 5x Given: X with diameters R
0 ¬x2 5x 36 S
R and TV
T
0 ¬(x 4)(x 9) Prove:
RT
VS X
x 4 ¬0 or x 9 ¬0 V
x ¬4 x ¬9 S
Discard x 9. So x ¬4. Proof:
14. 5x 6(8)
Statements Reasons
5x 48
48 1. X with diameters 1. Given
x
5 or 9.6 S
R and T
V
15. Draw the radius to the point of tangency. Use the
2. RXT VXS 2. Vertical are .
Pythagorean Theorem.
3. mRXT mVXS 3. Def. of
62 82 ¬(x 6)2 mVS
36 64 ¬x2 12x 36 4. mRT 4. Measure of arc
0 ¬x2 12x 64 equals measure of its
0 ¬(x 4)(x 16) central angle.
x 4 ¬0 or x 16 ¬0 5.
RT
VS 5. Def. of arcs
x ¬4 x ¬16
Discard x 16. So x ¬4. 24. Let x the distance from the center to the 5-inch
16. 5(5 x) ¬4(4 7) side.
25 5x ¬16 28 x2 (2.5)2 ¬42
5x ¬19 x2 6.25 ¬16
19 x2 ¬9.75
x ¬
5 or 3.8 x ¬3.1
17. 35 1
2 [(360 x) x]
The height is about 4 3.1 or 7.1 in.
70 360 2x 25. A; draw the segment from C to A.
2x 290 DB CA. Since diagonals of a rectangle are
x 145 congruent.
18. 180 (45 110) 25 DB r
x 1
2 (45 25)
1
2 (20) or 10 Chapter 10 Standardized Test Practice
19. 80 12 (110 x)
160 110 x
50 x Pages 588–589
20. C d 1. A; 3y 6x 9 is the same as y 2x 3. So the
C (50) line has slope m ¬2 and y-intercept (0, 3). The
C 157 graph that satisfies these conditions is A.
The circumference is about 157 ft. 2. C; m1 ¬m2
21. If d 50, r 25. 6x 5 ¬3x 13
(x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2 6x 3x ¬13 5
[x (2)]2 (y 5)2 ¬252 3x ¬18
(x 2)2 (y 5)2 ¬625 x ¬6
22. (x 1)2 (y 2)2 4 Use x to find the measure of 1.
Compare each expression in the equation to the m1 6x 5
standard form. 6(6) 5
(x h)2 ¬(x 1)2 (y k)2 ¬(y 2)2 36 5 or 31
x h ¬x 1 y k ¬y 2 3. A
h ¬1 k ¬2 4. B; 3(x 2) ¬2x 9
r2 4, so r 2. 3x 6 ¬2x 9
The center is at (1, 2), and the radius is 2. x ¬3
y Use x to find the measure of one side.
x 2 3 2 or 5
O Each side is 5 miles long.
x
x2 x2
x2
381 Chapter 10
5. A 13.
ABC is a semicircle.
18
0
6. D mABC 2 or 90
is a semicircle.
7. C; DEA DEA is composed of 14. DF AD or 12
adjacent arcs,
DE and EA. DE DF FE
¬mDE mEA
mDEA DE 12 18 or 30
mDEA ¬mDFE mEA Since AE is a tangent, CAE is a right angle and
180 ¬36 mEA AED is a right triangle. Use the Pythagorean
144 ¬mEA Theorem.
8. C; the measure of a minor arc is the measure of (AE)2 (AD)2 ¬(DE)2
its central angle. (AE)2 (12)2 ¬302
9. D (AE)2 144 ¬900
(AE)2 ¬756
10. mGDE mGED mDGE ¬180
AE ¬27.5
35 85 mDGE ¬180
120 mDGE ¬180 15. (BK)(KC) ¬(KF)(JK)
mDGE ¬60 8(12) ¬16(JK)
In DGE, G E
is the shortest side because it is 96 ¬16(JK)
opposite the smallest angle. 6 ¬JK
mFGE mGEF mF ¬180 X
16a. V and WY
65 55 mF ¬180 16b. Let w width, then
120 mF ¬180 3w 2 length
mF ¬60 2(3w 2) 2w ¬164
In GFE, FG GE because mGEF mF. 6w 4 2w ¬164
So FG is the shortest side of quadrilateral DEFG. 8w ¬160
ST 30 w ¬20
8 ¬
11.
12 The width is 20 in. and the length is 3(20) 2 or
12(ST) ¬8(30) 62 in.
12(ST) ¬240 17a. y B(1, 6)
ST ¬20
ST is 20 ft long.
12. Find a correspondence between ABC and DEF
so that their sides are proportional. (1, 2)
y
12
F O x
8 C
D E A(1, 2)
4
B 17b. The center is the midpoint of the diameter:
4
A
4 8 12
x
2 , 2 or (1, 2).
1
1 2 6
Chapter 10 382
Chapter 11 Areas of Polygons and Circles
Page 593 Getting Started 4. co- together, centr- center; circles with a common
1. A ¬ w 2. A ¬ w center
150 ¬ 15 38 ¬ 19 5. circum- around, scribe- write; to write around (a
10 ¬ 2 ¬ geometrical figure)
3. A ¬ w 4. A ¬ w 6. co- together, linear- line; together on the same line
21.16 ¬ 4.6 2000 ¬ 32 7. circum- around, about; ferre- to carry
4.6 ¬ 62.5 ¬ 8. Sample answers: polychromatic – multicolored,
5. A ¬ w 6. A ¬ w polymer – a chemical compound composed of a
450 ¬ 25 256 ¬ 20 repeating structural unit, polysyllabic – a word
18 ¬ 12.8 ¬ with more than three syllables
7. 1 1
2 a(b c) ¬ 2 6(8 10)
¬1
2 6(18) 54
8. 1 1
11-1 Areas of Parallelograms
2 ab 2 6 8 24
9. 1 1
2 (2b c) ¬ 2 (2 8 10)
¬1 Page 595 Geometry Activity
2 (16 10)
1. When the parallelogram is folded, the base of the
¬1
2 26 13
rectangle is 4 and the height is 5. So the area is
10. 1 1
2 d(a c) ¬ 2 11(6 10)
20 units2.
¬1 2. There are 2 rectangles, one on the bottom and one
2 11 16
formed by the folded triangles on top.
¬8 11 88
3. 40 units2
11. 1
(b c) ¬1(8 10)
2 2 4. The base of the parallelogram is half of the length
¬1
2 (18) ¬9
of the rectangle. The altitude of the parallelogram
12. 1 1
2 cd ¬ 2 10 11
is the same width as the width of the rectangle.
¬55 5. A w or A bh
13. ABD is a 30°-60°-90° B
triangle. B D
, or h, is
the longer leg, A D is Page 598 Check for Understanding
the shorter leg, and 1. The area of a rectangle is the product of the
B
A is the hypotenuse. h length and the width. The area of a parallelogram
AD ¬1
2 AC or 6
is the product of the base and the height. For both
60˚ quadrilaterals, the measure of the length of one
h ¬6 3
A D C side is multiplied by the length of the altitude.
12
2. See students’ work.
14. In the 30°-60°-90° triangle, the hypotenuse has a
3. P 2(5) 2(9) 28 ft
length of 22, so the shorter leg has a length of 11.
Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle to find the height, with
15. In the 45°-45°-90° C x as the length of the shorter leg.
triangle, the 9 ¬2x
length of the h
9 ¬x
hypotenuse is 15. 2
AB ¬BC 2 45˚ 923
height x3 ft
A B
15 ¬h 2 15 A ¬bh
15
¬h
2 ¬59
2 3
45
2 3
or about 39.0 ft2
15
2 ¬
¬h
2 2
15
2 The perimeter of the parallelogram is 28 ft, and
¬h
2 the area is about 39.0 ft2.
4. P 2(13) 2(10) 46 yd
Use a 45°-45°-90° triangle to find the height, x.
Page 594 Reading Mathematics 10 ¬x 2
1. bi- 2, sector- a subdivision or region; divide into 2 10
x
regions 2
2. poly- many, gon- closed figure; closed figure with 10
2
¬x
many sides
2 2
52 ¬x
3. equi- equal, lateral- sides; having sides of equal
length height x 52
yd
383 Chapter 11
A ¬bh A ¬bh
¬1352
¬217517 10 17
¬170 units2
¬652
or about 91.9 yd2 8. Left Parallelogram Rectangle
The perimeter of the parallelogram is 46 yd, and A ¬bh A ¬w
the area is about 91.9 yd2. 18 15 35 18
¬270 ft2 ¬630 ft2
5. P 4(3.2) 12.8 m
Right Parallelogram
A ¬s2
A ¬bh
¬(3.2)2 18 15
¬270 ft2
¬10.24 or about 10.2 m2
The total area is 270 630 270 or 1170 ft2.
The perimeter of the square is 12.8 m, and the
area is about 10.2 m2.
Pages 598–600 Practice and Apply
6. y 9. P 2(30) 2(10) 80 in.
V ( 2, 6) X ( 6, 6) Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle to find the height, with
x as the length of the shorter leg.
10 ¬2x
5 ¬x
height x 3 53 in.
A ¬bh
x ¬305 3
T ( 0, 0) Y ( 4, 0)
¬150 3 or about 259.8 in2.
The perimeter of the parallelogram is 80 in., and
6 0 6 the area is about 259.8 in2.
V
slope of T
2 0 2 or 3
0 6 6 10. Use the 45°-45°-90° triangle with hypotenuse 4 to
Y
slope of X
4 6 2 or 3
find the base and height of the parallelogram,
6 6 0 both equal to x.
X
slope of V
6 2 4 or 0
0 0 4 x 2
Y
0
slope of T 4 0 4 or 0 4
x
TVXY is a parallelogram, since opposite sides 2
have the same slope. Slopes of consecutive sides 4 2
x
are not negative reciprocals of each other, so the 2 2
parallelogram is neither a square nor a rectangle. 2 2 ¬x
A ¬bh base height x 2 2m
¬4 6
P 22 2 2(4) 4 2 8 or about 13.7 m
¬24 units2
A ¬bh
7. y V ( 2, 18) ¬22 22
T ( 10, 16) ¬8 m2
The perimeter of the parallelgram is about 13.7 m,
and the area is 8 m2.
11. Since all 4 sides have the same measure and the
angle is a right angle, the parallelogram is a square.
x P 4(5.4) 21.6 cm
X ( 3, 2)
Y ( 5, 4) A ¬s2
¬(5.4)2
¬29.16 or about 29.2 cm2
18 16 2 1 The perimeter is 21.6 cm, and the area is about
V
slope of T2 10 8 or 4
29.2 cm2.
4 (2) 2 1
Y
slope of X
5 (3) 8 or 4 12. P 2(15) 2(10) 50 in.
2 18 20
X
slope of V
3 2 5 or 4
Use a 45°-45°-90° triangle to find the height, x.
4 16 20 10 ¬x 2
Y
slope of T 5 10 5 or 4 10
2
x
TVXY is a rectangle, since opposite sides have the 2 2
same slope and the slopes of consecutive sides are 5 2 ¬x
negative reciprocals of each other. height x 5 2 in.
Length of X is
Y
[5 (3)] 2
[4
(2 )]2 A ¬bh
2 17. ¬155 2
Length of T is
Y [10 5]2 [16
(4)]2 ¬75 2 or about 106.1 in2
5 17. The perimeter is 50 in., and the area is about
106.1 in2.
Chapter 11 384
13. P 2(12) 2(10) 44 m 18. A ¬bh
Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle to find the height, with 100 ¬(x 15)(x)
x as the length of the shorter leg. 100 ¬x2 15x
10 ¬2x x2 15x 100 ¬0
5 ¬x (x 20)(x 5) ¬0
height x 3 5
3m x 20 ¬0 or x 5 ¬0
A ¬bh x ¬20 or x ¬5
Reject the negative solution.
¬125 3
h 5 units, b 20 units
¬60 3 or about 103.9 m2
19. A ¬bh
The perimeter is 44 m, and the area is about
2000 ¬(x 10)(x)
103.9 m2.
2000 ¬x2 10x
14. P 2(5.4) 2(4.2) 19.2 ft x 10x 2000 ¬0
2
3 (3) 0
F
slope of E3 (5) 8 or 0
4
4 0
G
slope of H
5 (3) 8 or 0
385 Chapter 11
4 (3) 7 6 2 8
G
slope of F 53 2
P
slope of O 4 2 2 or 4
4 (3) 7 NOPQ is a parallelogram, since opposite sides
slope of EH
3 (5) 2 have the same slope. Slopes of consecutive sides
EFGH is a parallelogram, since opposite sides
are not negative reciprocals of each other, so the
have the same slope. Slopes of consecutive sides
parallelogram is neither a square nor a rectangle.
are not negative reciprocals of each other, so the
Base: PQ is horizontal with length
parallelogram is neither a square nor a rectangle.
4 4 8.
Base: E F is horizontal with length
Height: Since P Q
and ON are horizontal
3 (5) 8.
segments, the distance between them, or height,
Height: Since G H and E F
are horizontal
can be measured on any vertical segment.
segments, the distance between them, or height,
Reading from the graph, the height is 8.
can be measured on any vertical segment.
A ¬bh
Reading from the graph, the height is 7.
¬8 8
A ¬bh
¬64 units2
¬8 7
¬56 units2 24. y
R ( 2, 4) S ( 8, 4)
22. y M ( 1, 6) L ( 6, 6)
x
U ( 2, 3) T ( 8, 3)
N ( 6, 2) O ( 2, 2)
X ( 2, 5)
x
5 7 2 2
slope of X
Y2 ( 1) 3 or 3
P ( 4, 6) 8 10 2 2
Q ( 4, 6) slope of W
V 4 1 3 or 3
8 5 3
6 (6) 0 slope of W
X
42 2
P
slope of Q
4 (4) 8 or 0
10 7 3
2
2 0
slope of V
Y
1 ( 1) 2
O
slope of N
2 (6) 8 or 0
6 2 8
Q
slope of N (6) 2 or 4
4
Chapter 11 386
VWXY is a rectangle, since opposite sides have 31. On the crosswalk, draw a 30°-60°-90° triangle
the same slope and the slopes of consecutive sides whose hypotenuse is 16 ft long and whose short
are negative reciprocals of each other. side lies along the left edge of the crosswalk. That
Length of Y
X
[2 (1)] 2 [5 7]2 13
short side measures 8 ft, and the remaining side,
Length of X
W [4 2]
2 [8 5]
2 13 which represents the perpendicular distance
between the stripes, measures 8 3 or about
Thus VWXY is in fact a square.
13.9 ft.
A ¬s2 2 32. P 2(8) 2(11) 38 m
¬ 13
A bh
¬13 units2
8 10
26. Guest bedroom Family room 80 m2
A ¬w A ¬w The perimeter is 38 m, and the area is 80 m2.
¬20 22 ¬25 22
33. P 2(4) 2(5.5) 19 m
¬440 ft2 ¬550 ft2
A bh
Hallway 45
¬A ¬w 20 m2
¬25 3 The perimeter is 19 m and the area is 80 m2.
¬75 ft2
34. The new perimeter is half of the original
The Bessos need 440 550 75 or 1065 ft2 of
perimeter. The new area is one half squared, or
carpet. Since there are 9 square feet per square
one fourth, the area of the original parallelogram.
yard, the family should order 1065 9 or 119 yd2
(rounded up to the nearest yd2). 35. Let the side length of one square be x. Then the
48 4x
27. The figure is composed of three 5 by 10 side length of the other square is 4 or
rectangles. 12 x.
x2 (12 x)2 ¬74
10
x 144 24x x2 ¬74
2
387 Chapter 11
42. For the equation (x h)2 (y k)2 r2, the 49. Use the Pythagorean Theorem.
center of the circle is (h, k) and the radius is r. For a2 b2 ¬c2
the equation (x 2.8)2 (y 7.6)2 34.81, which 52 122 ¬2
is equivalent to [x 2.8]2 [y (7.6)]2 5.92, 25 144 ¬2
the center is (2.8, 7.6) and r 5.9. 169 ¬2
43. Use Theorem 10.16. 13 ¬
10(10 22) ¬8(8 x) The length of plywood needed is 13 ft.
320 ¬64 8x 50. 1 1
2 (7y) ¬ 2 (7 2)
256 ¬8x ¬7
32 ¬x
51. 1 1
2 wx ¬ 2 (8)(4)
44. Use Theorem 10.15.
4 9 ¬x x ¬16
36 ¬x2 52. 1 1
2 z(x y) ¬ 2 (5)(4 2)
6 ¬x 15
45. Use Theorem 10.17. 53. 1 1
2 x(y w) ¬ 2 (4)(2 8)
14 14 ¬7(7 x)
196 ¬49 7x 20
147 ¬7x
21 ¬x
46. B y B
11-2 Areas of Triangles, Trapezoids,
and Rhombi
A A
C
C
Page 601 Geometry Activity
x 1. The two smaller triangles, combined, are the
C same size as ABC.
A 2. ABC is 1
2 the area of rectangle ACDE.
3. Since the area of rectangle ACDE is bh, for ABC
A 1
2 bh.
B
Image coordinates: A (1, 3), B (4, 6), C (5, 1)
The rotation angle is 180°. Page 605 Check for Understanding
47. 1. Sample answer:
y
F
G, H 2. Kiku is correct; she simplified the formula by
H, H
¬1 1
2 (37)(9) 2 (37)(18)
M
L 33
¬ 3
2 333
L
¬499.5 in2
L N x
6. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
1
¬2(12)(24 16)
M
M
¬240 yd2
N
N
Chapter 11 388
7.
AB is horizontal with y Pages 606–608 Practice and Apply
length 5 2 7 13. A ¬1
2 bh
or 7. Point C lies above C ( 1, 3)
¬1
2 (7.3)(3.4)
B
A a distance of
3 (3) 6 or ¬12.41 or about 12.4 cm2
6 units. x 14. A ¬1
2 bh
A ¬1
2 bh ¬1
2 (10.2)(7)
¬1
2 (7)(6) ¬35.7 ft2
B(5, 3) A(2, 3)
¬21 units2 15. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
G
8. F and H J are horizontal.
¬1
2 (10)(8 11)
FG ¬5 (1) y
¬6 or 6 F ( 1, 8) G(5, 8) ¬95 km2
HJ ¬1 3 16. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
¬2 or 2
¬1
2 (8.5)(8.5 14.2)
h ¬8 4 H ( 3, 4) ¬96.475 or about 96.5 yd2
¬4 or 4 J ( 1, 4)
17. A ¬1
2 d1d2
A ¬1
h(b1 b2)
2
¬1
2 (20 20)(30 30)
¬1
2 (4)(6 2)
x ¬1200 ft2
¬16 units2
P
9. L is horizontal, M
Q
is vertical. 18. A ¬1
2 d1d2
LP ¬0 (4)
M ( 2, 4) y ¬1
2 (17 17)(12 12)
¬4 or 4 ¬408 cm2
MQ ¬2 4 L ( 4, 3) 19. area of quadrilateral ABCD
¬2 or 2 area of ADC area of ABC
A ¬1
P ( 0, 3)
2 d1d2 Q ( 2, 2) D C
¬1
2 (4)(2) x
¬4 units2 5m
5m
8m
B
12 m
A
10. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
¬1 1
2 b1h1 2 b2h2
Substitute the known values into the formula.
¬1 1
2 (8)(5) 2 (12)(5)
250 ¬12 h(20 30)
¬50 m 2
250 ¬1
2 (50)h 20. area of quadrilateral WXYZ
250 ¬25h area of WXY area of WZY
10 ¬h
W
The height is 10 in. Z
11. A ¬1
2 d1d2 4 in.
6 in.
Substitute the known values into the formula. 18 in.
675 ¬1
2 (15 15)d2
X 21 in. Y
675 ¬15d2
45 ¬d2
¬1 1
2 b1h1 2 b2h2
SU ¬45 m
¬1 1
2 (21)(6) 2 (18)(4)
12. From Postulate 11.1, the area of each congruent
¬99 in2
rhombus is the same, namely 827 3 2
8 13 6 8 in .
21. In a 30°-60°-90° right triangle, the longer leg is
The width of one rhombus is 15 5 3 in. To
3 times as long as the shorter leg. Here, then,
find the other diagonal (the height), use the area
formula. b h3, so h b.
3
A ¬1
2 d1d2
A bh
63
1
8 ¬ 2 (3)d2
15 15
3
51
3 75 3 or about 129.9 mm2
8 ¬ 2 d2
17
4 ¬d2
17 1
The vertical diagonal measures
4 or 4 4 in.
389 Chapter 11
22.
PT and QR are horizontal. 27. is horizontal,
JL KM is vertical.
QR ¬5 3 y JL ¬3 (1) y
¬2 or 2 ¬4 or 4 8
PT ¬6 0 K
Q R KM ¬3 7
¬6 or 6 ¬10 or 10 4 L
h ¬7 3 J
A ¬1
2 d1d2
x
¬4 or 4 1 8 4 4 8
P T ¬2 (4)(10)
A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
4 M
x ¬20 units2
¬1
2 (4)(2 6)
8
¬16 units2
T
23. R and P Q
are horizontal. 28. is horizontal,
JL KM is vertical.
RT ¬4 4 y JL ¬5 (1) y
¬8 or 8 8 ¬6 or 6
PQ ¬2 (4) T R KM ¬10 2 4
K
¬2 or 2 4 ¬12 or 12 x
h ¬6 (5) A ¬1 8 4 4 8
2 d1d2
¬11 or 11 8 4 4 8x
4 ¬1
J 4
A ¬1 2 (6)(12) L
2 h(b1 b2)
P Q ¬36 units2 8
¬1
2 (11)(8 2)
8
M
¬55 units2
T
24. R and PQ are horizontal. L
29. J is horizontal, K
M
is vertical.
RT 1 6 y JL ¬10 2 y
P Q
5 or 5 8 ¬8 or 8
PQ 6 (3) KM ¬2 6 12
9 or 9 4 ¬4 or 4
R
h 8 2 8
T x A ¬1
2 d1d2
K
6 or 6 8 4 4 8
¬1
4 J
A ¬1 4 2 (8)(4) L
2 h(b1 b2)
x
¬16 units2 M
¬1
2 (6)(5 9)
8 4 8 12
¬42 units2
T
25. R and PQ are horizontal. 30. A 1
2 h(b1 b2)
RT 4 (2) y Solve for h.
2 or 2 P
PQ 1 (6)
Q 750 1
2 h(35 25)
7 7 750 ¬1
2 (60)h
h 3 (2) x
750 ¬30h
5 or 5
25 ¬h
A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
T R The height is 25 m.
¬1 31. A 1
2 h(b1 b2)
2 (5)(2 7)
¬22.5 units2 Solve for b2.
L
26. J is horizontal, K
M
is vertical. 188.35 ¬1
2 (8.7)(16.5 b2)
JL 12 2 y 376.7 ¬8.7(16.5 b2)
K
10 or 10 4 376.7 ¬143.55 8.7b2
KM 2 4 J L 233.15 ¬8.7b2
6 or 6 4 4 8 12 x 26.8 ¬b2
A ¬1
2 d1d2 4 M GK is about 26.8 ft.
32. A ¬1
2 d1d2
¬1
2 (10)(6) 8 Solve for d2.
¬30 units2 375 ¬1
12 2 (25)d2
375 ¬12.5d2
30 ¬d2
NQ 30 in.
Chapter 11 390
33. A ¬1
2 d1d2 41. A side length of 52 4 or 13 in. and a half-
Solve for d2. diagonal of 24 2 or 12 in. implies that the other
137.9 ¬1 half-diagonal measures 13 2 122 or 5 in.
2 (12.2)d2
137.9 ¬6.1d2 So d2 2 5 or 10 in. 13 13
22.6 ¬d2 A ¬1
2 d1d2 12
QS is about 22.6 m. ¬1
2 (24)(10)
24
13 13
34. A ¬1
2 bh ¬120 in2
Solve for b. 42. B
x
248 ¬1
2 b(16)
2x 3
248 ¬8b h
31 ¬b
The base measures 31 in. A
5 x C5
35. A ¬1
2 bh
Solve for h. x 10
300 ¬1
2 (30)h Let b1 x, b2 x 10, s 2x 3.
300 ¬15h P ¬b1 b2 2s
20 ¬h 52 ¬x (x 10) 2(2x 3)
The height is 20 cm. 52 ¬6x 4
36. Each rhombus has an area of 150 2 75 ft2. 48 ¬6x
8 ¬x
A ¬1
2 d1d2 So b1 8, b2 18, s 13.
75 ¬1
2 (12)d2 In order to find the area, we need to find h. Using
75 ¬6d2 right triangle ABC, AB s 13, and AC 5.
12.5 ¬d2 h2 52 ¬132
Each stone walkway is 12.5 ft long. h2 ¬ 144
37. From Exercise 36, d2 12.5 ft. h ¬12
A ¬1
d d2 2 h(b1 b2)
2 2
s2 ¬ 21 2
¬1
2 (12)(8 18)
s ¬
2 2
d 2 1 d 2 2
¬156 yd2
2
2
2 2
¬ 12
12
.5 43. b ¬1
3P
¬8.7 ¬1
3 (15)
Each side measures about 8.7 ft. ¬5 in.
Drawing the height divides the triangle into two
38. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
30°-60°-90° triangles each with base 1
2 b.
¬1
2 (122.81)(56 69.7)
12b
h ¬3
¬7718.6 ft2
12(5)
¬3
39. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
53
¬
2in.
1
¬2(199.8)(57.8 75.6) 1
A ¬ 2 bh
¬13,326.7 ft2
40. A side length of 20 4 or 5 m and a half-diagonal
¬1
2 (5) 2
5
3
of 8 2 or 4 m implies that the other half- 25 or about 10.8 in2
3
¬ 4
diagonal measures 52 42 or 3 m. So d2 2 3
or 6 m. 44. Because (34.0)2 (81.6)2 (88.4)2, the triangle is
5 5 a right triangle.
A ¬1
2 d1d2 4 A ¬1
2 bh
¬1
2 (8)(6) 8
5 5 ¬1
2 (34.0)(81.6)
¬24 m2
¬1387.2 m2
391 Chapter 11
45. LM ¬5 or 3 ft
2 42 50. The kite consists of two triangles, each with
JL ¬(8.5)
2 (4)2 or 7.5 ft b 25 in. and h 20 2 or 10 in.
JM ¬JL LM A ¬A1 A2
¬3 7.5 ¬2A1
¬10.5 ft ¬2(1
2 bh)
A ¬1
2 bh ¬bh
¬1
2 (10.5)(4) ¬25 10
¬21 ft2 ¬250 in2
46. A rhombus is made up of two congruent triangles. 51. Comparing heights, 6 2
3 1.
Using d1 and d2 instead of b and h, its area in 52. Left triangle Right triangle
2 bh is 2 2 d1 2 d2 or
reference to A 1 1 1 P 8 8.3 6.5 P 4 4.15 3.25
1
d1d2. 22.8 11.4
2
22.8 2
11.4 1
53.
47. False; Sample answer:
5 40
The area for each of 3
2
The ratio is the same.
these right triangles is 54. Left triangle Right triangle
4 6
6 square units. The A ¬1
bh A ¬1
perimeter of one triangle is 12 and the perimeter 2 2 bh
of the other is 8 40 or about 14.3. ¬1
2 (8)(6) ¬1
2 (4)(3)
48. Drawing the height of an equilateral triangle ¬24 ¬6
2
6 1 1
24 4 2
divides it into two 30°-60°-90° triangles each with 55.
base 1
2 b.
The ratio of the areas is the square of the scale
Left triangle factor.
2
6 1 1
24 4 2
12b
h ¬3 56.
22.8 2
11.4 1
12(4)
¬3
The ratio of the areas is the square of the ratio of
¬23
the perimeters.
A ¬1
2 bh 57. BH ¬6 and HA 3
BA ¬6 2 32
2 (4)23
¬1
¬ 45
¬43 or about 6.9 2
area of ABCD 45 or 45 ft2
P ¬3(4) 12
area of EFGH 92 81 ft2
Right triangle 45
ratio of areas 5
12b
h ¬3 81 9 or 5:9
58. Sample answer: Umbrellas have triangular panels
12(5)
¬3 of fabric or nylon. In order to make the panels to
fit the umbrella frame, the area of the triangles is
¬5
2 3
needed. Answers should include the following.
A ¬1
2 bh • Find the area of a triangle by multiplying the
base and the height and dividing by two.
2 (5) 2 3
¬1
5
• Rhombi are composed of two congruent
25
4 3
¬ or about 10.8 isosceles triangles, and trapezoids are composed
P 3(5) 15 of two triangles and a rectangle.
The scale factor and ratio of perimeters is 15
59. B; C is (0, 10), and A 1 1
2 bh 2 (10)(6)
12 2
5
or 4. 30 units .
25
or 2156, which 60. D; either 2x 7 0 or x 10 0, so either
4 3
The ratio of areas is 43
2
equals 4 .
5 x 72 or x 10.
49. Left rhombus Right rhombus 61. Let side b be the base and a be the other given
side. Then h asin C.
A ¬1
2 d1d2 A ¬1
2 d1d2 area 1
2 bh
¬1
2 (4)(6) ¬1
2 (2)(3) 1
2 absin C
¬12 ¬3
62. A 1
2 absin C
P ¬4213 P ¬413
¬1
2 (4)(7)sin 29°
¬813
¬6.79 in2
The scale factor and ratio of perimeters is
4
13 1
2. 63. A ¬1
2 absin C
813 2 ¬1
2 (4)(5)sin 37°
The ratio of areas is
12 4 , which equals 1
3 1
2 .
¬6.02 cm2
Chapter 11 392
64. A ¬1
2 absin C Page 609 Practice Quiz 1
¬1
2 (1.9)(2.3)sin 25° 1.
M y
¬0.92 ft2 8
J 4
L
x
Page 609 Maintain Your Skills
65. A ¬w 8 4 K 4 8
¬(22)(17) 4
¬374 cm2
8
66. Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle. The height of the
parallelogram x3 , where x 12(10) or 5. K
¬ 0 4 4
4 (8) 4 or 1
slope of J
A ¬bh 8 4
M
¬ 4
¬(15)(5 3)
slope of L 4 0 4 or 1
¬75 3 or about 129.9 in2 4
0 4
L
slope of K ¬
0 (4) 4 or 1
67. area ¬area of large rectangle 8 4
M
¬ 4
¬ area of “hanging” rectangle
slope of J 4 (8) 4 or 1
¬b1h1 b2h2 Opposite sides have the same slope and slopes of
¬(21)(9) (6)(7) consecutive sides are negative reciprocals of each
other.
¬231 ft2
JK [4 (8)]2
[0 4]2 42
68. For the circle with center (h, k) and radius r, the
equation is (x h)2 (y k)2 r2. KL [0 (
4)]
2 [4 0]2 4 2
Here, (x 1)2 (y 2)2 72, or Adjacent sides have the same length. JKLM is a
(x 1)2 (y 2)2 49. square.
69. For the circle with center (h, k) and radius r, the 2. Since JKLM is a square with side length 4 2,
equation is (x h)2 (y k)2 r2. A s2
2 2 (4 2)2
Here, [x (4)]2 y 12 2 ,
11
2
32 units2
or (x 4)2 y 2 4.
1 12 1
P
3. N is a horizontal segment with length
70. For the circle with center (h, k) and radius r, the 4 1 5 so b1 5. M
Q is a horizontal
equation is (x h)2 (y k)2 r2. segment with length 6 7 13 so b2 13.
Since N P
and M
Q are horizontal, the distance
Here, [x (1.3)]2 [y 5.6]2 3.52,
between them, the height, can be measured on
or (x 1.3)2 (y 5.6)2 12.25.
any vertical segment. Reading from the graph,
71. Each semicircle has a radius of 12 (3.5) 1.75 in.
h ¬6.
total inches of trim for one flower 5(r)
A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
¬5(1.75)
¬27.5 in. ¬1
2 (6)(5 13)
So she needs 10(27.5) or 275 in. to edge
¬54 units2
10 flowers.
72. 136 cos 25°, 136 sin 25° 123.3, 57.5 4. The bases of the trapezoid are vertical segments.
b1 WZ 3 (1) 4 and
73. 280 cos 52°, 280 sin 52° 172.4, 220.6
x b2 XY 7 1 6
46 ¬sin 73°
74. Since WZ and XY are vertical segments, the
x ¬46 sin 73° distance between them, or the height of the
¬44.0 trapezoid, can be measured along any horizontal
x segment. Reading from the graph, h 5.
30 ¬sin 42°
75.
x ¬30 sin 42° A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
¬20.1 ¬1
2 (5)(4 6)
76. 1 ¬25 units2
2 (6) ¬3
x
3 ¬tan 58° 5. A ¬1
2 d1d2
x ¬3 tan 58° 546 ¬1
2 (26)d2
¬4.8
546 ¬13d2
42 ¬d2
d2 is 42 yd long.
393 Chapter 11
4. Side length:
11-3 Areas of Regular Polygons and Since the perimeter
Circles is 108 meters, the 140
108
side length is 9
or 12 m. C
Page 611 Geometry Activity Apothem: C D is an 40
1. A 1
2 Pa. Since P (number of sides)(measure of
apothem of the
a side), each entry in the last row of the table is 1
2 regular nonagon. 20
The central angles B
times the product of the three entries above it.
6 D6
are all congruent. A
360°
The measure of each angle is 9 or 40°. C D
Number bisects ACB so mACD is 20°. AD 6. Write a
3 5 8 10 20 50 trigonometric ratio to find the length of C D.
of Sides
6 6
Measure tan 20°
CD or CD tan 20° 16.485 m
1.73r 1.18r 0.77r 0.62r 0.31r 0.126r
of a Side Area: A ¬1
2 Pa
Measure
of 0.5r 0.81r 0.92r 0.95r 0.99r 0.998r ¬1
2 (108)(16.485)
Apothem ¬890.2 m2
5. A 30°-60°-90°
Area 1.30r2 2.39r2 2.83r2 2.95r2 3.07r2 3.14r2 A
triangle is
2. The polygon appears to be a circle. formed by the 60
A 2.4 cm
radius of the cm
3. The areas of the polygons approach the area of 2. 4
the circle. circle, the
C 30 D
apothem, and B D B
4. The formula for the area of a circle is 3.14r2 or
half the base
r2.
of the equilateral E
triangle. AD is the
shorter leg, B D
is the
Page 613 Check for Understanding longer leg, and A B is the
1. Sample answer: Separate a hexagon inscribed in hypotenuse.
a circle into six congruent nonoverlapping
So, AD ¬1 2 2.4 1.2
C
isosceles triangles. The area of one triangle is one- B D
half the product of one side of the hexagon and BD ¬1.2 3 and
the apothem of the hexagon. The area of the BC 2.4 3
Next, find the height of the triangle DE. Since
hexagon is 61 2 sa. The perimeter of the
mEBD 60,
hexagon is 6s, so the formula is 1
2 Pa. DE 3 BD 3(1.2)( 3)
2. Sample answer: Another method besides 3.6
30°-60°-90° triangles is to use trigonometric shaded area ¬area of circle area of triangle
ratios.
¬r2 1
2 bh
3. Side length:
¬(2.4)2 1 2 (2.4
3)(3.6)
Since the perimeter is 42
42 ¬10.6 cm2
yards, the side length is
6 or
7 yd. 30˚
6. ABC is a 30°-60°-90° C
triangle. AB is the
Apothem: A 30°-60°-90°
shorter leg and A C is 30
triangle is formed by the
7 the longer leg.
apothem and one-half of a 3.5 AC 3 AB A 60 D
side of the hexagon. The B
3 3 3 3
shorter leg of the triangle is 1
2 (7) or 3.5. ADC is also a
The apothem is the longer leg of the triangle or 30°-60°-90° triangle in
3.5 3. which A C is the E
Area: A ¬1
2 Pa shorter leg and A D is the longer leg.
So AD 33 3 3 3 9.
2 (42) 3.53
¬1
CE 2 AC because AD is an altitude of CDE
¬127.3 yd2
6 3
shaded area ¬area of triangle area of circle
¬1
2 CE AD r
2
¬1
2 (63
)(9) (3)2
¬18.5 in2
Chapter 11 394
7. Small cushions Large cushion 12. Since we know that ABC C
radius 6 in. radius 10 in. is a regular triangle, it is
For cloth cover: For cloth cover: equilateral and ADC is a
r 6 3 9 in. r ¬10 3 13 in. 30°-60°-90° triangle. The 15.5 in. 30
A r2 A ¬r2 height, CD
, of the triangle
(9) 2 ¬(13)2 is the longer leg and AD is
81 ¬169 the shorter leg.
Area of cloth to cover both sides of all cushions 15
.5
AD 2 7.75 A D B
2(169) 14(81) CD AD 3 7.753 15.5 in.
1472 in2 The area of triangle ABC is
To convert to square yards, divide by 1296.
2
147 1 1
2AB CD 2(15.5)(7.753
)
1296 3.6 yd
2
104.0 in2
13. Apothem: The central
Pages 613–616 Practice and Apply angles of the octagon are
8. Side length: 72 8 or 9 in., and 1
2 (9) 4.5
all congruent so
36 0 C
Central angle: 360° 8 or 45°, mACB 8 or 45°.
10
45
and 1 D
C is an apothem of the
2 (45°) 22.5°
4.5 9
4.5 octagon. It bisects ACB
Apothem: tan 22.5° a
4.5 a 45 and is a perpendicular A5D B
a tan 22.5° 10.864 in. B
bisector of A. So
A ¬1
mACD 22.5. Since the side of the octagon has
2 Pa measure 10, AD 5.
¬1
2 (72)(10.864) 5
tan 22.5° CD
¬391.1 in2 5
CD
9. side length 842 4 or 212 m tan 22.5°
A ¬s2 12.07
2
¬21 2 perimeter 10 8 80
¬882 m2 Area: A ¬1
2 Pa
(Note: This is easier than finding the central
¬1
2 (80)(12.07)
angle, the apothem, and A 1
2 Pa.)
¬482.8 km2
10. ADC is a 45°-45°-90°
14. square side length 102
triangle so AD 12.
side length 2 12 24 cm shaded area area of circle area of square
C r2 s2
A s2
(10)2 (10 2)2
(24) 2
45° 114.2 units 2
576 cm2 12
(Note: This is easier than 45° 15. Circle radius: 5 2 2.5
finding the central angle A D B shaded area area of rectangle area of circle
1
and using A 2Pa.) w r2
(10)(5) (2.5)2
11. Side length: mACB 60 30.4 units2
so mACD 30 and ACD
16. Use 30°-60°-90° triangles. Half the base of the
is a 30°-60°-90° triangle. C equilateral triangle is 0.75 3, so the base is
AD is the shorter leg, 1.53 and the height is 3(0.75 3) or 2.25.
so CD 3 AD or shaded area ¬area of circle area of triangle
24
24 3 AD.
24 A D B ¬r2 1
2 ab
AD 24 3 3
3 83
3 3
¬(1.5)2 1
2 (1.53
)(2.25)
So, AB, the side length of the regular hexagon
is 2(83) 16 3 in. ¬4.1 units2
Perimeter: P 6(16 3) 96
3 in. 17. Use 30°-60°-90° triangles. Half the base of the
equilateral triangle is 3.63, so the base is 7.23
Area: A ¬1
2Pa and the height is 3(3.63) or 10.8.
¬1
2(963
)(24) shaded area ¬area of triangle area of circle
¬1995.3 in2 ¬1
2 bh r
2
¬1
2 (7.23
)(10.8) (3.6)2
¬26.6 units2
395 Chapter 11
18. The triangle is a 30°-60°-90° right triangle whose 23. The radius of the larger circle is x, while the
sides measure 5, 53 , and 10. Since the radius of the smaller circle is 1x. The ratio of
2
hypotenuse of the triangle is a diameter of the areas is
circle, and the length of the hypotenuse is twice x2 x2
2
the length of the shorter leg, the length of the x
1 1
2 x
2
diameter is 10. So the radius of the circle is 5. 2
1
shaded area ¬area of circle area of triangle
1
2
¬r2 1
2 bh
2
1 or 2:1
¬(5)2 1
2 (5)(53
)
24. The scale factor is 9
3
3 1 , so the ratio of areas
¬56.9 units2
between a large cake and a mini-cake is 3 1 1.
9
2
19. Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle. So when nine mini-cakes are compared to one
Apothem: The central angle of the regular large cake, the total area is equal. Nine mini-
360°
hexagon is 6 60°. The apothem bisects the cakes are the same size as one 9-inch cake, but
central angle so it forms a 30° angle with the nine mini-cakes cost 9 $4 or $36 while the 9-inch
hypotenuse of the triangle. So the apothem is the cake is only $15. The 9-inch cake gives more cake
3 21(4.1) 2.05
longer leg and its measure is 3. for the money.
Hexagon perimeter: 6(4.1) 24.6 25. 16-inch pizza 8-inch pizza
Radius: The radius of the inscribed circle is the r8 r4
apothem of the regular hexagon. A 82 A 42
shaded area ¬area of hexagon area of circle A 64 in.2 A 16 in.2
For 2 pizzas,
¬1
2 Pa r
2
A 2(16)
¬1
2 (24.6)(2.053
) (2.053
)2 32 in.2
¬4.1 units2 One 16-inch pizza; the area of the 16-inch pizza is
greater than the area of two 8-inch pizzas, so you
20. circle radius 1
2 (20) 10 in.
get more pizza for the same price.
Use a 30°-60° -90° triangle. 26.
Apothem: The central angle of the regular 4 y
360°
hexagon is 6 60°. The apothem bisects the T ( 0, 0) x
central angle so it forms a 30° angle with the 8 4 4 8
hypotenuse of the triangle, the radius of the 4
circumscribed circle. So the apothem is the longer
leg and has measure 3 1
2 (10) 5
3 in. U ( 7, 7) 8 W ( 7, 7)
Hexagon perimeter: 6(10) 60 in.
12
shaded area ¬area of circle area of hexagon
V ( 0, 14)
¬r2 1
2 Pa 16
¬(10)2 1 2 (60)(5
3) Explore: Looking at the graph, it appears that
¬54.4 in2 quadrilateral TUVW is a square.
21. From the solution to Exercise 14, the outer Plan: Show that TUVW is a parallelogram by
shaded area is 100 200. The inner circle’s showing that TU
W V and T U
W
V. A regular
1
radius is (10) 5 2 and so its area is parallelogram is a square. Find the area by using
2 the formula A s2.
(5 2) 50.
2
7 0 7
shaded area 100 200 50 U
Solve: slope of T
7 0 7 or 1
271.2 units2
slope of V 7
W (14)
7
70 7 or 1
22. Use 30°-60°-90° triangles. Half the base of the TU
[0 (7)]2
[0
(7)]2
72 72
equilateral triangle is 4 3, so the base is 8
3 7
2
and the height is 3(4 3) or 12. Also, the radius
of the inner circle is 4. VW
(0 7
)2 [
14 (
7)]2
72 72 7
2
shaded area ¬area of outer circle¬ area of triangle TU VW
¬ area of inner circle TUVW is a parallelogram.
¬r21 1
2 bh r2
2
UV (7 0)2
[7 (14)]2
72 72
¬(8)2 1
2 (83
)(12) (4)2
7 2
¬168.2 units2 The area of the square is s2 (UV)2 7
2
2
98 units .
2
Chapter 11 396
27. y The apothem of the regular octagon is the
8 segment connecting the center (0, 0) with the
H ( 0, 4
3 )
midpoint of a side.
4
Use the Midpoint Formula to find the midpoint of
G ( 12, 0) x C
B .
1612 8 4 x x y y 0 4
M
1
2
2 ,
1
2 M 2 , 2 M 2 , 2
2
3 3 3 7
4
8
J ( 0, 4
3 ) apothem length
2
2
258
3 0 7 0
2 2
A ¬1
2 Pa
58
)
¬1
2 (810 2
J
H is vertical.
HJ 43
43 ¬4145
or about 48.2 units2
8
3 or 83 30. C 2r
h 0 (12) rC
2
12 or 12
34
r2 17
A ¬1
2 bh
A ¬r2
2 83
¬1 (12)
¬(17)2
¬483
or about 83.1 units2 ¬289 or about 907.9 units2
28. y 31. C ¬2r
8 C
QX r ¬
2
P R
4
17
r ¬ 17
2 2
N x
A ¬r2
8 4 4 J 8 2
¬2
17
4
M K 28
9
8 L ¬4 or about 227.0 units
2
32. C ¬2r
The figure is a regular octagon centered at the C
r ¬
2
origin.
54
.8 27
.4
side length QR (4 0)
2 (4 5)2 r ¬2
17, so perimeter 8 17 A ¬r2
2
The apothem of the regular octagon is the ¬
27
.4
segment connecting the center (0, 0) with the
750
.76
midpoint of a side. ¬ or about 239.0 units2
R
Use the Midpoint Formula to find the midpoint of Q. 33. C ¬2r
x x y y 04 54
M
1
2 ,
1
2 M2, 2 r ¬C
2 2 2
M2, 9
2
91
r ¬ .4 45
2
.7
(2
0)
2 0
2
9 97
2 A ¬r2
apothem length 2 2
¬
45
.7
A ¬1
2 Pa 2088.49
¬ or about 664.8 units
2
97
¬1
2 (817
) 2 34. A ¬r2
¬21649
or about 81.2 units2 7850 ¬r2
29. y B
X
r ¬
7850
5
3
14
A C C ¬2r
5314
¬2
x
¬10 314 or about 314.1 ft
H D
At 2 tiles per foot, and rounding up, that makes
629 tiles.
G E 35. The square tiles will touch along the inner edge of
F the border, but there will be gaps along the outer
The figure is a regular octagon centered at the edge. The tiles used to fill the gaps should be
origin. triangles. There will be 629 gaps between the
side length BC (3 0
)2 (3
4)2
10, 629 square tiles, so 629 triangular tiles will be
so perimeter 8 10 needed.
397 Chapter 11
36. A ¬r2 45. The area of the garden equals that of a square of
¬(1.3)2 side length 175 ft combined with a circle of radius
¬1.69 or about 5.3 cm2 1(175) or 87.5 ft.
2
37. Use radius 11 in. area s2 r2
A r2 (175)2 (87.5)2
(11)2 7656.25 30,625
121 or about 380.1 in2 54,677.8 ft2
The perimeter is the circle’s circumference plus
38. Sample answer: Multiply the total area by 40%.
two side lengths from the square.
39. Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle. For the equilateral perimeter 2r 2s
triangle, the height is opposite the 60° angle so it 2(87.5) 2(175)
is the longer leg of the 30°-60°-90° triangle with 175 350
hypotenuse measure of 3. So, height 3 1
2 (3) 899.8 ft
3
23. 46. d1 d2 d3 20 40 60
For the circle, radius 1
2 (7) 3.5.
120 or about 377.0 ft
shaded area ¬area of circle area of triangle 47. The path is defined by an outer circle of radius
¬r2 1
2 bh 1(60) 5 25 and an inner circle of radius
2
1(40) 20.
2 (3) 2 3
¬(3.5)2 1 3 2
path area area of outer circle area of inner circle
¬12.25 94 3
r12 r22
¬34.6 units2 (25)2 (20)2
225 or about 706.9 ft2
40. circle diameter 122 92 15, and radius
1(15) 7.5.
48. No; the areas of the floors will increase by the
2 squares of 1, 3, 5, and 7, or 1, 9, 25, and 49. The
shaded area area of circle area of rectangle ratio of the areas is the square of the scale factor.
r2 w 4.
2 2
(7.5)2 (9)(12) 6.3 3 or 2 : 3
49.
56.25 108 50. Call the perimeter of the figure on the left P1 and
68.7 units2 the figure on the right P2.
41. r1 large radius 10, r2 small radius 5 P1 5(4.2) or 21 cm
shaded area ¬area of large circle P2 5(6.3) or 31.5 cm
¬¬area of small circles
21 2
¬r21 2r22 51. .5 3
31
¬(10)2 2(5)2 The ratio is the same.
¬50 or about 157.1 units2 52. Using the perimeter information from Exercise 50,
42. circle radii 1.5
A1 ¬1
2 Pa
shaded area area of square area of circles
s2 4r2 ¬1
2 (21)(2.88)
(6)2 4(1.5)2 ¬30.24 cm2
36 9
A2 ¬1
2 Pa
7.7 units2
43. Flip the right half top-for- ¬1
2 (31.5)(4.32)
bottom, to make it a mirror ¬68.04 cm2
2
68.04 9 3
image of the left half. Then 30.
53. 24 4 2
r1
there are three circles, with
radii of r1 15, r2 10, and r3 5. r2 The ratio of the areas is the square of the scale
shaded area r3 factor.
2
¬area of large circle
68.04 9 3
30.
24 4 2
54.
area of medium circle area of small circle
21 2
¬r21 r22 r23 .5 3
31
¬(15)2 (10)2 (5)2 The ratio of the areas is the square of the ratio of
¬150 or about 471.2 units2 the perimeters.
44. The large semicircle has radius r1 7.5, the small 55. The apothem of the larger hexagon equals the
semicircles have radii r2 2.5. radius of the circle, r 10. The apothem of the
shaded area ¬area of large semicircle smaller hexagon is 3
1r r.
3
2 2
¬ area of small semicircles
2 r2
¬2r12 3 1
1
2
¬1
2 1
2 [(7.5) ] 3 2 [(2.5) ]
2
Chapter 11 398
2r 3
ABCD is a parallelogram, since opposite sides
scale factor 3
r 2 have the same slope. Slopes of consecutive sides
area ratio ¬(scale factor)2 are not negative reciprocals of each other, so the
10
3 2 parallelogram is neither a square nor a rectangle.
¬
2 A ¬bh
3 ¬(7)(3)
¬4 or a ratio of 3 to 4
¬21 units2
(The value of r is irrelevant.)
63. y
56. Sample answer: You can find the areas of regular
polygons by finding the product of the perimeter
and the apothem and then multiplying by one
half. Answers should include the following. J ( 2, 1) F ( 4, 1)
• We need to know the length of each side and the x
length of the apothem.
• One method is to divide the area of the floor by
the area of each tile. Since the floor is
hexagonal and not rectangular, tiles of different
shapes will need to be ordered to cover the floor.
H ( 2, 5) G ( 4, 5)
57. B; for the circle, A r2 so that r
A
18
F
11
0
slope of J 4 (2) 6 or 0
32
. Square side length s 2
r 5 (5)
G 0
slope of H 4 (2) 6 or 0
2
(32
) 6 units. 1 (5)
J 6
58. B; since average sum x,
slope of H 2 (2) 0 is undefined
1 ( 5) 6
x sum average 90 15 6. slope of F
G 4 4 0 is undefined
FGHJ is a square, since the sides are all equal
and are all horizontal or vertical.
Page 616 Maintain Your Skills A ¬s2
59. A ¬1
2 d1d2 ¬(6)2
1 ¬36 units2
¬2(20)(26)
64. L ( 2, 5)
¬260 cm2 y M ( 1, 5)
399 Chapter 11
65. y ¬1
1 2
2 b1h b2h 2 r
¬1 1
2 (2)(4) 2 4 2 (2)
2
¬4 8 2
x ¬18.3 units2
y
R ( 1, 2) S ( 5, 2)
P ( 5, 7) h r
Q ( 1, 7) x
O b1 b2
7 (7)
P
0
slope of Q 5 (1) 6 or 0
2 (2)
S
0
slope of R 5 (1) 6 or 0 2. An irregular polygon is a polygon in which all
2 (7) sides are not congruent. If a shape can be
R 5
slope of Q 1 (1) 0 is undefined separated into semicircles or smaller circular
2 (7)
S
slope of P 5 is undefined regions, it is an irregular figure.
55 0
3. area ¬area of rectangle area of triangle
PQRS is a rectangle, since the sides are not all
equal but are all horizontal or vertical. ¬w 1
2 bh
A w ¬(9.2)(3.6) 1 2 (9.2)(8 3.6)
(6)(5) ¬53.36 or about 53.4 units2
30 units2 4. area ¬area of rectangle area of semicircle
66. HE ¬1 ¬w 1 2 r
2
2 (CD GF)
¬(32)(16) 1 2 (8)
2
38 ¬1
2 (46 GF)
¬512 32 or about 612.5 units2
76 ¬46 GF
5. area of MNPQ ¬area of MNQ area of QNP
30 ¬GF
¬1 1
2 bh1 2 bh2
67. WX ¬1
2 (CD HE)
¬1 1
2 (6)(5) 2 (6)(3)
¬1
2 (46 38)
¬24 units2
¬42
6. area ¬area of rectangle¬ combined area of two
68. Use GF 30 from Exercise 66. semicircles
YZ ¬1
2 (HE GF)
¬w r2
¬1 ¬(10)(4) (2)2
2 (38 30)
¬34 ¬40 4 or about 52.6 units2
69. h is opposite the 30° angle of a 30°-60°-90° 7. The height of the triangular portion is given by
triangle, so h 1
2 (12) 6.
(24)
2
143.3
2
triangle, so h 3 15 15
3. area ¬area of rectangle area of triangle
71. h is one leg of a 45°-45°-90° triangle, so ¬w 1
2 bh
h 1 8 4 2.
2 ¬(41.6)(24) 1
6 )
72. h is one leg of a 45°-45°-90° triangle, so 2 (41.6)(143.3
h 1 21 2 .
21 2
¬1247.4 in2
2
Chapter 11 400
9. area area of rectangle area of semicircle 19. y
¬w 1
2 r
2
P ( 5, 3)
¬(8)(12) 1
2 (4)
2 N ( 0, 3)
¬96 8 or about 70.9 units2
10. area area of rectangle area of triangle
x
¬w1 1
2 bh M ( 4, 0) Q ( 5, 0)
¬(12)(25) 1
2 (10)(8)
¬340 units2
11. area area of rectangle area of triangle
¬w1 1
area of trapezoid ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
2 bh
¬(62)(54) 1
¬1
2 (3)(5 9)
2 (62)(27)
¬4185 units2 ¬21 units2
12. area 2
area of one trapezoid 20. y
¬2 1
2 h(b1 b2)
V ( 3, 4)
U ( 2, 2) h2
¬h(b1 b2)
( 3, 2)
¬10(8 23) b2 h1
¬310 units2 x
13. area ¬area of rectangle
combined area of two semicircles
T ( 4, 2) b1 W ( 3, 2)
¬w r2
¬(22)(14) (7)2
¬308 49 or about 154.1 units2
14. The semicircle has radius 18 in. The perimeter is area ¬area of triangle
48 36 48 18 132 18 or area of trapezoid
about 188.5 in. ¬1 1
2 b2h2 2 h1(b1 b2)
15. area ¬area of rectangle area of semicircle
¬1 1
2 (5)(2) 2 (4)(7 5)
¬w 1
2 r
2
¬29 units2
¬(36)(48) 1
2 (18)
2
21. y
¬1728 162 or about 2236.9 in2 I ( 2, 4)
16. area ¬area of square
combined area of two triangles h2
¬s2 2 1
2 bh H ( 3, 1) b4 b2 x
¬s2 bh
¬(4)2 (4)(2) b1
¬24 units2 G ( 3, 1) h1 h3 b3 J ( 5, 1)
17. area ¬area of triangle area of semicircle K ( 1, 3)
¬1 1 2
2 bh 2 r
¬1
1
2 (6)(3) 2 (3)
2
area ¬area of trapezoid area of upper triangle
¬9 4.5 or about 23.1 units2 area of lower triangle
¬1 1 1
2 h1(b1 b2) 2 b3h2 2 b4h3
18. area ¬area of rectangle area of semicircle
area of semicircle ¬1 1 1
2 (5)(2 5) 2 (3)(5) 2 (8)(2)
¬area of rectangle
¬33 units2
¬w
¬(5)(4)
¬20 units2
401 Chapter 11
22. y 34. Hexagon side length 16, and perimeter 6 16
12 96. Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle to find the
P ( 8, 7) h1 apothem ¬x 3 where x 1
2 (16) 8.
h2 Q ( 3, 7)
8
area ¬area of circle area of hexagon
b2 h3 b1
S ( 1, 3) 4 b3 ¬r2 1
2 Pa
T ( 11, 1) x
¬(16)2 1
)
2 (96)(83
12 8 4 4 ¬256 3843
or about 139.1 units2
4 R ( 3, 2)
35. Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle. Base 1
3 (57) 19 ft.
where x 12(19) 9.5 ft.
Height x3
area ¬area of left trapezoid area of right A ¬1
2 bh
trapezoid area of triangle
¬1
)
2 (19)(9.53
¬1 1 1
2 h1(b1 b2) 2 h2(b1 b3) 2 b2h3
¬90.253 or about 156.3 ft2
¬1 1 1
2 (10)(4 6) 2 (4)(4 9) 2 (6)(3)
36. The area of the rhombus is divided into four
¬67 units2 congruent right triangles with hypotenuse
23. Sample answer: (23 squares)(2500 mi2 per square)
57,500 mi2 10
24. See students’ work.
25. Add the areas of the rectangles. 6
6 22 6 20 6 16 6 11 6 8 462
26. The actual area of the irregular region should be
smaller than the estimate. The rectangles drawn
are larger than the region. length 10 yd and one side length 6 yd. The other
27. Sample answer: Reduce the width of each side length is 10
2 62 8. So the two
rectangle. diagonals measure 12 yd and 2(8) 16 yd.
3 x.
28. Let BC x. Then the altitude of the triangle is 2 A ¬1
2 d1d2
ABC ¬1
2 bh 3 3
1(x)
2
3
2 x ¬1
2 (12)(16)
area of
area of BCDE ¬4 or 4 : 1
s2 x2
¬96 yd2
29. Sample answer: Windsurfers use the area of the
sail to catch the wind and stay afloat on the 37. Let the shorter base b1 x. Then b2 2x 5
water. Answers should include the following. and P 90 x (2x 5) 2(x 3) 5x 11
5x 11 ¬90
• To find the area of the sail, separate it into
5x ¬101
shapes. Then find the area of each shape. The
sum of areas is the area of the sail. x ¬20.2
• Sample answer: Surfboards and sailboards are A ¬1
2 h (b1 b2)
also irregular figures. ¬1
2 15 (x 2x 5)
30. B; let LM x. Then, starting at the bottom and
moving clockwise, ¬1
2 15 (20.2 40.4 5) 7.5(55.6)
P 7x 4x 4x 2x 2x x x x 22x. ¬417 m2
So 22x 66 and x LM 3. 38. The image of the point lies in quadrant IV, 6 units
area ¬area of A area of B area of C
away from the origin, at (x, y) 1 6, 6
1
¬s12 s22 s32 2 2
¬(12)2 (6)2 (3)2 (32, 32).
¬189 units2 39. 0.625
31. C; 16 92 4 81 85 .0
85 00
4.8
Page 621 Maintain Your Skills 20
32. area ¬area of square area of circle 16
¬s2 r2 40
¬(14)2 (7)2 40
¬196 49 or about 42.1 units2 0
33. area ¬area of circle area of triangle So 5
0.63.
8
¬r2 1
2 bh
2
¬ 12 1
1
2 2 (12)(12)
¬72 72 or about 154.2 units2
Chapter 11 402
40. 0.8125 3. Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle. Half the base of the
3
161.0
00
0
triangle is 42, so the apothem, which is also the
12.8
radius of the circle is 42
143
.
20 3
Triangle perimeter 3(84) 252
16
shaded area ¬area of triangle area of circle
40
32 ¬1
2 Pa r
2
2
2 (252)143
1 143
80
80
¬17643 588
0 or about 1208.1 units2
13
0.81.
So
16 4. pentagon central angle 360° 5 or 72°, and
41. 0.191... 1
2(72°) 36°.
.0
479 00
4.7 half side length 21 tan 36°, and
side length 42 tan 36°, so
4.30
4.23 perimeter 5(42 tan 36°) 210 tan 36°
152.574.
70
47 shaded area ¬area of pentagon area of circle
23 ¬1
2 Pa r
2
9
47 0.19.
So ¬1
2 (152.574)(21) (21)
2
403 Chapter 11
5. short side of one triangle 10, N 2
15. A ¬
360 r
so area of square 4 1
1
2 bh 4 2 (10)(10) or 200 72 80
¬ 360
(7.52)
area of circle r2 102 100
¬23.75 or about 74.6 units2
blue area ¬area of circle area of square yellow area
¬100 200 or about 114.2 units2 P(yellow) ¬
area of circle
23.75
P(blue) ¬ blue area ¬
area ofcircle (7.5 )
2
100 200
¬ ¬0.42
100
2
16. Using A r2, we find that the smallest circle
¬1 or about 0.36 encloses yd2, the medium circle 4 yd2, and the
6. 60 out of 100 squares are shaded. large circle 9 yd2.
P(shaded) 60 3 shaded area 9 4 6 yd2
100 5 or 0.6 shaded area
P(shaded) ¬
overall area
Pages 625–627 Practice and Apply 6
¬ 2
7. 60 out of 100 squares are shaded. 9 or 3
N 2
P(shaded) 60 17. area of sector ¬
360 r
100 0.60
6
0
8. 50 out of 100 squares are shaded. ¬
360 (6 )
2
50
P(shaded) 100 0.50 ¬6
9. 54 out of 100 squares are shaded. Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle, with the length of the
P(shaded) 54 short leg 1
2 (6) 3 so that apothem 33
.
100 0.54 1
10. A ¬N 2
r area of triangle ¬2bh
360
2 (6)33
¬1
72
¬ 0 (7.5 )
36
2
¬93
¬11.25 or about 35.3 units2 area of segment area of sector
area ofsector area of triangle
P(blue) ¬
area of circle
5
11.2 6 9 3 or about 3.3 units2
¬
(7.52) area of segment
P(shaded) ¬area of
circle
¬0.20
6 93
11. A ¬
N ¬
360 r
2 (6 )
2
60 1
3
¬ 360
60
7.52 ¬6 4 or about 0.03
N 2
18.75 or about 58.9 units2 18. area of sector ¬360 r A
5 120
P(pink) ¬18.7 ¬360 (8 )
2
(7.52)
64 16
1 ¬ 3
B
3 or about 0.33
12. A ¬ N r2 Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle,
360
45 4
5 45 with apothem 1
2 (8) 4.
C
¬ 360
(7.52)
66.3 units2 area of ABC ¬1
2 bh
1
P(purple) ¬
purple area
¬2(2 43
)(4)
area of circle
6 6.3
¬16 3
¬
(7.5 )
2 area of segment ¬area of sector
¬0.375 ¬ area of triangle
N 2 64
3 16
13. A ¬
360 r ¬ 3 or
40 ¬about 39.3 units2
¬ 0 (7.5 )
36
2
area of segment
¬6.25 or about 19.6 units2 P(shaded)
area of
circle
red area 64
163
P(red) ¬
area o
f circle 3
6.25 (8 )
2
¬
(7
.52) ¬1 3
3 4 or about 0.20
¬1
9 or about 0.11 N 2
19. area of sector
360 r
N 2
14. A ¬
360 r 72
360 (7.5 )
2
55 58 60
36 (7.52)
0 11.25
¬84.9 units2 The five central angles of the pentagon each
green area 36
0°
P(green) ¬
area ofcircle
measure 5 or 72°. Let s pentagon side length
84.9 and a apothem.
¬
(7.52)
¬0.48
Chapter 11 404
72° s
7.5 sin2 2
In Exercises 26–28, the overall area is
s 15 sin 36° (72) 49 units2. Also,
72° red area ¬ 12 ( 42 32) ( 72 62)
7.5 cos 2 a
a 7.5 cos 36° ¬21 units2
area of triangle ¬1
2 bh white area ¬1
2 (overall area red area)
1
¬2sa 1
¬2(49 21)
¬1
2 (15 sin 36°)(7.5 cos 36°) ¬14 units2
¬26.7 black area ¬white area
area of segment ¬area of sector ¬14 units2
¬ ¬ area of triangle black area
26. P(black) ¬
overall
¬11.25 26.7 area
¬8.6 14
¬
49
shaded area ¬3(area of segment) 2
¬7 or about 0.29
¬25.8
whitearea
P(shaded) ¬shaded area 27. P(white) ¬
area of circle overall area
14
¬25.8 ¬49
(7.52)
2
¬0.15 ¬7 or about 0.29
red area
In Exercises 20–23, 28. P(red) ¬
overall area
area of region 21
probability ¬
area of ¬
circle 49
total angle in region 3
¬
360° . ¬7 or about 0.43
28.
20. P(red) 8° 29. The chances of landing on a black or white sector
360° ¬0.08 are the same, so they should have the same point
147.6° 97.2°
21. P(blue or green) ¬
360° 0.68 value.
22. P(not red or blue) ¬1 P(red or blue) 30. Of the three colors, there is the highest
28.8° 147.6° probability of landing on red, so red should have a
¬1 360° lower point value than white or black.
¬0.51 31a. No; each colored sector has a different central
23. P(not orange or green) 1 P(orange or green) angle.
18°
97.2° 31b. No; there is not an equal chance of landing on
¬1 360°
each color.
¬0.68
32. Sample answer: Geometric probability can help
24. court area w
you determine the chance of a dart landing on the
¬(39)(39)
bullseye or high scoring sector. Answers should
¬1521 ft2
include the following.
39 27
out-of-bound lane width ¬ 2 ¬6 ft • Find the area of the circles containing the red
out-of-bounds area ¬w w sector. Divide the difference by the area of the
¬6 39 6 39 larger circle.
¬468 ft2 • Find the area of the center circle and divide by
out-of-bounds area the area of the largest circle on the board.
probability court area
33. C; total area ¬area of square area of semicircle
468
¬
1521 ¬s2 1
2 r
2
4
¬
13 or about 0.31 ¬52 1
2 (2.5 )
2
27
25. service box width ¬ 2 13.5 ft
¬34.8
service box area ¬1w1 shaded area ¬area of square area of semicircle
¬(13.5)(21) ¬52 1
2 (2.5 )
2
¬283.5 ft2
¬15.2
court area ¬2w2 shaded area
P(shaded)
¬(39)(39) total area
15.2
¬1521 ft2 ¬
34.8
service box area
probability ¬0.44
court area
283
.5 34. C; y 16 4 4, so 12 y 12 4 3.
¬
1521
¬0.19
405 Chapter 11
35. area area of rectangle area of left triangle 45. Use the Law of Cosines, with a g, b 32,
¬ area of upper triangle c 29, and A ¬41.
¬w 1 1 a2 ¬b2 c2 2bc cos A
2 b1h1 2 b2h2
g2 ¬322 292 2(32)(29) cos 41°
¬(28)(20) 1 1
2 (16)(35) 2 (28)(15)
g2 ¬1865 1856 cos 41°
¬1050 units2 g ¬1865
cos
1856 ° 41
36. area area of rectangle area of semicircle g ¬21.5
w 1
2 r
2
(12)(9) 1
2 (4)
2
¬(21)2 5. b
¬441 cm2 6. d
39. Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle.
1 1 7. P 2(23) 2(16) 78 ft
Half side length ¬(8), side length ¬(16), Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle to find the height, with
3
3
1 x as the length of the shorter leg.
perimeter ¬6 (16) 323
in.
3 16 ¬2x
1
A ¬2Pa 8 ¬x
1
¬2(323
)(8) height ¬x3 ¬83 ft
A ¬bh
¬1283 or about 221.7 in2
¬(23)(83 )
40. mAFB mBFC ¬180 ¬1843 or about 318.7 ft2
mAFB 72 ¬180
8. P ¬2(36) 2(22) ¬116 mm
mAFB ¬108
Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle to find the height, with
41. mCFD mAFD ¬180 x as the length of the shorter leg.
(4a 1) (2a 5) ¬180 22 ¬22x
6a 6 ¬180 11 ¬x ¬height
6a ¬186 A ¬bh
a ¬31 ¬(36)(11)
mCFD ¬4a 1 ¬396 mm2
¬4(31) 1 9. y
¬123
42. mCFD mAFD ¬180
(4a 1) (2a 5) ¬180
6a 6 ¬180 A ( 6, 1) B ( 1, 1)
6a ¬186
a ¬31 x
mAFD ¬2a 5
¬2(31) 5
¬57
43. From Exercises 40 and 42, mAFB ¬108 and
mAFD ¬57.
D ( 6, 6) C ( 1, 6)
mDFB ¬mAFB mAFD
¬108 57
ABCD is a square.
¬165
A ¬s2
44. Use the Law of Cosines, with a ¬p, b 6.8, ¬72
c 11.1, and A ¬57. ¬49 units2
a2 ¬b2 c2 2bc cos A
p2 ¬6.82 11.12 2(6.8)(11.1)cos 57°
p2 ¬169.45 150.96 cos 57°
p ¬169.4
5 0.96
15os c 57°
p ¬9.3
Chapter 11 406
3 1 4
10. y S
slope of R ¬ (1) or 1
5 4
3 (1)
2
S
slope of P ¬ (7) 2 or 1
5
G ( 2, 2) H ( 8, 2) 13 2
R
slope of Q ¬ (3) 2 or 1
1
x PQRS is a rectangle, since opposite sides have the
same slope and the slopes of consecutive sides are
negative reciprocals of each other.
E ( 7, 2) R
Length of S ¬[1
(5)]2
[1)]
(32
F ( 1, 2)
¬42
R
Length of Q ¬[1
(3)]2
[1 3]2 22
2 (2) PQRS is not a square since not all sides have the
G ¬ 4
slope of F 1 1 or 4
2 same length.
2 (2)
H
¬ 4 A ¬w
slope of E 7 1 or 4
8
2 (2) ¬(42)(22)
E
slope of F ¬7
1 0
6 or 0 ¬16 units2
2 2 0
H
slope of G ¬
8 2 6 or 0 13. A ¬1
2 bh
EFGH is a parallelogram, since opposite sides 336 ¬1
2 b(24)
have the same slope. Slopes of consecutive sides 336 ¬12b
are not negative reciprocals of each other, so the 28 ¬b
parallelogram is neither a square nor a rectangle. base ¬CE 28 in.
A ¬bh
14. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
¬6 4
¬24 units2 75 ¬1
2 h(17 13)
11. 75 ¬15h
L(5, 5) y
5 ¬h
The height is 5 m.
15.
M (1, 1) x 20
K ( 5, 0)
36
10
J ( 1, 4)
side length 100 5 20, and 1
2 (20) 10
0 (4)
K
¬ 4 central angle 360 5 72°, and 1
slope of J 5 (1) 4 or 1 10 2 (72°) 36°
15 4 apothem 36° 13.764
tan
M
slope of L ¬ (5) 4 or 1
1 A ¬1
2 Pa
1 (4)
5
M
slope of J ¬ (1) 0 undefined
1 ¬1
2 (100)(13.764)
5 0 5
L
slope of K ¬
5 (5) 0 undefined ¬688.2 in2
JKLM is a parallelogram, since opposite sides 16.
have the same slope. Slopes of consecutive sides
are not negative reciprocals of each other, so the
12
parallelogram is neither a square nor a rectangle. 18
A ¬bh
¬4 5
¬20 units2
6
12. y
half side length 12 (12) 6 mm
Q (3, 3) perimeter 10 12 120 mm
central angle 360° 10 36°, and 1
2 (36°) 18°
6
R (1, 1) apothem tan 18° 18.466
x
A ¬1
2 Pa
¬1
2 (120)(18.466)
P ( 7, 1)
¬1108.0 mm2
S ( 5, 3)
3 (1)
4
Q
slope of P ¬ (7) 4 or 1
3
407 Chapter 11
17. area ¬area of rectangle 5. T(5, 5)
y
¬ combined area of two semicircles
¬w r2
¬(8)(3) (1.5)2 S (9, 3)
¬24 2.25 or about 31.1 units2 U (3, 1)
18. For the height of the trapezoid, use a 30°-60°-90° x
triangle: x 4, so h 43 .
area ¬area of trapezoid area of semicircle R (7, 1)
¬1 1 2
2 h(b1 b2) 2 r
¬1
)(8 10) 1
2 (43 2 (4)
2
Chapter 11 408
N 2
7. y 13. A ¬
360 r
40 60
8 ¬ 360 (6 )
2
¬10
4 S ( 9, 3) red area
P(red) ¬
area of circle
8 4 4 T ( 12, 1)
10
¬
x (6 )
2
5
¬
18 or about 0.28
R ( 3, 6)
N 2
U ( 6, 8) 14. A
360 r
8
8
6
¬
360 (6 )
2
409 Chapter 11
Chapter 11 Standardized Test Practice 11. By the Exterior Angle Theorem,
mR mS ¬mSTP
mR 90 ¬150
Pages 632–633 mR ¬60
2x 4
1. B; 3 6 ¬18
12. Since pairs of vertical angles at C are congruent,
31 and A and E are congruent, by AA similarity
3 x 3 ¬18
2
ABC EDC.
x 2 ¬18 AB AC
ED ¬ EC
x ¬16
x ¬16 ¬1
A B 1 2
250 200
2. B; the angle of the path from the school to the
AB ¬250
200
11
2
baseball field is a 90° angle, and the angle of
Sam’s path from the library to the baseball field ¬140
is greater than that. So the angle of Sam’s path is 13. The image of J(6,3) for the translation
obtuse. (x, y) → (x, y 5) is J
(6, 3 5) or J
(6, 2).
3. A; let p, q, and r represent parts of the given 14. Use trigonometry.
statements. 1560
a. tan 38° ¬x
p: you exercise
156 0
q: you maintain better health x ¬
tan 38°
r: you will live longer
¬1997 ft
Given: p → q and q → r. Use the Law of Syllogism
1560
to conclude p → r. That is, if you exercise, you will b. tan 35° ¬ y
live longer. 1560
y ¬
tan
35°
4. C; mADE ¬180 mDEA mEAD
¬180 40 60 ¬2228 ft
¬80 c. Use the results from (a) and (b).
Since
DE is a transversal for
AD and
BE, and campground width ¬y x
corresponding angles ADE and BEC are ¬2228 1997
congruent, A D and BE are parallel. ¬231 ft
15. y
5. D; because the front of the tent is isosceles and
the entrance is an angle bisector, the two sides of B C
the front of the tent are congruent triangles, by
SAS. Then the two bases are of equal length,
namely 3 ft, and so the distance between the x
A
stakes is 3 3 or 6 ft.
D
6. D; the gazebo is a regular hexagon. The angle
measuring x is an exterior angle of the hexagon.
Each exterior angle of a regular hexagon
360
measures 6 or 60. So x 60.
7. A; this is Theorem 10.5.
a. Since BC is horizontal, D must lie on the
8. C; A 1 1
2 Pa 2 (6 9)(7.8) ¬210.6 cm
2
x-axis. And since the slope of A is 4
B
3 , the slope
9. The library coordinates are (4,3), and the fire C
of D 4
must be 3. So D must be located 4 units
station coordinates are (8, 3). The post office lies down and 3 units left of C(8,4), at D(5,0).
at the midpoint of the segment from (4, 3) to
b. AD 5, and height 4.
(8, 3). So the post office coordinates are given by
x x y y A ¬bh
4 3
M
1
2 1
, 2
¬
2 ,
8
2
3
¬(5)(4)
2 2
¬(2, 0) ¬20 units2
10. Put the equation in slope-intercept form.
3x 6y ¬12
6y ¬3x 12
y ¬1
2x 2
The slope of the graph of the equation is m ¬1
2.
The slope of the perpendicular line is the negative
reciprocal of 1
2 , or 2.
Chapter 11 410
Chapter 12 Surface Area
Page 635 Getting Started 2. In a square pyramid, the faces meet at a point. In
1. True; points A, C, and D lie in plane N , so ADC a square prism the faces are perpendicular to
lies in plane N . each base.
2. False; points A, B, and C do not lie in plane K , so 3. Sample answer:
ABC does not lie in plane K.
3. Cannot be determined; neither the given
information nor the figure allow a determination 4.
of whether or not the line containing A B is
parallel to plane K.
back view
4. False; the line containing A C
lies in plane N and
only lies in both plane N and plane K , so the corner view
line containing A C
does not lie in plane K. 5. The base is a hexagon, and six faces meet at a
5. The figure is a trapezoid with bases b1 19 ft point. So this solid is a hexagonal pyramid.
and b2 29 ft and height h 16 ft. The area is The base is ABCDEF. The faces are ABCDEF,
given by A 12 h(b1 b2).
AGF, FGE, EGD, DGC, CGB, and BGA.
A 1 The edges are A F, F
E
, E
D, D C
, C
B
, BA, A
G
, FG
,
2 (16)(19 29) 384
G
E, D
G , C
G, and B
G. The vertices are A, B, C, D,
The area of the figure is 384 ft2. E, F, and G.
6. The figure is a trapezoid with bases b1 12 mm 6. The bases are squares. So this is a square prism.
and b2 35 mm and height h 13 mm. The area The bases are KJIH and MNOL. The faces are
is given by A 1
2 h(b1 b2).
KJIH, MNOL, JNOI, JKMN, KHLM, and IHLO.
A 1 The edges are K H, K
J, J
I, IH
, J
N
, IO
, H
L, K
M
,
2 (13)(12 35) 305.5
N
M , M
L , N
O, and LO
. The vertices are H, K, J, I,
The area of the figure is 305.5 mm2.
L, M, N, and O.
7. The figure is a triangle with base b 1.9 m and
7. The bases are circles. So this is a cylinder. The
height h 1.9 m. The area is given by A 1
2 bh. bases are circles P and Q.
A 1
2 (1.9)(1.9) 1.805
8. To get round slices of cheese, slice the cheese
Rounded to the nearest tenth, the area of the parallel to the bases. To get rectangular slices,
figure is 1.8 m2. place the cheese on the slicer so the bases are
8. A ¬r2 perpendicular to the blade.
2
¬ d
2
¬1
4 d
2 Pages 640–642 Practice and Apply
9.
¬1
4 (19.0)
2
¬283.5 cm2
9. A r2
(1.5)2 back view
7.1 yd2
10. A ¬r2 corner view
2
¬ d
2
10.
¬1
4 d
2
back view
¬1
4 (10.4)
2
¬84.9 m2
corner view
11.
12-1 Three-Dimensional Figures back view
corner view
411 Chapter 12
13. 27. The resulting shape is a circle.
28. The resulting shape is a rectangle.
29. The resulting shape is a rectangle.
top view left view front view right view
30. The resulting shape is a square.
14. 31. intersecting three faces and parallel to base;
Cubes Tetrahedrons
right view left view
Prisms Pyramids
25. The resulting shape is a parabola.
26. The resulting shape is a triangle.
Chapter 12 412
43. Sample answer: Archaeologists use two- The figure is composed of two triangles, one
dimensional drawings to learn more about the rectangle, and one square. Find the area.
structure they are studying. Egyptologists can A ¬1 1
2 b1h1 2 b2h2 s w
2
compare two-dimensional drawings of the
pyramids and note similarities and any ¬1
1
2 (3)(2) 2 (2)(5) 3 (5)(3)
2
413 Chapter 12
Area: A ¬bh 3. 4.
¬(25)(103 )
¬250 3
¬433.0
The perimeter is 90 ft and the area is
approximately 433.0 ft2.
58. Base and Sides: Each pair of opposite sides of a
parallelogram has the same measure. Each base 5.
is 68 in. and each side is 42 in.
Perimeter: The perimeter of a polygon is the sum
of the measures of its sides. So, the perimeter of
the parallelogram is 2(68) 2(42) or 220 in. 4
Height: Use a 45-45-90 triangle to find the 7 6 7
height. Recall that if the measure of each leg is x,
then the length of the hypotenuse is x 2.
42 ¬x 2
42
¬x
2
212 ¬x Surface area 2(4 7) 2(4 6) 2(6 7)
So, the height of the parallelogram is 56 48 84
21 2 inches. 188
Area: A ¬bh The surface area of the rectangular prism is
¬(68)(212 ) 188 in2.
¬1428 2 6. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
¬2019.5 of the prism.
The perimeter is 220 in. and the area is 172 ¬82 h2
approximately 2019.5 in2. 289 ¬64 h2
59. A w 60. A ¬w 225 ¬h2
(20)(15) ¬(4)(13) 15 ¬h
300 ¬52
The area is 300 cm2. The area is 52 ft2.
61. A w
(60)(72)
4320
The area is 4320 in2.
62. A s2
1.72
2.9
9
The area is approximately 2.9 m2.
15 8 17
Chapter 12 414
7. 13. 14.
15.
10.
12.
415 Chapter 12
18. Surface area
1
2 2 6 8 5 8 5 6 5 10
48 40 30 50
168
The surface area of the triangular prism is
168 units2.
21. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
of the triangle.
2
52 ¬2 h2
4
Surface area ¬22 4 1
2 24
25 ¬4 h2
¬4 16 21 ¬h2
¬20
21 ¬h
The surface area of the square pyramid
is 20 units2.
19.
1
Surface area ¬2(5 7) 4 7 2 2 4 21
¬70 28 4 21
¬116.3
The surface area of the triangular prism is
approximately 116.3 units2.
Surface area 6(4.52) 22. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
121.5 unknown edge length.
The surface area of the cube is 121.5 units2. c2 ¬a2 b2
20. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the c2 ¬(8 6)2 62
hypotenuse of the right triangle. c2 ¬4 36
c2 ¬a2 b2 c2 ¬40
c2 ¬62 82 c ¬40
c2 ¬36 64 c ¬210
c2 ¬100 Find the area of the trapezoid.
1
c ¬10 A ¬2h(b1 b2)
1
¬2(6)(6 8)
¬42
Chapter 12 416
Surface area
2 13.5 5 6 2(3 5) 5 32
27 30 30 152
108.2
The surface area of the prism is approximately
108.2 units2.
24.
6.99 ft 6.99 ft
2.46 ft
9.89 ft
2.46 ft 2.46 ft
6.99 ft
6.99 ft
B
C D A B
A D
29. N 30. Q
S R
R
M R
Q
T U T
P
N
N
Q
417 Chapter 12
31. W X Z Figure C:
U
R
T
T V R
W
Y Z Surface area 2(2 4) 2(2 5) 2(4 5)
X Z 16 20 40
32. 76
The surface area of the rectangular prism is
76 units2.
36. Figure A:
Surface area 6(2 2)
24
The surface area of the cube is 24 units2.
Figure B:
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
33. of the triangles.
2
22 ¬h2 2
2
4 ¬h2 1
3 ¬h2
3 ¬h
1
Surface area ¬3(2 6) 2 2 2 3
34. ¬36 2 3
The surface area of the triangular prism is
(36 2 3) units2.
Figure C:
Surface area 2(4 8) 2(4 10) 2(8 10)
64 80 160
304
35. Figure A: The surface area of the rectangular prism is
304 units2.
37. The surface area quadruples when the
dimensions are doubled. For example, the surface
Surface area 6(1 1) area of the cube is 6(12) or 6 square units. When
6 the dimensions are doubled the surface area is
The surface area of the cube is 6 units2. 6(22) or 24 square units.
Figure B: 38. When dimensions are tripled, the surface area
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height will be nine times greater than the original
of the triangles. surface area. For example, the surface area of the
2
12 ¬h2 2
1 cube is 6(12) or 6 square units. The new surface
1 area is 6(32) or 54 square units.
1 ¬h2 4
39. No; 5 and 3 are opposite faces; the sum is 8.
3
4 ¬h2 40. Sample answer: Car manufacturers want their
3 cars to be as fuel efficient as possible. If the car is
2 ¬h designed so the front grill and windshield have a
smaller surface area, the car meets less resistance
from the wind. Answers should include the
following.
1
3 • A small compact car has less surface facing the
Surface area ¬3(1 3) 2 2 1 2 wind than a larger truck, so smaller sedans
3
¬9 2 tend to be more efficient than larger vehicles.
The surface area of the triangular prism is • Of the two-dimensional models studied in this
chapter, orthogonal drawings would be helpful
9 23 units2. to the designers.
41. C; only net C can be folded into a rectangular
prism.
Chapter 12 418
42. B; 16a3 54b3 2(8a3 27b3) 2. Sample answer: The bases are ACHG and BDFE.
2[(2a)3 (3b)3] The lateral faces are ABDC, GEFH, BEGA, and
2(2a 3b)(4a2 6ab 9b2) A
DFHC. The lateral edges are B, E
G
, F
H, and
C
D.
base D
F
Page 648 Maintain Your Skills lateral edges
43. The resulting shape is a rectangle. B
E lateral faces
44. The resulting shape is a triangle. base
C H
45. The resulting shape is a rectangle.
(20)(20) A
46. P(butterfly in the flower bed) ¬
(100)(200) G
¬0.02 3. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
47. mFLJ 180 because it is a semicircle. By the measure of the hypotenuse of the triangular base.
Inscribed Angle Theorem, c2 ¬a2 b2
c2 ¬82 152
mFHJ ¬1
2 mFLJ c2 ¬64 225
¬1
c2 ¬289
2 (180)
c ¬17
¬90
L Ph
48. mLK 60 because it is 1
6 the measure of a circle (17 15 8)(21)
(360). (40)(21)
49. mGHL 240 because it is 4
6 the measure of a 840
circle (360). T ¬L 2B
By the Inscribed Angle Theorem,
¬840 2 1
2 bh
mLFG ¬1
2 mGHL ¬840 (8)(15)
¬1
2 (240) ¬840 120
¬120 ¬960
50. A bh The lateral and surface areas are 840 units2 and
16 14 960 units2, respectively.
224 4. L(7 9 base) Ph
The area of the parallelogram is 224 ft2. (2 7 2 9)(6)
192
51. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
L(6 9 base) Ph
¬1
2 7(6 12)
(2 6 2 9)(7)
¬63 210
The area of the trapezoid is 63 cm2. L(6 7 base) Ph
(2 6 2 7)(9)
52. A ¬1
2 bh 234
¬1 T L 2B
2 6.5 4
234 2(6 7)
¬13
234 84
The area of the triangle is 13 yd2.
318
53. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
The lateral areas are 192 units2 (7 9 base),
210 units2 (6 9 base), and 234 units2
¬1
2 10(13 9)
(6 7 base). The surface area is 318 units2.
¬110 5. The perimeter of the ceiling (base) is 2(20)
The area of the trapezoid is 110 cm2. 2(15) 40 30 70 ft. Find the total surface
area to be painted.
TLB
Ph B
12-3 Surface Areas of Prisms (70)(12) (20)(15)
840 300
Page 651 Check for Understanding 1140
The surface area to be painted is 1140 ft2.
1. In a right prism the altitude is also a lateral edge.
In an oblique prism, the lateral edges are not
perpendicular to the base.
Pages 651–654 Practice and Apply
6. L(3 4 base) Ph
(2 3 2 4)(12)
168
419 Chapter 12
L(3 12 base) Ph 14. L ¬Ph
(2 3 2 12)(4) 156 ¬P(13)
120 512 ¬P
L(4 12 base) Ph The perimeter of the base must be 12 inches.
(2 4 2 12)(3) There are three rectangles with integer values for
96 the dimensions that have a perimeter of 12. The
The lateral areas are 168 units2 (3 4 base), dimensions of the base could be 5 1, 4 2, or
120 units2 (3 12 base), and 96 units2 3 3.
(4 12 base). 15. L ¬Ph
7. L Ph 96 ¬P(4)
(4 5 7)(8) 24 ¬P
128 The perimeter of the base must be 24 meters.
The lateral area is 128 units2. There are six rectangles with integer values for
8. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the the dimensions that have a perimeter of 24. The
measure of the third side of the triangular base. dimensions of the base could be 1 11, 2 10,
c2 ¬a2 b2 3 9, 4 8, 5 7, or 6 6.
c2 ¬72 82 16. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
c2 ¬49 64 measure of the third side of the triangular base.
c2 ¬113 c2 ¬a2 b2
c ¬113
172 ¬a2 82
L Ph 289 ¬a2 64
(7 8 113)(10) 225 ¬a2
256.3
15 ¬a
The lateral area is approximately 256.3 units2.
T ¬L 2B
9. L Ph ¬Ph 2B
(2 4 3 4 5)(9)
162 ¬(8 15 17)(4) 2 1
2 8 15
The lateral area is 162 units2. ¬280
10. L Ph The surface area of the prism is 280 units2.
(2 7 2 4 8 2)(9) 17. T L 2B
342 Ph 2B
The lateral area is 342 cm2. (3 3 3 3)(8) 2(3 3)
11. Find the lateral area of the hollowed-out prism, 114
including the inner faces. The surface area of the prism is 114 units2.
L (outer perimeter)h (inner perimeter)h 18. T L 2B
(4 4)(8) (4 1)(8) Ph 2B
160 (2 4 2 11)(7.5) 2(4 11)
The lateral area is 160 units2 (square base). 313
L 2(42 12) 2(4 8) 4(1 8) The surface area of the prism is 313 units2.
2(15) 2(32) 4(8)
19. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
30 64 32
measure of the third side of the triangular base.
126
c2 ¬a2 b2
The lateral area is 126 units2 (rectangular base).
152 ¬a2 92
12. The surface area of a cube is given by A 6s2, 225 ¬a2 81
where s is the length of a lateral edge. 144 ¬a2
864 6s2
12 ¬a
144 s2
T ¬L 2B
812 s
¬Ph 2B
The length of the lateral edge is 12 in.
13. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the ¬(9 12 15)(11.5) 2 1
2 9 12
measure of the hypotenuse of the triangular base. ¬522
c2 ¬a2 b2 The surface area of the prism is 522 units2.
c2 ¬52 122
c2 ¬169
c ¬13
So, P 5 12 13 30.
T ¬L 2B
T ¬Ph 2B
540 ¬30(h) 2 12 5 12
540 ¬30h 60
480 ¬30h
16 ¬h
The height is 16 cm.
Chapter 12 420
20. Use trigonometry, the Pythagorean Theorem, and 23. L Ph
the figure to find the measures of the missing (15 15 15 15)(10)
sides of the bases. 600
60
0
400 1.5 gallons needed for 1 coat
60
c So, 3 gallons are needed for 2 coats.
4
24. T L B
Ph B
9 h (15 15 15 15)(10) 152
825
For two coats, the surface area is 1650 ft2.
1650
400 4.125
Since only whole gallons may be purchased,
tan60 ¬h
4
5 gallons must be purchased to paint the walls
and ceiling.
4tan60 ¬h
5 $16 $80, so it will cost $80 to paint the
4 3 ¬h
walls and ceiling.
c2 ¬a2 b2
c2 ¬42 (43)2 25. Estimate the surface area of the Corn Palace
c2 ¬16 48 using a rectangular prism.
c2 ¬64 L Ph
c ¬8 (2 310 2 185)(45)
Find the surface area. 44,550
T ¬Ph 2B The area to be covered is estimated to be
44,550 ft2.
)(11) 2 1
¬(5 8 9 43 )(5 9)
2 (43 26. L ¬Ph
¬415.2 ¬(2 310 2 185)(45)
The surface area is approximately 415.2 units2. ¬44,550
21. Use trigonometry, the Pythagorean Theorem, and 44,5
50
15 ¬2970
the figure to find the measures of the missing
It takes 2970 bushels of grain to cover the Corn
sides of the bases.
Palace.
7
27. The actual amount needed will be higher because
the building is not a perfect rectangular prism.
28. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the missing
c measure.
h h c2 ¬a2 b2
c2 ¬22 (7 6)2
c2 ¬4 1
60 c ¬5
Find the area of the trapezoids.
4
A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
11
¬1
2 (2)(6 7)
tan 60 ¬h
4
¬13
4tan60 ¬h
Surface area 2(13) 62 6 5
43 ¬h
26 36 65
c2 ¬a2 b2
75.4
c2 ¬42 (43)2
The surface area of the glass is approximately
c ¬16 48
2
75.4 ft2.
c2 ¬64
c ¬8 29. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
Find the surface area. measures of the third sides of the triangular
T ¬Ph 2B bases.
Prism A:
¬(7 8 11 43)(10) 2 1
)(7 11)
2 (43 c2 ¬a2 b2
¬454.0 c2 ¬32 42
The surface area is approximately 454.0 units2. c2 ¬9 16
22. L Ph c2 ¬25
(15 15 15 15)(10) c ¬5
600
No, the walls are 600 ft2; 1.5 gallons will only be
enough for 1 coat.
421 Chapter 12
Prism B: So, the ratios of the surface areas of the prisms
c2 ¬a2 b2 are A : B 1 : 4, B : C 30 : 11, and
c2 ¬62 82 A : C 15 : 22.
c2 ¬36 64 33. A and B, because the heights of A and B are in
c2 ¬100 the same ratio as perimeters of bases.
c ¬10 34. Surface area of TV Ph 2B
Prism C: (2 20 2 30)(84)
c2 ¬a2 b2 2(20 30)
52 ¬a2 32 8400 1200
25 ¬a2 9 9600 cm2
16 ¬a2 Surface area of VCR Ph 2B
4 ¬a (100)(76) 2(600)
The base of Prism A the base of Prism C 7600 1200
because of the SSS Postulate. 8800 cm2
The sides of the bases of Prism B are proportional Surface area of CD Ph 2B
to the sides of the bases of Prisms A and C so (100)(60) 2(600)
base of A base of B and base of C base of B. 6000 1200
30. Using the side lengths calculated in Exercise 29, 7200 cm2
the perimeters of the bases are as follows. Surface area of video game system
Prism A: P 3 4 5 12 Ph 2B
Prism B: P 6 8 10 24 (100)(39) 2(600)
Prism C: P 3 4 5 12 3900 1200
So, the ratios of the perimeters of the bases are 5100 cm2
A : B 1 : 2, B : C 2 : 1, and A : C 1 : 1. Surface area of DVD Ph 2B
31. Prism A: (100)(35) 2(600)
B ¬1 3500 1200
2 bh
4700 cm2
¬1
2 (3)(4) 35. No, the surface area of the finished product will
¬6 be the sum of the lateral areas of each prism plus
Prism B: the area of the bases of the TV and DVD prisms.
B ¬1
2 bh It will also include the area of the overhang
¬1
2 (6)(8)
between each prism, but not the area of the
overlapping prisms.
¬24
Prism C: 36. Area of ends 10(20 30)
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the 6000
measure of the third side of the triangular base. Area of top (30)(84)
c2 ¬a2 b2 2520
52 ¬a2 32 Area of bottom (30)(35)
25 ¬a2 9 1050
16 ¬a2 Area of sides 2(20)(84 76 60 39 35)
4 ¬a 11,760
Area of overhangs 30[(84 76) (76 60)
B ¬1
2 bh (60 39) (39 35)]
¬1
2 (3)(4)
1470
¬6 Total surface area
So, the ratios of the areas of the bases of the prisms 6000 2520 1050 11,760 1470
are A : B 1 : 4, B : C 4 : 1, and A : C 1 : 1. 22,800
The total surface area of the finished model is
32. Using the values of the perimeters calculated in
22,800 cm2.
Exercise 30, the surface areas are as follows.
Prism A: 37. L ¬Ph 144
T ¬Ph 2B ¬3w
h ¬2w
¬(12)(6.5) 2 1
2 34
Find the perimeter in terms of h.
¬90 P ¬2 2w
Prism B: ¬2(3w) 2w
T ¬Ph 2B ¬8w
¬(24)(13) 2 1 ¬8h
2 68 2
¬360 ¬4h
Prism C:
T ¬Ph 2B
¬(12)(10) 2 1
2 34
¬132
Chapter 12 422
Find h.
144 ¬Ph
144 ¬(4h)h 8
144 ¬4h2 10 8
36 ¬h2 6
6 ¬h
So, P (4)(6) 24, w 6
2 3, and (3)(3) 9.
12 12
T Ph 2B
(24)(6) 2(3)(9)
6
144 54 10 8
198 8
The surface area is 198 cm2.
38. Sample answer: Brick masons use the
measurements of the structure and the T Ph 2B
measurements of the bricks to find the number of
bricks that will be needed. Answers should T (6 8 10)(12) 2 1
2 68
include the following. T 288 48
• The lateral area is important because the sides T 336
of the brick will show. Also, depending on the The surface area of the triangular prism is
project, only the lateral area of the structure 336 units2.
may be covered with brick. 45.
• It is important to overestimate the number of
bricks ordered in case some are damaged or the
calculations were inaccurate.
39. B; 121.5 6s2 where s is the length of each edge.
121.5
s2 ¬
6
s ¬
121.5
6
s ¬4.5 m
a
2 16 (a 4)(a 4) a
4
4a 16
40. D; 4 ,a
4
4(a 4)
41. L Ph
L (2 16 2 20)(18)
L 1296 cm2
T L 2B
T 1296 2(20)(15) T Ph 2B
T 1896 cm2 T (2 3 2 4)(6) 2(3)(4)
42. L Ph T 84 24
L (1 4 4.6)(3) T 108
L 28.8 cm2 The surface area of the rectangular prism is
T L 2B 108 units2.
T 28.8 2 1 46.
2 0.8 4.6
T 32.48 cm 2
back view
423 Chapter 12
53. To find this ratio, convert the height of the house
to inches from feet, then divide the height of the
drawing by the height of the house.
height of drawing in inches 5.5 5.5
height of house in inches 1
33 12 396 72
1
The scale factor of the drawing is
72 .
corner view
48. 54. Use a calculator.
A r2
(40)2
back view 5026.55 cm2
55. Use a calculator.
A ¬r2
2
¬d
2
2
¬2
50
¬(25)2
corner view
¬1963.50 in2
49. Since the radius of Q is 24, AQ QC 24.
56. Use a calculator. 57. Use a calculator.
QB BC ¬QC
A r2 A ¬r2
QB ¬QC BC
(3.5)2 ¬(82)2
QB ¬24 5
38.48 ft2 ¬21,124.07 mm2
QB ¬19
AB AQ QB
AB 24 19
AB 43
12-4 Surface Areas of Cylinders
50. Since the radius of Q is 24, AC 48.
Since the radius of R is 16, RD BR 16.
AD AC CR RD Page 657 Check for Understanding
AD 48 CR 16 1. Multiply the circumference of the base by the
AD 64 CR height and add the area of each base.
Find CR.
2. Sample answer:
BC CR ¬BR
CR ¬BR BC
CR ¬16 5
CR ¬11
So, AD 64 11 75.
51. Since the radius of Q is 24, QC 24.
Since the radius of R is 16, BR 16.
QB BC ¬QC 3. Jamie; since the cylinder has one base, the surface
QB ¬QC BC area will be the sum of the lateral area and one
QB ¬24 5 base.
QB ¬19 4. Use a calculator.
BC CR ¬BR T 2rh 2r2
CR ¬BR BC 2(4)(6) 2(4)2
CR ¬16 5
251.3
CR ¬11
The surface area is approximately 251.3 ft2.
QR QB BC CR
QR 19 5 11 5. Use a calculator.
QR 35 T ¬2rh 2r2
2
52. Let x be the distance climbed by the airplane as it ¬2d
2h 22
d
Chapter 12 424
6. Use the formula for surface area to write and 12. Use a calculator.
solve an equation for the radius. T 2rh 2r2
T ¬2rh 2r2 2(14)(14) 2(14)2
96 ¬2r(8) 2r2 2463.0
96 ¬16r 2r2 The surface area is approximately 2463.0 mm2.
48 ¬8r r2 13. Use a calculator.
0 ¬r2 8r 48 T 2rh 2r2
0 ¬(r 12)(r 4) 2(4)(6) 2(4)2
r ¬4 or 12 251.3
Since the radius of a circle cannot have a negative The surface area is approximately 251.3 ft2.
value, 12 is eliminated. So, the radius of the 14. Use a calculator.
base is 4 cm. T ¬2rh 2r2
7. Use the formula for surface area to write and 2
¬2d
2 h 2 2
d
solve an equation for the radius.
T ¬2rh 2r2 ¬dh 1
2 d
2
140 ¬2r(9) 2r2
140 ¬18r 2r2 ¬(8.2)(7.2) 1
2 (8.2)
2
70 ¬9r r2 ¬291.1
0 ¬r2 9r 70 The surface area is approximately 291.1 yd2.
0 ¬(r 14)(r 5) 15. Use a calculator.
r ¬5 or 14 T 2rh 2r2
Since the radius of a circle cannot have a negative 2(0.9)(4.4) 2(0.9)2
value, 14 is eliminated. So, the radius of the 30.0
base is 5 ft. The surface area is approximately 30.0 cm2.
8. Find the area of one label. 16. Use a calculator.
L ¬2rh T ¬2rh 2r2
¬2d
2 h
2
¬2d
2h 22
d
¬dh ¬dh 1
2 d
2
¬(2.5)(4)
¬10 ¬(9.6)(3.4) 1
2 (9.6)
2
¬517.5
The surface area is approximately 517.5 in2.
425 Chapter 12
19. Use the formula for surface area to write and 24. L ¬2rh
solve an equation for the radius. ¬2d
2h
T ¬2rh 2r2
320 ¬2r(12) 2r2 ¬dh
320 ¬24r 2r2 ¬(5)(13)
160 ¬12r r2 ¬204.2
0 ¬r2 12r 160 The lateral area of the silo is approximately
0 ¬(r 20)(r 8) 204.2 m2.
r ¬8 or 20 25. From Exercise 24, L 65. Use the formula for
Since the radius of a circle cannot have a negative lateral area to write and solve an equation for
value, 20 is eliminated. So, the radius of the the radius.
base is 8 m. L ¬2rh
20. Use the formula for surface area to write and 65 ¬2r(26)
solve an equation for the radius. 1.25 ¬r
T ¬2rh 2r2 The radius of the silo is 1.25 m.
425.1 ¬2r(6.8) 2r2 26. x
425.1 ¬13.6r 2r2
0 ¬2r2 13.6r 425.1
Use the quadratic formula to find r.
a ¬2 x–
2
b ¬13.6
c ¬425.1 Let the diameter of the circle be x. A regular
b ac
b 4
2
r ¬ 2a
hexagon can be separated into 6 congruent
13.6 (13.6
) 425.1
2 4(2)() nonoverlapping equilateral triangles. The sides of
¬ 2(2) each triangle are 2x. The perimeter of the hexagon
¬5.5 or 12.3 is 3x. The lateral area of the hexagonal pencil is
Since the radius of a circle cannot have a negative 33x. The radius of the circle is also 2x. The
value, 12.3 is eliminated. So, the radius of the
circumference of the circle is 22x or x. The
base is approximately 5.5 ft.
lateral area is approximately 34.6x square inches.
21. Since L 2rh, the lateral areas will be in the
The cylindrical pencil has the greater surface
ratio 3 : 2 : 1.
area.
L1 ¬25
2 (9)
27. Sample answer: Extreme sports participants use
¬141.4 a semicylinder for a ramp. Answers should
L2 ¬25
2 (6)
include the following.
• To find the lateral area of a semicylinder like
¬94.2
the half-pipe, multiply the height by the
L3 ¬25
2 (3)
circumference of the base and then divide by 2.
¬47.1 • A half-pipe ramp is half of a cylinder if the
The lateral areas are approximately 141.4 in2, ramp is an equal distance from the axis of the
94.2 in2, and 47.1 in2. cylinder.
22. To find the amount of aluminum foil needed to 28. B; T ¬2rh 2r2
2
cover the inside of the reflector, divide the ¬2d
2h 22
d
formula for surface area of a cylinder by 2.
2rh 2r 2 ¬dh 1
2 d
2
T ¬ 2
¬rh r2 ¬(8.2)(13.4) 1
2 (8.2)
2
¬d
2
¬450.8 cm2
2h 2
d
29. C; let x be the number of adult tickets sold. Then
¬1 1 2
2 dh 4 d
200 x is the number of student tickets sold.
2
¬1 1 1 1 total sales ¬adult sales student sales
2 5 2 (18) 4 5 2
500 ¬5x 2(200 x)
¬179.3 500 ¬5x 400 2x
Approximately 179.3 in2 of aluminum foil is 100 ¬3x
needed. 33.3 ¬x
23. T L 2B Since the total sales were more than $500, the
2rh 2r2 minimum number of adult tickets sold was 34.
Triple the height. 30. The locus of points 5 units from a given line is a
T 2r(3h) 2r2 cylinder with a radius of 5 units.
3(2rh) 2r2
3L 2B
The lateral area is tripled. The surface area is 5
increased, but not tripled.
Chapter 12 426
31. The locus of points equidistant from two opposite 39. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find x.
vertices of a face of a cube is a plane c2 ¬a2 b2
perpendicular to the line containing the opposite (5 x)2 ¬52 122
vertices of the face of the cube. 25 10x x2 ¬25 144
1 unit x2 10x 144 ¬0
(x 18)(x 8) ¬0
8 or 18 ¬x
Since the length of a segment cannot be negative,
18 is eliminated. So, x 8.
40. Use the Law of Cosines since the measures of two
sides and the included angle are known.
Page 659 Maintain Your Skills a2 ¬b2 c2 2bccosA
32. L(8 15 base) Ph a2 ¬6.32 7.12 2(6.3)(7.1)cos54
(2 8 2 15)(6) a2 ¬90.1 89.46cos54
276 a ¬90.1 89.46cos54
L(6 15 base) (2 6 2 15)(8) a ¬6.1
336 Use the Law of Sines to find mB and mC.
L(8 6 base) (2 8 2 6)(15) sinB sinA
b ¬ a
420 b
The lateral areas are 276 units2 (8 15 base), sinB ¬asinA
336 units2 (6 15 base), and 420 units2 B ¬sin1ab
sinA
(8 6 base).
B ¬sin1 25 sin54
6.3
6.1
33. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
measure of the third side of the triangular base. B ¬56.3
c2 ¬a2 b2 C
sin sinA
c ¬a
c2 ¬52 122
c2 ¬25 144 C ¬sin1acsinA
c2 ¬169 C ¬sin1
6.125 sin54
7.1
c ¬13
L Ph C ¬69.7
(5 12 13)(10) So, mB 56.3, mC 69.7, and a 6.1.
300 41. Use the Angle Sum Theorem to find mA.
The lateral area is 300 units2. mA mB mC ¬180
mA 47 69 ¬180
34. L(8 18 base) Ph
mA ¬64
(2 8 2 18)(6)
Use the Law of Sines to find b and c.
312
sinA sinB
a ¬b
L(6 18 base) (2 6 2 18)(8)
384 asi
b ¬ nB
sinA
L(8 6 base) (2 8 2 6)(18)
15sin47
504 b ¬
sin64
The lateral areas are 312 units2 (8 18 base), b ¬12.2
384 units2 (6 18 base), and 504 units2 sinA sinC
a ¬c
(8 6 base).
asinC
35. 36. c ¬sinA
15sin 69
c ¬
sin64
c ¬15.6
So, mA 64, b 12.2, and c 15.6.
42. A ¬1
2 bh
37. According to Theorem 10.11 on page 554, two
¬1
2 (20)(17)
segments that originate from the same exterior
point and are tangent to a circle are congruent. ¬170
So, x 27. The area of the triangle is 170 in2.
38. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find x. 43. A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
c2 ¬a2 b2 ¬1
2 (6)(7 11)
(4 6)2 ¬x2 62
100 ¬x2 36 ¬54
The area of the trapezoid is 54 cm2.
64 ¬x2
8 ¬x 44. A ¬1
2 bh
¬1
2 (38)(13)
¬247
The area of the triangle is 247 mm2.
427 Chapter 12
Page 659 Practice Quiz 1 2. A regular pyramid is only a regular polyhedron if
1. 2. all of the faces including the base are congruent
regular polygons. Since the faces of a pyramid are
triangles, the only regular pyramid that is also a
regular polyhedron is a tetrahedron.
3. The slant height is the hypotenuse of a right
corner view triangle with legs that are the altitude and a
3. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the segment with a length that is one-half the side
measure of the third side of the triangular base. measure of the base. Use the Pythagorean
c2 ¬a2 b2 Theorem to find the slant height of the regular
82 ¬a2 62 pyramid.
64 ¬a2 36 c2 ¬a2 b2
28 ¬a2 2 ¬22 72
28
¬a ¬53
27 ¬a Find the surface area.
L Ph T ¬1
2 P B
(6 8 27 )(12)
231.5 ¬1
2 (4 4 4 4)53
42
The lateral area of the prism is approximately ¬74.2
231.5 m2. The surface area of the regular pyramid is
4. From Question 3, L (6 8 2 7)(12) approximately 74.2 ft2.
T ¬L 2B 4. The altitude, slant height, and apothem form a
¬Ph 2B right triangle. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to
)(12) 2 1
¬(6 8 27 2 6 27
find the length of the apothem. Let x represent
the length of the apothem.
¬263.2 c2 ¬a2 b2
The surface area of the prism is approximately (32)2 ¬x2 32
263.2 m2. 18 ¬x2 9
5. Use the formula for surface area to write and 9 ¬x2
solve an equation for the radius. 3 ¬x
T ¬2rh 2r2 The side measure of the base is 2x 2(3) 6.
560 ¬2r(11) 2r2 Find the surface area.
280
¬11r r T ¬1
2
2 P B
280
0 ¬r2 11r ¬1
2 (6 6 6 6)(32
) 62
Use the quadratic formula to find r. ¬86.9
a ¬1 The surface area of the regular pyramid is
b ¬11 approximately 86.9 cm2.
280
c ¬ 5. The slant height is the hypotenuse of a right
b ac
b 4
2
r ¬ 2a
triangle with legs that are a lateral edge and a
segment with a length that is one-half the side
11
¬
2(1)
11
2
4(1)
280
measure of the base. Use the Pythagorean
Theorem to find the measure of the slant height.
¬5.4 or 16.4 c2 ¬a2 b2
2
Since the radius of a circle cannot have a negative 132 ¬2 2
10
value, 16.4 is eliminated. So, the radius of the
169 ¬2 25
base is approximately 5.4 ft.
144 ¬2
12 ¬
Find the surface area.
12-5 Surface Areas of Pyramids T ¬1
2 P B
¬1
2 (10 10 10 10)(12) 10
2
Chapter 12 428
Find the total amount of paper used given that 10. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the length
there are 6 pyramids per star. of the apothem. Let x represent the length of the
6L 6(16) apothem.
96 c2 ¬a2 b2
The amount of paper used is 16 in2 per pyramid 92 ¬x2 62
and 96 in2 per star. 81 ¬x2 36
45 ¬x2
35 ¬x
Pages 663–665 Practice and Apply The side measure of the base is 2x 2(35)
65 . Find the surface area.
7. T ¬1
2 P B
T ¬1
2 P B
¬1
2 (7 7 7 7)(5) 7
2
¬1
2 (4 65
)(9) (65
)2
¬119
The surface area of the regular pyramid is ¬421.5
119 cm2. The surface area of the regular pyramid is
approximately 421.5 cm2.
8. Find the measure of the apothem of the base, x.
36
0 11. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
The central angle of the hexagon is 6 60. So, height .
the angle formed by a radius and the apothem is c2 ¬a2 b2
60
2 30.
2
82 ¬6
2
2
64 ¬9 2
55 ¬2
55 ¬
Find the measure of the apothem of the base, x.
36
0
The central angle of the pentagon is 5 72.
30 x
So, the angle formed by a radius and the apothem
72
is 2 36.
2.25 in.
2.25
tan30 ¬ x
2.25
x ¬
tan30
Find the surface area.
36 x
T ¬1 1
2 P 2 Px
¬1
2 P( x)
3 yd
2 (6 4.5)6 tan30
¬1
2.2
5
tan36 ¬3x
¬133.6
3
The surface area of the regular pyramid is x ¬
tan36
approximately 133.6 in2. Find the surface area.
9. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height T ¬1 1
2 P 2 Px
of the triangular base.
c2 ¬a2 b2 ¬1
2 P( x)
2
82 ¬a2 8
2 2 (5 6)55
¬1 36
3
tan
64 ¬a2 16 ¬173.2
48 ¬a2 The surface area of the regular pyramid is
43 ¬a approximately 173.2 yd2.
Find the surface area. 12. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
T ¬1 height .
2 P B
c2 ¬a2 b2
¬1
1
2 (3 8)(10) 2 (8)(43
) 2
6.42 ¬2
3.2
2
¬147.7
The surface area of the regular pyramid is 40.96 ¬2.56 2
approximately 147.7 ft2. 38.4 ¬2
38.4
¬
Find the measure of the apothem of the base, x.
36
0
The central angle of the hexagon is 6 60. So,
the angle formed by a radius and the apothem is
60
2 30.
429 Chapter 12
Find the altitude of the triangular base.
c2 ¬a2 b2
122 ¬a2 62
144 ¬a2 36
108 ¬a2
63 ¬a
30 x Find the surface area.
T ¬1
2 P B
1.6 m ¬1
) 1
2 (3 12)(27
)
2 (12)(63
1.6
tan30 ¬x
¬157.6
1.
6
x ¬
tan30
The surface area of the regular pyramid is
approximately 157.6 cm2.
x ¬1.63
Find the surface area. 15. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
height .
T ¬1 1
2 P 2 Px
c2 ¬a2 b2
¬1
2
2 P( x)
42 ¬2 4
2
¬1
2 (6 3.2)(38.4
1.63
) 16 ¬2 4
¬86.1 12 ¬2
The surface area of the regular pyramid is 23 ¬
approximately 86.1 m2. is also the altitude of the triangular base. Find
the surface area.
13. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
apothem, x. T ¬1
2 P B
c2 ¬a2 b2 ¬1 ) 1
2 (3 4)(23 )
2 (4)(23
132 ¬122 x2
169 ¬144 x2 ¬27.7
25 ¬x2 The surface area of the regular pyramid is
5 ¬x approximately 27.7 ft2.
Find the side measure of the base, y. The central 16. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
36
0 apothem, x.
angle of the pentagon is 5 72. So, the angle c2 ¬a2 b2
formed by the radius and the apothem is
72 202 ¬52 x2
2 36.
400 ¬25 x2
375 ¬x2
¬x
515
The side measure of the base is twice the
apothem: 2x 1015 .
Find the lateral area of the roof.
36 5 in.
L ¬1
2 P
¬1
2 (4 1015
)(20)
y
¬1549.2
2 The area of the roof is approximately 1549.2 ft2.
y
2
tan36 ¬
5
17. Find the surface area of the first bottle.
10 tan36 ¬y T ¬1
2 P B
Find the surface area. ¬1
2 (4 3)(4) 3
2
T ¬1 1
2 P 2 Px
¬33
¬1 Find the dimensions of the base of the second
2 P( x)
bottle. Let the side measure be x.
1
¬2(5 10 tan36)(13 5) T ¬1
2 P B
¬326.9
T ¬1
2 (4x)(6) x
2
The surface area of the regular pyramid is
approximately 326.9 in2. 33 ¬12x x2
14. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant 0 ¬x2 12x 33
height . Use the quadratic formula to find x.
c2 ¬a2 b2 a ¬1
2 b ¬12
82 ¬2 2
12
c ¬33
64 ¬ 36
2
28 ¬2
27 ¬
Chapter 12 430
b b
x ¬ ac
2 4 1 P
L ¬\
2a 2
12 12
¬ 33)
4(1)(
2
¬1 107
.25
2 (4 214.5) cos53
2(1)
¬76,452.5
¬2.3 or 14.3
The lateral area is approximately 76,452.5 m2.
The length of the side cannot be negative, so
14.3 is eliminated. The base of the second bottle 21. Find the height of the pyramid using the
is approximately 2.3 inches on each side. Pythagorean Theorem. The apothem of the
pyramid is half the length of its base, which is
18. Find the side measure of the base. 12
360,0
00 600 12 ft: 2 6.
So, P 4(600) 2400 and the apothem is c2 ¬a2 b2
600 102 ¬a2 62
2 300.
100 ¬a2 36
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
64 ¬a2
height .
8 ¬a
c2 ¬a2 b2
The height of the solid is 12 8 20 ft.
2 ¬3002 3212
2 ¬193,041 22. Add the lateral areas of the pyramid and the
¬193,0
41 cube.
Find the lateral area. L ¬1
2 P Ph
L ¬1
¬1
2 P 2 (4 12)(10) (4 12)(12)
¬1
41
2 (2400)193,0 ¬816
The lateral area of the solid is 816 ft2.
¬527,237.2
The lateral area of the pyramid is approximately 23. The surface area of the solid is equal to the
527,237.2 ft2. lateral areas of the pyramid and the cube plus the
64
6 area of the cube’s base.
19. The apothem is half the length of the edge: 2
T ¬1
2 P Ph B
323. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
slant height . ¬1
2 (4 12)(10) (4 12)(12) 12
2
c2 ¬a2 b2 ¬960
2 ¬3232 3502 The surface area of the solid is 960 ft2.
2 ¬226,829
24. Each lateral face of the frustum is a trapezoid.
¬226,8
29
Find the area of one face.
Find the lateral area to find the area of the glass.
A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
L ¬1
2 P
¬1
2 (b1 b2)
¬1
2 (4 646)226,8
29
¬615,335.3 ¬1
2 (3)(2 4)
The area of the glass is approximately ¬9
615,335.3 ft2. The lateral area is 4A 4(9) 36 yd2.
20. The apothem is half the length of the side of the 25. Find the surface area of the truncated cube. The
214.5 area of the three intact faces is 3 in2. The
base: 2 107.25.
truncation cuts three faces in half, leaving three
triangles with a total area of 1.5 in2. The final
face is an equilateral triangle. Use the
Pythagorean Theorem to find the side measure of
the triangle.
53 c2 ¬a2 b2
c2 ¬12 12
c2 ¬2
c ¬2
Find the altitude of the triangle.
107.25
c2 ¬a2 b2
2
Find the slant height. )2 ¬a2
(2 2
2
107
.25
cos53 ¬ 2 ¬a2 1
2
107
.25 1.5 ¬a2
¬
cos53
Find the lateral area. 1.5
¬a
Find the area of the triangle.
A ¬1
2 bh
¬1
)1.5
2 (2
3
¬2
431 Chapter 12
3 A ¬bh
The surface area is 3 1.5 2 5.37 in . The
2
153
surface area of the original cube is 6 square ¬(22) 2
inches. The surface area of the truncated cube is
¬285.8
approximately 5.37 square inches. Truncating the
The perimeter is 74 ft and the area is
corner of the cube reduces the surface area by
approximately 285.8 ft2.
0.63 square inch.
34. P 24 2(32) 10 2(5) 6 (24 10 6)
26. Sample answer: Pyramids are used as an
122
alternative to rectangular prisms for the shapes
A (32)(24) (5)(24 10 6)
of buildings. Answers should include the
808
following.
The perimeter is 122 m and the area is 808 m2.
• We need to know the dimensions of the base
and slant height to find the lateral area and 35. P 17 12 (22 17) 9 22
surface area of a pyramid. (12 9 3 6) 3(6) 3
• Sample answer: The roof of a gazebo is often a 98
hexagonal pyramid. A (22)(12 9) (12)(22 17) 62
366
27. D; T ¬1
2 P B
The perimeter is 98 m and the area is 366 m2.
2
2 (20)(10) 4
¬1
2
0 36. M
F is reflected in line b, but F
M
lies on line b. So,
¬125 cm2 the reflected image of FM is F
M.
1 37. The reflected image of J K
in line a is G
F.
28. A; x ⊗ y ¬
xy 38. The reflected image of L in point M is point H.
1 ⊗ 3 ¬ 1
39. The reflected image of G M in line a is J
M
.
2 4
1 3
2 4
1 40. False; each pair of opposite sides must be
¬ congruent.
2 3
4 4
1 41. True; each pair of opposite sides is congruent.
¬
1
4
42. c2 ¬a2 b2
¬4 122 ¬82 b2
144 ¬64 b2
80 ¬b2
Page 665 Maintain Your Skills 45 ¬b
8.9 ¬b
29. T 2rh 2r2
The length is approximately 8.9 in.
2(7)(15) 2(7)2
967.6 43. c2 ¬a2 b2
The surface area is approximately 967.6 m2. c2 ¬142 162
c2 ¬196 256
30. T ¬2rh 2r2
2 c2 ¬452
¬2d
2h 22
d
c ¬2113
¬dh 1 c ¬21.3
2 d
2
The length is approximately 21.3 m.
¬(22)(14) 1
2 (22)
2
44. c2 ¬a2 b2
¬1727.9 112 ¬a2 62
The surface area is approximately 1727.9 cm2. 121 ¬a2 36
31. T 2rh 2r2 85 ¬a2
2(9)(23) 2(9)2 85 ¬a
1809.6 9.2 ¬a
The surface area is approximately 1809.6 yd2. The length is approximately 9.2 km.
32. T L 2B
Ph 2B
(2 6 2 2.5)(14) 2(6)(2.5)
268
12-6 Surface Areas of Cones
The surface area of the box is 268 in2.
33. P 2(22) 2(15) Page 668 Check for Understanding
44 30 1. Sample answer:
74 vertex
Find the height.
h ¬sin60 center of base
15
h ¬15sin60
153
h ¬
2
Chapter 12 432
2. The formula for the lateral area is derived from 9. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
the area of a sector of a circle. If the vertex of the height.
cone is not the center of this circle, the formula is c2 ¬a2 b2
not valid. 2 ¬92 92
3. T r r2 2 ¬162
(10)(17) (10)2 ¬92
848.2 T r r2
The surface area is approximately 848.2 cm2. (9)(92 ) (9)2
4. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant 614.3
height. The surface area is approximately 614.3 in2.
c2 ¬a2 b2 10. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the radius.
2 ¬122 102 c2 ¬a2 b2
2 ¬144 100 172 ¬r2 152
2 ¬244 289 ¬r2 225
¬261 64 ¬r2
T r r2 8 ¬r
(10)(261) (10)2 T r r2
804.9 (8)(17) (8)2
The surface area is approximately 804.9 ft2. 628.3
5. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant The surface area is approximately 628.3 ft2.
height. 11. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the radius.
c2 ¬a2 b2 c2 ¬a2 b2
2 ¬82 82 122 ¬r2 7.52
2 ¬128 144 ¬r2 56.25
¬82 87.75 ¬r2
T r r2 87.75
¬r
(8)(82) (8)2 T r r2
485.4 (87.75
)(12) (87.75 )2
The surface area is approximately 485.4 in2. 628.8
6. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant The surface area is approximately 628.8 m2.
height. 12. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
c2 ¬a2 b2 height.
2 c2 ¬a2 b2
2 ¬552 2
8.5
2 ¬2.62 6.42
¬3043.
0625 2 ¬47.72
L ¬r ¬47.72
¬ T r r2
2 3043.
8.5
0625
(2.6)47.72
(2.6)2
¬736.5
77.7
The lateral area is approximately 736.5 ft2.
The surface area is approximately 77.7 yd2.
13. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the radius.
c2 ¬a2 b2
Pages 668–670 Practice and Apply 182 ¬r2 162
7. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant 324 ¬r2 256
height. 68 ¬r2
c2 ¬a2 b2 217 ¬r
2 ¬52 122 T r r2
2 ¬169 (217 )(18) (217 )2
¬13 679.9
T r r2 The surface area is approximately 679.9 in2.
(5)(13) (5)2
14. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the radius.
282.7
c2 ¬a2 b2
The surface area is approximately 282.7 cm2.
19.12 ¬r2 8.72
8. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the radius. 364.81 ¬r2 75.69
c2 ¬a2 b2 289.12 ¬r2
102 ¬r2 82 289.1
2 ¬r
100 ¬r2 64 T r r2
36 ¬r2 (289.1
2 )(19.1) (289.1
2 )2
6 ¬r 1928.6
T r r2 The surface area is approximately 1928.6 m2.
(6)(10) (6)2
301.6
The surface area is approximately 301.6 ft2.
433 Chapter 12
15. Solve the surface area equation for the slant T r r2 2rh
height. r( r 2h)
T ¬r r2 (6)[213 6 2(6)]
T r2 ¬r 475.2
T r2 The surface area is approximately 475.2 in2.
r ¬
1020 (14.5)2 20. T r r2 2rh
¬
(14.5) r( r 2h)
7.9 ¬ (3)[5 3 2(5)]
The slant height is approximately 7.9 m. 169.6
16. Solve the surface area equation for the slant The surface area is approximately 169.6 ft2.
height. 21. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
T ¬r r2 height of the cone.
T r2 ¬r c2 ¬a2 b2
T
r2
¬ 2 ¬142 6.22
r ¬234.4
4
293.2
¬ (6.1) 2
(6.1) T r 2rh r2
9.2 ¬ r( 2h r)
The slant height is approximately 9.2 ft. (6.2)[234.4
4 2(28) 6.2]
1509.8
17. Use the surface area equation to solve for the
The surface area is approximately 1509.8 m2.
radius.
T ¬r r2 22. T ¬r
359 ¬r(15) r2 ¬d
2
359
0 ¬r2 15r ¬1
2 (42)(47.9)
Use the Quadratic Formula to solve for r. ¬3160.1
a ¬1
The area of the canvas used is approximately
b ¬15
3160.1 ft2.
359
c ¬ 23. Find the radius.
b ac
b 4
2
C ¬2r
r ¬ 2a
C ¬r
¬
15 152 4(1)
359
2
22
2 ¬r
2(1)
¬5.6 or 20.6 11
¬r
Since the radius of a circle cannot be negative,
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
20.6 is eliminated. So, the radius of the cone is
height.
approximately 5.6 ft.
c2 ¬a2 b2
18. Use the surface area equation to solve for the 2
radius. 2 ¬ 18
11 2
T ¬r r2
523 ¬r(12.1) r2
¬
12
1
2 324
Chapter 12 434
25. Use the equation for surface area to solve for the 29. Using the store feature on the calculator is the
diameter. most accurate technique to find the lateral area.
T ¬r r2 Rounding the slant height to either the tenths
2
T ¬d
2 2
d place or hundredths place changes the value of
the slant height, which affects the final
T ¬1 1 2
2 d 4 d
computation of the lateral area.
500 ¬1 1 2
2 d(20) 4 d
30. Never; the pyramid could be inscribed in the cone.
2000 31. Sometimes; only when the heights have the same
¬40d d
2
proportion.
2000
0 ¬d2 40d
32. As the altitude approaches zero, the slant height
Use the Quadratic Formula to solve for d. of the cone approaches the radius of the base. The
a1 lateral area approaches the area of the base. The
b 40 surface area approaches twice the area of the
2000 base.
c
b bac
4
2 33. Sample answer: Tepees are conical shaped
d ¬
2a structures. Lateral area is used because the
¬
40 402 4(1)
2000 ground may not always be covered in circular
canvas. Answers should include the following.
2(1)
• We need to know the circumference of the base
¬12 or 52
or the radius of the base and the slant height of
Since the diameter of a circle cannot be negative,
the cone.
52 is eliminated. So, the diameter of light on
• The open top reduces the lateral area of canvas
stage is approximately 12 ft.
needed to cover the sides. To find the actual
26. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant lateral area, subtract the lateral area of the
height. conical opening from the lateral area of the
c2 ¬a2 b2 structure.
2 ¬72 42
34. B; L ¬r
¬65
91.5 ¬r(15)
¬8.062257748
6.1 ft ¬r
Use the store feature of the calculator to save .
L r 35. D; let the odd integers be x 4, x 2, and x.
(4)(8.062257748) 3(x 4) ¬3 2x
101.3133 3x 12 ¬3 2x
The lateral area of the cone is approximately x ¬15
101.3133 in2.
27. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
Page 670 Maintain Your Skills
height.
36. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
c2 ¬a2 b2
height. The apothem is half the length of the
2 ¬72 42
base’s side.
¬65
c2 ¬a2 b2
¬8.1 2
L r 2 2 853
14
9 2
(4)(8.1) ¬733,1
59.25
101.7876
L ¬1
P
2
The slant height and lateral area of the cone are
approximately 8.1 in. and 101.7876 in2, ¬1
2 (4 149)733,1
59.25
respectively. ¬255,161.7
28. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant The lateral area is approximately 255,161.7 ft2.
height. 37. T ¬2rh 2r2
c2 ¬a2 b2 563 ¬2r(9.5) 2r2
2 ¬72 42 56
3
¬65
0 ¬r2 9.5r
2
¬8.06 Use the quadratic formula to solve for r.
L r a1
(4)(8.06) b 9.5
101.2849 56
3
c 2
The slant height and lateral area of the cone are b b
2 4ac
approximately 8.06 in. and 101.2849 in2, r ¬ 2a
respectively.
¬
9.5 9.52 4(1)
2
56
3
2(1)
¬5.8 or 15.3
435 Chapter 12
Since the radius of a circle cannot be negative, 44. Since the radius M K is perpendicular to the chord
15.3 is eliminated. So, the radius is G
F, it bisects the chord. So, LG is equal to FL,
approximately 5.8 ft. or 24.
38. T ¬2rh 2r2 45. Since the radius M P is perpendicular to the chord
185 ¬2r(11) 2r2 J
H , it bisects the chord and its arc. So, mPJ is
18
5
0 ¬r2 11r
2
equal to mHP , or 45.
Use the Quadratic Formula to solve for r. 46. Since the radius M P is perpendicular to the chord
a1 J
H , it bisects the chord and its arc. So, mHJ is
b 11 twice mHP , or 90.
18
5 47. Let x represent the geometric mean.
c
2
b b
2 4ac 7
x ¬
x
63
r ¬
2a
x2 ¬441
¬
11 112 4(1)
2
18
5
x ¬21
2(1) 48. Let x represent the geometric mean.
¬2.2 or 13.2 8 x
Since the radius of a circle cannot be negative, x ¬
18
13.2 is eliminated. So, the radius is x2 ¬144
approximately 2.2 m. x ¬12
39. T ¬2rh 2r2 49. Let x represent the geometric mean.
470 ¬2r(6.5) 2r2 16 x
x ¬
4
4
47
0
0 ¬r2 6.5r
2 x2 ¬704
Use the Quadratic Formula to solve for r. x ¬811 26.5
a1 50. C 2r 51. C ¬d
b 6.5 2(6) ¬(8)
47
c 0 37.7 ¬25.1
2
b b
2 4ac 52. C d 53. C ¬2r
r ¬
2a ¬(18) ¬2(8.2)
6.5
¬
6.5
2
4(1)
2
47
0 56.5
54. C d
¬51.5
55. C ¬2r
2(1)
(19.8) ¬2(4.1)
¬6.0 or 12.5
62.2 ¬25.8
Since the radius of a circle cannot be negative,
12.5 is eliminated. So, the radius is
approximately 6.0 yd.
40. T ¬2rh 2r2 Page 670 Practice Quiz 2
951 ¬2r(14) 2r2 1. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
95
1 height. The apothem is equal to half the base’s
0 ¬r2 14r
2 edge.
Use the Quadratic Formula to solve for r. c2 ¬a2 b2
a1 2 ¬62 102
b 14 ¬234
95
1
c T ¬1
2 P B
2
b b
2 4ac
r ¬
2a ¬1
2 (4 12)(234
) 122
¬
14 142 4(1)
2
95
1 ¬423.9
The surface area is approximately 423.9 cm2.
2(1)
2. Find the apothem of the base, x. The central angle
¬7.2 or 21.2 36
0
Since the radius of a circle cannot be negative, of the hexagon is 6 60. So, the angle formed
60
by the radius and the apothem is 2 30.
21.2 is eliminated. So, the radius is
approximately 7.2 cm.
41. Since the radius M K is perpendicular to the chord
G
F, it bisects the chord. So, FG is twice FL, or 48.
42. Since the radius M P is perpendicular to the chord
J
H , it bisects the chord. So, NJ is half of HJ,
or 24. 30 x
43. Since the radius M P is perpendicular to the chord
J
H , it bisects the chord. So, HN is half of HJ, 2 in.
or 24.
Chapter 12 436
tan30 ¬2x 3. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find AB.
2 AB2 ¬AC2 BC2
x ¬tan 30 AB2 ¬92 122
x ¬23 AB2 ¬81 144
Find the surface area. AB2 ¬225
T ¬1 1 AB ¬15
2 P 2 Px
4. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find AC.
¬1
2 P( x)
AB2 ¬AC2 BC2
¬1 152 ¬AC2 102
2 (6 4)(11 23
)
225 ¬AC2 100
¬173.6 125 ¬AC2
The surface area is approximately 173.6 in2. 11.2 ¬AC
3. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant 5. If Q is a point on C, then AQ is equal to the
height. radius of the sphere, and thus, AB. So, AQ 18.
c2 ¬a2 b2
6. T 4r2
2 ¬32 122
4(6.8)2
¬317
581.1
T r r2
The surface area is approximately 581.1 in2.
(3)(317) (3)2
144.9 7. Find the radius.
The surface area is approximately 144.9 ft2. C ¬2r
8 ¬2r
4. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
4 ¬r
height.
c2 ¬a2 b2 T ¬1
2 (4r ) r
2 2
¬123 ¬72.4
(1
0) The surface area is approximately 72.4 m2.
¬3.9
9. T 4r2
The slant height is approximately 3.9 in.
4(4.75)2
283.5
The surface area is approximately 283.5 in2.
12-7 Surface Areas of Spheres
Pages 674–676 Practice and Apply
Page 672 Geometry Activity: Surface Area 10. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find PR.
of a Sphere PR2 ¬PT 2 RT 2
1. 1 PR2 ¬42 32
4
2. r2 PR2 ¬16 9
PR2 ¬25
3. The surface area of a sphere is 4 times the area of
PR ¬5
the great circle.
11. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find PR.
PR2 ¬PT 2 RT 2
PR2 ¬32 82
Page 674 Check for Understanding
PR2 ¬9 64
1. Sample answer: PR2 ¬73
PR ¬8.5
12. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find PT.
PR2 ¬PT 2 RT 2
132 ¬PT 2 122
169 ¬PT 2 144
2. Tim; the surface area of a hemisphere is half of 25 ¬PT 2
the surface area of the sphere plus the area of the 5 ¬PT
great circle.
437 Chapter 12
13. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find PT. ¬290.3
PR2 ¬PT 2 RT 2 The surface area is approximately 290.3 ft2.
172 ¬PT 2 152 23. Find the radius.
289 ¬PT 2 225 A ¬r2
64 ¬PT 2 814.3 ¬r2
8 ¬PT
14. If X is a point on T, then PX is equal to the
814.3
¬r
radius of the sphere, and thus, PR. So, PX 9.4. T ¬4r2
2
814.3
15. If Y is a point on T, then PY is equal to the ¬4
radius of the sphere, and thus, PR. So, PY 12.8. ¬3257.2
16. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the radius The surface area is 3257.2 m2.
of the charcoal rack. 24. Find the radius.
c2 ¬a2 b2 A ¬r2
112 ¬r2 52 227.0 ¬r2
121 ¬r2 25
96 ¬r2
227.0
¬r
Find the difference in the areas. T ¬1
2 (4r ) r
2 2
(11)2 r2 121 96 ¬3r 2
25
2
78.5 ¬3
227.0
Chapter 12 438
31. Find the mean diameter. 40. The distance between opposite corners of the cube
7899.83 7926.41 7913.12
is equal to the diameter of the sphere. Use the
2 Pythagorean Theorem to find the diagonal of a
The diameter of the atmosphere is 200 miles cube face if the side is x.
longer than the mean value: 8113.12 mi. c2 ¬a2 b2
T ¬4r2 c2 ¬x2 x2
2
¬4d
2
c ¬x2
Now, find the opposite corner distance.
¬d2
c2 ¬a2 b2
¬(8113.12)2
c2 ¬x2 (x2 )2
¬206,788,161.4 mi2
c ¬3x
2 2
32. Find the mean diameter.
c ¬x3
7899.83 7926.41 7913.12
x
3
2 The radius is half this, so r 2 , where x is the
T 4r2, so 0.75T 0.75(4r2) 0.75d2 is the length of each side of the cube.
surface area of the water. 41. None; every line (great circle) that passes through
0.75(7913.12)2 147,538,933.4 mi2 X will also intersect g. All great circles intersect.
1 (4r2) r2
33. T ¬ 42. Sample answer: Sports equipment manufacturers
2
2 2
use the surface area of spheres to determine the
¬2d
2 2
d amount of material to cover the balls for different
sports. Answers should include the following.
¬1
2 1 2
2 d 4 d • The surface area of a sphere is four times the
¬3
4 (13)
2 area of the great circle of the sphere.
• Racquetball and basketball are other sports
¬398.2
that use balls.
The surface area is approximately 398.2 ft2.
43. A; the distance between opposite corners of the
34. T 4r2, so if the radius is twice as large,
rectangular solid is equal to the diameter of the
4(2r)2 16r2, and the ratio is
sphere.
16r2
4, or 4 : 1. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
4r2
35. Let T2 ¬1 diagonal of the 4 ⊗ 5 face.
2 T1. Then
1 c2 ¬a2 b2
4r2 ¬2(4r21)
2
c2 ¬42 52
r22 ¬1
2
2 r1
c ¬41
r1 Now, find the opposite corner distance.
r2 ¬ c2 ¬a2 b2
2
2 c2 ¬72 (41)2
r2 ¬2 r1 c ¬90
2
2 c ¬310
The ratio is 2 : 1.
The radius is half this, so
36. T 4r2, so if the radius is three times as large,
3
10
4(3r)2 36r2, and the ratio is r 2 4.74 in.
36r2 44. C; x
2 7 2 ¬x 1
9, or 9 : 1.
4r2
x2 7 ¬x 1
37. T ¬4r2
2 x2 7 ¬(x 1)2
¬4d
2
x2 7 ¬x2 2x 1
¬d2 6 ¬2x
12 mi : d2 (12)2 3 ¬x
144
452.4
20 mi : d2 (20)2 Page 676 Maintain Your Skills
400 45. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the radius
1256.6 of the base.
The surface area can range from 452.4 to c2 ¬a2 b2
1256.6 mi2. 192 ¬r2 132
38. T ¬4r2 192 ¬r2
2
¬4d
2
83 ¬r
T r r2
¬d2
(83 )(19) (83
)2
¬(7)2
1430.3
¬153.9
The surface area is approximately 1430.3 in2.
The surface area is approximately 153.9 mi2.
39. The side length of the cube is equal to the
diameter of the sphere, so the radius of the sphere
is half the side of the cube.
439 Chapter 12
46. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant 53. Find the radius squared.
height. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
c2 ¬a2 b2 [3 (2)]2 (2 7)2 ¬r2
2 ¬72 102 52 (5)2 ¬r2
¬149
25 25 ¬r2
T r r2 50 ¬r2
(7)149
(7)2 The equation of the circle is
422.4 (x 2)2 (y 7)2 50.
The surface area is approximately 422.4 m2. 54. Find the center.
47. T r r2 6
h 2
(4.2)(15.1) (4.2)2 2 4
8 5
254.7 k 2
3
2
The surface area is approximately 254.7 cm2. Find the radius squared.
2
48. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant (2 4)2
5 3
2 ¬r
2
height. 2
c2 ¬a2 b2 (2)2 2 ¬r
13 2
2
2 ¬7.42 2
11
.2 18
5
4 ¬r
2
¬86.12
The equation of the circle is
T ¬r r2 (x 4)2 y 3
2
2 4 .
18
5
2
¬d
2 2
d
¬1 1 2
2 d 4 d
¬1 1
Page 677 Geometry Activity: Locus and Spheres
2 (11.2)86.12 4 (11.2)
2
1.
¬261.8
5 15 5
The surface area is approximately 261.8 ft2.
49. T ¬1
2 P B
The locus of all points in space at a specific
¬1
2 (4 19)(16) 19
2
distance from a given point is a sphere. Thus, for
¬969 this problem, the locus of points is two spheres
The surface area is 969 yd2. each with a radius of 5 units with centers that are
50. The apothem is half the base, or 6 feet. endpoints of the given line segment.
Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant 2. Yes, the radii are congruent.
height. 3. Each sphere has a radius of 5 units and a
c2 ¬a2 b2 diameter of 10 units.
2 ¬62 (13)2
4. The segment is 25 units long and the radii of the
¬205
spheres are 5 units. So, the spheres are 15 units
T ¬1
2 P B
apart on the given segment.
¬1
2 (4 12)205
122 5. The spheres intersect at a plane. The intersection
of a plane and a sphere is a circle or a point. So,
¬487.6
the intersection is a circle.
The surface area is approximately 487.6 ft2.
6. A circle is a locus of points on a plane.
51. T ¬1
2 P B
7. The intersection is the set of all points
¬1
2 (4 11)(24) 11
2 equidistant from the midpoint of the given line
segment in the plane containing the
¬649
perpendicular bisector of the given line segment.
The surface area is 649 cm2.
8. The particles from an explosion disperse in a
52. The diameter of the fabric required is 9 2(3)
spherical pattern. Since the explosion is at ground
15 in.
level, the locus of points describing the dispersion
A ¬r2
2 of particles is a hemisphere with a radius of
¬d
2 300 ft.
¬1
4 (15)
2
¬176.7
The area of fabric needed is approximately Chapter 12 Study Guide and Review
176.7 in2.
Page 678 Vocabulary and Concept Check
1. d 2. i 3. b 4. h
5. a 6. j 7. e
8. g 9. c 10. f
Chapter 12 440
Pages 678–682 Lesson-by-Lesson Review T ¬1
2 P B
11. The solid is a cylinder. ¬1
2 (4 10)(12) 10
2
Bases: F and G
There are no faces, edges, or vertices. ¬340
12. The solid is a rectangular prism. The surface area is 340 units2.
Bases: rectangle WXYZ and rectangle STUV 16.
Faces: rectangles WXYZ, STUV, WXTS, XTUY,
YUVZ, and WZVS
Edges: WX, X
Y
, Y
Z, Z
W, S
T
, T
U
, U
V, V
S
, W
S
, X
T
,
U
Y , and Z
V
Vertices: S, T, U, V, W, X, Y, and Z
13. The solid is a triangular prism.
Base: BCD
Faces: ABC, ABD, ACD, and BCD
Edges: AB
, B
C, A
C, A
D
, B
D, and C
D
Vertices: A, B, C, and D
14. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
hypotenuse of the triangular base. T 6s2
c2 ¬a2 b2 6(4)2
c2 ¬32 42 96
c2 ¬25 The surface area is 96 units2.
c ¬5 17. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
measure of the third side of the triangular base.
c2 ¬a2 b2
62 ¬42 b2
36 ¬16 b2
20 ¬b2
25 ¬b
T ¬Ph 2B
¬(3 4 5)(6) 2 1
2 34
¬84
The surface area is 84 units2.
15. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
height.
c2 ¬a2 b2
2
132 ¬2 2
10
169 ¬2 25
144 ¬2
12 ¬ T ¬Ph 2B
)(8) 2 1
¬(4 6 25 2 4 25
¬133.7
12 The surface area is approximately 133.7 units2.
18.
13
10
T Ph 2B
(2 2 2 4)(5) 2(2)(4)
76
The surface area is approximately 76 units2.
441 Chapter 12
19. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the 25. T 2rh 2r2
measure of the fourth side of the trapezoidal base. 2(4)(58) 2(4)2
c2 ¬a2 b2 1558.2
c2 ¬42 (8 5)2 The surface area is approximately 1558.2 mm2.
c2 ¬25 26. T ¬2rh ¬2r2
c ¬5 2
¬2d
2 h 2 2
d
¬dh 1
2 d
2
¬(4)(8) 1
2 (4)
2
¬125.7
The surface area is approximately 125.7 km2.
27. T ¬1
2 P B
¬1
2 (4 8)(15) 8
2
¬304
The surface area is 304 units2.
28. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
height.
c2 ¬a2 b2
2
132 ¬2 2
10
169 ¬2 25
144 ¬2
12 ¬
The central angle of the pentagon measures
36
0
T ¬Ph 2B 5 or 72. So, the angle formed by a radius and
72
the apothem is
2 or 36.
¬(4 5 5 8)(8) 2 1
2 (4)(5 8)
Find the apothem, x.
¬228
The surface area is 228 units2.
20. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
hypotenuse of the triangular base.
c2 ¬a2 b2
c2 ¬152 202
c2 ¬625 36 x
c ¬25
L Ph
(15 20 25)(18) 5
1080 tan36 ¬5x
The lateral area is 1080 units2. 5
x ¬
21. L Ph tan36
(3 5 6 10)(3) T ¬1 1
2 P 2 Px
72
¬1
2 P( x)
The lateral area is 72 units2.
2 (5 10)12 tan36
¬1
22. L Ph 5
(3 8 7 5)(4) ¬472.0
92 The surface area is approximately 472.0 units2.
The lateral area is 92 units2.
29. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
23. T ¬2rh 2r2 of the triangular base.
2
¬2d
2h 22
d c2 ¬a2 b2
2
¬dh 1 52 ¬h2 5
2
2 d
2
25 ¬h2 6.25
¬(4)(12) 1
2 (4)
2
18.75
¬h
¬175.9
T ¬1 1
2 P 2 bh
The surface area is approximately 175.9 in2.
24. T 2rh 2r2 ¬1
1
2 (3 5)(3) 2 (5)18.75
2(6)(8) 2(6)2 ¬33.3
527.8 The surface area is approximately 33.3 units2.
The surface area is approximately 527.8 ft2.
Chapter 12 442
30. T r r2 37. T ¬1
2 (4r ) r
2 2
¬d2
¬3r2
¬(18.2)2
¬1040.6 ¬3
30
T ¬4r2
¬4
218
¬872
The surface area is 872 in2.
443 Chapter 12
7. 11. L Ph
(5 3 4 7 4)(8)
184
The lateral area is 184 units2.
12. T 2rh 2r2
2(8)(22) 2(8)2
1508.0
The surface area is approximately 1508.0 ft2.
13. T 2rh 2r2
2(3)(2) 2(3)2
94.2
The surface area is approximately 94.2 mm2.
T Ph 2B 14. T 2rh 2r2
(2 4 2 6)(3) 2(4)(6) 2(78)(100) 2(78)2
108 87,235.7
The surface area is 108 units2. The surface area is approximately 87,235.7 m2.
8. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant 15. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
height. height of the tetrahedron.
c2 ¬a2 b2 c2 ¬a2 b2
2
)2 ¬2 4
2
2
(226 62 ¬2 6
2
104 ¬2 4 36 ¬2 9
100 ¬2 27 ¬2
10 ¬ 33 ¬
36
0
The central angle of the triangular base is 3 or
120. So, the angle formed by a radius and the
12
0
apothem is 2 or 60. Find the apothem, x.
2 26
4
60 x
3
T ¬1
2 P B
tan60 ¬3x
¬1
2 (4 4)(10) 4
2
x ¬ 3
tan
60
¬96 x ¬3
The surface area is 96 units2. Use the Pythagorean Theorem with the apothem
9. L(3 5 base) Ph and slant height to find the height of the
(2 3 2 5)(6) tetrahedron.
96 c2 ¬a2 b2
L(3 6 base) (2 3 2 6)(5) (33)2 ¬(3 )2 b2
90 27 ¬3 b2
L(6 5 base) (2 6 2 5)(3) 24 ¬b2
66 4.9 ¬b
The lateral areas are 96 units2 (3 5 base), The height is approximately 4.9 8 12.9 units.
90 units2 (3 6 base), and 66 units2 16. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
(6 5 base). height of the tetrahedron.
10. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the c2 ¬a2 b2
2
hypotenuse. 62 ¬2 6
2
c2 ¬a2 b2
36 ¬2 9
c2 ¬152 202
27 ¬2
c2 ¬625
33 ¬
c ¬25
L ¬Lprism Ltetrahedron
L Ph
(15 20 25)(8) ¬Ph 1
2 P
480
The lateral area is 480 units2. ¬(3 6)(8) 1
2 (3 6)(33
)
¬190.8
The lateral area is approximately 190.8 units2.
Chapter 12 444
17. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant 24. The area of the plastic is equal to the area of the
height of the tetrahedron. The slant height is the prism minus the area of the 12 ft by 25 ft
same as the altitude of the base. rectangular face.
c2 ¬a2 b2 Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
2
62 ¬2 6
2
of the triangular part of the base.
c2 ¬a2 b2
36 ¬2 9 2
27 ¬2 102 ¬a2 2
12
33 ¬ 100 ¬a2 36
T ¬Ph 1 64 ¬a2
2 P B
8 ¬a
¬(3 6)(8) 1
) 1
2 (3 6)(33 2 6 33
T ¬Ph 2B (12)(25)
¬206.4 ¬(2 10 2 8 12)(25) 2
(8)(12)
The surface area is approximately 206.4 units2.
2 12 8 300
1
18. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the slant
height. ¬1188
c2 ¬a2 b2 The amount of plastic needed is 1188 ft2.
2 ¬242 72 25. D; T ¬6s2
2 ¬625 150 ¬6s2
¬25 25 ¬s2
T r r2 5 ¬s
(7)(25) (7)2 The length of each edge is 5 cm.
703.7
The surface area is approximately 703.7 units2.
19. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the radius.
c2 ¬a2 b2 Chapter 12 Standardized Test Practice
42 ¬32 r2
16 ¬9 r2 Pages 684–685
7 ¬r2 1. D; 3x 16 ¬2x 9
7 ¬r x ¬25
T r r2 [3(25) 16] ¬59
(7 )(4) (7)2 2. D; the change in x is 6 0 6 units.
55.2 D; The change in y is 9 1 8 units.
The surface area is approximately 55.2 units2. So, the other endpoint has coordinates
20. T r r2 (10 6, 6 8) (4, 2) or
(7)(12) (7)2 (10 6, 6 8) (16, 14).
417.8 3. C
The surface area is approximately 417.8 units2.
4. B; the relative length of each side corresponds to
21. T 4r2 the relative measure of its opposite angle.
4(15)2 mC 180 70 48 62
2827.4 C
A is longest, A
B
is in the middle, and B
C is
The surface area is approximately 2827.4 in2. shortest.
22. T ¬4r2 5. B; use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the
2
¬4d
2
length of AB
.
AC2 ¬BC2 AB2
¬d2
122 ¬52 AB2
¬(14)2
144 ¬25 AB2
¬615.8
119 ¬AB2
The surface area is approximately 615.8 m2.
10.9 ¬AB
23. Find the radius squared. The length of AB is approximately 10.9 in.
A ¬r2 N 2
116 ¬r2 6. B; A ¬
360 r
2
116 ¬ 2
N d
¬r
2
360
T ¬4r2 N
¬ 40 d
14
2
¬4
116 360
¬ 120
1440 (18)
2
¬464 ¬54
The surface area is 464 ft2. 7. C; for example, a tetrahedron is a Platonic Solid
but it is not a prism.
445 Chapter 12
8. B; use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the 14a. Sample answer:
height of the triangular bases.
c2 ¬a2 b2
2
22 ¬a2 2
2
4 ¬a2 1
3 ¬a2
3 ¬a
T ¬Ph 2B 15 ft
¬(3 2)(4) 2 1
2 2 3
¬27
The surface area is approximately 27 cm2.
9. A; T ¬4r2 18 in.
2
¬4d
2
¬d2 14b. Change the diameter from inches to feet. There
¬(4)2 1
are 12 inches in 1 foot, so 18 inches 8
12 or
¬50 1.5 feet.
The surface area is approximately 50 ft2. L ¬2rh
10. Let y be the height of the opposite side of the ¬2d
2 h
right triangle.
y ¬dh
tan58 ¬
47 ¬(1.5)(15)
47tan58 ¬y ¬71
75 ¬y The lateral area is approximately 71 ft2.
So, the height of the tree is approximately 14c. T ¬2rh 2r2
75 5 80 ft. 2
¬2d
2h 22
d
11. A ¬1
2 bh
¬dh 1
2 d
2
¬1
2 (12x 2x)(8x 2x)
¬(1.5)(15) 1
2 (1.5)
2
1
¬2(10x)(6x) ¬74
¬30x2 The surface area is approximately 74 ft2.
The area is 30x2 units2. 15a. T ¬r r2
12. area of deck 2
¬d
2 2
d
area of rectangle area of semicircle
w 1 ¬1 1 2
2 d 4 d
2 r
2
26 2
¬1
1
2 (8)(7) 4 (8)
2
2 2
(26)(16) 1
6
259 ¬138
The area of the deck is approximately 259 ft2. The surface area is approximately 138 in2.
13. Find the apothem, x. 15b. T ¬2rh 2r2
2
The central angle of the pentagonal base is ¬2d
2h 22
d
36
0
5 or 72. So, the angle formed by a radius and ¬dh 1
2 d
72 2
the apothem is
2 or 36.
¬(8)(22) 1
2 (8)
2
¬653
The surface area is approximately 653 in2.
15c. T ¬r 2rh r2
2
¬d
2 22h 2
d d
¬1 1
2 (8)(7) (8)(22) 4 (8)
2
4.5 cm
¬691
4.5
tan36 ¬ x The surface area is approximately 691 in2.
4.5
x ¬ tan36
T ¬1
2
P 1Px
2
¬1(5 9)(15) 1(5 9) 36
4.5
tan
2 2
¬476.9
The surface area is approximately 476.9 cm2.
Chapter 12 446
Chapter 13 Volume
Page 687 Getting Started 8.
1. a2 122 132
Solve for a.
a2 144 ¬169
a2 ¬25
a ¬25
30
a ¬5
2
2. 43 b2 82
7
Solve for b. 3.5
48 b2 ¬64 Apothem: A 30°-60°-90° triangle is formed by the
b2 ¬16 apothem and one-half of a side of the hexagon.
b ¬16
The shorter leg of the triangle is 1
2 (7) or 3.5.
b ¬4
2 The apothem is the longer leg of the triangle or
3. a2 a2 32 3.53.
Solve for a. perimeter 7 6 42
2a2 ¬18
a2 ¬9 Area: A 1
2 Pa
a ¬ 1
2 (42)3.53
9
a ¬3
127.3
4. b2 3b2 192
Solve for b. The area is approximately 127.3 ft2.
4b2 ¬192 9.
b2 ¬48
b ¬ 48
b ¬4 3 C
5. 256 72 c2
Solve for c. 45
256 49 ¬c2
305 ¬c2 13.4
c ¬ 305
6. 144 122 c2 A D B
Solve for c. Apothem: The central angles of the octagon are
360
144 144 ¬c2 all congruent, so mACB D
8 or 45. C is an
288 ¬c2 apothem of the octagon. It bisects ACB and is a
288 ¬c B
perpendicular bisector of A . So mACD 22.5.
c ¬122 Since the side of the octagon has measure 13.4,
7. AD 6.7.
6.
7
tan22.5° ¬
CD
6.7
CD ¬
tan 22.5°
¬16.175
30
perimeter (13.4)(8) 107.2
Area: A ¬1
2 Pa
7.2 ¬1
2 (107.2)(16.175)
3.6
Apothem: A 30°-60°-90° triangle is formed by the ¬867.0
apothem and one-half of a side of the hexagon. The area is approximately 867.0 mm2.
The shorter leg of the triangle is 1
(7.2) or 3.6.
2
The apothem is the longer leg of the triangle or
3.63.
perimeter (7.2)(6) 43.2
Area: A 1
Pa
2
(43.2)3.63
1
2
134.7
The area is approximately 134.7 cm2.
447 Chapter 13
10. 17. Let A be (x1, y1) in the Midpoint Formula.
1 2 x
W(10, 10) W 2 , 2
1 y
2
Write two equations to find the coordinates of B.
C 1x 1 y
10 2 10 ¬2
2 2
45 20 1 x2 20 ¬1 y2
10 19 x2 21 ¬y2
The coordinates of B are (19, 21).
A D B 18. Let B be (x2, y2) in the Midpoint Formula.
Apothem: The central angles of the octagon are
all congruent, so mACB 360
D
8 or 45. C is an W(0, 0) W
1
x 2(2)
,
1
y 2
2
apothem of the octagon. It bisects ACB and is a Write two equations to find the coordinates of A.
x (2) y 2
B
perpendicular bisector of A . So mACB 22.5. 0
1
0 ¬
1
2 2
Since the side of the octagon has measure 10,
0 x1 2 0 ¬y1 2
AD 5.
5 2 x1 2 ¬y1
tan22.5° ¬
CD The coordinates of A are (2, 2).
5
CD ¬
tan22.5°
¬12.07
perimeter (10)(8) 80 13-1 Volumes of Prisms and
Area: A ¬1
2 Pa
Cylinders
1
¬2(80)(12.07)
¬482.8 Page 688 Geometry Activity: Volume of a
The area is approximately 482.8 square in2. Rectangular Prism
1. 12 cubes in top layer 12 cubes in bottom layer
11. (5b)2 (5b)(5b)
24 cubes
(5)(5)(b)(b)
25b2 2. The prism is 4 cubes long, 3 cubes wide, and
2 2 cubes high. 4 3 2 24.
12. n
4 4 4
n n
3. They are the same.
n
n
44 4. See students’ work.
n
2
5. V wh
1
6
x 2
13. 3 3
x 3
x
4y 4y 4y
3x 3x Page 691 Check for Understanding
4y 4y 1. Sample answers: cans, roll of paper towels, and
3 3
xx
44yy chalk; boxes, crystals, and buildings
9x
2 2. Julia; Che did not multiply 33 correctly.
16y2
3. V Bh
4y 2 4y 4y
14. 1
2 (8)(12)(6)
7 7 7
4y 4y 288
The volume of the prism is 288 cm3.
77
44yy 4. The diameter of the base, the diagonal, and the
77 lateral edge form a right triangle. Use the
16y2 Pythagorean Theorem to find the height.
49 a2 b2 ¬c2
15. Let A be (x1, y1) and B be (x2, y2). The coordinates h2 82 ¬172
of the midpoint are h2 64 ¬289
x x y y 0 (5) 1 4 h2 ¬225
1
2
2
,
1
2
2
2, 2
h ¬15
5
3
2 , 2 or (2.5, 1.5) Now find the volume.
16. Let A be (x1, y1) and B be (x2, y2). The coordinates V r2h
of the midpoint are (42)(15)
x x y y 5 (3) 0 6 754.0
1
2
2
,
1
2
2
2, 2 The volume is approximately 754.0 in3.
(1, 3) 5. V r2h
(7.52)(18)
3180.9
The volume is approximately 3180.9 mm3.
Chapter 13 448
6. Use the formula for the volume of a rectangular 13. Find the volume of the oblique prism using the
prism. formula for a rectangular prism.
V Bh V Bh
(12)(12)(14) (2.5)(3.5)(3.2)
2016 28
The volume of the prism is 2016 ft3. The volume of the oblique prism is 28 ft3.
14. Find the volume of the oblique prism using the
formula for a rectangular prism.
Pages 692–694 Practice and Apply V Bh
7. The diameter of the base, the diagonal, and the (55)(35)(30)
lateral edge form a right triangle. Use the 57,750
Pythagorean Theorem to find the height. The volume of the oblique prism is 57,750 m3.
a2 b2 ¬c2 15. Find the volume of the oblique cylinder using the
h2 92 ¬152 formula for a right cylinder.
h2 81 ¬225 V r2h
h2 ¬144 (13.22)(27.6)
h ¬12 15,108.0
Now find the volume. The volume is approximately 15,108.0 mm3.
V r2h 16. Find the volume of the oblique cylinder using the
(4.52)(12) formula for a right cylinder.
763.4 V r2h
The volume is approximately 763.4 cm3. (2.62)(7.8)
8. V Bh 165.6
(18.7)(12.2)(3.6) The volume is approximately 165.6 yd3.
821.3 17. V ¬ r2h
The volume is approximately 821.3 in3. Solve for r.
9. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height 615.8 ¬ r2(4)
of the prism’s triangular base. 49 ¬r2
Let b 1
2 (base of triangle) 3 cm
7 ¬r
a2 b2 ¬c2 The diameter is about 2(7) or 14 m.
a2 32 ¬82 18. V ¬Bh
a2 9 ¬64 1152 ¬64h
a2 ¬55 18 ¬h
a ¬ 55 The lateral edge length is 18 in.
Now find the volume of the prism. 19. The solid is a rectangular prism with 4,
V Bh w 3, h 2.
1 V Bh
2 (6)(55
)(12)
(4)(3)(2)
267.0
24
The volume is approximately 267.0 cm3. The volume is 24 units3.
10. The radius of the base is 1
2 (18) or 9. 20. The solid is a triangular prism. Its height is h 5
V r2h
and its base has area B 1
2 (1)(1).
(92)(12.4)
V Bh
3155.4
The volume is approximately 3155.4 m3. 1
2 (1)(1)(5)
11. V Bh 2.5
(15)(10)(5) The volume is 2.5 units3.
750 21. The solid is a cylinder with r 2.1, h 3.5.
The volume of the prism is 750 in3. V r2h
12. Find the area, B, of the base using the formula for (2.12)(3.5)
the area of a trapezoid. 48.5
The volume is approximately 48.5 mm3.
B 1
2 h(b1 b2)
1
2 (4)(6 10)
32
Now find the volume of the prism.
V Bh
(32)(18)
576
The volume of the prism is 576 in3.
449 Chapter 13
22. Treat the solid as a large rectangular prism with 26. The core radius is 1
2 (35) or 17.5. The core height
a smaller one attached underneath. is 586 40 or 626.
22 cm V r2h
B1 (17.52)(626)
16 cm 602,282.6
The volume is approximately 602,282.6 ft3.
h1 16 cm
8 cm 27. The volume in gallons equals the volume r2h in
cubic feet multiplied by a conversion factor of
7 1
3
2 gal/ft .
h2 6 cm V r2h71
2
B2 8 cm
200,000 r2h(7.5)
volume volume of large rectangular prism Solve for r.
volume of smaller rectangular prism 26,667 ¬ r2h
B1h1 B2h2 26,667 ¬ r2(23)
r2 ¬369.1
(22)(8)(16) (8)(6)(6)
r ¬19.2
3104 The radius is approximately 19.2 ft.
The volume of the solid is 3104 cm3.
28. Consider the water to be added as a rectangular
23. volume volume of rectangular prism prism, with a height of 3 0.3 or 2.7.
volume of cylinder V Bh
Bh r2h (50)(25)(2.7)
(6)(6)(6) (1.52)(6) 3375 m3
173.6 Since 1 cubic meter equals 1000 liters, the volume
The volume is approximately 173.6 ft3. of water to be added is 3375(1000) or 3,375,000 L.
24. The solid covers 360° 120° 240° of the 360° in 29. Begin by finding the area of the hexagon.
24
0
a cylinder. So the solid is
360 of a cylinder.
24
0
volume
360 volume of cylinder
2
3 r h
2
20
2
3 (4 )(10)
2
10
335.1
30
The volume is approximately 335.1 ft3.
25. The holder can be modeled as a cylindrical solid
with a smaller cylindrical solid cut out of it. The Apothem: A 30°-60°-90° triangle is formed by the
smaller solid has the same radius as a can, and apothem and one-half of a side of the hexagon.
its height is 11.5 1 10.5. The larger solid has The hypotenuse is 1
2 (20) or 10. So the shorter leg
a radius of 1
2 (8.5) or 4.25.
is 1
(10) 5 and the longer leg is 53
2 . This is the
length of the apothem. One side of the hexagon
r2 6.5 cm measures 10 mm, so the perimeter is 10 6 or 60.
volume of brass block
volume of rectangular prism
volume of hexagonal prism
B1h1 B2h2
h1 11.5 cm h2 10.5 cm
wh1 1
2 Pah2
(50)(40)(60) 1
2 (60)(53
)(60)
104,411.5
r1 The volume is approximately 104,411.5 mm3.
8.5 cm
30. Set the density equal to mass
volume, then use
volume volume of holder and “cut out” 8.0 g/cm3 as the density. For the volume, use
volume of “cut out” 104,411.5 mm3 104.4115 cm3 from Exercise 29.
r12h1 r22h2
d ¬m
V
(4.25)2(11.5) (3.25)2(10.5) m
304.1 8.0 ¬
104.4115
The volume is approximately 304.1 cm3. m ¬(8.0)(104.4115)
¬835.3
The mass is approximately 835.3 g.
Chapter 13 450
31. Start by finding the area of the base. 38. T 4 r2
4 (8.5)2
907.9
C The surface area is approximately 907.9 in2.
39. T r r2
72
4 (6)(11) (62)
320.4
A D B
The surface area is approximately 320.4 m2.
Apothem: The central angles of the pentagon are 40. radius 1
2 (16) 8
451 Chapter 13
shaded area
P(shaded) total area 48. Use Theorem 10.17, about a tangent segment and
a secant segment.
28
2
669 x2 12(12 9.5)
0.42 x2 258
The probability is about 0.42, or 42%. x 258 or 258
44. Since x is a length, it must be positive. So discard
258.
x 16.1
49. Drawing the height divides the triangle into two
30°-60°-90° triangles each with base 1
2 (7) or 3.5.
The height is then 3.5 3. For the whole
30 equilateral triangle,
A 1
2 bh
26 13
1
2 (7)(3.53
)
15
6
The length of one side is 6 or 26. 21.22
Apothem: A 30°-60°-90° triangle is formed by the The area is approximately 21.22 in2.
apothem and one-half of a side of the hexagon. 50.
The shorter leg of the triangle is 1
2 (26) or 13. The
apothem is the longer leg of the triangle or 133 .
Area: A 1
2 Pa
1
2 (156)(133
)
30
1756.3
The area is approximately 1756.3 in2. 12 6
Chapter 13 452
52. 3. The heights are the same.
4. V 1
3 Bh
C
Pages 698–699 Check for Understanding
45 1. Consider first the base of the cone or pyramid.
When a circle with area r2 is doubled in size, the
50 new area is (2r)2 4( r2), or 4 times the original
area. Similarly, when a square with area s2 is
A D B doubled in size, the new area is (2s)2 4s2, or 4
Apothem: The central angles of the octagon are times the original area.
360
all congruent, so mACB D
8 or 45. C is an When, for a cone or pyramid, the height is also
apothem of the octagon. It bisects ACB and is a doubled, the new volume is
B
perpendicular bisector of A . So, mACD 22.5. V 1
3 (4B)(2h)
Since the side of the octagon has measure 50,
AD 25. 81
3 Bh
25 So in each case the volume is 8 times the original
tan 22.5° ¬
CD
volume.
25
CD ¬
tan 22.5° 2. The volume of a pyramid is one-third the volume
¬60.35534 of a prism of the same height as the pyramid and
perimeter 50 8 400 with bases congruent to the bases of the pyramid.
3. Sample answer:
Area: A 1
2 Pa
1
2 (400)(60.35534)
12,071.07
The area is approximately 12,071.07 ft2. 16
9
3 4
Page 695 Spread Sheet Investigation: Prisms
Use the formula A 2( w)h 2w in column E.
Use the formula V wh in column F. V 1
3 (3 )(16)
2 V 1
3 (4 )(9)
2
1
3 (8 )(20)
2
1340.4
13-2 Volumes of Pyramids and Cones The volume is approximately 1340.4 ft3.
7. Use the formula for the volume of a cone.
Page 696 Geometry Activity: Investigating the V 1
3 Bh
Volume of a Pyramid 1
3 (38,000)(77)
1. It took 3 pyramids of rice.
975,333.3
2. The areas of the bases are the same.
The volume is approximately 975,333.3 ft3.
453 Chapter 13
Pages 699–701 Practice and Apply a2 b2 c2
8. Find the area of the base first. 7.52 h2 (103)2
56.25 h ¬300
2
h2 ¬243.75
h ¬15.612
For the pyramid,
C
V 1
3 Bh
72
6 1
3 (20)(15)(15.612)
1561.2
The volume of the pyramid is approximately
A D B 1561.2 ft3.
Apothem: The central angles of the pentagon are 10. Use the Pythagorean Theorem with h pyramid
36
0
all congruent, so mACB D
5 or 72. C is an height.
apothem of the pentagon. It bisects ACB and is a2 b2 c2
B
a perpendicular bisector of A. So, mACD 36. 92 h2 152
Since the side of the pentagon has measure 6, 81 h2 ¬225
AD 3. h2 ¬144
3 h ¬12
tan36° ¬
CD For the pyramid,
3
CD ¬tan V 1
36° 3 Bh
¬4.13 1
3 (24)(18)(12)
perimeter 5(6) 30 cm
1728
Base area: A ¬1
2 Pa The volume of the pyramid is 1728 in3.
¬1
11. Use the Pythagorean Theorem with h cone
2 (30)(4.13)
height.
¬61.95
a2 b2 c2
Now find the volume of the pyramid. 182 h2 302
V ¬1
3 Bh 324 h2 ¬900
h2 ¬576
¬1
3 (61.95)(10) h ¬24
¬206.5 For the cone,
The volume of the pyramid is approximately
V 1
3 r h
2
206.5 cm3.
9. Find the height of the pyramid by first finding the 1
3 (18 )(24)
2
1
3 (52
)2(52
)
370.2
The volume is approximately 370.2 in3
10 10
13. r
The height of this triangle is 103
.
Now use the Pythagorean Theorem with
h pyramid height.
h
The distance from the center of the base of the
pyramid to one of the 20-in. edges is 1
2 (15) or 7.5. A
30
36
10 3 h
7.5
Chapter 13 454
Use trigonometry to find the radius of the base. 15. Use the Pythagorean Theorem with d diameter
1(36°) 18° of base.
2 a2 b2 c2
opposite
sin A ¬
hypotenuse d2 52 132
r d2 25 ¬169
sin18° ¬
30 d2 ¬144
r ¬30sin18° d ¬12
r ¬9.2705 For the cone, the radius is 21(12) or 6. The volume is
Similarly, find the height.
adjacent V 1
3 Bh
cosA ¬
hypotenuse
h
1
3 r h
2
cos 18°
30
1
3 (6 )(5)
2
h ¬30 cos 18°
h ¬28.5317 188.5
Now find the volume. The volume is approximately 188.5 cm3.
16. The radius of the base is r 1
2 (24) 12.
V 1
3 r h
2
Use the 30°-60°-90° triangle to find the height,
1
3 (9.2705) (28.5317)
2
which is the shorter leg: h 1
2 (15) 7.5.
2567.8 For the cone,
The volume of the cone is approximately
V 1
3 r h
2
2567.8 m3.
14. Calculate the area of the base, B, first. 1
3 (12 )(7.5)
2
1131.0
The volume is approximately 1131.0 ft3.
17. Find the height of the pyramid portion by first
finding the height of one of the triangular sides
(the pyramid slant height). Use the Pythagorean
15 15 Theorem.
h1
8 10 10
4
h1
1(8) 4. Now use the Pythagorean Theorem to
2
find the height of the triangular base.
a2 b2 c2
12
42 h12 152 6
16 h12 ¬225 a2 b2 c2
h12 ¬209 62 h12 102
h1 ¬209
36 h12 ¬100
Now calculate the area of the base. h12 ¬64
B 1
2 bh1
h1 ¬8
Now find the height of the pyramid, again using
1
2 (8)(209
)
the Pythagorean Theorem.
4209
Now find the height of the pyramid.
a2 b2 c2
152 h22 172 8 8
225 h22 ¬289 h2
h22 ¬64
h2 ¬8
For the pyramid, 12
6
V 1
3 Bh2
1
3 (4209
)(8)
154.2
The volume is approximately 154.2 m3.
455 Chapter 13
a2 b2 c2 a2 b2 ¬c2
62 h22 82 (24 16)2 h2 ¬102
36 h22 ¬64 64 h2 ¬100
h22 ¬28 h2 ¬36
h ¬6 cm
h2 ¬27
Let x equal the height of the “missing” cone. By
volume of solid volume of cube
using similar triangles,
volume of pyramid 16 x
24 ¬ x 6
s3 1
3 Bh2
2 ¬x
123 1
3 (12)(12)(27
) 3 x6
1982.0 2(x 6) ¬3x
2x 12 ¬3x
The volume is approximately 1982.0 mm3.
x ¬12 cm
18. Calculate the area of the hexagon first. The
center-to-vertex distance, s, which in a regular volume of frustum ¬volume of large cone
hexagon equals the side length, is found using the volume of “missing” cone
Pythagorean Theorem. ¬1 1 2
3 r (x h) 3 r x
2
¬1
2 1
3 (24 )(12 6) 3 (16 )(12)
2
¬7640.4 cm3
10 20. r 1
2 (103) 51.5 km, h 4.17 km
9.3
V 1
3 r h
2
1
3 (51.5 )(4.17)
2
s 11,581.9
a b ¬c2
2 2 The volume is approximately 11,581.9 km3.
s2 9.32 ¬102 21. m
3.776 k
s2 86.49 ¬100 9
s2 ¬13.51 Use trigonometry to find the radius of the base.
s ¬13.51
3.7
76
Apothem: tan 9° ¬ r
3.7
76
r ¬
tan 9°
¬23.840726
V 1
3 r h
2
¬1
3 (23.840726 )(3.776)
2
30 2247.5
The volume is approximately 2247.5 km3.
22.
1
2 13.51
410
1213.51
The apothem is 3 . 33
perimeter 613.51
r
Use trigonometry to find the radius of the base.
Area: A 1
2 Pa 410
tan 33° ¬r
1
3
2 (613.51
) 2 13.51 r ¬ 41
0
tan 33°
35.1 ¬631.344635
volume of solid ¬2 volume of one pyramid
V 1
3 r h
2
¬2 1
3 Bh 1
3 (631.344635 )(410)
2
¬2 1
3 (35.1)(9.3) 171,137,610.4
¬217.6 ft3 The volume is approximately 171,137,610 m3.
19. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
of the frustum.
16 mm
10
24 mm 24 16 mm
Chapter 13 456
23. r 1
2 (22.3) 11.15
30. Side view of tower with “missing portion”:
V 1
3 r h
2
1
3 (11.15 )(1.22)
2
158.8
The volume is approximately 158.8 km3.
24. 2
3 ; The volume of each pyramid that makes up the
h
solid on the left is 1
3 of the volume of the prism, so
the total volume of the solid on the left is 1 1
3 3
or 2
3 of the volume of the prism. 8
25. Use the formula for the volume of a pyramid.
V 1
3 Bh
1
2
3 (755 )(481)
35
91,394,008.3
The original volume of the pyramid is
approximately 91,394,008.3 ft3.
26. Use the formula for the volume of a pyramid.
15
V 1
3 Bh By similar triangles,
1
2
3 (755 )(449) 8
15
h
h 35
85,313,741.7 8h 280 ¬15h
The present day volume of the pyramid is 280 ¬7h
approximately 85,313,741.7 ft3. h ¬40 ft
volume of frustum ¬volume of large pyramid
27. 91,394,008.33 85,313,741.67 6,080,266.7
volume of “missing” portion
Approximately 6,080,266.7 cubic feet have been
lost. ¬1 1
3 B1h1 3 B2h2
28. The volume of the cone is 1
3 of the volume of the ¬1 1 2
3 (15 )(35 40) 3 (8 )(40)
2
cylinder, so
¬4771.7
probability 1 1
3
2
The volume of the frustum is approximately
3
4771.7 ft3.
29. Find the height of the pyramid using the 31. Calculate the slant height, using the fact that
Pythagorean Theorem. each face is an equilateral triangle.
A
12 30 12
8 8
h1
6 6
B C
5 5 The slant height equals 63 because it is the
a2 b2 c2 measure of the longer leg of the 30°-60°-90° right
52 h12 82 triangle. Now find the apothem of the base.
25 h12 ¬64
h12 ¬39
h1 ¬ 39 12 12
457 Chapter 13
36. V r2h
(82)(17)
3418.1
6 3 The volume is approximately 3418.1 m3.
h
37. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
of the triangle. One leg of the right triangle is 21(10)
or 5 ft.
2 3
a2 b2 ¬c2
h (23
2 )2 ¬(63)2
h 12 ¬108
2 13 13
h2 ¬96 h
h ¬4 6
Find the area of the base, B.
B 1
2 Pa 10 5
1 a2 b2 ¬c2
2 (36)(23
)
h2 52 ¬132
363 h2 25 ¬169
For the pyramid, h2 ¬144
V ¬1
h ¬12
3 Bh
For the prism, taking the triangles as bases,
¬1
3 (363
)(46) V ¬Bh
¬203.6 ¬1
2 (10)(12)(19)
The volume is approximately 203.6 in3. ¬1140
32. Sample answer: Architects use geometry to design The volume of the prism is 1140 ft3.
buildings that meet the needs of their clients. 38. Use the circumference to find the radius.
Answers should include the following. C ¬2 r
• The surface area at the top of a pyramid is 86 ¬2 r
much smaller than the surface area of the base. 43
There is less office space at the top, than on the
¬r
first floor. Now find the area.
• The silhouette of a pyramid-shaped building is T 4 r2
2
4
3
smaller than the silhouette of a rectangular 4
prism with the same height. If the light
2354.2
conditions are the same, the shadow cast by
the pyramid is smaller than the shadow cast The surface area is approximately 2354.2 cm2.
by the rectangular prism. 39. T 4 r2
33. B; V 1 4(64.5)
3 Bh 258
1
2
3b h The surface area is 258 yd2.
1
2
3 (2h) h
40. For the “missing” triangular corner,
4h 3 base 335 190 145
3 height 325 220 105
34. A; x3 9x x(x2 9) area of field ¬area of large rectangle
x(x2 9) or x(x2 9) area of “missing” triangle
x(x 3)(x 3) or x(x2 9) ¬w 1
2 bh
x(x2 9) is not one of the choices given. ¬(325)(335) 1
So the factors that could represent length, width, 2 (145)(105)
¬101,262.5
and height are x, x 3, and x 3.
The total area is 101,262.5 ft2.
41. 4 r2 4 (3.42)
145.27
Page 701 Maintain Your Skills
35. V Bh 42. 4
3 4
3 r 3 (7 )
3
(14)(12)(6) 1436.76
1008 43. 4 r2 4 (122)
The volume of the prism is 1008 in3. 1809.56
Chapter 13 458
Page 701 Practice Quiz 1 5. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
1. Use the formula for the volume of a cylinder. The of the triangular base.
radius is r 1
2 (4) or 2.
V r2h
(22)(10)
125.7
The volume is approximately 125.7 in3. 11 11
2. Use the formula for the volume of a cylinder.
The radius is r 1
2 (12) or 6.
V r2h
(62)(15)
1696.5 6
The volume is approximately 1696.5 m3. 3
3. First find the area of the hexagonal base. a2 b2 ¬c2
32 h2 ¬112
9 h2 ¬121
h2 ¬112
h ¬4 7
Now find the area of the base, B.
30 B ¬1
2 bh
6 ¬1
2 (6)(47
)
3
Apothem: A 30°-60°-90° triangle is formed by the ¬127
apothem and one-half of a side of the hexagon. For the pyramid,
The shorter leg of the triangle is 1
2 (6) or 3. The
apothem is the longer leg of the triangle or 33 . V ¬1
3 Bh
perimeter 6 6 36 ¬1
3 (127
)(4)
The area of the hexagonal base is
¬42.3
A 1
2 Pa The volume is approximately 42.3 in3.
1
2 (36)(33
)
543
For the prism, 13-3 Volumes of Spheres
V Bh
(54 3)(10)
935.3 Page 704 Check for Understanding
The volume is approximately 935.3 cm3. 1. The volume of a sphere was generated by adding
the volumes of an infinite number of small
4. r pyramids. Each pyramid has its base on the
surface of the sphere and its height from the base
to the center of the sphere.
2. Kenji; Winona divided the 12 by 3 before raising
h the result to the third power. Thus the order of
20
30 operations was not followed correctly.
3. V ¬4
3 r
3
¬4
3 (13 )
3
¬9202.8
Use a 30°-60°-90° triangle to find the radius of
The volume is approximately 9202.8 in3.
the base and the height.
4. The radius is 1
2 (12.5) 6.25.
r 1
2 (20) or 10 ft, and h 103
ft.
4
For the cone, V ¬3 r3
V ¬1 ¬4
3 (6.25 )
3
3 r h
2
¬1 ¬1022.7
3 (10 )(103
)
2
The volume is approximately 1022.7 cm3.
¬1813.8
The volume is approximately 1813.8 ft3.
459 Chapter 13
5. V ¬4
3 r
3 13. Use the circumference to find the radius.
¬4 C ¬2 r
3 (4 )
3
24 ¬2 r
¬268.1 12
¬r
The volume is approximately 268.1 in3.
6. Use the circumference to find the radius. Now find the volume.
C ¬2 r V ¬4
3 r
3
18 ¬2 r 3
¬4 12
3
9 ¬r
π ¬233.4
V ¬4 3 r
3 The volume is approximately 233.4 in3.
3
14. V ¬4
3 r
3
¬4 9
3 π
¬98.5 ¬4
3 (35.8 )
3
¬155.2 ¬68.6
The volume is approximately 155.2 m3. The volume is approximately 68.6 m3.
8. For the sphere, 16. radius 1 2 (28) 14
V ¬4
3 r
3 1
4
V ¬2 3 r3
¬4
3 (5 )
3
¬2
3 (14 )
3
50
0
¬ 3 ¬5747.0
For the cone, The volume is approximately 5747.0 ft3.
V ¬1 17. V ¬4
3 r
3
3 r h
2
¬1 ¬4
3 (12 )
3
3 (5 )(20)
2
¬50
0 ¬7238.2
3 The volume is approximately 7238.2 in3.
The two volumes are equal.
18. Find the radius.
Pages 704–706 Practice and Apply C ¬2 r
48 ¬2 r
9. V ¬4
3 r
3
24
¬r
¬4
3 (7.62 )
3
Now find the volume.
¬1853.3
The volume is approximately 1853.3 m3. V ¬4
3 r
3
3
10. radius 12 (33) 16.5
¬4 24
3
4
V ¬3 r3 ¬1867.6
The volume is approximately 1867.6 cm3.
¬4
3 (16.5 )
3
19. Use the formula for the volume of a sphere.
¬18,816.6 radius 1
2 (3476) 1738
The volume is approximately 18,816.6 in3.
V ¬4
3 r
3
11. radius 12 (18.4) 9.2
4 ¬4
3 (1738 )
3
V ¬3 r3
¬21,990,642,871
¬4
3 (9.2 )
3
The volume is approximately 21,990,642,871 km3.
¬3261.8 20. For the golf ball, r 1
2 (4.3) 2.15.
The volume is approximately 3261.8 ft3.
V ¬4
3 r
3
12. V ¬4
3 r
3
¬4
3 (2.15 )
3
3
¬4
3
3
2
¬41.63
¬2.7
The volume is approximately 2.7 cm3.
Chapter 13 460
For the tennis ball, r 1
2 (6.9) 3.45.
28. For the cylinder, r 1
2 (2.5) 1.25.
V ¬4 V r2h
3 r
3
(1.252)(7.5)
¬4
3 (3.45 )
3
36.82
¬172.01 For the three balls, r 12 (2.5) 1.25.
The difference is about 172.01 41.63 or
130.4 cm3.
V ¬3 4
3 r
3
¬4 (1.253)
21. For the cone, r 1
2 (4) 2.
¬24.54
V ¬1
3 r h
2 volume of empty space 36.82 24.54
12.3 in3
¬1
3 (2 )(10)
2
29. For the cube,
¬41.9 cm3 V ¬s3
For the ice cream, r 1
2 (4) 2.
216 ¬s3
6 ¬s
V ¬4
3 r
3
¬4
3 (2 )
3
¬33.5 cm3
Since the volume of the ice cream is less than the
volume of the cone, the cone will not overflow. r 3
33
volume of ice cream .5 3 2
22.
volume of cone 41.9
3 3
0.80
The cone will be about 80% filled.
23. V ¬4
3 r
3
¬4
3 (17 )
3
¬20,579.5
The volume is approximately 20,579.5 mm3. The radius of the sphere appears as r in the
figure. It is found by two applications of the
24. total volume “just right” percentage
Pythagorean Theorem. First, for the horizontal
20,579.5 0.59
right triangle:
12,141.9
a2 b2 ¬c2
The “just right” volume is approximately
32 32 ¬c2
12,141.9 mm3.
18 ¬c2
25. T 4 r2 18
¬c
4 (172) 32 ¬c
3631.68
Now for the vertical right triangle:
total area “wish for more” percentage
3631.7 0.32 a2 b2 ¬c2
1162.1 (32)2 32 ¬r2
The “wish for more” surface area is approximately 27 ¬r2
1162.1 mm2. 27 ¬r
26. A r2 33 ¬r
(172) For the sphere,
907.9 mm2 V ¬4
3 r
3
total area “wish for less” percentage
¬4
3 (33
)3
907.9 0.09
81.7 ¬587.7
The area of the “wish for less” sector is The volume of the sphere is approximately
approximately 81.7 mm2. 587.7 in3.
27. For the sphere, 30. Find the radius.
T ¬4 r2
V ¬4
3 r
3
784 ¬4 r2
¬4
3 (6 )
3 196 ¬r2
14 ¬r
¬288 cm3
Now find the volume.
For the cylinder,
V r2h V ¬4
3 r
3
(62)(12)
¬4
3 (14 )
3
432
volume of sphere 288 ¬11,494.0
2
432 3
The surface area is approximately 11,494.0 in3.
volume of cylinder
461 Chapter 13
31. total area area of curved half-sphere 40. Use the formula for the volume of a rectangular
area of flat bottom prism.
V ¬Bh
T 1
2 (4 r ) r
2 2
25.9 ¬(2.4)(5.0)
Find the radius. 25.9 ¬12
18.75 ¬3 r2 2.2 ¬
6.25 ¬r2 The depth is approximately 2.2 ft.
2.5 ¬r 41. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
Now find the volume. (x 2)2 [y (1)]2 ¬82
(x 2)2 (y 1)2 ¬64
V ¬1
4 3
2 3 r 42. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
¬2
3 (2.5 )
3
[x (4)]2 [y (3)]2 ¬(19)
2
¬1
3 (7.5 )(7)
2
¬412.3
The volume is approximately 412.3 m3.
Chapter 13 462
Page 710 Check for Understanding Pages 711–713 Practice and Apply
1. Sample answer: 7 in. 11. The bases have different shapes, so the two
5 in.
7 in. pyramids are neither congruent nor similar.
5 in.
12. The spheres are identical in shape but not in size
(unless a b), so they are considered similar.
13. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height
7 in. of the second cylinder.
6 in. a2 b2 ¬c2
12 in. 8 in.
122 h2 ¬202
144 h2 ¬400
h2 ¬256
2. If two solids are similar with a scale factor of
h ¬16 in.
a : b, then the surface areas have a ratio of a2 : b2
Since the two cylinders have the same height and
and the volumes have a ratio of a3 : b3.
diameter (2 6 12), they are congruent.
3. The two cones are of exactly the same shape and base edge of larger pyramid 12
6
size, so they are congruent. 14.
base edge of smaller pyramid 43
height of larger cylinder
4. 30
3 2
height of smaller cylinder 20
height of larger pyramid
36
6
3
2 height of smaller pyramid 122
diameter of larger cylinder 22
.5 33
15 Since the ratios are not the same, the pyramids
diameter of smaller cylinder
3
2
are neither congruent nor similar.
length of smaller prism10
15. 2
The two solids are similar. Since the scale factor length of larger prism 15 3
is not 1, they are not congruent.
width of smaller prism 1
height of larger pyramid 24 3
5. 18
width of larger prism
height of smaller pyramid
Since the ratios are not the same, the pyramids
4
3 are neither congruent nor similar.
The scale factor is 4 : 3. 16. The cubes are identical in shape but not in size,
surface area of larger pyramid 2
6. a2 so they are similar (but not congruent).
surface area of smaller pyramid b
2 17. 26 5
1 130 m high
42
3
49 5
1 245 m wide
16
9
93 5
1 465 m long
The ratio of the surface areas is 16 : 9.
volume of larger pyramid 3 18. Always; spheres have only one measure to
7. a3 compare.
volume of smaller pyramid b
43
3
19. Always; congruent solids have equal dimensions.
3
64 20. Sometimes; if the solids have a scale factor of 1,
27
the volumes will be equal.
The ratio of the volumes is 64 : 27. 21. Never; different solids cannot be similar.
diameter of smaller ball 2
8. 22. Never; different solids cannot be similar.
diameter of larger ball 16
23. Sometimes; solids that are not similar can have
1
8 the same surface area.
The scale factor is 1 : 8. 1
2
surface area of smaller ball a
24. 15
1000 0.015
9.
surface area of larger ball b2 The Micro-Car door handle is 0.015 cm long.
2
12 00 2
10 1,000,000
8 25. x 1 x 1
1
64 1,000,000x
The ratio of the surface areas is 1 : 64. The full-sized car’s surface area is 1,000,000x cm2.
volume of smaller ball 3
10. a3 26. 15 1 15
18 18
volume of larger ball b
5
3
13
8 6
1 The miniature door handle would be 5
6 or about
512 0.83 cm long.
The ratio of the volumes is 1 : 512.
463 Chapter 13
perimeter of smaller prism volume of smaller ball
29 3
27. 35. 3
perimeter of larger prism volume of larger ball 30
24,389
height of smaller prism’s base
27,0
00
height of larger prism’s base
The ratio of the volumes is 24,389 : 27,000.
4
10
36. 32 ft 32 12 384 in.
2
5
length of gigantic ear of corn
384
length of real ear of corn 10
The ratio of the perimeters of the bases is 2 : 5. 19
2
5
surface area of smaller prism 2
28. a2 The scale factor is 192 : 5.
surface area of larger prism b
2 2 37. Let V volume of normal kernel.
2
5 231 a3
4 V ¬b
3
25 3
¬ 2
19
The ratio of the surface areas is 4 : 25. 53
7,077,888
volume of smaller prism 3 ¬ 12
29. a3 5
volume of larger prism b
3 28,875 ¬7,077,888V
23 V ¬0.004
5
8
125 The volume of a normal kernel is approximately
The ratio of the volumes is 8 : 125. 0.004 in3.
5
30. Let V volume of larger prism. 38. scale factor
10
48 8
V ¬
1
125 2
6000 ¬8V volume of smaller cone
a
3
Chapter 13 464
41. The volume of the cone on top is equal to the sum 49. r
of the volumes of the cones inside the cylinder.
Justification: Call h the height of both solids. The
volume of the cone on top is 1
3 r h. If the height
2
A
of one cone inside the cylinder is c, then the 13
h
height of the other one is h c. Therefore, the
sum of the volume of the two cones is: 1 3 r c
2
1 1 1
r2(h c) or r2(c h c) or r2h.
3 3 3 46
42. Sample answer: Scale factors relate the actual
object to the miniatures. Answers should include
the following.
Use trigonometry to find the radius of the base.
• The scale factors that are commonly used are
1 : 24, 1 : 32, 1 : 43, and 1 : 64. 1(46°) ¬23°
2
opposite
• The actual object is 108 in. long. sinA ¬
hypotenuse
smallarea 2
a
large area ¬ b2
43. C; r
sin23° ¬
13
¬4
9
r ¬13sin23°
2
¬22 ¬5.0795
3
Similarly, find the height.
scale factor 2
3 adjacent
3 cosA ¬
hypote
nuse
a
sm all vo lume
large volume b3 h
3 cos23° ¬
1
23 3
3
8 h ¬13cos23°
or 8 : 27
27 ¬11.967
yz xyz
44. D; xy xy y
z Now find the volume.
y2z
V ¬1
3 r h
2
4
5 or 0.8
¬1
3 (5.0795) (11.967)
2
¬323.3
Page 713 Maintain Your Skills The volume is approximately 323.3 in3.
45. radius 12 (8) 4
50. V 1
3 Bh
4
V 3 r3
1
3 (11)(7)(15)
4
3 (4 )
3
385
268.1 The volume of the pyramid is 385 m3.
The volume is approximately 268.1 ft3. 51. Use trigonometry to find the radius of the base.
opposite
46. V 4
3 r
3 tanA ¬
adjacent
4
3 (9.5 )
3 21
tan62° ¬
r
3591.4 r ¬ 21
tan 62°
The volume is approximately 3591.4 m3.
¬11.166
47. V 4
3 r
3
Now find the volume.
4
3 (15.1 )
3
V ¬1
3 r h
2
14,421.8 ¬1
3 (11.166) (21)
2
The volume is approximately 14,421.8 cm3.
¬2741.8
48. radius 12 (23) 11.5
The volume is approximately 2741.8 ft3.
4
V 3 r3 52. Start with the formula for the surface area of a
cylinder.
4
3 (11.5 )
3
T ¬2 rh 2 r2
6370.6 430 ¬2 r(7.4) 2 r2
The volume is approximately 6370.6 in3. Solve for r.
2 r2 14.8 r 430 0
465 Chapter 13
Use the Quadratic Formula. 57. y 3x 5
b b
2 4ac Use x 4, y 17.
r ¬
2a 17 3(4) 5
14.8 (14.8
430)
)2 4(2 )( 17 12 5
¬ 2(2 ) 17 17
¬5.4 or 12.8 Yes, the ordered pair is on the graph.
Since the radius cannot be negative, discard 58. y 4x 1
12.8. Use x 2, y 9.
The radius is approximately 5.4 cm. 9 4(2) 1
53. Start with the formula for the surface area of a 981
cylinder. 99
T ¬2 rh 2 r2 Yes, the ordered pair is on the graph.
224.7 ¬2 r(10) 2 r2 59. y 7x 4
Solve for r. Use x 1, y 3.
2 r2 20 r 224.7 0 3 7(1) 4
Use the Quadratic Formula. 3 7 4
b b
2 4ac 3 11
r ¬ 2a
No, the ordered pair is not on the graph.
20
(20 )2 24.7)
4(2 )(2
¬ 2(2 )
¬2.8 or 12.8 Page 713 Practice Quiz 2
Since the radius cannot be negative, discard
1. V ¬4
3 r
3
12.8.
The radius is approximately 2.8 yd. ¬4
3 (25.3)
3
Chapter 13 466
2. Sample answer: Use the point at (2, 3, 4); 8. First, write a vertex matrix.
A(2, 3, 4), B(2, 0, 4), C(0, 0, 4), D(0, 3, 4), E(2, 3, 0), M N P Q R S T V
F(2, 0, 0), G(0, 0, 0), and H(0, 3, 0). x 0 3 3 0 0 0 3 3
z y 0 0 4 4 0 4 4 0
D (0, 3, 4) z 0 0 0 0 2 2 2 2
C (0, 0, 4)
Next, multiply each element by the scale factor, 2.
B (2, 0, 4) M N P Q R S T V
A (2, 3, 4)
0 3 3 0 0 0 3 3
G (0, 0, 0) H (0, 3, 0) 2 0 0 4 4 0 4 4 0
O y 0 0 0 0 2 2 2 2
F (2, 0, 0)
M N P Q R S T V
x
E (2, 3, 0)
0 6 6 0 0 0 6 6
0 0 8 8 0 8 8 0
3. A dilation of a rectangular prism will provide a
0 0 0 0 4 4 4 4
similar figure, but not a congruent one unless
r 1 or r 1. The coordinates of the vertices of the dilated
4. z image are M(0, 0, 0), N(6, 0, 0), P(6, 8, 0),
C (0, 0, 5) D (0, 1, 5) Q(0, 8, 0), R(0, 0, 4), S(0, 8, 4), T(6, 8, 4), and
V(6, 0, 4).
B (2, 0, 5)
z V
A (2, 1, 5) T
G (0, 0, 0) N
4 P
O H (0, 1, 0) y R 4 S
F (2, 0, 0) M
E (2, 1, 0)
x O 4 Q y
x
5. z
9. Write the coordinates of each corner. Then use the
Q ( 1, 0, 2) translation equation (x, y, z) → (x 48, y, z 16)
P ( 1, 4, 2) to find the coordinates of each vertex of the
R (0, 0, 2) rectangular prism that represents the storage
S (0, 4, 2)
U ( 1, 0, 0) container.
V (0, 0, 0) T ( 1, 4, 0)
O W (0, 4, 0) y Coordinates of the Translated coordinates,
x
vertices, (x, y, z) (x 48, y, z 16)
Preimage Image
6. DE
(x2 x 2
1) (y 2 y
1) (z
2
2 z
1)
2
(12, 8, 8) (36, 8, 24)
(1 0
)2 (5
0)2
(7
0)2 (12, 0, 8) (36, 0, 24)
75
or 53
(0, 0, 8) (48, 0, 24)
x x y y z z (0, 8, 8) (48, 8, 24)
M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
(12, 8, 0) (36, 8, 16)
2, 2, 2
0 1 0 5 0 7
(12, 0, 0) (36, 0, 16)
1
2, 2, 2
5 7 (0, 0, 0) (48, 0, 16)
(0, 8, 0) (48, 8, 16)
7. GH
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
[5 (
3)]2
[3
(4)]2
(5
6)2
186
Pages 717–719 Practice and Apply
x x y y z z
M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
10. z
F ( 2, 0, 2)
2, 2, 2
3 5 4 3 6 5
H ( 2, 0, 0) C ( 2, 2, 2)
E (0, 0, 2) D (0, 2, 2)
1, 7
2, 2
1 G ( 2, 2, 0)
I (0, 0, 0)
O J (0, 2, 0) y
x
467 Chapter 13
11. z 16. KL (x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
S (0, 4, 1) T (0, 0, 1)
(2
2)2
(2
2)2
(0
0)2
W (0, 4, 0) O
32
or 42
A (0, 0, 0) y
x x y y z z
R (3, 4, 1)
U (3, 0, 1) M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
2 (2) 2 (2) 0 0
2, 2, 2
V (3, 4, 0) B (3, 0, 0)
x
(0, 0, 0)
12. z
17. PQ
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
O D (0, 6, 0)
[3 (2)]2
[2
(5)]2 (
1
8)2
A (0, 0, 0) y
115
E (0, 0, 3) x x y y z z
B (4, 0, 0) C (4, 6, 0) M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
G (0, 6, 3) 5
2 3 (1)
2
(2) 8
2 , 2 ,
x 2, 2, 2
1 7 7
5
13. 2 2
z 0 3 (3 0) 0 4 2
5
M (0, 0, 0) O 10
x x y y z z
N (0, 1, 0) y M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
I (0, 0, 3)
L (4, 0, 0)
3
03
5
2 , 2,
2
0 4
5 0
J (0, 1, 3)
3 3 2
10, 2, 5
K (4, 1, 0)
x
19. GH (x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
H (4, 0, 3)
1 1) 2 (1) (2 6)
(
G (4, 1, 3) 2 2
5 5
2
14. z
P ( 2, 4, 0) 17
Q ( 2, 0, 0) x x y y z z
S (0, 4, 0) R (0, 0, 0) M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
O y 1
1 1
6 2 25
5
2 ,
2 , 2
K ( 2, 4, 4)
L ( 2, 0, 4) 3
5 , 10 , 4
7
N (0, 4, 4) M (0, 0, 4)
20. ST (x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
x
( 6
)
(5 4 4
2 2 2
43 3 ) (2
)
2
15. z 31
x x y y z z
R ( 1, 3, 0)
Q ( 1, 0, 0)
M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
O
S (0, 3, 0) y
63
2
43, 5 42
4 2
2 , 2
P (0, 0, 0)
5
, 92,
53 2
2
W ( 1, 3, 6) 21. BC
(x2
(y2
y1)2
x1)2 (z2
z1)2
(2
3
3)2
(4 2
)2 (4
2 )2
22
x V ( 1, 0, 6) 39
x x y y z z
T (0, 3, 6) U (0, 0, 6) M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
3
2
23
, 2 42
4 22
2, 2
3
2 , 3, 32
Chapter 13 468
22. distance The coordinates of the dilated image are
(x
x G(8, 6, 4), H(8, 0, 4), J(0, 0, 4), K(0, 6, 4),
2
1)
(y2
y1)2
(z2
2 z1)2
L(8, 6, 0), M(0, 6, 0), N(0, 0, 0), P(8, 0, 0).
(240
50)240
(100)
12
(2.5
2)2
z
292.7
The distance is approximately 292.7 miles. K J 4
23. First, write a vertex matrix. 4
E M 4 N
A B C D H G F
O 4 y
x 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 G
y 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 H
4 4
z 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1
L P
Next, multiply each element by the scale factor, 3.
A B C D E H G F x
1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1
3 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 25. Write the coordinates of each corner. Then use the
1 1 1 1 1 1 1 1 translation equation (x, y, z) → (x 2, y 5,
z 5) to find the coordinates of each vertex of the
A B C D E H G F rectangular prism.
3 0 0 3 3 0 0 3
Coordinates of the Translated coordinates,
0 0 3 3 0 0 3 3
vertices, (x, y, z) (x 2, y 5, z 5)
3 3 3 3 3 3 3 3
Preimage Image
The coordinates of the dilated image are
P(2, 3, 3) P(0, 2, 2)
A(3, 0, 3), B(0, 0, 3), C(0, 3, 3), D(3, 3, 3),
E(3, 0, 3), H(0, 0, 3), G(0, 3, 3), and F(3, 3, 3). Q(2, 0, 3) Q(0, 5, 2)
z R(0, 0, 3) R(2, 5, 2)
H S(0, 3, 3) S(2, 2, 2)
G
T(2, 0, 0) T(0, 5, 5)
E U(2, 3, 0) U(0, 2, 5)
F
V(0, 3, 0) V(2, 2, 5)
O y
W(0, 0, 0) W(2, 5, 5)
26. Write the coordinates of each corner. Then use the
B C translation equation (x, y, z) → (x 2, y 1,
x
z 1) to find the coordinates of each vertex of the
A rectangular prism.
D
Coordinates of the Translated coordinates,
24. First, write a vertex matrix. vertices, (x, y, z) (x 2, y 1, z 1)
G H J K L M N P Preimage Image
x 4 4 0 0 4 0 0 4 A(2, 0, 1) A(0, 1, 0)
y 3 0 0 3 3 3 0 0
z 2 2 2 2 0 0 0 0 B(2, 0, 0) B(0, 1, 1)
Next, multiply each element by the scale factor, 2. C(2, 1, 0) C(0, 2, 1)
G H J K L M N P
D(2, 1, 1) D(0, 2, 0)
4 4 0 0 4 0 0 4 E(0, 0, 1) E(2, 1, 0)
2 3 0 0 3 3 3 0 0 F(0, 1, 1) F(2, 2, 0)
2 2 2 2 0 0 0 0
G(0, 1, 0) G(2, 2, 1)
G H J K L M N P
H(0, 0, 0) H(2, 1, 1)
8 8 0 0 8 0 0 8
6 0 0 6 6 6 0 0
4 4 4 4 0 0 0 0
469 Chapter 13
27. Write the coordinates of each corner. Then use the 29. Write a vertex matrix and multiply it by the scale
translation equation (x, y, z) → (x 1, y 2, factor, 2.
z 2) to find the coordinates of each vertex of the A B C D E F G H A B C D E F G H
cube. 3 3 0 0 3 3 0 0 6 6 0 0 6 6 0 0
Coordinates of the Translated coordinates, 2 3 0 0 3 3 0 0 3 6 0 0 6 6 0 0 6
vertices, (x, y, z) (x 1, y 2, z 2) 3 3 3 3 0 0 0 0 6 6 6 6 0 0 0 0
Preimage Image The coordinates of the dilated image are
A(3, 3, 3) A(4, 5, 1) A(6, 6, 6), B(6, 0, 6), C(0, 0, 6), D(0, 6, 6),
E(6, 6, 0), F(6, 0, 0), G(0, 0, 0), and H(0, 6, 0).
B(3, 0, 3) B(4, 2, 1)
z
C(0, 0, 3) C(1, 2, 1) C D
D(0, 3, 3) D(1, 5, 1)
E(3, 3, 0) E(4, 5, 2)
C
F(3, 0, 0) F(4, 2, 2) D
G(0, 0, 0) G(1, 2, 2) B A
H(0, 3, 0) H(1, 5, 2) B A H
G
G O H y
z
C F
D E
A
B C D x
F E
G
O H y
side length of dilated cube 6 units
B A V s3
F E H 63
G
x 216 units3
30. Write a vertex matrix and multiply it by the scale
F E
factor 1
3.
28. Write the coordinates of each corner. Then use the A B C D E F G H A B C D E F G H
translation equation (x, y, z) → (x 2, y 3,
3 3 0 0 3 3 0 0 1 1 0 0 1 1 0 0
z 2) to find the coordinates of each vertex of the 1 3 0 0 3 3 0 0 3 1 0 0 1 1 0 0 1
3
cube. 3 3 3 3 0 0 0 0 1 1 1 1 0 0 0 0
Coordinates of the Translated coordinates, The coordinates of the dilated image are
vertices, (x, y, z) (x 2, y 3, z 2) A(1, 1, 1), B(1, 0, 1), C(0, 0, 1), D(0, 1, 1),
Preimage Image E(1, 1, 0), F(1, 0, 0), G(0, 0, 0), and H(0, 1, 0).
A(3, 3, 3) A(1, 0, 5)
z
B(3, 0, 3) B(1, 3, 5)
C(0, 0, 3) C(2, 3, 5) C
D
D(0, 3, 3) D(2, 0, 5)
E(3, 3, 0) E(1, 0, 2) D
F(3, 0, 0) F(1, 3, 2) B
C
G(0, 0, 0) G(2, 3, 2) B A A
H(0, 3, 0) H(2, 0, 2) G H H y
G
F E
C z
D
F E
A
B
G H x
C D
E
The scale factor is 1
3 , so the ratio of the volumes
F
B A for these two cubes is
G H volume of new cube 3
1 1
2
7.
O y
volume of original cube 33
F E
x
Chapter 13 470
31. first balloon location: (12, 12, 0.4) 36. The cube extends from x 2 4 2 to
second balloon location: (4, 10, 0.3) x 2 4 6, from y 4 4 0 to y 4 4 8,
and from z 6 4 2 to z 6 4 10. So the
distance (x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
coordinates of the vertices are A(2, 0, 2),
[4
(12)] 2 [
10 (12
)]2 [
0.3
0.4]2 B(6, 0, 2), C(6, 8, 2), D(2, 8, 2), E(2, 8, 10),
8.2 F(6, 8, 10), G(6, 0, 10), and H(2, 0, 10).
The distance between the balloons is z
approximately 8.2 miles. H E
x1 x2 y1 y2 z1 z2
32. M 2, 2, 2
2x 4y 7z
(5, 1, 2) 22 , 22 , 22 G F
2x 4y 7z A
5 ¬22 1 ¬22 2 ¬22 2 D
10 ¬2 x2 2 ¬4 y2 4 ¬7 z3
O 2 y
8 ¬x2 2 ¬y2 3 ¬z3
B C
Point B has coordinates (8, 2, 3). 4
33. The center of the sphere is the midpoint of the x
diameter. 37. Sample answer: Three-dimensional graphing is
x x y y z z
M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
used in computer animation to render images and
8 x 10 y 2 z
allow them to move realistically. Answers should
(4, 2, 6) 2, 2, 2
2 2 2
include the following.
8x 10 y 2 z • Ordered triples are a method of locating and
4 22 2 ¬22 6 ¬22 naming points in space. An ordered triple is
8 8 x2 4 ¬10 y2 12 ¬2 z2 unique to one point.
0 x2 14 ¬y2 14 ¬z2 • Applying transformations to points in space
The other endpoint has coordinates (0, 14, 14). would allow an animator to create realistic
movement in animation.
34. Use the midpoint formula with the endpoints of
x x y y z z
the diameter.
x1 x2 y1 y2 z1 z2
38. C;
M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
M ¬ 2, 2, 2 5 x 4 y 2 z
(4, 5, 3) 2, 2, 2 2 2 2
center 12
, 10 2
14 , 12 2
8 2
5x 4 y 2 z
2 4 22 5 ¬22 3 22
¬(1, 1, 7)
The radius is the distance from the center (1, 1, 7) 8 5 x2 10 4 y2 6 2 z2
to (14, 8, 2). Let the center be the point 3 x2 6 ¬y2 8 z2
(xc, yc, zc). The other endpoint has coordinates (3, 6, 8).
radius
(x2
xc)2
(y2
yc)2
(z2
zc)2 39. B; x 1 ¬x 1
x 1 ¬(x 1)2
(14
1)2
(8
1)2
(2 7
)2 x 1 ¬x2 2x 1
275 or 511 0 ¬x2 3x
35. The prism has moved down 5 units, right 3 units, 0 ¬x (x 3)
and forward 2 units. x 0 or x 3
(x, y, z) → (x 2, y 3, z 5) Check if each value satisfies the original
equation.
0 1 ¬0 1 3 1 ¬3 1
1 ¬1 4 ¬2
✓
1 ¬1 2 ¬2
So the solution is x 3.
40. The locus of points in space that satisfy the graph
of x y 5 is a plane perpendicular to the
xy-plane whose intersection with the xy-plane is
the graph of y x 5.
41. The locus of points in space that satisfy the graph
of x z 4 is a plane perpendicular to the
xz-plane whose intersection with the xz-plane is
the graph of z x 4.
471 Chapter 13
Page 719 Maintain Your Skills Pages 720–722 Lesson-by-Lesson Review
width of smaller prism 9 11. V Bh
42.
width of larger prism 18 (18)(7)(4)
1
504
2
height of smaller prism
The volume of the prism is 504 in3.
7
13 12. V r2h
height of larger prism
(32)(11)
Since the ratios are not the same, the prisms are
311.0
neither similar nor congruent.
The volume is approximately 311.0 m3.
2
diameter of smaller cylinder 5
43. 15 13. The 15-ft diagonal forms a right triangle with the
diameter of larger cylinder
height and width. Use the Pythagorean Theorem
2
3 to find the width.
height of smaller cylinder 12
a2 b2 ¬c2
height of larger cylinder 18
2 w2 32 ¬152
3 w2 9 ¬225
The two cylinders are similar. Since the scale w2 ¬216
factor is not 1, they are not congruent. w ¬66 ft
44. V 4
3 r
3 Now find the volume.
4 V Bh
3 (10 )
3
(17)(66 )(3)
4188.8 749.5
The volume is approximately 4188.8 cm3.
The volume is approximately 749.5 ft3.
45. radius 12 (13) 6.5 yd
14. First find the area of the hexagonal base.
4
V 3 r3
4
3 (6.5 )
3
1150.3
The volume is approximately 1150.3 yd3.
46. V 4
3 r
3
30
4
3 (17.2 )
3
21,314.4 3
1.5
The volume is approximately 21,314.4 m3.
Apothem: A 30°-60°-90° triangle is formed by the
47. radius 1
2 (29) 14.5 ft
apothem and one-half of a side of the hexagon.
V 4
3 r
3 The shorter leg of the triangle is 1
2 (3) or 1.5.
4
3 (14.5 )
3 The apothem is the longer leg of the triangle or
12,770.1 1.53.
The volume is approximately 12,770.1 ft3. perimeter 3 6 18
Area: A ¬1
2 Pa
1
¬2(18)(1.53
)
Chapter 13 Study Guide and Review ¬13.53
Now find the volume of the pyramid.
Page 720 Vocabulary and Concept Check V ¬1
1. pyramid 3 Bh
2. Congruent ¬1
)(14)
3 (13.53
3. an ordered triple ¬109.1
4. cylinder The volume is approximately 109.1 cm3.
5. similar 15. radius 1
2 (15) 7.5
6. prism Use the Pythagorean Theorem to find the height.
7. the Distance Formula in Space a2 b2 ¬c2
7.52 h2 262
8. sphere
56.25 h2 ¬676
9. Cavalieri’s Principle h2 ¬619.75
10. cone h ¬619.7
5
Chapter 13 472
For the cone, Now solve for .
V 1 232 ¬22 56
3 r h
2
176 ¬22
¬1
3 (7.5 )(619.7
2 5 ) 8 ¬
¬1466.4 For the right solid, the surface area is
The volume is approximately 1466.4 ft3. T ¬Ph 2B
232 ¬2(8 7)(h) 2(8 7)
16. V ¬1
3 Bh Now solve for h.
¬1 232 ¬30h 112
3 (17)(5)(13)
120 ¬h
¬368.3
4 ¬h
The volume is approximately 368.3 m3.
The solids have the same dimensions, so they are
17. V ¬4
3 r
3 congruent.
¬4
3 (2 )
3 23. Two spheres with different radii are similar,
though not congruent.
¬33.5
24. AB (x2
x1)2 (y2
y1)2 (z2 z1)2
The volume is approximately 33.5 ft3.
18. radius 1
2 (4) 2
[3 (
5)]2
[8
(
8)]2
[4
(2)]2
V ¬4 100
10
3 r
3
x x y y z z
¬4
3 (2 )
3 M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
3 8 (8)
¬33.5 5
¬ 2
, 2, 22 4
The volume is approximately 33.5 ft3. ¬(1, 8, 1)
19. Find the radius.
25. CD
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
C ¬2 r
65 ¬2 r ¬
[9
(9)]2
[9
2]2
[7
4]2
65
¬r ¬58
2 x x y y z z
Now find the volume. M
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
V ¬4
3 r
3 9 (9)
¬ , 2 9 47
3 2 2, 2
3 2
¬4 65
¬(9, 5.5, 5.5)
¬4637.6 26. EO ¬(x
2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
The volume is approximately 4637.6 mm3. ¬
(4
0)2
(5 0
)2 (5
0)2
20. Find the radius. ¬66
T ¬4 r2 x x y y z z
126 ¬4 r2 M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
4
, 5 0 50
63
¬r2
2 ¬ 2
0
2, 2
63
2 ¬r
¬(2, 2.5, 2.5)
Now find the volume. 27. FG
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
V ¬4 (2
5
2 )2 (
2
37 )
37 2 (
12 6
)2
3 r
3
422
3
3
¬4
63
2 x x y y z z
¬133.0
M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
6 (12)
The volume is approximately 133.0 cm3.
¬
52
2
22
, 37 2
37
, 2
21. Find the radius.
¬(1.52
, 37
, 3)
A ¬ r2
25 ¬ r2
25 ¬r2
5 ¬r Chapter 13 Practice Test
Now find the volume.
V ¬4
3 r
3 Page 723
¬4 1. b
3 (5 )
3
2. c
¬523.6
The volume is approximately 523.6 units3. 3. a
22. For the left solid, the surface area is
T ¬Ph 2B
232 2( 7)(4) 2( 7)
473 Chapter 13
4. The diameter of the base, the diagonal, and the Find the height using the Pythagorean Theorem
lateral edge form a right triangle. Find the and the fact that for a regular hexagon the
diameter using the Pythagorean Theorem. distance from the center to a vertex is the same
a2 b2 ¬c2 as the side length.
82 d2 ¬102
64 d2 ¬100
d2 ¬36
d ¬6 yd
radius 12 (6) 3
13
Now find the volume, using the formula for a h
cylinder.
V ¬ r2h
¬ (32)(8)
¬226.2
The volume is approximately 226.2 yd3. 5
5. Use the formula for a rectangular prism. a2 ¬c2
b2
V ¬Bh 52 h ¬132
2
¬(6)(14)(10) 25 h2 ¬169
¬840 h2 ¬144
The volume of the prism is 840 mm3. h ¬12 m
6. Find the width using the Pythagorean Theorem. Now find the volume.
a2 b2 ¬c2 V ¬1
3 Bh
72 w2 (74 )2
49 w2 ¬74 ¬31 (37.53
)(12)
w2 ¬25 ¬259.8
w ¬5 The volume is approximately 259.8 m3.
Now find the volume, using the formula for a
9. Use the formula for a cone.
rectangular prism.
V ¬Bh radius 1
2 (8.2) 4.1
¬(7)(5)(2) V ¬1
3 r h
2
¬70
¬1
3 (4.1 )(6.8)
2
The volume of the prism is 70 km3.
7. Use the formula for a pyramid. ¬119.7
The volume is approximately 119.7 cm3.
V ¬1
3 Bh 10. Use the formula for an oblique cone.
¬1
3 (5)(5)(3) First find the radius.
¬25 C ¬2 r
The volume of the pyramid is 25 ft3. 22 ¬2 r
11 ¬r
8. First find the area of the hexagonal base.
Now find the volume.
V ¬1
3 Bh
¬31 r2h
¬1
3 (11 )(9)
2
30
¬1140.4
The volume is approximately 1140.4 in3.
2.5
11. The length, the width, and the diagonal form a
5
right triangle. Use the Pythagorean Theorem to
Apothem: A 30°-60°-90° triangle is formed by the
find the width w.
apothem and one-half of a side of the hexagon.
a2 b2 c2
The shorter leg of the triangle is 1
2 (5) or 2.5. 782 w2 110.32
The apothem is the longer leg of the triangle or 6084 w2 ¬12,166.09
2.53. w2 ¬6082.09
perimeter 5 6 30 w ¬77.98776 ft
Area: A ¬1
2 Pa
¬1 )
2 (30)(2.53
¬37.53
Chapter 13 474
Consider the water as a rectangular prism. Now surface area of larger cylinder 2
find the volume in cubic feet, multiplied by a 17. ¬a
b2
surface area of smaller cylinder
conversion factor of 71
2 gallons per cubic foot.
2
¬
15
10
V ¬Bh71
2
2
¬3
2
¬(78)(77.98776)(17)(7.5)
2
¬775,588 ¬3
22
The volume of water is approximately
775,588 gal. ¬9
4
The ratio of the surface areas is 9 : 4.
12. V ¬4
3 r
3
3
volume of larger cylinder
a
¬4 volume of smaller cylinder ¬ b3
18.
3 (3 )
3
3
¬113.1 ¬
10
15
The volume is approximately 113.1 cm3. 3
¬3
2
13. Find the radius.
C ¬2 r ¬3
3
23
34 ¬2 r 2
7
17 ¬ 8
¬r
The ratio of the volumes is 27 : 8.
Now find the volume.
19. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
V ¬4
3 r
3
3 ¬
(0 0
)2 (
3 0
)2 (5
0)2
3
¬4 17
¬34
x x y y z z
¬663.7
The volume is approximately 663.7 ft3.
M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
0 0 (3) 0 5
14. Find the radius. ¬ 2 , 2, 2
0
T ¬4 r2
¬(0, 1.5, 2.5)
184 ¬4 r2
46 20. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
¬r
2
r ¬3.8265 ¬
(1
0)2
(10
0)2
(5
0)2
Now find the volume. ¬126
or 314
x x y y z z
V ¬4
3 r
3
M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
¬4 0 (1)
¬ 10 0 (5)
2 , 2
0
3 (3.8265 )
3
,
2
¬234.7 ¬(0.5, 5, 2.5)
The volume is approximately 234.7 in3.
21. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
15. Find the radius.
A ¬ r2 ¬
(9 0
)2 (5
0)2
(
7 0
)2
157 ¬ r2 ¬155
x x y y z z
157
¬r
2
M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
r ¬7.06928 9 0 5 0 (7)
Now find the volume.
0
¬ 2 , 2, 2
V ¬4 ¬(4.5, 2.5, 3.5)
3 r
3
¬1479.8 ¬
[3
(2)]2
[
5 2
]2 [
4 2
]2
The volume is approximately 1479.8 mm3. ¬86
x x y y z z
radius of larger cylinder
16.
radius of smaller cylinder
M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
2 (3) 2 (5) 2 (4)
height of larger cylinder
height of smaller cylinder
¬ , ,
2 2 2
15 ¬(2.5, 1.5, 1)
10 23. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
3
2 ¬
(9
9)2
(7
3)2
(6
4)2
The ratio of the radii is 3 : 2.
¬428
or 2107
x x y y z z
M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
9 9 37 46
¬ 2 , 2, 2
¬(0, 2, 5)
475 Chapter 13
24. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2 12z 27z 6z
5 2 z
12 z
27 5 6z 2
9. 3z 3z 3z
3z
¬
(3
8)2 2
[5 (6)] (10
1)2
4z4 9z 2
¬323
10. Sierra: p → q
x x y y z z
M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
Carlos: q → p
Carlos formed the contrapositive.
8 (3)
¬ 2
,
6
2
, 1 2
5 10
11. If the measures of the corresponding sides are the
¬(2.5, 0.5, 5.5) same, the triangles are congruent.
25. C; V ¬Bh 12. From Theorem 8.2, the sum of eight exterior
360 ¬(15)w(2) angles is 360, so that one exterior angle
36
0
360 ¬30w measures 8 45.
12 ¬w
B 45 C
Chapter 13 Standardized Test Practice x
x
Pages 724–725 A
1. A; ACD and ACB together form the right
angle, BCD.
2. B; 5x° ¬x° 90°
4x° ¬90°
x ¬22.5
and since x mDEF 90,
22.5 mDEF ¬90 Because the octagon is regular, AB CB, and
mDEF ¬67.5 ABC is an isosceles triangle, so mA mC.
3. C; the third side length must be greater than By the Exterior Angle Theorem,
21 13 8 and less than 21 13 33. mA mC 45
4. C; from the statement QRS is similar to TUV, x x ¬45
we know that Q and T are corresponding 2x ¬45
angles. x ¬22.5
5. B; volume of drilled block volume of prism 13. Point A lies on the x-axis, b units to the left of
volume of cylinder D(0, c) just as B is b units to the right of C. The
coordinates of A are (b, 0).
Bh r2h
(11)(5)(8) (22)(8) 14. V ¬1
3 r h
2
339.5 cm3 ¬1
3 (10 )(18)
2
6. B; C ¬2 r
¬600 cm3
25 ¬2 r
25 15a. The surface area of the small can is 54 in2 and
¬r
2 the surface area of the large can is 90 in2.
V ¬4
3 r
3 When the height is doubled, the lateral area of
3 the cylinder is doubled, but the area of the bases
¬3
4
25
2 remains the same. The surface area increases by
¬264 in3 a factor of 12
3 times.
height of larger cylinder 16 15b. The volume of the small can is 54 in3 and the
height of smaller cylinder 12
7. C;
volume of the larger can is 108 in3. The volume
4
increases by a factor of 2.
3
r 16. volume of tank volume of cone
4.5 ¬4
3 volume of cylinder
3r ¬18 volume of hemisphere
3 r h1 r h2 2 3 r
¬1
r ¬6 2 2 1 4 3
V ¬ r2h
¬1
2 2 2
3 (5 )(15) (5 )(45) 3 (5 )
3
¬ (62)(16)
¬1809.6 cm3 ¬4188.8
8. D; r ¬(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2 The volume is approximately 4188.8 m3.
¬(9 3)
2 (
2 1
)2 (
2 4
)2
¬9
Chapter 13 476
Prerequisite Skills
Pages 728–729 Graphing Ordered Pairs 16–31. Graph for Ex. 16–31:
1. The x-coordinate is 2. y T
The y-coordinate is 3. D
The ordered pair is (2, 3). M E
2. The x-coordinate is 1. A G
The y-coordinate is 1. C
N
The ordered pair is (1, 1). O x
H S
3. The x-coordinate is 2. B
The y-coordinate is 2. R F I
The ordered pair is (2, 2). L
4. The x-coordinate is 3. P
The y-coordinate is 3. 16. Start at the origin. Move 1 unit left, since the
The ordered pair is (3, 3). x-coordinate is 1. Then move 3 units up, since
5. The x-coordinate is 3. the y-coordinate is 3. Draw a dot, and label it M.
The y-coordinate is 1. Point M(1, 3) is in Quadrant II.
The ordered pair is (3, 1). 17. Start at the origin. Move 2 units right, since the
6. The point lies on the y-axis, so its x-coordinate x-coordinate is 2. Since the y-coordinate is 0, the
is 0. The y-coordinate is 3. The ordered pair is point lies on the x-axis. Draw a dot, and label it S.
(0, 3). Because it is on one of the axes, point S(2, 0) is
not in any quadrant.
7. The x-coordinate is 4.
The y-coordinate is 1. 18. Start at the origin. Move 3 units left, since the
The ordered pair is (4, 1). x-coordinate is 3. Then move 2 units down, since
the y-coordinate is 2. Draw a dot, and label it R.
8. The x-coordinate is 3.
Point R(3, 2) is in Quadrant III.
The y-coordinate is 2.
The ordered pair is (3, 2). 19. Start at the origin. Move 1 unit right, since the
x-coordinate is 1. Then move 4 units down, since
9. The x-coordinate is 1.
the y-coordinate is 4. Draw a dot, and label it P.
The y-coordinate is 1.
Point P(1, 4) is in Quadrant IV.
The ordered pair is (1, 1).
20. Start at the origin. Move 5 units right, since the
10. The x-coordinate is 1.
x-coordinate is 5. Then move 1 unit down, since
The y-coordinate is 4.
the y-coordinate is 1. Draw a dot, and label it B.
The ordered pair is (1, 4).
Point B(5, 1) is in Quadrant IV.
11. The x-coordinate is 3. The point lies on the x-axis,
21. Start at the origin. Move 3 units right, since the
so its y-coordinate is 0. The ordered pair is (3, 0).
x-coordinate is 3. Then move 4 units up, since the
12. The x-coordinate is 2. y-coordinate is 4. Draw a dot, and label it D. Point
The y-coordinate is 4. D(3, 4) is in Quadrant I.
The ordered pair is (2, 4).
22. Start at the origin. Move 2 units right, since the
13. The x-coordinate is 2. x-coordinate is 2. Then move 5 units up, since the
The y-coordinate is 4. y-coordinate is 5. Draw a dot, and label it T. Point
The ordered pair is (2, 4). T(2, 5) is in Quadrant I.
14. The x-coordinate is 3. 23. Start at the origin. Move 4 units left, since the
The y-coordinate is 3. x-coordinate is 4. Then move 3 units down, since
The ordered pair is (3, 3). the y-coordinate is 3. Draw a dot, and label it L.
15. The x-coordinate is 4. Point L(4, 3) is in Quadrant III.
The y-coordinate is 2. 24. Start at the origin. Move 2 units left, since the
The ordered pair is (4, 2). x-coordinate is 2. Then move 2 units up, since
the y-coordinate is 2. Draw a dot, and label it A.
Point A(2, 2) is in Quadrant II.
25. Start at the origin. Move 4 units right, since the
x-coordinate is 4. Then move 1 unit up, since the
y-coordinate is 1. Draw a dot, and label it N. Point
N(4, 1) is in Quadrant I.
26. Start at the origin. Move 3 units left, since the
x-coordinate is 3. Then move 1 unit down, since
the y-coordinate is 1. Draw a dot, and label it H.
Point H(3, 1) is in Quadrant III.
O (0, 0) x
O x
X ( 3, 1) Z ( 1, 1) ( 1, 2)
G( 3, 2)
O x
H( 1, 3)
a ¬40 b ¬16
The solution set is {aa 40}. The solution set is {bb 16}.
5. t ¬7 16. 4y ¬20
6 4y 20
¬
66t ¬6(7) 4 4
y ¬5
t ¬42 The solution set is {yy 5}.
The solution set is {tt 42}. 17. 12k ¬36
a
1
¬8
3
6. 1
12k 6
12 ¬ 12
11a
11
¬11(8)
k ¬3
The solution set is {kk 3}.
a
¬88
18. 4h ¬36
The solution set is {aa
88}. 4
h 36
4 ¬ 4
7. d 8
¬12
d 8 8
¬12 8 h ¬9
d
¬4 The solution set is {hh 9}.
The solution set is {dd
4}. 19. 2b 6
¬2
5
8. m 14 ¬10 2b 6 6
¬2 6
m 14 14 ¬10 14 5
m ¬4 2b
¬4
5
The solution set is {mm 4}.
52b
¬5(4)
9. 2z 9 ¬7z 1 2 5 2
2z 9 9 ¬7z 1 9 b
¬10
2z ¬7z 10 The solution set is {bb
10}.
2z 7z ¬7z 10 7z 20. 8t 1 ¬5
3
5z ¬10
5
z 10 8t 1 1 ¬5 1
5 ¬ 5
3
z ¬2 8t ¬6
3
The solution set is {zz 2}.
t ¬3(6)
3 8
10. 6t 10 ¬4t 8 3 8
6t 10 10 ¬4t 10 t ¬9
4
6t ¬4t 10
6t 4t ¬4t 10 4t The solution set is tt 9
4 .
2t ¬10
2t ¬
10
2 2
t ¬5
The solution set is {tt 5}.
w ¬7
3
3. 3x y 3
The solution set is ww 7
3 .
To find the x-intercept, let y 0.
4 3x y ¬3
5 k 17 ¬11
24.
3x 0 ¬3
4
5 k 17 17 ¬11 17
3x ¬3
4 x ¬1
5 k ¬28
To find the y-intercept, let x 0.
4 5 k ¬ 4 (28)
5
4 5 3x y ¬3
3(0) y ¬3
k ¬35
y ¬3
The solution set is {kk 35}.
y ¬3
Put a point on the x-axis at 1 and a point on the
y-axis at 3. Draw a line through the two points.
Page 741 Graphing Using Intercepts and Slope
y
1. 2x 3y 6
To find the x-intercept, let y 0.
2x 3y ¬6
2x 3(0) ¬6 O (1, 0) x
2x ¬6
x ¬3 (0, 3)
To find the y-intercept, let x 0. 3x y 3
2x 3y ¬6
2(0) 3y ¬6
3y ¬6 4. x 2y 2
y ¬2 To find the x-intercept, let y 0.
Put a point on the x-axis at 3 and a point on the x 2y ¬2
y-axis at 2. Draw a line through the two points. x 2(0) ¬2
y x ¬2
x ¬2
2x 3y 6 To find the y-intercept, let x 0.
x 2y 2
(0, 2) 0 2y 2
( 3, 0)
2y 2
O x y1
O x
5. 3x 4y 12
y x 2
To find the x-intercept, let y 0.
3x 4y ¬12
3x 4(0) ¬12 8. y x 2
3x ¬12 The y-intercept is 2. So, plot a point at (0, 2).
x ¬4 The slope is 1. From (0, 2), move up 1 unit and
To find the y-intercept, let x 0. right 1 unit. Plot a point. Draw a line connecting
3x 4y ¬12 the points.
3(0) 4y ¬12 y
4y ¬12
y ¬3 y x 2
Put a point on the x-axis at 4 and a point on the
y-axis at 3. Draw a line through the two points.
y O x
(0, 2) (1, 1)
3x 4y 12
(0, 3)
x 9. y x 1
O (4, 0) The y-intercept is 1. So, plot a point at (0, 1). The
slope is 1. From (0, 1), move up 1 unit and right
1 unit. Plot a point. Draw a line connecting the
points.
6. 4y x 4 y
To find the x-intercept, let y 0. y x 1
4y x ¬4
4(0) x ¬4
x ¬4
To find the y-intercept, let x 0. (0, 1) (1, 2)
4y x ¬4
4y 0 ¬4 O x
4y ¬4
y ¬1
Put a point on the x-axis at 4 and a point on the 10. y 3x 1
y-axis at 1. Draw a line through the two points. The y-intercept is 1. So, plot a point at (0, 1).
y The slope is 3. From (0, 1), move up 3 units and
right 1 unit. Plot a point. Draw a line connecting
the points.
y
(0, 1) 4y x 4
x
O (4, 0)
y 3x 1
(1, 2)
O x
(0, 1)
12. y 3x 1
The y-intercept is 1. So, plot a point at (0, 1). y 2x 2
The slope is 3. From (0, 1), move down 3 units
and right 1 unit. Plot a point. Draw a line O (1, 0) x
connecting the points.
(0, 2)
y
O x 16. 6x y 2
(0, 1) y 3x 1 To find the x-intercept, let y 0.
6x y ¬2
6x 0 ¬2
(1, 4) 6x ¬2
x ¬1
3
To find the y-intercept, let x 0.
13. y 2
3x 3
6x y ¬2
The y-intercept is 3. So, plot a point at (0, 3). 6(0) y ¬2
The slope is 2
3 . From (0, 3), move up 2 units and
y ¬2
right 3 units. Plot a point. Draw a line connecting Put a point on the x-axis at 1
3 and a point on
the points. the y-axis at 2. Draw a line through the two
y points.
y
2–
y 3
x 3
(0, 2)
O x –1, 0
3
(3, 1) O x
6x y 2
(0, 3)
14. y 1
2x 1
The y-intercept is 1. So, plot a point at (0, 1). 17. 2y x 2
To find the x-intercept, let y 0.
The slope is 1
2 . From (0, 1), move up 1 unit and
2y x ¬2
right 2 units. Plot a point. Draw a line connecting 2(0) x ¬2
the points. x ¬2
y x ¬2
y 1–
x 1 To find the y-intercept, let x 0.
2
2y x ¬2
2y 0 ¬2
(2, 0)
2y ¬2
O x
y ¬1
(0, 1)
3x 4y 12 1,–2 1
O x
0, –3
19. 4x 3y 6 2
(2, 3)
yx1
x
(0, 1)
x
y 3x 3 y 3x 1
3y x = 3
Substitute 6 3y for x in the second equation. 121 1
21
10. 16 ¬
1
4x 2y ¬32 6
11
4(6 3y) 2y ¬32 ¬
4
24 12y 2y ¬32
63 63
8 ¬
11.
24 14y ¬32
8
24 14y 24 ¬32 24 3
3
7
14y ¬56 ¬
2
2
2
14y 5
6
¬ 37
¬
14 14
y ¬4 22
37 2
Use x 6 3y to find the value of x. ¬
2 2 2
x 6 3y 3
14
x 6 3(4) ¬ 4
x 6 12
x 6 12.
28
8
147 ¬
288
1
47
The solution is (6, 4).
144 2
¬
49 3
122
Pages 744–745 Square Roots and Simplifying ¬
73
Radicals 122 3
¬
1. 32
¬
2 2
2 2
2 73 3
¬
42 2
12 6 4
6
¬7
3 or 7
¬42
p 2
1
0p3 10p
2. 75
¬
5 5
3 13. ¬
27 9 3
¬5
2 3
p10p
¬
¬53
33
3. 50
10
¬
50 10 p10p 33
¬¬
3
3 33
¬
2 5
5 2
5
p30p
¬
22 5
2 5
¬9
¬2 5 5
108
36 3
14. ¬
¬105
2q6 q
6
2
4. 12
20
¬
12 20 ¬
6 3
3 q 2
¬
2 2
3 2
25
6 32
¬
42 15
¬
3 q 2
2
¬415
6 or
6 3
6
¬
5. 6
6
¬
66 3 q 2
3 q
¬36
or 6 4 4 5 2
3
15. ¬
5 2
3 5 23
5 2 3
6. 16
25
¬
16 25
45 23
¬
4 4
55 ¬ 2
52 23
¬4 2 5
2
¬4 5 or 20 83
20
¬
25 12
20 83
¬
13
65
310
¬
42
¬9 6 4
4m n
6
5 310
16. (2c d ) (2)2(c3)2(d2)2
3 2 2
¬ 4c6d4
2
3 3 2 1
3 17. (5wx ) (5)3(w)3(x5)3
5 3
20. ¬
2 13
2 13
2
13 125w3x15
32 13
18. (6a b) 63(a5)3b3
5 3
¬ 216a15b3
(2)2 13
2
19. (k ) (13k2)2 (k2)3(3)(132)(k2)2
2 3
313
6 k63(169)k4
¬
4 13
169k6 k4 3
32 13
169k103
¬
9
20. (5w x ) (2w5)2 (5)2(w3)2(x2)2(2)2(w5)2
3 2 2
2
13 25w6x4(4)w10
¬
3 (25)(4)w6 w10 x4
100w16x4
21. (7y z )(4y ) (7)y3z2(4)4(y2)4
3 2 2 4
3. 9
9
2 c (8c ) ¬ 2 (8)(c c )
5 5
¬16p7q13
¬ 9
2 (8)(c
15) 23. (m 1)(m 4)
(m)(m) (m)(4) (1)(m) (1)(4)
¬36c6
m2 4m m 4
4. (n6)(10n2) (1)(10)(n6 n2) m2 5m 4
10(n62)
10n8
s2 10s 25 ¬3x2y2z3
3x z 2 3
34. (3f g) (3f )2 2(3f )(g) (g)2
2
¬
2
9f 2 6fg g2 y
w 4 3 (w) 4 3
35. (2r 5) (2r)2 2(2r)(5) (5)2
2
7. 6 ¬ 3
6
4r2 20r 25 w12
¬
2 2 216
36. t 8
3 ¬(t)2 2(t) 8 8
3 3
1
¬t2 6 64
3 t 9
8. 3q2 3
5 ¬ (3)3(q2)3
53
27q6
37. (x 4)(x2 5x 2) ¬
125
x(x2 5x 2) 4(x2 5x 2)
2y
2 2 (2)2(y2)2
x3 5x2 2x 4x2 20x 8 9. 7 ¬
72
x3 x2 22x 8 4y4
¬49
38. (x 2)(x2 3x 7)
2 4 4 2)4
x(x2 3x 7) 2(x2 3x 7) 5m
¬ 5 (m
10. 3 34
x3 3x2 7x 2x2 6x 14
625m8
x3 x2 13x 14 ¬8 1
39. (3b 2)(3b2 b 1) 4z2 16z 36
¬
2
4z z
16 3 6
4z 4z 4z
11.
3b(3b2 b 1) 2(3b2 b 1) 4z
9
9b3 3b2 3b 6b2 2b 2 ¬z 4 z
9b3 3b2 b 2 5d2 8 d 20
12. (5d2 8d 20) 10d ¬
40. (2j 7)(j2 2j 4) 10d
5d2 8d 20
2j(j2 2j 4) 7(j2 2j 4) ¬ 10d 10d 10d
2j3 4j2 8j 7j2 14j 28
¬d 4 2
2 5 d
2j3 3j2 6j 28
p3 12p2 3p 8
13. (p3 12p2 3p 8) 4p ¬
4p
p3 12p2 3p 8
¬
4p
4p 4p 4p
p2
¬ 3p 3 4 p
2
4
8 0 1 3
2
u 5
¬0 4. C B 2 2 2 8
2
10 6 7 6
u 5
2 ¬0
u ¬5
8 (1) 0 (3)
2 2 2 28
41. q 8q 16 ¬0
2
10 7 66
(q 4)2 ¬0
q 4 ¬0 9 3
q ¬4 4 6
42. a2 6a 9 ¬0 17 0
(a 3)2 ¬0
10 9
a 3 ¬0
5. 3A 3 4 3
a ¬3
1 11
3(10) 3(9)
Pages 752–753 Operations with Matrices 3(4) 3(3)
3(1) 3(11)
10 9 1 3
1. A B 4 3 2 8 30 27
1 11 7 6 12 9
3 33
10 (1) 9 (3)
42
1 7
3 8
11 6 6. 5B 5
1 3
2 8
7 6
9 12
5(1) 5(3)
6 5 5(2) 5(8)
6 17 5(7) 5(6)
5 15
1 3 8 0
2. B C 2 8 2 2 10 40
7 6 10 6 35 30
8 0
1 8 3 0 7. 4C 4 2 2
2 (2) 8 2 10 6
7 (10) 6 6
4(8) 4(0)
7 3 4(2) 4(2)
0 10 4(10) 4(6)
3 12
32 0
10 9 8 0 8 8
3. A C 4 3 2 2 40 24
1 11 10 6
8 0
8. 1 1
2C 2
2 2
10 8 9 0
10 6
4 (2) 3 2
1 (10) 11 6
1(8) 1
2 (0)
2
1 1
(2) 2(2)
2 9 2
6 5 (10) 1
1
2 2 (6)
9 5
4 0
1 1
5 3
2(10) 2(9) 8 0 3(10) 3(9) 3(1) 3(3)
2(4) 2(3) 2 2 3(4) 3(3) 3(2) 3(8)
2(1) 2(11) 10 6 3(1) 3(11) 3(7) 3(6)
20 18
8 0 30 27 3 9
8 6 2 2 12 9 6 24
2 22 10 6 3 33 21 18
20 8 18 0
30 (3) 27 (9)
8 (2) 6 2 12 6 9 24
2 (10) 22 6 3 21 33 18
28 18
33 18
6 4 6 33
12 28 24 15
10 9 8 0
10. A 5C 4 3 5 2 2 13. X Z 102 84 74 80
1 11 10 6
4 8 (8)
10 2(7) 4 0
10 9 5(8) 5(0)
4 3 5(2) 5(2)
1 11 5(10) 5(6) 63 16
4
10 9
40 0
4 3
1 11
10 10 14. Y Z 16 0
5
4 8
7 0
50 30
6 1 4 0 (8)
10 40 9 0 (7) 5 0
4 (10) 3 10
1 (50) 11 30 13 8
5
30 9
14 13 15. X Y 102 84 16 0
5
49 19
2 10(1) 8 0
6 4 (5)
8 0 1 3
11. 1
C B 1 2 2 2 8
2 2
10 6 7 6 34 89
16
1(8) 1(0) 16. 3Y 3
0
2 2 5
1 3
1(2) 1(2)
2 2 2 8
1(10) 1(6)
2 2 7 6 3(1)
3(6)
3(0)
3(5)
3 0
4 0 1 3
18 15
1 1 2 8
5 3 7 6
17. 6X 6 102 84
4 (1) 0 (3) 6(2) 6(8)
1 2 18 6(10) 6(4)
5 7 36
12
60
48
24
3 3
1 9
2 9
20 (2) 40 0 24. XY 2Z 102 84 16 0
2
4 8
35 12 0 (10)
5 7 0
9. A B C
Z AC ¬AB BC
X 42 ¬9a 12a
A B b 42 ¬21a
42 21
a
21 ¬ 21
2 ¬a
m BC ¬12a
BC ¬12(2)
Page 754 Lesson 1-2 BC ¬24
1. The measurement is precise to within 1
2 in. 10. 7b 13
So, a measurement of 42 in. could be 41 1
2 25 3b
to 42 1
2 in.
2. The measurement is precise to within 0.5 mm. So,
a measurement of 86 mm could be 85.5 to A B C
86.5 mm. AC ¬AB BC
7b 13 ¬25 3b
3. The measurement is precise to within 0.5 cm. So,
7b 13 13 ¬25 3b 13
a measurement of 251 cm could be 250.5 to
7b ¬12 3b
251.5 cm.
7b 3b ¬12 3b 3b
4. The measurement is precise to within 0.05 in. So, 4b ¬12
a measurement of 33.5 in. could be 33.45 to 4b 12
4 ¬ 4
33.55 in.
b ¬3
5. The measurement is precise to within 1
8 ft. BC 3b
So, a measurement of 5 1
1 3
4 ft could be 5 8 to 5 8 ft. BC 3(3)
6. The measurement is precise to within 0.5 m. So, a BC 9
measurement of 89 m could be 88.5 to 89.5 m. 11. 54
7.
4x 5x 5n 5 2n
16
A B C A B C
AB 4x ¬16 AC ¬AB BC
4x 16 54 ¬5n 5 2n
4 ¬ 4
54 ¬7n 5
x ¬4 54 5 ¬7n 5 5
BC 5x 49 ¬7n
BC 5(4) 49 7n
7 ¬ 7
BC 20
7 ¬n
BC ¬2n
BC ¬2(7)
BC ¬14
2
A B C 6 2 2 6 x
AC ¬AB BC 2
65 ¬6c 8 3c 1
6
65 ¬9c 7
65 7 ¬9c 7 7 M X
72 ¬9c (MO)2 ¬(MX)2 (OX)2
2
7 9 c
9 ¬ 9 (MO)2 ¬(8)2 (15)2
8 ¬c (MO)2 ¬289
BC ¬3c 1 MO ¬17
BC ¬3(8) 1 5. y
BC ¬25
6
Page 754 Lesson 1-3
T 2
1. y O
B
2 2 6 x
6
X A x
X R
(TR)2 ¬(TX)2 (RX)2
(TR)2 ¬(16)2 (12)2
(TR)2 ¬400
(AB)2 ¬(AX)2 (BX)2 TR ¬20
(AB)2 ¬(3)2 (4)2 6. y
(AB)2 ¬25 N
AB ¬5 6
2. 2
y N
O
6 2 6 x
4
X F
DM ¬
64 49
6
DM ¬113
2
Z DM ¬10.6
6 O2 x 8. d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
X 4
Y XY ¬
[1 (1)]2
(1
1)2
XY ¬22 (
2)2
8
XY ¬44
(XZ)2 ¬(XY)2 (ZY)2 XY ¬8
(XZ)2 ¬(12)2 (5)2 XY ¬2.8
(XZ)2 ¬169
XZ ¬13
A
D
K is the midpoint of C, by definition of bisect.
Conjecture: CK KD
2
6 (
2 2
¬ 0
15 7
2)
13
K L M
B
F E
. Therefore
3. In octagon ABCDEFGH, A 225 15 15
52
¬ 52 or
E
B F E
. So B
E
represents the distance from B 525
2
. 15 or about
52
to FE The distance between the lines is 52
A B 2.08 units.
5. Solve a system of equations to find the endpoints
H C
of a segment that is perpendicular to : y 2x 4
and m: y 2x 5 which is the same as
G D y 2x 5. The slope of lines and m is 2.
First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
F E to and m. The slope of p is the opposite
4. Solve a system of equations to find the endpoints
reciprocal of 2, or 1
2 . Use the y-intercept of line
of a segment that is perpendicular to
, (0, 4), as one of the endpoints of the
: y 2 2 1
3 x 2 and m: y 3 x 2 . The slope of lines
perpendicular segment.
2
and m is 3.
y
First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular (0, 4)
to and m. The slope of p is the opposite reciprocal p
of 32, or 23. Use the y-intercept of line , (0, 2), as
one of the endpoints of the perpendicular segment.
x
y 4 ¬1
1
3
4 x 4x ¬ 2 1
2x
17 5
y ¬1 4 x ¬ 2
2x 4
10
Next, use a system of equations to determine the x ¬
17
point of intersection of lines m and p. 10
m: y ¬2x 5 Substitute
17 for x in the second equation.
p: y ¬12x 4
y 4
10
17 1
Substitute 2x 5 for y in the second equation. 23
y
17
2x 5 ¬1
2x 4
2x 1
10
The point of intersection is
23
17 , 17 .
2 x ¬5 4
Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
5
x ¬9 10 23
2 distance between (0, 1) and
17 , 17 .
18
x ¬5 d ¬(x2
x1)
2 (y2 y1)2
18
Substitute
17
213
0
7 1
2 2
5 for x in the first equation. ¬ 10
1 8
y 2 5 5
y 11
5
¬
100 10
17 or
10
17
17
1
7
10 or about
17
The distance between the lines is
The point of intersection is 18
11
5 , 5 . 2.43 units.
17
Then, use the Distance Formula to determine the
7. 1. Graph line and point P. Place the compass
distance between (0, 4) and
18 1
1
5 , 5 . point at point P. Make the setting wide enough so
d ¬(x2
x1)2
(y2 y1)2 that when an arc is drawn, it intersects in two
places. Label these points of intersection A and B.
5
0
151
4
2 2
18
¬ 2. Put the compass at point A and draw an arc
above line .
81
¬
9 9
5 or 5
5
5
3. Using the same compass setting, put the
9
5 compass at point B and draw an arc to intersect
The distance between the lines is 5 or about the one drawn in step 2. Label the point of
4.02 units.
intersection Q.
6. Solve a system of equations to find the endpoints
4. Draw
PQ.
PQ . Label point R at the
of a segment that is perpendicular to and m,
intersection of
PQ and . The segment constructed
where : x 4y 6 is the same as y 1 3
4x 2
from point P(2, 1) perpendicular to the line ,
and m: x 4y 4 is the same as y 1
The slope of lines and m is 1 .
4 x 1.
appears to intersect line at R 3
5
2 , 2 . Use the
4 Distance Formula to find the distance between
First, write an equation of a line p perpendicular
point P and line .
to and m. The slope of p is the opposite
reciprocal of 1
4 , or 4. Use the y-intercept of line y
m, (0, 1), as one of the endpoints of the Q B
perpendicular segment.
R
y
p A O x
m P
x
d ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
2
2 2
¬ 2 5 (1)
3 2
y y1 m(x x1)
y 1 ¬4(x 0)
4
¬
9 7 7
2 or 2
2
2
7
2
y 1 ¬4x The distance between P and is 2 units.
y ¬4x 1 8. 1. Graph line and point P. Place the compass
Next, use a system of equations to determine the point at point P. Make the setting wide enough so
point of intersection of lines and p. that when an arc is drawn, it intersects in two
: y 1 3 places. Label these points of intersection A and B.
4 x 2
p: y 4x 1
3 4 1 2 PL PL Z(4b, 0)
Alt. Int. Alt. Int. Reflex. X(0, 0) x
Th. Th. Prop.
3. • Use the origin as vertex S of the triangle.
FLP MPL • Place the base of the triangle, SR
, along the
ASA positive x-axis.
• Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
MP FL • Since R is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
CPCTC x-coordinate is (3 a) because the base of the
triangle is (3 a) units long.
• Because R T
is vertical, the x-coordinate of T is
Page 762 Lesson 4-6
(3 a). And because RT 3 a, the
1. DAB is opposite BD and DBA is opposite AD
,
y-coordinate of T is (3 a).
so DAB DBA. y
2. FBG is opposite FG and FGB is opposite B
F, T(3 a, 3 a)
so FBG FGB.
3. BEF is opposite BG and BGF is opposite B
E, R(3 a, 0)
so BEF BGF. S(0, 0) x
4. By the converse of the Isosceles Triangle
Theorem, the sides opposite congruent angles are 4. • Use the origin as vertex D of the triangle.
B
congruent. So, FF E
. • Place the base of the triangle along the positive
5. By the converse of the Isosceles Triangle x-axis.
Theorem, the sides opposite congruent angles are • Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
A
congruent. So, B B C
. • Since E is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its
6. By the converse of the Isosceles Triangle x-coordinate is 1
4 b because the base of the
Theorem, the sides opposite congruent angles are triangle is 1
b units long.
4
D
congruent. So, B C D
. • Because CDE is equilateral and thus C
D C E,
the x-coordinate of C is halfway between D and
Page 762 Lesson 4-7 E at 1
8 b. We cannot determine the y-coordinate
1. • Use the origin as vertex B of the triangle.
in terms of b, so call it c.
• Place the base of the triangle along the positive
y
x-axis. C(1–8b, c)
• Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
• Since C is on the x-axis, its y-coordinate is 0. Its E(1–4b, 0)
x-coordinate is r because the base of the D(0, 0) x
triangle is r units long.
• Since ABC is isosceles, the x-coordinate of A 5. Vertex A is on the y-axis, at an unspecified
is halfway between 0 and r or 2r. We cannot distance from the origin. Its coordinates are (0, b).
determine the y-coordinate in terms of r, so call Since B is on the x-axis, the y-coordinate of B is 0.
it b. Because ABC is isosceles, the x-coordinate of A
y is halfway between the x-coordinate of B and C.
A(r–2, b) So the x-coordinate of B is a. The coordinates of
B are (0, a).
C(r, 0) 6. Side FE
can be seen to be vertical, so the
B(0, 0) x x-coordinate of F is the same as the x-coordinate
of E, namely b. F is the same distance from E as
2. • Use the origin as vertex X of the triangle.
E is from the origin, namely b units. So the
Z
• Place the base of the triangle, X , along the y-coordinate of F is b. The coordinates of F are
positive x-axis. (b, b).
• Position the triangle in the first quadrant.
n8 n2
8 2
n 2
n 8 2
8
intersection
intersection 2 66
8 32
The range of values that fits all three is
The range of values that fits all three is 2 n 66.
8 n 32. 15. Let the measure of the third side be n, and solve
12. Let the measure of the third side be n, and solve each inequality to determine the range of values
each inequality to determine the range of values for n.
for n. 2 29 n 2 n 29 n 29 2
88n 8n8 n88 31 n or n 31 n 27 n 27
16 n or n 16 n0 n0 Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
Graph the inequalities on the same number line. n 31
31
n 16
16
n 27
27
n0
0 n 27
27
intersection
intersection
0 16 27 31
The range of values that fits all the inequalities is The range of values that fits all three is
0 n 16. 27 n 31.
13. Let the measure of the third side be n, and solve 16. Let the measure of the third side be n, and solve
each inequality to determine the range of values each inequality to determine the range of values
for n. for n.
18 36 n 18 n 36 n 36 18 25 80 n 25 n 80 n 80 25
54 n or n 54 n 18 n 18 105 n or n 105 n 55 n 55
Graph the inequalities on the same number line. Graph the inequalities on the same number line.
n 54 n 105
54 105
n 18 n 55
18 55
n 18 n 55
18
55
intersection
18 54 intersection
55 105
The range of values that fits all three is
The range of values that fits all three is
18 n 54.
55 n 105.
1. RS RT 1. Given B
A A D, A
C
A C, and mCAD mCAB. By
the SAS Inequality, CD CB.
2. UV VS US 2. Triangle Inequality
CD CB
Theorem
2x 7 6.56
3. US UR RS 3. Segment Addition 2x 13.56
Postulate x 6.78
4. UV VS UR 4. Substitution Also, by the Triangle Inequality Theorem,
RS AB AD BD.
5. UV VS UR 5. Substitution AB AD BD
RT 15 15 6.56 2x 7
6. UR RT UT 6. Triangle Inequality 30 2x 0.44
Theorem 30.44 2x
15.22 x
7. UV VS UT 7. Transitive Property
The two inequalities can be written as the
of Inequality
compound inequality 6.78 x 15.22.
18. Given: quadrilateral ABCD 7. 3x 1
A B A B
Prove: AD CD AB BC
45
3x 1
3x 1
3x 1
D C
Proof:
D C
5x 21
Statements Reasons
Because ABD is equilateral, mABD 60 and
1. quadrilateral ABCD 1. Given so mABD mDBC. Since A BC B and D
B
C
2. Draw A. 2. Through any two B
D , the SAS inequality allows us to conclude that
points there is AD DC.
exactly one line. AD DC
3. AD CD AC 3. Triangle Inequality 3x 1 5x 21
AB AC BC Theorem 1 21 3x 5x
4. AC BC AB 4. Subtraction 20 2x
Property of 10 x
Inequality Also, the measure of any side is always greater
5. AD CD BC than 0.
5. Transitive Property
AB 5x 21 0
of Inequality
5x 21
6. AD CD AB 6. Addition Property x 4.2
BC of Inequality The two inequalities can be written as the
compound inequality 4.2 x 10.
IJ 3 or 10 2
3 2
3
2. From the Triangle Proportionality Theorem,
QU DR
AU AD .
Substitute the known measures.
12
5 x 64
x¬ 3 x8
12
5 2
The perimeter of GHI is 3 or 41 3 units. The geometric mean is 8.
5. Let x represent the geometric mean.
Page 766 Lesson 6-6 3
2 x
x
62
1.
x2 36
x 36
x6
The geometric mean is 6.
x2 7 53
100
DF [4 (2)]2 (3 2)2
x
7
100 (2)
2 (5 ) 2
7 29
x
10
7
By the converse of the Pythagorean Theorem, if the
The altitude is 10 or approximately 0.3. sum of the squares of the measures of two sides of
10. Let x represent the altitude. a triangle equals the square of the measure of the
12 x
x
longest side then the triangle is a right triangle.
32
x2 384 EF 2¬ DE2 DF 2
x 384
)2¬ (34
(53 )2 (29 )2
x 86 53¬ 34 29
The altitude is 86 or about 19.6. 53¬ 63
11. Let x represent the altitude. Since the sum of the squares of two sides does not
4
2 equal the square of the longest side, DEF is not
x
x 42
a right triangle.
x2 32 3. Use the Distance Formula to determine the
x 32 lengths of the sides.
x 42
d (x2 x1)2 (y2 y1)2
The altitude is 42 or about 5.7.
12. Let x represent the altitude. DE (2 2)2 [4 (1)]2
7 x (4)
2 (3)2
x 24 25
x 168
2
5
x 168
x 242 EF [4 (2)]2 ( 2
1 (4)]
or about 13.0.
The altitude is 242 (2)
2 3 2
13
Page 767 Lesson 7-2 DF (4 2)2 [1 (1)]2
1. Use the Distance Formula to determine the (6)
2 0 2
Use a calculator.
N 55°
45°¬ B
Page 768 Lesson 7-7 Therefore, c 29.1, mA 80, and mB 45.
1. e2¬ c2 d2 2cdcosE 6. We know an angle and the opposite side, so we
1502¬ 1002 1252 2(100)(125)cosE use the Law of Sines.
22,500¬ 10,000 15,625 25,000cos E N
sin sin
O
n ¬ o
3125¬ 25,000cos E sin8 0° sin
O
315 3.5 ¬ 1.7
25,
000 ¬ cosE 1.7si n 80°
¬ sinO
3.5
E¬ cos1 00
3125
25,0 sin
1 1.7s i
3.5
¬ O
n 80°
E¬ 82.8°
29°¬ O
2. c2¬ d2 e2 2decosC
Use the Angle Sum Theorem to find mP.
52¬ 62 92 2(6)(9)cos C
mN mO mP 180
25¬ 36 81 108cos C
80 29 mP ¬180
92¬ 108cos C
92 109 mP ¬180
1
08 ¬ cosC mP ¬71
C¬ cos1 8
92
10
Find p using the Law of Sines.
N
sin sin
P
C¬ 31.6° n ¬ p
sin 8
0° sin 71°
3.5 ¬ p
psin80°¬ 3.5sin71°
3.5 si
n 71°
p¬ sin 80°
p¬ 3.4
Therefore, mO 29, mP 71, and p 3.4.
2 (1, 1.5)
x Since the diagonals bisect each other, QRST is a
4 2 2 4
parallelogram.
2
10. I (10, 9)
4 y
H (13, 5) 6
J (2, 4)
O (5, 6) N (3, 6)
10 2 2
If the opposite sides of a quadrilateral are x
parallel, then it is a parallelogram. G (5, 0) 2
2
2
M
slope of L
5 (3) or 0 6
6 (6)
N
slope of O 3 (5) or 0
6 2 8
O
slope of L
5 (3) 2 or 4
First use the Distance Formula to determine
2
6 8 I and G J are congruent.
N
slope of M
3 5 2 or 4
whether opposite sides H
Since opposite sides have the same slope, HI [10 (13)] 2 (9 5)2
M
L
O N and LO
MN. 32 42 or 5
Therefore, LMNO is a parallelogram. GJ [2 (5)]2 (4 0)2
8. W (5, 6) 32 42 or 5
y Since HI GJ, H I G
J.
X (2, 5) Next, use the Slope Formula to determine
4 whether HI
G
J.
95 4
2 I
slope of H 10 (13) or 3
40 4
J
slope of G 2 (5) or 3
6 4 2 x
I and G
H J have the same slope, so they are
Z (8, 2) 2 parallel. Since one pair of opposite sides is
congruent and parallel, GHIJ is a parallelogram.
4
Y (3, 4)
Page 770 Lesson 8-4
Use the Distance Formula to determine whether 1. Because a rectangle is a parallelogram, diagonals
X
opposite sides are congruent. Start with W and T
Q and SR
bisect each other.
Y
Z, which appear to be different lengths. QU UT
WX [2 (5)]2
(5 6)2 2x 3 4x 9
7 2 or 50
2 (1) 2x 4x 3 9
ZY [3 (8)]2 [ 2
4 (2)] 2x 12
x6
5 (
2 2) or 29
2
QU 2x 3
X
Since W and X Y are not congruent, WXYZ is not
2(6) 3
a parallelogram.
15
9. R (0, 6) The diagonals of a rectangle are congruent.
y R
S
¬ QT
SR¬ QT
Q (5, 4) 4
1SR¬ 1QT
2 2
2 SU¬ QU
SU¬ 15
4 2 2 4 x 2. The diagonals of a rectangle are congruent and
S (3, 1) bisect each other.
T
Q¬ RS
T (2, 3) 4 QT¬ RS
If the diagonals bisect each other, then the figure 1QT¬ 1RS
2 2
is a parallelogram. So the two diagonals must UT¬ RU
have the same point as their midpoint. x 9¬ 3x 6
Find the midpoint of QS. x 3x¬ 9 6
x x y y
5 3 4 (1)
1
2, 2 2, 2
2 1 2 2x¬ 15
x¬ 7.5
(1, 1.5)
¬6
9 or 3
2 4
1 4
Q
slope of T ¬ 11 2
x
3
¬ 0 or undefined 2 2 X (3, 1)
7 6 Y (7, 2)
S
slope of R ¬
10 4 W (1, 2)
1
¬6
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, Z (1, 5)
R
Q and TS. So, QRST is a trapezoid.
2b. Use the Distance Formula to determine whether A quadrilateral is a trapezoid if exactly one pair
the legs are congruent. of opposite sides is parallel. Use the Slope
QT ¬ (1 1
)2 (4 1)2 Formula.
1
(2)
¬ 0 3
2 2 X
slope of W ¬ 31
¬ 32 or 3 ¬1
2
RS ¬ (10 4)2 (7 6
)2 2
(5)
Y
slope of Z ¬ 71
¬6 1
2 2
¬37 ¬3
1
6 or 2
Since the legs are not congruent, QRST is not an 2 (5)
W
slope of Z ¬ 11
isosceles trapezoid.
3a. ¬3
0 or undefined
y
4 2
(1)
Y
slope of X ¬ 73
L (1, 2) 1 1
¬ 4 or 4
O (3, 1)
X
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, W
4 2 2 x and ZY. So, WXYZ is a trapezoid.
M (4, 1) 4b. Use the Distance Formula to determine whether
2
the legs are congruent.
4 ZW ¬ (1 1)2 [
2 (
5)]2
N (3, 5) ¬ 0 3
2 2
¬ 9 or 3
A quadrilateral is a trapezoid if exactly one pair XY ¬ (7 3)2 [
2 (
1)]2
of opposite sides is parallel. Use the Slope
¬ 4 (
2 1) 2
Formula.
5 1 ¬ 17
N
slope of O ¬
3 (
3) Since the legs are not congruent, WXYZ is not an
6
¬6 or 1
isosceles trapezoid.
2
1 F
5. E is the median.
M
slope of L ¬
41
3 EF 1
2 (AB CD)
¬3 or 1
2
1 13 1
2 (8 CD)
L
slope of O ¬
1 (3)
26 8 CD
¬1
4 18 CD
1
(5)
M
slope of N ¬ 43 Q
6. P is the median.
¬4
PQ 1
2 (LM ON)
1 or 4
N
Exactly one pair of opposite sides is parallel, O PQ 1
2 (21 17)
and LM
. So, LMNO is a trapezoid. PQ 19
3b. Use the Distance Formula to determine whether M
L
O N, so M and N are consecutive
the legs are congruent. supplementary angles.
OL ¬ [1 (
3)]2 (2
1)2 mM mN ¬180
¬ 4 1
2 2
mM 96 ¬180
¬ 17 mM ¬84
NM ¬ (4 3) 2 [ 2
1 (5)] Similarly, L and O are supplementary.
¬ 12 42 mL mO ¬180
¬ 17 36 mO ¬180
mO ¬144
Since the legs are congruent, LMNO is an
isosceles trapezoid.
D(0, 0) C (a, 0) x
Proof:
AC ¬(a 0)2 (0
a)2
¬a a
2 2
¬2a2
BD ¬(a 0)2 (a
0)2
¬a a
2 2
¬2a2
AC BD
ACBD
A A
x 2
P P
O
x Page 771 Lesson 9-2
1.
Q Q
R R
5. To find the coordinates of each point of the image,
for each point of the original square, multiply
both coordinates by 1.
B(4, 4) → B(4, 4) D(1, 4) → D(1, 4)
F(1, 1) → F(1, 1) H(4, 1) → H(4, 1)
Plot the reflected vertices and connect them to c d
form the image BDFH. Reflect the blue figure in line c, then reflect the
resulting image in d to produce the red figure. The
red figure is a translation image of the blue figure.
M L C D
M
This translation moved every point of the
O x preimage 2 units left and 3 units up.
A(1, 3) → A(1 2, 3 3) or A(1, 6)
B(1, 1) → B(1 2, 1 3) or B(3, 4)
C(1, 2) → C(1 2, 2 3) or C(3, 1)
This translation moved each point of the D(3, 2) → D(3 2, 2 3) or D(1, 1)
preimage 2 units right and 1 unit up. E(3, 1) → E(3 2, 1 3) or E(1, 4)
L(2, 3) → L(2 2, 3 1) or L(4, 4) Plot the translated vertices and connect them to
M(4, 1) → M(4 2, 1 1) or M(2, 2) form pentagon ABCDE.
Plot the translated vertices and connect them to 8. R y
form segment LM.
5. y R
D
E O T x
F O x
E D S T
S
F This translation moved every point of the
preimage 3 units right and 2 units down.
This translation moved every point of the R(4, 3) → R(4 3, 3 2) or R(1, 1)
preimage 1 unit left and 3 units down.
S(2, 3) → S(2 3, 3 2) or S(1, 5)
D(1, 2) → D(1 1, 2 3) or D(0, 1)
T(2, 1) → T(2 3, 1 2) or T(5, 3)
E(2, 1) → E(2 1, 1 3) or E(3, 2)
Plot the translated vertices and connect them to
F(3, 1) → F(3 1, 1 3) or F(4, 4) form triangle RST.
Plot the translated vertices and connect them to
form triangle DEF. Page 772 Lesson 9-3
6. y 1. • First graph KLM.
X • Draw a segment from point P(1, 1) to point
K(4, 2).
X W • Use a protractor to measure a 90° angle
W counterclockwise with PK
as one side.
O x
• Draw PR.
Z
• Use a compass to copy PK onto
PR. Name the
Y
segment PK.
Y Z
• Repeat with points L and M. KLM is the
image of KLM under a 90° counterclockwise
This translation moved every point of the rotation about the point P(1, 1).
preimage 1 unit right and 1 unit down.
R y
W(1, 1) → W(1 1, 1 1) or W(2, 0) L (1, 3)
X(2, 3) → X(2 1, 3 1) or X(1, 2) K (2, 2)
K (4, 2)
Y(3, 2) → Y(3 1, 2 1) or Y(2, 3)
M (2, 1)
Z(2, 2) → Z(2 1, 2 1) or Z(3, 3)
x
Plot the translated vertices and connect them to P (1, 1)
form quadrilateral WXYZ. L (3, 1)
M (1, 0)
J H J J
I y x
I x I x
I
Page 772 Lesson 9-4
J H H
H
1. No; Use the algebraic method to determine whether
a semi-regular tessellation can be created using
regular hexagons and squares of side length 1 unit.
4. First reflect NOP in the y-axis. Then label the Each interior angle of a hexagon measures
image NOP. Next, reflect the image in the line 180(6 2)
or 120°, and each interior angle of a
y x. N
O
P
is the image of NOP under 6
reflections in the y-axis and the line y x. The square measures 90°.
coordinates of the image are N
(1, 3), Find whole number values for h and t so that
O
(3, 5), and P
(3, 2). The angle of rotation 120h 90t 360.
is 90° clockwise. Let h 1.
120(1) 90t ¬360
y yx 120 90t ¬360
90t ¬240
t ¬2.67
N N
Let h 2.
x 120(2) 90t ¬360
P
240 90t ¬360
N
90t ¬120
O P P O t ¬1.33
Let h 3.
O
120(3) 90t ¬360
360 90t ¬360
90t ¬0
t ¬0
There are no more reasonable possibilities. So, a
semi-regular tessellation cannot be created from
regular hexagons and squares.
F
1, 3
2
F(3, 2) F(9, 6)
H
0, 3
2
H(0, 2) H(0, 6)
8.
Preimage Image Image
(x, y) (3x, 3y) 13x, 13y y
OB D B D
E(2, 1) E(6, 3) E
2 1
3, 3 H F
x
9. X(1, 1)
Preimage Image Image
(x, y) (3x, 3y) 13x, 13y x
y
mX ¬tan1 2
3
C ¬33.7
A vector in standard position that is equal to XY
forms a 33.7° angle with the negative x-axis in
B D the second quadrant. So it forms a 180 33.7 or
146.3° angle with the positive x-axis.
C Thus, XY has a magnitude of about 3.6 units and
B D
x a direction of about 146.3°.
O A
X(2, 1)
x
X(1, 1) x
y y Y(4, 4)
tan X ¬
2
1
x2 x1
y y
¬2 (
1) tan X ¬
2
1
2 (1) x2 x1
¬3
3 or 1 ¬ 4
4
2
1
mX ¬tan1(1)
¬5
6
¬45
A vector in standard position that is equal to XY
mX ¬tan1 5
6
¬39.8
forms a 45° angle with the positive x-axis in the
first quadrant. A vector in standard position that is equal to XY
forms a 39.8° angle with the negative x-axis in
Thus, XY has a magnitude of about 4.2 units and
the third quadrant. So it forms a 180 39.8 or
a direction of 45°.
219.8° angle with the positive x-axis.
3. Find the magnitude.
Thus, XY has a magnitude of about 7.8 units and
XY ¬(x
2 x1)2
(y2 y1)2 a direction of about 219.8°.
¬[2 (5)]
2 (3 4)2 5. Find the magnitude.
¬58 XY ¬(x
XY 2 x1)2 (y2
y1)2
¬7.6 ¬[2 (
2)]
2 [2 2
(1)]
Graph XY to determine how to find the direction. ¬17
Draw a right triangle that has XY as its
¬4.1
hypotenuse and an acute angle at X.
Graph XY to determine how to find the direction.
X(5, 4) y
Draw a right triangle that has XY as its
hypotenuse and an acute angle at X.
y
y y Y(2, 2)
tan X ¬
2
1
x2 x1
3 4
¬ y y
2 (5)
tan X ¬
2
1
x2 x1
¬7
3
2 (1)
mX ¬tan1 7
3 ¬2 (2)
¬66.8 ¬1
4
A vector in standard position that is equal to XY mX ¬tan1 1
4
forms a 66.8° angle with the positive x-axis in the ¬14.0
fourth quadrant. So it forms a 360 66.8 or
293.2° angle with the positive x-axis.
H
I
7
0
tan ¬
50
J
H ¬7
5
I
J
¬tan1 75
O x ¬54.5°
The vector forms a 54.5° angle with the positive
x-axis.
Thus, c d has a magnitude of about 8.6 units
and a direction of about 54.5°.
O x
O x (4, 3)
3 0
tan ¬
4 0
60
tan ¬
3
0 ¬3
4
¬2
¬tan1(2)
¬tan1 34
¬36.9
¬63.4° The vector forms a 36.9° angle with the negative
The vector forms a 63.4° angle with the negative x-axis in the third quadrant. So it forms a 180
x-axis in the second quadrant. So it forms a 36.9 or 216.9° angle with the positive x-axis.
180 63.4 or 116.6° angle with the positive Thus, s t has a magnitude of 5 units and a
x-axis. Thus, a b has a magnitude of about 6.7 direction of about 216.9°.
units and a direction of about 116.6°. 14. m n ¬2, 3 2, 3
12. x y ¬1, 2 4, 6 ¬2 (2), 3 3
¬1 4, 2 (6) ¬0, 0
¬5, 4 The magnitude of the zero vector 0, 0 is
Find the magnitude, using initial point (0, 0) and 02 02 or 0. The direction is undefined.
endpoint (5, 4).
15. u v ¬7, 2 4, 1
x y ¬ (5 0
)2 (
4 0)2
¬7 4, 2 1
¬ 41
¬3, 3
¬6.4 Find the magnitude, using initial point (0, 0) and
Graph the resultant to determine how to find the endpoint (3, 3).
direction. Draw a right triangle.
u v ¬ (3 0)2 (3 0)2
y
¬ 18
¬3 2
¬4.2
x Graph the resultant to determine how to find the
O direction. Draw a right triangle.
y
(3, 3)
(5, 4)
0
4
tan ¬
50
O x
¬4
5
¬tan1 45
¬38.7°
The vector forms a 38.7° angle with the positive
3
0
x-axis in the fourth quadrant. So it forms a tan ¬
3 0
360 38.7 or 321.3° angle with the positive x-axis. ¬1
Thus, x y has a magnitude of about 6.4 units ¬tan1 (1)
and a direction of about 321.3°. ¬45°
¬1
2 (150) or 75 Page 776 Lesson 10-8
2. Find the measure of an angle that forms a linear 1. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
pair with 6. If X is the angle that intercepts [x 1]2 [y (2)]2 ¬22
the 40° arc, (x 1)2 (y 2)2 ¬4
mX 12 (40 35)
2. The origin is the point (0, 0).
¬1
(x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
2 (75) or 37.5 (x 0)2 (y 0)2 ¬42
m6 180 mX
x2 y2 ¬16
180 37.5 or 142.5
3. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
3. 360 140 ¬220 2
[x (3)]2 [y (4)]2 ¬11
m7 ¬1
2 (220) or 110
(x 3)2 (y 4)2 ¬11
4. x 1
2 (80 40)
4. If d 6, r 3.
x 1
2 (40) or 20 (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
[x 3]2 [y (1)]2 ¬32
5. 15 ¬1
2 (80 2x)
(x 3)2 (y 1)2 ¬9
15 ¬40 x
5. (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
25 ¬x
(x 6)2 (y 12)2 ¬72
25 ¬x
(x 6)2 (y 12)2 ¬49
6. x ¬1
2 (6x 40)
6. If d 8, r 4.
x ¬3x 20 (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
2x ¬20 (x 4)2 (y 0)2 ¬42
x ¬10 (x 4)2 y2 ¬16
7. If d 22, r 11.
Page 775 Lesson 10-7 (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
1. x 8 ¬4 10 [x 6]2 [y (6)]2 ¬112
8x ¬40 (x 6)2 (y 6)2 ¬121
x ¬5 8. If d 2, r 1.
2. 5 x ¬3 10 (x h)2 (y k)2 ¬r2
5x ¬30 [x (5)]2 [y 1]2 ¬12
x ¬6 (x 5)2 (y 1)2 ¬1
¬28
9
2
2
O x ¬1262 or about 178.2
(3, 1) The area is about 178.2 ft2 and the perimeter is
74 ft.
3. Area: For a rectangle,
A w
12. Write the equation in standard form. 18.3(6.2)
(x 1)2 (y 4)2 12 113.5
The center is at (1, 4), and the radius is 1. Perimeter: The perimeter is 2(18.3) 2(6.2) 49.
Draw a circle with radius 1, centered at (1, 4). The perimeter is 49 m and the area is about
y 113.5 m2.
4. To determine the shape, first graph each point
(1, 4)
and draw the quadrilateral. Then determine the
slope of each side.
y
R (1, 3)
x Q (3, 3)
O
T (3, 1)
S (1, 1)
x
¬3
0 , which is undefined
1
1
Y
slope of X ¬
2 (1)
¬0
3 or 0 Base: Since AD and B
C
are horizontal, find their
1 (2)
Y
slope of Z ¬
22
lengths by subtracting the x-coordinates of their
endpoints.
¬3
0 , which is undefined b1 AD 7 1
Opposite sides have the same slope, so they are 6 or 6
parallel. WXYZ is a parallelogram. All sides are b2 BC 4 2
horizontal or vertical, so the parallelogram is a 2 or 2
rectangle. All sides have length 3 so they are Height: Because the bases are horizontal
congruent. So the rectangle is a square. segments, the distance between them can be
A s2 measured on a vertical line. Subtract the
32 y-coordinates.
9 h 3 1 or 2
The area of WXYZ is 9 units2.
Area: A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
N (3, 4)
Explore: To find the area of the rhombus, we
x need to know the length of each diagonal.
B (4, 1)
A (1, 1) Plan: Use coordinate geometry to find the length
of each diagonal. Use the formula to find the area
of rhombus LMNO.
Solve: Let OM be d1 and LN be d2.
Base: Since AB and D
C
are horizontal, find their Subtract the x-coordinates of O and M to find that
lengths by subtracting the x-coordinates of their d1 is 8.
endpoints. Subtract the y-coordinates of L and N to find that
b1 AB 4 1 d2 is 4.
3 or 3
A ¬1
2 d1d2
b2 DC 8 1
7 or 7 ¬1
2 (8)(4) or 16
Height: Because the bases are horizontal The area of rhombus LMNO is 16 units2.
segments, the distance between them can be Examine: The rhombus is made up of two
measured on a vertical line. Subtract the M
congruent triangles with base O . Each triangle
y-coordinates. has base 8 and height 2. So the area of the
h 5 (1) or 6
Area: A ¬1
1
rhombus 2 2 8 2 16.
2 h(b1 b2)
9. N (3, 6) y
¬1
2 (6)(3 7)
¬30
The area of trapezoid ABCD is 30 units2. M (4, 2) O (2, 2)
7. y
x
A (2, 2) B (4, 2)
L (3, 2)
x
Explore: To find the area of the rhombus, we
C (3, 2) need to know the length of each diagonal.
D (1, 2)
Plan: Use coordinate geometry to find the length
of each diagonal. Use the formula to find the area
Base: Since DC and A
B
are horizontal, find their of rhombus LMNO.
lengths by subtracting the x-coordinates of their Solve: Let MO be d1 and NL be d2.
endpoints. Subtract the x-coordinates of M and O to find that
b1 DC 3 1 d1 is 2.
2 or 2 Subtract the y-coordinates of N and L to find that
d2 is 8.
b2 AB 4 (2)
6 or 6 A ¬1
2 d1d2
Height: Because the bases are horizontal ¬1
2 (2)(8) or 8
segments, the distance between them can be The area of rhombus LMNO is 8 units2.
measured on a vertical line. Subtract the Examine: The rhombus is made up of two
y-coordinates. O
congruent triangles with base M. Each triangle
h 2 (2) or 4 has base 2 and height 4.
Area: A ¬1
2 h(b1 b2)
So the area of the rhombus 2 1
2 2 4 8.
¬1
2 (4)(2 6)
¬16
The area of trapezoid ABCD is 16 units2.
T (3, 0) x 1 1
2 (6)(2) 2 (4)(6 3)
24
The area of LMNOP is 24 units2.
¬20
¬62.8 in2
To find the probability, divide the area of the
sector by the area of the circle. The area of the
circle is r2, and r ¬10.
250
¬ 9
E B 26
¬87.3 in2
To find the probability, divide the area of the
sector by the area of the circle. The area of the 13
circle is r2, and r ¬10. 60
area ofsector C
P(blue) ¬
area of circle
A D
25
0
9
The apothem is 1
2 (26) or 13. Using properties of
¬ 102
30°-60°-90° triangles, if AD x, BD x3
, so
¬25
90 or about 0.28
x3 ¬13
The probability that a random point is in the blue 13
3
x ¬
3
sectors is about 0.28.
13
3 26
3
3. Use the formula to find the total area of the sectors. Then AD 3 , AC
3 , and the perimeter
26
A ¬N 2
r is 6 3 or 523
3
.
360
80 110 A ¬1
2 Pa
¬ 360 (10 )
2
1
475 ¬2(523)(13)
¬ 9
¬338 3
¬165.8 in2
The radius of the circle is 13, so
To find the probability, divide the area of the area of shaded region
sector by the area of the circle. The area of the area of hexagon area of circle
circle is r2, and r ¬10.
338 3 (132)
area ofsector
P(green) ¬
area of circle 338 3 169
47
5
9 54.5 units2
¬
102 Probability:
19 shaded area
¬
36 or about 0.53
P(shaded) ¬
area of hexagon
The probability that a random point is in the 54.5
¬
green sectors is about 0.53. 338 3
¬0.09
4. Area of the shaded region: The area of the
The probability that a random point is in the
shaded region is the area of the large circle minus
shaded region is about 0.09.
the area of the small circle, where the radii are r1
100 units and r2 50 units. 6. Area of shaded region: The area of the shaded
area of shaded region region is the area of the triangle minus the areas
area of large circle area of small circle of the two circles.
r12 r22 Area of triangle: b ¬16 2 15
h ¬3 5 5 13
(1002) (502) 1
7500 A ¬2bh
23,561.9 units2 1
¬2 (16 215
)(13)
Area of the square: The square is 80 50 ¬154.4 units2
100 50 80 or 360 units across.
Area of circles (3)2 (5)2 ¬(32 52)
A ¬s2
¬34 units2
¬3602
¬129,600 units2 Area of shaded region ¬154.4 34 units2
¬47.6 units2
Probability:
Probability:
shaded area
P(shaded) ¬
area of
square P(shaded) ¬ shaded area
area of tri angle
0
750
¬
129,600 ¬
47.6
154.4
¬0.18 ¬0.31
The probability that a random point is in the The probability that a random point is in the
shaded region is about 0.18. shaded region is about 0.31.
3.
¬ ¬1
2 (30)(102
) 253
36 ¬255.4
a The surface area is approximately 255.4 cm2.
5. To find the surface area, first find the length of
11 22 the sides of the base. A right triangle is formed by
36
0° the slant height, the edge with length 17, and half
The central angle of the pentagon measures 5 the side of the base. Let a be one-half the side
or 72°. Let represent the measure of the angle length of the base.
formed by a radius and the apothem. Then, c2 ¬a2 b2
72
2
or 36. Use trigonometry to find the length 172 ¬a2 152
of the apothem. 289 ¬a2 225
11
tan36° ¬ a
64 ¬a2
a ¬ 11
8 ¬a
tan 36° So the side length of the base is 2(8) or 16 ft, and
¬15.14 the perimeter is 4(16) or 64 ft. Find the surface
Next, find the perimeter and area of the base. area.
P ¬5s
T ¬1
2 P B
¬5(22) or 110
B ¬1
¬1
2 (64)(15) 16
2
2 Pa
¬1
¬736
2 (110)(15.14)
The surface area is 736 ft2.1
¬832.7 2
6. Each side, including the base, is an equilateral
Finally, find the surface area.
triangle of side length 3 centimeters. The altitude
T ¬1
2 P B
3 1
of this triangle is 2 (3), or 1.5
3. Find the
¬1
2 (110)(40) 832.7
area of a side.
¬3032.7 A ¬1
2 bh
The surface area is approximately 3032.7 m2.
¬1
2 (3)(1.53
)
4. To find the surface area, first find the slant height
¬2.25 3
of the pyramid. The slant height is the altitude of
Find the total area.
a triangle with base of 10 and sides of 15.
T ¬4A
¬4(2.25 3)
¬9 3 or about 15.6
The surface area is approximately 15.6 cm2.
¬1
2 [4(0.4934) ] (0.4934)
2 2
¬2.3
The surface area is approximately 2.3 in2.
A (3, 3, 3) (3, 0, 0)
x (3, 0, 3)
( 1, 0, 0)
( 1, 2, 0)
6. • Plot the x-coordinate first. Draw a segment from
(0, 0, 0) the origin 3 units in the negative direction.
O y
( 1, 0, 3) (0, 2, 0) • To plot the y-coordinate, draw a segment 1 unit
in the positive direction.
E ( 1, 2, 3)
x
(0, 2, 3)
• To plot the z-coordinate, draw a segment 4 units
(0, 0, 3)
in the negative direction.
• Label the coordinate Y.
3. • Plot the x-coordinate first. Draw a segment from • Draw the rectangular prism and label each
the origin 3 units in the positive direction. vertex.
• To plot the y-coordinate, draw a segment 1 unit z
in the negative direction. ( 3, 0, 0)
• To plot the z-coordinate, draw a segment 2 units ( 3, 1, 0)
in the positive direction.
(0, 0, 0) y
• Label the coordinate I.
O
• Draw the rectangular prism and label each vertex. (0, 1, 0)
z Y ( 3, 1, 4)
(0, 0, 2) x
( 3, 0, 4)
(0, 1, 2) (0, 0, 4) (0, 1, 4)
(3, 0, 2)
O 7. Find the distance.
(0, 0, 0) y
I (3, 1, 2) AB ¬
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
(0, 1, 0)
(3, 1, 0) ¬
[3 (
3)]2
(3
3)2
(
1 1
)2
x (3, 0, 0)
¬76 or 219
4. • Plot the x-coordinate first. Draw a segment from Find the midpoint.
x x y y z z
the origin 2 units in the positive direction.
• To plot the y-coordinate, draw a segment 1 unit
M ¬
1
2
2 ,
1
2
2 ,
1
2
2
3
3
in the negative direction. ¬ 2 , 3 3 11
2, 2
• To plot the z-coordinate, draw a segment 3 units ¬(0, 0, 0)
in the positive direction.
8. Find the distance.
• Label the coordinate Z.
• Draw the rectangular prism and label each vertex. OP ¬ (x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
z ¬
(2
2)2
[4
(1)]2
[ 2
4 (3)]
(0, 1, 3) (0, 0, 3) ¬42
Z (2, 1, 3) Find the midpoint.
x x y y z z
(0, 1, 0) (2, 0, 3)
O M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
(0, 0, 0) y
2 2 1 4 3 4
(2, 1, 0) ¬ 2 , 2, 2
(2, 0, 0)
x ¬(0, 1.5, 3.5)
9. Find the distance.
5. • Plot the x-coordinate first. Draw a segment from DE ¬ (x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
the origin 4 units in the negative direction.
¬
(0 0
)2 [5
(5)]2
[3
(3)]2
• To plot the y-coordinate, draw a segment 2 units
in the negative direction. ¬136
or 234
• To plot the z-coordinate, draw a segment 4 units Find the midpoint.
x x y y z z
in the negative direction.
• Label the coordinate Q.
M ¬
1
2, 2, 2
2 1 2 1 2
0 0 5 5 3 3
• Draw the rectangular prism and label each vertex. ¬ 2 , 2, 2
¬(0, 0, 0)
Statements Reasons
Chapter 3 Parallel and Perpendicular
Lines 1.
MQNP
; 4 3 1. Given
2. 3 5 2. Alternate interior
Page 784 angles are congruent.
1. Alternate interior angles are congruent, so 3. 4 5 3. Transitive Property
1 2. 4. 1 4 4. Corresponding angles
2. 1 and 3 form a linear pair. are congruent.
m1 m3 ¬180 5. 1 5 5. Transitive Property
75 m3 ¬180
m3 ¬105
3. 2 and 4 form a linear pair.
m2 m4 ¬180
75 m4 ¬180
m4 ¬105
CA CA
Reflexive Prop.
P Q
C
1.
PH bisects YHX. 1. Given
2. YHP XHP 2. Definition of angle
bisector O
3.
PHY X
3. Given
4. YPH and XPH 4. Definition of 4. For each of the triangle’s three angles, use the
are right angles. perpendicular lines compass and straightedge to construct the angle
5. YPH XPH 5. All right angles are bisector. The point where all three angle bisectors
congruent. intersect is the incenter.
6. Y X 6. Third Angle Theorem
X
7. HH Y
7. Converse of the
Isosceles Triangle K
Theorem
5. Explore: The angle measures are unknown, but
8. YHX is an 8. Definition of isosceles
information is given about relationships among
isosceles triangle. triangle
the three measures.
10. Given: ABC is a right y Plan: Write and solve a system of equations with
isosceles triangle. the three angle measures as variables.
B (0, a)
M is the midpoint Solve: Let x mA, y mB, and z mC.
B
of A. M Solve the following system, which represents the
M
Prove: C A B information given in the problem and also uses
the Angle Sum Theorem:
C (0, 0) A (a, 0) x xy2
Proof: Place the triangle so z 2y 14
that the vertices are A(a, 0), B(0, a), and C(0, 0). x y z 180
By the Midpoint Formula, the coordinates of M are Use the first two equations to make substitutions
0
a a0
2 , 2 or 2, 2.
a a in the third equation.
(y 2) y (2y 14) ¬180
B
Find the slopes of A and CM
. 4y 12 ¬180
0 a a
B
Slope of A a0 a 1 4y ¬192
a
0 a
y ¬48
M
Slope of C
2
a
2
a
1 Find x and z.
0
2 2
xy2
The product of the slopes is 1, so C
M
A
B
.
48 2 or 50
47
light 6500 station
Use trigonometry to find h.
C
7. Given: KLMN
Prove: PQRS is a rectangle.
Proof: K L
Statements Reasons P
Q
1. ABCD, A
E
C
F 1. Given S
Opp. sides of a are . R
2. B
AD C
2.
3. A C 3. Opp. of a are . N M
4. BAE DCF 4. SAS Proof: The diagram indicates that KNS
5. B
E DF
, 5. CPCTC SNM MLQ QLK and NKS SKL
BEA DFC LMQ QMN in KLMN. Since KLR,
C
6. B A
D
6. Def. of KNS, MLQ, and MNP all have two angles
7. DFC FDE 7. Alt. Int. Angles Th. congruent, the third angles are congruent by the
8. BEA FDE Third Angle Theorem. So QRS KSN
8. Transitive Property
MQL SPQ. Since they are vertical angles,
B
9. ED
F
9. Corresponding Angles KSN PSR and MQL PQR. Therefore,
Postulate QRS PSR PQR SPQ. PQRS is a
10. Quadrilateral 10. If one pair of opp. parallelogram since if both pairs of opposite
EBFD is a sides is and , then angles are congruent, the quadrilateral is a
parallelogram. the quad. is a . parallelogram. KSN and KSP form a linear
pair and are therefore supplementary angles.
5. The legs are made so that they will bisect each KSP and PSR form a linear pair and are
other, so the quadrilateral formed by the ends of supplementary angles. Therefore, KSN and
the legs is always a parallelogram. Therefore, the PSR are supplementary. Since they are also
top of the stand is parallel to the floor. congruent, each is a right angle. If a
6. Given: WXZY, 1 and 2 are complementary. parallelogram has one right angle, it has four
Prove: WXZY is a rectangle. right angles. Therefore, PQRS is a rectangle.
W Y 8. Sample answer: He should measure the angles at
1 the vertices to see if they are 90 or he can check
2 to see if the diagonals are congruent.
X Z 9. The legs of the trapezoids are part of the
diagonals of the square. The diagonals of a square
Proof: bisect opposite angles, so each base angle of a
trapezoid measures 45°. One pair of sides is
Statements Reasons
parallel and the base angles are congruent.
1. WXZY, 1 and 2 1. Given
10. Since the perimeter of the floor tile is 48 inches,
are complementary 4
8
the measure of each side is 4 or 12 inches.
2. m1 m2 90 2. Def. of Similarly, the measure of each side of the red
complementary square is 4 inches. So, the sum of the measures of
3. m1 m2 3. Angle Sum the bases of a trapezoid is 12 4 or 16 inches.
mX 180 Theorem The trapezoids are isosceles, so the lengths of the
4. 90 mX 180 4. Substitution two remaining sides are the same. We need the
height of a trapezoid to find the lengths of the
5. mX 90 5. Subtraction
remaining sides. Since the heights of the
6. X Y 6. Opp. of a
trapezoids are identical, the sum of twice the
are .
height of the trapezoid and the width of the red
7. mY 90 7. Substitution square is equal to width of the floor tile or 12
8. X and XWY are 8. Cons. in are inches. Find the height of a trapezoid.
suppl. X and XZY suppl. 2h 4 ¬12
are suppl. 2h ¬8
9. mX mXWY 180 9. Def. of suppl. h ¬4
mX mXZY 180 The height of a trapezoid is 4 inches. Notice that
10. 90 mXWY 180 10. Substitution the height and side of a trapezoid and one third of
90 mXZY 180 12
the side of the floor tile 3 or 4 inches form a
plane.
3
0 y
tan ¬
190
3
0
¬tan1
190
O x
¬9.0°
The resultant direction of the plane is about
9.0° west of due south. Therefore, the resultant
velocity and direction of the plane is about
192.4 miles per hour at about 9.0° west of due south.
10 1
will produce
0
11. Sample answer: The matrix
1 0
y-axis. Then the matrix will produce the
0 1
vertices for a reflection of the second figure in the Page 791
x-axis. This figure will be upside down. 1. Since the tire travels about 50.21 inches during
one rotation of the wheel, the circumference of the
10
0
12. The matrix will produce the vertices for tire is 50.21 inches. The circumference of a circle
1
is related to its diameter by C
d, so the
a 180° rotation about the origin. The figure will be
upside down and in Quadrant III. diameter is d C 50.27
or about 16 inches.
13. The matrix for Exercise 12 has the first row 2. The total number of students surveyed is equal to
entries for the first matrix used in Exercise 11 the sum of the numbers in the column on the
and the second row entries for the second matrix right.
used in 11. 910 234 624 364 468 2600
The number of students that participated in the
14. The vertex matrix for the figure in Quadrant I is
survey was 2600.
4 5 7 5 4 3 1 3 reason.
0 1 6 4 4 1 2 1 4 4
Number of
4 5 7 5 4 3 1 3
Or use the rotation matrix to obtain the vertex Seek potential for
624 86.4°
matrix. human inhabitance
1 0
Increase human
468 64.8°
4 4 1 2 1 4 4 knowledge
x
H
Proof:
Statements Reasons First, find x.
30 x ¬50 50
1.
MHT is a 1. Given 2
50
semicircle, x ¬30
RHT M x ¬83.3
2. THM is a rt. . 2. If an inscribed The diameter of the circle is about 30 83.3 or
intercepts a semicircle, 113.3 cm, so the radius of the circle that contains
113.3
the is a rt. . the arch is about
2 or 56.7 cm.
3. TRH is a rt. . 3. Def. of lines 10. The diameter of Earth is 7,926 miles, so the radius
7,9
26
4. THM TRH 4. All rt. are . of Earth is 2 or 3,963 miles. Since 80% of the
5. T T 5. Reflexive Property space junk orbits Earth at a distance of 1,200
6. TRH THM 6. AA Similarity miles, the radius of the orbit is 1,200 3,963 or
TR TH 5,163 miles. The equation of a circle with center
7. 7. Def. of s
RH HM (0, 0) and radius of r units is given by x2 y2 r2.
So, assuming that the orbit is circular, an
equation that models the orbit of 80% of space
junk with Earth’s center at the origin is
x2 y2 26,656,569.
18
2 1
4 (18) (28 5 12 2)
2 2
(216 9106
9162 )
(216 9106
812 ) 1330
The surface area of the bin is
(216 9106
812) 1330 ft2.
60
9. The globe is a sphere. Find the surface area of a
3 3
sphere of diameter 16 inches.
T 4
r2 Apothem: In a 30°-60°-90° triangle, if the side
2 opposite the 30° angle is x units long, the side
4
d
2 opposite the 60° angle is x3 units long. Here the
d2 apothem of the hexagon measures 33 inches.
(16)2 Area: A 1
2 Pa
256
804.2 1
2 (36)(33
)
The surface area of the globe is about 804.2 in.2. 543
10. Earth is a sphere. Find the surface area of a Now find the volume of air.
sphere of diameter 7926 miles. Fully expanded: The bellows of the concertina is
T 4
r2 36 2 2 32 inches tall.
2
4
d
2
V Bh
d2 (543 )(32)
(7926)2 2993.0
197,359,487.5 Compressed: The bellows of the concertina is
The surface area of Earth is 197,359,487.5 mi2. 7 2 2 3 inches tall.
11. The ratio of the surface area of the globe to that V Bh
of Earth is equal to the ratio of the surface area of (543 )(3)
Africa on the globe to that of Africa on the Earth. 280.6
Let x be the surface area of Africa on the globe. So, the volume of air in the concertina is
Find x. 2993.0 in3 when fully expanded and 280.6 in3
x 256
when compressed.
11,700,000 ¬197,359
,487.5 4. Each cell has a radius of 1
2 (75) or 37.5 ft. Find the
256
(11,700,000) volume of one cell.
x ¬
197,359,487.5
V
r2h
x ¬47.7
(37.5)2(210)
About 47.7 in.2 will be used to represent Africa on 295,312.5
the globe.
4 OT
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
3
(0.75)
3
1.8
(3 0)
2 (
8 0)2
(
1 0)2
The volume is approximately 1.8 in3. 74
8. Write the ratio of the corresponding measures of OR
(x2
x1)2
(y2
y1)2
(z2
z1)2
the spheres. 165 feet equals 12(165) or 1980
(7
0)2
(4
0)2
(2
0)2
inches.
diameter of the larger sphere
69
198 0
1.5 The star located at S is farthest from the center of
diameter of the smaller sphere
1320 the room.
1
The scale factor is 1320 to 1.